This is a modern-English version of First Principles, originally written by Spencer, Herbert.
It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling,
and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If
you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.
Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.
Transcriber's Note:
Transcriber's Note:
The cover image was created by the transcriber and is placed in the public domain.
The cover image was created by the transcriber and is now in the public domain.
FIRST
PRINCIPLES.
PREFACE.
This volume is the first of a series described in a prospectus originally distributed in March, 1860. Of that prospectus, the annexed is a reprint.
This book is the first in a series outlined in a brochure that was first distributed in March 1860. The attached is a reprint of that brochure.
A philosophy system.
Mr. Herbert Spencer proposes to issue in periodical parts a connected series of works which he has for several years been preparing. Some conception of the general aim and scope of this series may be gathered from the following Programme.
Mr. Herbert Spencer plans to release a connected series of works in regular installments that he has been preparing for several years. You can get an idea of the overall goal and scope of this series from the following Program.
First Principles.
Part I. The Unknowable.—Carrying a step further the doctrine put into shape by Hamilton and Mansel; pointing out the various directions in which Science leads to the same conclusions; and showing that in this united belief in an Absolute that transcends not only human knowledge but human conception, lies the only possible reconciliation of Science and Religion.
Part I. The Unknown.—Expanding on the ideas developed by Hamilton and Mansel; highlighting the different ways Science reaches the same conclusions; and demonstrating that this shared belief in an Absolute that goes beyond both human understanding and imagination is the only way to reconcile Science and Religion.
Part II. Laws of the Knowable.—A statement of the ultimate principles discernible throughout all manifestations of the Absolute—those highest generalizations now being disclosed by Science which are severally true not of one class of phenomena but of all classes of phenomena; and which are thus the keys to all classes of phenomena.[1]
Part II. Laws of the Understandable.—A description of the core principles that can be seen across all expressions of the Absolute—those highest generalizations currently revealed by Science that are true not just for one type of phenomenon but for all types of phenomena; and which serve as the keys to understanding all types of phenomena.[1]
vi[In logical order should here come the application of these First Principles to Inorganic Nature. But this great division it is proposed to pass over: partly because, even without it, the scheme is too extensive; and partly because the interpretation of Organic Nature after the proposed method, is of more immediate importance. The second work of the series will therefore be—]
vi[In logical order, this is where the application of these First Principles to Inorganic Nature should be. However, we propose to skip this large section: partly because the overall scheme is already too broad, and partly because applying the proposed method to Organic Nature is of more immediate significance. Therefore, the second work in the series will be—]
The Principles of Biology.
Vol. 1.
Part I. The Data of Biology.—Including those general truths of Physics and Chemistry with which rational Biology must set out.
Part I. The Data of Biology.—Including the fundamental concepts of Physics and Chemistry that rational Biology must begin with.
II. The Inductions of Biology.—A statement of the leading generalizations which Naturalists, Physiologists, and Comparative Anatomists, have established.
II. The Inductions of Biology.—A summary of the main principles that Naturalists, Physiologists, and Comparative Anatomy experts have developed.
III. The Evolution of Life.—Concerning the speculation commonly known as “The Development Hypothesis”—its à priori and à posteriori evidences.
III. The Evolution of Life.—Regarding the idea commonly referred to as “The Development Hypothesis”—its a priori and after the fact evidence.
Vol. 2.
IV. Morphological Development.—Pointing out the relations that are everywhere traceable between organic forms and the average of the various forces to which they are subject; and seeking in the cumulative effects of such forces a theory of the forms.
IV. Morphological Development.—Highlighting the connections that can be found everywhere between living forms and the overall range of different forces they are exposed to; and looking for a theory of these forms in the combined effects of such forces.
V. Physiological Development.—The progressive differentiation of functions similarly traced; and similarly interpreted as consequent upon the exposure of different parts of organisms to different sets of conditions.
V. Physical Development.—The gradual specialization of functions is similarly noted and understood as resulting from the exposure of various parts of organisms to different sets of conditions.
VI. The Laws of Multiplication.—Generalizations respecting the rates of reproduction of the various classes of plants and animals; followed by an attempt to show the dependence of these variations upon certain necessary causes.[2]
VI. The Rules of Multiplication.—General ideas about the reproduction rates of different plant and animal classes; followed by an effort to demonstrate how these variations depend on certain essential factors.[2]
Psychology Principles.
Vol. 1.
Part I. The Data of Psychology.—Treating of the general connexions of Mind and Life and their relations to other modes of the Unknowable.
Part I. The Data of Psychology.—Discussing the overall connections between Mind and Life and how they relate to other forms of the Unknowable.
II. The Inductions of Psychology.—A digest of such generalizations respecting mental phenomena as have already been empirically established.
II. The Fundamentals of Psychology.—A summary of the generalizations about mental phenomena that have already been established through observation.
III. General Synthesis.—A republication, with additional chapters, of the same part in the already-published The Principles of Psychology.
III. Overview.—A new edition, with extra chapters, of the same section in the previously released The Principles of Psychology.
IV. Special Synthesis.—A republication, with extensive revisions and additions, of the same part, &c. &c.
IV. Special Synthesis.—A re-release, with significant updates and new content, of the same section, etc. etc.
V. Physical Synthesis.—An attempt to show the manner in which the succession of states of consciousness conforms to a certain fundamental law of nervous action that follows from the First Principles laid down at the outset.
V. Physical Synthesis.—This section aims to explain how the sequence of states of consciousness adheres to a specific fundamental law of nervous action that stems from the First Principles established at the beginning.
Vol. 2.
VI. Special Analysis.—As at present published, but further elaborated by some additional chapters.
VI. Special Analysis.—As currently published, but expanded with some extra chapters.
VII. General Analysis.—As at present published, with several explanations and additions.
VII. Overall Analysis.—As currently published, with various explanations and additions.
VIII. Corollaries.—Consisting in part of a number of derivative principles which form a necessary introduction to Sociology.[3]
VIII. Conclusions.—This includes several related principles that are essential for understanding Sociology.[3]
Sociology Principles.
Vol. 1.
Part I. The Data of Sociology.—A statement of the several sets of factors entering into social phenomena—human ideas and feelings considered in their necessary order of evolution; surrounding natural conditions; and those ever complicating conditions to which Society itself gives origin.
Part I. The Basics of Sociology.—A description of the various factors involved in social phenomena—human ideas and emotions viewed in their essential order of development; the natural conditions around us; and those complex factors that Society itself creates.
II. The Inductions of Sociology.—General facts, structural and functional, as gathered from a survey of Societies and their changes: in viiiother words, the empirical generalizations that are arrived at by comparing different societies, and successive phases of the same society.
II. The Inductions of Sociology.—General facts, both structural and functional, collected from examining societies and how they change: in other words, the empirical insights gained by comparing different societies and various stages of the same society.
III. Political Organization.—The evolution of governments, general and local, as determined by natural causes; their several types and metamorphoses; their increasing complexity and specialization; and the progressive limitation of their functions.
III. Political Structure.—The development of governments, both general and local, shaped by natural factors; their various types and transformations; their growing complexity and specialization; and the ongoing restriction of their roles.
Vol. 2.
IV. Ecclesiastical Organization.—Tracing the differentiation of religious government from secular; its successive complications and the multiplication of sects; the growth and continued modification of religious ideas, as caused by advancing knowledge and changing moral character; and the gradual reconciliation of these ideas with the truths of abstract science.
IV. Church Organization.—Examining the separation of religious authority from political power; the ongoing complexities and the increase in different sects; the evolution and consistent transformation of religious beliefs driven by advancing knowledge and shifting moral values; and the gradual alignment of these beliefs with the principles of abstract science.
V. Ceremonial Organization.—The natural history of that third kind of government which, having a common root with the others, and slowly becoming separate from and supplementary to them, serves to regulate the minor actions of life.
V. Event Planning.—The natural history of that third type of government which, sharing a common origin with the others, gradually becomes distinct from and adds to them, helps to manage the minor aspects of life.
VI. Industrial Organization.—The development of productive and distributive agencies, considered, like the foregoing, in its necessary causes: comprehending not only the progressive division of labour, and the increasing complexity of each industrial agency, but also the successive forms of industrial government as passing through like phases with political government.
VI. Industrial Organization.—The growth of production and distribution systems, examined, like the previous sections, in terms of its essential causes: including not just the evolving division of labor and the increasing complexity of each industrial entity, but also the various forms of industrial governance that change alongside political governance.
Vol. 3.
VII. Lingual Progress.—The evolution of Languages regarded as a psychological process determined by social conditions.
VII. Language Development.—The evolution of languages seen as a psychological process influenced by social conditions.
VIII. Intellectual Progress.—Treated from the same point of view: including the growth of classifications; the evolution of science out of common knowledge; the advance from qualitative to quantitative prevision, from the indefinite to the definite, and from the concrete to the abstract.
VIII. Intellectual Advancement.—Discussed from the same perspective: covering the development of classifications; the evolution of science from basic knowledge; the shift from qualitative to quantitative understanding, from the vague to the specific, and from the tangible to the abstract.
IX. Æsthetic Progress.—The Fine Arts similarly dealt with: tracing their gradual differentiation from primitive institutions and from each other; their increasing varieties of development; and their advance in reality of expression and superiority of aim.
IX. Aesthetic Development.—The Fine Arts also focused on: tracing their gradual separation from primitive institutions and from one another; their growing diversity in development; and their progress in authenticity of expression and higher objectives.
X. Moral Progress.—Exhibiting the genesis of the slow emotional modifications which human nature undergoes in its adaptation to the social state.
X. Ethical Advancement.—Showing the origins of the gradual emotional changes that human nature experiences as it adjusts to social conditions.
ixXI. The Consensus.—Treating of the necessary interdependence of structures and of functions in each type of society, and in the successive phases of social development.[4]
ixXI. The Agreement.—Discussing the essential connection between structures and functions in every type of society, and across the various stages of social development.[4]
Moral Principles.
Vol. 1.
Part I. The Data of Morality.—Generalizations furnished by Biology, Psychology and Sociology, which underlie a true theory of right living: in other words, the elements of that equilibrium between constitution and conditions of existence, which is at once the moral ideal and the limit towards which we are progressing.
Part I. The Data of Morality.—Insights provided by Biology, Psychology, and Sociology, which form the basis of a genuine understanding of how to live rightly: in other words, the components of the balance between our nature and the circumstances of our lives, which represents both the moral ideal and the goal we are striving to achieve.
II. The Inductions of Morality.—Those empirically-established rules of human action which are registered as essential laws by all civilized nations: that is to say—the generalizations of expediency.
II. The Foundations of Morality.—Those rules of human behavior that are recognized as fundamental laws by all civilized nations: in other words—the general principles of practicality.
III. Personal Morals.—The principles of private conduct—physical, intellectual, moral and religious—that follow from the conditions to complete individual life: or, what is the same thing—those modes of private action which must result from the eventual equilibration of internal desires and external needs.
III. Personal Ethics.—The principles of personal behavior—physical, intellectual, moral, and spiritual—that arise from the conditions necessary for a full individual life: or, in other words, those ways of acting privately that must come from balancing our inner desires with our external needs.
Vol. 2.
IV. Justice.—The mutual limitations of men’s actions necessitated by their co-existence as units of a society—limitations, the perfect observance of which constitutes that state of equilibrium forming the goal of political progress.
IV. Justice.—The boundaries that individuals must respect due to their existence together in a society—boundaries that, when fully honored, create the balance that is the aim of political advancement.
V. Negative Beneficence.—Those secondary limitations, similarly necessitated, which, though less important and not cognizable by law, are yet requisite to prevent mutual destruction of happiness in various indirect ways: in other words—those minor self-restraints dictated by what may be called passive sympathy.
V. Harmful Non-maleficence.—These secondary limitations, which are also necessary, though less significant and not recognized by law, are still required to avoid the mutual destruction of happiness in various indirect ways: in other words—those small acts of self-restraint driven by what could be described as passive sympathy.
xVI. Positive Beneficence.—Comprehending all modes of conduct, dictated by active sympathy, which imply pleasure in giving pleasure—modes of conduct that social adaptation has induced and must render ever more general; and which, in becoming universal, must fill to the full the possible measure of human happiness.[5]
xVI. Positive Benefit.—Understanding all the ways of behaving that come from genuine empathy and involve joy in bringing joy to others—behaviors that social adjustment has encouraged and should continue to expand; and which, by becoming widespread, should maximize the potential for human happiness.[5]
In anticipation of the obvious criticism that the scheme here sketched out is too extensive, it may be remarked that an exhaustive treatment of each topic is not intended; but simply the establishment of principles, with such illustrations as are needed to make their bearings fully understood. It may also be pointed out that, besides minor fragments, one large division (The Principles of Psychology) is already, in great part, executed. And a further reply is, that impossible though it may prove to execute the whole, yet nothing can be said against an attempt to set forth the First Principles and to carry their applications as far as circumstances permit.
In anticipation of the obvious criticism that the plan outlined here is too broad, it should be noted that a comprehensive treatment of each topic isn’t the goal; instead, it’s simply to establish principles, with enough examples to clarify their relevance. It’s also worth mentioning that, aside from some smaller segments, one major section (The Principles of Psychology) is already mostly completed. Additionally, even though it may be unrealistic to cover everything, there’s nothing wrong with trying to present the First Principles and explore their applications as much as the situation allows.
The price per Number to be half-a-crown; that is to say, the four Numbers yearly issued to be severally delivered, post free, to all annual subscribers of Ten Shillings.
The price for each Number will be two shillings and sixpence; that is to say, the four Numbers released each year will be delivered individually, postage included, to all annual subscribers who pay Ten Shillings.
This Programme I have thought well to reprint for two reasons:—the one being that readers may, from time to time, be able to ascertain what topics are next to be dealt with; the other being that an outline of the scheme may remain, in case it should never be completed.
This Program, I've decided to reprint for two reasons: first, so readers can periodically see which topics will be addressed next; second, to provide an outline of the plan in case it never gets completed.
The successive instalments of which this volume consists, were issued to the subscribers at the following dates:—Part I. (pp. 1–80) in October, 1860; Part II. (pp. 81–176) in January, 1861; Part III. (pp. 177–256) in April, 1861; Part IV. (pp. 257–334) in October, 1861; Part V. (pp. 335–416) in March, 1862; and Part VI. (pp. 417–504) in June, 1862.
The parts that make up this volume were sent to subscribers on the following dates: Part I. (pp. 1–80) in October 1860; Part II. (pp. 81–176) in January 1861; Part III. (pp. 177–256) in April 1861; Part IV. (pp. 257–334) in October 1861; Part V. (pp. 335–416) in March 1862; and Part VI. (pp. 417–504) in June 1862.
London, June 5th, 1862
London, June 5, 1862
1. One of these generalizations is that currently known as “the Conservation of Force;” a second may be gathered from a published essay on “Progress: its Law and Cause;” a third is indicated in a paper on “Transcendental Physiology;” and there are several others.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.One of these general ideas is known today as “the Conservation of Force;” a second can be found in a published essay on “Progress: its Law and Cause;” a third is mentioned in a paper on “Transcendental Physiology;” and there are several others.
2. The ideas to be developed in the second volume of the Principles of Biology the writer has already briefly expressed in sundry Review-Articles. Part IV. will work out a doctrine suggested in a paper on “The Laws of Organic Form,” published in the Medico-Chirurgical Review for January, 1859. The germ of Part V. is contained in the essay on “Transcendental Physiology:” See Essays, pp. 280–90. And in Part VI. will be unfolded certain views crudely expressed in a “Theory of Population,” published in the Westminster Review for April, 1852.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.The ideas that will be developed in the second volume of the Principles of Biology have already been briefly discussed in various review articles. Part IV will expand on a concept introduced in a paper titled “The Laws of Organic Form,” which was published in the Medico-Chirurgical Review in January 1859. The foundation for Part V is found in the essay “Transcendental Physiology:” See Essays, pp. 280–90. In Part VI, some ideas that were expressed in a basic way in a “Theory of Population,” published in the Westminster Review in April 1852, will be elaborated upon.
3. Respecting the several additions to be made to the Principles of Psychology, it seems needful only to say that Part V. is the unwritten division named in the preface to that work—a division of which the germ is contained in a note on page 544, and of which the scope has since been more definitely stated in a paper in the Medico-Chirurgical Review for Jan. 1859.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Regarding the additional sections to be included in the Principles of Psychology, it's only necessary to mention that Part V. is the unwritten section referred to in the preface of that work—this section has its beginnings in a note on page 544, and its details have been clarified in a paper published in the Medico-Chirurgical Review for January 1859.
4. Of this treatise on Sociology a few small fragments may be found in already-published essays. Some of the ideas to be developed in Part II. are indicated in an article on “The Social Organism,” contained in the last number of the Westminster Review; those which Part V. will work out, may be gathered from the first half of a paper written some years since on “Manners and Fashion;” of Part VIII. the germs are contained in an article on the “Genesis of Science;” two papers on “The Origin and Function of Music” and “The Philosophy of Style,” contain some ideas to be embodied in Part IX.; and from a criticism of Mr. Bain’s work on “The Emotions and the Will,” in the last number of the Medico-Chirurgical Review, the central idea to be developed in Part X. may be inferred.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.In this sociology treatise, you'll find a few excerpts in essays that have already been published. Some ideas that will be expanded in Part II. are highlighted in an article called “The Social Organism,” featured in the latest issue of the Westminster Review; the concepts that Part V. will explore can be found in the first half of a paper written years ago on “Manners and Fashion.” The foundational ideas for Part VIII. are in an article about the “Genesis of Science.” Two papers on “The Origin and Function of Music” and “The Philosophy of Style” include ideas that will be developed in Part IX.; and from a critique of Mr. Bain’s work on “The Emotions and the Will,” published in the latest issue of the Medico-Chirurgical Review, you can infer the central idea that will be explored in Part X.
5. Part IV. of the Principles of Morality will be co-extensive (though not identical) with the first half of the writer’s Social Statics.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Part IV of the Principles of Morality will cover the same topics (though not exactly) as the first half of the writer’s Social Statics.
CONTENTS.
PART I.—THE UNKNOWABLE. | ||
---|---|---|
CHAP. | PAGE | |
I.— | RELIGION AND SCIENCE | 3 |
II.— | ULTIMATE RELIGIOUS IDEAS | 25 |
III.— | ULTIMATE SCIENTIFIC IDEAS | 47 |
IV.— | THE RELATIVITY OF ALL KNOWLEDGE | 68 |
V.— | THE RECONCILIATION | 98 |
PART II.—LAWS OF THE KNOWABLE. | ||
I.— | LAWS IN GENERAL | 127 |
II.— | THE LAW OF EVOLUTION | 146 |
III.— | THE LAW OF EVOLUTION (CONTINUED) | 175 |
IV.— | THE CAUSES OF EVOLUTION | 219 |
V.— | SPACE, TIME, MATTER, MOTION, AND FORCE | 224 |
VI.— | THE INDESTRUCTIBILITY OF MATTER | 238 |
VII.— | THE CONTINUITY OF MOTION | 246 |
VIII.— | THE PERSISTENCE OF FORCE | 251 |
IX.— | THE CORRELATION AND EQUIVALENCE OF FORCES | 259 |
xiiX.— | THE DIRECTION OF MOTION | 286 |
XI.— | THE RHYTHM OF MOTION | 313 |
XII.— | THE CONDITIONS ESSENTIAL TO EVOLUTION | 335 |
XIII.— | THE INSTABILITY OF THE HOMOGENEOUS | 358 |
XIV.— | THE MULTIPLICATION OF EFFECTS | 388 |
XV.— | DIFFERENTIATION AND INTEGRATION | 416 |
VI.— | EQUILIBRATION | 440 |
XVII.— | SUMMARY AND CONCLUSION | 487 |
PART I.
THE UNKNOWN.
CHAPTER I.
Religion and Science.
§ 1. We too often forget that not only is there “a soul of goodness in things evil,” but very generally also, a soul of truth in things erroneous. While many admit the abstract probability that a falsity has usually a nucleus of reality, few bear this abstract probability in mind, when passing judgment on the opinions of others. A belief that is finally proved to be grossly at variance with fact, is cast aside with indignation or contempt; and in the heat of antagonism scarcely any one inquires what there was in this belief which commended it to men’s minds. Yet there must have been something. And there is reason to suspect that this something was its correspondence with certain of their experiences: an extremely limited or vague correspondence perhaps; but still, a correspondence. Even the absurdest report may in nearly every instance be traced to an actual occurrence; and had there been no such actual occurrence, this preposterous misrepresentation of it would never have existed. Though the distorted or magnified image transmitted to us through the refracting medium of rumour, is utterly unlike the reality; yet in the absence of the reality there would have been no distorted or magnified image. And thus it is with human beliefs in general. Entirely wrong as they may appear, the implication is that they germinated out of actual experiences—originally contained, and perhaps still contain, some small amount of verity.
§ 1. We often forget that not only is there “a soul of goodness in things evil,” but generally, there's also a soul of truth in things that are incorrect. While many acknowledge the general idea that a falsehood often has a kernel of reality, few remember this when judging the opinions of others. A belief that is ultimately shown to be grossly different from the truth is dismissed with anger or disdain; and in the heat of disagreement, hardly anyone asks what made this belief appealing to people. But there must have been something. It’s reasonable to suspect that this something matched certain of their experiences: perhaps a very limited or vague connection, but still, a connection. Even the most absurd story can usually be traced back to an actual event; without such an occurrence, this ridiculous distortion wouldn’t have existed. Although the warped or exaggerated image conveyed to us through the lens of rumor is completely unlike the reality, without that reality, there would have been no distorted or exaggerated image. And that’s how it is with human beliefs in general. Completely wrong as they may seem, they imply that they sprouted from real experiences—originally contained some amount of truth, and perhaps still do.
4More especially may we safely assume this, in the case of beliefs that have long existed and are widely diffused; and most of all so, in the case of beliefs that are perennial and nearly or quite universal. The presumption that any current opinion is not wholly false, gains in strength according to the number of its adherents. Admitting, as we must, that life is impossible unless through a certain agreement between internal convictions and external circumstances; admitting therefore that the probabilities are always in favour of the truth, or at least the partial truth, of a conviction; we must admit that the convictions entertained by many minds in common are the most likely to have some foundation. The elimination of individual errors of thought, must give to the resulting judgment a certain additional value. It may indeed be urged that many widely-spread beliefs are received on authority; that those entertaining them make no attempts at verification; and hence it may be inferred that the multitude of adherents adds but little to the probability of a belief. But this is not true. For a belief which gains extensive reception without critical examination, is thereby proved to have a general congruity with the various other beliefs of those who receive it; and in so far as these various other beliefs are based upon personal observation and judgment, they give an indirect warrant to one with which they harmonize. It may be that this warrant is of small value; but still it is of some value.
4We can safely assume this, especially for beliefs that have been around for a long time and are widely accepted; and even more so for beliefs that are enduring and almost universal. The idea that any popular opinion isn't completely wrong becomes stronger with the number of people who support it. Accepting that life is impossible without some agreement between our internal beliefs and external realities; therefore, acknowledging that the odds generally favor the truth—or at least a partial truth—of a belief; we must recognize that beliefs shared by many are likely to have some basis in reality. Removing individual errors in thinking adds some value to the resulting judgment. It could be argued that many widespread beliefs are based on authority, and the people who hold them don't verify them, suggesting that having a lot of followers doesn’t significantly boost a belief's credibility. But that isn’t accurate. A belief that gains widespread acceptance without critical scrutiny shows it aligns well with the diverse beliefs of those who accept it; and as far as those various beliefs are based on personal experiences and judgments, they provide indirect support for the belief that fits well with them. This support may not be very strong, but it still holds some value.
Could we reach definite views on this matter, they would be extremely useful to us. It is important that we should, if possible, form something like a general theory of current opinions; so that we may neither over-estimate nor under-estimate their worth. Arriving at correct judgments on disputed questions, much depends on the attitude of mind we preserve while listening to, or taking part in, the controversy; and for the preservation of a right attitude, it is needful that we should learn how true, and yet how untrue, are average human beliefs. On the one hand, we must keep free from 5that bias in favour of received ideas which expresses itself in such dogmas as “What every one says must be true,” or “The voice of the people is the voice of God.” On the other hand, the fact disclosed by a survey of the past, that majorities have usually been wrong, must not blind us to the complementary fact, that majorities have usually not been entirely wrong. And the avoidance of these extremes being a prerequisite to catholic thinking, we shall do well to provide ourselves with a safe-guard against them, by making a valuation of opinions in the abstract. To this end we must contemplate the kind of relation that ordinarily subsists between opinions and facts. Let us do so with one of those beliefs which under various forms has prevailed among all nations in all times.
If we could come to clear conclusions on this topic, it would be really helpful for us. It's important to try to create a general theory of current opinions so that we don't either overrate or underrate their value. Getting accurate judgments on contentious issues relies a lot on the mindset we maintain while engaging in or listening to the debate; to maintain the right mindset, we need to understand how true, and yet how untrue, average human beliefs are. On one hand, we must avoid the bias towards accepted ideas that shows up in sayings like “What everyone says must be true” or “The voice of the people is the voice of God.” On the other hand, looking back at history shows us that majorities have often been wrong, but we shouldn't ignore the fact that majorities have usually not been entirely wrong. Avoiding these extremes is essential for broad-minded thinking, so it’s wise to protect ourselves against them by assessing opinions in general. To do this, we need to consider the typical relationship between opinions and facts. Let’s examine one of those beliefs that has existed in various forms across all nations at all times.
§ 2. The earliest traditions represent rulers as gods or demigods. By their subjects, primitive kings were regarded as superhuman in origin, and superhuman in power. They possessed divine titles; received obeisances like those made before the altars of deities; and were in some cases actually worshipped. If there needs proof that the divine and half-divine characters originally ascribed to monarchs were ascribed literally, we have it in the fact that there are still existing savage races, among whom it is held that the chiefs and their kindred are of celestial origin, or, as elsewhere, that only the chiefs have souls. And of course along with beliefs of this kind, there existed a belief in the unlimited power of the ruler over his subjects—an absolute possession of them, extending even to the taking of their lives at will: as even still in Fiji, where a victim stands unbound to be killed at the word of his chief; himself declaring, “whatever the king says must be done.”
§ 2. The earliest traditions depict rulers as gods or demigods. To their subjects, primitive kings were seen as superhuman in both origin and power. They held divine titles, received reverence similar to that shown before the altars of deities, and in some cases, were even worshipped. If we need evidence that the divine and semi-divine qualities originally attributed to monarchs were taken literally, we can see it in existing primitive societies, where chiefs and their families are believed to have celestial origins, or where only chiefs are thought to have souls. Naturally, alongside these beliefs, there was also a belief in the ruler's absolute power over their subjects—essentially owning them, including the power to take their lives at will. This is still evident in Fiji, where a victim stands unbound to be killed at the command of their chief, who states, “whatever the king says must be done.”
In times and among races somewhat less barbarous, we find these beliefs a little modified. The monarch, instead of being literally thought god or demigod, is conceived to be a man having divine authority, with perhaps more or less of divine 6nature. He retains however, as in the East to the present day, titles expressing his heavenly descent or relationships; and is still saluted in forms and words as humble as those addressed to the Deity. While the lives and properties of his people, if not practically so completely at his mercy, are still in theory supposed to be his.
In less barbaric times and among more civilized societies, we see these beliefs evolve slightly. The monarch is no longer viewed as a literal god or demigod but is seen as a man with divine authority, perhaps possessing some divine qualities. He still keeps titles that reflect his heavenly origins or connections, and people continue to greet him in ways similar to how they would address a Deity. Although the lives and properties of his subjects are not entirely under his control, they are still theoretically considered to belong to him.
Later in the progress of civilization, as during the middle ages in Europe, the current opinions respecting the relationship of rulers and ruled are further changed. For the theory of divine origin, there is substituted that of divine right. No longer god or demigod, or even god-descended, the king is now regarded as simply God’s vice-gerent. The obeisances made to him are not so extreme in their humility; and his sacred titles lose much of their meaning. Moreover his authority ceases to be unlimited. Subjects deny his right to dispose at will of their lives and properties; and yield allegiance only in the shape of obedience to his commands.
Later in the development of civilization, particularly during the Middle Ages in Europe, people's views on the relationship between rulers and the ruled underwent significant changes. The theory of divine origin was replaced by the concept of divine right. The king is now seen not as a god or demigod, or even as someone descended from a god, but simply as God's representative on Earth. The deference shown to him is less extreme in its humility, and his sacred titles lose much of their significance. Furthermore, his authority is no longer absolute. Subjects challenge his right to control their lives and property as he wishes, and they offer their loyalty only in the form of obedience to his commands.
With advancing political opinion has come still greater restriction of imperial power. Belief in the supernatural character of the ruler, long ago repudiated by ourselves for example, has left behind it nothing more than the popular tendency to ascribe unusual goodness, wisdom, and beauty to the monarch. Loyalty, which originally meant implicit submission to the king’s will, now means a merely nominal profession of subordination, and the fulfilment of certain forms of respect. Our political practice, and our political theory, alike utterly reject those regal prerogatives which once passed unquestioned. By deposing some, and putting others in their places, we have not only denied the divine rights of certain men to rule; but we have denied that they have any rights beyond those originating in the assent of the nation. Though our forms of speech and our state-documents still assert the subjection of the citizens to the ruler, our actual beliefs and our daily proceedings implicitly assert the contrary. We obey no laws save those of our own making. We have entirely divested the monarch of legislative power; and should immediately 7rebel against his or her exercise of such power, even in matters of the smallest concern. In brief, the aboriginal doctrine is all but extinct among us.
With evolving political views has come even greater restriction of imperial power. The belief in the ruler's supernatural qualities, which we long ago rejected, has left behind nothing more than a common tendency to attribute exceptional goodness, wisdom, and beauty to the monarch. Loyalty, which originally meant complete submission to the king’s wishes, now means just a superficial acknowledgment of authority and following certain customs of respect. Both our political practices and theories completely dismiss those royal privileges that once went unchallenged. By removing some leaders and replacing them with others, we have not only rejected the divine rights of certain individuals to govern; we have also denied that they possess any rights beyond those granted by the people's consent. Although our language and state documents still claim that citizens are subject to the ruler, our true beliefs and everyday actions imply the opposite. We follow no laws except those that we create ourselves. We have fully stripped the monarch of legislative power; and we would immediately resist any attempt by him or her to exercise such power, even in the most trivial matters. In short, the original doctrine is nearly dead among us.
Nor has the rejection of primitive political beliefs, resulted only in transferring the authority of an autocrat to a representative body. The views entertained respecting governments in general, of whatever form, are now widely different from those once entertained. Whether popular or despotic, governments were in ancient times supposed to have unlimited authority over their subjects. Individuals existed for the benefit of the State; not the State for the benefit of individuals. In our days, however, not only has the national will been in many cases substituted for the will of the king; but the exercise of this national will has been restricted to a much smaller sphere. In England, for instance, though there has been established no definite theory setting bounds to governmental authority; yet, in practice, sundry bounds have been set to it which are tacitly recognized by all. There is no organic law formally declaring that the legislature may not freely dispose of the citizens’ lives, as early kings did when they sacrificed hecatombs of victims; but were it possible for our legislature to attempt such a thing, its own destruction would be the consequence, rather than the destruction of citizens. How entirely we have established the personal liberties of the subject against the invasions of State-power, would be quickly demonstrated, were it proposed by Act of Parliament forcibly to take possession of the nation, or of any class, and turn its services to public ends; as the services of the people were turned by primitive rulers. And should any statesman suggest a re-distribution of property such as was sometimes made in ancient democratic communities, he would be met by a thousand-tongued denial of imperial power over individual possessions. Not only in our day have these fundamental claims of the citizen been thus made good against the State, but sundry minor claims likewise. Ages ago, laws regulating dress and mode of living fell into disuse; and 8any attempt to revive them would prove the current opinion to be, that such matters lie beyond the sphere of legal control. For some centuries we have been asserting in practice, and have now established in theory, the right of every man to choose his own religious beliefs, instead of receiving such beliefs on State-authority. Within the last few generations we have inaugurated complete liberty of speech, in spite of all legislative attempts to suppress or limit it. And still more recently we have claimed and finally obtained under a few exceptional restrictions, freedom to trade with whomsoever we please. Thus our political beliefs are widely different from ancient ones, not only as to the proper depositary of power to be exercised over a nation, but also as to the extent of that power.
The rejection of primitive political beliefs hasn't just meant shifting the authority from a single autocrat to a representative body. Our views on governments, regardless of their form, are now vastly different from those of the past. In ancient times, whether they were popular or tyrannical, governments were thought to have unlimited authority over their subjects. People existed for the benefit of the State, not the other way around. Nowadays, the national will has replaced the king's will in many cases, but this national will operates within a much narrower scope. In England, for example, although there isn't a clear theory outlining limits to government power, various boundaries have been established in practice that everyone acknowledges. There’s no formal law stating that the legislature can't freely control citizens' lives, as ancient kings did when they sacrificed numerous victims; however, if our legislature tried to do something like that, it would lead to its own downfall rather than harming the citizens. The extent to which we have secured personal liberties against state encroachment would quickly be shown if Parliament attempted to forcibly take over the nation or any group and redirect their services for public purposes, as primitive rulers did. If any politician proposed a redistribution of property like that which occurred in ancient democracies, they would be met with a loud denial of any government authority over individual possessions. Not only have we established these fundamental rights for citizens against the State, but we've also secured various minor claims. Long ago, laws regulating dress and lifestyle fell out of use, and any effort to revive them would show that current opinion sees these issues as outside the realm of legal control. For centuries, we've been claiming in practice, and now have established in theory, the right of every individual to choose their own religious beliefs instead of accepting those dictated by the State. In recent generations, we have achieved complete freedom of speech, despite various legislative attempts to suppress or limit it. Even more recently, we've demanded and finally attained the freedom to trade with whoever we choose, with only a few exceptional restrictions. Thus, our political beliefs are vastly different from ancient ones, not just concerning who should wield power over a nation but also regarding the scope of that power.
Not even here has the change ended. Besides the average opinions which we have just described as current among ourselves, there exists a less widely-diffused opinion going still further in the same direction. There are to be found men who contend that the sphere of government should be narrowed even more than it is in England. The modern doctrine that the State exists for the benefit of citizens, which has now in a great measure supplanted the ancient doctrine that the citizens exist for the benefit of the State, they would push to its logical results. They hold that the freedom of the individual, limited only by the like freedom of other individuals, is sacred; and that the legislature cannot equitably put further restrictions upon it, either by forbidding any actions which the law of equal freedom permits, or taking away any property save that required to pay the cost of enforcing this law itself. They assert that the sole function of the State is the protection of persons against each other, and against a foreign foe. They urge that as, throughout civilization, the manifest tendency has been continually to extend the liberties of the subject, and restrict the functions of the State, there is reason to believe that the ultimate political condition must be one in which personal freedom is the greatest possible and 9governmental power the least possible: that, namely, in which the freedom of each has no limit but the like freedom of all; while the sole governmental duty is the maintenance of this limit.
Not even here has change stopped. Besides the common opinions we've just described as typical among ourselves, there's a less widespread view that goes even further in the same direction. There are people who argue that the role of government should be limited even more than it currently is in England. The modern belief that the State exists for the benefit of its citizens, which has largely replaced the old belief that citizens exist for the benefit of the State, is something they would take to its logical conclusion. They believe that an individual's freedom, restricted only by the same freedom of others, is sacred; and that the legislature cannot justly impose further restrictions by prohibiting any actions permitted by the law of equal freedom or by taking away property except for what is necessary to cover the cost of enforcing that law. They argue that the only role of the State is to protect individuals from each other and from foreign enemies. They point out that throughout civilization, there has been a clear trend to expand individual liberties and limit the scope of the State, leading to the belief that the ultimate political situation should be one where personal freedom is maximized and governmental power is minimized: specifically, a situation where the freedom of each person is limited only by the freedom of everyone else, with the sole responsibility of the government being to uphold this limit. 9
Here then in different times and places we find concerning the origin, authority, and functions of government, a great variety of opinions—opinions of which the leading genera above indicated subdivide into countless species. What now must be said about the truth or falsity of these opinions? Save among a few barbarous tribes the notion that a monarch is a god or demigod is regarded throughout the world as an absurdity almost passing the bounds of human credulity. In but few places does there survive a vague notion that the ruler possesses any supernatural attributes. Most civilized communities, which still admit the divine right of governments, have long since repudiated the divine right of kings. Elsewhere the belief that there is anything sacred in legislative regulations is dying out: laws are coming to be considered as conventional only. While the extreme school holds that governments have neither intrinsic authority, nor can have authority given to them by convention; but can possess authority only as the administrators of those moral principles deducible from the conditions essential to social life. Of these various beliefs, with their innumerable modifications, must we then say that some one alone is wholly right and all the rest wholly wrong; or must we say that each of them contains truth more or less completely disguised by errors? The latter alternative is the one which analysis will force upon us. Ridiculous as they may severally appear to those not educated under them, every one of these doctrines has for its vital element the recognition of an unquestionable fact. Directly or by implication, each of them insists on a certain subordination of individual actions to social requirements. There are wide differences as to the power to which this subordination is due; there are wide differences as to the motive for this subordination; there are 10wide differences as to its extent; but that there must be some subordination all are agreed. From the oldest and rudest idea of allegiance, down to the most advanced political theory of our own day, there is on this point complete unanimity. Though, between the savage who conceives his life and property to be at the absolute disposal of his chief, and the anarchist who denies the right of any government, autocratic or democratic, to trench upon his individual freedom, there seems at first sight an entire and irreconcilable antagonism; yet ultimate analysis discloses in them this fundamental community of opinion; that there are limits which individual actions may not transgress—limits which the one regards as originating in the king’s will, and which the other regards as deducible from the equal claims of fellow-citizens.
Here in different times and places, we see a wide range of opinions about the origin, authority, and functions of government—opinions that can be categorized into numerous subtypes based on the main themes mentioned earlier. Now, what should we say about the truth or falsity of these opinions? Except among a few primitive tribes, the idea that a monarch is a god or demigod is seen as absurd worldwide, almost beyond belief. Only in a few places is there a vague idea that rulers have any supernatural qualities. Most civilized societies that still acknowledge the divine right of governments have long rejected the divine right of kings. In other places, the belief that there is anything sacred about legislative regulations is fading: laws are increasingly viewed as mere conventions. Meanwhile, the most extreme viewpoint argues that governments have no inherent authority and cannot receive authority by convention; they can only have authority as the enforcers of moral principles that arise from the fundamental conditions necessary for social life. With these various beliefs and their countless modifications, should we conclude that one opinion is entirely correct and all others are completely wrong? Or should we say that each belief contains some truth, albeit somewhat obscured by errors? The latter option is what analysis leads us to. As ridiculous as they may seem to those not raised within them, each of these doctrines acknowledges an undeniable reality. Directly or indirectly, they all insist on a certain subordination of individual actions to social needs. There are significant differences regarding the authority that justifies this subordination, the motivation behind it, and its extent; but everyone agrees that there must be *some* subordination. From the oldest and simplest idea of loyalty to the most developed political theory of our time, there is total agreement on this point. Although there appears to be an irreconcilable conflict between the primitive individual who sees his life and property as completely at the mercy of his chief and the anarchist who denies any government—be it autocratic or democratic—the right to infringe on his personal freedom, a deeper analysis reveals a fundamental consensus: that there are limits to individual actions that cannot be overstepped—limits that one sees as originating from the king’s will, and the other views as arising from the equal rights of fellow citizens.
It may perhaps at first sight seem that we here reach a very unimportant conclusion; namely, that a certain tacit assumption is equally implied in all these conflicting political creeds—an assumption which is indeed of self-evident validity. The question, however, is not the value or novelty of the particular truth in this case arrived at. My aim has been to exhibit the more general truth, which we are apt to overlook, that between the most opposite beliefs there is usually something in common,—something taken for granted by each; and that this something, if not to be set down as an unquestionable verity, may yet be considered to have the highest degree of probability. A postulate which, like the one above instanced, is not consciously asserted but unconsciously involved; and which is unconsciously involved not by one man or body of men, but by numerous bodies of men who diverge in countless ways and degrees in the rest of their beliefs; has a warrant far transcending any that can be usually shown. And when, as in this case, the postulate is abstract—is not based on some one concrete experience common to all mankind, but implies an induction from a great variety of experiences, we may say that it ranks next in certainty to the postulates of exact science.
It might seem at first glance that we’re reaching a rather insignificant conclusion: that a certain unspoken assumption is implied across all these conflicting political beliefs—an assumption that is quite obviously valid. However, the issue isn’t about the worth or originality of the specific truth we’ve arrived at. My goal has been to highlight a broader truth that we often overlook: that even the most opposing beliefs usually share something in common—something that each side takes for granted; and while this may not be regarded as an unquestionable fact, it can be thought of as having a high degree of probability. A postulate like the one mentioned, which isn’t consciously stated but is unconsciously involved, isn’t just recognized by one person or group, but by many different groups who diverge in countless ways and degrees in their other beliefs. This gives it a validity that far exceeds what can typically be demonstrated. And when, as in this case, the postulate is abstract—not based on any single concrete experience common to all humanity, but instead derived from a wide variety of experiences—we can say that it ranks just behind the certainties found in exact science.
11Do we not thus arrive at a generalization which may habitually guide us when seeking for the soul of truth in things erroneous? While the foregoing illustration brings clearly home the fact, that in opinions seeming to be absolutely and supremely wrong something right is yet to be found; it also indicates the method we should pursue in seeking the something right. This method is to compare all opinions of the same genus; to set aside as more or less discrediting one another those various special and concrete elements in which such opinions disagree; to observe what remains after the discordant constituents have been eliminated; and to find for this remaining constituent that abstract expression which holds true throughout its divergent modifications.
11So, don’t we reach a general idea that can guide us when we're looking for the truth in flawed beliefs? While the example above clearly shows that even opinions that seem completely and utterly wrong can still contain something right, it also points out how we should go about finding that something right. The approach is to compare all opinions of the same kind, to set aside those various specific details where these opinions disagree, to see what’s left after removing the conflicting parts, and to identify that remaining element with an abstract term that remains true across its different versions.
§3. A candid acceptance of this general principle and an adoption of the course it indicates, will greatly aid us in dealing with those chronic antagonisms by which men are divided. Applying it not only to current ideas with which we are personally unconcerned, but also to our own ideas and those of our opponents, we shall be led to form far more correct judgments. We shall be ever ready to suspect that the convictions we entertain are not wholly right, and that the adverse convictions are not wholly wrong. On the one hand we shall not, in common with the great mass of the unthinking, let our beliefs be determined by the mere accident of birth in a particular age on a particular part of the Earth’s surface; and, on the other hand, we shall be saved from that error of entire and contemptuous negation, which is fallen into by most who take up an attitude of independent criticism.
§3. Being open to this general principle and following the path it suggests will really help us tackle the ongoing conflicts that divide people. If we apply this not only to ideas that don’t personally affect us but also to our own beliefs and those of our opponents, we’ll be able to make much better judgments. We’ll always be ready to question whether the beliefs we hold are completely right and recognize that opposing views might not be completely wrong. On one hand, we won’t let our beliefs be dictated by the random chance of being born in a specific time and place; on the other hand, we’ll avoid the mistake of completely dismissing everything, which many who adopt an independent critique end up doing.
Of all antagonisms of belief, the oldest, the widest, the most profound and the most important, is that between Religion and Science. It commenced when the recognition of the simplest uniformities in surrounding things, set a limit to the previously universal fetishism. It shows itself everywhere throughout the domain of human knowledge: affecting men’s interpretations alike of the simplest mechanical accidents and 12of the most complicated events in the histories of nations. It has its roots deep down in the diverse habits of thought of different orders of minds. And the conflicting conceptions of nature and life which these diverse habits of thought severally generate, influence for good or ill the tone of feeling and the daily conduct.
Among all conflicts of belief, the oldest, most widespread, most profound, and most significant is the one between Religion and Science. It began when acknowledging the simplest patterns in our surroundings limited the previously universal fetishism. This conflict appears throughout the landscape of human knowledge, impacting how people interpret both basic mechanical events and the most complex occurrences in the histories of nations. Its roots run deep in the varied ways of thinking among different types of minds. The conflicting views of nature and life that arise from these different ways of thinking shape, for better or worse, our feelings and daily actions.
An unceasing battle of opinion like this which has been carried on throughout all ages under the banners of Religion and Science, has of course generated an animosity fatal to a just estimate of either party by the other. On a larger scale, and more intensely than any other controversy, has it illustrated that perennially significant fable concerning the knights who fought about the colour of a shield of which neither looked at more than one face. Each combatant seeing clearly his own aspect of the question, has charged his opponent with stupidity or dishonesty in not seeing the same aspect of it; while each has wanted the candour to go over to his opponent’s side and find out how it was that he saw everything so differently.
An ongoing battle of opinions like this, which has persisted through the ages under the banners of Religion and Science, has inevitably created a deep-seated hostility that prevents either side from fairly evaluating the other. On a broader scale, and more intensely than any other debate, it has highlighted that timeless fable about the knights who fought over the color of a shield, without ever looking at more than one side. Each fighter, clearly seeing their own perspective on the issue, has accused their opponent of foolishness or dishonesty for not seeing things the same way. Meanwhile, neither has shown the openness to switch sides and discover why the other views everything so differently.
Happily the times display an increasing catholicity of feeling, which we shall do well in carrying as far as our natures permit. In proportion as we love truth more and victory less, we shall become anxious to know what it is which leads our opponents to think as they do. We shall begin to suspect that the pertinacity of belief exhibited by them must result from a perception of something we have not perceived. And we shall aim to supplement the portion of truth we have found with the portion found by them. Making a more rational estimate of human authority, we shall avoid alike the extremes of undue submission and undue rebellion—shall not regard some men’s judgments as wholly good and others as wholly bad; but shall rather lean to the more defensible position that none are completely right and none are completely wrong.
Fortunately, we're seeing a growing openness of feelings these days, and we should embrace that as much as we can. The more we value truth over victory, the more curious we'll be about why our opponents think the way they do. We might start to realize that their strong beliefs come from an understanding of something we haven't grasped yet. Our goal will be to add the truths we've discovered to those they've found. By taking a more sensible view of human authority, we can steer clear of both extreme submission and extreme rebellion. We won't view some people's opinions as completely good and others as completely bad; instead, we'll lean toward the more reasonable idea that no one is entirely right or entirely wrong.
Preserving, as far as may be, this impartial attitude, let us then contemplate the two sides of this great controversy. 13Keeping guard against the bias of education and shutting out the whisperings of sectarian feeling, let us consider what are the à priori probabilities in favour of each party.
Maintaining an unbiased perspective, let’s take a look at both sides of this significant debate. 13 By being aware of the influences of our upbringing and ignoring the pressure of personal beliefs, let’s examine the a priori probabilities supporting each side.
§4. When duly realized, the general principle above illustrated must lead us to anticipate that the diverse forms of religious belief which have existed and which still exist, have all a basis in some ultimate fact. Judging by analogy the implication is, not that any one of them is altogether right; but that in each there is something right more or less disguised by other things wrong. It may be that the soul of truth contained in erroneous creeds is very unlike most, if not all, of its several embodiments; and indeed, if, as we have good reason to expect, it is much more abstract than any of them, its unlikeness necessarily follows. But however different from its concrete expressions, some essential verity must be looked for. To suppose that these multiform conceptions should be one and all absolutely groundless, discredits too profoundly that average human intelligence from which all our individual intelligences are inherited.
§4. When properly understood, the general principle described above should lead us to expect that the various forms of religious belief that have existed and still exist are all based on some ultimate truth. By analogy, this suggests that none of them is completely correct; rather, each one contains something true, albeit somewhat obscured by other false aspects. It's possible that the essence of truth present in flawed beliefs is very different from most, if not all, its various forms; and indeed, if, as we have good reason to believe, it is much more abstract than any of them, its differences are to be expected. But no matter how different it is from its tangible expressions, some fundamental truth must be found. To assume that these diverse ideas should all be completely unfounded greatly undermines the fundamental human intelligence from which all our individual intellects come.
This most general reason we shall find enforced by other more special ones. To the presumption that a number of diverse beliefs of the same class have some common foundation in fact, must in this case be added a further presumption derived from the omnipresence of the beliefs. Religious ideas of one kind or other are almost if not quite universal. Even should it be true, as alleged, that there exist tribes of men who have nothing approaching to a theory of creation—even should it be true that only when a certain phase of intelligence is reached do the most rudimentary of such theories make their appearance; the implication is practically the same. Grant that among all races who have passed a certain stage of intellectual development there are found vague notions concerning the origin and hidden nature of surrounding things; and there arises the inference that such notions are necessary products of progressing intelligence. Their endless variety serves but 14to strengthen this conclusion: showing as it does a more or less independent genesis—showing how, in different places and times, like conditions have led to similar trains of thought, ending in analogous results. That these countless different, and yet allied, phenomena presented by all religions are accidental or factitious, is an untenable supposition. A candid examination of the evidence quite negatives the doctrine maintained by some, that creeds are priestly inventions. Even as a mere question of probabilities it cannot rationally be concluded that in every society, past and present, savage and civilized, certain members of the community have combined to delude the rest, in ways so analogous. To any who may allege that some primitive fiction was devised by some primitive priesthood, before yet mankind had diverged from a common centre, a reply is furnished by philology; for philology proves the dispersion of mankind to have commenced before there existed a language sufficiently organized to express religious ideas. Moreover, were it otherwise tenable, the hypothesis of artificial origin fails to account for the facts. It does not explain why, under all changes of form, certain elements of religious belief remain constant. It does not show us how it happens that while adverse criticism has from age to age gone on destroying particular theological dogmas, it has not destroyed the fundamental conception underlying these dogmas. It leaves us without any solution of the striking circumstance that when, from the absurdities and corruptions accumulated around them, national creeds have fallen into general discredit, ending in indifferentism or positive denial, there has always by and by arisen a re-assertion of them: if not the same in form, still the same in essence. Thus the universality of religious ideas, their independent evolution among different primitive races, and their great vitality, unite in showing that their source must be deep-seated instead of superficial. In other words, we are obliged to admit that if not supernaturally derived as 15the majority contend, they must be derived out of human experiences, slowly accumulated and organized.
This overall reason will be backed up by more specific ones. The assumption that many different beliefs in the same category share some common basis in reality needs to be supplemented with another assumption based on the widespread nature of these beliefs. Religious ideas of one kind or another are almost universally found. Even if it’s true, as some claim, that there are tribes of people without a concept of creation, or that such basic theories only emerge once a certain level of intelligence is reached; the implication remains largely the same. If we assume that among all cultures that have reached a certain level of intellectual development, there are vague ideas about the origins and deeper nature of the world around them, we can infer that these ideas are necessary outcomes of advancing intelligence. Their vast variety only strengthens this conclusion: it demonstrates a largely independent origin, showing how similar conditions have led to comparable lines of thought at different times and places, resulting in similar conclusions. The idea that these countless diverse yet related phenomena across all religions are coincidental or artificial is an unsustainable belief. A straightforward examination of the evidence contradicts the claim made by some that belief systems are simply the inventions of priests. Even as a mere matter of chance, it isn’t reasonable to conclude that in every society, both past and present, primitive and advanced, certain members of the community have banded together to mislead others in such similar ways. For those who might suggest that some basic myth was created by a primitive priesthood before humanity diverged from a common origin, philology offers a counterargument; it shows that the dispersion of humanity began before there was a sufficiently organized language to express religious ideas. Furthermore, even if that idea could be valid, the theory of an artificial origin fails to explain the facts. It doesn’t clarify why, despite changes in form, certain elements of religious belief remain consistent. It doesn't reveal why, while criticism has historically dismantled specific theological doctrines, the fundamental concept underlying these doctrines has persisted. It leaves us puzzled about the striking fact that when, due to the absurdities and corruptions that have accumulated around them, national belief systems fall into general disrepute, often leading to indifference or outright denial, they are eventually reaffirmed—if not in the same way, then still in essence. Thus, the universality of religious ideas, their independent evolution among various primitive groups, and their significant endurance all point to a source that must be deeply rooted rather than superficial. In other words, we must acknowledge that if these ideas are not supernaturally derived, as most argue, they must arise from human experiences, slowly gathered and organized.
Should it be asserted that religious ideas are products of the religious sentiment, which, to satisfy itself, prompts imaginations that it afterwards projects into the external world, and by and by mistakes for realities; the problem is not solved, but only removed further back. Whether the wish is father to the thought, or whether sentiment and idea have a common genesis, there equally arises the question—Whence comes the sentiment? That it is a constituent in man’s nature is implied by the hypothesis; and cannot indeed be denied by those who prefer other hypotheses. And if the religious sentiment, displayed habitually by the majority of mankind, and occasionally aroused even in those seemingly devoid of it, must be classed among human emotions, we cannot rationally ignore it. We are bound to ask its origin and its function. Here is an attribute which, to say the least, has had an enormous influence—which has played a conspicuous part throughout the entire past as far back as history records, and is at present the life of numerous institutions, the stimulus to perpetual controversies, and the prompter of countless daily actions. Any Theory of Things which takes no account of this attribute, must, then, be extremely defective. If with no other view, still as a question in philosophy, we are called on to say what this attribute means; and we cannot decline the task without confessing our philosophy to be incompetent.
Should we claim that religious ideas are the results of religious feelings, which drive our imaginations to create concepts that we later mistake for reality, the issue isn't really resolved; it’s just pushed further back. Whether our desires shape our thoughts or if feelings and ideas originate from the same place, the question remains—where does this sentiment come from? The assumption is that it's a part of human nature, and this cannot be denied by those who support other theories. If the religious sentiment is a common emotion among most people and can occasionally stir even those who seem to lack it, we can't simply overlook it. We must ask where it originates and what purpose it serves. This characteristic, to say the least, has significantly influenced human history, has played a major role throughout time recorded by history, and continues to energize many institutions, spark ongoing debates, and motivate countless daily actions. Any Theory of Things that doesn't consider this characteristic must be fundamentally flawed. Even if only as a philosophical inquiry, we are tasked with explaining what this characteristic means; failing to address it would mean admitting our philosophy is inadequate.
Two suppositions only are open to us: the one that the feeling which responds to religious ideas resulted, along with all other human faculties, from an act of special creation; the other that it, in common with the rest, arose by a process of evolution. If we adopt the first of these alternatives, universally accepted by our ancestors and by the immense majority of our contemporaries, the matter is at once settled: man is directly endowed with the religious feeling by a 16creator; and to that creator it designedly responds. If we adopt the second alternative, then we are met by the questions—What are the circumstances to which the genesis of the religious feeling is due? and—What is its office? We are bound to entertain these questions; and we are bound to find answers to them. Considering all faculties, as we must on this supposition, to result from accumulated modifications caused by the intercourse of the organism with its environment, we are obliged to admit that there exist in the environment certain phenomena or conditions which have determined the growth of the feeling in question; and so are obliged to admit that it is as normal as any other faculty. Add to which that as, on the hypothesis of a development of lower forms into higher, the end towards which the progressive changes directly or indirectly tend, must be adaptation to the requirements of existence; we are also forced to infer that this feeling is in some way conducive to human welfare. Thus both alternatives contain the same ultimate implication. We must conclude that the religious sentiment is either directly created, or is created by the slow action of natural causes; and whichever of these conclusions we adopt, requires us to treat the religious sentiment with respect.
We have only two options to consider: one is that the feeling associated with religious ideas came about through a special act of creation, just like all other human abilities; the other is that it, like the rest, developed through evolution. If we choose the first option, which has been widely accepted by our ancestors and the vast majority of people today, then it’s clear-cut: humans are directly given the religious feeling by a creator, and this feeling responds to that creator intentionally. If we take the second option, then we face questions: What circumstances led to the development of the religious feeling? And what role does it play? We must consider these questions and find answers. If we assume that all abilities have come from gradual changes due to the interaction of organisms with their environment, we have to accept that there are certain phenomena or conditions in the environment that have influenced the development of this feeling; therefore, we must recognize that it is as natural as any other ability. Furthermore, under the idea that simpler forms evolve into more complex ones, we must conclude that the ultimate goal of these progressive changes is to adapt to life's demands; hence, we can deduce that this feeling somehow supports human well-being. Thus, both options reach the same fundamental conclusion. We must conclude that the religious sentiment is either directly created or results from the gradual effects of natural causes; and no matter which conclusion we choose, we are obligated to treat the religious sentiment with respect.
One other consideration should not be overlooked—a consideration which students of Science more especially need to have pointed out. Occupied as such are with established truths, and accustomed to regard things not already known as things to be hereafter discovered, they are liable to forget that information, however extensive it may become, can never satisfy inquiry. Positive knowledge does not, and never can, fill the whole region of possible thought. At the uttermost reach of discovery there arises, and must ever arise, the question—What lies beyond? As it is impossible to think of a limit to space so as to exclude the idea of space lying outside that limit; so we cannot conceive of any explanation profound enough to exclude the question—What is the explanation of that explanation? Regarding Science as a gradually increasing 17sphere, we may say that every addition to its surface does but bring it into wider contact with surrounding nescience. There must ever remain therefore two antithetical modes of mental action. Throughout all future time, as now, the human mind may occupy itself, not only with ascertained phenomena and their relations, but also with that unascertained something which phenomena and their relations imply. Hence if knowledge cannot monopolize consciousness—if it must always continue possible for the mind to dwell upon that which transcends knowledge; then there can never cease to be a place for something of the nature of Religion; since Religion under all its forms is distinguished from everything else in this, that its subject matter is that which passes the sphere of experience.
One more point shouldn’t be overlooked—especially one that students of science need to recognize. Since they’re focused on established truths and tend to view unknown things as what will eventually be discovered, they might forget that no amount of information, no matter how vast, can fully satisfy inquiry. Positive knowledge does not, and never will, encompass the entire realm of possible thought. At the farthest edge of discovery, the question always arises—What lies beyond? Just as it’s impossible to think of a limit to space without imagining space beyond that limit, we can’t conceive of any explanation deep enough to rule out the question—What is the explanation for that explanation? If we think of science as a gradually expanding sphere, we can say that every addition to its surface only brings it into wider contact with the surrounding unknown. Therefore, two opposing modes of mental activity will always exist. Throughout all future time, just as now, the human mind can engage not only with confirmed phenomena and their relationships but also with that unconfirmed something that those phenomena and their relationships suggest. So, if knowledge can’t monopolize consciousness—if it will always be possible for the mind to contemplate what goes beyond knowledge—then there will always be a space for something like religion; because religion, in all its forms, is distinguished by its subject matter, which goes beyond the realm of experience.
Thus, however untenable may be any or all the existing religious creeds, however gross the absurdities associated with them, however irrational the arguments set forth in their defence, we must not ignore the verity which in all likelihood lies hidden within them. The general probability that widely-spread beliefs are not absolutely baseless, is in this case enforced by a further probability due to the omnipresence of the beliefs. In the existence of a religious sentiment, whatever be its origin, we have a second evidence of great significance. And as in that nescience which must ever remain the antithesis to science, there is a sphere for the exercise of this sentiment, we find a third general fact of like implication. We may be sure therefore that religions, though even none of them be actually true, are yet all adumbrations of a truth.
Thus, no matter how unreasonable any or all of the current religious beliefs may seem, no matter how ridiculous the absurdities tied to them are, and no matter how illogical the arguments defending them might be, we shouldn't overlook the truth that likely lies hidden within them. The common belief that widely-held views aren't completely unfounded is supported here by an additional probability due to the widespread nature of these beliefs. The existence of a religious sentiment, regardless of its source, provides us with another significant piece of evidence. And since there is a realm for the expression of this sentiment in a state of ignorance that will always contrast with science, we find a third related fact. Therefore, we can be confident that religions, even if none of them are actually true, are still all reflections of a deeper truth.
§ 5. As, to the religious, it will seem absurd to set forth any justification for Religion; so, to the scientific, will it seem absurd to defend Science. Yet to do the last is certainly as needful as to do the first. If there exists a class who, in contempt of its follies and disgust at its corruptions, have contracted towards Religion a repugnance which makes them overlook the fundamental verity contained in it; so, too, is 18there a class offended to such a degree by the destructive criticisms men of science make on the religious tenets they regard as essential, that they have acquired a strong prejudice against Science in general. They are not prepared with any avowed reasons for their dislike. They have simply a remembrance of the rude shakes which Science has given to many of their cherished convictions, and a suspicion that it may perhaps eventually uproot all they regard as sacred; and hence it produces in them a certain inarticulate dread.
§ 5. Just as it seems ridiculous to religious people to justify Religion, it also seems ridiculous to scientists to defend Science. However, doing the latter is just as necessary as doing the former. There are individuals who, despite the absurdities and corruption associated with Religion, have developed a deep-seated aversion that leads them to overlook its fundamental truths. Similarly, there are those who have become so offended by the harsh critiques that scientists make of the religious beliefs they see as essential that they've developed a strong bias against Science as a whole. They don’t have clear reasons for their dislike; they just carry a memory of the harsh challenges that Science has posed to many of their deeply held beliefs, along with a suspicion that it might eventually undermine everything they hold sacred, resulting in a vague, inarticulate fear.
What is Science? To see the absurdity of the prejudice against it, we need only remark that Science is simply a higher development of common knowledge; and that if Science is repudiated, all knowledge must be repudiated along with it. The extremest bigot will not suspect any harm in the observation that the sun rises earlier and sets later in the summer than in the winter; but will rather consider such an observation as a useful aid in fulfilling the duties of life. Well, Astronomy is an organized body of similar observations, made with greater nicety, extended to a larger number of objects, and so analyzed as to disclose the real arrangements of the heavens, and to dispel our false conceptions of them. That iron will rust in water, that wood will burn, that long kept viands become putrid, the most timid sectarian will teach without alarm, as things useful to be known. But these are chemical truths: Chemistry is a systematized collection of such facts, ascertained with precision, and so classified and generalized as to enable us to say with certainty, concerning each simple or compound substance, what change will occur in it under given conditions. And thus is it with all the sciences. They severally germinate out of the experiences of daily life; insensibly as they grow they draw in remoter, more numerous, and more complex experiences; and among these, they ascertain laws of dependence like those which make up our knowledge of the most familiar objects. Nowhere is it possible to draw a line and say—here Science begins. And as it is the function of 19common observation to serve for the guidance of conduct; so, too, is the guidance of conduct the office of the most recondite and abstract inquiries of Science. Through the countless industrial processes and the various modes of locomotion which it has given to us, Physics regulates more completely our social life than does his acquaintance with the properties of surrounding bodies regulate the life of the savage. Anatomy and Physiology, through their effects on the practice of medicine and hygiene, modify our actions almost as much as does our acquaintance with the evils and benefits which common environing agencies may produce on our bodies. All Science is prevision; and all prevision ultimately aids us in greater or less degree to achieve the good and avoid the bad. As certainly as the perception of an object lying in our path warns us against stumbling over it; so certainly do those more complicated and subtle perceptions which constitute Science, warn us against stumbling over intervening obstacles in the pursuit of our distant ends. Thus being one in origin and function, the simplest forms of cognition and the most complex must be dealt with alike. We are bound in consistency to receive the widest knowledge which our faculties can reach, or to reject along with it that narrow knowledge possessed by all. There is no logical alternative between accepting our intelligence in its entirety, or repudiating even that lowest intelligence which we possess in common with brutes.
What is Science? To understand the absurdity of the prejudice against it, we just need to note that Science is really just a more advanced form of common knowledge; and if we reject Science, we have to reject all knowledge along with it. Even the most extreme bigot won’t see any harm in noticing that the sun rises earlier and sets later in the summer than in the winter; instead, they would think of it as a helpful observation for everyday life. Well, Astronomy is a structured collection of similar observations, made with more accuracy, covering a larger number of objects, and analyzed to reveal the true arrangements of the heavens and correct our misconceptions about them. The idea that iron rusts in water, that wood burns, and that food spoils if kept too long are things even the most cautious person will teach without worry, as they are useful to know. But these are chemical truths: Chemistry is a systematically organized collection of such facts, discovered with precision, classified, and generalized so we can confidently say what changes will happen to each simple or compound substance under certain conditions. And this is how it is with all the sciences. They each grow from our daily experiences; as they develop, they gradually incorporate more distant, numerous, and complex experiences; and among these, they identify laws of dependence similar to those that inform our understanding of the most familiar objects. There’s no clear line where Science begins. Just as common observations guide our actions, so do the most intricate and theoretical inquiries of Science. Through the countless industrial processes and various modes of transportation it provides, Physics influences our social lives more completely than a savage’s understanding of the properties of the world around them. Anatomy and Physiology, through their impact on medicine and hygiene, affect our actions almost as much as our knowledge of the good and bad effects that our surroundings can have on our bodies. All Science is about predicting outcomes; and all predictions ultimately help us to achieve good outcomes and avoid bad ones to some extent. Just as spotting an object in our path warns us not to trip over it, those more complex and subtle insights that make up Science warn us of obstacles in the way of our distant goals. Therefore, since they share the same origin and purpose, we should treat both the simplest forms of knowledge and the most complex ones in the same way. We must either embrace the broadest knowledge our abilities can grasp or reject along with it the limited knowledge that all beings possess. There is no logical choice between accepting our intelligence in its entirety or dismissing even the basic intelligence we share with animals.
To ask the question which more immediately concerns our argument—whether Science is substantially true?—is much like asking whether the sun gives light. And it is because they are conscious how undeniably valid are most of its propositions, that the theological party regard Science with so much secret alarm. They know that during the two thousand years of its growth, some of its larger divisions—mathematics, physics, astronomy—have been subject to the rigorous criticism of successive generations; and have notwithstanding become ever more firmly established. They know 20that, unlike many of their own doctrines, which were once universally received but have age by age been more frequently called in question, the doctrines of Science, at first confined to a few scattered inquirers, have been slowly growing into general acceptance, and are now in great part admitted as beyond dispute. They know that men of science throughout the world subject each other’s results to the most searching examination; and that error is mercilessly exposed and rejected as soon as discovered. And, finally, they know that still more conclusive testimony is to be found in the daily verification of scientific predictions, and in the never-ceasing triumphs of those arts which Science guides.
To ask the question that is more directly related to our discussion—whether Science is fundamentally true?—is similar to asking if the sun provides light. It's because they are aware of how undeniably valid most scientific propositions are that the theological side views Science with such hidden concern. They understand that over the two thousand years of its development, some of its major fields—mathematics, physics, astronomy—have endured the strict scrutiny of successive generations; and yet they have become increasingly solidified. They realize that, unlike many of their own beliefs that were once widely accepted but have been questioned more frequently over time, the principles of Science, which were initially limited to a few curious minds, have gradually gained widespread acceptance and are now largely regarded as unquestionable. They know that scientists around the world rigorously test each other's findings, and that mistakes are harshly exposed and discarded as soon as they're found. Lastly, they understand that even more convincing evidence comes from the daily confirmation of scientific predictions and the continuous successes of the technologies shaped by Science.
To regard with alienation that which has such high credentials is a folly. Though in the tone which many of the scientific adopt towards them, the defenders of Religion may find some excuse for this alienation; yet the excuse is a very insufficient one. On the side of Science, as on their own side, they must admit that short-comings in the advocates do not tell essentially against that which is advocated. Science must be judged by itself: and so judged, only the most perverted intellect can fail to see that it is worthy of all reverence. Be there or be there not any other revelation, we have a veritable revelation in Science—a continuous disclosure, through the intelligence with which we are endowed, of the established order of the Universe. This disclosure it is the duty of every one to verify as far as in him lies; and having verified, to receive with all humility.
To dismiss something with such impressive credentials is foolish. While the way that many scientists approach them may give defenders of Religion some reasons for this dismissal, those reasons are quite inadequate. On both sides, they must acknowledge that the failings of advocates don’t fundamentally undermine what they advocate. Science should be evaluated on its own merits, and when it is, only the most twisted minds can fail to recognize that it deserves deep respect. Whether or not there is another revelation, we have a true revelation in Science—a continuous uncovering, through our intelligence, of the Universe's established order. It is everyone’s duty to verify this as much as possible; once verified, we should accept it with complete humility.
§6. On both sides of this great controversy, then, truth must exist. An unbiassed consideration of its general aspects forces us to conclude that Religion, everywhere present as a weft running through the warp of human history, expresses some eternal fact; while it is almost a truism to say of Science that it is an organised mass of facts, ever growing, and ever being more completely purified from errors. And if both have bases in the reality of things, then between them there 21must be a fundamental harmony. It is an incredible hypothesis that there are two orders of truth, in absolute and everlasting opposition. Only on some Manichean theory, which among ourselves no one dares openly avow however much his beliefs may be tainted by it, is such a supposition even conceivable. That Religion is divine and Science diabolical, is a proposition which, though implied in many a clerical declamation, not the most vehement fanatic can bring himself distinctly to assert. And whoever does not assert this, must admit that under their seeming antagonism lies hidden an entire agreement.
§6. On both sides of this major controversy, truth must exist. A fair consideration of its overall aspects leads us to conclude that Religion, consistently present as a thread running through the fabric of human history, reflects some eternal truth; while it’s almost a given to say that Science is an organized body of facts, constantly expanding and increasingly refined from errors. If both have foundations in reality, then there must be a fundamental harmony between them. It's an incredible idea that there are two orders of truth, in absolute and eternal conflict. Only under some Manichean theory, which no one among us dares to openly admit, no matter how much their beliefs may be influenced by it, is such a notion even thinkable. The idea that Religion is divine and Science is evil is a claim that, even if suggested in many clerical speeches, not even the most passionate fanatic can clearly state. And anyone who doesn't make this claim must acknowledge that beneath their apparent conflict lies a complete agreement.
Each side, therefore, has to recognize the claims of the other as standing for truths that are not to be ignored. He who contemplates the Universe from the religious point of view, must learn to see that this which we call Science is one constituent of the great whole; and as such ought to be regarded with a sentiment like that which the remainder excites. While he who contemplates the universe from the scientific point of view, must learn to see that this which we call Religion is similarly a constituent of the great whole; and being such, must be treated as a subject of science with no more prejudice than any other reality. It behoves each party to strive to understand the other, with the conviction that the other has something worthy to be understood; and with the conviction that when mutually recognized this something will be the basis of a complete reconciliation.
Each side needs to acknowledge the claims of the other as representing truths that shouldn’t be dismissed. Those who view the Universe from a religious perspective must recognize that what we call Science is part of the broader whole, and should be regarded with a similar appreciation as the other parts inspire. Meanwhile, those who view the Universe from a scientific perspective must understand that what we call Religion is also a part of that broader whole, and should be approached as a subject of science, without more bias than any other reality. It is essential for each group to strive to understand the other, believing that the other has something valuable to contribute; and with the belief that when both sides are acknowledged, this understanding will form the basis for complete reconciliation.
How to find this something—how to reconcile them, thus becomes the problem which we should perseveringly try to solve. Not to reconcile them in any makeshift way—not to find one of those compromises we hear from time to time proposed, which their proposers must secretly feel are artificial and temporary; but to arrive at the terms of a real and permanent peace between them. The thing we have to seek out, is that ultimate truth which both will avow with absolute sincerity—with not the remotest mental reservation. There shall be no concession—no yielding on either side of 22something that will by and by be reasserted; but the common ground on which they meet shall be one which each will maintain for itself. We have to discover some fundamental verity which Religion will assert, with all possible emphasis, in the absence of Science; and which Science, with all possible emphasis, will assert in the absence of Religion—some fundamental verity in the defence of which each will find the other its ally.
How to find this something—how to bring them together—becomes the challenge we should work hard to solve. Not to bring them together in a quick and easy way—not to find one of those compromises that people sometimes suggest, which the ones proposing must secretly think are fake and temporary; but to achieve terms for a real and lasting peace between them. What we need to uncover is that ultimate truth which both will wholeheartedly acknowledge—with not the slightest hint of doubt. There will be no concessions—no compromises from either side that will later be reneged on; instead, the common ground where they meet will be one that each will uphold on its own. We need to discover some fundamental truth that Religion will affirm, with all possible strength, in the absence of Science; and that Science, with all possible strength, will affirm in the absence of Religion—some fundamental truth in defense of which each will find the other as a supporter.
Or, changing the point of view, our aim must be to co-ordinate the seemingly opposed convictions which Religion and Science embody. From the coalescence of antagonist ideas, each containing its portion of truth, there always arises a higher development. As in Geology when the igneous and aqueous hypotheses were united, a rapid advance took place; as in Biology we are beginning to progress through the fusion of the doctrine of types with the doctrine of adaptations; as in Psychology the arrested growth recommences now that the disciples of Kant and those of Locke have both their views recognized in the theory that organized experiences produce forms of thought; as in Sociology, now that it is beginning to assume a positive character, we find a recognition of both the party of progress and the party of order, as each holding a truth which forms a needful complement to that held by the other; so must it be on a grander scale with Religion and Science. Here too we must look for a conception which combines the conclusions of both; and here too we may expect important results from their combination. To understand how Science and Religion express opposite sides of the same fact—the one its near or visible side, and the other its remote or invisible side—this it is which we must attempt; and to achieve this must profoundly modify our general Theory of Things.
Or, changing the perspective, our goal should be to bring together the seemingly conflicting beliefs that Religion and Science represent. When opposing ideas, each with its own truth, merge, it leads to a higher level of understanding. Just like in Geology, where the combination of volcanic and water-based theories led to significant progress; in Biology, where we're starting to advance through merging the concept of types with the idea of adaptations; in Psychology, where growth resumes now that both Kant's and Locke's followers have their views acknowledged in the theory that organized experiences shape thought; and in Sociology, which is becoming more positive, recognizing both the progressives and the traditionalists, each holding a truth that complements the other—so it should also apply on a larger scale with Religion and Science. Here, too, we should seek a concept that unifies the insights of both, and we can anticipate important outcomes from their integration. Understanding how Science and Religion reflect different facets of the same reality—one showing the immediate or visible aspect and the other the distant or invisible aspect—is what we must strive for; and achieving this will require a deep modification of our overall Theory of Things.
Already in the foregoing pages the method of seeking such a reconciliation has been vaguely foreshadowed. Before proceeding further, however, it will be well to treat the question of method more definitely. To find that truth in which 23Religion and Science coalesce, we must know in what direction to look for it, and what kind of truth it is likely to be.
Already in the previous pages, the approach to finding such a reconciliation has been hinted at. Before moving on, it’s important to discuss the method more clearly. To discover the truth where 23Religion and Science come together, we need to understand where to search for it and what type of truth we can expect.
§ 7. We have found à priori reason for believing that in all religions, even the rudest, there lies hidden a fundamental verity. We have inferred that this fundamental verity is that element common to all religions, which remains after their discordant peculiarities have been mutually cancelled. And we have further inferred that this element is almost certain to be more abstract than any current religious doctrine. Now it is manifest that only in some highly abstract proposition, can Religion and Science find a common ground. Neither such dogmas as those of the trinitarian and unitarian, nor any such idea as that of propitiation, common though it may be to all religions, can serve as the desired basis of agreement; for Science cannot recognize beliefs like these: they lie beyond its sphere. Hence we see not only that, judging by analogy, the essential truth contained in Religion is that most abstract element pervading all its forms; but also that this most abstract element is the only one in which Religion is likely to agree with Science.
§ 7. We have found a priori reason to believe that in all religions, even the simplest ones, there is a hidden fundamental truth. We have concluded that this fundamental truth is the common element found in all religions, which remains after removing their conflicting unique aspects. Additionally, we have inferred that this element is likely to be more abstract than any current religious doctrine. Now it is clear that only in some highly abstract statement can Religion and Science find common ground. Neither doctrines like those of the trinitarian and unitarian, nor concepts like propitiation, although common to all religions, can serve as the foundation for agreement; Science cannot accept beliefs like these, as they are outside its domain. Therefore, we see not only that, based on analogy, the essential truth found in Religion is that most abstract element that permeates all its forms; but also that this most abstract element is the only one in which Religion is likely to align with Science.
Similarly if we begin at the other end, and inquire what scientific truth can unite Science and Religion. It is at once manifest that Religion can take no cognizance of special scientific doctrines; any more than Science can take cognizance of special religious doctrines. The truth which Science asserts and Religion indorses cannot be one furnished by mathematics; nor can it be a physical truth; nor can it be a truth in chemistry: it cannot be a truth belonging to any particular science. No generalization of the phenomena of space, of time, of matter, or of force, can become a Religious conception. Such a conception, if it anywhere exists in Science, must be more general than any of these—must be one underlying all of them. If there be a fact which Science recognizes in common with Religion, it must be that 24fact from which the several branches of Science diverge, as from their common root.
Similarly, if we start from the other end and ask what scientific truth can connect Science and Religion, it’s clear that Religion can’t acknowledge specific scientific doctrines any more than Science can recognize specific religious doctrines. The truth that Science asserts and Religion supports can’t be something provided by mathematics, nor can it be a physical truth, nor a truth in chemistry; it can’t be a truth tied to any particular science. No generalization of the phenomena of space, time, matter, or force can become a religious concept. Such a concept, if it exists in Science, must be broader than any of these and must underlie all of them. If there is a fact that Science shares with Religion, it must be that fact from which the various branches of Science branch out, just like they do from a common root.
Assuming then, that since these two great realities are constituents of the same mind, and respond to different aspects of the same Universe, there must be a fundamental harmony between them; we see good reason to conclude that the most abstract truth contained in Religion and the most abstract truth contained in Science must be the one in which the two coalesce. The largest fact to be found within our mental range must be the one of which we are in search. Uniting these positive and negative poles of human thought, it must be the ultimate fact in our intelligence.
Assuming that these two significant realities are parts of the same mind and correspond to different aspects of the same Universe, there must be a fundamental harmony between them. We have good reason to believe that the most abstract truths in Religion and Science should coincide. The greatest fact within our understanding has to be what we're searching for. By bringing together these positive and negative aspects of human thought, it should represent the ultimate truth in our understanding.
§ 8. Before proceeding in the search for this common datum let me bespeak a little patience. The next three chapters, setting out from different points and converging to the same conclusion, will be comparatively unattractive. Students of philosophy will find in them much that is more or less familiar; and to most of those who are unacquainted with the literature of modern metaphysics, they may prove somewhat difficult to follow.
§ 8. Before we continue our search for this common ground, I ask for a bit of patience. The next three chapters will come from different angles but lead to the same conclusion, and they might be a bit dull. Philosophy students will find a lot that's somewhat familiar; for most people who aren't familiar with modern metaphysics literature, these chapters might be a bit challenging to understand.
Our argument however cannot dispense with these chapters; and the greatness of the question at issue justifies even a heavier tax on the reader’s attention. The matter is one which concerns each and all of us more than any other matter whatever. Though it affects us little in a direct way, the view we arrive at must indirectly affect us in all our relations—must determine our conception of the Universe, of Life, of Human Nature—must influence our ideas of right and wrong, and so modify our conduct. To reach that point of view from which the seeming discordance of Religion and Science disappears, and the two merge into one, must cause a revolution of thought fruitful in beneficial consequences, and must surely be worth an effort.
Our argument, however, can't skip over these chapters; the significance of the issue at hand justifies an even greater demand on the reader’s attention. This topic affects each and every one of us more than anything else. Although it impacts us indirectly, the perspective we adopt will indirectly influence all our relationships—it will shape our understanding of the Universe, Life, and Human Nature—it will sway our notions of right and wrong, and consequently alter our behavior. To arrive at a perspective from which the apparent conflict between Religion and Science disappears, merging them into one view, will spark a revolution in thinking that brings about positive change, and it’s certainly worth the effort.
Here ending preliminaries, let us now address ourselves to this all-important inquiry.
Here, having finished the preliminaries, let's now focus on this crucial question.
CHAPTER II.
TOP RELIGIOUS CONCEPTS.
§ 9. When, on the sea-shore, we note how the hulls of distant vessels are hidden below the horizon, and how, of still remoter vessels, only the uppermost sails are visible, we realize with tolerable clearness the slight curvature of that portion of the sea’s surface which lies before us. But when we seek in imagination to follow out this curved surface as it actually exists, slowly bending round until all its meridians meet in a point eight thousand miles below our feet, we find ourselves utterly baffled. We cannot conceive in its real form and magnitude even that small segment of our globe which extends a hundred miles on every side of us; much less the globe as a whole. The piece of rock on which we stand can be mentally represented with something like completeness: we find ourselves able to think of its top, its sides, and its under surface at the same time; or so nearly at the same time that they seem all present in consciousness together; and so we can form what we call a conception of the rock. But to do the like with the Earth we find impossible. If even to imagine the antipodes as at that distant place in space which it actually occupies, is beyond our power; much more beyond our power must it be at the same time to imagine all other remote points on the Earth’s surface as in their actual places. Yet we habitually speak as though we had an idea of the Earth—as though we could think of it in the same way that we think of minor objects.
§ 9. When we stand on the shore and see how the hulls of distant ships disappear below the horizon, while only the tops of the sails of even more distant vessels are visible, we can clearly notice the slight curve of the sea’s surface in front of us. However, when we try to imagine this curved surface as it really is, gradually bending until all its meridians meet at a point eight thousand miles below us, we become completely puzzled. We can’t fully grasp the true shape and size of even that small section of our planet that extends a hundred miles in every direction; let alone the entire globe. The piece of rock we’re standing on can be pictured in some completeness: we can think about the top, the sides, and the underside almost simultaneously, to the point where they all feel present in our mind together; thus, we can create what we call a mental image of the rock. But doing the same with Earth is impossible for us. Even imagining the opposite side of the world as that far-off spot in space is beyond our capability; it’s even harder to picture all the other distant points on the Earth’s surface in their actual locations. Yet, we usually talk as if we have a clear idea of the Earth—as if we could think about it just like we think about smaller objects.
26What conception, then, do we form of it? the reader may ask. That its name calls up in us some state of consciousness is unquestionable; and if this state of consciousness is not a conception, properly so called, what is it? The answer seems to be this:—We have learnt by indirect methods that the Earth is a sphere; we have formed models approximately representing its shape and the distribution of its parts; generally when the Earth is referred to, we either think of an indefinitely extended mass beneath our feet, or else, leaving out the actual Earth, we think of a body like a terrestrial globe; but when we seek to imagine the Earth as it really is, we join these two ideas as well as we can—such perception as our eyes give us of the Earth’s surface we couple with the conception of a sphere. And thus we form of the Earth, not a conception properly so called, but only a symbolic conception.[6]
26So, what idea do we have about it? The reader might ask. It's clear that the name brings about some awareness in us; and if this awareness isn’t a true concept, then what is it? The answer seems to be this: We’ve learned through indirect methods that the Earth is a sphere; we've created models that roughly represent its shape and how its parts are arranged. Usually, when we talk about the Earth, we either think of an endless mass beneath us, or we envision a globe-like body; but when we try to imagine the Earth as it really is, we combine these two ideas as best as we can—what we see of the Earth’s surface with the idea of a sphere. So we picture the Earth, not as a fully realized concept, but just as a symbolic idea. [6]
A large proportion of our conceptions, including all those of much generality, are of this order. Great magnitudes, great durations, great numbers, are none of them actually conceived, but are all of them conceived more or less symbolically; and so, too, are all those classes of objects of which we predicate some common fact. When mention is made of any individual man, a tolerably complete idea of him is formed. If the family he belongs to be spoken of, probably but a part of it will be represented in thought: under the necessity of attending to that which is said about the family, we realize in imagination only its most important or familiar members, and pass over the rest with a nascent consciousness which we know could, if requisite, be made complete. Should something be remarked of the class, say farmers, to which this family belongs, we neither enumerate in thought all the individuals contained in the class, nor believe that we could do so if required; but we are content with taking some few samples 27of it, and remembering that these could be indefinitely multiplied. Supposing the subject of which something is predicated be Englishmen, the answering state of consciousness is a still more inadequate representative of the reality. Yet more remote is the likeness of the thought to the thing, if reference be made to Europeans or to human beings. And when we come to propositions concerning the mammalia, or concerning the whole of the vertebrata, or concerning animals in general, or concerning all organic beings, the unlikeness of our conceptions to the objects named reaches its extreme. Throughout which series of instances we see, that as the number of objects grouped together in thought increases, the concept, formed of a few typical samples joined with the notion of multiplicity, becomes more and more a mere symbol; not only because it gradually ceases to represent the size of the group, but also because as the group grows more heterogeneous, the typical samples thought of are less like the average objects which the group contains.
A large part of our ideas, including many general ones, belong to this category. We don't actually conceive of great sizes, long durations, or huge numbers; we think of them more symbolically. This also applies to classes of objects where we state some common fact. When we talk about any individual man, we form a fairly complete idea of him. If we mention his family, we likely only think of part of it; while we focus on what is said about the family, we only imagine its most important or familiar members, leaving the rest in a state of awareness that we know could be filled in if needed. If we then reference the group, like farmers, to which this family belongs, we neither think of every individual in the group nor believe we could do so if asked; we’re fine with just considering a few examples and remembering that there could be many more. If the subject is Englishmen, our mental picture is even less representative of reality. The gap between thought and reality widens even more when we think about Europeans or humans. And when we talk about mammals, vertebrates, animals in general, or all living beings, the disparity between our ideas and the mentioned objects reaches its peak. Throughout these examples, we see that as the number of objects considered increases, the concept formed from a few typical examples combined with the idea of multiplicity becomes more of a mere symbol; not only because it gradually stops reflecting the size of the group, but also because as the group becomes more diverse, the typical examples we think of have less in common with the average objects found in that group.
This formation of symbolic conceptions, which inevitably arises as we pass from small and concrete objects to large and to discrete ones, is mostly a very useful, and indeed necessary, process. When, instead of things whose attributes can be tolerably well united in a single state of consciousness, we have to deal with things whose attributes are too vast or numerous to be so united, we must either drop in thought part of their attributes, or else not think of them at all—either form a more or less symbolic conception, or no conception. We must predicate nothing of objects too great or too multitudinous to be mentally represented; or we must make our predications by the help of extremely inadequate representations of such objects—mere symbols of them.
This creation of symbolic ideas, which naturally happens as we move from small, concrete objects to larger, more abstract ones, is mostly a really helpful, and indeed essential, process. When we deal with things whose qualities are too vast or numerous to be easily grasped in one thought, we either have to ignore some of their qualities or not think about them at all—either form a more or less symbolic idea, or have no idea at all. We can't make claims about objects that are too big or too numerous to be mentally represented; or we have to make our claims using very inadequate representations of such objects—just mere symbols of them.
But while by this process alone we are enabled to form general propositions, and so to reach general conclusions, we are by this process perpetually led into danger, and very often into error. We habitually mistake our symbolic conceptions for real ones; and so are betrayed into countless false inferences. 28Not only is it that in proportion as the concept we form of any thing or class of things, misrepresents the reality, we are apt to be wrong in any assertion we make respecting the reality; but it is that we are led to suppose we have truly conceived a great variety of things which we have conceived only in this fictitious way; and further to confound with these certain things which cannot be conceived in any way. How almost unavoidably we fall into this error it will be needful here to observe.
But while this process allows us to create general statements and reach broad conclusions, it also constantly puts us at risk of making mistakes and believing inaccuracies. We often confuse our symbolic ideas with actual reality, which leads us to numerous incorrect assumptions. 28Not only do we tend to be wrong in any claims we make about reality if our concepts misrepresent it, but we also come to believe that we truly understand a wide range of things that we have only imagined in this misleading manner; furthermore, we mix these up with certain realities that cannot be understood in any form. We must take note of how easily we fall into this trap.
From objects readily representable in their totality, to those of which we cannot form even an approximate representation, there is an insensible transition. Between a pebble and the entire Earth a series of magnitudes might be introduced, each of which differed from the adjacent ones so slightly that it would be impossible to say at what point in the series our conceptions of them became inadequate. Similarly, there is a gradual progression from those groups of a few individuals which we can think of as groups with tolerable completeness, to those larger and larger groups of which we can form nothing like true ideas. Whence it is manifest that we pass from actual conceptions to symbolic ones by infinitesimal steps. Note next that we are led to deal with our symbolic conceptions as though they were actual ones, not only because we cannot clearly separate the two, but also because, in the great majority of cases, the first serve our purposes nearly or quite as well as the last—are simply the abbreviated signs we substitute for those more elaborate signs which are our equivalents for real objects. Those very imperfect representations of ordinary things which we habitually make in thinking, we know can be developed into adequate ones if needful. Those concepts of larger magnitudes and more extensive classes which we cannot make adequate, we still find can be verified by some indirect process of measurement or enumeration. And even in the case of such an utterly inconceivable object as the Solar System, we yet, through the fulfilment of predictions founded on our symbolic conception of it, gain the 29conviction that this symbolic conception stands for an actual existence, and, in a sense, truly expresses certain of its constituent relations. Thus our symbolic conceptions being in the majority of cases capable of development into complete ones, and in most other cases serving as steps to conclusions which are proved valid by their correspondence with observation, we acquire a confirmed habit of dealing with them as true conceptions—as real representations of actualities. Learning by long experience that they can, if needful, be verified, we are led habitually to accept them without verification. And thus we open the door to some which profess to stand for known things, but which really stand for things that cannot be known in any way.
From things we can easily understand completely to those we can’t even represent closely, there’s a subtle shift. Between a pebble and the whole Earth, there’s a range of sizes that connect them, each differing just enough that it's hard to pinpoint when our understanding becomes inadequate. Similarly, there's a gradual movement from small groups of people that we can think about quite well to larger and larger groups for which we can’t form accurate ideas at all. This shows that we shift from real ideas to symbolic ones in tiny steps. Next, we often treat our symbolic ideas as if they were real, not only because we can't clearly separate the two, but also because, in most cases, the symbols work just as well or almost as well as the real concepts—they are just shorthand for the more detailed representations of actual things. Those imperfect mental images of common objects we usually create can be expanded into accurate ones if needed. For larger concepts and broader categories that we can't fully grasp, we find they can still be checked through indirect methods of measuring or counting. Even with something as hard to imagine as the Solar System, we gain confidence that our symbolic idea represents something real because our predictions based on that idea tend to be accurate, showing it reflects certain real relationships. Since most of our symbolic concepts can often be developed into complete ones and usually lead to conclusions that hold up when we observe them, we develop a habit of treating them as true ideas—actual representations of reality. Through long experience, we learn that they can be verified if necessary, which leads us to often accept them without question. This opens the door to some that claim to represent known realities but actually refer to things that can’t be known at all.
To sum up, we must say of conceptions in general, that they are complete only when the attributes of the object conceived are of such number and kind that they can be represented in consciousness so nearly at the same time as to seem all present together; that as the objects conceived become larger and more complex, some of the attributes first thought of fade from consciousness before the rest have been represented, and the conception thus becomes imperfect; that when the size, complexity, or discreteness of the object conceived becomes very great, only a small portion of its attributes can be thought of at once, and the conception formed of it thus becomes so inadequate as to be a mere symbol; that nevertheless such symbolic conceptions, which are indispensable in general thinking, are legitimate, provided that by some cumulative or indirect process of thought, or by the fulfilment of predictions based on them, we can assure ourselves that they stand for actualities; but that when our symbolic conceptions are such that no cumulative or indirect processes of thought can enable us to ascertain that there are corresponding actualities, nor any predictions be made whose fulfilment can prove this, then they are altogether vicious and illusive, and in no way distinguishable from pure fictions.
To sum up, we can say about concepts in general that they are complete only when the characteristics of the object being thought of are numerous and varied enough to be represented in our mind almost simultaneously, making them feel like they are all present at once. As the objects we think about become larger and more complex, some of the attributes we initially consider fade from our awareness before the others are fully represented, causing the concept to become imperfect. When the size, complexity, or individuality of the object grows significantly, we can only think of a small portion of its attributes at once, making our understanding of it so insufficient that it becomes just a symbol. However, these symbolic concepts, which are essential for general thinking, are valid, as long as we can somehow confirm that they represent real things, either through a cumulative process of thought or by fulfilling predictions based on them. Yet, when our symbolic concepts are such that no cumulative or indirect reasoning can help us verify that there are corresponding real things, and no predictions can be made that would demonstrate this, then they are entirely flawed and misleading, indistinguishable from pure fictions.
30§ 10. And now to consider the bearings of this general truth on our immediate topic—Ultimate Religious Ideas.
30§ 10. Now let's think about how this general truth relates to our current topic—Ultimate Religious Ideas.
To the aboriginal man and to every civilized child the problem of the Universe suggests itself. What is it? and whence comes it? are questions that press for solution, when, from time to time, the imagination rises above daily trivialities. To fill the vacuum of thought, any theory that is proposed seems better than none. And in the absence of others, any theory that is proposed easily gains a footing and afterwards maintains its ground: partly from the readiness of mankind to accept proximate explanations; partly from the authority which soon accumulates round such explanations when given.
To the native person and to every modern child, the mystery of the Universe becomes a pressing question. What is it? Where does it come from? These questions demand answers when, occasionally, our imagination rises above everyday concerns. To fill the void in understanding, any theory that comes up seems better than having none at all. And in the lack of alternatives, any proposed theory quickly finds acceptance and manages to hold its ground: partly because people are quick to accept surface-level explanations, and partly because authority builds up around such explanations once they are presented.
A critical examination, however, will prove not only that no current hypothesis is tenable, but also that no tenable hypothesis can be framed.
A critical examination, however, will show not only that no current hypothesis is valid, but also that no valid hypothesis can be created.
§ 11. Respecting the origin of the Universe three verbally intelligible suppositions may be made. We may assert that it is self-existent; or that it is self-created; or that it is created by an external agency. Which of these suppositions is most credible it is not needful here to inquire. The deeper question, into which this finally merges, is, whether any one of them is even conceivable in the true sense of the word. Let us successively test them.
§ 11. When it comes to the origin of the Universe, three clear ideas can be considered. We might say that it exists by itself, or that it came into being by itself, or that it was created by something outside of itself. It's not necessary to determine which of these ideas is the most believable. The more profound question, which ultimately connects to this, is whether any of these ideas can truly be imagined in the proper sense of the word. Let’s examine each of them in turn.
When we speak of a man as self-supporting, of an apparatus as self-acting, or of a tree as self-developed, our expressions, however inexact, stand for things that can be realized in thought with tolerable completeness. Our conception of the self-development of a tree is doubtless symbolic. But though we cannot really represent in consciousness the entire series of complex changes through which the tree passes, yet we can thus represent the leading features of the series; and general experience teaches us that by long continued observation we could gain the power to realize in thought a series of changes more fully representing the actual 31series: that is, we know that our symbolic conception of self-development can be expanded into something like a real conception; and that it expresses, however inaccurately, an actual process in nature. But when we speak of self-existence, and, helped by the above analogies, form some vague symbolic conception of it, we delude ourselves in supposing that this symbolic conception is of the same order as the others. On joining the word self to the word existence, the force of association makes us believe we have a thought like that suggested by the compound word self-acting. An endeavour to expand this symbolic conception, however, will undeceive us. In the first place, it is clear that by self-existence we especially mean, an existence independent of any other—not produced by any other: the assertion of self-existence is simply an indirect denial of creation. In thus excluding the idea of any antecedent cause, we necessarily exclude the idea of a beginning; for to admit the idea of a beginning—to admit that there was a time when the existence had not commenced—is to admit that its commencement was determined by something, or was caused; which is a contradiction. Self-existence, therefore, necessarily means existence without a beginning; and to form a conception of self-existence is to form a conception of existence without a beginning. Now by no mental effort can we do this. To conceive existence through infinite past-time, implies the conception of infinite past-time, which is an impossibility. To this let us add, that even were self-existence conceivable, it would not in any sense be an explanation of the Universe. No one will say that the existence of an object at the present moment is made easier to understand by the discovery that it existed an hour ago, or a day ago, or a year ago; and if its existence now is not made in the least degree more comprehensible by its existence during some previous finite period of time, then no accumulation of such finite periods, even could we extend them to an infinite period, would make it more comprehensible. Thus the Atheistic theory is not only absolutely unthinkable, 32but, even if it were thinkable, would not be a solution. The assertion that the Universe is self-existent does not really carry us a step beyond the cognition of its present existence; and so leaves us with a mere re-statement of the mystery.
When we talk about a person as self-sufficient, a machine as self-operating, or a tree as self-growing, our phrases, even if not precise, refer to concepts that we can understand fairly well. Our idea of a tree's self-growth is definitely symbolic. Although we can’t fully grasp all the complex changes a tree goes through, we can certainly capture the main aspects of that process. Experience shows us that after observing for a long time, we could improve our understanding of these changes to better represent what actually happens. In other words, we know our symbolic idea of self-growth can be expanded to resemble a real idea; it conveys, even if not accurately, a real process in nature. However, when we discuss self-existence and, using the previous examples, create a vague symbolic idea about it, we trick ourselves into thinking this idea is on the same level as the others. By combining the word self with existence, the association leads us to believe we have a thought similar to what the term self-operating suggests. Trying to expand this symbolic idea will reveal our misconception. Firstly, it’s clear that by self-existence, we particularly mean an existence that is independent of anything else—not created by anything else: claiming self-existence is basically denying creation. By excluding the concept of any prior cause, we automatically eliminate the idea of a beginning; because to accept the notion of a beginning—acknowledging there was a time when existence hadn’t started—is to admit that its beginning was determined or caused by something, which is contradictory. Therefore, self-existence must imply existence without a beginning; forming a concept of self-existence means conceiving of existence that has no starting point. However, no mental effort can achieve this. To imagine existence through an infinite past implies understanding infinite past time, which is impossible. Moreover, even if self-existence could be imagined, it wouldn’t explain the Universe in any way. No one would argue that knowing an object existed an hour ago, a day ago, or a year ago makes its existence right now any clearer; if its current existence isn’t more understandable because it existed for some previous period, then no amount of those periods, even if we stretched them to infinity, would clarify it. Thus, the Atheistic theory is not only completely unthinkable, but even if it were thinkable, that wouldn’t resolve anything. The claim that the Universe is self-existent doesn’t really advance our understanding of its current existence; it merely reiterates the mystery.
The hypothesis of self-creation, which practically amounts to what is called Pantheism, is similarly incapable of being represented in thought. Certain phenomena, such as the precipitation of invisible vapour into cloud, aid us in forming a symbolic conception of a self-evolved Universe; and there are not wanting indications in the heavens, and on the earth, which help us to render this conception tolerably definite. But while the succession of phases through which the Universe has passed in reaching its present form, may perhaps be comprehended as in a sense self-determined; yet the impossibility of expanding our symbolic conception of self-creation into a real conception, remains as complete as ever. Really to conceive self-creation, is to conceive potential existence passing into actual existence by some inherent necessity; which we cannot do. We cannot form any idea of a potential existence of the universe, as distinguished from its actual existence. If represented in thought at all, potential existence must be represented as something, that is as an actual existence; to suppose that it can be represented as nothing, involves two absurdities—that nothing is more than a negation, and can be positively represented in thought; and that one nothing is distinguished from all other nothings by its power to develope into something. Nor is this all. We have no state of consciousness answering to the words—an inherent necessity by which potential existence became actual existence. To render them into thought, existence, having for an indefinite period remained in one form, must be conceived as passing without any external or additional impulse, into another form; and this involves the idea of a change without a cause—a thing of which no idea is possible. Thus the terms of this hypothesis do not stand for real thoughts; but merely suggest the 33vaguest symbols incapable of any interpretation. Moreover, even were it true that potential existence is conceivable as a different thing from actual existence; and that the transition from the one to the other can be mentally realized as a self-determined change; we should still be no forwarder: the problem would simply be removed a step back. For whence the potential existence? This would just as much require accounting for as actual existence; and just the same difficulties would meet us. Respecting the origin of such a latent power, no other suppositions could be made than those above named—self-existence, self-creation, creation by external agency. The self-existence of a potential universe is no more conceivable than we have found the self-existence of the actual universe to be. The self-creation of such a potential universe would involve over again the difficulties here stated—would imply behind this potential universe a more remote potentiality; and so on in an infinite series, leaving us at last no forwarder than at first. While to assign as the source of this potential universe an external agency, would be to introduce the notion of a potential universe for no purpose whatever.
The idea of self-creation, which is essentially what we call Pantheism, cannot really be clearly understood. Certain events, like how invisible vapor turns into clouds, help us form a symbolic idea of a self-evolving Universe; there are signs in the sky and on earth that make this idea somewhat clear. However, even though we might think of the sequence of phases the Universe went through to reach its current state as somewhat self-determined, we still can't expand our symbolic idea of self-creation into a real understanding. To truly grasp self-creation means imagining potential existence becoming actual existence out of some inherent necessity, which is something we can't do. We can't conceive of a potential existence of the universe as separate from its actual existence. If we are to think about potential existence at all, it must be seen as something, an actual existence; to think of it as nothing involves two contradictions—that nothing is just a negation and can't be positively thought of; and that one nothing can be different from all other nothings by having the ability to become something. Moreover, we have no state of consciousness that corresponds to the idea of an inherent necessity that turns potential existence into actual existence. To make sense of this, we must imagine existence, which remains in one form for an indefinite time, somehow changing into another form without any external stimulation or added trigger; this implies a change without a cause—a notion we can't conceive. Thus, the terms of this hypothesis don't represent real thoughts; they merely hint at the most vague symbols that cannot be interpreted. Furthermore, even if we could conceive of potential existence as something different from actual existence and believe that the shift from one to the other could be imagined as a self-determined change, we'd still be stuck. The question would simply shift back a step. Where does the potential existence come from? It would need to be explained just as much as actual existence, and we would face the same challenges. Regarding the origin of such latent power, we could only hypothesize similar ideas—self-existence, self-creation, or creation by some external force. The self-existence of a potential universe is just as unimaginable as the self-existence of the actual universe has proven to be. The self-creation of such a potential universe would again lead us back to the difficulties already mentioned—suggesting that behind this potential universe is a further, more distant potentiality, and so on in an endless sequence, leaving us no closer to an answer than we were initially. To say this potential universe comes from an external force would merely introduce the idea of a potential universe without serving any real purpose.
There remains to be examined the commonly-received or theistic hypothesis—creation by external agency. Alike in the rudest creeds and in the cosmogony long current among ourselves, it is assumed that the genesis of the Heavens and the Earth is effected somewhat after the manner in which a workman shapes a piece of furniture. And this assumption is made not by theologians only, but by the immense majority of philosophers, past and present. Equally in the writings of Plato, and in those of not a few living men of science, we find it taken for granted that there is an analogy between the process of creation and the process of manufacture. Now in the first place, not only is this conception one that cannot by any cumulative process of thought, or the fulfilment of predictions based on it, be shown to answer to anything actual; and not only is it that in the absence of all evidence 34respecting the process of creation, we have no proof of correspondence even between this limited conception and some limited portion of the fact; but it is that the conception is not even consistent with itself—cannot be realized in thought, when all its assumptions are granted. Though it is true that the proceedings of a human artificer may vaguely symbolize to us a method after which the Universe might be shaped, yet they do not help us to comprehend the real mystery; namely, the origin of the material of which the Universe consists. The artizan does not make the iron, wood, or stone, he uses; but merely fashions and combines them. If we suppose suns, and planets, and satellites, and all they contain to have been similarly formed by a “Great Artificer,” we suppose merely that certain pre-existing elements were thus put into their present arrangement. But whence the pre-existing elements? The comparison helps us not in the least to understand that; and unless it helps us to understand that, it is worthless. The production of matter out of nothing is the real mystery, which neither this simile nor any other enables us to conceive; and a simile which does not enable us to conceive this, may just as well be dispensed with. Still more manifest does the insufficiency of this theory of creation become, when we turn from material objects to that which contains them—when instead of matter we contemplate space. Did there exist nothing but an immeasurable void, explanation would be needed as much as now. There would still arise the question—how came it so? If the theory of creation by external agency were an adequate one, it would supply an answer; and its answer would be—space was made in the same manner that matter was made. But the impossibility of conceiving this is so manifest, that no one dares to assert it. For if space was created, it must have been previously non-existent. The non-existence of space cannot, however, by any mental effort be imagined. It is one of the most familiar truths that the idea of space as surrounding us on all sides, is not for a moment to be got rid of—not only are we compelled to think of 35space as now everywhere present, but we are unable to conceive its absence either in the past or the future. And if the non-existence of space is absolutely inconceivable, then, necessarily, its creation is absolutely inconceivable. Lastly, even supposing that the genesis of the Universe could really be represented in thought as the result of an external agency, the mystery would be as great as ever; for there would still arise the question—how came there to be an external agency? To account for this only the same three hypotheses are possible—self-existence, self-creation, and creation by external agency. Of these the last is useless: it commits us to an infinite series of such agencies, and even then leaves us where we were. By the second we are practically involved in the same predicament; since, as already shown, self-creation implies an infinite series of potential existences. We are obliged therefore to fall back upon the first, which is the one commonly accepted and commonly supposed to be satisfactory. Those who cannot conceive a self-existent universe; and who therefore assume a creator as the source of the universe; take for granted that they can conceive a self-existent creator. The mystery which they recognize in this great fact surrounding them on every side, they transfer to an alleged source of this great fact; and then suppose that they have solved the mystery. But they delude themselves. As was proved at the outset of the argument, self-existence is rigorously inconceivable; and this holds true whatever be the nature of the object of which it is predicated. Whoever agrees that the atheistic hypothesis is untenable because it involves the impossible idea of self-existence, must perforce admit that the theistic hypothesis is untenable if it contains the same impossible idea.
There still needs to be discussed the commonly accepted or theistic idea—creation by an outside force. In both the simplest beliefs and the long-standing cosmogony present among us, it is assumed that the creation of the heavens and the earth occurs somewhat like a craftsman shaping a piece of furniture. This assumption is held not just by theologians but by the vast majority of philosophers, both past and present. We find in the writings of Plato and in those of several contemporary scientists a presumption that there's a similarity between the process of creation and the process of manufacturing. Now, first of all, this concept cannot be shown, through any accumulated reasoning or successful predictions based on it, to correspond to anything actual; and there is no proof of any connection between this limited idea and even a small slice of reality in the absence of all evidence about the creation process. Moreover, the idea does not even remain consistent within itself—it cannot be fully realized in thought when all its assumptions are accepted. Although it’s true that what a human craftsman does might vaguely symbolize a method by which the universe could be constructed, it does not help us grasp the real mystery; that is, the source of the materials that make up the universe. The craftsman does not create the iron, wood, or stone he uses; he merely shapes and combines them. If we assume that suns, planets, and satellites, along with everything they contain, were similarly formed by a “Great Craftsman,” we would just be suggesting that certain pre-existing elements were arranged in their current setup. But where did those pre-existing elements come from? This comparison does nothing to help us understand that; and unless it clarifies that, it is useless. The creation of matter from nothing is the real mystery, which neither this analogy nor any other allows us to conceive; and an analogy that doesn’t help us understand this can just as well be discarded. The inadequacy of this theory of creation becomes even more evident when we shift our focus from material objects to the space that contains them. If there was only an endless void, we would still need an explanation just as much as we do now. The question would still arise—how did it come to be that way? If the theory of creation by an outside force were adequate, it would provide an answer; and that answer would be—space was created in the same manner that matter was created. But the impossibility of imagining this is so clear that no one dares to claim it. Because if space was created, it must have been non-existent before. However, the idea of space not existing simply cannot be imagined. It is one of the most obvious truths that the concept of space surrounding us on all sides can’t be disregarded for a moment— not only are we forced to think of space as currently everywhere present, but we can’t imagine it being absent either in the past or the future. If the non-existence of space is completely unimaginable, then its creation is, by necessity, equally inconceivable. Finally, even if we could really picture the origin of the universe as the result of an external force, the mystery would still be as great as ever; the question would still arise—how did this external force come to exist? To explain this, we only have the same three possibilities—self-existence, self-creation, and creation by an outside agency. Of these, the last is of no help: it leads us to an infinite series of such forces and still leaves us where we started. The second option puts us in a practically similar situation; as previously shown, self-creation implies an infinite series of potential existences. Therefore, we must revert to the first option, which is the one commonly accepted and believed to be satisfactory. Those who cannot imagine a self-existent universe, and thus assume a creator as the source of the universe, take for granted that they can envision a self-existent creator. They transfer the mystery they see in this vast reality surrounding them onto a supposed source of this reality, believing they have solved the mystery. But they are misled. As shown at the beginning of the argument, self-existence is inherently inconceivable; and this remains true regardless of the nature of the object being considered. Anyone who agrees that the atheistic hypothesis is untenable because it involves the impossible idea of self-existence must also admit that the theistic hypothesis is untenable if it also contains the same impossible idea.
Thus these three different suppositions respecting the origin of things, verbally intelligible though they are, and severally seeming to their respective adherents quite rational, turn out, when critically examined, to be literally unthinkable. It is not a question of probability, or credibility, but of conceivability. Experiment proves that the elements of these hypotheses 36cannot even be put together in consciousness; and we can entertain them only as we entertain such pseud-ideas as a square fluid and a moral substance—only by abstaining from the endeavour to render them into actual thoughts. Or, reverting to our original mode of statement, we may say that they severally involve symbolic conceptions of the illegitimate and illusive kind. Differing so widely as they seem to do, the atheistic, the pantheistic, and the theistic hypotheses contain the same ultimate element. It is impossible to avoid making the assumption of self-existence somewhere; and whether that assumption be made nakedly, or under complicated disguises, it is equally vicious, equally unthinkable. Be it a fragment of matter, or some fancied potential form of matter, or some more remote and still less imaginable cause, our conception of its self-existence can be formed only by joining with it the notion of unlimited duration through past time. And as unlimited duration is inconceivable, all those formal ideas into which it enters are inconceivable; and indeed, if such an expression is allowable, are the more inconceivable in proportion as the other elements of the ideas are indefinite. So that in fact, impossible as it is to think of the actual universe as self-existing, we do but multiply impossibilities of thought by every attempt we make to explain its existence.
Therefore, these three different theories about the origin of things, though they may be understandable and seem reasonable to their supporters, end up being literally unthinkable when examined closely. It’s not a matter of likelihood or believability, but of what we can actually conceive. Experiments show that the elements of these ideas can’t even be assembled in our minds; we can only think of them as we do with concepts like a square liquid or a moral substance—only by avoiding the effort to turn them into real thoughts. Or, to restate it, they each involve symbolic ideas that are both misguided and misleading. Despite their apparent differences, the atheistic, pantheistic, and theistic theories all share the same fundamental element. It’s impossible to escape the assumption of some form of self-existence; whether this assumption is made plainly or wrapped in complex disguises, it’s equally flawed and unthinkable. Whether it’s a piece of matter, some imagined potential form of matter, or an even more abstract and unimaginable cause, our notion of its self-existence can only be formed by adding the idea of infinite duration through past time. And since infinite duration is inconceivable, all the formal ideas it enters into are likewise inconceivable; indeed, if such an expression can be used, they become even more inconceivable as the other elements of those ideas are vague. Thus, as impossible as it is to think of the actual universe as self-existing, every effort we make to explain its existence just adds more impossibilities to our thoughts.
§ 12. If from the origin of the Universe we turn to its nature, the like insurmountable difficulties rise up before us on all sides—or rather, the same difficulties under new aspects. We find ourselves on the one hand obliged to make certain assumptions; and yet on the other hand we find these assumptions cannot be represented in thought.
§ 12. If we shift our focus from the origin of the Universe to its nature, we encounter the same insurmountable challenges from all directions—or rather, the same challenges appearing in different ways. On one hand, we are compelled to make certain assumptions; yet on the other hand, we discover that these assumptions cannot be fully grasped in our thoughts.
When we inquire what is the meaning of the various effects produced upon our senses—when we ask how there come to be in our consciousness impressions of sounds, of colours, of tastes, and of those various attributes which we ascribe to bodies; we are compelled to regard them as the effects of some cause. We may stop short in the belief that this cause 37is what we call matter. Or we may conclude, as some do, that matter is only a certain mode of manifestation of spirit; which is therefore the true cause. Or, regarding matter and spirit as proximate agencies, we may attribute all the changes wrought in our consciousness to immediate divine power. But be the cause we assign what it may, we are obliged to suppose some cause. And we are not only obliged to suppose some cause, but also a first cause. The matter, or spirit, or whatever we assume to be the agent producing on us these various impressions, must either be the first cause of them or not. If it is the first cause, the conclusion is reached. If it is not the first cause, then by implication there must be a cause behind it; which thus becomes the real cause of the effect. Manifestly, however complicated the assumptions, the same conclusion must inevitably be reached. We cannot think at all about the impressions which the external world produces on us, without thinking of them as caused; and we cannot carry out an inquiry concerning their causation, without inevitably committing ourselves to the hypothesis of a First Cause.
When we ask what the various effects on our senses mean—like how we experience sounds, colors, tastes, and the different qualities we attribute to objects—we have to see them as the result of some cause. We might settle on the idea that this cause is what we call matter. Alternatively, some might argue that matter is just a way of expressing spirit, which would then be the true cause. Or, if we see matter and spirit as near agents, we might attribute all the changes in our consciousness to direct divine power. Regardless of what cause we propose, we have to assume there is *some* cause. Moreover, we must also assume there is a first cause. The matter, spirit, or whatever we believe is creating these impressions must either be the first cause or not. If it is the first cause, then we have our answer. If it is not, then there must be a cause behind it, which becomes the real cause of the effect. Clearly, no matter how complex the assumptions are, we must reach the same conclusion. We cannot think about the impressions the external world creates in us without considering them as caused; and we cannot investigate their causation without inevitably agreeing on the idea of a First Cause.
But now if we go a step further, and ask what is the nature of this First Cause, we are driven by an inexorable logic to certain further conclusions. Is the First Cause finite or infinite? If we say finite we involve ourselves in a dilemma. To think of the First Cause as finite, is to think of it as limited. To think of it as limited, necessarily implies a conception of something beyond its limits: it is absolutely impossible to conceive a thing as bounded without conceiving a region surrounding its boundaries. What now must we say of this region? If the First Cause is limited, and there consequently lies something outside of it, this something must have no First Cause—must be uncaused. But if we admit that there can be something uncaused, there is no reason to assume a cause for anything. If beyond that finite region over which the First Cause extends, there lies a region, which we are compelled to regard as infinite, over which it does not extend—if we admit 38that there is an infinite uncaused surrounding the finite caused; we tacitly abandon the hypothesis of causation altogether. Thus it is impossible to consider the First Cause as finite. And if it cannot be finite it must be infinite.
But now if we take it a step further and ask what the nature of this First Cause is, we are led by unavoidable logic to certain conclusions. Is the First Cause finite or infinite? If we say it's finite, we get ourselves into a dilemma. To think of the First Cause as finite means to think of it as limited. To think of it as limited necessarily implies a concept of something beyond its limits: it’s completely impossible to conceive of something as bounded without thinking of a region surrounding those boundaries. So what should we say about this region? If the First Cause is limited, and there’s something outside of it, this something must have no First Cause—it must be uncaused. But if we accept that there can be something uncaused, there’s no reason to assume a cause for anything. If beyond that finite region which the First Cause covers there lies a region we have to consider as infinite, which it does not cover—if we accept that there is an infinite uncaused surrounding the finite caused; we subtly abandon the idea of causation altogether. Therefore, it’s impossible to see the First Cause as finite. And if it can't be finite, it must be infinite.
Another inference concerning the First Cause is equally unavoidable. It must be independent. If it is dependent it cannot be the First Cause; for that must be the First Cause on which it depends. It is not enough to say that it is partially independent; since this implies some necessity which determines its partial dependence, and this necessity, be it what it may, must be a higher cause, or the true First Cause, which is a contradiction. But to think of the First Cause as totally independent, is to think of it as that which exists in the absence of all other existence; seeing that if the presence of any other existence is necessary, it must be partially dependent on that other existence, and so cannot be the First Cause. Not only however must the First Cause be a form of being which has no necessary relation to any other form of being, but it can have no necessary relation within itself. There can be nothing in it which determines change, and yet nothing which prevents change. For if it contains something which imposes such necessities or restraints, this something must be a cause higher than the First Cause, which is absurd. Thus the First Cause must be in every sense perfect, complete, total: including within itself all power, and transcending all law. Or to use the established word, it must be absolute.
Another conclusion about the First Cause is just as clear. It has to be independent. If it relies on something else, it can't be the First Cause; that would just make it dependent on whatever it's relying on, which would itself need to be the First Cause. Saying it is partially independent isn't enough either; that suggests some requirement that causes its partial dependence, and this requirement, whatever it is, must be a higher cause or the true First Cause, which is a contradiction. However, to view the First Cause as completely independent means thinking of it as something that exists without any other existence. Since if any other existence is necessary, it must be somewhat reliant on that other existence, and so it can't be the First Cause. Moreover, the First Cause must be a way of being that has no necessary relationship with any other type of being, and it can't have any necessary relationship within itself. There can't be anything in it that causes change, and at the same time, nothing that stops change. If it has something that imposes these necessities or restrictions, then that something would have to be a cause greater than the First Cause, which is unreasonable. Therefore, the First Cause must be, in every way, perfect, complete, and total: encompassing all power within itself and going beyond all laws. Or, to use the common term, it must be absolute.
Here then respecting the nature of the Universe, we seem committed to certain unavoidable conclusions. The objects and actions surrounding us, not less than the phenomena of our own consciousness, compel us to ask a cause; in our search for a cause, we discover no resting place until we arrive at the hypothesis of a First Cause; and we have no alternative but to regard this First Cause as Infinite and Absolute. These are inferences forced upon us by arguments from which there appears no escape. It is hardly needful however to show those who have followed thus far, how illusive are these 39reasonings and their results. But that it would tax the reader’s patience to no purpose, it might easily be proved that the materials of which the argument is built, equally with the conclusions based on them, are merely symbolic conceptions of the illegitimate order. Instead, however, of repeating the disproof used above, it will be desirable to pursue another method; showing the fallacy of these conclusions by disclosing their mutual contradictions.
Here regarding the nature of the Universe, we seem to be led to certain unavoidable conclusions. The objects and actions around us, as well as the phenomena of our own consciousness, force us to ask for a cause; in our search for a cause, we find no resting place until we reach the idea of a First Cause; and we have no choice but to see this First Cause as Infinite and Absolute. These are inferences that seem to have no escape from the arguments presented. However, it doesn't really need to be shown to those who have followed this far how misleading these reasoning processes and their outcomes are. But, to avoid wasting the reader's patience, it could easily be demonstrated that the materials of the argument, along with the conclusions drawn from them, are simply symbolic concepts of an incorrect order. Instead of repeating the disproval mentioned earlier, it would be better to take another approach; revealing the fallacy of these conclusions by exposing their internal contradictions.
Here I cannot do better than avail myself of the demonstration which Mr Mansel, carrying out in detail the doctrine of Sir William Hamilton, has given in his “Limits of Religious Thought.” And I gladly do this, not only because his mode of presentation cannot be improved, but also because, writing as he does in defence of the current Theology, his reasonings will be the more acceptable to the majority of readers.
Here, I can’t do better than use the explanation provided by Mr. Mansel, who thoroughly elaborates on Sir William Hamilton’s ideas in his book "Limits of Religious Thought." I’m happy to do this, not only because his way of presenting the information is top-notch, but also because, since he is writing in defense of contemporary Theology, his arguments will resonate more with most readers.
§ 13. Having given preliminary definitions of the First Cause, of the Infinite, and of the Absolute, Mr Mansel says:—
§ 13. After providing initial definitions of the First Cause, the Infinite, and the Absolute, Mr. Mansel states:—
“But these three conceptions, the Cause, the Absolute, the Infinite, all equally indispensable, do they not imply contradiction to each other, when viewed in conjunction, as attributes of one and the same Being? A Cause cannot, as such, be absolute: the Absolute cannot, as such, be a cause. The cause, as such, exists only in relation to its effect: the cause is a cause of the effect; the effect is an effect of the cause. On the other hand, the conception of the Absolute implies a possible existence out of all relation. We attempt to escape from this apparent contradiction, by introducing the idea of succession in time. The Absolute exists first by itself, and afterwards becomes a Cause. But here we are checked by the third conception, that of the Infinite. How can the Infinite become that which it was not from the first? If Causation is a possible mode of existence, that which exists without causing is not infinite; that which becomes a cause has passed beyond its former limits.” * * *
“But these three ideas—the Cause, the Absolute, and the Infinite—are all equally necessary. Don’t they contradict each other when we look at them together as characteristics of the same Being? A Cause can’t be absolute; the Absolute can’t, in itself, be a cause. A cause only exists in relation to its effect: the cause produces the effect; the effect is a result of the cause. On the other hand, the idea of the Absolute suggests it could exist independently of any relations. We try to resolve this contradiction by introducing the concept of succession in time. The Absolute exists on its own first, and then later becomes a Cause. But this brings us back to the third idea, that of the Infinite. How can the Infinite become something it wasn’t from the very beginning? If Causation is one possible way of existing, then what exists without causing anything is not infinite; if something becomes a cause, it has gone beyond its original limits.”
“Supposing the Absolute to become a cause, it will follow 40that it operates by means of freewill and consciousness. For a necessary cause cannot be conceived as absolute and infinite. If necessitated by something beyond itself, it is thereby limited by a superior power; and if necessitated by itself, it has in its own nature a necessary relation to its effect. The act of causation must therefore be voluntary; and volition is only possible in a conscious being. But consciousness again is only conceivable as a relation. There must be a conscious subject, and an object of which he is conscious. The subject is a subject to the object; the object is an object to the subject; and neither can exist by itself as the absolute. This difficulty, again, may be for the moment evaded, by distinguishing between the absolute as related to another and the absolute as related to itself. The Absolute, it may be said, may possibly be conscious, provided it is only conscious of itself. But this alternative is, in ultimate analysis, no less self-destructive than the other. For the object of consciousness, whether a mode of the subject’s existence or not, is either created in and by the act of consciousness, or has an existence independent of it. In the former case, the object depends upon the subject, and the subject alone is the true absolute. In the latter case, the subject depends upon the object, and the object alone is the true absolute. Or if we attempt a third hypothesis, and maintain that each exists independently of the other, we have no absolute at all, but only a pair of relatives; for coexistence, whether in consciousness or not, is itself a relation.”
“Assuming the Absolute becomes a cause, it follows that it operates through free will and consciousness. A necessary cause cannot be thought of as absolute and infinite. If it is required by something outside of itself, it is limited by a higher power; and if it is required by itself, it inherently has a necessary relationship to its effect. The act of causing must therefore be voluntary, and volition is only possible in a conscious being. However, consciousness itself can only be understood as a relationship. There must be a conscious subject and an object that the subject is aware of. The subject relates to the object, and the object relates to the subject; neither can exist independently as the absolute. This challenge can be temporarily avoided by distinguishing between the absolute as it relates to another and the absolute as it relates to itself. It could be argued that the Absolute might be conscious, as long as it is only aware of itself. But this alternative is, upon closer examination, just as self-defeating as the other. The object of consciousness, whether a part of the subject’s existence or not, is either created by the act of consciousness or exists independently of it. In the first case, the object relies on the subject, making the subject the true absolute. In the second case, the subject relies on the object, making the object the true absolute. Or, if we propose a third option and argue that each exists separately from the other, we have no absolute at all, just a pair of related entities; since coexistence, whether in consciousness or not, is itself a relation.”
“The corollary from this reasoning is obvious. Not only is the Absolute, as conceived, incapable of a necessary relation to anything else; but it is also incapable of containing, by the constitution of its own nature, an essential relation within itself; as a whole, for instance, composed of parts, or as a substance consisting of attributes, or as a conscious subject in antithesis to an object. For if there is in the absolute any principle of unity, distinct from the mere accumulation of parts or attributes, this principle alone is the true absolute. 41If, on the other hand, there is no such principle, then there is no absolute at all, but only a plurality of relatives. The almost unanimous voice of philosophy, in pronouncing that the absolute is both one and simple, must be accepted as the voice of reason also, so far as reason has any voice in the matter. But this absolute unity, as indifferent and containing no attributes, can neither be distinguished from the multiplicity of finite beings by any characteristic feature, nor be identified with them in their multiplicity. Thus we are landed in an inextricable dilemma. The Absolute cannot be conceived as conscious, neither can it be conceived as unconscious: it cannot be conceived as complex, neither can it be conceived as simple: it cannot be conceived by difference, neither can it be conceived by the absence of difference: it cannot be identified with the universe, neither can it be distinguished from it. The One and the Many, regarded as the beginning of existence, are thus alike incomprehensible.”
The conclusion from this thinking is clear. Not only is the Absolute, as defined, unable to have a necessary connection to anything else, but it also cannot have an essential relationship within itself due to its own nature; for example, as a whole made up of parts, or as a substance that consists of attributes, or as a conscious subject in contrast to an object. If there is any unifying principle in the Absolute that is separate from just a collection of parts or attributes, then this principle is the true Absolute. 41If, however, there is no such principle, then there is no Absolute at all, just a variety of relative things. The almost unanimous view of philosophers that the Absolute is both one and simple should also be regarded as the voice of reason to the extent that reason has any say in this. However, this absolute unity, as indifferent and without attributes, cannot be separated from the diversity of finite beings by any distinct feature, nor can it be equated with them in their diversity. This leaves us in a complicated predicament. The Absolute can't be thought of as conscious, nor can it be thought of as unconscious: it can't be viewed as complex, nor can it be viewed as simple: it can't be understood through difference, nor can it be understood through the lack of difference: it can't be identified with the universe, nor can it be distinguished from it. The One and the Many, seen as the origin of existence, are thus equally incomprehensible.
“The fundamental conceptions of Rational Theology being thus self-destructive, we may naturally expect to find the same antagonism manifested in their special applications. * * * How, for example, can Infinite Power be able to do all things, and yet Infinite Goodness be unable to do evil? How can Infinite Justice exact the utmost penalty for every sin, and yet Infinite Mercy pardon the sinner? How can Infinite Wisdom know all that is to come, and yet Infinite Freedom be at liberty to do or to forbear? How is the existence of Evil compatible with that of an infinitely perfect Being; for if he wills it, he is not infinitely good; and if he wills it not, his will is thwarted and his sphere of action limited?” * * *
“The basic ideas of Rational Theology are self-defeating, so we can naturally expect to see the same contradictions in their specific applications. * * * For instance, how can Infinite Power do anything, yet Infinite Goodness be unable to do evil? How can Infinite Justice demand the maximum punishment for every sin, and still Infinite Mercy forgive the sinner? How can Infinite Wisdom know everything that will happen, while Infinite Freedom has the ability to choose or refrain from acting? How can Evil exist alongside an infinitely perfect Being; because if He allows it, He is not infinitely good, and if He does not allow it, His will is hindered and His ability to act is limited?” * * *
“Let us, however, suppose for an instant that these difficulties are surmounted, and the existence of the Absolute securely established on the testimony of reason. Still we have not succeeded in reconciling this idea with that of a Cause: we have done nothing towards explaining how the absolute can give rise to the relative, the infinite to the finite. If the condition of casual activity is a higher state than that of quiescence, 42the Absolute, whether acting voluntarily or involuntarily, has passed from a condition of comparative imperfection to one of comparative perfection; and therefore was not originally perfect. If the state of activity is an inferior state to that of quiescence, the Absolute, in becoming a cause, has lost its original perfection. There remains only the supposition that the two states are equal, and the act of creation one of complete indifference. But this supposition annihilates the unity of the absolute, or it annihilates itself. If the act of creation is real, and yet indifferent, we must admit the possibility of two conceptions of the absolute, the one as productive, the other as non-productive. If the act is not real, the supposition itself vanishes.” * * *
“Let’s imagine for a moment that these challenges are overcome, and the existence of the Absolute is firmly established on rational grounds. Even then, we haven’t managed to reconcile this concept with that of a Cause; we still haven't explained how the absolute can lead to the relative, or the infinite to the finite. If the condition of causal activity is a higher state than that of stillness, then the Absolute, whether acting on its own or not, has moved from a state of relative imperfection to one of relative perfection, meaning it wasn't originally perfect. If the state of activity is a lower state than that of stillness, then the Absolute, by becoming a cause, has lost its original perfection. The only remaining assumption is that the two states are equal, and the act of creation is one of total indifference. However, this assumption either destroys the unity of the absolute or contradicts itself. If the act of creation is real but indifferent, we must accept the possibility of two interpretations of the absolute, one as productive and the other as non-productive. If the act is not real, then the assumption itself disappears.” * * *
“Again, how can the relative be conceived as coming into being? If it is a distinct reality from the absolute, it must be conceived as passing from non-existence into existence. But to conceive an object as non-existent, is again a self-contradiction; for that which is conceived exists, as an object of thought, in and by that conception. We may abstain from thinking of an object at all; but, if we think of it, we cannot but think of it as existing. It is possible at one time not to think of an object at all, and at another to think of it as already in being; but to think of it in the act of becoming, in the progress from not being into being, is to think that which, in the very thought, annihilates itself.” * * *
“Once again, how can we think of the relative as coming into existence? If it's a separate reality from the absolute, we have to see it as moving from non-existence to existence. But thinking of something as non-existent is a contradiction; because what we think about exists, at least as a thought, through that very thought. We might choose not to think about something at all; but if we do think about it, we can't help but see it as existing. It's possible at one moment not to think about something, and at another moment to consider it as already existing; but to think of it as in the process of becoming, transitioning from not being to being, means thinking about something that, in that very thought, destroys itself.”
“To sum up briefly this portion of my argument. The conception of the Absolute and Infinite, from whatever side we view it, appears encompassed with contradictions. There is a contradiction in supposing such an object to exist, whether alone or in conjunction with others; and there is a contradiction in supposing it not to exist. There is a contradiction in conceiving it as one; and there is a contradiction in conceiving it as many. There is a contradiction in conceiving it as personal; and there is a contradiction in conceiving it as impersonal. It cannot, without contradiction, be represented as active; nor, without equal contradiction, be represented as 43inactive. It cannot be conceived as the sum of all existence; nor yet can it be conceived as a part only of that sum.”
“To briefly summarize this part of my argument, the idea of the Absolute and Infinite, no matter how we look at it, seems filled with contradictions. There’s a contradiction in assuming such a thing exists, whether on its own or alongside others; and there’s a contradiction in assuming it doesn’t exist. There’s a contradiction in thinking of it as one; and there’s a contradiction in thinking of it as many. There’s a contradiction in imagining it as personal; and there’s a contradiction in imagining it as impersonal. It cannot be represented as active without contradiction; nor can it be represented as inactive without the same contradiction. It cannot be conceived as the totality of all existence; nor can it be conceived as just a part of that totality.”
§ 14. And now what is the bearing of these results on the question before us? Our examination of Ultimate Religious Ideas has been carried on with the view of making manifest some fundamental verity contained in them. Thus far however we have arrived at negative conclusions only. Criticising the essential conceptions involved in the different orders of beliefs, we find no one of them to be logically defensible. Passing over the consideration of credibility, and confining ourselves to that of conceivability, we see that Atheism, Pantheism, and Theism, when rigorously analysed, severally prove to be absolutely unthinkable. Instead of disclosing a fundamental verity existing in each, our investigation seems rather to have shown that there is no fundamental verity contained in any. To carry away this conclusion, however, would be a fatal error; as we shall shortly see.
§ 14. So, what do these results mean for the question at hand? Our exploration of Ultimate Religious Ideas has aimed to uncover some basic truth within them. However, up to this point, we've only reached negative conclusions. By evaluating the core concepts involved in the various belief systems, we find that none of them are logically sustainable. Ignoring the issue of credibility and focusing only on what can be conceived, we see that Atheism, Pantheism, and Theism, when thoroughly analyzed, each turn out to be completely unimaginable. Instead of revealing a fundamental truth present in each, our investigation seems to indicate that there isn't a fundamental truth in any of them. However, to take away this conclusion would be a critical mistake, as we will soon demonstrate.
Leaving out the accompanying moral code, which is in all cases a supplementary growth, every Religion may be defined as an à priori theory of the Universe. The surrounding facts being given, some form of agency is alleged which, in the opinion of those alleging it, accounts for these facts. Be it in the rudest Fetishism, which assumes a separate personality behind every phenomenon; be it in Polytheism, in which these personalities are partially generalized; be it in Monotheism, in which they are wholly generalized; or be it in Pantheism, in which the generalized personality becomes one with the phenomena; we equally find an hypothesis which is supposed to render the Universe comprehensible. Nay, even that which is commonly regarded as the negation of all Religion—even positive Atheism, comes within the definition; for it, too, in asserting the self-existence of Space, Matter, and Motion, which it regards as adequate causes of every appearance, propounds an à priori theory from which 44it holds the facts to be deducible. Now every theory tacitly asserts two things: firstly, that there is something to be explained; secondly, that such and such is the explanation. Hence, however widely different speculators may disagree in the solutions they give of the same problem; yet by implication they agree that there is a problem to be solved. Here then is an element which all creeds have in common. Religions diametrically opposed in their overt dogmas, are yet perfectly at one in the tacit conviction that the existence of the world with all it contains and all which surrounds it, is a mystery ever pressing for interpretation. On this point, if on no other, there is entire unanimity.
Leaving out the accompanying moral code, which is always an additional development, every religion can be defined as an beforehand theory of the universe. Given the surrounding facts, some form of agency is claimed that, according to those making the claim, explains these facts. Whether it's in the simplest form of Fetishism, which assumes a separate personality behind every phenomenon; in Polytheism, where these personalities are somewhat generalized; in Monotheism, where they are completely generalized; or in Pantheism, where the generalized personality merges with the phenomena; we find a hypothesis that aims to make the universe understandable. Even what is often viewed as the complete denial of all religion—even positive Atheism—fits within this definition; for it, too, by asserting the self-existence of Space, Matter, and Motion, which it sees as adequate causes of every occurrence, presents an a priori theory from which it believes the facts can be derived. Now, every theory implicitly claims two things: first, that there is something to explain; and second, that this is the explanation. Thus, no matter how greatly different theorists may disagree on the solutions they offer to the same problem, they implicitly agree that there is a problem to solve. Here is a common element shared by all belief systems. Religions that are completely opposed in their explicit doctrines still completely agree in the unspoken belief that the existence of the world with everything it contains and surrounds it is a mystery that constantly seeks interpretation. On this point, if on no other, there is total agreement.
Thus we come within sight of that which we seek. In the last chapter, reasons were given for inferring that human beliefs in general, and especially the perennial ones, contain, under whatever disguises of error, some soul of truth; and here we have arrived at a truth underlying even the grossest superstitions. We saw further that this soul of truth was most likely to be some constituent common to conflicting opinions of the same order; and here we have a constituent which may be claimed alike by all religions. It was pointed out that this soul of truth would almost certainly be more abstract than any of the beliefs involving it; and the truth we have arrived at is one exceeding in abstractness the most abstract religious doctrines. In every respect, therefore, our conclusion answers to the requirements. It has all the characteristics which we inferred must belong to that fundamental verity expressed by religions in general.
Thus we’ve come closer to what we’re after. In the last chapter, we discussed reasons for believing that human beliefs, especially the enduring ones, contain, despite any errors, some core truth; and here we’ve identified a truth that exists even within the most extreme superstitions. We also saw that this core truth is likely a common element found in conflicting views of the same type; and here we have a component that can be claimed by all religions. It was noted that this core truth is probably more abstract than any beliefs that involve it; and the truth we’ve found is even more abstract than the most abstract religious doctrines. In every way, therefore, our conclusion meets the requirements. It has all the characteristics we deduced must belong to that fundamental truth expressed by religions in general.
That this is the vital element in all religions is further proved by the fact, that it is the element which not only survives every change, but grows more distinct the more highly the religion is developed. Aboriginal creeds, though pervaded by the idea of personal agencies which are usually unseen, yet conceive these agencies under perfectly concrete and ordinary forms—class them with the visible agencies of men and animals; and so hide a vague perception of mystery in 45disguises as unmysterious as possible. The Polytheistic conceptions in their advanced phases, represent the presiding personalities in greatly idealized shapes, existing in a remote region, working in subtle ways, and communicating with men by omens or through inspired persons; that is, the ultimate causes of things are regarded as less familiar and comprehensible. The growth of a Monotheistic faith, accompanied as it is by a denial of those beliefs in which the divine nature is assimilated to the human in all its lower propensities, shows us a further step in the same direction; and however imperfectly this higher faith is at first realized, we yet see in altars “to the unknown and unknowable God,” and in the worship of a God that cannot by any searching be found out, that there is a clearer recognition of the inscrutableness of creation. Further developments of theology, ending in such assertions as that “a God understood would be no God at all,” and “to think that God is, as we can think him to be, is blasphemy,” exhibit this recognition still more distinctly; and it pervades all the cultivated theology of the present day. Thus while other constituents of religious creeds one by one drop away, this remains and grows even more manifest; and so is shown to be the essential constituent.
That this is the key element in all religions is further proven by the fact that it not only survives every change but becomes clearer as the religion develops. Indigenous beliefs, while influenced by the idea of unseen personal forces, still envision these forces in concrete and ordinary ways—classifying them alongside the visible actions of people and animals, thereby masking a vague sense of mystery in the least mysterious forms possible. Advanced polytheistic ideas portray leading deities in highly idealized forms, existing in distant realms, operating in subtle ways, and communicating with humans through omens or inspired individuals; that is, the ultimate causes of things are seen as less familiar and understandable. The rise of monotheism, accompanied by a rejection of beliefs that equate the divine nature with human flaws, represents a further step in this direction; and even if this higher belief is initially imperfectly realized, we still observe altars “to the unknown and unknowable God,” and the worship of a God that cannot be fully comprehended, indicating a clearer recognition of the mystery of creation. Further theological developments, culminating in statements like “a God understood would be no God at all,” and “to think that God is as we can think him to be is blasphemy,” make this recognition even more evident, and it permeates all modern theology. Thus, while other elements of religious beliefs gradually fade away, this one remains and becomes even more apparent, proving it to be the essential element.
Nor does the evidence end here. Not only is the omnipresence of something which passes comprehension, that most abstract belief which is common to all religions, which becomes the more distinct in proportion as they develope, and which remains after their discordant elements have been mutually cancelled; but it is that belief which the most unsparing criticism of each leaves unquestionable—or rather makes ever clearer. It has nothing to fear from the most inexorable logic; but on the contrary is a belief which the most inexorable logic shows to be more profoundly true than any religion supposes. For every religion, setting out though it does with the tacit assertion of a mystery, forthwith proceeds to give some solution of this mystery; and so asserts that it is not a mystery passing human comprehension. But 46an examination of the solutions they severally propound, shows them to be uniformly invalid. The analysis of every possible hypothesis proves, not simply that no hypothesis is sufficient, but that no hypothesis is even thinkable. And thus the mystery which all religions recognize, turns out to be a far more transcendent mystery than any of them suspect—not a relative, but an absolute mystery.
The evidence doesn’t stop here. The widespread presence of something beyond understanding—this most abstract belief shared by all religions—becomes clearer as they evolve, and it remains even after their conflicting aspects have been set aside. It's this belief that survives the harshest critiques each religion faces or, more accurately, it becomes even more evident. It has nothing to fear from the harshest logic; in fact, that logic reveals this belief to be more profoundly true than any religion assumes. Each religion starts with the unspoken acknowledgment of a mystery but quickly attempts to provide an explanation, thereby claiming it's not a mystery beyond human understanding. However, an examination of the explanations they offer reveals them to be consistently flawed. The analysis of every potential hypothesis shows that not only is no hypothesis sufficient, but that no hypothesis can even be formulated. Thus, the mystery acknowledged by all religions turns out to be a much more profound mystery than any of them realize—not a relative mystery, but an absolute one.
Here, then, is an ultimate religious truth of the highest possible certainty—a truth in which religions in general are at one with each other, and with a philosophy antagonistic to their special dogmas. And this truth, respecting which there is a latent agreement among all mankind from the fetish-worshipper to the most stoical critic of human creeds, must be the one we seek. If Religion and Science are to be reconciled, the basis of reconciliation must be this deepest, widest, and most certain of all facts—that the Power which the Universe manifests to us is utterly inscrutable.
Here’s a fundamental religious truth that everyone can agree on—a truth that unites religions and even aligns with philosophies that challenge their specific beliefs. This truth, which all humanity—from those who worship idols to the most critical thinkers—implicitly supports, is what we need to find. If we're going to bring Religion and Science together, the foundation for that must be this profound, universal, and undeniable fact: the Force that the Universe reveals to us is completely beyond our understanding.
6. Those who may have before met with this term, will perceive that it is here used in quite a different sense.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Those who might have encountered this term before will realize that it's used in a completely different way here.
CHAPTER III.
TOP SCIENTIFIC CONCEPTS.
§ 15. What are Space and Time? Two hypotheses are current respecting them: the one that they are objective, and the other that they are subjective—the one that they are external to, and independent of, ourselves, the other that they are internal, and appertain to our own consciousness. Let us see what becomes of these hypotheses under analysis.
§ 15. What are Space and Time? There are two ideas about them: one is that they are objective, and the other is that they are subjective—one says they exist outside of us and independently, while the other argues they are internal and relate to our own consciousness. Let's examine what happens to these ideas when we analyze them.
To say that Space and Time exist objectively, is to say that they are entities. The assertion that they are non-entities is self-destructive: non-entities are non-existences; and to allege that non-existences exist objectively, is a contradiction in terms. Moreover, to deny that Space and Time are things, and so by implication to call them nothings, involves the absurdity that there are two kinds of nothing. Neither can they be regarded as attributes of some entity; seeing, not only that it is impossible really to conceive any entity of which they are attributes, but seeing further that we cannot think of them as disappearing, even if everything else disappeared; whereas attributes necessarily disappear along with the entities they belong to. Thus as Space and Time cannot be either non-entities, nor the attributes of entities, we have no choice but consider them as entities. But while, on the hypothesis of their objectivity, Space and Time must be classed as things, we find, on experiment, that to represent them in thought as things is impossible. To be conceived at all, a thing must be conceived as having attributes. We 48can distinguish something from nothing, only by the power which the something has to act on our consciousness; the several affections it produces on our consciousness (or else the hypothetical causes of them), we attribute to it, and call its attributes; and the absence of these attributes is the absence of the terms in which the something is conceived, and involves the absence of a conception. What now are the attributes of Space? The only one which it is possible for a moment to think of as belonging to it, is that of extension; and to credit it with this implies a confusion of thought. For extension and Space are convertible terms: by extension, as we ascribe it to surrounding objects, we mean occupancy of Space; and thus to say that Space is extended, is to say that Space occupies Space. How we are similarly unable to assign any attribute to Time, scarcely needs pointing out. Nor are Time and Space unthinkable as entities only from the absence of attributes; there is another peculiarity, familiar to readers of metaphysics, which equally excludes them from the category. All entities which we actually know as such, are limited; and even if we suppose ourselves either to know or to be able to conceive some unlimited entity, we of necessity in so classing it positively separate it from the class of limited entities. But of Space and Time we cannot assert either limitation or the absence of limitation. We find ourselves totally unable to form any mental image of unbounded Space; and yet totally unable to imagine bounds beyond which there is no Space. Similarly at the other extreme: it is impossible to think of a limit to the divisibility of Space; yet equally impossible to think of its infinite divisibility. And, without stating them, it will be seen that we labour under like impotencies in respect to Time. Thus we cannot conceive Space and Time as entities, and are equally disabled from conceiving them as either the attributes of entities or as non-entities. We are compelled to think of them as existing; and yet cannot bring them within those conditions under which existences are represented in thought.
To say that Space and Time exist independently is to say that they are entities. Claiming they are not entities is self-defeating: non-entities are non-existences, and to argue that non-existences exist independently is a contradiction. Furthermore, denying that Space and Time are things, and implying they are nothing, leads to the absurdity of having two types of nothing. They also can’t be seen as characteristics of some entity; not only is it impossible to genuinely conceive of any entity to which they belong, but we also cannot imagine them disappearing, even if everything else were to vanish; attributes necessarily disappear with the entities they belong to. Since Space and Time cannot be non-entities or attributes of entities, we have no choice but to consider them as entities. But while, assuming their objectivity, Space and Time must be classified as things, we find that it is impossible to represent them in thought as things. To be conceived at all, a thing must be thought of as having attributes. We can distinguish something from nothing only by the ability of the something to affect our consciousness; we attribute the various effects it produces on our consciousness (or the potential causes of those effects) to it, calling them its attributes; and the lack of these attributes signifies the lack of terms in which the something is conceived, leading to an absence of conception. Now, what are the attributes of Space? The only one that can even briefly be thought of as belonging to it is extension, but assigning this to Space shows a confusion of thought. Extension and Space are interchangeable terms: when we refer to extension as it relates to surrounding objects, we mean the occupancy of Space; therefore, to say that Space is extended is to say that Space occupies Space. Similarly, we cannot assign any attribute to Time, which is obvious. Time and Space are not only difficult to think of as entities due to the lack of attributes; there is another characteristic known to those familiar with metaphysics that also excludes them from this category. All entities we actually recognize as such are limited; and even if we imagine that we can conceive of some unlimited entity, we must necessarily separate it positively from the class of limited entities. However, we cannot claim either limitation or the absence of limitation for Space and Time. We find ourselves completely unable to form any mental image of unbounded Space; yet we are equally unable to envision boundaries beyond which there is no Space. Similarly, at the other end: it is impossible to think of a limit to the divisibility of Space, yet equally impossible to imagine its infinite divisibility. Without explicitly stating it, it should be clear that we struggle with similar limitations regarding Time. Thus, we cannot conceive of Space and Time as entities and are equally unable to think of them as either the attributes of entities or as non-entities. We are forced to think of them as existing; yet we cannot fit them into the conditions under which existences are represented in thought.
49Shall we then take refuge in the Kantian doctrine? shall we say that Space and Time are forms of the intellect,—“à priori laws or conditions of the conscious mind”? To do this is to escape from great difficulties by rushing into greater. The proposition with which Kant’s philosophy sets out, verbally intelligible though it is, cannot by any effort be rendered into thought—cannot be interpreted into an idea properly so called, but stands merely for a pseud-idea. In the first place, to assert that Space and Time, as we are conscious of them, are subjective conditions, is by implication to assert that they are not objective realities: if the Space and Time present to our minds belong to the ego, then of necessity they do not belong to the non-ego. Now it is absolutely impossible to think this. The very fact on which Kant bases his hypothesis—namely that our consciousness of Space and Time cannot be suppressed—testifies as much; for that consciousness of Space and Time which we cannot rid ourselves of, is the consciousness of them as existing objectively. It is useless to reply that such an inability must inevitably result if they are subjective forms. The question here is—What does consciousness directly testify? And the direct testimony of consciousness is, that Time and Space are not within but without the mind; and so absolutely independent of it that they cannot be conceived to become non-existent even were the mind to become non-existent. Besides being positively unthinkable in what it tacitly denies, the theory of Kant is equally unthinkable in what it openly affirms. It is not simply that we cannot combine the thought of Space with the thought of our own personality, and contemplate the one as a property of the other—though our inability to do this would prove the inconceivableness of the hypothesis—but it is that the hypothesis carries in itself the proof of its own inconceivableness. For if Space and Time are forms of thought, they can never be thought of; since it is impossible for anything to be at once the form of thought and the matter of thought. That Space and Time are objects 50of consciousness, Kant emphatically asserts by saying that it is impossible to suppress the consciousness of them. How then, if they are objects of consciousness, can they at the same time be conditions of consciousness? If Space and Time are the conditions under which we think, then when we think of Space and Time themselves, our thoughts must be unconditioned; and if there can thus be unconditioned thoughts, what becomes of the theory?
49Should we then rely on Kant's ideas? Should we claim that Space and Time are forms of the mind—“a priori laws or conditions of conscious thought”? Doing so may help us avoid difficulties, but it just leads us into bigger ones. The starting point of Kant's philosophy, while understandable in words, can't be converted into a true idea; it merely represents a pseudo-idea. First, stating that Space and Time, as we experience them, are subjective conditions indirectly means they aren't objective realities: if the Space and Time in our minds belong to the ego, then they can't belong to the non-ego. This concept is impossible to grasp. The very basis of Kant's argument—our inescapable awareness of Space and Time—proves the opposite; because our awareness of Space and Time that we can't shake off is of their objective existence. It's pointless to argue that such an inability must arise if they are subjective forms. The real question is—What does consciousness directly attest? The direct affirmation of consciousness is that Time and Space exist outside the mind; they are so independent of it that we can't imagine them ceasing to exist even if the mind itself were gone. Moreover, Kant's theory is not only fundamentally flawed in what it implies, but it's also absurd in what it claims. It’s not just that we can't think about Space as a property of our own self—even the inability to do this would prove the theory's absurdity. The theory itself provides evidence of its own impossibility. If Space and Time are thought forms, then they can never be truly thought about; nothing can be both the form of thought and the matter of thought at the same time. Kant insists that Space and Time are objects of consciousness, boldly stating that we can't suppress awareness of them. So, if they are objects of consciousness, how can they also be conditions of consciousness? If Space and Time are the conditions for thinking, then when we think about Space and Time themselves, our thoughts must be unrestricted; and if unrestricted thoughts can exist, what happens to the theory?
It results therefore that Space and Time are wholly incomprehensible. The immediate knowledge which we seem to have of them, proves, when examined, to be total ignorance. While our belief in their objective reality is insurmountable, we are unable to give any rational account of it. And to posit the alternative belief (possible to state but impossible to realize) is merely to multiply irrationalities.
It turns out that Space and Time are completely beyond our understanding. The immediate sense we think we have of them, when looked at closely, reveals that we are completely ignorant. Even though we can’t shake our belief in their objective reality, we can’t provide any logical explanation for it. Proposing an alternative belief—something we can describe but can’t truly understand—only adds to the confusion.
§ 16. Were it not for the necessities of the argument, it would be inexcusable to occupy the reader’s attention with the threadbare, and yet unended, controversy respecting the divisibility of matter. Matter is either infinitely divisible or it is not: no third possibility can be named. Which of the alternatives shall we accept? If we say that Matter is infinitely divisible, we commit ourselves to a supposition not realizable in thought. We can bisect and re-bisect a body, and continually repeating the act until we reduce its parts to a size no longer physically divisible, may then mentally continue the process without limit. To do this, however, is not really to conceive the infinite divisibility of matter, but to form a symbolic conception incapable of expansion into a real one, and not admitting of other verification. Really to conceive the infinite divisibility of matter, is mentally to follow out the divisions to infinity; and to do this would require infinite time. On the other hand, to assert that matter is not infinitely divisible, is to assert that it is reducible to parts which no conceivable power can divide; and this verbal 51supposition can no more be represented in thought than the other. For each of such ultimate parts, did they exist, must have an under and an upper surface, a right and a left side, like any larger fragment. Now it is impossible to imagine its sides so near that no plane of section can be conceived between them; and however great be the assumed force of cohesion, it is impossible to shut out the idea of a greater force capable of overcoming it. So that to human intelligence the one hypothesis is no more acceptable than the other; and yet the conclusion that one or other must agree with the fact, seems to human intelligence unavoidable.
§ 16. If it weren't necessary for the argument, it would be unreasonable to engage the reader with the tired and ongoing debate about whether matter is divisible. Matter is either infinitely divisible or it isn't; there’s no third option. Which one should we choose? If we say that matter is infinitely divisible, we are assuming something that can't be fully grasped in thought. We can keep cutting a body in half over and over until its parts become so small that they can no longer be physically divided, and we could mentally continue that process indefinitely. However, this doesn’t actually entail understanding the infinite divisibility of matter; it's merely creating a symbolic idea that can't expand into a real one and isn’t open to further verification. To genuinely understand the infinite divisibility of matter would mean to conceptually follow those divisions to infinity, which would take infinite time. On the flip side, claiming that matter isn't infinitely divisible means asserting that it can be broken down into parts that no conceivable force could divide; and this idea can’t be mentally represented any better than the other hypothesis. Each of these ultimate parts, if they existed, would have a top and bottom surface, a right and left side, just like any larger piece. It’s impossible to envision their sides being so close together that there isn't a plane of division to consider; no matter how strong we assume the force of cohesion to be, we cannot disregard the idea of an even stronger force that could overcome it. Thus, for human understanding, neither hypothesis is more acceptable than the other; yet the conclusion that one or the other must align with reality seems unavoidable to human thought.
Again, leaving this insoluble question, let us ask whether substance has, in reality, anything like that extended solidity which it presents to our consciousness. The portion of space occupied by a piece of metal, seems to eyes and fingers perfectly filled: we perceive a homogeneous, resisting mass, without any breach of continuity. Shall we then say that Matter is as actually solid as it appears? Shall we say that whether it consists of an infinitely divisible element or of ultimate units incapable of further division, its parts are everywhere in actual contact? To assert as much entangles us in insuperable difficulties. Were Matter thus absolutely solid, it would be, what it is not—absolutely incompressible; since compressibility, implying the nearer approach of constituent parts, is not thinkable unless there is unoccupied space between the parts. Nor is this all. It is an established mechanical truth, that if a body, moving at a given velocity, strikes an equal body at rest in such wise that the two move on together, their joint velocity will be but half that of the striking body. Now it is a law of which the negation is inconceivable, that in passing from any one degree of magnitude to any other, all intermediate degrees must be passed through. Or, in the case before us, a body moving at velocity 4, cannot, by collision, be reduced to velocity 2, without passing through all velocities between 4 and 2. But were Matter truly solid—were its units absolutely 52incompressible and in absolute contact—this “law of continuity,” as it is called, would be broken in every case of collision. For when, of two such units, one moving at velocity 4 strikes another at rest, the striking unit must have its velocity 4 instantaneously reduced to velocity 2; must pass from velocity 4 to velocity 2 without any lapse of time, and without passing through intermediate velocities; must be moving with velocities 4 and 2 at the same instant, which is impossible.
Once again, setting aside this unsolvable question, let's consider whether substance really possesses the kind of extended solidity that it appears to have in our awareness. The space taken up by a piece of metal seems to be completely filled to our eyes and touch: we perceive a uniform, resistant mass without any breaks in continuity. Should we then claim that Matter is as solid as it seems? Should we assert that whether it is made up of infinitely divisible elements or ultimate units that cannot be divided any further, its parts are in constant actual contact? To claim so leads us into insurmountable challenges. If Matter were truly absolutely solid, it would be what it is not—absolutely incompressible; since compressibility, which involves the closer approach of constituent parts, is inconceivable unless there is empty space between them. And that's not all. It is a well-established mechanical principle that if a body moving at a certain speed collides with an equal body at rest in such a way that they both move together afterward, their combined speed will be only half that of the original moving body. Now, it is a law, the denial of which is unimaginable, that as we transition from one level of magnitude to another, we must pass through all the intermediate levels. In our scenario, a body moving at speed 4 cannot, through collision, be reduced to speed 2 without moving through all the speeds between 4 and 2. However, if Matter were truly solid—if its units were absolutely incompressible and in direct contact—this “law of continuity,” as it is known, would be violated in every collision. For when one of two such units, one moving at speed 4, strikes another at rest, the moving unit would have to have its speed 4 instantaneously reduced to speed 2; it would have to drop from speed 4 to speed 2 without any passage of time and without going through the intermediate speeds; it would need to be moving at speeds 4 and 2 simultaneously, which is impossible.
The supposition that Matter is absolutely solid being untenable, there presents itself the Newtonian supposition, that it consists of solid atoms not in contact but acting on each other by attractive and repulsive forces, varying with the distances. To assume this, however, merely shifts the difficulty: the problem is simply transferred from the aggregated masses of matter to these hypothetical atoms. For granting that Matter, as we perceive it, is made up of such dense extended units surrounded by atmospheres of force, the question still arises—What is the constitution of these units? We have no alternative but to regard each of them as a small piece of matter. Looked at through a mental microscope, each becomes a mass of substance such as we have just been contemplating. Exactly the same inquiries may be made respecting the parts of which each atom consists; while exactly the same difficulties stand in the way of every answer. And manifestly, even were the hypothetical atom assumed to consist of still minuter ones, the difficulty would re-appear at the next step; nor could it be got rid of even by an infinite series of such assumptions.
The idea that matter is completely solid is impossible to support, leading us to the Newtonian idea that it is made up of solid atoms that don’t touch each other but interact through attractive and repulsive forces that change with distance. However, accepting this just moves the trouble: the issue shifts from the combined masses of matter to these theoretical atoms. Even if we accept that matter, as we see it, is composed of such dense, extended units surrounded by fields of force, we still have to ask—what makes up these units? We can only see each of them as a small piece of matter. When examined closely, each looks like a mass of substance we have just discussed. The same questions can be asked about what each atom consists of, and the same challenges come up with every answer. Clearly, even if we assume these hypothetical atoms are made up of even smaller ones, the issue would come back at the next level; we couldn’t escape it even with an infinite series of such assumptions.
Boscovich’s conception yet remains to us. Seeing that Matter could not, as Leibnitz suggested, be composed of unextended monads (since the juxtaposition of an infinity of points having no extension, could not produce that extension which matter possesses); and perceiving objections to the view entertained by Newton; Boscovich proposed an intermediate theory, uniting, as he considered, the advantages of 53both and avoiding their difficulties. His theory is, that the constituents of Matter are centres of force—points without dimensions, which attract and repel each other in suchwise as to be kept at specific distances apart. And he argues, mathematically, that the forces possessed by such centres might so vary with the distances, that under given conditions the centres would remain in stable equilibrium with definite interspaces; and yet, under other conditions, would maintain larger or smaller interspaces. This speculation however, ingeniously as it is elaborated, and eluding though it does various difficulties, posits a proposition which cannot by any effort be represented in thought: it escapes all the inconceivabilities above indicated, by merging them in the one inconceivability with which it sets out. A centre of force absolutely without extension is unthinkable: answering to these words we can form nothing more than a symbolic conception of the illegitimate order. The idea of resistance cannot be separated in thought from the idea of an extended body which offers resistance. To suppose that central forces can reside in points not infinitesimally small but occupying no space whatever—points having position only, with nothing to mark their position—points in no respect distinguishable from the surrounding points that are not centres of force;—to suppose this, is utterly beyond human power.
Boscovich’s ideas still resonate with us today. He argued that matter couldn’t, as Leibnitz suggested, be made up of unextended monads (since placing infinite points without extension together couldn’t create the extension that matter has); and he also saw problems with Newton’s perspective. Boscovich proposed a middle ground that combined, in his view, the strengths of both theories while avoiding their issues. His theory states that the building blocks of matter are centers of force—point-like entities with no dimensions that attract and repel each other, keeping a specific distance apart. He mathematically argued that the forces from these centers could vary with distance so that under certain conditions, the centers would maintain stable equilibrium with definite spaces between them; yet, under other circumstances, they would have larger or smaller separations. However, this theory, as clever as it is constructed, proposes an idea that cannot truly be grasped: it merges all the mentioned difficulties into one major inconsistency. A center of force that has no extension is unimaginable: we can only create a symbolic idea of the flawed order that accompanies this concept. The idea of resistance cannot be separated from the notion of an extended body that offers resistance. To believe that central forces can exist in points that aren’t infinitesimally small yet occupy no space at all—points that only have a location with nothing to indicate that location—points indistinguishable from surrounding points that aren’t centers of force; to think this is utterly beyond human capability.
Here it may possibly be said, that though all hypotheses respecting the constitution of Matter commit us to inconceivable conclusions when logically developed, yet we have reason to think that one of them corresponds with the fact. Though the conception of Matter as consisting of dense indivisible units, is symbolic and incapable of being completely thought out, it may yet be supposed to find indirect verification in the truths of chemistry. These, it is argued, necessitate the belief that Matter consists of particles of specific weights, and therefore of specific sizes. The general law of definite proportions seems impossible on any other condition than the existence of ultimate atoms; and though the combining 54weights of the respective elements are termed by chemists their “equivalents,” for the purpose of avoiding a questionable assumption, we are unable to think of the combination of such definite weights, without supposing it to take place between definite numbers of definite particles. And thus it would appear that the Newtonian view is at any rate preferable to that of Boscovich. A disciple of Boscovich, however, may reply that his master’s theory is involved in that of Newton; and cannot indeed be escaped. “What,” he may ask, “is it that holds together the parts of these ultimate atoms?”. “A cohesive force,” his opponent must answer. “And what,” he may continue, “is it that holds together the parts of any fragments into which, by sufficient force, an ultimate atom might be broken?” Again the answer must be—a cohesive force. “And what,” he may still ask, “if the ultimate atom were, as we can imagine it to be, reduced to parts as small in proportion to it, as it is in proportion to a tangible mass of matter—what must give each part the ability to sustain itself, and to occupy space?” Still there is no answer but—a cohesive force. Carry the process in thought as far as we may, until the extension of the parts is less than can be imagined, we still cannot escape the admission of forces by which the extension is upheld; and we can find no limit until we arrive at the conception of centres of force without any extension.
Here it might be said that although all theories about the structure of Matter lead us to unimaginable conclusions when logically worked out, we have reason to believe that one of them aligns with reality. While the idea of Matter being made up of dense, indivisible units is symbolic and can't be fully conceptualized, it might still find indirect support in the truths of chemistry. It is argued that these truths require us to believe that Matter consists of particles with specific weights, and thus specific sizes. The general law of definite proportions seems impossible without the existence of fundamental atoms; and although chemists refer to the combining weights of the respective elements as their "equivalents" to avoid a questionable assumption, we can't think of the combination of such specific weights without assuming it occurs between definite numbers of specific particles. Therefore, it seems that the Newtonian perspective is at least preferable to that of Boscovich. A follower of Boscovich might argue that his master's theory is included in Newton's and cannot truly be avoided. “What,” he might ask, “is it that holds the parts of these ultimate atoms together?” “A cohesive force,” his opponent has to reply. “And what,” he might continue, “is it that holds together the parts of any fragments that an ultimate atom could potentially break into under enough force?” Again, the answer must be — a cohesive force. “And what,” he may still inquire, “if the ultimate atom were, as we can imagine, reduced to parts as small in relation to it as it is to a physical mass of matter — what allows each part to maintain itself and take up space?” Still, the only answer is — a cohesive force. As we stretch this thought process as far as we can, until the size of the parts becomes inconceivable, we still can't avoid admitting the existence of forces that uphold this extension; and we find no limit until we reach the concept of centers of force without any extension.
Matter then, in its ultimate nature, is as absolutely incomprehensible as Space and Time. Frame what suppositions we may, we find on tracing out their implications that they leave us nothing but a choice between opposite absurdities.
Matter, at its core, is just as completely incomprehensible as Space and Time. No matter what assumptions we make, we discover that exploring their implications only presents us with a choice between two contradictory absurdities.
§ 17. A body impelled by the hand is clearly perceived to move, and to move in a definite direction: there seems at first sight no possibility of doubting that its motion is real, or that it is towards a given point. Yet it is easy to show that we not only may be, but usually are, quite wrong in both these 55judgments. Here, for instance, is a ship which, for simplicity’s sake, we will suppose to be anchored at the equator with her head to the West. When the captain walks from stem to stern, in what direction does he move? East is the obvious answer—an answer which for the moment may pass without criticism. But now the anchor is heaved, and the vessel sails to the West with a velocity equal to that at which the captain walks. In what direction does he now move when he goes from stem to stern? You cannot say East, for the vessel is carrying him as fast towards the West as he walks to the East; and you cannot say West for the converse reason. In respect to surrounding space he is stationary; though to all on board the ship he seems to be moving. But now are we quite sure of this conclusion?—Is he really stationary? When we take into account the Earth’s motion round its axis, we find that instead of being stationary he is travelling at the rate of 1000 miles per hour to the East; so that neither the perception of one who looks at him, nor the inference of one who allows for the ship’s motion, is anything like the truth. Nor indeed, on further consideration, shall we find this revised conclusion to be much better. For we have forgotten to allow for the Earth’s motion in its orbit. This being some 68,000 miles per hour, it follows that, assuming the time to be midday, he is moving, not at the rate of 1000 miles per hour to the East, but at the rate of 67,000 miles per hour to the West. Nay, not even now have we discovered the true rate and the true direction of his movement. With the Earth’s progress in its orbit, we have to join that of the whole Solar system towards the constellation Hercules; and when we do this, we perceive that he is moving neither East nor West, but in a line inclined to the plane of the Ecliptic, and at a velocity greater or less (according to the time of the year) than that above named. To which let us add, that were the dynamic arrangements of our sidereal system fully known to us, we should probably discover the direction and rate of his actual movement to differ considerably even from 56these. How illusive are our ideas of Motion, is thus made sufficiently manifest. That which seems moving proves to be stationary; that which seems stationary proves to be moving; while that which we conclude to be going rapidly in one direction, turns out to be going much more rapidly in the opposite direction. And so we are taught that what we are conscious of is not the real motion of any object, either in its rate or direction; but merely its motion as measured from an assigned position—either the position we ourselves occupy or some other. Yet in this very process of concluding that the motions we perceive are not the real motions, we tacitly assume that there are real motions. In revising our successive judgments concerning a body’s course or velocity, we take for granted that there is an actual course and an actual velocity—we take for granted that there are fixed points in space with respect to which all motions are absolute; and we find it impossible to rid ourselves of this idea. Nevertheless, absolute motion cannot even be imagined, much less known. Motion as taking place apart from those limitations of space which we habitually associate with it, is totally unthinkable. For motion is change of place; but in unlimited space, change of place is inconceivable, because place itself is inconceivable. Place can be conceived only by reference to other places; and in the absence of objects dispersed through space, a place could be conceived only in relation to the limits of space; whence it follows that in unlimited space, place cannot be conceived—all places must be equidistant from boundaries that do not exist. Thus while we are obliged to think that there is an absolute motion, we find absolute motion incomprehensible.
§ 17. A body pushed by a hand is easily seen to move, and to move in a specific direction: at first glance, it seems undeniable that its movement is real or directed towards a certain point. However, it’s easy to demonstrate that we may not only be, but often are, completely wrong in both of these judgments. Here’s an example: imagine a ship anchored at the equator, facing West. When the captain walks from the front to the back, what direction is he moving? The obvious answer is East—a response that may initially go unchallenged. But now the anchor is raised, and the ship sails West at the same speed the captain walks. In which direction does he move when he walks from front to back? You can't say East, because the ship is carrying him West at the same speed he walks East; and you can't say West for the opposite reason. In relation to the surrounding space, he remains stationary; yet to everyone on board, he seems to be moving. But are we really sure of this conclusion? Is he actually stationary? When we factor in the Earth's rotation, we find that instead of being stationary, he is traveling East at about 1000 miles per hour; thus, neither what an observer sees nor what someone considers based on the ship’s motion reveals the complete truth. And, upon further reflection, this revised conclusion isn’t much better, as we also need to account for the Earth’s orbit. If we assume it’s midday, he is moving not at 1000 miles per hour East, but rather at 67,000 miles per hour West. Even then, we haven't pinpointed his true speed and direction. When we take into account the Earth's orbit, we also need to consider the movement of the entire Solar System towards the constellation Hercules; and when we do this, we realize he is moving neither East nor West, but along a path inclined to the plane of the Ecliptic, at a speed that changes depending on the time of year. Moreover, if we had complete knowledge of the dynamics of our galaxy, we would likely find that the direction and speed of his actual movement differ significantly from what we've calculated. This illustrates how deceptive our ideas about motion can be. What seems to be moving is actually still; what appears still is in motion; and what we believe to be moving quickly in one direction turns out to be moving much faster in the opposite direction. Thus, we learn that our awareness of motion isn't about the true motion of any object, whether in terms of speed or direction; instead, it only reflects its motion as viewed from a certain point—our own position or another one. Yet, in this very process of understanding that the motions we observe aren't the real ones, we implicitly assume that real motions exist. In reevaluating our successive judgments about an object’s path or speed, we presume there is a genuine path and a genuine speed—we assume there are fixed points in space against which all motion can be measured; and we find it hard to shake this idea. However, absolute motion can't even be imagined, let alone known. Motion outside the spatial limitations we usually associate it with is entirely inconceivable. Motion is a change of location; but in limitless space, change of location is impossible to comprehend because a location itself is also inconceivable. A location can only be understood in relation to other locations; and without objects scattered through space, a location could only be conceived in relation to nonexistent boundaries; hence it follows that in infinite space, location cannot be conceived—all locations would have to be equidistant from boundaries that do not exist. Thus, while we feel compelled to believe that absolute motion exists, we find absolute motion to be incomprehensible.
Another insuperable difficulty presents itself when we contemplate the transfer of Motion. Habit blinds us to the marvelousness of this phenomenon. Familiar with the fact from childhood, we see nothing remarkable in the ability of a moving thing to generate movement in a thing that is stationary. It is, however, impossible to understand it. In 57what respect does a body after impact differ from itself before impact? What is this added to it which does not sensibly affect any of its properties and yet enables it to traverse space? Here is an object at rest and here is the same object moving. In the one state it has no tendency to change its place; but in the other it is obliged at each instant to assume a new position. What is it which will for ever go on producing this effect without being exhausted? and how does it dwell in the object? The motion you say has been communicated. But how?—What has been communicated? The striking body has not transferred a thing to the body struck; and it is equally out of the question to say that it has transferred an attribute. What then has it transferred?
Another huge challenge arises when we consider the transfer of motion. Our habits make us overlook how amazing this phenomenon actually is. Since we’ve known about it since childhood, we don’t think it’s remarkable that a moving object can cause a stationary object to move. However, it’s really difficult to grasp. How does a body differ after impact from how it was before? What is this addition that doesn’t visibly change any of its properties yet allows it to move through space? Here’s an object at rest and the same object in motion. In one state, it has no urge to change its position; but in the other, it must continuously take on a new position. What is it that keeps creating this effect without running out? And how is it contained within the object? You say motion has been transferred. But how? What exactly has been transferred? The striking object hasn’t moved a thing to the object it hit; and it makes no sense to say it has transferred an attribute. So what, then, has it actually transferred?
Once more there is the old puzzle concerning the connexion between Motion and Rest. We daily witness the gradual retardation and final stoppage of things projected from the hand or otherwise impelled; and we equally often witness the change from Rest to Motion produced by the application of force. But truly to represent these transitions in thought, we find impossible. For a breach of the law of continuity seems necessarily involved; and yet no breach of it is conceivable. A body travelling at a given velocity cannot be brought to a state of rest, or no velocity, without passing through all intermediate velocities. At first sight nothing seems easier than to imagine it doing this. It is quite possible to think of its motion as diminishing insensibly until it becomes infinitesimal; and many will think equally possible to pass in thought from infinitesimal motion to no motion. But this is an error. Mentally follow out the decreasing velocity as long as you please, and there still remains some velocity. Halve and again halve the rate of movement for ever, yet movement still exists; and the smallest movement is separated by an impassable gap from no movement. As something, however minute, is infinitely great in comparison with nothing; so is even the least conceivable motion, infinite as compared with rest. The 58converse perplexities attendant on the transition from Rest to Motion, need not be specified. These, equally with the foregoing, show us that though we are obliged to think of such changes as actually occurring, their occurrence cannot be realized.
Once again, we face the age-old question about the connection between Motion and Rest. Every day, we observe objects slowing down and finally coming to a halt when thrown or pushed; we also frequently see how applying force shifts things from Rest to Motion. However, accurately representing these transitions in our minds proves to be impossible. There's an inherent contradiction in the continuity law, yet it's hard to imagine a scenario where it's broken. An object moving at a certain speed cannot simply stop without going through all the speeds in between. At first glance, it seems easy to picture the object gradually slowing down until it reaches a speed of zero. Many might think it's just as easy to go from infinitesimal motion to no motion at all. But that's a mistake. You can mentally track the decreasing speed for as long as you want, and there will still be some speed left. Halve that speed endlessly, yet movement remains; even the tiniest motion is fundamentally distinct from no motion. Something, no matter how insignificant, is infinitely greater than nothing; similarly, even the tiniest conceivable movement is infinite compared to rest. The 58reverse complexities involved in moving from Rest to Motion don’t need detailing. Like the previous case, they illustrate that while we must think of these changes as actually happening, we can't fully grasp their realization.
Thus neither when considered in connexion with Space, nor when considered in connexion with Matter, nor when considered in connexion with Rest, do we find that Motion is truly cognizable. All efforts to understand its essential nature do but bring us to alternative impossibilities of thought.
Thus, whether we look at it in relation to Space, Matter, or Rest, we find that Motion is not truly understandable. All attempts to grasp its fundamental nature only lead us to different impossibilities of thought.
§ 18. On lifting a chair, the force exerted we regard as equal to that antagonistic force called the weight of the chair; and we cannot think of these as equal without thinking of them as like in kind; since equality is conceivable only between things that are connatural. The axiom that action and reaction are equal and in opposite directions, commonly exemplified by this very instance of muscular effort versus weight, cannot be mentally realized on any other condition. Yet, contrariwise, it is incredible that the force as existing in the chair really resembles the force as present to our minds. It scarcely needs to point out that the weight of the chair produces in us various feelings according as we support it by a single finger, or the whole hand, or the leg; and hence to argue that as it cannot be like all these sensations there is no reason to believe it like any. It suffices to remark that since the force as known to us is an affection of consciousness, we cannot conceive the force existing in the chair under the same form without endowing the chair with consciousness. So that it is absurd to think of Force as in itself like our sensation of it, and yet necessary so to think of it if we realize it in consciousness at all.
§ 18. When lifting a chair, the force we apply is equal to the opposing force known as the weight of the chair; and we can only think of these as equal if we consider them to be similar in nature, because we can only perceive equality between things that share a natural connection. The principle that for every action there is an equal and opposite reaction, commonly illustrated by this example of muscle effort vs. weight, cannot be truly understood under any other circumstances. However, it is hard to believe that the force in the chair is actually similar to the force we perceive. It is evident that the weight of the chair evokes different feelings depending on whether we support it with a single finger, our whole hand, or our leg; therefore, we could argue that since it cannot resemble all these sensations, there’s no reason to believe it resembles any of them. It’s important to note that since the force we know is a quality of our consciousness, we cannot imagine the force in the chair existing in the same way without attributing consciousness to the chair itself. Thus, it is illogical to think of Force as being inherently like our sensation of it, yet it is necessary to perceive it this way if we are aware of it at all.
How, again, can we understand the connexion between Force and Matter? Matter is known to us only through its manifestations of Force: our ultimate test of Matter is the 59ability to resist: abstract its resistance and there remains nothing but empty extension. Yet, on the other hand, resistance is equally unthinkable apart from Matter—apart from something extended. Not only, as pointed out some pages back, are centres of force devoid of extension unimaginable; but, as an inevitable corollary, we cannot imagine either extended or unextended centres of force to attract and repel other such centres at a distance, without the intermediation of some kind of matter. We have here to remark, what could not without anticipation be remarked when treating of Matter, that the hypothesis of Newton, equally with that of Boscovich, is open to the charge that it supposes one thing to act upon another through a space which is absolutely empty—a supposition which cannot be represented in thought. This charge is indeed met by the introduction of a hypothetical fluid existing between the atoms or centres. But the problem is not thus solved: it is simply shifted, and re-appears when the constitution of this fluid is inquired into. How impossible it is to elude the difficulty presented by the transfer of Force through space, is best seen in the case of astronomical forces. The Sim acts upon us in such way as to produce the sensations of light and heat; and we have ascertained that between the cause as existing in the Sun, and the effect as experienced on the Earth, a lapse of about eight minutes occurs: whence unavoidably result in us, the conceptions of both a force and a motion. So that for the assumption of a luminiferous ether, there is the defence, not only that the exercise of force through 95,000,000 of miles of absolute vacuum is inconceivable, but also that it is impossible to conceive motion in the absence of something moved. Similarly in the case of gravitation. Newton described himself as unable to think that the attraction of one body for another at a distance, could be exerted in the absence of an intervening medium. But now let us ask how much the forwarder we are if an intervening medium be assumed. This ether whose undulations according to the received hypothesis constitute 60heat and light, and which is the vehicle of gravitation—how is it constituted? We must regard it, in the way that physicists do regard it, as composed of atoms which attract and repel each other—infinitesimal it may be in comparison with those of ordinary matter, but still atoms. And remembering that this ether is imponderable, we are obliged to conclude that the ratio between the interspaces of these atoms and the atoms themselves, is incommensurably greater than the like ratio in ponderable matter; else the densities could not be incommensurable. Instead then of a direct action by the Sun upon the Earth without anything intervening, we have to conceive the Sun’s action propagated through a medium whose molecules are probably as small relatively to their interspaces as are the Sun and Earth compared with the space between them: we have to conceive these infinitesimal molecules acting on each other through absolutely vacant spaces which are immense in comparison with their own dimensions. How is this conception easier than the other? We still have mentally to represent a body as acting where it is not, and in the absence of anything by which its action may be transferred; and what matters it whether this takes place on a large or a small scale? We see therefore that the exercise of Force is altogether unintelligible. We cannot imagine it except through the instrumentality of something having extension; and yet when we have assumed this something, we find the perplexity is not got rid of but only postponed. We are obliged to conclude that matter, whether ponderable or imponderable, and whether aggregated or in its hypothetical units, acts upon matter through absolutely vacant space; and yet this conclusion is positively unthinkable.
How can we understand the connection between Force and Matter? We only know Matter through its expressions of Force: our ultimate measure of Matter is its ability to resist; if we take away its resistance, all that's left is empty space. However, it's also impossible to think of resistance without Matter—without something that takes up space. As noted earlier, centers of force without extension are unimaginable; and, as a result, we cannot conceive of either extended or unextended centers of force attracting or repelling each other from a distance without some kind of matter in between. It's worth noting, something we couldn't mention earlier when discussing Matter, is that both Newton's and Boscovich's hypotheses suggest one thing can act on another through completely empty space—a thought that cannot be fully grasped. This issue is acknowledged by introducing a hypothetical fluid that exists between the atoms or centers. But this doesn't solve the problem; it simply shifts it, reappearing when we question the nature of this fluid. The difficulty of transferring Force through space is especially clear in the case of astronomical forces. The Sun affects us in a way that produces the sensations of light and heat, and we've determined that there’s roughly an eight-minute delay between the cause as it exists in the Sun and the effect experienced on Earth, leading us to think about both force and motion. So, the need for a luminiferous ether is justified not only because the exercise of force through 95,000,000 miles of complete vacuum is unimaginable, but also because it’s impossible to conceive motion without something being moved. The same applies to gravitation. Newton himself said he couldn't believe that one body could attract another at a distance without an intermediary medium. But let's consider how much progress we've made if we take an intermediary medium into account. This ether, whose undulations supposedly generate heat and light, and which is the medium for gravitation—what is it made of? We must consider it, as physicists do, to be made up of atoms that attract and repel each other—infinitesimal compared to ordinary matter, but still atoms. And since this ether is weightless, we must conclude that the ratio between the spaces between these atoms and the atoms themselves is significantly greater than that in regular matter; otherwise, their densities could not differ so greatly. Instead of a direct action from the Sun on the Earth without anything in between, we have to picture the Sun's action being transmitted through a medium whose molecules are probably as tiny relative to their spaces as the Sun and Earth are compared to the distance between them: we have to imagine these tiny molecules acting on each other through vast empty spaces that are enormous compared to their own sizes. How is this idea any easier to understand than the last? We still need to mentally depict a body acting where it isn’t, without anything to carry its action; and does it really matter if this occurs on a large or small scale? Therefore, we see that the exercise of Force is completely unintelligible. We cannot imagine it without something that has extension; yet, once we assume this something, the confusion doesn't go away, it just gets postponed. We must conclude that matter, whether it has weight or not, and whether it's clumped together or in its hypothetical units, acts on matter through entirely empty space; and yet, this conclusion is utterly unimaginable.
Again, Light, Heat, Gravitation and all central forces, vary inversely as the squares of the distances; and physicists in their investigations assume that the units of matter act upon each other according to the same law—an assumption which indeed they are obliged to make; since this law is not simply an empirical one, but one deducible mathematically from the 61relations of space—one of which the negation is inconceivable. But now, in any mass of matter which is in internal equilibrium, what must follow? The attractions and repulsions of the constituent atoms are balanced. Being balanced, the atoms remain at their present distances; and the mass of matter neither expands nor contracts. But if the forces with which two adjacent atoms attract and repel each other both vary inversely as the squares of the distances, as they must; and if they are in equilibrium at their present distances, as they are; then, necessarily, they will be in equilibrium at all other distances. Let the atoms be twice as far apart, and their attractions and repulsions will both be reduced to one fourth of their present amounts. Let them be brought within half the distance, and their attractions and repulsions will both be quadrupled. Whence it follows that this matter will as readily as not assume any other density; and can offer no resistance to any external agents. Thus we are obliged to say that these antagonist molecular forces do not both vary inversely as the squares of the distances, which is unthinkable; or else that matter does not possess that attribute of resistance by which alone we distinguish it from empty space, which is absurd.
Once again, Light, Heat, Gravitation, and all central forces change inversely with the squares of the distances. Physicists, in their studies, assume that units of matter influence one another according to the same rule—an assumption they have to make, since this rule isn't just based on observation; it can be mathematically derived from the 61relationships of space—one of which, the opposite, is unimaginable. Now, in any mass of matter that's in internal equilibrium, what must happen? The attractions and repulsions of the atoms that make it up are balanced. Because they are balanced, the atoms stay at their current distances, meaning the mass of matter neither expands nor contracts. But if the forces with which two neighboring atoms attract and repel each other both decrease in proportion to the square of the distance, as they should; and if they are in equilibrium at their current distances, as they are; then they will also remain in equilibrium at all other distances. If the atoms are twice as far apart, their attractions and repulsions will both decrease to a quarter of what they are now. If they come within half the distance, their attractions and repulsions will quadruple. Therefore, this matter can easily take on any other density and won't resist any external influences. Thus, we must conclude that these opposing molecular forces do not both change inversely with the squares of the distances, which is unimaginable; or that matter lacks the resistance that distinguishes it from empty space, which is absurd.
While then it is impossible to form any idea of Force in itself, it is equally impossible to comprehend either its mode of exercise or its law of variation.
While it’s impossible to understand Force on its own, it’s also impossible to grasp how it’s applied or how it changes.
§ 19. Turning now from the outer to the inner world, let us contemplate, not the agencies to which we ascribe our subjective modifications, but the subjective modifications themselves. These constitute a series. Difficult as we find it distinctly to separate and individualize them, it is nevertheless beyond question that our states of consciousness occur in succession.
§ 19. Now shifting our focus from the external world to the internal one, let’s consider not the factors we attribute our personal changes to, but the changes themselves. These form a sequence. While it can be challenging to clearly separate and define them, it’s undeniable that our states of awareness happen one after the other.
Is this chain of states of consciousness infinite or finite? We cannot say infinite; not only because we have indirectly reached the conclusion that there was a period when it commenced, 62but also because all infinity is inconceivable—an infinite series included. We cannot say finite; for we have no knowledge of either of its ends. Go back in memory as far as we may, we are wholly unable to identify our first states of consciousness: the perspective of our thoughts vanishes in a dim obscurity where we can make out nothing. Similarly at the other extreme. We have no immediate knowledge of a termination to the series at a future time; and we cannot really lay hold of that temporary termination of the series reached at the present moment. For the state of consciousness recognized by us as our last, is not truly our last. That any mental affection may be contemplated as one of the series, it must be remembered—represented in thought, not presented. The truly last state of consciousness is that which is passing in the very act of contemplating a state just past—that in which we are thinking of the one before as the last. So that the proximate end of the chain eludes us, as well as the remote end.
Is this chain of states of consciousness infinite or finite? We can't say it's infinite; not only because we've indirectly concluded that there was a time when it began, 62 but also because the idea of infinity is hard to grasp—an infinite series included. We can't say it's finite either, since we have no knowledge of either of its ends. No matter how far back we try to remember, we can't identify our first states of consciousness: the perspective of our thoughts fades into a vague obscurity where we can't make anything out. The same goes for the other end. We have no direct knowledge of when this series will end in the future; and we can't really grasp that temporary endpoint of the series we reach at the present moment. The state of consciousness we recognize as our last isn't truly our last. For any mental experience to be considered part of the series, it must be remembered—represented in thought, not presented. The true last state of consciousness is the one occurring while we’re contemplating a state that just passed—that in which we are thinking of the one before as the last. So, the immediate end of the chain escapes us, just as the distant end does.
“But,” it may be said, “though we cannot directly know consciousness to be finite in duration, because neither of its limits can be actually reached; yet we can very well conceive it to be so.” No: not even this is true. In the first place, we cannot conceive the terminations of that consciousness which alone we really know—our own—any more than we can perceive its terminations. For in truth the two acts are here one. In either case such terminations must be, as above said, not presented in thought, but represented; and they must be represented as in the act of occurring. Now to represent the termination of consciousness as occurring in ourselves, is to think of ourselves as contemplating the cessation of the last state of consciousness; and this implies a supposed continuance of consciousness after its last state, which is absurd. In the second place, if we regard the matter objectively—if we study the phenomena as occurring in others, or in the abstract, we are equally foiled. Consciousness implies perpetual change and the perpetual 63establishment of relations between its successive phases. To be known at all, any mental affection must be known as such or such—as like these foregoing ones or unlike those: if it is not thought of in connexion with others—not distinguished or identified by comparison with others, it is not recognized—is not a state of consciousness at all. A last state of consciousness, then, like any other, can exist only through a perception of its relations to previous states. But such perception of its relations must constitute a state later than the last, which is a contradiction. Or to put the difficulty in another form:—If ceaseless change of state is the condition on which alone consciousness exists, then when the supposed last state has been reached by the completion of the preceding change, change has ceased; therefore consciousness has ceased; therefore the supposed last state is not a state of consciousness at all; therefore there can be no last state of consciousness. In short, the perplexity is like that presented by the relations of Motion and Rest. As we found it was impossible really to conceive Rest becoming Motion or Motion becoming Rest; so here we find it is impossible really to conceive either the beginning or the ending of those changes which constitute consciousness.
"But," one might argue, "even though we can't directly know that consciousness is finite in duration, because we can't actually reach either limit, we can still conceive it to be so." No, that's not true either. First, we can't conceive the endpoints of that consciousness which we truly know—our own—any more than we can perceive those endpoints. In reality, the two actions are the same. In either situation, such endpoints must not be presented in thought but represented; and they must be represented as happening. To represent the end of consciousness as happening in ourselves means to think of ourselves as observing the stopping of our last state of consciousness; and this suggests a supposed continuation of consciousness after its last state, which is nonsensical. Secondly, if we look at the issue objectively—if we observe the phenomena in others or in the abstract—we face the same problem. Consciousness involves constant change and the ongoing establishment of connections between its successive phases. To be known at all, any mental experience must be recognized as such or such—as similar to those before or different from those after: if it isn't thought about in relation to others—not distinguished or identified by comparison with others—it isn't recognized; it doesn't count as a state of consciousness. A final state of consciousness, like any other, can only exist through a perception of its relations to previous states. However, this perception of its relations must create a state that comes after the last one, which is contradictory. To express the issue differently: if continuous change of state is the only condition under which consciousness exists, then when the supposed last state is reached by the completion of the preceding change, change has stopped; thus, consciousness has stopped; therefore, the supposed last state isn't a state of consciousness at all; hence, there cannot be a last state of consciousness. In summary, the confusion is similar to that concerning the relationships of Motion and Rest. Just as we found it impossible to truly conceive Rest turning into Motion or Motion turning into Rest, we also find it impossible to genuinely conceive either the beginning or the end of those changes that make up consciousness.
Hence, while we are unable either to believe or to conceive that the duration of consciousness is infinite, we are equally unable either to know it as finite, or to conceive it as finite.
Hence, while we can't either believe or understand that the length of consciousness is infinite, we're equally unable to know it as finite or to imagine it as finite.
§ 20. Nor do we meet with any greater success when, instead of the extent of consciousness, we consider its substance. The question—What is this that thinks? admits of no better solution than the question to which we have just found none but inconceivable answers.
§ 20. We also don't find any better results when we look at the substance of consciousness instead of its extent. The question—What is this that thinks?—has no clearer answer than the previous question, which we just found only unimaginable responses to.
The existence of each individual as known to himself, has been always held by mankind at large, the most incontrovertible of truths. To say—“I am as sure of it as I am sure that I exist,” is, in common speech, the most emphatic expression of certainty. And this fact of personal existence, 64testified to by the universal consciousness of men, has been made the basis of sundry philosophies; whence may be drawn the inference, that it is held by thinkers, as well as by the vulgar, to be beyond all facts unquestionable.
The existence of each person as they know themselves has always been seen by humanity as one of the most undeniable truths. To say, "I am as sure of this as I am sure I exist," is, in everyday language, the strongest way to express certainty. This fact of personal existence, 64acknowledged by the universal awareness of people, has served as the foundation for various philosophies; from which it can be inferred that thinkers, just like ordinary people, regard it as an unquestionable fact.
Belief in the reality of self, is, indeed, a belief which no hypothesis enables us to escape. What shall we say of these successive impressions and ideas which constitute consciousness? Shall we say that they are the affections of something called mind, which, as being the subject of them, is the real ego? If we say this, we manifestly imply that the ego is an entity. Shall we assert that these impressions and ideas are not the mere superficial changes wrought on some thinking substance, but are themselves the very body of this substance—are severally the modified forms which it from moment to moment assumes? This hypothesis, equally with the foregoing, implies that the individual exists as a permanent and distinct being; since modifications necessarily involve something modified. Shall we then betake ourselves to the sceptic’s position, and argue that we know nothing more than our impressions and ideas themselves—that these are to us the only existences; and that the personality said to underlie them is a mere fiction? We do not even thus escape; since this proposition, verbally intelligible but really unthinkable, itself makes the assumption which it professes to repudiate. For how can consciousness be wholly resolved into impressions and ideas, when an impression of necessity implies something impressed? Or again, how can the sceptic who has decomposed his consciousness into impressions and ideas, explain the fact that he considers them as his impressions and ideas? Or once more, if, as he must, he admits that he has an impression of his personal existence, what warrant can he show for rejecting this impression as unreal while he accepts all his other impressions as real? Unless he can give satisfactory answers to these queries, which he cannot, he must abandon his conclusions; and must admit the reality of the individual mind.
Belief in the existence of the self is, in fact, a belief that no theory allows us to escape. What should we make of these ongoing impressions and thoughts that make up our consciousness? Should we say they are the feelings of something called the mind, which, as the subject of them, is the true ego? If we claim this, we are clearly suggesting that the ego is a real entity. Should we argue that these impressions and ideas are not just superficial changes happening to some thinking substance, but are actually the very essence of that substance—each being a unique form it takes from moment to moment? This idea, just like the previous one, suggests that the individual exists as a permanent and separate being since modifications necessarily involve something that is being modified. Should we then take the skeptic’s stance and argue that we know nothing more than our own impressions and ideas—that these are the only realities we have, and that the personality said to underlie them is just a fiction? Even then, we can’t escape; this statement, which is understandable in words but really unthinkable, makes the assumption it claims to reject. For how can consciousness be entirely broken down into impressions and ideas when an impression necessarily implies something that is being impressed? Or how can the skeptic, who has analyzed his consciousness into impressions and ideas, explain why he views them as his impressions and ideas? Furthermore, if he must acknowledge that he has an impression of his own existence, what reason does he have to dismiss this impression as unreal while accepting all his other impressions as real? Unless he can provide satisfactory answers to these questions, which he cannot, he must abandon his conclusions and accept the reality of the individual mind.
But now, unavoidable as is this belief—established though 65it is, not only by the assent of mankind at large, endorsed by divers philosophers, but by the suicide of the sceptical argument—it is yet a belief admitting of no justification by reason: nay, indeed, it is a belief which reason, when pressed for a distinct answer, rejects. One of the most recent writers who has touched upon this question—Mr Mansel—does indeed contend that in the consciousness of self, we have a piece of real knowledge. The validity of immediate intuition he holds in this case unquestionable: remarking that “let system-makers say what they will, the unsophisticated sense of mankind refuses to acknowledge that mind is but a bundle of states of consciousness, as matter is (possibly) a bundle of sensible qualities.” On which position the obvious comment is, that it does not seem altogether a consistent one for a Kantist, who pays but small respect to “the unsophisticated sense of mankind” when it testifies to the objectivity of space. Passing over this, however, it may readily be shown that a cognition of self, properly so called, is absolutely negatived by the laws of thought. The fundamental condition to all consciousness, emphatically insisted upon by Mr Mansel in common with Sir William Hamilton and others, is the antithesis of subject and object. And on this “primitive dualism of consciousness,” “from which the explanations of philosophy must take their start,” Mr Mansel founds his refutation of the German absolutists. But now, what is the corollary from this doctrine, as bearing on the consciousness of self? The mental act in which self is known, implies, like every other mental act, a perceiving subject and a perceived object. If, then, the object perceived is self, what is the subject that perceives? or if it is the true self which thinks, what other self can it be that is thought of? Clearly, a true cognition of self implies a state in which the knowing and the known are one—in which subject and object are identified; and this Mr Mansel rightly holds to be the annihilation of both.
But now, as unavoidable as this belief is—firmly established not only by the agreement of humanity as a whole, supported by various philosophers, and bolstered by the collapse of skeptical arguments—it remains a belief that cannot be justified by reason. In fact, when reason is pushed for a clear answer, it rejects this belief. One of the more recent writers on this topic—Mr. Mansel—argues that in the awareness of self, we possess genuine knowledge. He insists that the validity of immediate intuition in this situation is unquestionable, stating that "let system-makers say what they will, the straightforward understanding of mankind refuses to accept that the mind is just a collection of states of consciousness, like matter may be a collection of observable qualities." The obvious critique of this position is that it doesn’t seem entirely consistent for someone who follows Kant, who places little value on “the straightforward understanding of mankind” when it comes to the objectivity of space. However, setting this aside, it can be easily shown that a true awareness of self is entirely negated by the laws of thought. The basic condition for all consciousness, a point emphasized by Mr. Mansel along with Sir William Hamilton and others, is the distinction between subject and object. Mr. Mansel builds his argument against the German absolutists on this “primitive dualism of consciousness,” “from which the explanations of philosophy must take their start.” But what is the implication of this doctrine regarding self-awareness? The mental act in which self is recognized entails, like every other mental act, a perceiving subject and a perceived object. If the object perceived is self, then what is the subject that perceives? Or if it is the true self that thinks, what other self could it be that is being thought of? Clearly, a true understanding of self requires a state where the knower and the known are one—where the subject and object are identical; and this is something that Mr. Mansel correctly sees as the destruction of both.
So that the personality of which each is conscious, and of which the existence is to each a fact beyond all others the most 66certain, is yet a thing which cannot truly be known at all: knowledge of it is forbidden by the very nature of thought.
So, the personality that each person is aware of, and which they see as the most certain fact of all, is actually something that cannot be truly understood at all: knowledge of it is restricted by the very nature of thought.
§ 21. Ultimate Scientific Ideas, then, are all representative of realities that cannot be comprehended. After no matter how great a progress in the colligation of facts and the establishment of generalizations ever wider and wider—after the merging of limited and derivative truths in truths that are larger and deeper has been carried no matter how far; the fundamental truth remains as much beyond reach as ever. The explanation of that which is explicable, does but bring out into greater clearness the inexplicableness of that which remains behind. Alike in the external and the internal worlds, the man of science sees himself in the midst of perpetual changes of which he can discover neither the beginning nor the end. If, tracing back the evolution of things, he allows himself to entertain the hypothesis that the Universe once existed in a diffused form, he finds it utterly impossible to conceive how this came to be so; and equally, if he speculates on the future, he can assign no limit to the grand succession of phenomena ever unfolding themselves before him. In like manner if he looks inward, he perceives that both ends of the thread of consciousness are beyond his grasp; nay, even beyond his power to think of as having existed or as existing in time to come. When, again, he turns from the succession of phenomena, external or internal, to their intrinsic nature, he is just as much at fault. Supposing him in every case able to resolve the appearances, properties, and movements of things, into manifestations of Force in Space and Time; he still finds that Force, Space, and Time pass all understanding. Similarly, though the analysis of mental actions may finally bring him down to sensations, as the original materials out of which all thought is woven, yet he is little forwarder; for he can give no account either of sensations themselves or of that something which is conscious of sensations. Objective and subjective things he thus ascertains to be alike inscrutable in 67their substance and genesis. In all directions his investigations eventually bring him face to face with an insoluble enigma; and he ever more clearly perceives it to be an insoluble enigma. He learns at once the greatness and the littleness of the human intellect—its power in dealing with all that comes within the range of experience; its impotence in dealing with all that transcends experience. He realizes with a special vividness the utter incomprehensibleness of the simplest fact, considered in itself. He, more than any other, truly knows that in its ultimate essence nothing can be known.
§ 21. Ultimate Scientific Ideas represent realities that can't be fully understood. No matter how much progress is made in connecting facts and forming broader generalizations—even as limited and derivative truths blend into larger and deeper truths—the fundamental truth remains just as unreachable as ever. Explaining what can be explained only highlights how much is still inexplicable. In both the external and internal worlds, a scientist finds themselves amid constant changes with no clear beginning or end. If they look back at the evolution of things and consider the possibility that the Universe once existed in a diffuse state, they struggle to understand how that could have happened. Likewise, when speculating about the future, they can't set any limits on the ongoing succession of phenomena before them. Similarly, when looking inward, they realize that both ends of consciousness are beyond their reach; they can't even conceive of them as having existed or existing in the future. When they shift focus from the series of phenomena—whether external or internal—to their intrinsic nature, they encounter the same confusion. Even if they can break down the appearances, properties, and movements of things into manifestations of Force in Space and Time, they still find that Force, Space, and Time defy comprehension. Additionally, while analyzing mental actions might lead them to sensations as the base materials of thought, they still make no progress because they can't explain sensations themselves or what it is that is aware of those sensations. Thus, both objective and subjective experiences remain equally inscrutable in their substance and origin. In every direction, their investigations ultimately confront them with an unsolvable mystery, and they increasingly recognize it as such. They become aware of the strengths and limitations of human intellect—its effectiveness in addressing everything within the realm of experience and its inability to tackle anything that surpasses it. They vividly realize the complete incomprehensibility of even the simplest fact when viewed in isolation. They, more than anyone else, truly know that in its ultimate essence, nothing can be known.
CHAPTER IV.
THE RELATIVITY OF ALL KNOWLEDGE.
§ 22. The same conclusion is thus arrived at, from whichever point we set out. If, respecting the origin and nature of things, we make some assumption, we find that through an inexorable logic it inevitably commits us to alternative impossibilities of thought; and this holds true of every assumption that can be imagined. If, contrariwise, we make no assumption, but set out from the sensible properties of surrounding objects, and, ascertaining their special laws of dependence, go on to merge these in laws more and more general, until we bring them all under some most general laws; we still find ourselves as far as ever from knowing what it is which manifests these properties to us: clearly as we seem to know it, our apparent knowledge proves on examination to be utterly irreconcilable with itself. Ultimate religious ideas and ultimate scientific ideas, alike turn out to be merely symbols of the actual, not cognitions of it.
§ 22. We reach the same conclusion no matter where we start. If we make any assumptions about the origin and nature of things, we find that, through strict logic, we end up trapped in impossible thoughts; this is true for every assumption we can think of. On the other hand, if we don’t make any assumptions and instead begin with the observable properties of things around us, identifying their specific laws of dependence and gradually combining them into broader laws until we encompass everything under some general principles, we still find ourselves just as far from understanding what reveals these properties to us. Even though it seems like we know, our apparent understanding turns out to be completely inconsistent upon closer inspection. Ultimate religious ideas and ultimate scientific ideas end up being just symbols of reality, not true knowledge of it.
The conviction, so reached, that human intelligence is incapable of absolute knowledge, is one that has been slowly gaining ground as civilization has advanced. Each new ontological theory, from time to time propounded in lieu of previous ones shown to be untenable, has been followed by a new criticism leading to a new scepticism. All possible conceptions have been one by one tried and found wanting; and 69so the entire field of speculation has been gradually exhausted without positive result: the only result arrived at being the negative one above stated—that the reality existing behind all appearances is, and must ever be, unknown. To this conclusion almost every thinker of note has subscribed. “With the exception,” says Sir William Hamilton, “of a few late Absolutist theorisers in Germany, this is, perhaps, the truth of all others most harmoniously re-echoed by every philosopher of every school.” And among these he names—Protagoras, Aristotle, St. Augustin, Boethius, Averroes, Albertus Magnus, Gerson, Leo Hebræus, Melancthon, Scaliger, Francis Piccolomini, Giordano Bruno, Campanella, Bacon, Spinoza, Newton, Kant.
The belief, now accepted, that human intelligence can't achieve absolute knowledge has been gradually gaining traction as society progresses. Every new theory about existence, proposed to replace the previous ones that have been proven flawed, has led to fresh critiques and increasing skepticism. All conceivable ideas have been attempted and found lacking; thus, the whole area of speculation has been slowly depleted without any positive outcome: the only conclusion reached is the negative one stated above—that the reality behind all appearances is, and will always be, unknown. Almost every significant thinker has agreed with this. “Except,” says Sir William Hamilton, “for a few recent Absolutist theorists in Germany, this is probably the truth most consistently echoed by every philosopher from every school.” Among those he lists are—Protagoras, Aristotle, St. Augustine, Boethius, Averroes, Albertus Magnus, Gerson, Leo Hebræus, Melancthon, Scaliger, Francis Piccolomini, Giordano Bruno, Campanella, Bacon, Spinoza, Newton, Kant.
It yet remains to point out how this belief may be established rationally, as well as empirically. Not only is it that, as in the earlier thinkers above named, a vague perception of the inscrutableness of things in themselves results from discovering the illusiveness of sense-impressions; and not only is it that, as shown in the foregoing chapters, definite experiments evolve alternative impossibilities of thought out of every ultimate conception we can frame; but it is that the relativity of our knowledge is demonstrable analytically. The induction drawn from general and special experiences, may be confirmed by a deduction from the nature of our intelligence. Two ways of reaching such a deduction exist. Proof that our cognitions are not, and never can be, absolute, is obtainable by analyzing either the product of thought, or the process of thought. Let us analyze each.
It still needs to be pointed out how this belief can be proven both rationally and empirically. It's not just that, like earlier thinkers mentioned, a vague sense of the mystery of things comes from realizing the deceptive nature of our senses; and it's not just that, as discussed in the previous chapters, specific experiments reveal alternative impossibilities of thought from every ultimate idea we can come up with; but also that the relativity of our knowledge can be shown analytically. The conclusions drawn from general and specific experiences can be supported by a deduction based on the nature of our intelligence. There are two ways to reach such a deduction. Proof that our knowledge is not, and can never be, absolute can be obtained by analyzing either the product of thought or the process of thought. Let’s analyze each.
§ 23. If, when walking through the fields some day in September, you hear a rustle a few yards in advance, and on observing the ditch-side where it occurs, see the herbage agitated, you will probably turn towards the spot to learn by what this sound and motion are produced. As you approach there flutters into the ditch, a partridge; on seeing which 70your curiosity is satisfied—you have what you call an explanation of the appearances. The explanation, mark, amounts to this; that whereas throughout life you have had countless experiences of disturbance among small stationary bodies, accompanying the movement of other bodies among them, and have generalized the relation between such disturbances and such movements, you consider this particular disturbance explained, on finding it to present, an instance of the like relation. Suppose you catch the partridge; and, wishing to ascertain why it did not escape, examine it, and find at one spot, a slight trace of blood upon its feathers. You now understand, as you say, what has disabled the partridge. It has been wounded by a sportsman—adds another case to the many cases already seen by you, of birds being killed or injured by the shot discharged at them from fowling-pieces. And in assimilating this case to other such cases, consists your understanding of it. But now, on consideration, a difficulty suggests itself. Only a single shot has struck the partridge, and that not in a vital place: the wings are uninjured, as are also those muscles which move them; and the creature proves by its struggles that it has abundant strength. Why then, you inquire of yourself, does it not fly? Occasion favouring, you put the question to an anatomist, who furnishes you with a solution. He points out that this solitary shot has passed close to the place at which the nerve supplying the wing-muscles of one side, diverges from the spine; and that a slight injury to this nerve, extending even to the rupture of a few fibres, may, by preventing a perfect co-ordination in the actions of the two wings, destroy the power of flight. You are no longer puzzled. But what has happened?—what has changed your state from one of perplexity to one of comprehension? Simply the disclosure of a class of previously known cases, along with which you can include this case. The connexion between lesions of the nervous system and paralysis of limbs has been already many times brought 71under your notice; and you here find a relation of cause and effect that is essentially similar.
§ 23. If one day in September, while walking through the fields, you hear a rustling a few yards ahead of you and, looking towards the ditch where the sound is coming from, see the plants moving, you'll likely turn to find out what's causing the noise and movement. As you get closer, a partridge flutters into the ditch; upon seeing this, your curiosity is satisfied—you now have what you call an explanation for what you observed. This explanation amounts to this: throughout your life, you've had countless experiences of disturbances among small stationary objects when other objects move among them, and you've generalized the relationship between these disturbances and movements. So, you consider this particular disturbance explained because it fits that same pattern. Now, suppose you catch the partridge and, wanting to know why it didn’t escape, you examine it and find a small trace of blood on its feathers. You now understand, as you say, what has caused the partridge to be disabled. It has been wounded by a hunter—this adds another example to the many you've already seen of birds being killed or injured by shots fired at them from guns. Your understanding of this case comes from relating it to other similar cases. However, upon thinking more, a question arises. Only one shot has hit the partridge, and it didn't strike a vital spot: its wings are unharmed, as are the muscles that move them; and the bird shows by its struggles that it has plenty of strength. So, you ask yourself, why doesn’t it fly? If the opportunity arises, you pose the question to an anatomist, who provides you with a solution. He explains that this single shot passed close to where the nerve supplying the wing muscles on one side diverges from the spine, and that even a slight injury to this nerve, including the rupture of a few fibers, can prevent perfect coordination between the actions of both wings, thus disabling flight. You are no longer confused. But what has changed your state from one of puzzlement to one of comprehension? Simply the revelation of a category of cases you already knew about, which allows you to include this case. You have previously noticed the connection between damage to the nervous system and paralysis of limbs, and now you've identified a similar cause-and-effect relationship.
Let us suppose you are led on to make further inquiries concerning organic actions, which, conspicuous and remarkable as they are, you had not before cared to understand. How is respiration effected? you ask—why does air periodically rush into the lungs? The answer is that in the higher vertebrata, as in ourselves, influx of air is caused by an enlargement of the thoracic cavity, due, partly to depression of the diaphragm, partly to elevation of the ribs. But how does elevation of the ribs enlarge the cavity? In reply the anatomist shows you that the plane of each pair of ribs makes an acute angle with the spine; that this angle widens when the moveable ends of the ribs are raised; and he makes you realize the consequent dilatation of the cavity, by pointing out how the area of a parallelogram increases as its angles approach to right angles—you understand this special fact when you see it to be an instance of a general geometrical fact. There still arises, however, the question—why does the air rush into this enlarged cavity? To which comes the answer that, when the thoracic cavity is enlarged, the contained air, partially relieved from pressure, expands, and so loses some of its resisting power; that hence it opposes to the pressure of the external air a less pressure; and that as air, like every other fluid, presses equally in all directions, motion must result along any line in which the resistance is less than elsewhere; whence follows an inward current. And this interpretation you recognize as one, when a few facts of like kind, exhibited more plainly in a visible fluid such as water, are cited in illustration. Again, when it was pointed out that the limbs are compound levers acting in essentially the same way as levers of iron or wood, you might consider yourself as having obtained a partial rationale of animal movements. The contraction of a muscle, seeming before utterly unaccountable, would seem less unaccountable were you shown 72how, by a galvanic current, a series of soft iron magnets could be made to shorten itself, through the attraction of each magnet for its neighbours:—an alleged analogy which especially answers the purpose of our argument; since, whether real or fancied, it equally illustrates the mental illumination that results on finding a class of cases within which a particular case may possibly be included. And it may be further noted how, in the instance here named, an additional feeling of comprehension arises on remembering that the influence conveyed through the nerves to the muscles, is, though not positively electric, yet a form of force nearly allied to the electric. Similarly when you learn that animal heat arises from chemical combination, and so is evolved as heat is evolved in other chemical combinations—when you learn that the absorption of nutrient fluids through the coats of the intestines, is an instance of osmotic action—when you learn that the changes undergone by food during digestion, are like changes artificially producible in the laboratory; you regard yourself as knowing something about the natures of these phenomena.
Let’s say you start to ask more questions about organic processes, which, as noticeable and interesting as they are, you hadn’t cared to understand before. How does breathing happen? you ask—why does air come rushing into the lungs repeatedly? The answer is that in higher vertebrates, including us, the inflow of air is caused by an expansion of the chest cavity, partly due to the diaphragm dropping down and partly because the ribs rise. But how does the rising of the ribs make the cavity bigger? In response, the anatomist shows you that each pair of ribs forms an acute angle with the spine; when the movable ends of the ribs are lifted, that angle widens. He helps you understand how this enlarges the cavity by pointing out how the area of a parallelogram increases as its angles get closer to right angles—you grasp this specific detail when you see it as an example of a broader geometrical principle. Still, the question remains—why does the air rush into this expanded cavity? The answer is that when the chest cavity enlarges, the air inside, which is partially relieved of pressure, expands and loses some of its resisting force; therefore, it pushes back against the pressure of the outside air with less force. Since air, like any other fluid, pushes equally in all directions, movement must occur in any direction where the resistance is lower than in others; this creates an inward flow. And you recognize this interpretation as valid when a few similar examples, demonstrated more clearly in a visible fluid like water, are used for comparison. Moreover, when it’s explained that the limbs work like compound levers, acting similarly to levers made of metal or wood, you might feel you’ve gained a partial rationale for animal movements. The contraction of a muscle, which once seemed completely inexplicable, would make more sense if you were shown how a series of soft iron magnets can shorten themselves through the attraction each magnet has for the others when connected to a galvanic current:—this suggested analogy is particularly helpful for our argument, since whether it’s real or imagined, it also highlights the clarity of thought that comes from recognizing a type of case that includes a particular case. It’s also worth noting that, in this example, you gain an extra sense of understanding by remembering that the force transmitted through the nerves to the muscles is closely related to electrical force, even if it’s not exactly electric. Similarly, when you discover that body heat comes from chemical reactions and is released just like heat from other chemical processes—when you learn that nutrients are absorbed through the intestines via osmotic action—when you realize that the changes that food undergoes during digestion are similar to changes that can be artificially produced in a lab; you feel like you’re knowing something about the nature of these phenomena.
Observe now what we have been doing. Turning to the general question, let us note where these successive interpretations have carried us. We began with quite special and concrete facts. In explaining each, and afterwards explaining the more general facts of which they are instances, we have got down to certain highly general facts:—to a geometrical principle or property of space, to a simple law of mechanical action, to a law of fluid equilibrium—to truths in physics, in chemistry, in thermology, in electricity. The particular phenomena with which we set out, have been merged in larger and larger groups of phenomena; and as they have been so merged, we have arrived at solutions that we consider profound in proportion as this process has been carried far. Still deeper explanations are simply further steps in the same direction. When, for instance, it is asked 73why the law of action of the lever is what it is, or why fluid equilibrium and fluid motion exhibit the relations which they do, the answer furnished by mathematicians consists in the disclosure of the principle of virtual velocities—a principle holding true alike in fluids and solids—a principle under which the others are comprehended. And similarly, the insight obtained into the phenomena of chemical combination, heat, electricity, &c., implies that a rationale of them, when found, will be the exposition of some highly general fact respecting the constitution of matter, of which chemical, electrical, and thermal facts, are merely different manifestations.
Look at what we’ve been doing. Turning to the broader question, let’s note where these successive interpretations have taken us. We started with specific and concrete facts. As we explained each one and then the more general facts they represented, we landed on certain highly general facts: a geometrical principle or property of space, a simple law of mechanical action, a law of fluid equilibrium—truths in physics, chemistry, thermology, and electricity. The particular phenomena we began with have merged into larger groups of phenomena, and as this merging has happened, we’ve arrived at solutions that we consider profound, especially as this process has progressed. Even deeper explanations are just further steps in the same direction. For example, when we ask why the law of the lever works as it does, or why fluid equilibrium and motion show the relationships they do, mathematicians provide the answer through the principle of virtual velocities—a principle that applies to both fluids and solids—a principle under which the others are understood. Similarly, the insights we gain into the phenomena of chemical combinations, heat, electricity, and so on suggest that a rationale for them, when discovered, will reveal some highly general fact about the structure of matter, of which chemical, electrical, and thermal facts are merely different expressions.
Is this process limited or unlimited? Can we go on for ever explaining classes of facts by including them in larger classes; or must we eventually come to a largest class? The supposition that the process is unlimited, were any one absurd enough to espouse it, would still imply that an ultimate explanation could not be reached; since infinite time would be required to reach it. While the unavoidable conclusion that it is limited (proved not only by the finite sphere of observation open to us, but also by the diminution in the number of generalizations that necessarily accompanies increase of their breadth) equally implies that the ultimate fact cannot be understood. For if the successively deeper interpretations of nature which constitute advancing knowledge, are merely successive inclusions of special truths in general truths, and of general truths in truths still more general; it obviously follows that the most general truth, not admitting of inclusion in any other, does not admit of interpretation. Manifestly, as the most general cognition at which we arrive cannot be reduced to a more general one, it cannot be understood. Of necessity, therefore, explanation must eventually bring us down to the inexplicable. The deepest truth which we can get at, must be unaccountable. Comprehension must become something other than comprehension, before the ultimate fact can be comprehended.
Is this process limited or unlimited? Can we keep going forever explaining kinds of facts by fitting them into larger categories, or do we eventually have to settle on a largest category? The idea that the process is unlimited, if anyone were foolish enough to believe it, would still suggest that we can't reach a final explanation since infinite time would be needed to do so. On the other hand, the unavoidable conclusion that it is limited—demonstrated not only by the finite range of observation available to us but also by the decrease in the number of generalizations that comes with broader ones—implies that the ultimate fact remains beyond our understanding. If the continually deeper interpretations of nature that make up advancing knowledge are just layers of specific truths included in general truths, and general truths included in even broader truths, it clearly follows that the most general truth, which can't be included in anything else, can't be interpreted. Clearly, since the most general understanding we reach can't be broken down into something more general, it can't be grasped. Therefore, explanations must eventually lead us to the inexplicable. The deepest truth we can uncover must remain unexplainable. Understanding must transform into something different from understanding before we can grasp the ultimate fact.
74§ 24. The inference which we thus find forced upon us when we analyze the product of thought, as exhibited objectively in scientific generalizations, is equally forced upon us by an analysis of the process of thought, as exhibited subjectively in consciousness. The demonstration of the necessarily relative character of our knowledge, as deduced from the nature of intelligence, has been brought to its most definite shape by Sir William Hamilton. I cannot here do better than extract from his essay on the “Philosophy of the Unconditioned,” the passage containing the substance of his doctrine.
74§ 24. The conclusion we reach when we examine the outcomes of thought, as shown in scientific generalizations, is also evident when we look at the thought process itself, as revealed in our consciousness. The proof of the inherently relative nature of our knowledge, based on how intelligence works, has been most clearly articulated by Sir William Hamilton. Here, I can best summarize his doctrine by quoting a passage from his essay on the “Philosophy of the Unconditioned.”
“The mind can conceive,” he argues, “and consequently can know,” only the limited, and the conditionally limited. The unconditionally unlimited, or the Infinite, the unconditionally limited, or the Absolute, cannot positively be construed to the mind; they can be conceived, only by a thinking away from, or abstraction of, those very conditions under which thought itself is realized; consequently, the notion of the Unconditioned is only negative,—negative of the conceivable itself. For example, on the one hand we can positively conceive, neither an absolute whole, that is, a whole so great, that we cannot also conceive it as a relative part of a still greater whole; nor an absolute part, that is, a part so small, that we cannot also conceive it as a relative whole, divisible into smaller parts. On the other hand, we cannot positively represent, or realize, or construe to the mind (as here understanding and imagination coincide), an infinite whole, for this could only be done by the infinite synthesis in thought of finite wholes, which would itself require an infinite time for its accomplishment; nor, for the same reason, can we follow out in thought an infinite divisibility of parts. The result is the same, whether we apply the process to limitation in space, in time, or in degree. The unconditional negation, and the unconditional affirmation of limitation; in other words, the infinite and absolute, properly so called, are thus equally inconceivable to us.
“The mind can conceive,” he argues, “and therefore can know,” only the limited, and the conditionally limited. The unconditionally unlimited, or the Infinite, and the unconditionally limited, or the Absolute, cannot be grasped by the mind in a positive way; they can only be thought of by moving away from, or abstracting those very conditions under which thought exists; as a result, the idea of the Unconditioned is merely negative — a negation of what can actually be conceived. For instance, on one hand, we cannot positively conceive either an absolute whole, meaning a whole so vast that we cannot also think of it as a relative part of an even larger whole, or an absolute part, meaning a part so tiny that we cannot also conceive it as a relative whole that can be divided into smaller parts. On the other hand, we cannot positively represent, realize, or conceive in the mind (where understanding and imagination come together) an infinite whole, since this could only be achieved by infinitely combining finite wholes in thought, which would itself take an infinite amount of time to complete; nor, for the same reason, can we think through an infinite divisibility of parts. The outcome is the same, whether we look at limitation in space, in time, or in degree. The unconditional negation and the unconditional affirmation of limitation; in other words, the infinite and absolute, properly so called, are thus equally unimaginable to us.
75As the conditionally limited (which we may briefly call the conditioned) is thus the only possible object of knowledge and of positive thought—thought necessarily supposes conditions. To think is to condition; and conditional limitation is the fundamental law of the possibility of thought. For, as the greyhound cannot outstrip his shadow, nor (by a more appropriate simile) the eagle outsoar the atmosphere in which he floats, and by which alone he may be supported; so the mind cannot transcend that sphere of limitation, within and through which exclusively the possibility of thought is realized. Thought is only of the conditioned; because, as we have said, to think is simply to condition. The absolute is conceived merely by a negation of conceivability; and all that we know, is only known as
75Since the conditionally limited (which we can briefly call the conditioned) is the only possible object of knowledge and positive thought—thought necessarily relies on conditions. To think is to condition; and conditional limitation is the basic rule for the possibility of thought. Just as a greyhound cannot outrun its shadow, or more appropriately, an eagle cannot soar beyond the atmosphere that supports it, the mind cannot go beyond that sphere of limitation, within and through which the possibility of thought is realized. Thought is only about the conditioned; because, as we said, to think is simply to condition. The absolute is understood only through a negation of what can be conceived; and everything we know is only known as
How, indeed, it could ever be doubted that thought is only of the conditioned, may well be deemed a matter of the profoundest admiration. Thought cannot transcend consciousness; consciousness is only possible under the antithesis of a subject and object of thought, known only in correlation, and mutually limiting each other; while, independently of this, all that we know either of subject or object, either of mind or matter, is only a knowledge in each of the particular, of the plural, of the different, of the modified, of the phenomenal. We admit that the consequence of this doctrine is,—that philosophy, if viewed as more than a science of the conditioned, is impossible. Departing from the particular, we admit, that we can never, in our highest generalizations, rise above the finite; that our knowledge, whether of mind or matter, can be nothing more than a knowledge of the relative manifestations of an existence, which in itself it is our highest wisdom to recognize as beyond the reach of philosophy,—in the language of St Austin,—‘cognoscendo ignorari, et ignorando cognosci.’
How can anyone seriously doubt that thought is only concerned with what is conditioned? This is truly remarkable. Thought cannot go beyond consciousness; consciousness only exists through the relationship between a subject and an object of thought, which are known only in relation to each other and limit one another. Apart from this, everything we know about either the subject or object, whether it's about the mind or the material world, is merely a knowledge of specific instances, of plurality, of differences, of modifications, and of phenomena. We acknowledge that the implication of this idea is that philosophy, if regarded as more than a study of the conditioned, is impossible. Moving away from specifics, we recognize that we can never rise above the finite, even in our most abstract generalizations; our knowledge, whether it pertains to mind or matter, can only be knowledge of the relative expressions of an existence that, in itself, we should ultimately understand to be beyond the scope of philosophy — in the words of St. Augustine, ‘know by being ignorant, and know by knowing.’
“The conditioned is the mean between two extremes,—two 76inconditionates, exclusive of each other, neither of which can be conceived as possible, but of which, on the principles of contradiction and excluded middle, one must be admitted as necessary. On this opinion, therefore, reason is shown to be weak, but not deceitful. The mind is not represented as conceiving two propositions subversive of each other, as equally possible; but only, as unable to understand as possible, either of two extremes; one of which, however, on the ground of their mutual repugnance, it is compelled to recognize as true. We are thus taught the salutary lesson, that the capacity of thought is not to be constituted into the measure of existence; and are warned from recognizing the domain of our knowledge as necessarily co-extensive with the horizon of our faith. And by a wonderful revelation, we are thus, in the very consciousness of our inability to conceive aught above the relative and finite, inspired with a belief in the existence of something unconditioned beyond the sphere of all comprehensible reality.”
“The conditioned is the middle ground between two extremes—two unconditioned states that exclude each other, neither of which can be conceived as possible, but based on the principles of contradiction and excluded middle, one must be accepted as necessary. Thus, reason is shown to be weak, but not deceitful. The mind is not depicted as thinking of two contradictory propositions as equally possible; instead, it simply cannot grasp either of the two extremes as possible. However, due to their mutual opposition, it is forced to acknowledge one as true. This teaches us a valuable lesson that our capacity for thought should not be seen as the measure of what exists; we are cautioned against assuming that the limits of our knowledge match the boundaries of our faith. And through a remarkable revelation, we are inspired with a belief in the existence of something unconditioned, beyond the realm of all comprehensible reality, in the very awareness of our inability to comprehend anything beyond the relative and finite.”
Clear and conclusive as this statement of the case appears when carefully studied, it is expressed in so abstract a manner as to be not very intelligible to the general reader. A more popular presentation of it, with illustrative applications, as given by Mr Mansel in his “Limits of Religious Thought,” will make it more fully understood. The following extracts, which I take the liberty of making from his pages, will suffice.
Clear and straightforward as this statement of the case seems when examined closely, it's presented in such an abstract way that it's not very understandable for the average reader. A more accessible explanation, with relatable examples, as provided by Mr. Mansel in his “Limits of Religious Thought,” will help clarify it. The following excerpts, which I’m taking the liberty of quoting from his work, will be sufficient.
“The very conception of consciousness, in whatever mode it may be manifested, necessarily implies distinction between one object and another. To be conscious, we must be conscious of something; and that something can only be known, as that which it is, by being distinguished from that which it is not. But distinction is necessarily limitation; for, if one object is to be distinguished from another, it must possess some form of existence which the other has not, or it must not possess some form which the other has. But it is obvious 77the Infinite cannot be distinguished, as such, from the Finite, by the absence of any quality which the Finite possesses; for such absence would be a limitation. Nor yet can it be distinguished by the presence of an attribute which the Finite has not; for, as no finite part can be a constituent of an infinite whole, this differential characteristic must itself be infinite; and must at the same time have nothing in common with the finite. We are thus thrown back upon our former impossibility; for this second infinite will be distinguished from the finite by the absence of qualities which the latter possesses. A consciousness of the Infinite as such thus necessarily involves a self-contradiction; for it implies the recognition, by limitation and difference, of that which can only be given as unlimited and indifferent. * * *
“The very idea of consciousness, no matter how it shows up, implies distinction between one object and another. To be conscious, we have to be aware of something, and that something can only be recognized for what it is by distinguishing it from what it isn’t. But distinction is inherently limitation; if one object is to be set apart from another, it must have some form of existence that the other doesn’t, or it must lack some form that the other has. It’s clear that the Infinite can’t be distinguished, as such, from the Finite by the absence of any quality that the Finite has; because such absence would mean a limitation. Nor can it be distinguished by having an attribute that the Finite lacks; since no finite part can be part of an infinite whole, this distinguishing feature must also be infinite, and at the same time have nothing in common with the finite. We’re thus back at our previous impossibility; for this second infinite will be distinguished from the finite by lacking qualities that the latter possesses. A consciousness of the Infinite as such therefore necessarily results in a self-contradiction; because it suggests recognition, through limitation and difference, of something that can only be represented as unlimited and indifferent. * * *
“This contradiction, which is utterly inexplicable on the supposition that the infinite is a positive object of human thought, is at once accounted for, when it is regarded as the mere negation of thought. If all thought is limitation;—if whatever we conceive is, by the very act of conception, regarded as finite,—the infinite, from a human point of view, is merely a name for the absence of those conditions under which thought is possible. To speak of a Conception of the Infinite is, therefore, at once to affirm those conditions and to deny them. The contradiction, which we discover in such a conception, is only that which we have ourselves placed there, by tacitly assuming the conceivability of the inconceivable. The condition of consciousness is distinction; and condition of distinction is limitation. We can have no consciousness of Being in general which is not some Being in particular: a thing, in consciousness, is one thing out of many. In assuming the possibility of an infinite object of consciousness, I assume, therefore, that it is at the same time limited and unlimited;—actually something, without which it could not be an object of consciousness, and actually nothing, without which it could not be infinite. * * *
“This contradiction, which is totally puzzling if we think of the infinite as a positive aspect of human thought, makes sense when we see it as just the negation of thought. If all thought involves limitations—if everything we conceive is, by that very act of conception, considered finite—the infinite, from a human perspective, is simply a term for the absence of the conditions that make thought possible. To talk about a Conception of the Infinite is, therefore, to both affirm and deny those conditions simultaneously. The contradiction we find in such a conception is just what we’ve placed there ourselves by quietly assuming the possibility of what cannot be conceived. The foundation of consciousness is distinction, and the foundation of distinction is limitation. We can’t have any awareness of Being in general that isn’t a particular Being: a thing in consciousness is one thing among many. By assuming the possibility of an infinite object of consciousness, I’m also implying that it is both limited and unlimited—actually something, without which it couldn’t be an object of consciousness, and actually nothing, without which it couldn’t be infinite. * * *
“A second characteristic of Consciousness is, that it is only 78possible in the form of a relation. There must be a Subject, or person conscious, and an Object, or thing of which he is conscious. There can be no consciousness without the union of these two factors; and, in that union, each exists only as it is related to the other. The subject is a subject, only in so far as it is conscious of an object: the object is an object, only in so far as it is apprehended by a subject: and the destruction of either is the destruction of consciousness itself. It is thus manifest that a consciousness of the Absolute is equally self-contradictory with that of the Infinite. To be conscious of the Absolute as such, we must know that an object, which is given in relation to our consciousness, is identical with one which exists in its own nature, out of all relation to consciousness. But to know this identity, we must be able to compare the two together; and such a comparison is itself a contradiction. We are in fact required to compare that of which we are conscious with that of which we are not conscious; the comparison itself being an act of consciousness, and only possible through the consciousness of both its objects. It is thus manifest that, even if we could be conscious of the absolute, we could not possibly know that it is the absolute: and, as we can be conscious of an object as such, only by knowing it to be what it is, this is equivalent to an admission that we cannot be conscious of the absolute at all. As an object of consciousness, every thing is necessarily relative; and what a thing may be out of consciousness, no mode of consciousness can tell us.
“A second characteristic of Consciousness is that it is only 78possible in the form of a relation. There must be a Subject, or a person who is conscious, and an Object, or the thing that they are aware of. There can be no consciousness without the connection of these two elements; and, in that connection, each exists only as it relates to the other. The subject is a subject only insofar as it is conscious of an object: the object is an object only as it is recognized by a subject: and the removal of either means the end of consciousness itself. It is clear that being conscious of the Absolute is just as contradictory as being aware of the Infinite. To be aware of the Absolute as such, we must realize that an object, which is perceived in relation to our consciousness, is identical to one that exists in its own nature, independent of all relation to consciousness. But to understand this identity, we need to be able to compare the two together; and such a comparison is itself a contradiction. We are essentially asked to compare what we are conscious of with what we are not conscious of; the comparison itself being an act of consciousness, and only possible through the awareness of both its objects. Thus, it is evident that, even if we could be conscious of the absolute, we could not definitely know that it is the absolute: and since we can only recognize an object as such by understanding it for what it is, this means that we cannot be conscious of the absolute at all. As an object of consciousness, everything is necessarily relative; and what something may be outside of consciousness, no form of consciousness can reveal to us.
“This contradiction, again, admits of the same explanation as the former. Our whole notion of existence is necessarily relative; for it is existence as conceived by us. But Existence, as we conceive it, is but a name for the several ways in which objects are presented to our consciousness,—a general term, embracing a variety of relations. The Absolute, on the other hand, is a term expressing no object of thought, but only a denial of the relation by which thought is constituted. To assume absolute existence as an object of thought, is thus to 79suppose a relation existing when the related terms exist no longer. An object of thought exists, as such, in and through its relation to a thinker; while the Absolute, as such, is independent of all relation. The Conception of the Absolute thus implies at the same time the presence and absence of the relation by which thought is constituted; and our various endeavours to represent it are only so many modified forms of the contradiction involved in our original assumption. Here, too, the contradiction is one which we ourselves have made. It does not imply that the Absolute cannot exist; but it implies, most certainly, that we cannot conceive it as existing.”
“This contradiction can be explained the same way as the previous one. Our entire idea of existence is necessarily relative; it’s existence as we understand it. However, Existence, as we perceive it, is just a label for the different ways objects are presented to our awareness—it's a broad term that includes a variety of relationships. The Absolute, on the other hand, refers to something that doesn’t represent an object of thought but simply indicates the absence of the relationship that gives rise to thought. To consider absolute existence as an object of thought is to assume a relationship exists even when the related elements no longer exist. An object of thought exists, as such, through its connection to a thinker; while the Absolute, in itself, is independent of any relationship. The Conception of the Absolute therefore suggests both the presence and absence of the relationship that forms thought; and our various attempts to express it are merely different forms of the contradiction stemming from our initial assumption. Here, too, we have created the contradiction ourselves. It doesn’t mean that the Absolute cannot exist; rather, it certainly means that we cannot imagine it as existing.”
Here let me point out how the same general inference may be evolved from another fundamental condition of thought, omitted by Sir W. Hamilton, and not supplied by Mr Mansel;—a condition which, under its obverse aspect, we have already contemplated in the last section. Every complete act of consciousness, besides distinction and relation, also implies likeness. Before it can become an idea, or constitute a piece of knowledge, a mental state must not only be known as separate in kind from certain foregoing states to which it is known as related by succession; but it must further be known as of the same kind with certain other foregoing states. That organization of changes which constitutes thinking, involves continuous integration as well as continuous differentiation. Were each new affection of the mind perceived simply as an affection in some way contrasted with the preceding ones—were there but a chain of impressions, each of which as it arose was merely distinguished from its predecessors; consciousness would be an utter chaos. To produce that orderly consciousness which we call intelligence, there requires the assimilation of each impression to others, that occurred earlier in the series. Both the successive mental states, and the successive relations which they bear to each other, must be classified; and classification involves not only a parting of the unlike, but also a binding together of the like. In brief, a true cognition is possible only through 80an accompanying recognition. Should it be objected that if so, there cannot be a first cognition, and hence there can be no cognition; the reply is, that cognition proper arises gradually—that during the first stage of incipient intelligence, before the feelings produced by intercourse with the outer world have been put into order, there are no cognitions, strictly so called; and that, as every infant shows us, these slowly emerge out of the confusion of unfolding consciousness as fast as the experiences are arranged into groups—as fast as the most frequently repeated sensations, and their relations to each other, become familiar enough to admit of their recognition as such or such, whenever they recur. Should it be further objected that if cognition pre-supposes recognition, there can be, no cognition, even by an adult, of an object never before seen; there is still the sufficient answer that in so far as it is not assimilated to previously-seen objects, it is not known, and that it is known in so far as it is assimilated to them. Of this paradox the interpretation is, that an object is classifiable in various ways, with various degrees of completeness. An animal hitherto unknown (mark the word), though not referable to any established species or genus, is yet recognized as belonging to one of the larger divisions—mammals, birds, reptiles, or fishes; or should it be so anomalous that its alliance with any of these is not determinable, it may yet be classed as vertebrate or invertebrate; or if it be one of those organisms of which it is doubtful whether the animal or vegetal characteristics predominate, it is still known as a living body; even should it be questioned whether it is organic, it remains beyond question that it is a material object, and it is cognized by being recognized as such. Whence it is manifest that a thing is perfectly known only when it is in all respects like certain things previously observed; that in proportion to the number of respects in which it is unlike them, is the extent to which it is unknown; and that hence when it has absolutely no attribute in common 81with anything else, it must be absolutely beyond the bounds of knowledge.
Here let me point out how the same overall conclusion can come from another fundamental aspect of thinking that Sir W. Hamilton overlooked and Mr. Mansel didn't address—an aspect we already examined in the last section. Every complete act of awareness, besides differentiation and relation, also implies similarity. Before it can become an idea or form a piece of knowledge, a mental state must be recognized not only as distinct from certain prior states to which it is related in sequence but also as similar to other prior states. The organization of changes that makes up thinking involves continuous integration as well as continuous differentiation. If each new thought was simply seen as different from the previous ones—if there were just a sequence of impressions, each distinguished only from its predecessors—consciousness would be total chaos. To create the orderly awareness that we call intelligence, we need to relate each impression to others that occurred earlier in the sequence. Both the sequential mental states and the relationships they have with each other must be categorized; and classification requires not only separating the unlike but also bringing together the like. In short, true understanding is only possible through an accompanying recognition. Should it be argued that, if that’s the case, there can’t be a first cognition, and therefore no cognition at all; the response is that true cognition develops gradually—that in the initial stages of emerging intelligence, before the feelings produced by interaction with the outside world are organized, there are no cognitions in the strict sense; and that, as every infant shows us, these slowly evolve out of the confusion of developing consciousness as experiences are grouped—just as the most frequently repeated sensations and their relationships become familiar enough to be recognized as such whenever they reoccur. Should it be further argued that if cognition relies on recognition, then there can be no cognition, even by an adult, of something never seen before; the sufficient answer is that to the extent it is not related to previously seen objects, it is not known, and it is known to the extent that it is related to them. This paradox can be interpreted as an object being classifiable in various ways, with different levels of completeness. An animal that’s previously unknown (note the word) may not fit into any established species or genus, yet it is recognized as belonging to one of the broader categories—mammals, birds, reptiles, or fish; or if it’s so unusual that we can’t determine its connection to any of these, it can still be classified as vertebrate or invertebrate; or if it’s one of those organisms where it’s unclear whether the animal or plant traits are dominant, it is still identified as a living body; even if there’s a question about whether it’s organic, it remains undeniable that it is a material object, and it is recognized as such. Hence, it’s clear that something is completely known only when it is similar in every way to certain things already observed; and the more ways it is unlike them, the less we know about it; and therefore, when it shares no traits at all with anything else, it must be completely beyond the reach of knowledge.
Observe the corollary which here concerns us. A cognition of the Real, as distinguished from the Phenomenal, must, if it exists, conform to this law of cognition in general. The First Cause, the Infinite, the Absolute, to be known at all, must be classed. To be positively thought of, it must be thought of as such or such—as of this or that kind. Can it be like in kind to anything of which we have sensible experience? Obviously not. Between the creating and the created, there must be a distinction transcending any of the distinctions existing between different divisions of the created. That which is uncaused cannot be assimilated to that which is caused: the two being, in the very naming, antithetically opposed. The Infinite cannot be grouped along with something that is finite; since, in being so grouped, it must be regarded as not-infinite. It is impossible to put the Absolute in the same category with anything relative, so long as the Absolute is defined as that of which no necessary relation can be predicated. Is it then that the Actual, though unthinkable by classification with the Apparent, is thinkable by classification with itself? This supposition is equally absurd with the other. It implies the plurality of the First Cause, the Infinite, the Absolute; and this implication is self-contradictory. There cannot be more than one First Cause; seeing that the existence of more than one would involve the existence of something necessitating more than one, which something would be the true First Cause. How self-destructive is the assumption of two or more Infinites, is manifest on remembering that such Infinites, by limiting each other, would become finite. And similarly, an Absolute which existed not alone but along with other Absolutes, would no longer be an absolute but a relative. The Unconditioned therefore, as class-able neither with any form of the conditioned nor with any other Unconditioned, cannot be classed at all. And to admit that it cannot be known as of such or such kind, is to admit that it is unknowable.
Look at the related point we're discussing here. Understanding the Real, as different from the Phenomenal, must, if it exists, follow this general rule of understanding. The First Cause, the Infinite, the Absolute, to be known in any way, must be categorized. To be thought of positively, it has to be considered as one type or another—this kind or that kind. Can it resemble anything we have sensory experience of? Clearly not. There must be a distinction between the creator and the created that goes beyond any differences found among various categories of the created. What is uncaused cannot be compared to what is caused; the two are fundamentally opposed just by their definitions. The Infinite cannot be categorized with anything finite; if it were, it would no longer be considered infinite. It's impossible to put the Absolute in the same category as anything relative as long as the Absolute is defined as something that can't have any necessary relationship. So, can the Actual, although it can't be classified with the Apparent, be classified with itself? This idea is just as ridiculous as the previous one. It suggests multiple First Causes, the Infinite, the Absolute; and that idea contradicts itself. There can't be more than one First Cause, since having more than one would mean the existence of something that requires multiple causes, which would itself be the true First Cause. The idea of two or more Infinites is clearly self-destructive because those Infinites, by limiting each other, would become finite. Similarly, an Absolute that exists alongside other Absolutes would cease to be absolute and instead be relative. Therefore, the Unconditioned cannot be categorized with any form of the conditioned or with any other Unconditioned at all. Admitting that it can't be known as this kind or that kind is to accept that it is unknowable.
82Thus, from the very nature of thought, the relativity of our knowledge is inferable in three several ways. As we find by analyzing it, and as we see it objectively displayed in every proposition, a thought involves relation, difference, likeness. Whatever does not present each of these does not admit of cognition. And hence we may say that the Unconditioned, as presenting none of them, is trebly unthinkable.
82So, based on the very nature of thought, we can infer the relativity of our knowledge in three different ways. Through analysis, and as we observe it presented in every statement, a thought involves relation, difference, and likeness. Anything that doesn’t show each of these cannot be understood. Therefore, we can say that the Unconditioned, since it presents none of them, is three times unthinkable.
§ 25. From yet another point of view we may discern the same great truth. If, instead of examining our intellectual powers directly as exhibited in the act of thought, or indirectly as exhibited in thought when expressed by words, we look at the connexion between the mind and the world, a like conclusion is forced upon us. In the very definition of Life, when reduced to its most abstract shape, this ultimate implication becomes visible.
§ 25. From another perspective, we can see the same fundamental truth. If we look at the connection between the mind and the world instead of directly examining our intellectual abilities as shown in the act of thinking, or indirectly as they show up in thoughts expressed through words, we are led to a similar conclusion. In the most basic definition of Life, this ultimate implication becomes clear.
All vital actions, considered not separately but in their ensemble, have for their final purpose the balancing of certain outer processes by certain inner processes. There are unceasing external forces tending to bring the matter of which organic bodies consist, into that state of stable equilibrium displayed by inorganic bodies; there are internal forces by which this tendency is constantly antagonized; and the perpetual changes which constitute Life, may be regarded as incidental to the maintenance of the antagonism. To preserve the erect posture, for instance, we see that certain weights have to be neutralized by certain strains: each limb or other organ, gravitating to the Earth and pulling down the parts to which it is attached, has to be preserved in position by the tension of sundry muscles; or in other words, the group of forces which would if allowed bring the body to the ground, has to be counterbalanced by another group of forces. Again, to keep up the temperature at a particular point, the external process of radiation and absorption of heat by the surrounding medium, must be met by a corresponding internal process of chemical combination, whereby more heat may be evolved; to which add, that if from atmospheric changes the loss 83becomes greater or less, the production must become greater or less. And similarly throughout the organic actions in general.
All essential actions, considered together rather than separately, ultimately aim to balance certain external processes with specific internal processes. There are constant external forces trying to push the matter that makes up living bodies into a stable state similar to that of non-living matter; there are also internal forces that continually resist this tendency. The ongoing changes that define life can be seen as part of maintaining this opposition. To keep an upright posture, for example, certain weights need to be offset by specific strains: each limb or organ, which is pulled down toward the Earth, must remain in place due to the tension of various muscles; in other words, the set of forces that would otherwise bring the body down must be countered by another set of forces. Similarly, to maintain a specific temperature, the external process of radiating and absorbing heat from the surrounding environment must be matched by an internal chemical process that generates more heat. Furthermore, if changes in the atmosphere cause an increase or decrease in heat loss, the generation of heat must also adjust accordingly. This principle applies throughout all organic processes in general.
When we contemplate the lower kinds of life, we see that the correspondences thus maintained are direct and simple; as in a plant, the vitality of which mainly consists in osmotic and chemical actions responding to the co-existence of light, heat, water, and carbonic acid around it. But in animals, and especially in the higher orders of them, the correspondences become extremely complex. Materials for growth and repair not being, like those which plants require, everywhere present, but being widely dispersed and under special forms, have to be found, to be secured, and to be reduced to a fit state for assimilation. Hence the need for locomotion; hence the need for the senses; hence the need for prehensile and destructive appliances; hence the need for an elaborate digestive apparatus. Observe, however, that these successive complications are essentially nothing but aids to the maintenance of the organic balance in its integrity, in opposition to those physical, chemical, and other agencies which tend to overturn it. And observe, moreover, that while these successive complications subserve this fundamental adaptation of inner to outer actions, they are themselves nothing else but further adaptations of inner to outer actions. For what are those movements by which a predatory creature pursues its prey, or by which its prey seeks to escape, but certain changes in the organism fitted to meet certain changes in its environment? What is that compound operation which constitutes the perception of a piece of food, but a particular correlation of nervous modifications, answering to a particular correlation of physical properties? What is that process by which food when swallowed is reduced to a fit form for assimilation, but a set of mechanical and chemical actions responding to the mechanical and chemical actions which distinguish the food? Whence it becomes manifest, that while Life in its simplest form is the correspondence of certain inner physico-chemical actions with certain outer physico-chemical actions, each advance to a higher 84form of Life consists in a better preservation of this primary correspondence by the establishment of other correspondences.
When we think about the simpler forms of life, we see that the connections they maintain are straightforward and direct; take a plant, whose vitality mainly comes from osmotic and chemical processes reacting to the presence of light, heat, water, and carbon dioxide around it. However, in animals, especially the more advanced ones, these connections become very complex. The materials needed for growth and repair are not as readily available as those that plants need; instead, they are dispersed and come in specific forms, requiring animals to seek them out, secure them, and refine them for absorption. This leads to the need for movement, the development of senses, tools for grasping and breaking things down, and a sophisticated digestive system. However, it's important to note that these complexities are really just ways to maintain the balance of the organism against the physical, chemical, and other forces that could disrupt it. Additionally, while these complexities serve to adapt internal processes to external conditions, they are also further adaptations of internal actions to external ones. For instance, when a predatory animal chases its prey or when the prey tries to escape, these are just adjustments in the organism responding to changes in the environment. Similarly, the way an organism perceives food involves a specific alignment of nervous reactions that correspond to the physical characteristics of the food. The process of breaking down food once ingested is just a series of mechanical and chemical actions that match the mechanical and chemical traits of the food. Thus, it's clear that while Life in its most basic form is the alignment of certain inner physical and chemical actions with certain outer ones, each progress to a higher form of Life is about better maintaining this primary alignment through the establishment of additional connections.
Divesting this conception of all superfluities and reducing it to its most abstract shape, we see that Life is definable as the continuous adjustment of internal relations to external relations. And when we so define it, we discover that the physical and the psychial life are equally comprehended by the definition. We perceive that this which we call Intelligence, shows itself when the external relations to which the internal ones are adjusted, begin to be numerous, complex, and remote in time or space; that every advance in Intelligence essentially consists in the establishment of more varied, more complete, and more involved adjustments; and that even the highest achievements of science are resolvable into mental relations of co-existence and sequence, so co-ordinated as exactly to tally with certain relations of co-existence and sequence that occur externally. A caterpillar, wandering at random and at length finding its way on to a plant having a certain odour, begins to eat—has inside of it an organic relation between a particular impression and a particular set of actions, answering to the relation outside of it, between scent and nutriment. The sparrow, guided by the more complex correlation of impressions which the colour, form, and movements of the caterpillar gave it; and guided also by other correlations which measure the position and distance of the caterpillar; adjusts certain correlated muscular movements in such way as to seize the caterpillar. Through a much greater distance in space is the hawk, hovering above, affected by the relations of shape and motion which the sparrow presents; and the much more complicated and prolonged series of related nervous and muscular changes, gone through in correspondence with the sparrow’s changing relations of position, finally succeed when they are precisely adjusted to these changing relations. In the fowler, experience has established a relation between the appearance and flight of a hawk and the destruction of other birds, including game; there is also in him an established relation between 85those visual impressions answering to a certain distance in space, and the range of his gun; and he has learned, too, by frequent observation, what relations of position the sights must bear to a point somewhat in advance of the flying bird, before he can fire with success. Similarly if we go back to the manufacture of the gun. By relations of co-existence between colour, density, and place in the earth, a particular mineral is known as one which yields iron; and the obtainment of iron from it, results when certain correlated acts of ours, are adjusted to certain correlated affinities displayed by ironstone, coal, and lime, at a high temperature. If we descend yet a step further, and ask a chemist to explain the explosion of gunpowder, or apply to a mathematician for a theory of projectiles, we still find that special or general relations of co-existence and sequence between properties, motions, spaces &c., are all they can teach us. And lastly, let it be noted that what we call truth, guiding us to successful action and the consequent maintenance of life, is simply the accurate correspondence of subjective to objective relations; while error, leading to failure and therefore towards death, is the absence of such accurate correspondence.
Divesting this idea of all unnecessary details and reducing it to its simplest form, we can define Life as the ongoing adjustment of internal relationships to external relationships. When we define it this way, we find that both physical and mental life fit within this definition. We see that what we call Intelligence becomes evident when the external relationships to which the internal ones adjust become numerous, complex, and distant in time or space; that every step forward in Intelligence essentially involves forming more varied, more complete, and more intricate adjustments; and that even the highest achievements of science can be broken down into mental relationships of co-existence and sequence, closely aligned with certain external relationships of co-existence and sequence. A caterpillar, wandering aimlessly until it finally lands on a plant with a specific scent, starts to eat—inside it has an organic connection between a particular impression and a specific set of actions, corresponding to the relationship outside it between scent and food. The sparrow, guided by the more complex connections of impressions involving the color, shape, and movements of the caterpillar, along with other connections that gauge the caterpillar’s distance and position, adjusts its muscular movements to successfully catch the caterpillar. The hawk, hovering above and affected by the shape and movement it sees in the sparrow, engages in a much more complicated and extended series of nervous and muscular adjustments that correspond with the sparrow's changing position until it successfully aligns itself with those changes. The bird hunter has learned through experience to connect the sight and flight of a hawk with the threat it poses to other birds, including game; he has established a relationship between specific visual impressions at a certain distance and the effective range of his gun; and he has also learned, by observing frequently, what position the sights should be aimed at ahead of a flying bird for a successful shot. Similarly, if we consider the creation of the gun. Through the relationships between color, density, and location in the earth, a certain mineral is identified as one that produces iron; acquiring iron from it happens when our specific actions are aligned with the related properties of ironstone, coal, and lime at high temperatures. If we go even further and ask a chemist to explain the explosion of gunpowder or seek a mathematician's theory on projectiles, we still find that they can only teach us about special or general relationships of co-existence and sequence between properties, motions, spaces, etc. Lastly, it's important to note that what we call truth—which helps us take successful actions and maintain life—simply reflects the precise correspondence between subjective and objective relationships; while error, which leads to failure and death, results from the lack of this precise correspondence.
If, then, Life in all its manifestations, inclusive of Intelligence in its highest forms, consists in the continuous adjustment of internal relations to external relations, the necessarily relative character of our knowledge becomes obvious. The simplest cognition being the establishment of some connexion between subjective states, answering to some connexion between objective agencies; and each successively more complex cognition being the establishment of some more involved connexion of such states, answering to some more involved connexion of such agencies; it is clear that the process, no matter how far it be carried, can never bring within the reach of Intelligence, either the states themselves or the agencies themselves. Ascertaining which things occur along with which, and what things follow what, supposing it to be pursued exhaustively, must still leave us with co-existences and sequences only. If 86every act of knowing is the formation of a relation in consciousness parallel to a relation in the environment, then the relativity of knowledge is self-evident—becomes indeed a truism. Thinking being relationing, no thought can ever express more than relations.
If life, in all its forms, including the highest levels of intelligence, is about continuously adjusting our internal experiences to our external surroundings, the relative nature of our knowledge becomes clear. The simplest form of understanding is about establishing a connection between our internal states and external events; as we move to more complex understandings, we establish more intricate connections between our internal states and external influences. It's evident that this process, no matter how extensive, can never fully capture either the internal states or the external influences themselves. Even if we thoroughly investigate which things occur together and which things follow others, we will still only have a list of co-existing and sequential events. If every act of understanding creates a relationship in our minds that parallels a relationship in the world around us, then the relativity of knowledge is obvious—it becomes a given. Since thinking is all about relating, no thought can ever express anything beyond these relationships.
And here let us not omit to mark how that to which our intelligence is confined, is that with which alone our intelligence is concerned. The knowledge within our reach, is the only knowledge that can be of service to us. This maintenance of a correspondence between internal actions and external actions, which both constitutes our life at each moment and is the means whereby life is continued through subsequent moments, merely requires that the agencies acting upon us shall be known in their co-existences and sequences, and not that they shall be known in themselves. If x and y are two uniformly connected properties in some outer object, while a and b are the effects they produce in our consciousness; and if while the property x produces in us the indifferent mental state a, the property y produces in us the painful mental state b (answering to a physical injury); then, all that is requisite for our guidance, is, that x being the uniform accompaniment of y externally, a shall be the uniform accompaniment of b internally; so that when, by the presence of x, a is produced in consciousness, b, or rather the idea of b, shall follow it, and excite the motions by which the effect of y may be escaped. The sole need is that a and b and the relation between them, shall always answer to x and y and the relation between them. It matters nothing to us if a and b are like x and y or not. Could they be exactly identical with them, we should not be one whit the better off; and their total dissimilarity is no disadvantage to us.
And here we should note that what our understanding is limited to is only what our understanding deals with. The knowledge we can access is the only knowledge that can help us. This connection between our internal reactions and external actions, which makes up our life at every moment and enables life to carry on in the following moments, only needs the influences acting on us to be understood in how they relate and follow each other, rather than being understood in their own right. If x and y are two consistently linked characteristics of some external object, while a and b are the effects they create in our awareness; and if the characteristic x leads to the neutral mental state a, while the characteristic y leads to the painful mental state b (reflecting a physical injury); then, all we need to guide us is for x to consistently accompany y externally and for a to consistently accompany b internally. This means that when x causes a in our awareness, b, or more accurately the idea of b, should follow and trigger the actions necessary to avoid the consequences of y. All that’s required is that a and b and the relationship between them always correspond to x and y and their relationship. It doesn’t matter to us if a and b resemble x and y or not. Even if they were exactly the same, it wouldn’t make any difference to us; and their complete dissimilarity is not a disadvantage.
Deep down then in the very nature of Life, the relativity of our knowledge is discernible. The analysis of vital actions in general, leads not only to the conclusion that things in themselves cannot be known to us; but also to the conclusion that knowledge of them, were it possible, would be useless.
Deep down, the true nature of life reveals the relativity of our knowledge. Examining vital actions in general leads us to conclude not only that we cannot truly know things as they are, but also that even if we could, that knowledge would be pointless.
87§ 26. There still remains the final question—What must we say concerning that which transcends knowledge? Are we to rest wholly in the consciousness of phenomena?—is the result of inquiry to exclude utterly from our minds everything but the relative? or must we also believe in something beyond the relative?
87§ 26. There’s one last question to consider—What should we think about what goes beyond our understanding? Should we focus only on the awareness of things we can experience?—does our investigation mean we completely disregard everything except the relative? Or should we also believe in something that exists beyond the relative?
The answer of pure logic is held to be, that by the limits of our intelligence we are rigorously confined within the relative; and that anything transcending the relative can be thought of only as a pure negation, or as a non-existence. “The absolute is conceived merely by a negation of conceivability,” writes Sir William Hamilton. “The Absolute and the Infinite” says Mr Mansel, “are thus, like the Inconceivable and the Imperceptible, names indicating, not an object of thought or of consciousness at all, but the mere absence of the conditions under which consciousness is possible.” From each of which extracts may be deduced the conclusion, that since reason cannot warrant us in affirming the positive existence of what is cognizable only as a negation, we cannot rationally affirm the positive existence of anything beyond phenomena.
The answer of pure logic suggests that, due to the limits of our intelligence, we are strictly confined to the relative; anything that goes beyond the relative can only be thought of as a pure negation or as something that doesn't exist. “The absolute is understood only by negating what can be conceived,” writes Sir William Hamilton. “The Absolute and the Infinite,” states Mr. Mansel, “are, like the Inconceivable and the Imperceptible, terms that don’t refer to any object of thought or consciousness at all, but merely indicate the absence of the conditions needed for consciousness to occur.” From these statements, we can conclude that since reason cannot support us in asserting the positive existence of something that can only be recognized as a negation, we cannot rationally assert the positive existence of anything beyond phenomena.
Unavoidable as this conclusion seems, it involves, I think, a grave error. If the premiss be granted, the inference must doubtless be admitted; but the premiss, in the form presented by Sir William Hamilton and Mr Mansel, is not strictly true. Though, in the foregoing pages, the arguments used by these writers to show that the Absolute is unknowable, have been approvingly quoted; and though these arguments have been enforced by others equally thoroughgoing; yet there remains to be stated a qualification, which saves us from that scepticism otherwise necessitated. It is not to be denied that so long as we confine ourselves to the purely logical aspect of the question, the propositions quoted above must be accepted in their entirety; but when we contemplate its more general, or psychological, aspect, we find that these propositions are imperfect statements of the truth: omitting, or rather excluding, as they do, an all-important fact. To speak specifically:—Besides 88that definite consciousness of which Logic formulates the laws, there is also an indefinite consciousness which cannot be formulated. Besides complete thoughts, and besides the thoughts which though incomplete admit of completion, there are thoughts which it is impossible to complete; and yet which are still real, in the sense that they are normal affections of the intellect.
As unavoidable as this conclusion seems, I believe it involves a serious mistake. If we accept the premise, then the inference is certainly valid; however, the premise as presented by Sir William Hamilton and Mr. Mansel isn’t completely accurate. Although I’ve previously quoted the arguments these writers use to claim that the Absolute is unknowable, and these arguments have been supported by others with similar rigor, there is still a crucial qualification that protects us from that skepticism that would otherwise be required. It’s true that as long as we limit ourselves to the purely logical side of the question, the above propositions must be fully accepted; but when we consider its broader, or psychological, aspect, we find that these propositions are incomplete representations of the truth, as they exclude a very important fact. Specifically: in addition to that definite consciousness defined by the laws of Logic, there exists an indefinite consciousness that cannot be fully articulated. Alongside complete thoughts, and alongside incomplete thoughts that can be completed, there are thoughts that cannot be completed; yet they are still real in the sense that they are normal expressions of the intellect.
Observe in the first place, that every one of the arguments by which the relativity of our knowledge is demonstrated, distinctly postulates the positive existence of something beyond the relative. To say that we cannot know the Absolute, is, by implication, to affirm that there is an Absolute. In the very denial of our power to learn what the Absolute is, there lies hidden the assumption that it is; and the making of this assumption proves that the Absolute has been present to the mind, not as a nothing, but as a something. Similarly with every step in the reasoning by which this doctrine is upheld. The Noumenon, everywhere named as the antithesis of the Phenomenon, is throughout necessarily thought of as an actuality. It is rigorously impossible to conceive that our knowledge is a knowledge of Appearances only, without at the same time conceiving a Reality of which they are appearances; for appearance without reality is unthinkable. Strike out from the argument the terms Unconditioned, Infinite, Absolute, with their equivalents, and in place of them write, “negation of conceivability,” or “absence of the conditions under which consciousness is possible,” and you find that the argument becomes nonsense. Truly to realize in thought any one of the propositions of which the argument consists, the Unconditioned must be represented as positive and not negative. How then can it be a legitimate conclusion from the argument, that our consciousness of it is negative? An argument, the very construction of which assigns to a certain term a certain meaning, but which ends in showing that this term has no such meaning, is simply an elaborate suicide. Clearly, then, the very demonstration that a definite consciousness of the Absolute 89is impossible to us, unavoidably presupposes an indefinite consciousness of it.
First, notice that every argument demonstrating the relativity of our knowledge clearly assumes the positive existence of something beyond the relative. To claim that we can't know the Absolute implies that there is an Absolute. In denying our ability to understand what the Absolute is, we implicitly assume that it exists; and making this assumption shows that the Absolute has been present in our minds, not as nothing, but as something. The same holds true for every step of reasoning supporting this doctrine. The Noumenon, consistently presented as the opposite of the Phenomenon, is inherently regarded as a reality. It is entirely impossible to think of our knowledge as a mere knowledge of Appearances without simultaneously recognizing a Reality of which they are appearances; because appearances without reality are unimaginable. If you remove the terms Unconditioned, Infinite, Absolute, and their equivalents from the argument, replacing them with “negation of conceivability” or “absence of the conditions under which consciousness is possible,” the argument becomes nonsensical. To truly comprehend any of the propositions in the argument, the Unconditioned must be seen as positive rather than negative. How can it then be a valid conclusion from the argument that our awareness of it is negative? An argument that assigns a specific term a specific meaning but ultimately shows that this term lacks such meaning is simply a form of self-destruction. Clearly, the very demonstration that a definite awareness of the Absolute is impossible for us necessarily presupposes an indefinite awareness of it.
Perhaps the best way of showing that by the necessary conditions of thought, we are obliged to form a positive though vague consciousness of this which transcends distinct consciousness, is to analyze our conception of the antithesis between Relative and Absolute. It is a doctrine called in question by none, that such antinomies of thought as Whole and Part, Equal and Unequal, Singular and Plural, are necessarily conceived as correlatives: the conception of a part is impossible without the conception of a whole; there can be no idea of equality without one of inequality. And it is admitted that in the same manner, the Relative is itself conceivable as such, only by opposition to the Irrelative or Absolute. Sir William Hamilton however, in his trenchant (and in most parts unanswerable) criticism on Cousin, contends, in conformity with his position above stated, that one of these correlatives is nothing whatever beyond the negation of the other. “Correlatives” he says “certainly suggest each other, but correlatives may, or may not, be equally real and positive. In thought contradictories necessarily imply each other, for the knowledge of contradictories is one. But the reality of one contradictory, so far from guaranteeing the reality of the other, is nothing else than its negation. Thus every positive notion (the concept of a thing by what it is) suggests a negative notion (the concept of a thing by what it is not); and the highest positive notion, the notion of the conceivable, is not without its corresponding negative in the notion of the inconceivable. But though these mutually suggest each other, the positive alone is real; the negative is only an abstraction of the other, and in the highest generality, even an abstraction of thought itself.” Now the assertion that of such contradictories “the negative is only an abstraction of the other”—“is nothing else than its negation,”—is not true. In such correlatives as Equal and Unequal, it is obvious enough that the negative concept contains something 90besides the negation of the positive one; for the things of which equality is denied are not abolished from consciousness by the denial. And the fact overlooked by Sir William Hamilton, is, that the like holds even with those correlatives of which the negative is inconceivable, in the strict sense of the word. Take for example the Limited and the Unlimited. Our notion of the Limited is composed, firstly of a consciousness of some kind of being, and secondly of a consciousness of the limits under which it is known. In the antithetical notion of the Unlimited, the consciousness of limits is abolished; but not the consciousness of some kind of being. It is quite true that in the absence of conceived limits, this consciousness ceases to be a concept properly so called; but it is none the less true that it remains as a mode of consciousness. If, in such cases, the negative contradictory were, as alleged, “nothing else” than the negation of the other, and therefore a mere nonentity, then it would clearly follow that negative contradictories could be used interchangeably: the Unlimited might be thought of as antithetical to the Divisible; and the Indivisible as antithetical to the Limited. While the fact that they cannot be so used, proves that in consciousness the Unlimited and the Indivisible are qualitatively distinct, and therefore positive or real; since distinction cannot exist between nothings. The error, (very naturally fallen into by philosophers intent on demonstrating the limits and conditions of consciousness,) consists in assuming that consciousness contains nothing but limits and conditions; to the entire neglect of that which is limited and conditioned. It is forgotten that there is something which alike forms the raw material of definite thought and remains after the definiteness which thinking gave to it has been destroyed. Now all this applies by change of terms to the last and highest of these antinomies—that between the Relative and the Non-relative. We are conscious of the Relative as existence under conditions and limits; it is impossible that these conditions and limits can be thought of apart from something to which 91they give the form; the abstraction of these conditions and limits, is, by the hypothesis, the abstraction of them only; consequently there must be a residuary consciousness of something which filled up their outlines; and this indefinite something constitutes our consciousness of the Non-relative or Absolute. Impossible though it is to give to this consciousness any qualitative or quantitative expression whatever, it is not the less certain that it remains with us as a positive and indestructible element of thought.
Perhaps the best way to show that due to the necessary conditions of thought, we're compelled to form a positive yet vague awareness of something that goes beyond clear consciousness, is to analyze our understanding of the contrast between the Relative and the Absolute. It's an unquestioned principle that contradictions in thought, such as Whole and Part, Equal and Unequal, Singular and Plural, are necessarily understood as correlatives: you can’t conceive of a part without considering a whole; there can't be an idea of equality without the idea of inequality. Similarly, it's accepted that the Relative can only be understood in opposition to the Irrelative or Absolute. However, Sir William Hamilton, in his sharp (and largely unrefutable) critique of Cousin, argues, consistent with his previously stated position, that one of these correlatives is purely the negation of the other. He states, "Correlatives certainly suggest each other, but correlatives may or may not be equally real and positive. In thought, contradictories necessarily imply each other, because knowledge of contradictories is one. However, the reality of one contradictory does not guarantee the reality of the other; it is, in fact, just its negation. Thus, every positive notion (what a thing is) suggests a negative notion (what a thing is not); and the highest positive notion, the idea of the conceivable, has its corresponding negative in the idea of the inconceivable. While these mutually suggest one another, the positive is the only real; the negative is just an abstraction of the other, and in the highest generality, it's even an abstraction of thought itself." Now, the assertion that such contradictories “the negative is only an abstraction of the other”—“is nothing else than its negation”—is not true. In correlatives like Equal and Unequal, it is clear that the negative concept has something 90 more than just the negation of the positive one; the things that are denied equality do not disappear from our awareness due to that denial. And the fact that Sir William Hamilton overlooked is that this holds true even for those correlatives whose negative is inconceivable in the strictest sense. Take the Limited and the Unlimited, for example. Our idea of the Limited consists, firstly, of an awareness of some kind of being, and secondly, an awareness of the limits within which it is known. In the contrasting idea of the Unlimited, the awareness of limits is removed; but the awareness of some kind of being remains. It is accurate that without perceived limits, this awareness stops being a proper concept; however, it still exists as a form of consciousness. If, in such cases, the negative contradictory were, as claimed, “nothing else” than the negation of the other, thus a mere nonentity, it would clearly imply that negative contradictories could be interchanged: the Unlimited could be thought of as opposing the Divisible; and the Indivisible could oppose the Limited. The fact that they cannot be used this way proves that in our consciousness, the Unlimited and Indivisible are qualitatively distinct, and therefore positive or real; since distinctions can’t exist between nonentities. The mistake, (which philosophers often make while trying to illustrate the limits and conditions of consciousness,) lies in assuming that consciousness contains nothing but limits and conditions; completely ignoring what is limited and conditioned. It’s forgotten that there is something that forms both the basic material of definite thought and remains after the clarity that thinking provided has been erased. Now, everything mentioned applies, with a shift in terms, to the final and highest of these contradictions—the one between the Relative and the Non-relative. We recognize the Relative as existence under particular conditions and limits; it is impossible to think of these conditions and limits without also considering something to which they provide structure; by the hypothesis, the abstraction of these conditions and limits is, therefore, an abstraction of them only; as a result, there must be an underlying awareness of something that fills in their outlines; and this indefinite something constitutes our awareness of the Non-relative or Absolute. Even though it is impossible to attribute any qualitative or quantitative description to this awareness, it is nonetheless clear that it remains with us as a positive and indestructible element of thought.
Still more manifest will this truth become when it is observed that our conception of the Relative itself disappears, if our conception of the Absolute is a pure negation. It is admitted, or rather it is contended, by the writers I have quoted above, that contradictories can be known only in relation to each other—that Equality, for instance, is unthinkable apart from its correlative Inequality; and that thus the Relative can itself be conceived only by opposition to the Non-relative. It is also admitted, or rather contended, that the consciousness of a relation implies a consciousness of both the related members. If we are required to conceive the relation between the Relative and Non-relative without being conscious of both, “we are in fact” (to quote the words of Mr Mansel differently applied) “required to compare that of which we are conscious with that of which we are not conscious; the comparison itself being an act of consciousness, and only possible through the consciousness of both its objects.” What then becomes of the assertion that “the Absolute is conceived merely by a negation of conceivability,” or as “the mere absence of the conditions under which consciousness is possible?” If the Non-relative or Absolute, is present in thought only as a mere negation, then the relation between it and the Relative becomes unthinkable, because one of the terms of the relation is absent from consciousness. And if this relation is unthinkable, then is the Relative itself unthinkable, for want of its antithesis: whence results the disappearance of all thought whatever.
This truth becomes even clearer when we realize that our understanding of the Relative itself fades away if we see the Absolute as just a pure negation. The writers I've referred to earlier argue that contradictions can only be understood in relation to one another—that Equality, for example, cannot be thought of without its opposite, Inequality; therefore, the Relative can only be conceived when contrasted with the Non-relative. They also argue that being aware of a relationship means being aware of both things that are related. If we're asked to think about the relationship between the Relative and Non-relative without recognizing both, “we are in fact” (to borrow Mr. Mansel's words in a different context) “being asked to compare what we are aware of with what we are not aware of; and the act of comparison itself requires consciousness, only possible through awareness of both objects.” So what happens to the claim that “the Absolute is understood simply as a negation of what can be thought,” or as “just the lack of the conditions that allow consciousness?” If the Non-relative or Absolute only exists in thought as a mere negation, then the relationship between it and the Relative becomes unimaginable, because one part of the relationship is not present in consciousness. And if this relationship is unthinkable, then the Relative itself also becomes unthinkable, lacking its opposite, leading to the complete absence of all thought.
92Let me here point out that both Sir Wm Hamilton and Mr Mansel, do, in other places, distinctly imply that our consciousness of the Absolute, indefinite though it is, is positive and not negative. The very passage already quoted from Sir Wm Hamilton, in which he asserts that “the absolute is conceived merely by a negation of conceivability,” itself ends with the remark that, “by a wonderful revelation, we are thus, in the very consciousness of our inability to conceive aught above the relative and finite, inspired with a belief in the existence of something unconditioned beyond the sphere of all comprehensible reality.” The last of these assertions practically admits that which the other denies. By the laws of thought as Sir Wm Hamilton has interpreted them, he finds himself forced to the conclusion that our consciousness of the Absolute is a pure negation. He nevertheless finds that there does exist in consciousness an irresistible conviction of the real “existence of something unconditioned.” And he gets over the inconsistency by speaking of this conviction as “a wonderful revelation”—“a belief” with which we are “inspired:” thus apparently hinting that it is supernaturally at variance with the laws of thought. Mr Mansel is betrayed into a like inconsistency. When he says that “we are compelled, by the constitution of our minds, to believe in the existence of an Absolute and Infinite Being,—a belief which appears forced upon us, as the complement of our consciousness of the relative and the finite;” he clearly says by implication that this consciousness is positive, and not negative. He tacitly admits that we are obliged to regard the Absolute as something more than a negation—that our consciousness of it is not “the mere absence of the conditions under which consciousness is possible.”
92Let me point out that both Sir Wm Hamilton and Mr Mansel, in other places, clearly imply that our awareness of the Absolute, despite being indefinite, is positive rather than negative. The earlier passage from Sir Wm Hamilton, where he claims that “the absolute is conceived merely by a negation of conceivability,” ends with the statement that, “by a wonderful revelation, we are thus, in the very consciousness of our inability to conceive anything above the relative and finite, inspired with a belief in the existence of something unconditioned beyond the realm of all comprehensible reality.” The last assertion practically acknowledges what the other denies. According to the laws of thought as interpreted by Sir Wm Hamilton, he feels compelled to conclude that our awareness of the Absolute is a pure negation. Yet, he finds that there exists in consciousness an undeniable conviction of the real “existence of something unconditioned.” He navigates this contradiction by referring to this conviction as “a wonderful revelation”—“a belief” with which we are “inspired,” suggesting that it is supernaturally at odds with the laws of thought. Mr Mansel falls into a similar inconsistency. When he states that “we are compelled, by the structure of our minds, to believe in the existence of an Absolute and Infinite Being,—a belief which seems forced upon us, as the complement of our awareness of the relative and the finite;” he clearly implies that this awareness is positive, not negative. He implicitly admits that we must see the Absolute as something beyond mere negation—that our awareness of it is not “the simple absence of the conditions under which consciousness is possible.”
The supreme importance of this question must be my apology for taxing the reader’s attention a little further, in the hope of clearing up the remaining difficulties. The necessarily positive character of our consciousness of the Unconditioned, 93which, as we have seen, follows from an ultimate law of thought, will be better understood on contemplating the process of thought.
The great importance of this question is my reason for asking the reader to focus a bit longer, in hopes of resolving the last remaining issues. The inherently positive nature of our awareness of the Unconditioned, 93 which, as we have seen, arises from a fundamental law of thought, will be clearer when we consider the process of thinking.
One of the arguments used to prove the relativity of our knowledge, is, that we cannot conceive Space or Time as either limited or unlimited. It is pointed out that when we imagine a limit, there simultaneously arises the consciousness of a space or time existing beyond the limit. This remoter space or time, though not contemplated as definite, is yet contemplated as real. Though we do not form of it a conception proper, since we do not bring it within bounds, there is yet in our minds the unshaped material of a conception. Similarly with our consciousness of Cause. We are no more able to form a circumscribed idea of Cause, than of Space or Time; and we are consequently obliged to think of the Cause which transcends the limits of our thought as positive though indefinite. Just in the same manner that on conceiving any bounded space, there arises a nascent consciousness of space outside the bounds; so, when we think of any definite cause, there arises a nascent consciousness of a cause behind it: and in the one case as in the other, this nascent consciousness is in substance like that which suggests it, though without form. The momentum of thought inevitably carries us beyond conditioned existence to unconditioned existence; and this ever persists in us as the body of a thought to which we can give no shape.
One of the arguments used to show the relativity of our knowledge is that we can’t imagine Space or Time as either limited or unlimited. It’s noted that when we think of a limit, we also become aware of a space or time that exists beyond that limit. This further space or time, while not seen as specific, is viewed as real. Even though we don’t form a clear idea of it since we can’t define it, we still have an undefined concept in our minds. The same goes for our understanding of Cause. We can’t create a clear idea of Cause any more than we can with Space or Time; therefore, we have to think of the Cause that goes beyond the limits of our thoughts as real, even if it’s vague. Just as thinking of any limited space brings about an emerging awareness of space beyond the boundaries, when we consider any specific cause, we also develop an emerging awareness of a cause behind it. In both cases, this emerging awareness is fundamentally similar to what triggered it, even if it lacks form. The momentum of thought naturally leads us beyond finite existence to infinite existence; and this remains within us as an unshaped idea that we can’t fully define.
Hence our firm belief in objective reality—a belief which metaphysical criticisms cannot for a moment shake. When we are taught that a piece of matter, regarded by us as existing externally, cannot be really known, but that we can know only certain impressions produced on us, we are yet, by the relativity of our thought, compelled to think of these in relation to a positive cause—the notion of a real existence which generated these impressions becomes nascent. If it be proved to us that every notion of a real existence which we can frame, is utterly inconsistent with itself—that matter, 94however conceived by us, cannot be matter as it actually is, our conception, though transfigured, is not destroyed: there remains the sense of reality, dissociated as far as possible from those special forms under which it was before represented in thought. Though Philosophy condemns successively each attempted conception of the Absolute—though it proves to us that the Absolute is not this, nor that, nor that—though in obedience to it we negative, one after another, each idea as it arises; yet, as we cannot expel the entire contents of consciousness, there ever remains behind an element which passes into new shapes. The continual negation of each particular form and limit, simply results in the more or less complete abstraction of all forms and limits; and so ends in an indefinite consciousness of the unformed and unlimited.
So, we strongly believe in objective reality—a belief that can't be shaken by metaphysical arguments. When we're told that a piece of matter, which we see as existing externally, can't be truly known and that we can only understand the impressions it creates in us, we're still forced by the relativity of our thoughts to consider these impressions in relation to an actual cause—the idea of a real existence that created these impressions starts to emerge. Even if we're shown that every idea of real existence we can come up with is completely inconsistent with itself—that matter, no matter how we think of it, can't truly be matter as it is—our understanding, though transformed, isn't destroyed: the sense of reality remains, as separate as possible from the specific forms that originally represented it in our thoughts. Although Philosophy successively rejects each attempt to understand the Absolute—proving that the Absolute isn't this, that, or the other thing—and we negate each idea as it comes up, we can't eliminate everything from our consciousness; there will always be an element that takes on new forms. The ongoing rejection of each specific form and boundary simply leads to a more or less complete abstraction from all forms and boundaries, ultimately resulting in an indefinite awareness of the formless and limitless.
And here we come face to face with the ultimate difficulty—How can there possibly be constituted a consciousness of the unformed and unlimited, when, by its very nature, consciousness is possible only under forms and limits? If every consciousness of existence is a consciousness of existence as conditioned, then how, after the negation of conditions, can there be any residuum?. Though not directly withdrawn by the withdrawal of its conditions, must not the raw material of consciousness be withdrawn by implication? Must it not vanish when the conditions of its existence vanish? That there must be a solution of this difficulty is manifest; since even those who would put it, do, as already shown, admit that we have some such consciousness; and the solution appears to be that above shadowed forth. Such consciousness is not, and cannot be, constituted by any single mental act; but is the product of many mental acts. In each concept there is an element which persists. It is alike impossible for this element to be absent from consciousness, and for it to be present in consciousness alone: either alternative involves unconsciousness—the one from the want of the substance; the other from the want of the form. But the persistence of this element under successive conditions, necessitates a sense of it as 95distinguished from the conditions, and independent of them. The sense of a something that is conditioned in every thought, cannot be got rid of, because the something cannot be got rid of. How then must the sense of this something be constituted? Evidently by combining successive concepts deprived of their limits and conditions. We form this indefinite thought, as we form many of our definite thoughts, by the coalescence of a series of thoughts. Let me illustrate this. A large complex object, having attributes too numerous to be represented at once, is yet tolerably well conceived by the union of several representations, each standing for part of its attributes. On thinking of a piano, there first rises in imagination its visual appearance, to which are instantly added (though by separate mental acts) the ideas of its remote side and of its solid substance. A complete conception, however, involves the strings, the hammers, the dampers, the pedals; and while successively adding these to the conception, the attributes first thought of lapse more or less completely out of consciousness. Nevertheless, the whole group constitutes a representation of the piano. Now as in this case we form a definite concept of a special existence, by imposing limits and conditions in successive acts; so, in the converse case, by taking away the limits and conditions in successive acts, we form an indefinite notion of general existence. By fusing a series of states of consciousness, in each of which, as it arises, the limitations and conditions are abolished, there is produced a consciousness of something unconditioned. To speak more rigorously:—this consciousness is not the abstract of any one group of thoughts, ideas, or conceptions; but it is the abstract of all thoughts, ideas, or conceptions. That which is common to them all, and cannot be got rid of, is what we predicate by the word existence. Dissociated as this becomes from each of its modes by the perpetual change of those modes, it remains as an indefinite consciousness of something constant under all modes—of being apart from its appearances. The distinction we feel between special and general existence, is the 96distinction between that which is changeable in us, and that which is unchangeable. The contrast between the Absolute and the Relative in our minds, is really the contrast between that mental element which exists absolutely, and those which exist relatively.
And here we encounter the ultimate challenge—How can we possibly have a consciousness of the unformed and limitless, when consciousness, by its very definition, can only exist with forms and limits? If every awareness of existence is an awareness of existence as conditioned, then how can there be anything left after we negate those conditions? Even if the raw material of consciousness is not directly removed when its conditions are withdrawn, doesn't it still have to vanish implicitly? Doesn't it disappear when the conditions for its existence go away? That there must be a solution to this problem is clear; even those who raise it acknowledge that we do have some kind of consciousness, as already shown. The solution seems to lie in what has been suggested. Such consciousness cannot be created by any single mental act; rather, it is the result of many mental acts. Each concept carries a persistent element. It is equally impossible for this element to be absent from consciousness as it is for it to be present in consciousness alone: either scenario leads to unconsciousness—one due to the absence of substance; the other due to the absence of form. But the persistence of this element across different conditions demands a recognition of it as distinct from and independent of those conditions. The awareness of something conditioned in every thought cannot be eliminated, because that something cannot be eliminated. So how is this awareness of that something formed? Clearly, it is formed by merging successive concepts that lack their limits and conditions. We create this vague thought, just like we create many of our precise thoughts, by combining a series of thoughts. Allow me to illustrate this. A large complex object, which has too many attributes to be represented all at once, can still be reasonably conceived by combining several representations, each representing part of its attributes. When thinking of a piano, the first image that comes to mind is its visual appearance, which is then complemented (though through separate mental acts) by ideas of its other side and solid structure. However, a complete conception requires the strings, hammers, dampers, and pedals; and as we gradually add these to our conception, the initially thought attributes fade more or less completely from consciousness. Still, the entire group forms a representation of the piano. Just as we develop a specific concept of a particular existence by successively imposing limits and conditions, we form an indefinite idea of general existence by successively removing limits and conditions. By merging a series of states of consciousness, each of which eliminates limitations and conditions as it arises, we produce a consciousness of something unconditioned. To put it more precisely: this consciousness is not an abstract concept drawn from any individual group of thoughts, ideas, or concepts; it is the abstract of all thoughts, ideas, or concepts. What is common to them all and cannot be eliminated is what we refer to as existence. As this becomes dissociated from each of its forms through the constant change of those forms, it remains as a vague awareness of something constant across all forms—of being apart from its appearances. The distinction we perceive between specific and general existence is the difference between what is changeable in us and what is unchangeable. The contrast between the Absolute and the Relative in our minds is essentially the contrast between that mental element which exists absolutely and those that exist relatively.
By its very nature, therefore, this ultimate mental element is at once necessarily indefinite and necessarily indestructible. Our consciousness of the unconditioned being literally the unconditioned consciousness, or raw material of thought to which in thinking we give definite forms, it follows that an ever-present sense of real existence is the very basis of our intelligence. As we can in successive mental acts get rid of all particular conditions and replace them by others, but cannot get rid of that undifferentiated substance of consciousness which is conditioned anew in every thought; there ever remains with us a sense of that which exists persistently and independently of conditions. At the same time that by the laws of thought we are rigorously prevented from forming a conception of absolute existence; we are by the laws of thought equally prevented from ridding ourselves of the consciousness of absolute existence: this consciousness being, as we here see, the obverse of our self-consciousness. And since the only possible measure of relative validity among our beliefs, is the degree of their persistence in opposition to the efforts made to change them, it follows that this which persists at all times, under all circumstances, and cannot cease until consciousness ceases, has the highest validity of any.
By its very nature, this ultimate mental element is both indefinite and indestructible. Our awareness of the unconditioned being is essentially the unconditioned consciousness, or the raw material of thought that we shape into definite forms when we think. This means that a constant sense of real existence is the foundation of our intelligence. While we can shed specific conditions in our thinking and replace them with others, we can’t escape that unrefined substance of consciousness, which is reconditioned with every thought. Therefore, there always remains with us a sense of what exists consistently and independently of conditions. Even though the laws of thought prevent us from fully conceptualizing absolute existence, they also prevent us from losing our awareness of absolute existence; this awareness is, as we see here, the counterpoint to our self-awareness. Since the only reliable measure of the validity of our beliefs is how persistent they are in the face of attempts to change them, it follows that what persists at all times, under all circumstances, and cannot cease until consciousness itself ceases, holds the highest validity of all.
To sum up this somewhat too elaborate argument:—We have seen how in the very assertion that all our knowledge, properly so called, is Relative, there is involved the assertion that there exists a Non-relative. We have seen how, in each step of the argument by which this doctrine is established, the same assumption is made. We have seen how, from the very necessity of thinking in relations, it follows that the Relative is itself inconceivable, except as related to a real Non-relative. We have seen that unless a real Non-relative 97or Absolute be postulated, the Relative itself becomes absolute; and so brings the argument to a contradiction. And on contemplating the process of thought, we have equally seen how impossible it is to get rid of the consciousness of an actuality lying behind appearances; and how, from this impossibility, results our indestructible belief in that actuality.
To wrap up this somewhat complicated argument: We’ve seen how the assertion that all our knowledge is relative implies the existence of a non-relative. We’ve noted how each step in the argument supporting this idea relies on the same assumption. We’ve observed that because we must think in terms of relationships, the relative cannot be imagined without being connected to a real non-relative. We’ve pointed out that unless we assume the existence of a real non-relative or absolute, the relative itself becomes absolute, leading to a contradiction. And upon reflecting on the thought process, we’ve also noted how impossible it is to eliminate the awareness of a reality underlying appearances, and how this impossibility shapes our unwavering belief in that reality.
CHAPTER V.
THE RECONCILIATION.
§ 27. Thus do all lines of argument converge to the same conclusion. The inference reached à priori. in the last chapter, confirms the inferences which, in the two preceding chapters, were reached à posteriori. Those imbecilities of the understanding that disclose themselves when we try to answer the highest questions of objective science, subjective science proves to be necessitated by the laws of that understanding. We not only learn by the frustration of all our efforts, that the reality underlying appearances is totally and for ever inconceivable by us; but we also learn why, from the very nature of our intelligence, it must be so. Finally we discover that this conclusion, which, in its unqualified form, seems opposed to the instinctive convictions of mankind, falls into harmony with them when the missing qualification is supplied. Though the Absolute cannot in any manner or degree be known, in the strict sense of knowing, yet we find that its positive existence is a necessary datum of consciousness; that so long as consciousness continues, we cannot for an instant rid it of this datum; and that thus the belief which this datum constitutes, has a higher warrant than any other whatever.
§ 27. All lines of reasoning lead to the same conclusion. The inference reached a priori in the last chapter confirms the inferences made after the fact in the two chapters before that. The foolishness of our understanding reveals itself when we try to tackle the biggest questions of objective science, and subjective science shows that this is determined by the laws of that understanding. We not only discover through the failure of all our efforts that the reality behind appearances is completely and permanently beyond our comprehension, but we also understand why, due to the very nature of our intelligence, this must be the case. Ultimately, we find that this conclusion, which seems to contradict humanity's instinctive beliefs in its unqualified form, actually aligns with them when we add the missing qualification. Although the Absolute cannot be known in any way or to any degree in the strict sense, we realize that its positive existence is a necessary part of consciousness; as long as consciousness exists, we cannot escape this fact for even a moment; and thus the belief that this fact represents has stronger justification than any other belief.
Here then is that basis of agreement we set out to seek. This conclusion which objective science illustrates, and subjective science shows to be unavoidable,—this conclusion which, while it in the main expresses the doctrine of the English 99school of philosophy, recognizes also a soul of truth in the doctrine of the antagonist German school—this conclusion which brings the results of speculation into harmony with those of common sense; is also the conclusion which reconciles Religion with Science. Common Sense asserts the existence of a reality; Objective Science proves that this reality cannot be what we think it; Subjective Science shows why we cannot think of it as it is, and yet are compelled to think of it as existing; and in this assertion of a Reality utterly inscrutable in nature, Religion finds an assertion essentially coinciding with her own. We are obliged to regard every phenomenon as a manifestation of some Power by which we are acted upon; phenomena being, so far as we can ascertain, unlimited in their diffusion, we are obliged to regard this Power as omnipresent; and criticism teaches us that this Power is wholly incomprehensible. In this consciousness of an Incomprehensible Omnipresent Power, we have just that consciousness on which Religion dwells. And so we arrive at the point where Religion and Science coalesce.
Here is the foundation of agreement we set out to find. This conclusion, which objective science illustrates and subjective science shows to be inevitable—this conclusion, which mainly reflects the beliefs of the English school of philosophy while acknowledging a kernel of truth in the opposing German school—this conclusion aligns the outcomes of speculation with those of common sense and also reconciles Religion with Science. Common sense asserts that reality exists; objective science proves that this reality isn’t what we think it is; subjective science explains why we can't conceive of it as it is, yet we are compelled to believe it exists. In this assertion of a reality that is completely unknowable in nature, Religion finds a statement that closely matches its own. We must view every phenomenon as a manifestation of some Power acting upon us; given that phenomena appear to be unlimited in their spread, we must see this Power as omnipresent; and criticism teaches us that this Power is entirely beyond our understanding. In this awareness of an Incomprehensible Omnipresent Power, we find what Religion emphasizes. Thus, we reach a point where Religion and Science come together.
To understand fully how real is the reconciliation thus reached, it will be needful to look at the respective attitudes that Religion and Science have all along maintained towards this conclusion. We must observe how, all along, the imperfections of each have been undergoing correction by the other; and how the final out-come of their mutual criticisms, can be nothing else than an entire agreement on this deepest and widest of all truths.
To fully grasp how genuine this reconciliation is, we need to examine the attitudes that Religion and Science have held toward this conclusion all along. We should note how each has been correcting the flaws of the other over time; and how the ultimate result of their mutual critiques can only lead to total agreement on this most profound and broadest of all truths.
§ 28. In Religion let us recognize the high merit that from the beginning it has dimly discerned the ultimate verity, and has never ceased to insist upon it. In its earliest and crudest forms it manifested, however vaguely and inconsistently, an intuition forming the germ of this highest belief in which all philosophies finally unite. The consciousness of a mystery is traceable in the rudest fetishism. Each higher religious creed, rejecting those definite and simple interpretations of 100Nature previously given, has become more religious by doing this. As the quite concrete and conceivable agencies alleged as the causes of things, have been replaced by agencies less concrete and conceivable, the element of mystery has of necessity become more predominant. Through all its successive phases the disappearance of those positive dogmas by which the mystery was made unmysterious, has formed the essential change delineated in religious history. And so Religion has ever been approximating towards that complete recognition of this mystery which is its goal.
§ 28. In religion, let’s acknowledge the great value it has had since the beginning in recognizing the ultimate truth, and how it has consistently emphasized it. In its earliest and most basic forms, it expressed, however vaguely and inconsistently, an instinct that served as the foundation of this highest belief, in which all philosophies ultimately converge. The awareness of a mystery can be found even in the simplest forms of belief. Each advanced religious doctrine, by rejecting the straightforward interpretations of Nature that came before it, has become more deeply religious. As the obvious and understandable causes attributed to things have been replaced by less tangible and understandable forces, the element of mystery has naturally become more prominent. Throughout its various stages, the elimination of those clear doctrines that stripped the mystery of its essence has marked the fundamental change outlined in religious history. Thus, religion has always been moving closer to a complete acknowledgment of this mystery, which is its ultimate aim.
For its essentially valid belief, Religion has constantly done battle. Gross as were the disguises under which it first espoused this belief, and cherishing this belief, though it still does, under disfiguring vestments, it has never ceased to maintain and defend it. It has everywhere established and propagated one or other modification of the doctrine that all things are manifestations of a Power that transcends our knowledge. Though from age to age, Science has continually defeated it wherever they have come in collision, and has obliged it to relinquish one or more of its positions; it has still held the remaining ones with undiminished tenacity. No exposure of the logical inconsistency of its conclusions—no proof that each of its particular dogmas was absurd, has been able to weaken its allegiance to that ultimate verity for which it stands. After criticism has abolished all its arguments and reduced it to silence, there has still remained with it the indestructible consciousness of a truth which, however faulty the mode in which it had been expressed, was yet a truth beyond cavil. To this conviction its adherence has been substantially sincere. And for the guardianship and diffusion of it, Humanity has ever been, and must ever be, its debtor.
For its fundamentally valid belief, religion has always fought hard. Although it started with some pretty questionable disguises and still holds onto this belief under distorted appearances, it has never stopped defending it. It has established and spread various versions of the idea that everything is a manifestation of a power beyond our understanding. Despite being defeated time and again by science throughout history whenever the two have clashed, forcing religion to give up some of its positions, it has clung to the ones it still holds with unwavering determination. No amount of logical criticism of its conclusions—no proof that any of its specific doctrines were ridiculous—has weakened its commitment to the ultimate truth it represents. Even when criticism has dismantled all its arguments and left it speechless, it has still held onto an unshakeable awareness of a truth that, though it was poorly articulated, remains undeniable. Its commitment to this belief has been genuinely sincere. Humanity has always owed it—and will always owe it—a debt for its protection and spread of this truth.
But while from the beginning, Religion has had the all-essential office of preventing men from being wholly absorbed in the relative or immediate, and of awakening them to a consciousness of something beyond it, this office has been but very imperfectly discharged. Religion has ever been more or less 101irreligious; and it continues to be partially irreligious even now. In the first place, as implied above, it has all along professed to have some knowledge of that which transcends knowledge; and has so contradicted its own teachings. While with one breath it has asserted that the Cause of all things passes understanding, it has, with the next breath, asserted that the Cause of all things possesses such or such attributes—can be in so far understood. In the second place, while in great part sincere in its fealty to the great truth it had had to uphold, it has often been insincere, and consequently irreligious, in maintaining the untenable doctrines by which it has obscured this great truth. Each assertion respecting the nature, acts, or motives of that Power which the Universe manifests to us, has been repeatedly called in question, and proved to be inconsistent with itself, or with accompanying assertions. Yet each of them has been age after age insisted on, in spite of a secret consciousness that it would not bear examination. Just as though unaware that its central position was impregnable, Religion has obstinately held every outpost long after it was obviously indefensible. And this naturally introduces us to the third and most serious form of irreligion which Religion has displayed; namely, an imperfect belief in that which it especially professes to believe. How truly its central position is impregnable, Religion has never adequately realized. In the devoutest faith as we habitually see it, there lies hidden an innermost core of scepticism; and it is this scepticism which causes that dread of inquiry displayed by Religion when face to face with Science. Obliged to abandon one by one the superstitions it once tenaciously held, and daily finding its cherished beliefs more and more shaken, Religion shows a secret fear that all things may some day be explained; and thus itself betrays a lurking doubt whether that Incomprehensible Cause of which it is conscious, is really incomprehensible.
But while from the start, Religion has played the crucial role of keeping people from being completely consumed by the immediate or superficial, and of awakening them to the awareness of something greater, it has done this job very imperfectly. Religion has always been somewhat unreligious, and it still is partly unreligious today. First of all, as mentioned before, it has claimed to have some understanding of what goes beyond knowledge; and in doing so, it has contradicted its own teachings. While in one breath it has stated that the Cause of all things is beyond comprehension, in the next it has asserted that this Cause has specific attributes—meaning it can be somewhat understood. Secondly, even though it has often been sincere in its commitment to the great truth it is supposed to uphold, it has also often been insincere, and thus irreligious, in defending the untenable beliefs that have clouded this great truth. Every claim about the nature, actions, or motives of that Power which the Universe reveals to us has been repeatedly questioned and proven to be inconsistent either with itself or with other claims. Yet each claim has been insisted upon age after age, despite a hidden awareness that it wouldn’t hold up under scrutiny. As if unaware that its central stance was solid, Religion has stubbornly clung to every outpost long after it became obviously indefensible. This naturally leads us to the third and most serious form of irreligion that Religion has shown; namely, a flawed belief in what it specifically claims to believe. How truly its central stance is solid is something Religion has never fully grasped. In the deeply devout faith that we typically observe, there lies an innermost core of skepticism; and it is this skepticism that causes the fear of inquiry exhibited by Religion when confronted with Science. Forced to give up one by one the superstitions it once clung to, and constantly finding its cherished beliefs increasingly shaken, Religion reveals an underlying fear that everything may one day be explained; and thus, it betrays a lingering doubt about whether that Incomprehensible Cause it acknowledges is truly incomprehensible.
Of Religion then, we must always remember, that amid its many errors and corruptions it has asserted and diffused a 102supreme verity. From the first, the recognition of this supreme verity, in however imperfect a manner, has been its vital element; and its various defects, once extreme but gradually diminishing, have been so many failures to recognize in full that which it recognized in part. The truly religious element of Religion has always been good; that which has proved untenable in doctrine and vicious in practice, has been its irreligious element; and from this it has been ever undergoing purification.
Of religion, we must always remember that despite its many mistakes and flaws, it has acknowledged and spread a102 supreme truth. From the beginning, recognizing this supreme truth, even in an imperfect way, has been its essential aspect; and its various shortcomings, once extreme but gradually fading, have been failures to fully acknowledge what it recognized in part. The truly religious aspect of religion has always been good; what has been unsustainable in doctrine and harmful in practice has been its irreligious side; and it has constantly been undergoing purification from this.
§ 29. And now observe that all along, the agent which has effected the purification has been Science. We habitually overlook the fact that this has been one of its functions. Religion ignores its immense debt to Science; and Science is scarcely at all conscious how much Religion owes it. Yet it is demonstrable that every step by which Religion has progressed from its first low conception to the comparatively high one it has now reached, Science has helped it, or rather forced it, to take; and that even now, Science is urging further steps in the same direction.
§ 29. Now, notice that throughout this process, the force that has driven the purification has been Science. We often overlook that this has been one of its roles. Religion fails to recognize its huge debt to Science; and Science is hardly aware of how much Religion owes it. However, it's clear that every step Religion has taken from its initial basic understanding to the more advanced perspective it holds today has been aided—and in many ways compelled—by Science; and even now, Science is pushing for additional progress in that direction.
Using the word Science in its true sense, as comprehending all positive and definite knowledge of the order existing among surrounding phenomena, it becomes manifest that from the outset, the discovery of an established order has modified that conception of disorder, or undetermined order, which underlies every superstition. As fast as experience proves that certain familiar changes always happen in the same sequence, there begins to fade from the mind the conception of a special personality to whose variable will they were before ascribed. And when, step by step, accumulating observations do the like with the less familiar changes, a similar modification of belief takes place with respect to them.
Using the word Science in its true sense, which includes all the solid and definite knowledge about the patterns in the surrounding phenomena, it becomes clear that from the very beginning, discovering an established order has changed how we view disorder, or the idea of an uncertain order, that lies at the heart of every superstition. As experience shows that certain familiar changes always happen in the same sequence, the notion of a special personality, whose unpredictable will they were once attributed to, starts to fade from the mind. And as we accumulate observations that do the same with less familiar changes, a similar change in belief occurs regarding those as well.
While this process seems to those who effect, and those who undergo it, an anti-religious one, it is really the reverse. Instead of the specific comprehensible agency before assigned, there is substituted a less specific and less comprehensible agency; and though this, standing in opposition to the previous 103one, cannot at first call forth the same feeling, yet, as being less comprehensible, it must eventually call forth this feeling more fully. Take an instance. Of old the Sun was regarded as the chariot of a god, drawn by horses. How far the idea thus grossly expressed, was idealized, we need not inquire. It suffices to remark that this accounting for the apparent motion of the Sun by an agency like certain visible terrestrial agencies, reduced a daily wonder to the level of the commonest intellect. When, many centuries after, Kepler discovered that the planets moved round the Sun in ellipses and described equal areas in equal times, he concluded that in each planet there must exist a spirit to guide its movements. Here we see that with the progress of Science, there had disappeared the idea of a gross mechanical traction, such as was first assigned in the case of the Sun; but that while for this there was substituted an indefinite and less-easily conceivable force, it was still thought needful to assume a special personal agent as a cause of the regular irregularity of motion. When, finally, it was proved that these planetary revolutions with all their variations and disturbances, conformed to one universal law—when the presiding spirits which Kepler conceived were set aside, and the force of gravitation put in their place; the change was really the abolition of an imaginable agency, and the substitution of an unimaginable one. For though the law of gravitation is within our mental grasp, it is impossible to realize in thought the force of gravitation. Newton himself confessed the force of gravitation to be incomprehensible without the intermediation of an ether; and, as we have already seen, (§ 18,) the assumption of an ether does not in the least help us. Thus it is with Science in general. Its progress in grouping particular relations of phenomena under laws, and these special laws under laws more and more general, is of necessity a progress to causes that are more and more abstract. And causes more and more abstract, are of necessity causes less and less conceivable; since the formation of an abstract 104conception involves the dropping of certain concrete elements of thought. Hence the most abstract conception, to which Science is ever slowly approaching, is one that merges into the inconceivable or unthinkable, by the dropping of all concrete elements of thought. And so is justified the assertion, that the beliefs which Science has forced upon Religion, have been intrinsically more religious than those which they supplanted.
While this process seems anti-religious to both those who carry it out and those who experience it, it's actually the opposite. Instead of the specific, understandable force that was previously assigned, a less specific and less understandable force is introduced. Though this new force, standing in opposition to the previous one, may not initially evoke the same feelings, its lack of clarity will eventually elicit those feelings more completely. For example, in the past, the Sun was seen as the chariot of a god, pulled by horses. We don't need to delve into how much this crude idea was idealized. It's enough to note that explaining the Sun's apparent motion through an agency similar to certain visible forces on Earth made a daily wonder accessible to ordinary understanding. Many centuries later, when Kepler discovered that the planets orbit the Sun in ellipses and cover equal areas in equal times, he proposed that each planet had a spirit guiding its movements. Here, we see that as Science progressed, the idea of a crude mechanical force, like the one initially assigned to the Sun, disappeared. However, even as it was replaced by a more vague and less easily understood force, people still felt the need to posit a specific personal agent to explain the regular irregularity of motion. Finally, when it was shown that these planetary revolutions, along with all their variations and disturbances, followed a single universal law—when the guiding spirits that Kepler imagined were dismissed, and the force of gravity was introduced—the change essentially eliminated a conceivable agency and replaced it with an unimaginable one. While the law of gravity can be understood mentally, it's impossible to conceptualize the force of gravity itself. Newton himself admitted that the force of gravity is incomprehensible without involving an ether; and as we've already noted, the assumption of an ether doesn't help us at all. This is how it is with Science in general. Its development in organizing specific relations of phenomena under laws, and these specific laws under increasingly general laws, inevitably leads to causes that are more abstract. More abstract causes, by their nature, become less conceivable, since forming an abstract idea means leaving out certain concrete elements of thought. Therefore, the most abstract idea that Science is gradually moving towards is one that merges into the inconceivable or unthinkable, as all concrete elements of thought are dropped. This validates the claim that the beliefs Science has imposed on Religion are intrinsically more religious than the ones they replaced.
Science however, like Religion, has but very incompletely fulfilled its office. As Religion has fallen short of its function in so far as it has been irreligious; so has Science fallen short of its function in so far as it has been unscientific. Let us note the several parallelisms. In its earlier stages, Science, while it began to teach the constant relations of phenomena, and so discredited the belief in separate personalities as the causes of them, itself substituted the belief in causal agencies which, if not personal, were yet concrete. When certain facts were said to show “Nature’s abhorrence of a vacuum,” when the properties of gold were explained as due to some entity called “aureity,” and when the phenomena of life were attributed to “a vital principle;” there was set up a mode of interpreting the facts, which, while antagonistic to the religious mode, because assigning other agencies, was also unscientific, because it professed to know that about which nothing was known. Having abandoned these metaphysical agencies—having seen that they were not independent existences, but merely special combinations of general causes, Science has more recently ascribed extensive groups of phenomena to electricity, chemical affinity, and other like general powers. But in speaking of these as ultimate and independent entities, Science has preserved substantially the same attitude as before. Accounting thus for all phenomena, those of Life and Thought included, it has not only maintained its seeming antagonism to Religion, by alleging agencies of a radically unlike kind; but, in so far as it has tacitly assumed a knowledge of these agencies, it has continued 105unscientific. At the present time, however, the most advanced men of science are abandoning these later conceptions, as their predecessors abandoned the earlier ones. Magnetism, heat, light &c, which were awhile since spoken of as so many distinct imponderables, physicists are now beginning to regard as different modes of manifestation of some one universal force; and in so doing are ceasing to think of this force as comprehensible. In each phase of its progress, Science has thus stopped short with superficial solutions—has unscientifically neglected to ask what was the nature of the agents it so familiarly invoked. Though in each succeeding phase it has gone a little deeper, and merged its supposed agents in more general and abstract ones, it has still, as before, rested content with these as if they were ascertained realities. And this, which has all along been the unscientific characteristic of Science, has all along been a part cause of its conflict with Religion.
Science, like Religion, has not fully accomplished its purpose. Just as Religion has failed in its role by being irreligious, Science has fallen short by being unscientific. Let's look at the similarities. In its early stages, Science started to teach the constant relationships of phenomena, which discredited the idea that separate personalities caused them. Instead, it replaced this belief with causal agencies that, while not personal, were still concrete. When certain facts were described as showing "Nature's abhorrence of a vacuum," when the properties of gold were explained as coming from something called "aureity," and when life's phenomena were attributed to "a vital principle," a way of interpreting these facts was established that, although opposed to religious interpretations by attributing different agencies, was also unscientific because it claimed to understand things that were actually unknown. After rejecting these metaphysical agencies—realizing they were not independent entities but merely specific combinations of general causes—Science has more recently attributed large groups of phenomena to electricity, chemical affinity, and other similar general forces. However, by referring to these as ultimate and independent entities, Science has maintained a fundamentally similar stance as before. By explaining all phenomena, including those of Life and Thought, it has not only continued to oppose Religion by proposing radically different types of agencies but has also remained unscientific because it has implicitly claimed knowledge of these agencies. Nowadays, the leading scientists are moving away from these later ideas, just as their predecessors did before them. Magnetism, heat, light, etc., which were once treated as distinct imponderables, are now being viewed by physicists as different expressions of a single universal force, and in doing so, they are starting to see this force as something that isn’t fully understandable. In each stage of its development, Science has offered superficial solutions and has unscientifically overlooked asking about the nature of the agents it frequently referred to. Even as it has progressed and combined its supposed agents into more general and abstract concepts, it has remained satisfied with these as if they were confirmed realities. This persistent unscientific characteristic of Science has been a contributing factor to its ongoing conflict with Religion.
§ 30. We see then that from the first, the faults of both Religion and Science have been the faults of imperfect development. Originally a mere rudiment, each has been growing into a more complete form; the vice of each has in all times been its incompleteness; the disagreements between them have throughout been nothing more than the consequences of their incompleteness; and as they reach their final forms, they come into entire harmony.
§ 30. So, we see that from the beginning, the flaws in both Religion and Science have stemmed from their incomplete development. Initially just basic concepts, each has been evolving into a more complete form; the issue with each has always been their incompleteness. The disagreements between them have simply been the result of this lack of completeness, and as they achieve their final forms, they come into full harmony.
The progress of intelligence has throughout been dual. Though it has not seemed so to those who made it, every step in advance has been a step towards both the natural and the supernatural. The better interpretation of each phenomenon has been, on the one hand, the rejection of a cause that was relatively conceivable in its nature but unknown in the order of its actions, and, on the other hand, the adoption of a cause that was known in the order of its actions but relatively inconceivable in its nature. The first advance out of universal fetishism, manifestly involved the conception of agencies less 106assimilable to the familiar agencies of men and animals, and therefore less understood; while, at the same time, such newly-conceived agencies in so far as they were distinguished by their uniform effects, were better understood than those they replaced. All subsequent advances display the same double result. Every deeper and more general power arrived at as a cause of phenomena, has been at once less comprehensible than the special ones it superseded, in the sense of being less definitely representable in thought; while it has been more comprehensible in the sense that its actions have been more completely predicable. The progress has thus been as much towards the establishment of a positively unknown as towards the establishment of a positively known. Though as knowledge approaches its culmination, every unaccountable and seemingly supernatural fact, is brought into the category of facts that are accountable or natural; yet, at the same time, all accountable or natural facts are proved to be in their ultimate genesis unaccountable and supernatural. And so there arise two antithetical states of mind, answering to the opposite sides of that existence about which we think. While our consciousness of Nature under the one aspect constitutes Science, our consciousness of it under the other aspect constitutes Religion.
The advancement of intelligence has always been twofold. While it may not have seemed that way to those experiencing it, every step forward has led us toward both the natural and the supernatural. A better understanding of each phenomenon has involved, on one hand, discarding a cause that was somewhat understandable in its nature but unknown in how it acted, and on the other hand, embracing a cause that was known in its actions but not easily grasped in its nature. The initial move away from universal fetishism clearly required the idea of agencies that are less relatable to the familiar forces of people and animals, making them less understood; however, these newly conceived agencies, as long as they were characterized by their consistent effects, were better understood than those they replaced. All later advancements show the same dual outcomes. Each deeper and broader power recognized as a cause of phenomena has been less understandable than the specific ones it replaced, in that it’s less clearly representable in thought; while it has been easier to grasp since its actions have been more consistently predictable. Progress, therefore, has been toward the establishment of what is completely unknown as well as towards what is known. Even as knowledge approaches its peak, every unexplainable and seemingly supernatural fact is categorized as explainable or natural; yet, simultaneously, all explainable or natural facts are shown to be ultimately unexplainable and supernatural. This leads to two opposing mindsets reflecting the different aspects of that existence we contemplate. While our understanding of Nature in one way forms Science, our understanding of it in another way forms Religion.
Otherwise contemplating the facts, we may say that Religion and Science have been undergoing a slow differentiation; and that their ceaseless conflicts have been due to the imperfect separation of their spheres and functions. Religion has, from the first, struggled to unite more or less science with its nescience; Science has, from the first, kept hold of more or less nescience as though it were a part of science. Each has been obliged gradually to relinquish that territory which it wrongly claimed, while it has gained from the other that to which it had a right; and the antagonism between them has been an inevitable accompaniment of this process. A more specific statement will make this clear. Religion, though at the outset it asserted a mystery, also made numerous definite 107assertions respecting this mystery—professed to know its nature in the minutest detail; and in so far as it claimed positive knowledge, it trespassed upon the province of Science. From the times of early mythologies, when such intimate acquaintance with the mystery was alleged, down to our own days, when but a few abstract and vague propositions are maintained, Religion has been compelled by Science to give up one after another of its dogmas—of those assumed cognitions which it could not substantiate. In the mean time, Science substituted for the personalities to which Religion ascribed phenomena, certain metaphysical entities; and in doing this it trespassed on the province of Religion; since it classed among the things which it comprehended, certain forms of the incomprehensible. Partly by the criticisms of Religion, which has occasionally called in question its assumptions, and partly as a consequence of spontaneous growth, Science has been obliged to abandon these attempts to include within the boundaries of knowledge that which cannot be known; and has so yielded up to Religion that which of right belonged to it. So long as this process of differentiation is incomplete, more or less of antagonism must continue. Gradually as the limits of possible cognition are established, the causes of conflict will diminish. And a permanent peace will be reached when Science becomes fully convinced that its explanations are proximate and relative; while Religion becomes fully convinced that the mystery it contemplates is ultimate and absolute.
Otherwise contemplating the facts, we might say that Religion and Science have been slowly differentiating from each other; and that their ongoing conflicts have resulted from their imperfect separation of roles and functions. Religion has, from the beginning, struggled to connect science with its unknowns; Science has, from the beginning, held onto those unknowns as if they were part of science. Each has had to gradually let go of the territory it mistakenly claimed while gaining from the other what it was entitled to; and the tension between them has been an unavoidable part of this process. A more specific explanation will clarify this. Religion, while initially asserting a mystery, also made many specific claims about this mystery—it claimed to know its nature in great detail; and as far as it claimed positive knowledge, it overstepped into the realm of Science. From the early mythologies, when such close familiarity with the mystery was claimed, right up to today, when only a few abstract and vague statements are held, Religion has been forced by Science to abandon one dogma after another—those assumed truths it could not back up. Meanwhile, Science replaced the personalities that Religion attributed to phenomena with certain metaphysical entities; and in doing so, it overstepped into the realm of Religion, since it included among the things it understood certain forms of the incomprehensible. Partly due to the critiques from Religion, which has sometimes questioned its assumptions, and partly as a result of natural development, Science has had to give up these attempts to include within the boundaries of knowledge what cannot be known; and has thus yielded to Religion that which rightly belonged to it. As long as this process of differentiation is incomplete, some level of conflict must continue. Gradually, as the limits of possible understanding are established, the reasons for conflict will lessen. A lasting peace will be achieved when Science fully realizes that its explanations are provisional and relative; while Religion fully acknowledges that the mystery it contemplates is ultimate and absolute.
Religion and Science are therefore necessary correlatives. As already hinted, they stand respectively for those two antithetical modes of consciousness which cannot exist asunder. A known cannot be thought of apart from an unknown; nor can an unknown be thought of apart from a known. And by consequence neither can become more distinct without giving greater distinctness to the other. To carry further a metaphor before used,—they are the positive and negative poles of 108thought; of which neither can gain in intensity without increasing the intensity of the other.
Religion and science are therefore two sides of the same coin. As I mentioned before, they represent two opposing ways of understanding that can't exist without each other. You can't think of something known without also considering something unknown; nor can you think of the unknown without having some knowledge to connect it to. As a result, neither can become clearer without making the other clearer as well. To extend a metaphor I've used before—they are like the positive and negative poles of thought; neither can become stronger without boosting the strength of the other. 108
§ 31. Thus the consciousness of an Inscrutable Power manifested to us through all phenomena, has been growing ever clearer; and must eventually be freed from its imperfections. The certainty that on the one hand such a Power exists, while on the other hand its nature transcends intuition and is beyond imagination, is the certainty towards which intelligence has from the first been progressing. To this conclusion Science inevitably arrives as it reaches its confines; while to this conclusion Religion is irresistibly driven by criticism. And satisfying as it does the demands of the most rigorous logic at the same time that it gives the religious sentiment the widest possible sphere of action, it is the conclusion we are bound to accept without reserve or qualification.
§ 31. The awareness of an Unknowable Power revealed to us through all experiences has been becoming clearer over time and must eventually be liberated from its flaws. The certainty that, on one hand, such a Power exists, while on the other hand, its true nature goes beyond what we can intuit or imagine, is the certainty that intelligence has been advancing towards from the beginning. Science inevitably reaches this conclusion as it approaches its limits, while Religion finds itself compelled toward this conclusion through critique. Meeting the demands of strict logic, while also providing the broadest possible space for religious feeling, it is the conclusion we must accept without hesitation or exception.
Some do indeed allege that though the Ultimate Cause of things cannot really be thought of by us as having specified attributes, it is yet incumbent upon us to assert these attributes. Though the forms of our consciousness are such that the Absolute cannot in any manner or degree be brought within them, we are nevertheless told that we must represent the Absolute to ourselves under these forms. As writes Mr Mansel, in the work from which I have already quoted largely—“It is our duty, then, to think of God as personal; and it is our duty to believe that He is infinite.”
Some people claim that while we can't actually think of the Ultimate Cause of things as having specific qualities, we still have to assert those qualities. Even though the way we perceive things means that we can’t fully grasp the Absolute, we're still told that we need to conceptualize the Absolute in those terms. As Mr. Mansel writes in the work I've already quoted from extensively, “It's our duty to think of God as personal; and it’s our duty to believe that He is infinite.”
That this is not the conclusion here adopted, needs hardly be said. If there be any meaning in the foregoing arguments, duty requires us neither to affirm nor deny personality. Our duty is to submit ourselves with all humility to the established limits of our intelligence; and not perversely to rebel against them. Let those who can, believe that there is eternal war set between our intellectual faculties and our moral obligations. I for one, admit no such radical vice in the constitution of things.
That this is not the conclusion adopted here hardly needs saying. If there’s any meaning in the arguments above, our duty requires us neither to confirm nor deny personality. Our responsibility is to humbly accept the established limits of our understanding and not to stubbornly rebel against them. Let those who can believe that there’s an eternal conflict between our intellect and our moral responsibilities. I, for one, see no such fundamental flaw in the way things are.
109This which to most will seem an essentially irreligious position, is an essentially religious one—nay is the religious one, to which, as already shown, all others are but approximations. In the estimate it implies of the Ultimate Cause, it does not fall short of the alternative position, but exceeds it. Those who espouse this alternative position, make the erroneous assumption that the choice is between personality and something lower than personality; whereas the choice is rather between personality and something higher. Is it not just possible that there is a mode of being as much transcending Intelligence and Will, as these transcend mechanical motion? It is true that we are totally unable to conceive any such higher mode of being. But this is not a reason for questioning its existence; it is rather the reverse. Have we not seen how utterly incompetent our minds are to form even an approach to a conception of that which underlies all phenomena? Is it not proved that this incompetency is the incompetency of the Conditioned to grasp the Unconditioned? Does it not follow that the Ultimate Cause cannot in any respect be conceived by us because it is in every respect greater than can be conceived? And may we not therefore rightly refrain from assigning to it any attributes whatever, on the ground that such attributes, derived as they must be from our own natures, are not elevations but degradations? Indeed it seems somewhat strange that men should suppose the highest worship to lie in assimilating the object of their worship to themselves. Not in asserting a transcendant difference, but in asserting a certain likeness, consists the element of their creed which they think essential. It is true that from the time when the rudest savages imagined the causes of all things to be creatures of flesh and blood like themselves, down to our own time, the degree of assumed likeness has been diminishing. But though a bodily form and substance similar to that of man, has long since ceased, among cultivated races, to be a literally-conceived attribute of the Ultimate Cause—though the grosser human desires have been also rejected as unfit elements of the 110conception—though there is some hesitation in ascribing even the higher human feelings, save in greatly idealized shapes; yet it is still thought not only proper, but imperative, to ascribe the most abstract qualities of our nature. To think of the Creative Power as in all respects anthropomorphous, is now considered impious by men who yet hold themselves bound to think of the Creative Power as in some respects anthropomorphous; and who do not see that the one proceeding is but an evanescent form of the other. And then, most marvellous of all, this course is persisted in even by those who contend that we are wholly unable to frame any conception whatever of the Creative Power. After it has been shown that every supposition respecting the genesis of the Universe commits us to alternative impossibilities of thought—after it has been shown that each attempt to conceive real existence ends in an intellectual suicide—after it has been shown why, by the very constitution of our minds, we are eternally debarred from thinking of the Absolute; it is still asserted that we ought to think of the Absolute thus and thus. In all imaginable ways we find thrust upon us the truth, that we are not permitted to know—nay are not even permitted to conceive—that Reality which is behind the veil of Appearance; and yet it is said to be our duty to believe (and in so far to conceive) that this Reality exists in a certain defined manner. Shall we call this reverence? or shall we call it the reverse?
109This perspective may seem irreligious to many, but it’s actually a deeply religious one—indeed, it's the most genuine religious view, to which all others are just approximations. In terms of its understanding of the Ultimate Cause, it doesn’t just match the alternative position; it surpasses it. Those who support the alternative view mistakenly believe that the choice lies between something personal and something lesser than personality; instead, the choice is really between personality and something greater. Isn’t it possible that there exists a mode of being that transcends Intelligence and Will just as much as they transcend mechanical motion? While it’s true that we can’t conceive of such a higher mode of being, that doesn’t mean we should doubt its existence; if anything, it suggests the opposite. Haven’t we seen how completely inadequate our minds are to grasp even a glimpse of what lies beneath all phenomena? Doesn’t it demonstrate that this inadequacy is simply the limitation of the Conditioned trying to understand the Unconditioned? Doesn’t it follow that the Ultimate Cause must be beyond our comprehension because it exceeds what we can imagine? Shouldn’t we then refrain from ascribing any attributes to it, since those attributes can only come from our own nature and are therefore not elevated but degrading? It seems quite odd that people think the highest form of worship is to make the object of their worship resemble themselves. The essence of their belief, which they see as essential, lies not in declaring a transcendent difference but in claiming some likeness. It’s true that since the most primitive savages thought all things were caused by beings like themselves, there has been a gradual decline in the assumed likeness. While a physical form resembling that of humans has long ceased to be a literal attribute of the Ultimate Cause among more advanced cultures—though coarser human desires have also been dismissed as unsuitable elements of this conception—there’s still a strong tendency to ascribe the most abstract qualities of our nature. It’s now considered impious to think of the Creative Power as entirely anthropomorphic, yet many still feel compelled to think of it as somewhat anthropomorphic, failing to see that one view is just a fleeting version of the other. Remarkably, even those who argue that we cannot form any concept of the Creative Power continue to hold this perspective. After we’ve shown that every assumption about the origins of the Universe leads us to conflicting impossibilities of thought—after we’ve demonstrated that every attempt to understand real existence ends in intellectual failure—after we’ve explained why, due to the very nature of our minds, we are forever barred from thinking about the Absolute, it’s still asserted that we should think about the Absolute in specific ways. In every conceivable way, we are confronted with the truth that we cannot know—or even conceive—of the Reality behind the appearances; and yet, we are told it is our duty to believe (and thus to conceive) that this Reality exists in a certain defined manner. Should we call this reverence? Or should we call it the opposite? 110
Volumes might be written upon the impiety of the pious. Through the printed and spoken thoughts of religious teachers, may almost everywhere be traced a professed familiarity with the ultimate mystery of things, which, to say the least of it, seems anything but congruous with the accompanying expressions of humility. And surprisingly enough, those tenets which most clearly display this familiarity, are those insisted upon as forming the vital elements of religious belief. The attitude thus assumed, can be fitly represented only by further developing a simile long current in theological controversies—the simile of the watch. If for a moment we made the grotesque 111supposition that the tickings and other movements of a watch constituted a kind of consciousness; and that a watch possessed of such a consciousness, insisted on regarding the watchmaker’s actions as determined like its own by springs and escapements; we should simply complete a parallel of which religious teachers think much. And were we to suppose that a watch not only formulated the cause of its existence in these mechanical terms, but held that watches were bound out of reverence so to formulate this cause, and even vituperated, as atheistic watches, any that did not venture so to formulate it; we should merely illustrate the presumption of theologians by carrying their own argument a step further. A few extracts will bring home to the reader the justice of this comparison. We are told, for example, by one of high repute among religious thinkers, that the Universe is “the manifestation and abode of a Free Mind, like our own; embodying His personal thought in its adjustments, realizing His own ideal in its phenomena, just as we express own inner faculty and character through the natural language of an external life. In this view, we interpret Nature by Humanity; we find the key to her aspects in such purposes and affections as our own consciousness enables us to conceive; we look everywhere for physical signals of an ever-living Will; and decipher the universe as the autobiography of an Infinite Spirit, repeating itself in miniature within our Finite Spirit.” The same writer goes still further. He not only thus parallels the assimilation of the watchmaker to the watch,—he not only thinks the created can “decipher” “the autobiography” of the Creating; but he asserts that the necessary limits of the one are necessary limits of the other. The primary qualities of bodies, he says, “belong eternally to the material datum objective to God” and control his acts; while the secondary ones are “products of pure Inventive Reason and Determining Will”—constitute “the realm of Divine originality.” * * * “While on this Secondary field His Mind and ours are thus contrasted, they meet in resemblance again upon the Primary: 112for the evolutions of deductive Reason there is but one track possible to all intelligences; no merum arbitrium can interchange the false and true, or make more than one geometry, one scheme of pure Physics, for all worlds; and the Omnipotent Architect Himself, in realizing the Kosmical conception, in shaping the orbits out of immensity and determining seasons out of eternity, could but follow the laws of curvature, measure and proportion.” That is to say, the Ultimate Cause is like a human mechanic, not only as “shaping” the “material datum objective to” Him, but also as being obliged to conform to the necessary properties of that “datum.” Nor is this all. There follows some account of “the Divine psychology,” to the extent of saying that “we learn” “the character of God—the order of affections in Him” from “the distribution of authority in the hierarchy of our impulses.” In other words, it is alleged that the Ultimate Cause has desires that are to be classed as higher and lower like our own.[7] Every one has heard of the king who wished he had been present at the creation of the world, that he might have given good advice. He was humble however compared with those who profess to understand not only the relation of the Creating to the created, but also how the Creating is constituted. And yet this transcendant audacity, which claims to penetrate the secrets of the Power manifested to us through all existence—nay even to stand behind that Power and note the conditions to its action—this it is which passes current as piety! May we not without hesitation affirm that a sincere recognition of the truth that our own and all other existence is a mystery absolutely and for ever beyond our comprehension, contains more of true religion than all the dogmatic theology ever written?
Volumes could be written about the irreverence of the devout. In the printed and spoken teachings of religious leaders, we can often see a claimed familiarity with the ultimate mysteries of life that, at the very least, seems completely out of sync with their expressions of humility. Surprisingly, the beliefs that most clearly show this familiarity are those insisted upon as essential components of faith. This attitude can only be aptly illustrated by further expanding on a long-standing analogy used in theological debates—the analogy of the watch. If we momentarily entertain the absurd idea that the ticking and other movements of a watch create a type of consciousness and that a watch with such awareness views its creator’s actions as dictated by mechanisms like its own, we would simply be completing a parallel that religious leaders reflect on often. If we were to assume that a watch not only explained its existence in these mechanical terms but also believed that other watches should reverently do the same and even criticized those that didn’t as atheistic watches, we’d just be highlighting the presumption of theologians by taking their argument a step further. A few quotes will help the reader grasp the validity of this analogy. For instance, we are informed by a well-respected religious thinker that the Universe is “the manifestation and abode of a Free Mind, like ours; embodying His personal thought in its adjustments, realizing His own ideal in its phenomena, much like we express our inner ability and character through the natural language of an external life. In this perspective, we interpret Nature through Humanity; we find the key to her aspects in such intentions and feelings that our own consciousness allows us to imagine; we search everywhere for physical signs of a living Will; and interpret the universe as the autobiography of an Infinite Spirit, reflecting itself in miniature within our Finite Spirit.” The same author goes even further. He not only parallels the maker with the creation—he believes that the created can “decipher” “the autobiography” of the Creator; but he also claims that the necessary limits of one reflect the necessary limits of the other. He states that the primary qualities of matter “eternally belong to the material data objective to God” and govern His actions; while the secondary qualities are “products of pure Inventive Reason and Determining Will”—constituting “the realm of Divine originality.” “While in this Secondary realm, His Mind and ours are contrasted, they meet again in similarity upon the Primary: for the developments of deductive Reason can only follow one path available to all intelligences; no *merum arbitrium* can mix up false and true, or create more than one geometry, one principle of pure Physics for all worlds; and the Omnipotent Creator Himself, in realizing the cosmic vision, in shaping the orbits from infinity and determining seasons from eternity, had no choice but to follow the laws of curvature, measure, and proportion.” In other words, the Ultimate Cause resembles a human mechanic, not only in “shaping” the “material data objective to” Him, but also in being required to conform to the necessary properties of that “data.” Moreover, there is a description of “the Divine psychology,” suggesting that “we learn” “the character of God—the order of feelings in Him” from “the distribution of authority in the hierarchy of our impulses.” In other words, it is suggested that the Ultimate Cause has desires that can be classified as higher and lower, similar to our own. Everyone has heard of the king who wished he could have been present at the creation of the world so he could’ve given some good advice. He was humble, however, compared to those who claim to understand not only the connection between the Creator and the created but also how the Creator is constituted. Yet, this transcendent boldness, which insists on delving into the secrets of the Power made evident to us through all existence—indeed, even claiming to stand behind that Power and note the conditions of its operation—this is what is regarded as piety! Can we not confidently affirm that a genuine acknowledgment of the truth that our own and all other existence is a mystery completely and forever beyond our understanding contains more true religion than all the dogmatic theology ever penned?
Meanwhile let us recognize whatever of permanent good there is in these persistent attempts to frame conceptions of that which cannot be conceived. From the beginning it has 113been only through the successive failures of such conceptions to satisfy the mind, that higher and higher ones have been gradually reached; and doubtless, the conceptions now current are indispensable as transitional modes of thought. Even more than this may be willingly conceded. It is possible, nay probable, that under their most abstract forms, ideas of this order will always continue to occupy the background of our consciousness. Very likely there will ever remain a need to give shape to that indefinite sense of an Ultimate Existence, which forms the basis of our intelligence. We shall always be under the necessity of contemplating it as some mode of being; that is—of representing it to ourselves in some form of thought, however vague. And we shall not err in doing this so long as we treat every notion we thus frame as merely a symbol, utterly without resemblance to that for which it stands. Perhaps the constant formation of such symbols and constant rejection of them as inadequate, may be hereafter, as it has hitherto been, a means of discipline. Perpetually to construct ideas requiring the utmost stretch of our faculties, and perpetually to find that such ideas must be abandoned as futile imaginations, may realize to us more fully than any other course, the greatness of that which we vainly strive to grasp. Such efforts and failures may serve to maintain in our minds a due sense of the incommensurable difference between the Conditioned and the Unconditioned. By continually seeking to know and being continually thrown back with a deepened conviction of the impossibility of knowing, we may keep alive the consciousness that it is alike our highest wisdom and our highest duty to regard that through which all things exist as The Unknowable.
Meanwhile, let’s acknowledge any lasting value in these ongoing efforts to define what can’t be fully understood. From the start, it has only been through the repeated failures of these definitions to satisfy us that we’ve gradually reached higher and better ones; and surely, the ideas we have now are crucial as steps along the way. We can even go so far as to agree that it's likely these abstract ideas will always linger in the background of our minds. There will probably always be a need to give form to that vague sense of an Ultimate Existence that underlies our understanding. We’ll always feel compelled to think of it as some kind of existence; that is, to represent it to ourselves in some way of thinking, no matter how unclear. We won’t be wrong in doing this as long as we treat every idea we create as just a symbol, completely different from what it represents. Perhaps the ongoing creation of such symbols, followed by their rejection as insufficient, will continue to be a way of growth, just as it has been in the past. Constantly creating ideas that stretch our thinking to the limit, only to find that we have to discard them as empty fantasies, may help us understand more fully than anything else the vastness of what we’re trying to grasp. These efforts and setbacks may help keep in our minds a proper sense of the immense difference between the Conditioned and the Unconditioned. By continually trying to understand and being repeatedly faced with the deep realization of our limits, we may sustain the awareness that it is both our greatest wisdom and our highest responsibility to regard that through which all things exist as The Unknowable.
§ 32. An immense majority will refuse with more or less of indignation, a belief seeming to them so shadowy and indefinite. Having always embodied the Ultimate Cause so far as was needful to its mental realization, they must necessarily resent the substitution of an Ultimate Cause which cannot be mentally 114realized at all. “You offer us,” they say, “an unthinkable abstraction in place of a Being towards whom we may entertain definite feelings. Though we are told that the Absolute is real, yet since we are not allowed to conceive it, it might as well be a pure negation. Instead of a Power which we can regard as having some sympathy with us, you would have us contemplate a Power to which no emotion whatever can be ascribed. And so we are to be deprived of the very substance of our faith.”
§ 32. An overwhelming majority will reject, with varying degrees of anger, a belief that seems so vague and unclear. Having always understood the Ultimate Cause in a way that was necessary for them to mentally grasp it, they will inevitably resist the idea of an Ultimate Cause that cannot be fully understood. “You’re offering us,” they say, “an impossible abstraction instead of a Being we can have real feelings for. Even though we’re told that the Absolute is real, since we can’t truly conceive of it, it might as well be nothing at all. Instead of a Power that we can see as having some connection to us, you want us to consider a Power to which we can’t assign any emotions at all. And so, we’re supposed to be stripped of the very core of our faith.”
This kind of protest of necessity accompanies every change from a lower creed to a higher. The belief in a community of nature between himself and the object of his worship, has always been to man a satisfactory one; and he has always accepted with reluctance those successively less concrete conceptions which have been forced upon him. Doubtless, in all times and places, it has consoled the barbarian to think of his deities as so exactly like himself in nature, that they could be bribed by offerings of food; and the assurance that deities could not be so propitiated, must have been repugnant, because it deprived him of an easy method of gaining supernatural protection. To the Greeks it was manifestly a source of comfort that on occasions of difficulty they could obtain, through oracles, the advice of their gods,—nay, might even get the personal aid of their gods in battle; and it was probably a very genuine anger which they visited upon philosophers who called in question these gross ideas of their mythology. A religion which teaches the Hindoo that it is impossible to purchase eternal happiness by placing himself under the wheel of Juggernaut, can scarcely fail to seem a cruel one to him; since it deprives him of the pleasurable consciousness that he can at will exchange miseries for joys. Nor is it less clear that to our Catholic ancestors, the beliefs that crimes could be compounded for by the building of churches, that their own punishments and those of their relatives could be abridged by the saying of masses, and that divine aid or forgiveness might be gained through the intercession 115of saints, were highly solacing ones; and that Protestantism, in substituting the conception of a God so comparatively unlike ourselves as not to be influenced by such methods, must have appeared to them hard and cold. Naturally, therefore, we must expect a further step in the same direction to meet with a similar resistance from outraged sentiments. No mental revolution can be accomplished without more or less of laceration. Be it a change of habit or a change of conviction, it must, if the habit or conviction be strong, do violence to some of the feelings; and these must of course oppose it. For long-experienced, and therefore definite, sources of satisfaction, have to be substituted sources of satisfaction that have not been experienced, and are therefore indefinite. That which is relatively well known and real, has to be given up for that which is relatively unknown and ideal. And of course such an exchange cannot be made without a conflict involving pain. Especially then must there arise a strong antagonism to any alteration in so deep and vital a conception as that with which we are here dealing. Underlying, as this conception does, all others, a modification of it threatens to reduce the superstructure to ruins. Or to change the metaphor—being the root with which are connected our ideas of goodness, rectitude, or duty, it appears impossible that it should be transformed without causing these to wither away and die. The whole higher part of the nature almost of necessity takes up arms against a change which, by destroying the established associations of thought, seems to eradicate morality.
This kind of protest naturally comes with every transition from a lower belief system to a higher one. The idea of a shared nature between oneself and the object of worship has always been comforting to humans, and they've always been hesitant to accept the progressively abstract concepts that have been imposed on them. Throughout history, it’s been reassuring for people to picture their gods as so much like themselves that they could be appeased with food offerings; the notion that these gods couldn't be swayed in such a way would have been upsetting because it took away a simple way to gain supernatural protection. For the Greeks, it was comforting that in tough times they could consult oracles for their gods' advice—indeed, they might even receive their gods' assistance in battle. It’s likely that they felt genuine anger towards philosophers who challenged these straightforward beliefs about their mythology. A religion that tells Hindus they cannot buy eternal happiness by placing themselves under the wheel of Juggernaut must seem harsh to them, as it takes away the satisfying thought that they can trade their suffering for joy at will. Similarly, it's evident that for our Catholic ancestors, beliefs like being able to offset sins by building churches, easing their own or their relatives' punishments by saying masses, and gaining divine help or forgiveness through saints’ intercession were deeply reassuring. Protestantism, by presenting a God who is so different from ourselves that He can't be influenced by such actions, must have seemed harsh and unwelcoming to them. So, it’s reasonable to expect that any further shift in the same direction would encounter similar backlash from deeply held feelings. Any significant mental shift involves some painful disruption. Whether it's a change in habits or beliefs, if these habits or beliefs are strong, they will clash with some feelings, which will naturally resist. Long-established sources of satisfaction need to be replaced with new, untested sources, which feel uncertain. The familiar and tangible must be abandoned for what is unknown and ideal. This kind of swap can't happen without conflict and pain. Especially with a fundamental and vital belief like the one we're discussing, resistance is bound to be strong. Since this belief underpins all others, altering it threatens to bring everything else crashing down. Or, to put it another way—acting as the root of our ideas about goodness, morality, or duty, it seems impossible for it to be changed without those ideas withering away and dying. The entire higher part of our nature is likely to fight back against a change that seems to erase these established ways of thinking about morality.
This is by no means all that has to be said for such protests. There is a much deeper meaning in them. They do not simply express the natural repugnance to a revolution of belief, here made specially intense by the vital importance of the belief to be revolutionized; but they also express an instinctive adhesion to a belief that is in one sense the best—the best for those who thus cling to it, though not abstractedly 116the best. For here let me remark that what were above spoken of as the imperfections of Religion, at first great but gradually diminishing, have been imperfections only as measured by an absolute standard; and not as measured by a relative one. Speaking generally, the religion current in each age and among each people, has been as near an approximation to the truth as it was then and there possible for men to receive: the more or less concrete forms in which it has embodied the truth, have simply been the means of making thinkable what would otherwise have been unthinkable; and so have for the time being served to increase its impressiveness. If we consider the conditions of the case, we shall find this to be an unavoidable conclusion. During each stage of evolution, men must think in such terms of thought as they possess. While all the conspicuous changes of which they can observe the origins, have men and animals as antecedents, they are unable to think of antecedents in general under any other shapes; and hence creative agencies are of necessity conceived by them in these shapes. If during this phase, these concrete conceptions were taken from them, and the attempt made to give them comparatively abstract conceptions, the result would be to leave their minds with none at all; since the substituted ones could not be mentally represented. Similarly with every successive stage of religious belief, down to the last. Though, as accumulating experiences slowly modify the earliest ideas of causal personalities, there grow up more general and vague ideas of them; yet these cannot be at once replaced by others still more general and vague. Further experiences must supply the needful further abstractions, before the mental void left by the destruction of such inferior ideas can be filled by ideas of a superior order. And at the present time, the refusal to abandon a relatively concrete notion for a relatively abstract one, implies the inability to frame the relatively abstract one; and so proves that the change would be premature and injurious. Still 117more clearly shall we see the injuriousness of any such premature change, on observing that the effects of a belief upon conduct must be diminished in proportion as the vividness with which it is realized becomes less. Evils and benefits akin to those which the savage has personally felt, or learned from those who have felt them, are the only evils and benefits he can understand; and these must be looked for as coming in ways, like those of which he has had experience. His deities must be imagined to have like motives and passions and methods with the beings around him; for motives and passions and methods of a higher character, being unknown to him, and in great measure unthinkable by him, cannot be so realized in thought as to influence his deeds. During every phase of civilization, the actions of the Unseen Reality, as well as the resulting rewards and punishments, being conceivable only in such forms as experience furnishes, to supplant them by higher ones before wider experiences have made higher ones conceivable, is to set up vague and uninfluential motives for definite and influential ones. Even now, for the great mass of men, unable through lack of culture to trace out with due clearness those good and bad consequences which conduct brings round through the established order of the Unknowable, it is needful that there should be vividly depicted future torments and future joys—pains and pleasures of a definite kind, produced in a manner direct and simple enough to be clearly imagined. Nay still more must be conceded. Few if any are as yet fitted wholly to dispense with such conceptions as are current. The highest abstractions take so great a mental power to realize with any vividness, and are so inoperative upon conduct unless they are vividly realized, that their regulative effects must for a long period to come be appreciable on but a small minority. To see clearly how a right or wrong act generates consequences, internal and external, that go on branching out more widely as years progress, requires a rare power of analysis. To mentally represent even a single series 118of these consequences, as it stretches out into the remote future, requires an equally rare power of imagination. And to estimate these consequences in their totality, ever multiplying in number while diminishing in intensity, requires a grasp of thought possessed by none. Yet it is only by such analysis, such imagination, and such grasp, that conduct can be rightly guided in the absence of all other control: only so can ultimate rewards and penalties be made to outweigh proximate pains and pleasures. Indeed, were it not that throughout the progress of the race, men’s experiences of the effects of conduct have been slowly generalized into principles—were it not that these principles have been from generation to generation insisted on by parents, upheld by public opinion, sanctified by religion, and enforced by threats of eternal damnation for disobedience—were it not that under these potent influences, habits have been modified, and the feelings proper to them made innate—were it not, in short, that we have been rendered in a considerable degree organically moral; it is certain that disastrous results would ensue from the removal of those strong and distinct motives which the current belief supplies. Even as it is, those who relinquish the faith in which they have been brought up, for this most abstract faith in which Science and Religion unite, may not uncommonly fail to act up to their convictions. Left to their organic morality, enforced only by general reasonings imperfectly wrought out and difficult to keep before the mind, their defects of nature will often come out more strongly than they would have done under their previous creed. The substituted creed can become adequately operative only when it becomes, like the present one, an element in early education, and has the support of a strong social sanction. Nor will men be quite ready for it until, through the continuance of a discipline which has already partially moulded them to the conditions of social existence, they are completely moulded to those conditions.
This is far from everything that needs to be said about such protests. They hold a much deeper meaning. They do not just reflect the natural aversion to a shift in belief, which is made especially intense by the crucial importance of the belief being challenged; they also show an instinctive attachment to a belief that, in one sense, is the best—the best for those who cling to it, though not necessarily the best in an abstract sense. For here, let me point out that what was previously described as the flaws of Religion—initially significant but gradually decreasing—have been flaws only when measured by an absolute standard and not by a relative one. Generally speaking, the religion relevant to each era and each culture has been as close an approximation to the truth as was possible for people at that time and place: the various concrete forms in which it has expressed the truth have simply served to make thinkable what would otherwise be unimaginable; thus, they have temporarily increased its impact. If we examine the situation, we will find that this is an unavoidable conclusion. During each stage of evolution, people must think in terms of the ideas they possess. As long as all the noticeable changes they can observe have humans and animals as their origins, they cannot conceptualize ancestors in any other forms; therefore, creative forces have necessarily to be conceived in these forms. If, during this phase, these concrete concepts were taken away and attempts made to give them more abstract notions, the result would leave their minds with nothing at all; since the substituted concepts could not be represented mentally. This holds true for every successive stage of religious belief, down to the last. Although, as accumulated experiences slowly alter the initial ideas of causal agents, broader and vaguer ideas of them develop; these cannot be immediately replaced by ideas that are even more general and vague. Further experiences must provide the necessary additional abstractions before the mental void left by eliminating such simpler ideas can be filled with superior concepts. And right now, the refusal to let go of a relatively concrete idea for a more abstract one indicates the inability to formulate the more abstract concept; confirming that the shift would be premature and harmful. Even more clearly, we can see how harmful any such premature change would be by noting that the impact of a belief on behavior must decrease as the clarity with which it is understood diminishes. Only the evils and benefits similar to those a primitive person has experienced or learned about from others who have experienced them are the only evils and benefits they can comprehend; and these must be anticipated in ways akin to what they have personally encountered. Their deities must be imagined to have similar motives, emotions, and methods as the beings around them; because motives, emotions, and methods of a higher nature—being unfamiliar and largely unimaginable to them—cannot be grasped in thought to influence their actions. Throughout every phase of civilization, the actions of the Unseen Reality, as well as the resulting rewards and punishments, can only be conceived in the forms that experience supplies. To replace them with higher notions before broader experiences allow for the understanding of these higher concepts is to create vague and uninfluential motives to substitute clear and impactful ones. Even today, for the vast majority of people, who, due to a lack of education, cannot clearly identify the good and bad outcomes that behavior brings about through the established order of the Unknowable, it is still essential to vividly depict future suffering and future joy—pain and pleasure of a specific nature, produced in a way that is direct and simple enough to be clearly envisioned. Moreover, it must be acknowledged that few, if any, are currently capable of completely doing away with the prevailing concepts. The highest abstractions require immense mental effort to realize vividly, and their impact on behavior must be appreciable for only a small minority for a long time to come. Understanding how a right or wrong action generates consequences, both internal and external, that continue to ripple out further as time goes on requires an exceptional analytical ability. To mentally visualize even a single chain of these consequences stretching far into the future demands an equally rare imaginative capacity. And to gauge these consequences in their totality—constantly multiplying in number while diminishing in intensity—requires a thought process that no one possesses. Yet, it is only through such analysis, such imagination, and such comprehension that behavior can be appropriately guided in the absence of other controls; only then can ultimate rewards and punishments outweigh immediate pains and pleasures. In fact, if it weren't for the fact that throughout the progress of humanity people’s experiences regarding the results of their actions have gradually been generalized into principles—if these principles had not been emphasized from generation to generation by parents, upheld by public opinion, sanctified by religion, and enforced through threats of eternal damnation for disobedience—if it weren't for the powerful influences of these practices, where habits have been changed and the associated feelings have become innate—essentially, if we had not been to a significant degree inherently moral, there would definitely be disastrous consequences from removing the strong and distinct motivations that current beliefs provide. As it stands, those who abandon the faith in which they were raised for this most abstract belief, where Science and Religion converge, may frequently struggle to live up to their convictions. Left only to their inherent morality, supported only by general reasonings that are incompletely formulated and hard to keep in mind, their natural deficits might emerge more strongly than they would have under their previous beliefs. The new belief can only be fully effective when it becomes, like the current one, a fundamental part of early education and is backed by strong social validation. Men won't be ready for it until, through continued discipline that has already partially shaped them to fit social conditions, they become fully aligned with those conditions.
We must therefore recognize the resistance to a change of 119theological opinion, as in great measure salutary. It is not simply that strong and deep-rooted feelings are necessarily excited to antagonism—it is not simply that the highest moral sentiments join in the condemnation of a change which seems to undermine their authority; but it is that a real adaptation exists between an established belief and the natures of those who defend it; and that the tenacity of the defence measures the completeness of the adaptation. Forms of religion, like forms of government, must be fit for those who live under them; and in the one case as in the other, that form which is fittest is that for which there is an instinctive preference. As certainly as a barbarous race needs a harsh terrestrial rule, and habitually shows attachment to a despotism capable of the necessary rigour; so certainly does such a race need a belief in a celestial rule that is similarly harsh, and habitually shows attachment to such a belief. And just in the same way that the sudden substitution of free institutions for tyrannical ones, is sure to be followed by a reaction; so, if a creed full of dreadful ideal penalties is all at once replaced by one presenting ideal penalties that are comparatively gentle, there will inevitably be a return to some modification of the old belief. The parallelism holds yet further. During those early stages in which there is an extreme incongruity between the relatively best and the absolutely best, both political and religious changes, when at rare intervals they occur, are necessarily violent; and necessarily entail violent retrogressions. But as the incongruity between that which is and that which should be, diminishes, the changes become more moderate, and are succeeded by more moderate retrogressions; until, as these movements and counter-movements decrease in amount and increase in frequency, they merge into an almost continuous growth. That adhesion to old institutions and beliefs, which, in primitive societies, opposes an iron barrier to any advance, and which, after the barrier has been at length burst through, brings back the institutions and beliefs from that too-forward position to which the momentum of change had carried them, and so helps to 120re-adapt social conditions to the popular character—this adhesion to old institution and beliefs, eventually becomes the constant check by which the constant advance is prevented from being too rapid. This holds true of religious creeds and forms, as of civil ones. And so we learn that theological conservatism, like political conservatism, has an all-important function.
We must therefore acknowledge the resistance to changing theological beliefs as largely beneficial. It's not just that strong, deeply-rooted feelings create opposition; it's not solely that profound moral sentiments unite against a change that seems to threaten their authority. It's that there’s a genuine connection between established beliefs and the people who uphold them, and the strength of this defense measures how well those beliefs fit. Just like forms of religion, forms of government must suit the people living under them; in either case, the most suitable form is the one that people instinctively prefer. Just as a primitive society requires a harsh earthly governance and typically has an attachment to a strong leader who enforces necessary strictness, such a society also needs a belief in a similarly stern divine authority and often shows loyalty to that belief. Similarly, when oppressive systems are suddenly replaced with free institutions, a backlash is certain to occur; likewise, if a belief in severe spiritual consequences is abruptly swapped for one that suggests milder consequences, there will inevitably be a return to some version of the old belief. This parallel holds even further. In the early stages where there’s a significant mismatch between what is relatively best and what is absolutely best, both political and religious changes, when they do happen, are often violent and lead to violent backslides. But as the gap between reality and what should be narrows, changes become more moderate, and the subsequent backslides are milder; until, as these shifts and counter-shifts decrease in intensity and increase in frequency, they blend into an almost ongoing development. The adherence to old institutions and beliefs, which in early societies stands as a solid barrier to progress, and which, once that barrier is finally broken, pulls back institutions and beliefs from the overly ambitious stance the momentum of change has pushed them to, helps to realign social conditions with the character of the people. This attachment to old institutions and beliefs eventually acts as a continuous check that prevents progress from moving too quickly. This applies to both religious doctrines and civil systems. Thus, we recognize that theological conservatism, like political conservatism, plays a crucial role.
§ 33. That spirit of toleration which is so marked a characteristic of modern times, and is daily growing more conspicuous, has thus a far deeper meaning than is supposed. What we commonly regard simply as a due respect for the right of private judgment, is really a necessary condition to the balancing of the progressive and conservative tendencies—is a means of maintaining the adaptation between men’s beliefs and their natures. It is therefore a spirit to be fostered; and it is a spirit which the catholic thinker, who perceives the functions of these various conflicting creeds, should above all other men display. Doubtless whoever feels the greatness of the error to which his fellows cling and the greatness of the truth which they reject, will find it hard to show a due patience. It is hard for him to listen calmly to the futile arguments used in support of irrational doctrines, and to the misrepresentation of antagonist doctrines. It is hard for him to bear the manifestation of that pride of ignorance which so far exceeds the pride of science. Naturally enough such a one will be indignant when charged with irreligion because he declines to accept the carpenter-theory of creation as the most worthy one. He may think it needless as it is difficult, to conceal his repugnance to a creed which tacitly ascribes to The Unknowable a love of adulation such as would be despised in a human being. Convinced as he is that all punishment, as we see it wrought out in the order of nature, is but a disguised beneficence, there will perhaps escape from him an angry condemnation of the belief that punishment is a divine vengeance, and that divine vengeance is eternal. He may be tempted to show his contempt when he is told that actions instigated by 121an unselfish sympathy or by a pure love of rectitude, are intrinsically sinful; and that conduct is truly good only when it is due to a faith whose openly-professed motive is other-worldliness. But he must restrain such feelings. Though he may be unable to do this during the excitement of controversy, or when otherwise brought face to face with current superstitions, he must yet qualify his antagonism in calmer moments; so that his mature judgment and resulting conduct may be without bias.
§ 33. The spirit of tolerance that stands out so clearly in modern times and is becoming increasingly noticeable holds a much deeper significance than most people realize. What we often see as mere respect for individual judgment is actually an essential factor in balancing progressive and conservative views—it's a way to ensure that people's beliefs align with their nature. Therefore, this spirit should be encouraged; it is especially important for a thoughtful individual who understands the functions of these conflicting beliefs to embody it more than anyone else. Certainly, anyone aware of the seriousness of the error their peers cling to and the significance of the truth they dismiss will find it challenging to remain patient. It’s tough for them to calmly listen to the pointless arguments used to defend irrational beliefs and the misrepresentation of opposing views. It’s hard for them to tolerate the display of ignorance that often surpasses scientific pride. Naturally, they will feel angry when accused of irreligion for rejecting the simplistic theory of creation. They may find it unnecessary, as well as difficult, to hide their disdain for a belief system that implicitly suggests The Unknowable craves praise, which would be looked down upon in a human. Convinced that all punishment, as observed in the natural order, is just a veiled form of benevolence, they might express strong disapproval of the belief that punishment is a form of divine retribution, and that this divine wrath is everlasting. They might feel tempted to show their disdain when told that actions motivated by selfless compassion or a genuine love for goodness are inherently sinful and that true moral conduct is only valid when stemming from a faith whose openly stated intention is other-worldliness. However, they must control such emotions. While they may struggle to do this during heated debates or when confronted with prevalent superstitions, they should strive to temper their opposition in calmer moments, ensuring that their final judgments and actions remain unbiased.
To this end let him ever bear in mind three cardinal facts—two of them already dwelt upon, and one still to be pointed out. The first is that with which we set out; namely the existence of a fundamental verity under all forms of religion, however degraded. In each of them there is a soul of truth. Through the gross body of dogmas traditions and rites which contain it, it is always visible—dimly or clearly as the case may be. This it is which gives vitality even to the rudest creed; this it is which survives every modification; and this it is which we must not forget when condemning the forms under which it is presented. The second of these cardinal facts, set forth at length in the foregoing section, is, that while those concrete elements in which each creed embodies this soul of truth, are bad as measured by an absolute standard, they are good as measured by a relative standard. Though from higher perceptions they hide the abstract verity within them; yet to lower perceptions they render this verity more appreciable than it would otherwise be. They serve to make real and influential over men, that which would else be unreal and uninfluential. Or we may call them the protective envelopes, without which the contained truth would die. The remaining cardinal fact is, that these various beliefs are parts of the constituted order of things; and not accidental but necessary parts. Seeing how one or other of them is everywhere present; is of perennial growth; and when cut down, redevelops in a form but slightly modified; we 122cannot avoid the inference that they are needful accompaniments of human life, severally fitted to the societies in which they are indigenous. From the highest point of view, we must recognize them as elements in that great evolution of which the beginning and end are beyond our knowledge or conception—as modes of manifestation of The Unknowable; and as having this for their warrant.
To this end, always remember three key facts—two we've already discussed, and one more that still needs to be highlighted. The first is the fundamental truth underlying all religions, no matter how distorted they may be. Each of them contains a core of truth. It's always visible, whether dimly or clearly, through the dense layers of dogmas, traditions, and rites surrounding it. This truth is what gives life even to the most primitive belief systems; it survives every change; and we must keep this in mind when we criticize the ways it is expressed. The second key fact, explained in detail in the previous section, is that while the concrete aspects of each belief system may be flawed when judged by an absolute standard, they hold value when assessed by a relative standard. Even though they obscure the abstract truth from higher perspectives, they make that truth more understandable for those at lower levels of perception. They help bring to life and give influence to concepts that might otherwise seem irrelevant and powerless. We can also think of them as protective layers, without which the truth contained would perish. The last key fact is that these various beliefs are essential components of the established order of things; they aren't random but necessary parts. Given that one or another is always present, constantly evolving, and capable of re-emerging in slightly altered forms when suppressed, we can't help but conclude that they are essential elements of human life, each suited to the societies in which they originate. From the highest perspective, we must recognize them as parts of the grand evolution whose beginning and end are beyond our understanding; as forms of expression of The Unknowable, supported by this fundamental reality.
Our toleration therefore should be the widest possible. Or rather, we should aim at something beyond toleration, as commonly understood. In dealing with alien beliefs, our endeavour must be, not simply to refrain from injustice of word or deed; but also to do justice by an open recognition of positive worth. We must qualify our disagreement with as much as may be of sympathy.
Our tolerance should be as broad as it can be. In fact, we should strive for something more than just tolerance as it’s usually defined. When engaging with different beliefs, we shouldn’t just avoid being unjust in our words or actions; we should also acknowledge and appreciate their positive value. We need to temper our disagreements with as much sympathy as possible.
§ 34. These admissions will perhaps be held to imply, that the current theology should be passively accepted; or, at any rate, should not be actively opposed. “Why,” it may be asked, “if all creeds have an average fitness to their times and places, should we not rest content with that to which we are born? If the established belief contains an essential truth—if the forms under which it presents this truth, though intrinsically bad, are extrinsically good—if the abolition of these forms would be at present detrimental to the great majority—nay, if there are scarcely any to whom the ultimate and most abstract belief can furnish an adequate rule of life; surely it is wrong, for the present at least, to propagate this ultimate and most abstract belief.”
§ 34. These admissions might suggest that we should just accept the current theology as it is or, at the very least, not actively fight against it. “Why,” one might ask, “if every belief system is suited to its own time and place, shouldn't we be satisfied with what we have grown up with? If the established belief holds a fundamental truth—if the way it conveys this truth is inherently flawed but serves a purpose on the outside—if getting rid of these beliefs would harm most people—indeed, if there are very few who could use the ultimate and most abstract belief as a guideline for living; shouldn't we consider it wrong, at least for now, to spread this ultimate and most abstract belief?”
The reply is, that though existing religious ideas and institutions have an average adaptation to the characters of the people who live under them; yet, as these characters are ever changing, the adaptation is ever becoming imperfect; and the ideas and institutions need remodelling with a frequency proportionate to the rapidity of the change. Hence, while it is requisite that free play should be given to conservative thought and action, progressive thought and action must also have free 123play. Without the agency of both, there cannot be those continual re-adaptations which orderly progress demands.
The response is that while current religious beliefs and organizations generally fit the characteristics of the people they serve, these characteristics are constantly changing, making the fit less effective over time. Consequently, the beliefs and organizations need to be updated as frequently as the pace of change occurs. Therefore, while it's important to allow space for conservative ideas and actions, progressive ideas and actions also need to have room to thrive. Without the involvement of both, there can't be the ongoing adjustments that orderly progress requires. 123
Whoever hesitates to utter that which he thinks the highest truth, lest it should be too much in advance of the time, may reassure himself by looking at his acts from an impersonal point of view. Let him duly realize the fact that opinion is the agency through which character adapts external arrangements to itself—that his opinion rightly forms part of this agency—is a unit of force, constituting, with other such units, the general power which works out social changes; and he will perceive that he may properly give full utterance to his innermost conviction: leaving it to produce what effect it may. It is not for nothing that he has in him these sympathies with some principles and repugnance to others. He, with all his capacities, and aspirations, and beliefs, is not an accident, but a product of the time. He must remember that while he is a descendant of the past, he is a parent of the future; and that his thoughts are as children born to him, which he may not carelessly let die. He, like every other man, may properly consider himself as one of the myriad agencies through whom works the Unknown Cause; and when the Unknown Cause produces in him a certain belief, he is thereby authorized to profess and act out that belief. For, to render in their highest sense the words of the poet—
Whoever hesitates to speak what he believes to be the highest truth, fearing it may be too ahead of its time, can find reassurance by viewing his actions from a broader perspective. He should recognize that public opinion is the force that adapts external circumstances to individual character—and that his opinion is an important part of this force—a single unit of energy contributing, along with other units, to the collective power that drives social change. He will see that he can truly express his deepest convictions and allow them to make whatever impact they can. It’s no coincidence that he feels a connection to some principles and a rejection of others. He, with all his abilities, ambitions, and beliefs, is not a random occurrence; he is shaped by his time. He must keep in mind that while he inherits from the past, he also gives rise to the future; his thoughts are like children he has brought into the world, and he should not neglect them. Like everyone else, he can view himself as one of the countless forces through which the Unknown Cause operates; when the Unknown Cause instills a certain belief in him, he is justified in expressing and acting on that belief. To truly capture the essence of the poet’s words—
Not as adventitious therefore will the wise man regard the faith which is in him. The highest truth he sees he will fearlessly utter; knowing that, let what may come of it, he is thus playing his right part in the world—knowing that if he can effect the change he aims at—well: if not—well also; though not so well.
The wise man won't see the faith inside him as just a coincidence. He will confidently speak the highest truth he recognizes, understanding that no matter what happens, he is fulfilling his role in the world—realizing that if he can bring about the change he seeks—great; if not—still okay; though not as okay.
7. 124These extracts are from an article entitled “Nature and God,” published in the National Review for October, 1860.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.124These excerpts come from an article titled “Nature and God,” published in the National Review in October 1860.
PART II.
LAWS OF THE KNOWN.
CHAPTER I.
GENERAL LAWS.
§ 35. We have seen that intellectual advance has been dual—has been towards the establishment of both a positively unknown and a positively known. In making ever more certain the inaccessibility of one kind of truth, experience has made ever more certain the accessibility of another kind. The differentiation of the knowable from the unknowable, is shown as much in the reduction of the one to perfect clearness, as in the reduction of the other to impenetrable mystery. Progressing enlightenment discloses a definite limit to human intelligence; and while all which lies on the other side of the limit, is, with increasing distinctness, seen to transcend our finite faculties, it grows more and more obvious that all which lies on this side of the limit may become an indisputable possession.
§ 35. We've seen that intellectual progress has been twofold—moving toward the establishment of both something we positively don't know and something we positively do know. As we get more certain about the inaccessibility of one type of truth, experience makes us more sure about the accessibility of another type. The distinction between what can be known and what can't be known is evident both in the clarity we achieve with the knowable and in the complexity we encounter with the unknowable. This growing understanding reveals a clear limit to human intelligence; while everything beyond this limit increasingly appears to go beyond our finite capabilities, it becomes more and more apparent that everything on this side of the limit can be firmly grasped.
To speak specifically—it has been shown that though we can never learn the nature of that which is manifested to us, we are daily learning more completely the order of its manifestations. We are conscious of effects produced in us by something separate from ourselves. The effects of which we are conscious—the changes of consciousness which make up our mental life, we ascribe to the forces of an external world. The intrinsic character of these forces—of this external world—of that which underlies all appearances, we find inscrutable; as is also the internal something whose changes constitute consciousness, but at the same time we 128find that among the changes of consciousness thus produced, there exist various constant relations; and we have no choice but to ascribe constancy to the relations which subsist among the inscrutable causes of these changes. Observation early discloses certain invariable connexions of coexistence and sequence among phenomena. Accumulating experiences tend continually to augment the number of invariable connexions recognized. When, as in the later stages of civilization, there arises not only a diligent gathering together of experiences but a critical comparison of them, more remote and complex connexions are added to the list. And gradually there grows up the habit of regarding these uniformities of relation as characterizing all manifestations of the Unknowable. Under the endless variety and seeming irregularity, there is ever more clearly discerned that “constant course of procedure” which we call Law.
To be specific—it has been shown that while we can never truly understand the nature of what is presented to us, we are constantly becoming more aware of the order of those presentations. We are aware of effects that are caused by something outside of ourselves. The effects we notice—the changes in awareness that make up our mental lives—we attribute to the forces of an external world. The inherent nature of these forces—of this external world—of what lies beneath all appearances remains a mystery; the same goes for the internal element whose changes create consciousness. However, among the changes in consciousness that occur, we find various consistent relationships; we have no choice but to attribute consistency to the relationships that exist among the mysterious causes of these changes. Early observation reveals certain unchanging connections of coexistence and sequence among phenomena. As experiences accumulate, the number of recognized constant connections continues to grow. When, as in the later stages of civilization, there is not just careful gathering of experiences but also critical comparison of them, more distant and complex connections are added to the list. Gradually, the habit of seeing these patterns of relationship as defining all manifestations of the Unknowable develops. Beneath the endless variety and apparent randomness, we increasingly recognize that “constant course of procedure” which we call Law.
The growing belief in the universality of Law, is so conspicuous to all cultivated minds as scarcely to need illustration. None who read these pages will ask for proof that this has been the central element of intellectual progress. But though the fact is sufficiently familiar, the philosophy of the fact is not so; and it will be desirable now to consider it. Partly because the development of our conception of Law will so be rendered more comprehensible; but chiefly because our subsequent course will thus be facilitated; I propose here to enumerate the several conditions that determine the order in which the various relations among phenomena are discovered. Seeing, as we shall, the consequent necessity of this order; and enabled, as we shall also be, to estimate the future by inference from the past; we shall perceive how inevitable is our advance towards the ultimatum that has been indicated.
The growing belief in the universality of Law is clear to anyone educated, so it hardly needs any explanation. No one reading these pages will ask for proof that this has been a key part of intellectual progress. While this fact is well-known, the philosophy behind it is less so, and it’s worthwhile to explore it now. This will help us understand the development of our concept of Law better and make our future discussions easier. I want to outline the various conditions that dictate the order in which we discover relationships among phenomena. As we’ll see, understanding this order is necessary, and by looking to the past, we’ll be able to anticipate the future. This will help us recognize how inevitable our progress is toward the goal we’ve identified.
§ 36. The recognition of Law, being the recognition of uniformity of relations among phenomena, it follows that the order in which different groups of phenomena are reduced to 129law, must depend on the frequency and distinctness with which the uniform relations they severally present, are experienced. At any given stage of progress, those uniformities will be most recognized with which men’s minds have been oftenest and most strongly impressed. In proportion partly to the number of times a relation has been presented to consciousness (not merely to the senses); and in proportion partly to the vividness with which the terms of the relation have been cognized; will be the degree in which the constancy of connexion is perceived.
§ 36. The recognition of law is about acknowledging the consistency of relationships among phenomena. It follows that the order in which different groups of phenomena are classified as law must depend on how often and clearly the consistent relationships they show are experienced. At any given stage of progress, the uniformities that will be most recognized are those that have made the strongest and most frequent impressions on people's minds. The more often a relationship has been presented to awareness (not just to the senses) and the more vividly the components of the relationship have been understood, the more likely it is that the consistency of that connection will be recognized.
The frequency and impressiveness with which different classes of relations are repeated in conscious experience, thus primarily determining the succession in which they are generalized, there result certain derivative principles to which this succession must more immediately and obviously conform. First in importance comes the directness with which personal welfare is affected. While, among surrounding things, many do not appreciably influence the body in any way, some act detrimentally and some beneficially, in various degrees; and manifestly, those things whose actions on the organism are most influential, will, cæteris paribus, be those whose laws of action are earliest observed. Second in order, is the conspicuousness of one or both the phenomena between which a relation is to be perceived. On every side are countless phenomena so concealed as to be detected only by close observation; others not obtrusive enough to attract notice; others which moderately solicit the attention; others so imposing or vivid as to force themselves upon consciousness; and supposing incidental conditions to be the same, these last will of course be among the first to have their relations generalized. In the third place, we have the absolute frequency with which the relations occur. There are coexistences and sequences of all degrees of commonness, from those which are ever present to those which are extremely rare; and it is clear that the rare coexistences and sequences, as well as the sequences which are very long in taking place, 130will not be reduced to law so soon as those which are familiar and rapid. Fourthly has to be added the relative frequency of occurrence. Many events and appearances are more or less limited to times and places; and as a relation which does not exist within the environment of an observer, cannot be cognized by him, however common it may be elsewhere or in another age, we have to take account of the surrounding physical circumstances, as well as the state of society, of the arts, and of the sciences—all of which affect the frequency with which certain groups of facts are exposed to observation. The fifth corollary to be noticed, is, that the succession in which different classes of phenomena are reduced to law, depends in part on their simplicity. Phenomena presenting great composition of causes or conditions, have their essential relations so masked, that it requires accumulated experiences to impress upon consciousness the true connexion of antecedents and consequents they involve. Hence, other things equal, the progress of generalization will be from the simple to the complex; and this it is which M. Comte has wrongly asserted to be the sole regulative principle of the progress. Sixth, and last, comes the degree of abstractness. Concrete relations are the earliest acquisitions. The colligation of any group of these into a general relation, which is the first step in abstraction, necessarily comes later than the discovery of the relations colligated. The union of a number of these lowest generalizations into a higher and more abstract generalization, is necessarily subsequent to the formation of such lowest generalizations. And so on continually, until the highest and most abstract generalizations have been reached.
The frequency and significance with which various types of relationships are repeated in our conscious experience primarily determine the order in which they are generalized. This leads to certain derived principles that this order must clearly and obviously adhere to. First in importance is how directly personal well-being is impacted. While many surrounding things have little effect on the body, some can be harmful and others beneficial, to varying degrees; and clearly, those things that most influence the organism will, other things being equal, be the ones whose laws of action are observed first. Second, we have how noticeable one or both phenomena are that show a relationship. There are countless phenomena all around us that are so hidden they can only be seen with careful observation; others are not prominent enough to grab attention; some moderately catch our eye; and others are so striking or vivid that they demand our awareness. Assuming all other conditions are equal, these most striking phenomena will naturally be among the first to have their relationships generalized. Third, we have the absolute frequency of the relationships. There are simultaneous occurrences and sequences that range from those that are always present to those that are very rare; and it's clear that rare occurrences and long sequences will not be generalized as quickly as those that are common and happen quickly. Fourth, we must also consider the relative frequency of occurrence. Many events and phenomena are somewhat limited to specific times and places; and because a relationship that doesn't exist in an observer's environment cannot be recognized by them—no matter how common it may be elsewhere or in another era—we must consider the physical circumstances surrounding them, as well as the state of society, the arts, and the sciences—all of which affect how often certain groups of facts are observed. The fifth related point is that the order in which different types of phenomena are turned into laws depends in part on their simplicity. Phenomena with a complex mix of causes or conditions have their essential relationships so obscured that it takes accumulated experiences to help us grasp the true connection between the causes and effects they involve. Therefore, other things being the same, the process of generalization tends to move from the simple to the complex; and this is what M. Comte has incorrectly claimed to be the only guiding principle of progress. Lastly, we have the degree of abstraction. Concrete relationships are the first things we understand. The linking of any group of these into a more general relationship, which is the first step towards abstraction, naturally happens after we have discovered those linked relationships. Combining several of these lowest generalizations into a higher, more abstract generalization must come after forming the simplest generalizations. This process continues until we reach the highest and most abstract generalizations.
These then are the several derivative principles. The frequency and vividness with which uniform relations are repeated in conscious experience, determining the recognition of their uniformity; and this frequency and vividness depending on the above conditions; it follows that the order in which different classes of facts are generalized, must depend 131on the extent to which the above conditions are fulfilled in each class. Let us mark how the facts harmonize with this conclusion: taking first a few that elucidate the general truth, and afterwards some that are illustrative of the several special truths which we here see follow from it.
These are the various derivative principles. The frequency and clarity with which consistent patterns appear in our conscious experience influence our ability to recognize their consistency. This frequency and clarity depend on the conditions mentioned earlier; therefore, the order in which different classes of facts are generalized must rely on how well these conditions are met in each class. Let’s point out how the facts align with this conclusion: first, we’ll consider a few that clarify the general truth, and then we’ll look at some that illustrate the specific truths that we see emerge from it.
§ 37. The relations earliest known as uniformities, are those subsisting between the common physical properties of matter—tangibility, visibility, cohesion, weight &c. We have no trace of an era in human history when the resistance offered by every visible object, was regarded as caused by the will of the object; or when the pressure of a body on the hand supporting it, was ascribed to the direct agency of a living being. And accordingly, we see that these are the relations oftenest repeated in consciousness; being as they are, objectively frequent, conspicuous, simple, concrete, and of immediate personal concern.
§ 37. The relationships first known as uniformities are those between the common physical properties of matter—tangibility, visibility, cohesion, weight, etc. There’s no record in human history of a time when the resistance from every visible object was seen as the result of the object's will, or when the pressure of an object on a supporting hand was attributed to the direct action of a living being. As a result, we notice that these are the relationships most frequently experienced in our awareness; they are often present objectively, noticeable, straightforward, tangible, and directly relevant to personal experience.
Similarly with respect to the ordinary phenomena of motion. The fall of a mass on the withdrawal of its support, is a sequence which directly affects bodily welfare, is conspicuous, simple, concrete, and very often repeated. Hence it is one of the uniformities recognized before the dawn of tradition. We know of no time when movements due to terrestrial gravitation were attributed to volition. Only when the relation is obscured—only, as in the case of an aerolite, where the antecedent of the descent is unperceived, do we find the fetishistic conception persistent. On the other hand, motions of intrinsically the same order as that of a falling stone—those of the heavenly bodies—long remain ungeneralized; and until their uniformity is seen, are construed as results of will. This difference is clearly not dependent on comparative complexity or abstractness; since the motion of a planet in an ellipse, is as simple and concrete a phenomenon as the motion of a projected arrow in a parabola. But the antecedents are not conspicuous; the sequences are of long duration; and they are infrequently repeated. 132Hence in a given period, there cannot be the same multiplied experiences of them. And that this is the chief cause of their slow reduction to law, we see in the fact that they are severally generalized in the order of their frequency and conspicuousness—the moon’s monthly cycle, the sun’s annual change, the periods of the inferior planets, the periods of the superior planets.
Similarly concerning the ordinary phenomena of motion. The fall of an object when its support is removed is a process that directly impacts physical well-being; it's noticeable, straightforward, tangible, and often repeated. That's why it's one of the patterns recognized long before recorded history. We don't know of any time when movements caused by Earth's gravity were thought to be voluntary. Only when the connection is unclear—like in the case of a meteorite, where the cause of its fall isn't obvious—do we see this superstitious idea persist. On the other hand, motions that are fundamentally similar to that of a falling stone—those of celestial bodies—remain unrecognized for a long time; until their consistency is acknowledged, they are interpreted as acts of will. This difference isn't due to complexity or abstraction; the motion of a planet in an ellipse is just as simple and tangible as that of a thrown arrow in a parabola. However, the causes aren't obvious; their effects last a long time; and they occur infrequently. 132 Therefore, during any specific timeframe, there can't be the same repeated experiences of them. This is the main reason they take so long to be understood as laws, as evidenced by the fact that they are recognized in the order of their frequency and visibility—the moon’s monthly cycle, the sun’s yearly changes, the periods of the inferior planets, and the periods of the superior planets.
While astronomical sequences were still ascribed to volition, certain terrestrial sequences of a different kind, but some of them equally without complication, were interpreted in like manner. The solidification of water at a low temperature, is a phenomenon that is simple, concrete, and of much personal concern. But it is neither so frequent as those which we saw are earliest generalized, nor is the presence of the antecedent so uniformly conspicuous. Though in all but tropical climates, mid-winter displays the relation between cold and freezing with tolerable constancy; yet, during the spring and autumn, the occasional appearance of ice in the mornings has no very manifest connexion with coldness of the weather. Sensation being so inaccurate a measure, it is not possible for the savage to experience the definite relation between a temperature of 32° and the congealing of water; and hence the long-continued conception of personal agency. Similarly, but still more clearly, with the winds. The absence of regularity and the inconspicuousness of the antecedents, allowed the mythological explanation to survive for a great period.
While astronomical events were still attributed to will, certain earthly sequences of a different kind, though some equally straightforward, were interpreted in the same way. The solidification of water at low temperatures is a phenomenon that is simple, tangible, and personally relevant. However, it is neither as common as those early generalized instances we observed, nor is the existence of the cause always apparent. Although in all but tropical climates, mid-winter shows a fairly consistent relationship between cold and freezing, during spring and autumn, the occasional presence of ice in the mornings doesn’t have a clear connection to the weather’s coldness. Since sensation is such an unreliable measure, a person living in primitive conditions cannot accurately perceive the direct relationship between a temperature of 32°F and water freezing; thus, the notion of personal agency persists for a long time. This is similarly, but even more clearly, true for the winds. The lack of regularity and the subtlety of the causes allowed mythological explanations to endure for an extended period.
During the era in which the uniformity of many quite simple inorganic relations was still unrecognized, certain classes of organic relations, intrinsically very complex and special, were generalized. The constant coexistence of feathers and a beak, of four legs with a bony internal framework, of a particular leaf with poisonous berries, are facts which were, and are, familiar to every savage. Did a savage find a bird with teeth, or a mammal clothed with feathers, he would be as much surprised as an instructed naturalist; and would probably make a fetish of the anomalous form: so 133showing that while the exceptional relation suggested the notion of a personal cause, the habitual relation did not. Now these uniformities of organic structure which are so early perceived, are of exactly the same class as those more numerous ones later established by biology. The constant coexistence of mammary glands with two occipital condyles in the skull, of vertebræ with teeth lodged in sockets, of frontal horns with the habit of rumination, are generalizations as purely empirical as those known to the aboriginal hunter. The vegetal physiologist cannot in the least understand the complex relation between the kind of leaf and the kind of fruit borne by a particular plant: he knows these and like connexions simply in the same manner that the barbarian knows them. But the fact that sundry of the uniform relations which chiefly make up the organic sciences, were very early recognized, is due to the high degree of vividness and frequency with which they were presented to consciousness. Though the connexion between the form of a given creature and the sound it makes, or the quality of its fur, or the nature of its flesh, is extremely involved; yet the two terms of the relation are conspicuous; are usually observed in close juxtaposition in time and space; are so observed perhaps daily, or many times a day; and above all a knowledge of their connexion has a direct and obvious bearing on personal welfare. Meanwhile, we see that innumerable other relations of exactly the same order, which are displayed with even greater frequency by surrounding plants and animals, remain for thousands of years unrecognized, if they are unobtrusive or of no apparent moment.
During a time when many simple inorganic relationships were still overlooked, certain types of organic relationships, which were inherently complex and specific, were generalized. The consistent presence of feathers with a beak, four legs with a bony internal structure, or a specific leaf linked to poisonous berries were facts familiar to everyone living in primitive conditions. If someone from that time found a bird with teeth or a mammal covered in feathers, they would be just as surprised as a knowledgeable naturalist and might even idolize the unusual creature; showing that while the unusual relationships suggested a personal explanation, the common ones did not. Today, the patterns of organic structure that were recognized early on are categorized the same way as the more numerous ones established later by biology. The consistent presence of mammary glands along with two occipital condyles in the skull, vertebrae with teeth situated in sockets, and frontal horns along with the behavior of rumination are generalizations that are just as empirical as those known to early hunters. A plant physiologist cannot fully grasp the complicated relationship between a specific type of leaf and the fruit it produces; they understand these connections just like the primitive person does. However, the early recognition of many of the key uniform relationships that make up the organic sciences is due to how vivid and frequent these connections were presented to awareness. Although the link between an animal’s form and the sound it makes, the quality of its fur, or the nature of its flesh is very complicated, the two aspects of the relationship are clear, are often seen together in time and space, and might be observed daily or multiple times a day. Most importantly, knowing these connections has a direct impact on personal well-being. Meanwhile, we observe that countless other relationships of the same kind, which are even more frequently shown by nearby plants and animals, go unnoticed for thousands of years if they are subtle or seem unimportant.
When, passing from this primitive stage to a more advanced stage, we trace the discovery of those less familiar uniformities which constitute what is technically distinguished as Science, we find the order of discovery to be still determined in the same manner. We shall most clearly see this in contemplating separately the influence of each derivative condition; as was proposed in the last section.
When we move from this basic stage to a more advanced one, and look at the discovery of those less familiar patterns that are known as Science, we find that the way they were discovered is still determined in the same way. We will see this most clearly by examining the impact of each related condition separately, as was suggested in the last section.
134§ 38. How relations that have an immediate bearing on the maintenance of life, are, other things equal, necessarily fixed in the mind before those which have no such immediate bearing, is abundantly illustrated in the history of Science. The habits of existing uncivilized races, who fix times by moons and barter so many of one article for so many of another, show us that numeration, which is the germ of mathematical science, commenced under the immediate pressure of personal wants; and it can scarcely be doubted that those laws of numerical relations which are embodied in the rules of arithmetic, were first brought to light through the practice of mercantile exchange. Similarly with Geometry. The derivation shows us that it originally included only certain methods of partitioning ground and laying out buildings. The properties of the scales and the lever, involving the first principle in mechanics, were early generalized under the stimulus of commercial and architectural needs. To fix the times of religious festivals and agricultural operations, were the motives which led to the establishment of the simpler astronomic periods. Such small knowledge of chemical relations as was involved in ancient metallurgy, was manifestly obtained in seeking how to improve tools and weapons. In the alchemy of later times, we see how greatly an intense hope of private benefit contributed to the disclosure of a certain class of uniformities. Nor is our own age barren of illustrations. “Here,” says Humboldt when in Guiana, “as in many parts of Europe, the sciences are thought worthy to occupy the mind, only so far as they confer some immediate and practical benefit on society.” “How is it possible to believe,” said a missionary to him, “that you have left your country to come and be devoured by mosquitoes on this river, and to measure lands that are not your own.” Our coasts furnish like instances. Every sea-side naturalist knows how great is the contempt with which fishermen regard the collection of objects for the microscope or aquarium: their incredulity as to the possible value of such things, being so 135great, that they can scarcely be induced even by bribes to preserve the refuse of their nets. Nay, we need not go for evidence beyond daily table-talk. The demand for “practical science”—for a knowledge that can be brought to bear on the business of life; joined to the ridicule commonly vented on pursuits that have no obvious use; suffice to show that the order in which different coexistences and sequences are discovered, greatly depends on the directness with which they affect our welfare.
134§ 38. It's clear from the history of science that our understanding of things that are crucial for survival comes before our understanding of those that don't have immediate relevance. The way uncivilized societies measure time by the moon and trade one item for another shows us that counting, which is the basis of math, started from basic personal needs. It's hard to argue against the idea that arithmetic rules were initially developed through trade practices. The same goes for Geometry; it originally focused on methods for dividing land and creating buildings. Principles of scales and levers, fundamental to mechanics, were first understood because of commercial and architectural demands. The scheduling of religious festivals and farming activities motivated the creation of basic astronomical calendars. The little knowledge of chemical relationships in ancient metallurgy clearly came from attempts to make better tools and weapons. In later alchemy, we can see how a strong desire for personal gain drove the uncovering of certain patterns. Even in our own time, examples are plentiful. “Here,” Humboldt noted in Guiana, “as in many parts of Europe, sciences are only considered valuable if they offer immediate practical benefits to society.” A missionary once asked him, “How can you believe you've left your country to be eaten by mosquitoes on this river, just to measure land that isn't yours?” Our coastal areas provide similar examples. Any seaside naturalist knows how little respect fishermen have for collecting things for a microscope or aquarium; they are so skeptical about the value of these items that even bribes don’t motivate them to keep the leftovers from their nets. We don't have to look far for proof; just daily conversations show that the demand for “practical science”—knowledge applicable to everyday life—coupled with the mockery directed at pursuits that seem useless, illustrates that the order in which we discover various relationships greatly depends on how directly they impact our well-being. 135
That, when all other conditions are the same, obtrusive relations will be generalized before unobtrusive ones, is so nearly a truism that examples appear almost superfluous. If it be admitted that by the aboriginal man, as by the child, the co-existent properties of large surrounding objects are noticed before those of minute objects; and that the external relations which bodies present are generalized before their internal ones; it must be admitted that in all subsequent stages of progress, the comparative conspicuousness of relations has greatly affected the order in which they were recognized as uniform. Hence it happened that after the establishment of those very manifest sequences constituting a lunation, and those less manifest ones marking a year, and those still less manifest ones marking the planetary periods, Astronomy occupied itself with such inconspicuous sequences as those displayed in the repeating cycle of lunar eclipses, and those which suggested the theory of epicycles and eccentrics; while modern Astronomy deals with still more inconspicuous sequences: some of which, as the planetary rotations, are nevertheless the simplest which the heavens present. In Physics, the early use of canoes implied an empirical knowledge of certain hydrostatic relations that are intrinsically more complex than sundry static relations then unknown; but these hydrostatic relations were thrust upon observation. Or if we compare the solution of the problem of specific gravity by Archimedes, with the discovery of atmospheric pressure by Torricelli, (the two involving mechanical relations of exactly the same kind,) 136we perceive that the much earlier occurrence of the first than the last, was determined neither by a difference in their bearings on personal welfare, nor by a difference in the frequency with which illustrations of them come under observation, nor by relative simplicity; but solely by the greater obtrusiveness of the connexion between antecedent and consequent in the one case than in the other. Similarly with Chemistry. The burning of wood, the rusting of iron, the putrefaction of dead bodies, were early known as consequents uniformly related to certain antecedents; but not until long after was there reached a like empirical knowledge of the effect produced by air in the decomposition of soil: a phenomenon of equal simplicity, equal or greater importance, and greater frequency; but one that is extremely unobtrusive. Among miscellaneous illustrations, it may be pointed out that the connexions between lightning and thunder and between rain and clouds, were established long before others of the same order; simply because they thrust themselves on the attention. Or the long-delayed discovery of the microscopic forms of life, with all the phenomena they present, may be named as very clearly showing how certain groups of relations that are not ordinarily perceptible, though in all other respects like long-familiar relations, have to wait until changed conditions render them perceptible. But, without further details, it needs only to consider the inquiries which now occupy the electrician, the chemist, the physiologist, to see that Science has advanced and is advancing from the more conspicuous phenomena to the less conspicuous ones.
That when all other conditions are the same, noticeable relationships will be recognized before less noticeable ones is almost a given, so examples seem almost unnecessary. If we accept that primitive people, just like children, notice the obvious characteristics of large objects around them before they notice the smaller ones, and that the external relationships that bodies exhibit are recognized before their internal ones, then we must acknowledge that in all later stages of progress, the relative visibility of relationships has significantly influenced the order in which they were identified as consistent. Consequently, after figuring out the clear sequences that make up a lunar cycle, the less obvious ones that define a year, and the even less obvious ones that outline planetary periods, Astronomy began to focus on the subtle sequences displayed in the repeating cycle of lunar eclipses and those that led to the theory of epicycles and eccentrics. Meanwhile, modern Astronomy engages with even more subtle sequences, some of which, like planetary rotations, are among the simplest phenomena presented by the heavens. In Physics, the early use of canoes indicated an empirical understanding of certain hydrostatic relationships that are inherently more complex than some static relationships that were then unknown, but these hydrostatic relationships forced themselves into observation. If we compare Archimedes’ solution to the problem of specific gravity with Torricelli’s discovery of atmospheric pressure (both involving mechanical relationships of the same kind), we see that the much earlier occurrence of the first compared to the second was not determined by a difference in their implications for personal welfare, by the frequency with which examples of them came into view, or by relative simplicity; rather, it was solely due to the more apparent connection between cause and effect in one case than in the other. The same applies to Chemistry. The burning of wood, the rusting of iron, and the decay of dead bodies were early recognized as outcomes consistently related to certain causes; however, it took much longer to gain a similar empirical understanding of the effect of air on soil decomposition, despite it being equally simple, equally or more significant, and happening more frequently; it simply is much less noticeable. Among other examples, it’s worth noting that the connections between lightning and thunder and between rain and clouds were established long before others of the same kind, simply because they attract attention more readily. The long-overdue discovery of microscopic life forms, along with all the phenomena they exhibit, clearly illustrates how certain groups of relationships that are not usually perceptible, although in every other way similar to long-known relationships, must wait until conditions change to make them visible. But without going into more details, it suffices to consider the inquiries currently engaging electricians, chemists, and physiologists to see that science has progressed and continues to progress from the more obvious phenomena to the less obvious ones.
How the degree of absolute frequency of a relation affects the recognition of its uniformity, we see in contrasting certain biological facts. Death and disease are near akin in most of their relations to us; while in respect of complexity, conspicuousness, and the directness with which they personally concern us, diseases in general may be put pretty nearly on a level with each other. But there are great differences in the times at which the natural sequences they severally exhibit 137are recognized as such. The connexion between death and bodily injury, constantly displayed not only in men but in all inferior creatures, was known as an established uniformity while yet diseases were thought supernatural. Among diseases themselves, it is observable that comparatively unusual ones were regarded as of demoniacal origin during ages when the more frequent were ascribed to ordinary causes: a truth paralleled indeed among our own peasantry, who by the use of charms show a lingering superstition with respect to rare disorders, which they do not show with respect to common ones, such as colds. Passing to physical illustrations, we may note that within the historic period, whirlpools were accounted for by the agency of water-spirits; but we do not find that within the same period the disappearance of water on exposure either to the sun or to artificial heat was interpreted in an analogous way: though a much more marvellous occurrence, and a much more complex one, its great frequency led to the early establishment of it as a natural uniformity. Rainbows and comets do not differ greatly in conspicuousness, and a rainbow is intrinsically the more involved phenomenon; but chiefly because of their far greater commonness, rainbows were perceived to have a direct dependence on sun and rain while yet comets were regarded as supernatural appearances.
How the level of absolute frequency of a relationship affects the recognition of its consistency can be seen when we compare certain biological facts. Death and disease are closely related in many ways; however, in terms of complexity, visibility, and how directly they affect us, diseases can largely be viewed as being on a similar level. Yet, there are significant differences in the timing of how we recognize the natural sequences they show. The link between death and physical injury, clearly demonstrated not only in humans but also in all lower creatures, was accepted as an established norm while diseases were still thought to be supernatural. Among diseases themselves, it’s noticeable that relatively uncommon ones were seen as having a demonic origin during times when more frequent illnesses were attributed to natural causes: a reality that can still be seen among our own rural communities, where the use of charms shows a lingering superstition towards rare illnesses, unlike common ones like colds. When we look at physical examples, we note that during historical times, whirlpools were explained by the actions of water spirits; however, we don’t see that the disappearance of water when exposed to the sun or artificial heat was interpreted in a similar way: despite being a much more remarkable and complicated event, its high frequency led to it being established early on as a natural norm. Rainbows and comets don’t differ much in visibility, and a rainbow is inherently the more complex phenomenon; but mainly due to their much greater frequency, rainbows were understood to have a direct connection to sun and rain, while comets were viewed as supernatural phenomena.
That races living inland must long have remained ignorant of the daily and monthly sequences of the tides, and that intertropical races could not early have comprehended the phenomena of northern winters, are extreme illustrations of the influence which relative frequency has on the recognition of uniformities. Animals which, where they are indigenous, call forth no surprise by their structure or habits, because these are so familiar, when taken to a part of the earth where they have never been seen, are looked at with an astonishment approaching to awe—are even thought supernatural: a fact which will suggest numerous others that show how the localization of phenomena, in part controls the order in which they 138are reduced to law. Not only however does their localization in space affect the progression, but also their localization in time. Facts which are rarely if ever manifested during one era, are rendered very frequent in another, simply through the changes wrought by civilization. The lever, of which the properties are illustrated in the use of sticks and weapons, is vaguely understood by every savage—on applying it in a certain way he rightly anticipates certain effects; but the action of the equally simple wedge, which is not commonly displayed till tool-making has made some progress, is less early generalized; while the wheel and axle, pulley, and screw, cannot have their powers either empirically or rationally known till the advance of the arts has more or less familiarized them. Through those various means of exploration which we have inherited and are ever increasing, we have become acquainted with a vast range of chemical relations that were relatively non-existent to the primitive man: to highly developed industries we owe both the substances and the apparatus that have disclosed to us countless uniformities which our ancestors had no opportunity of seeing, and therefore could not recognize. These and sundry like instances that will occur to the reader, show that the accumulated materials, and processes, and appliances, and products, which characterize the environments of complex societies, greatly increase the accessibility of various classes of relations; and by so multiplying the experiences of them, or making them relatively frequent, facilitate their generalization. To which add, that various classes of phenomena presented by society itself, as for instance those which political economy formulates, become relatively frequent and therefore recognizable in advanced social states; while in less advanced ones they are too rarely displayed to have their relations perceived, or, as in the least advanced ones, are not displayed at all.
That people living inland must have long been unaware of the daily and monthly changes of the tides, and that those in the tropics could not have easily understood the phenomena of northern winters, are clear examples of how the frequency of experiences influences our ability to recognize patterns. Animals that are unremarkable in their own habitats because they are so familiar seem astonishing—almost supernatural—when viewed in places where they've never been seen. This illustrates how the local environment affects the order in which we understand phenomena. Not only does where something occurs influence its recognition, but also when it happens. Events that rarely occur during one time period can become quite common in another due simply to changes brought about by civilization. The lever, which is demonstrated by using sticks and weapons, is vaguely understood by any primitive person—they correctly expect certain effects from using it in a specific way. However, the action of the simple wedge, which isn't usually recognized until tool-making has progressed, is generalized later; while the wheel and axle, pulley, and screw can't be understood until the arts have sufficiently advanced. Through the various methods of exploration that we have inherited and continue to develop, we have learned about a vast array of chemical relationships that were almost nonexistent for primitive humans. We owe the substances and tools that help us reveal countless patterns to our highly developed industries—patterns that our ancestors had no chance to observe and therefore couldn't recognize. These examples, among others that readers may think of, demonstrate that the accumulated materials, processes, tools, and products that define complex societies greatly enhance our access to various types of relationships. By increasing our experiences with these relationships or making them more common, it becomes easier to generalize them. Additionally, various types of phenomena presented by society itself, such as those outlined by political economy, become more common and therefore recognizable in advanced social states, while in less advanced ones, they are too rare to discern their relationships, or in the least developed societies, they don't appear at all.
That, where no other circumstances interfere, the order in which different uniformities are established varies as their complexity, is manifest. The geometry of straight lines was understood 139before the geometry of curved lines; the properties of the circle before the properties of the ellipse, parabola and hyperbola; and the equations of curves of single curvature were ascertained before those of curves of double curvature. Plane trigonometry comes in order of time and simplicity before spherical trigonometry; and the mensuration of plane surfaces and solids before the mensuration of curved surfaces and solids. Similarly with mechanics: the laws of simple motion were generalized before those of compound motion; and those of rectilinear motion before those of curvilinear motion. The properties of equal-armed levers, or scales, were understood before those of the lever with unequal arms; and the law of the inclined plane was formulated earlier than that of the screw, which involves it. In chemistry, the progress has been from the simple inorganic compounds, to the more involved organic ones. And where, as in most of the other sciences, the conditions of the exploration are more complicated, we still may clearly trace relative complexity as one of the determining circumstances.
That, where no other factors interfere, the order in which different uniformities are established varies based on their complexity, is clear. The geometry of straight lines was understood before the geometry of curved lines; the properties of the circle before those of the ellipse, parabola, and hyperbola; and the equations of single-curvature curves were determined before those of double-curvature curves. Plane trigonometry comes chronologically and simplistically before spherical trigonometry; and measuring flat surfaces and solids comes before measuring curved surfaces and solids. The same applies to mechanics: the laws of simple motion were generalized before those of compound motion; and the laws of straight-line motion were established before those of curved motion. The properties of equal-armed levers, or scales, were understood before those of levers with unequal arms; and the law of the inclined plane was formulated before that of the screw, which depends on it. In chemistry, the progress has moved from simple inorganic compounds to more complex organic ones. And where, as in most other sciences, the conditions of exploration are more complicated, we can still clearly identify relative complexity as one of the key factors.
The progression from concrete relations to abstract ones, and from the less abstract to the more abstract, is equally obvious. Numeration, which in its primary form concerned itself only with groups of actual objects, came earlier than simple arithmetic: the rules of which deal with numbers apart from objects. Arithmetic, limited in its sphere to concrete numerical relations, is alike earlier and less abstract than Algebra, which deals with the relations of these relations. And in like manner, the Infinitesimal Calculus comes after Algebra, both in order of evolution and in order of abstractness. In Astronomy, the progress has been from special generalizations, each expressing the motions of a particular planet, to the generalizations of Kepler, expressing the motions of the planets at large; and then to Newton’s generalization, expressing the motions of all heavenly bodies whatever. Similarly with Physics, Chemistry and Biology, there has ever been an advance from the relations of particular facts 140and particular classes of facts, to the relations presented by still wider classes—to truths of a high generality or greater abstractness.
The shift from concrete relationships to abstract ones, and from less abstract to more abstract, is just as clear. Counting, which originally focused only on groups of real objects, came before simple arithmetic: the principles of which deal with numbers independent of objects. Arithmetic, which is limited to concrete numerical relationships, is also earlier and less abstract than Algebra, which addresses the relationships between these relationships. Likewise, the Infinitesimal Calculus comes after Algebra, both in terms of development and abstraction. In Astronomy, the progress has moved from specific generalizations, each describing the motion of a particular planet, to Kepler's generalizations about the motions of planets in general, and then to Newton’s generalization, which describes the motions of all heavenly bodies. The same pattern is observed in Physics, Chemistry, and Biology, where there has always been a move from the relationships of specific facts and classes of facts to the relations presented by broader classes—to truths that are more general or more abstract. 140
Brief and rude as is this sketch of a mental development that has been long and complicated, it fulfils its end if it displays the several conditions that have regulated the course of the development. I venture to think it shows inductively, what was deductively inferred, that the order in which separate groups of uniformities are recognized, depends not on one circumstance but on several circumstances. A survey of the facts makes it manifest that the various classes of relations are generalized in a certain succession, not solely because of one particular kind of difference in their natures; but also because they are variously placed with respect to time, space, other relations, and our own constitutions: our perception of them being influenced by all these conditions in endless combinations. The comparative degrees of importance, of obtrusiveness, of absolute frequency, of relative frequency, of simplicity, of concreteness, are every one of them factors; and from their union in proportions that are more or less different in every case, there results a highly complex process of mental evolution. But while it thus becomes manifest that the proximate causes of the succession in which relations are reduced to law, are numerous and involved; it also becomes manifest that there is one ultimate cause to which these proximate ones are subordinate. As the several circumstances that determine the early or late recognition of uniformities, are circumstances that determine the number and strength of the impressions which these uniformities make on the mind; it follows that the progression conforms to a certain fundamental principle of psychology. We see à posteriori, what we concluded à priori, that the order in which relations are generalized, depends on the frequency and impressiveness with which they are repeated in conscious experience.
While this brief and somewhat harsh overview of a complex mental development may seem inadequate, it achieves its purpose by highlighting the various factors that have influenced this development. I believe it demonstrates inductively what was inferred deductively: that the sequence in which different groups of patterns are recognized relies not on a single factor but on multiple ones. A review of the evidence clearly shows that various types of relationships are generalized in a specific order, not just because of a single type of difference in their nature, but also due to their positioning regarding time, space, other relationships, and our own mental frameworks; our perception of them is affected by all these elements in countless combinations. The varying degrees of importance, visibility, absolute frequency, relative frequency, simplicity, and concreteness are all contributing factors; and from their unique combinations in different proportions in each case arises a highly complex mental evolution. However, while it becomes clear that the immediate reasons behind the order in which relationships are established as laws are numerous and complicated, it is also evident that there is one ultimate cause that these immediate factors depend on. Since the various conditions that lead to the early or late recognition of patterns are also the ones that influence the intensity and number of impressions these patterns leave on the mind, it follows that the progression aligns with a certain core principle of psychology. We observe after the fact what we originally concluded a priori: that the order in which relationships are generalized is determined by how often and powerfully they are repeated in our conscious experiences.
§ 39. And now to observe the bearings of these truths on 141our general argument. Having roughly analyzed the progress of the past, let us take advantage of the light thus thrown on the present, and consider what is implied respecting the future.
§ 39. Now let's look at how these truths relate to our overall argument. After briefly analyzing the progress of the past, let's use this insight to understand the present and consider what it means for the future.
Note first that the likelihood of the universality of Law, has been ever growing greater. Out of the countless coexistences and sequences with which mankind are environed, they have been continually transferring some from the group whose order was supposed to be arbitrary, to the group whose order is known to be uniform. Age by age, the number of recognized connexions of phenomena has been increasing; and that of unrecognized connexions decreasing. And manifestly, as fast as the class of ungeneralized relations becomes smaller, the probability that among them there may be some that do not conform to law, becomes less. To put the argument numerically—It is clear that when out of surrounding phenomena a hundred of several kinds have been found to occur in constant connexions, there arises a slight presumption that all phenomena occur in constant connexions. When uniformity has been established in a thousand cases, more varied in their kinds, the presumption gains strength. And when the established cases of uniformity mount to myriads, including many of each variety, it becomes an ordinary induction that uniformity exists everywhere. Just as from the numerous observed cases in which heavenly bodies have been found to move in harmony with the law of gravitation, it is inferred that all heavenly bodies move in harmony with the law of gravitation; so, from the innumerable observed cases in which phenomena are found to stand in invariable connexions, it is inferred that in all cases phenomena stand in invariable connexions.
Note first that the likelihood of the universality of Law has been steadily increasing. Out of the countless coexistences and sequences that surround humanity, we have continually shifted some from the category that was thought to be arbitrary to the category known to be consistent. Over time, the number of recognized connections between phenomena has been growing, while the number of unrecognized connections has been falling. Clearly, as the class of non-generalized relations gets smaller, the chance that some of them do not follow a law decreases. To put it simply—when a hundred instances of various kinds are found to occur in constant connections, there is a slight assumption that all phenomena occur in constant connections. When uniformity has been established in a thousand cases, which are more varied, that assumption gets stronger. And when the instances of uniformity reach myriads, covering many different types, it becomes a common conclusion that uniformity exists everywhere. Just as we infer that all heavenly bodies move in accordance with the law of gravitation from the many observed cases where they do, we infer that all phenomena are connected in a consistent manner based on the countless observed cases showing invariable connections.
Silently and insensibly their experiences have been pressing men on towards the conclusion thus drawn. Not out of a conscious regard for these abstract reasons, but from a habit of thought which these abstract reasons formulate and justify, all minds have been advancing towards a belief in the constancy 142of surrounding coexistences and sequences. Familiarity with special uniformities, has generated the abstract conception of uniformity—the idea of Law; and this idea has been in successive generations slowly gaining fixity and clearness. Especially has it been thus among those whose knowledge of natural phenomena is the most extensive—men of science. The Mathematician, the Physicist, the Astronomer, the Chemist, severally acquainted with the vast accumulations of uniformities established by their predecessors, and themselves daily adding new ones as well as verifying the old, acquire a far stronger faith in Law than is ordinarily possessed. With them this faith, ceasing to be merely passive, becomes an active stimulus to inquiry. Wherever there exist phenomena of which the dependence is not yet ascertained, these most cultivated intellects, impelled by the conviction that here too there is some invariable connexion, proceed to observe, compare, and experiment; and when they discover the law to which the phenomena conform, as they eventually do, their general belief in the universality of law is further strengthened. So overwhelming is the evidence, and such the effect of this discipline, that to the advanced student of nature, the proposition that there are lawless phenomena, has become not only incredible but almost inconceivable.
Silently and subtly, their experiences have been pushing people toward this conclusion. Not out of a deliberate consideration for these abstract reasons, but from a way of thinking that these abstract reasons shape and support, all minds have been moving toward a belief in the consistency of surrounding coexistences and sequences. Familiarity with specific patterns has led to the abstract concept of uniformity—the idea of Law; and this idea has been steadily gaining clarity and solidity over generations. This has been especially true among those with the most extensive knowledge of natural phenomena—scientists. Mathematicians, Physicists, Astronomers, and Chemists, each familiar with the vast accumulations of patterns established by their predecessors, and who themselves continuously add new ones as well as verify the old, have a much stronger belief in Law than is typically held. For them, this belief, moving beyond mere passivity, becomes an active motivation for inquiry. Wherever there are phenomena with unknown dependencies, these highly skilled minds, driven by the conviction that there is also some unchanging connection here, proceed to observe, compare, and experiment; and when they eventually discover the law governing these phenomena, their general faith in the universality of law is further reinforced. The evidence is so compelling, and the impact of this training so profound, that for the advanced student of nature, the idea that there are lawless phenomena has become not just unbelievable but nearly inconceivable.
Hence we may see how inevitably there must spread among mankind at large, this habitual recognition of law which already distinguishes modern thought from ancient thought. Not only is it that each conquest of generalization over a region of fact hitherto ungeneralized, and each merging of lower generalizations in a higher one, adds to the distinctness of this recognition among those immediately concerned—not only is it that the fulfilment of the predictions made possible by every new step, and the further command so gained of nature’s forces, prove to the uninitiated the validity of these generalizations and the doctrine they illustrate; but it is that widening education is daily diffusing among the mass of men, that knowledge of generalizations which has been hitherto confined to 143the few. And as fast as this diffusion goes on, must the belief of the scientific become the belief of the world at large. The simple accumulation of instances, must inevitably establish in the general mind, a conviction of the universality of law; even were the influence of this accumulation to be aided by no other.
Thus, we can see how undeniably there must be a growing acknowledgment of law among humanity as a whole, which already sets modern thinking apart from ancient thinking. It’s not just that every new generalization over previously unaddressed areas of fact, and each integration of simpler ideas into broader concepts, enhances the clarity of this acknowledgment among those directly involved—it's also that the evidence supporting these predictions, made possible by every new progression, alongside the increased control over nature's forces, demonstrates to those unfamiliar with the concepts the validity of these generalizations and the principles they reflect. Furthermore, expanding education is increasingly spreading among the masses the understanding of these generalizations, which was previously limited to a select few. As this spread continues, the scientific community's beliefs will inevitably become the beliefs of society at large. The straightforward accumulation of examples will certainly create a shared understanding in the general population of the universality of law, even if no other factors contribute to this influence.
§ 40. But it will be aided by another. From the evidence above set forth, it may be inferred that a secondary influence will by and by enforce this primary one. That law is universal, will become an irresistible conclusion when it is perceived that the progress in the discovery of laws itself conforms to law; and when it is hence understood why certain groups of phenomena have been reduced to law, while other groups are still unreduced. When it is seen that the order in which uniformities are recognized, must depend upon the frequency and vividness with which they are repeated in conscious experience; when it is seen that, as a matter of fact, the most common, important, conspicuous, concrete and simple uniformities were the earliest recognized, because they were experienced oftenest and most distinctly; when it is further seen that from the beginning the advance has been to the recognition of uniformities which, from one or other circumstance, were less often experienced; it will by implication be seen that long after the great mass of phenomena have been generalized, there must remain phenomena which, from their rareness, or unobtrusiveness, or seeming unimportance, or complexity, or abstractness, are still ungeneralized. Thus will be furnished a solution to a difficulty sometimes raised. When it is asked why the universality of law is not already fully established, there will be the answer that the directions in which it is not yet established are those in which its establishment must necessarily be latest. That state of things which is inferable beforehand, is just the state which we find to exist. If such coexistences and sequences as those of Biology and Sociology are not yet reduced to law, the presumption is not 144that they are irreducible to law, but that their laws elude our present means of analysis. Having long ago proved uniformity throughout all the lower classes of relations; and having been step by step proving uniformity throughout classes of relations successively higher and higher; if we have not at present succeeded with the highest classes, it may be fairly concluded that our powers are at fault, rather than that the uniformity does not exist. And unless we make the absurd assumption that the process of generalization, now going on with unexampled rapidity, has reached its limit, and will suddenly cease, we must infer that ultimately mankind will discover a constant order of manifestation even in the most involved, obscure, and abstract phenomena.
§ 40. But it will be supported by another factor. Based on the evidence presented, we can conclude that a secondary influence will eventually reinforce this primary one. The idea that law is universal will become an undeniable conclusion once we realize that the advancement in discovering laws follows a pattern; and when we understand why some groups of phenomena have been established as laws, while others have not. When we recognize that the order in which we identify patterns is influenced by how often and clearly they appear in our conscious experience; when we see that the most common, significant, obvious, concrete, and straightforward patterns were recognized first because they were encountered most frequently and distinctly; when we further recognize that from the beginning, our progress has been toward identifying patterns that were less frequently experienced for various reasons, it will become clear that long after a significant number of phenomena have been generalized, there must still be phenomena that remain unrecognized due to their rarity, subtlety, seeming unimportance, complexity, or abstract nature. This provides a resolution to a question that sometimes arises. When people wonder why the universality of law isn't fully established yet, the answer is that the areas where it is not yet established are those where it will likely be the last to do so. The situation we can infer beforehand is precisely the situation we find ourselves in. If relationships in Biology and Sociology aren't yet formulated into laws, it doesn't mean they are irreducible to law; rather, it suggests that we currently lack the analytical tools to uncover their laws. Having already demonstrated uniformity in all the lower levels of relations, and gradually proving uniformity in increasingly complex relationships; if we haven't yet succeeded with the highest levels, it suggests that our abilities are limited, not that uniformity isn't present. Unless we make the unreasonable assumption that the ongoing process of generalization, which is currently happening at an unprecedented speed, has hit its peak and will suddenly stop, we should conclude that eventually, humanity will uncover a consistent order even in the most complex, obscure, and abstract phenomena.
§ 41. Not even yet, however, have we exhausted the evidence. The foregoing arguments have to be merged in another, still more cogent, which fuses all fragmentary proofs into one general proof.
§ 41. Not even yet, however, have we exhausted the evidence. The previous arguments need to be combined into another, even more compelling one, that brings all the separate pieces of evidence together into a single, comprehensive proof.
Thus far we have spoken of laws that are more or less special; and from the still-continuing disclosure of special laws, each formulating some new class of phenomena, have inferred that eventually all classes of phenomena will be formulated. If, now, we find that there are laws of far higher generality, to which those constituting the body of Science are subordinate; the fact must greatly strengthen the proof that Law is universal. If, underneath different groups of concrete phenomena, Mechanical, Chemical, Thermal, Electric, &c., we discern certain uniformities of action common to them all; we have a new and weighty reason for believing that uniformity of action pervades the whole of nature. And if we also see that these most general laws hold not only of the inorganic but of the organic worlds—if we see that the phenomena of Life, of Mind, of Society, whose special laws are yet unestablished, nevertheless conform to these most general laws; the proof of the universality of Law amounts to demonstration.
So far, we've talked about laws that are more or less specific; and from the ongoing discovery of these special laws, each outlining some new category of phenomena, we've deduced that eventually, all categories of phenomena will be defined. If we now find that there are laws of much greater generality that encompass those that make up the core of Science, this fact must significantly strengthen the argument that Law is universal. If, beneath different groups of concrete phenomena—Mechanical, Chemical, Thermal, Electrical, etc.—we notice certain consistent patterns of behavior that are common to all of them, we have a new and compelling reason to believe that uniformity of action exists throughout all of nature. And if we also observe that these most general laws apply not only to the inorganic but also to the organic worlds—if we see that the phenomena of Life, Mind, and Society, whose specific laws have yet to be established, still align with these most fundamental laws; the proof of the universality of Law becomes undeniable.
That there are laws of this transcendant generality, has now 145to be shown. To specify and illustrate them, will be the purpose of the succeeding chapters. And while, in contemplating them, we shall perceive how irresistible is the conclusion that the workings of the Unknowable are distinguished from those of finite agents by their absolute uniformity; we shall at the same time familiarize ourselves with those primary facts through which all other facts are to be interpreted.
That there are laws of this supreme generality needs to be demonstrated. The goal of the upcoming chapters is to specify and illustrate them. As we reflect on these laws, we'll realize that the workings of the Unknowable are strikingly different from those of finite agents due to their total uniformity. At the same time, we'll get acquainted with the fundamental facts that will help us understand all other facts.
CHAPTER II.
THE LAW OF EVOLUTION. __A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__
§ 42. The class of phenomena to be considered under the title of Evolution, is in a great measure co-extensive with the class commonly indicated by the word Progress. But the word Progress is here inappropriate, for several reasons. To specify these reasons will perhaps be the best way of showing what is to be understood by Evolution.
§ 42. The type of phenomena we’re looking at under the concept of Evolution largely overlaps with what people usually refer to as Progress. However, the term Progress isn't quite right for several reasons. Outlining these reasons will likely be the best way to clarify what we mean by Evolution.
In the first place, the current conception of Progress is shifting and indefinite. Sometimes it comprehends little more than simple growth—as of a nation in the number of its members and the extent of territory over which it has spread. At other times it has reference to quantity of material products—as when the advance of agriculture and manufactures is the topic. Now the superior quality of these products is contemplated; and then the new or improved appliances by which they are produced. When, again, we speak of moral or intellectual progress, we refer to the state of the individual or people exhibiting it; while, when the progress of Knowledge, of Science, of Art, is commented upon, we have in view certain abstract results of human thought and action. In the second place, besides being more or less vague, the 147ordinary idea of Progress is in great measure erroneous. It takes in not so much the reality as its accompaniments—not so much the substance as the shadow. That progress in intelligence seen during the growth of the child into the man, or the savage into the philosopher, is commonly regarded as consisting in the greater number of facts known and laws understood; whereas the actual progress consists in those internal modifications of which this increased knowledge is the expression. Social progress is supposed to consist in the produce of a greater quantity and variety of the articles required for satisfying men’s wants—in the increasing security of person and property—in widening freedom of action; whereas, rightly understood, social progress consists in those changes of structure in the social organism which have entailed these consequences. The interpretation is a teleological one. The phenomena are contemplated solely as bearing on human happiness. Only those changes are held to constitute progress, which directly or indirectly tend to heighten human happiness. And they are thought to constitute progress simply because they tend to heighten human happiness. In the third place, in consequence of its teleological implications, the term Progress is rendered scarcely applicable to a wide range of phenomena which are intrinsically of the same nature as those included under it. The metamorphoses of an insect are only by analogy admitted within the scope of the word, as popularly accepted; though, considered in themselves, they have as much right there as the changes which constitute civilization. Having no apparent bearing on human interests, an increasing complication in the arrangement of ocean-currents, would not ordinarily be regarded as progress; though really of the same character as phenomena which are so regarded.
In the first place, the current idea of Progress is changing and unclear. Sometimes it means just simple growth—like a nation increasing its population and expanding its territory. At other times, it refers to the amount of material products—like when we discuss advancements in agriculture and manufacturing. Sometimes we consider the higher quality of these products, and at other times, the new or improved methods used to produce them. When we talk about moral or intellectual progress, we refer to the condition of the individual or society showing it; while when we comment on the progress of Knowledge, Science, or Art, we focus on specific abstract outcomes of human thought and action. Secondly, in addition to being vague, the usual idea of Progress is largely incorrect. It emphasizes not so much the reality as its byproducts—not so much the substance as the shadow. The progress in intelligence observed during a child's growth into adulthood or a savage becoming a philosopher is commonly seen as consisting of a greater number of facts known and laws understood; meanwhile, the actual progress consists in the internal changes that this increased knowledge expresses. Social progress is thought to consist of a larger quantity and variety of goods needed to satisfy people's wants—in the growing safety of individuals and property—in expanding freedom of action; whereas, when properly understood, social progress actually involves structural changes in the social structure that lead to these outcomes. The interpretation is teleological. The phenomena are viewed solely in terms of their impact on human happiness. Only those changes are seen as progress that directly or indirectly contribute to increasing human happiness. They are believed to constitute progress simply because they tend to enhance human happiness. Thirdly, due to its teleological implications, the term Progress is hardly applicable to a broad range of phenomena that are fundamentally similar to those it includes. The changes of an insect are often only analogously included under the term, as commonly understood; however, when considered in themselves, they have as much right to be there as the changes that define civilization. An increasing complexity in the arrangement of ocean currents, which appears to have no relevant connection to human interests, would typically not be seen as progress; yet it is fundamentally the same type of phenomenon as those that are recognized as progress.
Hence the need for another word. Our purpose here is to analyze the various class of changes usually considered as Progress, together with others like them which are not so considered; and to see what is their intrinsic peculiarity—what 148is their essential nature apart from their bearings on our welfare. And that we may avoid the confusion of thought likely to result from pre-established associations, it will be best to substitute for the term Progress, the term Evolution. Our question is then—what is Evolution?
Hence the need for another word. Our goal here is to analyze the different types of changes typically seen as Progress, along with others that are not viewed that way; and to understand their unique characteristics—what their essential nature is apart from how they relate to our well-being. To avoid any confusion that might come from established associations, it would be better to replace the term Progress with the term Evolution. Our question then is—what is Evolution?
§ 43. In respect to that evolution which individual organisms display, this question has been answered. Pursuing an idea which Harvey set afloat, Wolff, Goethe, and Von Baer, have established the truth that the series of changes gone through during the development of a seed into a tree, or an ovum into an animal, constitute an advance from homogeneity of structure to heterogeneity of structure. In its primary stage, every germ consists of a substance that is uniform throughout, both in texture and chemical composition. The first step is the appearance of a difference between two parts of this substance; or, as the phenomenon is called in physiological language, a differentiation. Each of these differentiated divisions presently begins itself to exhibit some contrast of parts; and by and by these secondary differentiations become as definite as the original one. This process is continuously repeated—is simultaneously going on in all parts of the growing embryo; and by endless such differentiations there is finally produced that complex combination of tissues and organs, constituting the adult animal or plant. This is the history of all organisms whatever. It is settled beyond dispute that organic evolution consists in a change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous.
§ 43. Regarding the development that individual organisms undergo, this question has already been resolved. Expanding on an idea proposed by Harvey, Wolff, Goethe, and Von Baer established the fact that the series of changes that occur during the transformation of a seed into a tree, or an egg into an animal, represents a shift from uniformity in structure to variability in structure. At its initial stage, every germ consists of a substance that is consistent in texture and chemical makeup. The first step is the emergence of a difference between two areas of this substance; or, in physiological terms, this is known as differentiation. Each of these differentiated parts soon begins to show some contrast within themselves; eventually, these secondary differentiations become as distinct as the original one. This process is continually repeated—happening simultaneously in all parts of the growing embryo; and through countless such differentiations, a complex arrangement of tissues and organs is created, forming the adult animal or plant. This is the story of all organisms. It is indisputable that organic evolution involves a shift from the uniform to the diverse.
Now I propose in the first place to show, that this law of organic evolution is the law of all evolution. Whether it be in the development of the Earth, in the development of Life upon its surface, in the development of Society, of Government, of Manufactures, of Commerce, of Language, Literature, Science, Art, this same advance from the simple to the complex, through successive differentiations, holds uniformly. From the earliest traceable cosmical changes down to the 149latest results of civilization, we shall find that the transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous, is that in which Evolution essentially consists.
Now I want to first show that the law of organic evolution is the law of all evolution. Whether it's the development of the Earth, the evolution of life on its surface, or the development of society, government, manufacturing, commerce, language, literature, science, and art, the same pattern of moving from the simple to the complex, through successive differentiations, consistently applies. From the earliest observable cosmic changes to the latest advances in civilization, we will find that evolution essentially consists of the transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous.
§ 44. With the view of showing that if the Nebular Hypothesis be true, the genesis of the solar system supplies one illustration of this law, let us assume that the matter of which the sun and planets consist was once in a diffused form; and that from the gravitation of its atoms there resulted a gradual concentration. By the hypothesis, the solar system in its nascent state existed as an indefinitely extended and nearly homogeneous medium—a medium almost homogeneous in density, in temperature, and in other physical attributes. The first advance towards consolidation resulted in a differentiation between the occupied space which the nebulous mass still filled, and the unoccupied space which it previously filled. There simultaneously resulted a contrast in density and a contrast in temperature, between the interior and the exterior of this mass. And at the same time there arose throughout it, rotatory movements, whose velocities varied according to their distances from its centre. These differentiations increased in number and degree until there was evolved the organized group of sun, planets, and satellites, which we now know—a group which presents numerous contrasts of structure and action among its members. There are the immense contrasts between the sun and the planets, in bulk and in weight; as well as the subordinate contrasts between one planet and another, and between the planets and their satellites. There is the similarly marked contrast between the sun as almost stationary, and the planets as moving round him with great velocity; while there are the secondary contrasts between the velocities and periods of the several planets, and between their simple revolutions and the double ones of their satellites, which have to move round their primaries while moving round the sun. There is the yet further strong contrast between the sun and the planets in respect of temperature; and 150there is reason to suppose that the planets and satellites differ from each other in their proper heat, as well as in the heat they receive from the sun. When we bear in mind that, in addition to these various contrasts, the planets and satellites also differ in respect to their distances from each other and their primary; in respect to the inclinations of their orbits, the inclinations of their axes, their times of rotation on their axes, their specific gravities, and their physical constitutions; we see what a high degree of heterogeneity the solar system exhibits, when compared with the almost complete homogeneity of the nebulous mass out of which it is supposed to have originated.
§ 44. To demonstrate that if the Nebular Hypothesis is correct, the formation of the solar system is one example of this principle, let’s assume that the matter making up the sun and planets was once dispersed. From the gravitational attraction of its atoms, a gradual concentration occurred. According to the hypothesis, the solar system in its early state existed as a vast and nearly uniform medium—one that was almost uniform in density, temperature, and other physical characteristics. The initial step towards becoming solid led to a distinction between the space occupied by the nebulous mass and the unoccupied space it once filled. This created a difference in density and temperature between the inside and the outside of this mass. Simultaneously, rotational movements emerged throughout it, with the speeds varying based on their distance from the center. These distinctions multiplied in number and intensity until the organized group of the sun, planets, and satellites that we recognize today was formed—a group that shows significant structural and functional contrasts among its members. There are enormous differences between the sun and the planets in terms of size and weight, as well as smaller differences between individual planets and between planets and their satellites. The sun is almost stationary, while the planets revolve around it at high speeds; there are also secondary differences in the speeds and orbits of the various planets, and between their simple rotations and the complex movements of their satellites, which orbit their main planets while also circling the sun. Furthermore, there is a significant difference in temperature between the sun and the planets, and it’s likely that the planets and satellites vary in their individual heat as well as in the heat they receive from the sun. When we consider that, in addition to these various differences, the planets and satellites also vary in their distances from one another and their main bodies; in the angles of their orbits, the tilts of their axes, their rotation periods, their specific gravities, and their physical makeups; we can see how diverse the solar system is compared to the almost total uniformity of the nebulous mass from which it is believed to have formed.
§ 45. Passing from this hypothetical illustration, which must be taken for what it is worth, without prejudice to the general argument, let us descend to a more certain order of evidence.
§ 45. Moving on from this hypothetical example, which should be considered for its worth, without affecting the overall argument, let's shift to a more reliable set of evidence.
It is now generally agreed among geologists that the Earth was at first a mass of molten matter; and that it is still fluid and incandescent at the distance of a few miles beneath its surface. Originally, then, it was homogeneous in consistence, and, because of the circulation that takes place in heated fluids, must have been comparatively homogeneous in temperature; and it must have been surrounded by an atmosphere consisting partly of the elements of air and water, and partly of those various other elements which assume a gaseous form at high temperatures. That slow cooling by radiation which is still going on at an inappreciable rate, and which, though originally far more rapid than now, necessarily required an immense time to produce any decided change, must ultimately have resulted in the solidification of the portion most able to part with its heat; namely, the surface. In the thin crust thus formed, we have the first marked differentiation. A still further cooling, a consequent thickening of this crust, and an accompanying deposition of all solidifiable elements contained in the atmosphere, must finally have been followed by the 151condensation of the water previously existing as vapour. A second marked differentiation must thus have arisen; and as the condensation must have taken place on the coolest parts of the surface—namely, about the poles—there must thus have resulted the first geographical distinction of parts.
It’s now widely accepted among geologists that the Earth started as a mass of molten material and that it’s still liquid and glowing just a few miles below the surface. Initially, it was uniform in consistency and, due to the circulation in heated fluids, it must have also been relatively uniform in temperature. It was likely surrounded by an atmosphere made up of elements of air and water, along with various other elements that become gas at high temperatures. The slow cooling process through radiation, which still happens at an almost negligible rate, initially occurred much faster but took a considerable amount of time to create any significant changes, ultimately leading to the solidification of the surface, which was most capable of losing heat. In this thin crust that formed, we see the first clear differentiation. Further cooling, thickening of this crust, and the settling of all solidifiable elements from the atmosphere would have eventually led to the condensation of the water that was previously vapor. This would have resulted in a second significant differentiation, and since condensation likely happened in the coolest areas—the poles—this would have created the first geographical distinctions.
To these illustrations of growing heterogeneity, which, though deduced from the known laws of matter, may be regarded as more or less hypothetical, Geology adds an extensive series that have been inductively established. Its investigations show that the Earth has been continually becoming more heterogeneous through the multiplication of the strata which form its crust; further, that it has been becoming more heterogeneous in respect of the composition of these strata, the latter of which, being made from the detritus of the older ones, are many of them rendered highly complex by the mixture of materials they contain; and that this heterogeneity has been vastly increased by the action of the Earth’s still molten nucleus upon its envelope: whence have resulted not only a great variety of igneous rocks, but the tilting up of sedimentary strata at all angles, the formation of faults and metallic veins, the production of endless dislocations and irregularities. Yet again, geologists teach us that the Earth’s surface has been growing more varied in elevation—that the most ancient mountain systems are the smallest, and the Andes and Himalayas the most modern; while, in all probability, there have been corresponding changes in the bed of the ocean. As a consequence of these ceaseless differentiations, we now find that no considerable portion of the Earth’s exposed surface is like any other portion, either in contour, in geologic structure, or in chemical composition; and that in most parts it changes from mile to mile in all these characteristics.
To these examples of increasing diversity, which, although based on the established laws of matter, can be considered somewhat hypothetical, Geology contributes a large series of findings that have been established through induction. Its studies indicate that the Earth has continuously become more diverse through the layering of sediments that form its crust; additionally, it has become more diverse in terms of the composition of these layers, many of which, formed from the debris of older layers, are enriched with a complex mix of materials. This diversity has been significantly increased by the activity of the Earth’s still molten core on its outer layers, resulting not only in a wide range of igneous rocks but also in the tilting of sedimentary layers at various angles, the creation of faults and metallic veins, and countless dislocations and irregularities. Moreover, geologists tell us that the Earth’s surface has been becoming more varied in height—where the oldest mountain ranges are the shortest and the Andes and Himalayas are the newest; likely, there have also been corresponding changes in the ocean floor. As a result of these continuous differentiations, we now find that no significant area of the Earth’s exposed surface is like any other area, either in shape, in geological structure, or in chemical makeup; and that in most places, these characteristics vary from mile to mile.
Moreover, it must not be forgotten that there has been simultaneously going on a gradual differentiation of climates. As fast as the Earth cooled and its crust solidified, there arose appreciable differences in temperature between those parts of its surface most exposed to the sun and those less exposed. 152Gradually, as the cooling progressed, these differences became more pronounced; until there finally resulted the marked contrasts between regions of perpetual ice and snow, regions where winter and summer alternately reign for periods varying according to the latitude, and regions where summer follows summer with scarcely an appreciable variation. At the same time, the successive elevations and subsidences of different portions of the Earth’s crust, tending as they have done to the present irregular distribution of land and sea, have entailed various modifications of climate beyond those dependent on latitude; while a yet further series of such modifications have been produced by increasing differences of elevation in the land, which have in sundry places brought arctic, temperate, and tropical climates to within a few miles of each other. And the general result of these changes is, that not only has every extensive region its own meteorologic conditions, but that every locality in each region differs more or less from others in those conditions: as in its structure, its contour, its soil.
Moreover, it's important to remember that a gradual differentiation of climates has been happening at the same time. As the Earth cooled and its crust solidified, noticeable temperature differences emerged between the areas most exposed to the sun and those less exposed. 152 Gradually, as the cooling continued, these differences became more pronounced, leading to significant contrasts between regions of permanent ice and snow, regions where winter and summer alternate for varying lengths of time depending on latitude, and regions where summers follow one after another with little variation. At the same time, different parts of the Earth's crust have undergone various elevations and subsidences, contributing to the current uneven distribution of land and sea, which has caused various climate modifications beyond just latitude. Additionally, increasing differences in elevation have created situations where arctic, temperate, and tropical climates can be found just a few miles apart. The overall result of these changes is that not only does every large region have its own weather conditions, but each locality within those regions varies more or less in those conditions: including its structure, shape, and soil.
Thus, between our existing Earth, the phenomena of whose varied crust neither geographers, geologists, mineralogists nor meteorologists have yet enumerated, and the molten globe out of which it was evolved, the contrast in heterogeneity is sufficiently striking.
Thus, between our current Earth, whose various surface features neither geographers, geologists, mineralogists, nor meteorologists have fully classified, and the molten core from which it was formed, the difference in diversity is quite striking.
§ 46. When from the Earth itself we turn to the plants and animals that have lived, or still live, upon its surface, we find ourselves in some difficulty from lack of facts. That every existing organism has been developed out of the simple into the complex, is indeed the first established truth of all; and that every organism which has existed was similarly developed, is an inference that no physiologist will hesitate to draw. But when we pass from individual forms of life to Life in general, and inquire whether the same law is seen in the ensemble of its manifestations,—whether modern plants and animals are of more heterogeneous structure than ancient ones, 153and whether the Earth’s present Flora and Fauna are more heterogeneous than the Flora and Fauna of the past,—we find the evidence so fragmentary, that every conclusion is open to dispute. Two-thirds of the Earth’s surface being covered by water; a great part of the exposed land being inaccessible to, or untravelled by, the geologist; the greater part of the remainder having been scarcely more than glanced at; and even the most familiar portions, as England, having been so imperfectly explored, that a new series of strata has been added within these few years,—it is manifestly impossible for us to say with any certainty what creatures have, and what have not, existed at any particular period. Considering the perishable nature of many of the lower organic forms, the metamorphosis of many sedimentary strata, and the gaps that occur among the rest, we shall see further reason for distrusting our deductions. On the one hand, the repeated discovery of vertebrate remains in strata previously supposed to contain none,—of reptiles where only fish were thought to exist,—of mammals where it was believed there were no creatures higher than reptiles; renders it daily more manifest how small is the value of negative evidence. On the other hand, the worthlessness of the assumption that we have discovered the earliest, or anything like the earliest, organic remains, is becoming equally clear. That the oldest known aqueous formations have been greatly changed by igneous action, and that still older ones have been totally transformed by it, is becoming undeniable. And the fact that sedimentary strata earlier than any we know, have been melted up, being admitted, it must also be admitted that we cannot say how far back in time this destruction of sedimentary strata has been going on. Thus it is manifest that the title Palæozoic, as applied to the earliest known fossiliferous strata, involves a petitio principii; and that, for aught we know to the contrary, only the last few chapters of the Earth’s biological history may have come down to us.
§ 46. When we shift our focus from the Earth itself to the plants and animals that have lived, or still live, on its surface, we encounter some difficulties due to a lack of facts. It’s indeed a well-established truth that every existing organism has developed from simple to complex forms; and the idea that every organism that has ever existed was developed in the same way is a conclusion that no physiologist would dispute. However, when we move from individual life forms to Life as a whole and ask whether the same pattern is evident in the overall manifestations—whether modern plants and animals are more diverse than ancient ones, and whether today's Flora and Fauna are more varied than those from the past—we find the evidence so limited that any conclusions are up for debate. With two-thirds of the Earth's surface covered by water, much of the exposed land being inaccessible or unexplored by geologists, and even the most familiar areas, like England, having been so incompletely surveyed that new layers of rock have been identified in recent years—it’s clear that we cannot definitively say which creatures existed and which did not at any specific time. Given the fragile nature of many lower organic forms, the transformation of many sedimentary layers, and the gaps that exist among the rest, there's ample reason to question our conclusions. On one hand, the repeated discovery of vertebrate fossils in layers previously thought to contain none—of reptiles where only fish were believed to be present—of mammals where it was assumed no creatures more advanced than reptiles existed—illustrates just how limited the value of negative evidence is. On the other hand, it’s becoming just as clear that the assumption we've found the oldest, or anything close to the oldest, organic remains is worthless. It is undeniable that the oldest known aquatic formations have been significantly altered by volcanic activity, and that even older formations have been completely transformed by it. With the acknowledgment that sedimentary layers older than any we currently know have been melted down, we must also recognize that we cannot determine how far back in time this destruction of sedimentary layers has been ongoing. Therefore, it’s evident that the term Palæozoic, as applied to the earliest known fossil-bearing layers, involves a begging the question; and for all we know, only the last few chapters of the Earth's biological history may have been preserved for us.
All inferences drawn from such scattered facts as we find, 154must thus be extremely questionable. If, looking at the general aspect of evidence, a progressionist argues that the earliest known vertebrate remains are those of Fishes, which are the most homogeneous of the vertebrata; that Reptiles, which are more heterogeneous, are later; and that later still, and more heterogeneous still, are Mammals and Birds; it may be replied that the Palæozoic deposits, not being estuary deposits, are not likely to contain the remains of terrestrial vertebrata, which may nevertheless have existed at that era. The same answer may be made to the argument that the vertebrate fauna of the Palæozoic period, consisting so far as we know, entirely of Fishes, was less heterogeneous than the modern vertebrate fauna, which includes Reptiles, Birds and Mammals, of multitudinous genera; or the uniformitarian may contend with great show of truth, that this appearance of higher and more varied forms in later geologic eras, was due to progressive immigration—that a continent slowly upheaved from the ocean at a point remote from pre-existing continents, would necessarily be peopled from them in a succession like that which our strata display. At the same time the counter-arguments may be proved equally inconclusive. When, to show that there cannot have been a continuous evolution of the more homogeneous organic forms into the more heterogeneous ones, the uniformitarian points to the breaks that occur in the succession of these forms; there is the sufficient answer that current geological changes show us why such breaks must occur, and why, by subsidences and elevations of large area, there must be produced such marked breaks as those which divide the three great geologic epochs. Or again, if the opponent of the development hypothesis cites the facts set forth by Professor Huxley in his lecture on “Persistent Types”—if he points out that “of some two hundred known orders of plants, not one is exclusively fossil,” while “among animals, there is not a single totally extinct class; and of the orders, at the outside not more than seven per cent. are unrepresented in the existing creation”—if he 155urges that among these some have continued from the Silurian epoch to our own day with scarcely any change—and if he infers that there is evidently a much greater average resemblance between the living forms of the past and those of the present, than consists with this hypothesis; there is still a satisfactory reply, on which in fact Prof. Huxley insists; namely, that we have evidence of a “pre-geologic era” of unknown duration. And indeed, when it is remembered, that the enormous subsidences of the Silurian period show the Earth’s crust to have been approximately as thick then as it is now—when it is concluded that the time taken to form so thick a crust, must have been immense as compared with the time which has since elapsed—when it is assumed, as it must be, that during this comparatively immense time the geologic and biologic changes went on at their usual rates; it becomes manifest, not only that the palæontological records which we find, do not negative the theory of evolution, but that they are such as might rationally be looked for.
All conclusions made from the scattered facts we have are therefore quite questionable. If a progressive thinker argues that the earliest known vertebrate remains are Fishes, which are the most uniform of vertebrates; that Reptiles, which are more diverse, appeared later; and that Mammals and Birds, which are even more diverse, came even later; one could argue that the Paleozoic deposits, which aren’t estuary deposits, are unlikely to contain remains of land vertebrates, even if they may have existed back then. The same response applies to the claim that the vertebrate life of the Paleozoic period, which as far as we know consisted entirely of Fishes, was less diverse than today’s vertebrate life, which includes Reptiles, Birds, and Mammals from countless genera. The uniformitarian might convincingly argue that the appearance of more advanced and varied forms in later geological eras is due to progressive immigration—that a continent emerging slowly from the ocean, far from existing continents, would gradually be populated by them in a sequence similar to what our rock layers show. At the same time, the counterarguments can also be shown to be inconclusive. When a uniformitarian points out the gaps in the succession of these forms to argue against a continuous evolution from the simpler to the more complex, it can be sufficiently answered that current geological changes explain why such gaps happen, and why major subsidence and elevation of large areas must create the distinct breaks that separate the three major geological epochs. Alternatively, if a critic of the development hypothesis cites facts from Professor Huxley's lecture on “Persistent Types”—if they highlight that “of about two hundred known orders of plants, none are entirely fossil,” while “among animals, there’s not a single completely extinct class; and at most, no more than seven percent of the orders are unrepresented in current life”—if they emphasize that some of these have persisted from the Silurian era to today with hardly any change—and if they imply that there's clearly a greater average resemblance between living forms of the past and those of today than this hypothesis allows for; there remains a solid response, which Professor Huxley indeed supports: that we have evidence of a “pre-geologic era” of unknown length. And when we remember that the significant subsidence of the Silurian period shows the Earth’s crust to have been about as thick back then as it is now—when we conclude that the time needed to create such a thick crust must have been immense compared to the time that followed—when we assume that during this relatively vast period, geological and biological changes occurred at their typical rates; it becomes clear that not only do the paleontological records we find not contradict the theory of evolution, but they also logically match what we would expect.
Moreover, it must not be forgotten that though the evidence suffices neither for proof nor disproof, yet some of its most conspicuous facts support the belief, that the more heterogeneous organisms and groups of organisms, have been evolved from the less heterogeneous ones. The average community of type between the fossils of adjacent strata, and still more the community that is found between the latest tertiary fossils and creatures now existing, is one of these facts. The discovery in some modern deposits of such forms as the Palæotherium and Anaplotherium, which, if we may rely on Prof. Owen, had a type of structure intermediate between some of the types now existing, is another of these facts. And the comparatively recent appearance of Man, is a third fact of this kind, which possesses still greater significance. Hence we may say, that though our knowledge of past life upon the Earth, is too scanty to justify us in asserting an evolution of the simple into the complex, either in individual forms or in 156the aggregate of forms; yet the knowledge we have, not only consists with the belief that there has been such an evolution, but rather supports it than otherwise.
Moreover, we must remember that while the evidence doesn’t fully prove or disprove anything, some of its most noticeable facts support the idea that more diverse organisms and groups of organisms have evolved from less diverse ones. The average similarity between fossils in adjacent layers, and especially the similarity found between the latest tertiary fossils and currently existing creatures, is one of these facts. The discovery of forms like the Palæotherium and Anaplotherium in some modern deposits, which Prof. Owen suggests had a structure type that falls between some of the existing types, is another of these facts. The relatively recent emergence of humans is a third fact of this kind, which is even more significant. Therefore, we can say that while our knowledge of past life on Earth is too limited to confidently claim an evolution from simple to complex, either in individual forms or in the overall collection of forms, what we do know not only aligns with the belief that such an evolution has occurred but also supports it.
§ 47. Whether an advance from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous is or is not displayed in the biological history of the globe, it is clearly enough displayed in the progress of the latest and most heterogeneous creature—Man. It is alike true that, during the period in which the Earth has been peopled, the human organism has grown more heterogeneous among the civilized divisions of the species; and that the species, as a whole, has been made more heterogeneous by the multiplication of races and the differentiation of these races from each other. In proof of the first of these positions, we may cite the fact that, in the relative development of the limbs, the civilized man departs more widely from the general type of the placental mammalia, than do the lower human races. Though often possessing well-developed body and arms, the Papuan has extremely small legs: thus reminding us of the quadrumana, in which there is no great contrast in size between the hind and fore limbs. But in the European, the greater length and massiveness of the legs has become very marked—the fore and hind limbs are relatively more heterogeneous. Again, the greater ratio which the cranial bones bear to the facial bones, illustrates the same truth. Among the vertebrata in general, evolution is marked by an increasing heterogeneity in the vertebral column, and more especially in the segments constituting the skull: the higher forms being distinguished by the relatively larger size of the bones which cover the brain, and the relatively smaller size of those which form the jaws, &c. Now, this characteristic, which is stronger in Man than in any other creature, is stronger in the European than in the savage. Moreover, judging from the greater extent and variety of faculty he exhibits, we may infer that the civilized man has also a more complex or heterogeneous nervous system than the uncivilized 157man; and indeed the fact is in part visible in the increased ratio which his cerebrum bears to the subjacent ganglia. If further elucidation be needed, we may find it in every nursery. The infant European has sundry marked points of resemblance to the lower human races; as in the flatness of the alæ of the nose, the depression of its bridge, the divergence and forward opening of the nostrils, the form of the lips, the absence of a frontal sinus, the width between the eyes, the smallness of the legs. Now, as the developmental process by which these traits are turned into those of the adult European, is a continuation of that change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous displayed during the previous evolution of the embryo, which every physiologist will admit; it follows that the parallel developmental process by which the like traits of the barbarous races have been turned into those of the civilized races, has also been a continuation of the change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. The truth of the second position—that Mankind, as a whole, have become more heterogeneous—is so obvious as scarcely to need illustration. Every work on Ethnology, by its divisions and subdivisions of races, bears testimony to it. Even were we to admit the hypothesis that Mankind originated from several separate stocks, it would still remain true that as, from each of these stocks, there have sprung many now widely different tribes, which are proved by philological evidence to have had a common origin, the race as a whole is far less homogeneous than it once was. Add to which, that we have, in the Anglo-Americans, an example of a new variety arising within these few generations; and that, if we may trust to the descriptions of observers, we are likely soon to have another such example in Australia.
§ 47. Whether there is a shift from the similar to the different in the biological history of the Earth is clearly seen in the evolution of the latest and most diverse creature—Humans. It is also true that, during the time the Earth has been inhabited, the human body has become more diverse among the civilized groups; and that the species as a whole has become more diverse due to the rise of different races and the variations among these races. To support the first point, we can mention that, in the relative development of limbs, civilized humans differ more from the general type of placental mammals than do the lower human races. While often having well-developed bodies and arms, Papuans have very small legs, resembling the quadrupeds, where there is little size difference between the hind and forelimbs. In contrast, Europeans show a distinct increase in the length and robustness of their legs—making the fore and hind limbs relatively more different. Additionally, the greater proportion of the cranial bones compared to the facial bones illustrates the same idea. Among vertebrates in general, evolution is characterized by increasing diversity in the vertebral column, especially in the segments forming the skull: higher forms are marked by relatively larger bones that protect the brain and relatively smaller bones that make up the jaws, etc. This characteristic is more pronounced in Humans than in any other creature and is even more pronounced in Europeans than in primitive people. Furthermore, based on the greater range and variety of abilities they display, we can infer that civilized individuals have a more complex or varied nervous system compared to uncivilized individuals; indeed, this is partially visible in the increased ratio of the cerebrum to the underlying ganglia. If further clarification is needed, we can see it in every nursery. The European infant shares several notable similarities with lower human races, such as the flatness of the nose's wings, the indentation of its bridge, the outward opening and divergence of the nostrils, the shape of the lips, the absence of a frontal sinus, the space between the eyes, and the smallness of the legs. Now, as the growth process by which these traits develop into those of the adult European is a continuation of the shift from the similar to the different seen in the earlier evolution of the embryo—which every physiologist will confirm—it follows that the comparable development process transforming the traits of primitive races into those of civilized races has also been a continuation of the shift from the similar to the different. The truth of the second point—that Humanity as a whole has become more diverse—is so clear that it hardly requires illustration. Every work on Ethnology, with its classifications and subdivisions of races, provides evidence for this. Even if we were to accept the theory that Humanity originated from several distinct lineages, it would still be true that from each of these lineages, many now vastly different tribes have emerged, which are shown by linguistic evidence to share a common origin, making the race as a whole much less uniform than it once was. In addition, we have the Anglo-Americans as an example of a new variety emerging within just a few generations; and if we can trust the observations of others, we are likely soon to see another such example in Australia.
§ 48. On passing from Humanity under its individual form, to Humanity as socially embodied, we find the general law still more variously exemplified. The change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous, is displayed equally in the 158progress of civilization as a whole, and in the progress of every tribe or nation; and is still going on with increasing rapidity.
§ 48. When moving from individual humanity to humanity as a social entity, we see the general law reflected in even more diverse ways. The shift from uniformity to diversity is evident in the overall progress of civilization as well as in the development of each tribe or nation; and this change is continuing at an accelerating pace.
As we see in existing barbarous tribes, society in its first and lowest form is a homogeneous aggregation of individuals having like powers and like functions: the only marked difference of function being that which accompanies difference of sex. Every man is warrior, hunter, fisherman, tool-maker, builder; every woman performs the same drudgeries; every family is self-sufficing, and, save for purposes of aggression and defence, might as well live apart from the rest. Very early, however, in the process of social evolution, we find an incipient differentiation between the governing and the governed. Some kind of chieftainship seems coeval with the first advance from the state of separate wandering families to that of a nomadic tribe. The authority of the strongest makes itself felt among a body of savages, as in a herd of animals, or a posse of school-boys. At first, however, it is indefinite, uncertain; is shared by others of scarcely inferior power; and is unaccompanied by any difference in occupation or style of living: the first ruler kills his own game, makes his own weapons, builds his own hut, and, economically considered, does not differ from others of his tribe. Gradually, as the tribe progresses, the contrast between the governing and the governed grows more decided. Supreme power becomes hereditary in one family; the head of that family, ceasing to provide for his own wants, is served by others; and he begins to assume the sole office of ruling. At the same time there has been arising a co-ordinate species of government—that of Religion. As all ancient records and traditions prove, the earliest rulers are regarded as divine personages. The maxims and commands they uttered during their lives are held sacred after their deaths, and are enforced by their divinely-descended successors; who in their turns are promoted to the pantheon of the race, there to be worshipped and propitiated along with their predecessors: the most ancient 159of whom is the supreme god, and the rest subordinate gods. For a long time these connate forms of government—civil and religious—continue closely associated. For many generations the king continues to be the chief priest, and the priesthood to be members of the royal race. For many ages religious law continues to contain more or less of civil regulation, and civil law to possess more or less of religious sanction; and even among the most advanced nations these two controlling agencies are by no means completely differentiated from each other. Having a common root with these, and gradually diverging from them, we find yet another controlling agency—that of Manners or ceremonial usages. All titles of honour are originally the names of the god-king; afterwards of God and the king; still later of persons of high rank; and finally come, some of them, to be used between man and man. All forms of complimentary address were at first the expressions of submission from prisoners to their conqueror, or from subjects to their ruler, either human or divine—expressions that were afterwards used to propitiate subordinate authorities, and slowly descended into ordinary intercourse. All modes of salutation were once obeisances made before the monarch and used in worship of him after his death. Presently others of the god-descended race were similarly saluted; and by degrees some of the salutations have become the due of all.[9] Thus, no sooner does the originally homogeneous social mass differentiate into the governed and the governing parts, than this last exhibits an incipient differentiation into religious and secular—Church and State; while at the same time there begins to be differentiated from both, that less definite species of government which rides our daily intercourse—a species of government which, as we may see in heralds’ colleges, in books of the peerage, in masters of ceremonies, is not without a certain embodiment of its own. Each of these kinds of government is itself subject to successive differentiations. In the course of ages, there 160arises, as among ourselves, a highly complex political organization of monarch, ministers, lords and commons, with their subordinate administrative departments, courts of justice, revenue offices, &c., supplemented in the provinces by municipal governments, county governments, parish or union governments—all of them more or less elaborated. By its side there grows up a highly complex religious organization, with its various grades of officials from archbishops down to sextons, its colleges, convocations, ecclesiastical courts, &c.; to all which must be added the ever-multiplying independent sects, each with its general and local authorities. And at the same time there is developed a highly complex aggregation of customs, manners, and temporary fashions, enforced by society at large, and serving to control those minor transactions between man and man which are not regulated by civil and religious law. Moreover, it is to be observed that this ever-increasing heterogeneity in the governmental appliances of each nation, has been accompanied by an increasing heterogeneity in the governmental appliances of different nations: all of which are more or less unlike in their political systems and legislation, in their creeds and religious institutions, in their customs and ceremonial usages.
As we see in existing primitive tribes, society in its earliest and simplest form is a group of individuals with similar abilities and roles: the only notable difference in roles being based on gender. Every man is a warrior, hunter, fisherman, tool-maker, and builder; every woman does the same types of hard work; each family is self-sufficient and, except for purposes of attack and defense, could just as well live independently from others. However, very early in social evolution, we observe the beginning of a distinction between those who govern and those who are governed. Some kind of chieftaincy seems to arise alongside the first move from living as separate wandering families to forming a nomadic tribe. The authority of the strongest member is felt among a group of savages, similar to a herd of animals or a group of schoolboys. Initially, though, this authority is vague, uncertain; it is shared by others who are nearly as powerful; and it does not come with a difference in jobs or lifestyle: the first leader hunts his own food, makes his own tools, builds his own shelter, and, economically speaking, is not different from the other tribe members. Gradually, as the tribe develops, the difference between the rulers and the ruled becomes clearer. Ultimate power becomes hereditary within one family; the head of that family stops taking care of his own needs and is instead served by others; he starts to take on the exclusive role of ruling. At the same time, another form of government is emerging—that of Religion. As all ancient records and traditions indicate, the earliest rulers are seen as divine figures. The maxims and commands they gave during their lives are considered sacred after their deaths and are enforced by their divinely-descended successors; who in turn are elevated to the pantheon of their people, where they are worshipped and honored alongside their ancestors: the oldest of whom is the supreme god, and the others are subordinate gods. For a long time, these intertwined forms of governance—civil and religious—remain closely linked. For many generations, the king is also the chief priest, and the priesthood consists of members of the royal family. For many ages, religious law continues to include aspects of civil regulation, and civil law retains elements of religious sanction; and even among the most advanced nations, these two governing forces are not completely separated. Having a common origin with these, and gradually diverging from them, we find yet another governing force—that of Manners or ceremonial customs. All titles of honor originally refer to the god-king; later, they refer to God and the king; still later, to individuals of high rank; and ultimately, some of them come to be used between individuals. All forms of polite address were initially expressions of submission from prisoners to their conqueror or from subjects to their ruler, either human or divine—expressions that were later used to appease subordinate authorities and gradually entered ordinary interactions. All types of greetings were once gestures of respect made before the monarch and used in worship of him after his death. Eventually, others from the god-descended line were similarly greeted; and over time, some of these greetings have become the right of all. Thus, as soon as the originally uniform social group separates into the governed and the governing sectors, the latter starts to exhibit an initial distinction between religious and secular—Church and State; while at the same time, there begins to emerge from both a less defined form of governance that influences our daily interactions—a type of governance which, as we can see in heralds’ colleges, in books of peerage, and in masters of ceremonies, has its own distinct form. Each of these types of governance is itself subject to ongoing distinctions. Over the ages, there develops, as in our own society, a highly complex political structure of monarchs, ministers, lords, and commoners, with their subordinate administrative departments, courts of law, revenue offices, etc., further supplemented in local areas by municipal governments, county governments, parish or union governments—all more or less developed. Alongside it, a highly complex religious structure emerges, with various levels of officials from archbishops down to sextons, along with colleges, convocations, ecclesiastical courts, etc.; to which we must add the ever-increasing number of independent sects, each with its own general and local authorities. Simultaneously, there develops a highly complex web of customs, manners, and temporary fashions, enforced by society at large, which help regulate the minor interactions between individuals that are not governed by civil and religious law. Moreover, it should be noted that this continuous increase in diversity within each nation’s governing structures has been matched by an increasing diversity between the governing structures of different nations: all of which differ in their political systems and laws, in their beliefs and religious institutions, and in their customs and ceremonial practices.
Simultaneously there has been going on a second differentiation of a more familiar kind; that, namely, by which the mass of the community has been segregated into distinct classes and orders of workers. While the governing part has undergone the complex development above detailed, the governed part has undergone an equally complex development; which has resulted in that minute division of labour characterizing advanced nations. It is needless to trace out this progress from its first stages, up through the caste divisions of the East and the incorporated guilds of Europe, to the elaborate producing and distributing organization existing among ourselves. Political economists have long since indicated the evolution which, beginning with a tribe whose members severally perform the same actions, each for himself 161ends with a civilized community whose members severally perform different actions for each other; and they have further pointed out the changes through which the solitary producer of any one commodity, is transformed into a combination of producers who, united under a master, take separate parts in the manufacture of such commodity. But there are yet other and higher phases of this advance from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous in the industrial organization of society. Long after considerable progress has been made in the division of labour among the different classes of workers, there is still little or no division of labour among the widely separated parts of the community: the nation continues comparatively homogeneous in the respect that in each district the same occupations are pursued. But when roads and other means of transit become numerous and good, the different districts begin to assume different functions, and to become mutually dependent. The calico-manufacture locates itself in this county, the woollen-manufacture in that; silks are produced here, lace there; stockings in one place, shoes in another; pottery, hardware, cutlery, come to have their special towns; and ultimately every locality grows more or less distinguished from the rest by the leading occupation carried on in it. Nay, more, this subdivision of functions shows itself not only among the different parts of the same nation, but among different nations. That exchange of commodities which free-trade promises so greatly to increase, will ultimately have the effect of specializing, in a greater or less degree, the industry of each people. So that beginning with a barbarous tribe, almost if not quite homogeneous in the functions of its members, the progress has been, and still is, towards an economic aggregation of the whole human race; growing ever more heterogeneous in respect of the separate functions assumed by separate nations, the separate functions assumed by the local sections of each nation, the separate functions assumed by the many kinds of makers and traders in each town, and the separate functions assumed 162by the workers united in producing each commodity.
At the same time, there has been a second differentiation of a more familiar nature; specifically, the way in which the community has been divided into distinct classes and groups of workers. While those in power have experienced the complex development described above, those who are governed have also gone through an equally complex evolution; this has led to the detailed division of labor that defines advanced nations. It’s unnecessary to trace this progress from its early stages, through the caste systems of the East and the guild structures of Europe, to the sophisticated production and distribution systems we have today. Political economists have long pointed out the evolution that, starting with a tribe where members individually perform the same tasks, culminates in a civilized society where members perform different tasks for one another. They have noted the changes where a single producer of a commodity transforms into a collective of producers who, united under a leader, take on different roles in manufacturing that commodity. However, there are further and more advanced stages of this shift from uniformity to diversity in the industrial organization of society. Long after significant progress has been made in the division of labor among various classes of workers, there is still limited or no division of labor among the widely separated sectors of the community: the nation remains relatively uniform in that each region engages in similar jobs. But as transportation methods like roads improve and multiply, different areas start to take on distinct roles and become interdependent. Cotton manufacturing settles in one county, woolen manufacturing in another; silk is produced here, lace there; stockings in one place, shoes in another; pottery, hardware, and cutlery develop their own specialty towns; ultimately, each region becomes more or less characterized by its main industry. Moreover, this division of labor appears not only among different parts of the same nation but also among different nations. The exchange of goods that free trade promises to enhance will eventually lead to a greater or lesser degree of specialization in each nation's industry. Thus, starting with a primitive tribe, almost entirely uniform in the roles of its members, progress has been, and continues to be, towards an economic integration of the entire human race; becoming increasingly diverse concerning the distinct roles taken on by different nations, the separate roles taken by local sections of each nation, the various roles assumed by different types of manufacturers and traders in each town, and the separate roles taken by the workers grouped together in producing each commodity.
§ 49. Not only is the law thus clearly exemplified in the evolution of the social organism, but it is exemplified with equal clearness in the evolution of all products of human thought and action; whether concrete or abstract, real or ideal. Let us take Language as our first illustration.
§ 49. Not only is the law clearly shown in the development of the social organism, but it is also clearly shown in the development of all products of human thought and action; whether they are concrete or abstract, real or ideal. Let’s use language as our first example.
The lowest form of language is the exclamation, by which an entire idea is vaguely conveyed through a single sound; as among the lower animals. That human language ever consisted solely of exclamations, and so was strictly homogeneous in respect of its parts of speech, we have no evidence. But that language can be traced down to a form in which nouns and verbs are its only elements, is an established fact. In the gradual multiplication of parts of speech out of these primary ones—in the differentiation of verbs into active and passive, of nouns into abstract and concrete—in the rise of distinctions of mood, tense, person, of number and case—in the formation of auxiliary verbs, of adjectives, adverbs, pronouns, prepositions, articles—in the divergence of those orders, genera, species, and varieties of parts of speech by which civilized races express minute modifications of meaning—we see a change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. And it may be remarked, in passing, that it is more especially in virtue of having carried this subdivision of functions to a greater extent and completeness, that the English language is superior to all others. Another aspect under which we may trace the development of language, is the differentiation of words of allied meanings. Philology early disclosed the truth that in all languages words may be grouped into families having a common ancestry. An aboriginal name, applied indiscriminately to each of an extensive and ill-defined class of things or actions, presently undergoes modifications by which the chief divisions of the class are expressed. These several names springing 163from the primitive root, themselves become the parents of other names still further modified. And by the aid of those systematic modes which presently arise, of making derivatives and forming compound terms expressing still smaller distinctions, there is finally developed a tribe of words so heterogeneous in sound and meaning, that to the uninitiated it seems incredible they should have had a common origin. Meanwhile, from other roots there are being evolved other such tribes, until there results a language of some sixty thousand or more unlike words, signifying as many unlike objects, qualities, acts. Yet another way in which language in general advances from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous, is in the multiplication of languages. Whether, as Max Müller and Bunsen think, all languages have grown from one stock, or whether, as some philologists say, they have grown from two or more stocks, it is clear that since large families of languages, as the Indo-European, are of one parentage, they have become distinct through a process of continuous divergence. The same diffusion over the Earth’s surface which has led to the differentiation of the race, has simultaneously led to a differentiation of their speech: a truth which we see further illustrated in each nation by the peculiarities of dialect found in separate districts. Thus the progress of Language conforms to the general law, alike in the evolution of languages, in the evolution of families of words, and in the evolution of parts of speech.
The simplest form of language is the exclamation, which conveys an entire idea vaguely through a single sound, much like it does among animals. We have no evidence to suggest that human language ever consisted entirely of exclamations, meaning it was strictly uniform in its parts of speech. However, it’s a well-established fact that language can be traced back to a form where only nouns and verbs are present. Through the gradual expansion of parts of speech from these basic elements — as verbs differentiate into active and passive, nouns split into abstract and concrete, and distinctions in mood, tense, person, number, and case arise — through the formation of auxiliary verbs, adjectives, adverbs, pronouns, prepositions, and articles — and the branching out of those orders, kinds, types, and varieties of parts of speech that civilized cultures use to express subtle changes in meaning — we see a shift from uniformity to diversity. It’s worth noting that the English language is particularly advanced in this subdivision of functions, making it superior to all others. Another aspect through which we can trace the evolution of language is the differentiation of words with related meanings. Linguistics early revealed that across all languages, words can be organized into families stemming from a common origin. An original name, which was applied indiscriminately to a broad and vague class of things or actions, eventually undergoes changes that express the main divisions of the class. These various names, derived from the primitive root, become the sources of other names that are further modified. With the help of systematic methods that emerge for creating derivatives and forming compound terms that express even smaller distinctions, we ultimately develop a collection of words so diverse in sound and meaning that, to those unfamiliar, it seems unbelievable they share a common origin. Meanwhile, other tribes of words are evolving from different roots, leading to the creation of a language with sixty thousand or more distinct words, each representing unique objects, qualities, and actions. Another way in which language in general progresses from uniformity to diversity is through the multiplication of languages. Whether, as Max Müller and Bunsen believe, all languages have evolved from a single source, or whether, as some linguists suggest, they have developed from two or more sources, it’s evident that major families of languages, like the Indo-European, share a common ancestry. They have become distinct through a process of continuous divergence. The same migration across the Earth’s surface that has led to the differentiation of races has also caused the divergence of their languages: a truth further illustrated by the unique dialects found in different regions within each nation. Therefore, the evolution of language follows a general principle, evident in the development of languages, families of words, and parts of speech.
On passing from spoken to written language, we come upon several classes of facts, all having similar implications. Written language is connate with Painting and Sculpture; and at first all three are appendages of Architecture, and have a direct connexion with the primary form of all Government—the theocratic. Merely noting by the way the fact that sundry wild races, as for example the Australians and the tribes of South Africa, are given to depicting personages and events upon the walls of caves, which are probably regarded 164as sacred places, let us pass to the case of the Egyptians. Among them, as also among the Assyrians, we find mural paintings used to decorate the temple of the god and the palace of the king (which were, indeed, originally identical); and as such they were governmental appliances in the same sense that state-pageants and religious feasts were. Further, they were governmental appliances in virtue of representing the worship of the god, the triumphs of the god-king, the submission of his subjects, and the punishment of the rebellious. And yet again they were governmental, as being the products of an art reverenced by the people as a sacred mystery. From the habitual use of this pictorial representation, there naturally grew up the but slightly-modified practice of picture-writing—a practice which was found still extant among the Mexicans at the time they were discovered. By abbreviations analogous to those still going on in our own written and spoken language, the most familiar of these pictured figures were successively simplified; and ultimately there grew up a system of symbols, most of which had but a distant resemblance to the things for which they stood. The inference that the hieroglyphics of the Egyptians were thus produced, is confirmed by the fact that the picture-writing of the Mexicans was found to have given birth to a like family of ideographic forms; and among them, as among the Egyptians, these had been partially differentiated into the kuriological or imitative, and the tropical or symbolic: which were, however, used together in the same record. In Egypt, written language underwent a further differentiation; whence resulted the hieratic and the epistolographic or enchorial: both of which are derived from the original hieroglyphic. At the same time we find that for the expression of proper names, which could not be otherwise conveyed, phonetic symbols were employed; and though it is alleged that the Egyptians never actually achieved complete alphabetic writing, yet it can scarcely be doubted that these phonetic symbols occasionally used in aid of their 165ideographic ones, were the germs out of which alphabetic writing grew. Once having become separate from hieroglyphics, alphabetic writing itself underwent numerous differentiations—multiplied alphabets were produced: between most of which, however, more or less connexion can still be traced. And in each civilized nation there has now grown up, for the representation of one set of sounds, several sets of written signs, used for distinct purposes. Finally, through a yet more important differentiation came printing; which, uniform in kind as it was at first, has since become multiform.
Upon moving from spoken to written language, we encounter several types of facts, all with similar implications. Written language is linked to painting and sculpture; initially, all three are extensions of architecture and have a direct connection to the original form of government—the theocratic. Noting that some primitive cultures, like the Australians and tribes in South Africa, tend to depict figures and events on cave walls, which are likely seen as sacred places, we turn to the case of the Egyptians. Among them, as with the Assyrians, mural paintings were used to adorn the temple of the god and the palace of the king (which were originally the same); and these served as governmental tools in the same way that state ceremonies and religious festivals did. Furthermore, they functioned as governmental tools because they represented the worship of the god, the victories of the god-king, the obedience of his subjects, and the punishment of rebels. Additionally, they were governmental because they resulted from an art that the people revered as a sacred mystery. From the regular use of this pictorial representation, the slightly modified practice of picture-writing naturally developed—a practice that still existed among the Mexicans when they were discovered. Through abbreviations similar to those still in use today in our own spoken and written language, the most recognizable of these pictured figures were gradually simplified; eventually, a system of symbols emerged, most of which only vaguely resembled the things they represented. The conclusion that Egyptian hieroglyphics arose in this way is supported by the fact that the picture-writing of the Mexicans led to a similar family of ideographic forms; and among them, as with the Egyptians, these were partially categorized into the kuriological or imitative, and the tropical or symbolic: which were nevertheless used together in the same records. In Egypt, written language underwent further differentiation, resulting in hieratic and epistolographic or enchorial: both of which derive from the original hieroglyphic. At the same time, we see that phonetic symbols were used for proper names, which couldn't be communicated otherwise; and while it is stated that the Egyptians never fully developed alphabetic writing, it is hard to deny that these phonetic symbols, sometimes used alongside their ideographic ones, were the precursors to alphabetic writing. Once alphabetic writing separated from hieroglyphics, it underwent numerous changes—resulting in multiple alphabets, most of which still have some connection. Today, in each civilized nation, different sets of written signs have developed to represent one set of sounds for distinct purposes. Finally, through an even more significant differentiation came printing; which, while initially uniform, has since become diverse.
§ 50. While written language was passing through its earlier stages of development, the mural decoration which formed its root was being differentiated into Painting and Sculpture. The gods, kings, men, and animals represented, were originally marked by indented outlines and coloured. In most cases these outlines were of such depth, and the object they circumscribed so far rounded and marked out in its leading parts, as to form a species of work intermediate between intaglio and bas-relief. In other cases we see an advance upon this: the raised spaces between the figures being chiselled off, and the figures themselves appropriately tinted, a painted bas-relief was produced. The restored Assyrian architecture at Sydenham, exhibits this style of art carried to greater perfection—the persons and things represented, though still barbarously coloured, are carved out with more truth and in greater detail; and in the winged lions and bulls used for the angles of gateways, we may see a considerable advance towards a completely sculptured figure; which, nevertheless, is still coloured, and still forms part of the building. But while in Assyria the production of a statue proper, seems to have been little, if at all, attempted, we may trace in Egyptian art the gradual separation of the sculptured figure from the wall. A walk through the collection in the British Museum will clearly show this; while it will at the same time afford an opportunity of observing 166the evident traces which the independent statues bear of their derivation from bas-relief: seeing that nearly all of them not only display that union of the limbs with the body which is the characteristic of bas-relief, but have the back of the statue united from head to foot with a block which stands in place of the original wall. Greece repeated the leading stages of this progress. As in Egypt and Assyria, these twin arts were at first united with each other and with their parent, Architecture; and were the aids of Religion and Government. On the friezes of Greek temples, we see coloured bas-reliefs representing sacrifices, battles, processions, games—all in some sort religious. On the pediments we see painted sculptures more or less united with the tympanum, and having for subjects the triumphs of gods or heroes. Even when we come to statues that are definitely separated from the buildings to which they pertain, we still find them coloured; and only in the later periods of Greek civilization, does the differentiation of sculpture from painting appear to have become complete. In Christian art we may clearly trace a parallel re-genesis. All early paintings and sculptures throughout Europe, were religious in subject—represented Christs, crucifixions, virgins, holy families, apostles, saints. They formed integral parts of church architecture, and were among the means of exciting worship: as in Roman Catholic countries they still are. Moreover, the early sculptures of Christ on the cross, of virgins, of saints, were coloured; and it needs but to call to mind the painted madonnas and crucifixes still abundant in continental churches and highways, to perceive the significant fact that painting and sculpture continue in closest connexion with each other, where they continue in closest connexion with their parent. Even when Christian sculpture was pretty clearly differentiated from painting, it was still religious and governmental in its subjects—was used for tombs in churches and statues of kings; while, at the same time, painting, where not purely ecclesiastical, was applied to the 167decoration of palaces, and besides representing royal personages, was almost wholly devoted to sacred legends. Only in quite recent times have painting and sculpture become entirely secular arts. Only within these few centuries has painting been divided into historical, landscape, marine, architectural, genre, animal, still-life, &c., and sculpture grown heterogeneous in respect of the variety of real and ideal subjects with which it occupies itself.
§ 50. While written language was developing, the mural art that underpinned it was evolving into Painting and Sculpture. The depictions of gods, kings, humans, and animals were initially outlined with indentations and colors. In many instances, these outlines were deeply carved, and the objects they enclosed were rounded and highlighted in prominent areas, creating a kind of artwork that was between intaglio and bas-relief. In other cases, there was progress: the raised areas between the figures were carved away, and the figures themselves were colored appropriately, resulting in a painted bas-relief. The restored Assyrian architecture at Sydenham showcases this artistic style further refined—the depicted figures and objects, although still primitively colored, are carved with more accuracy and detail; in the winged lions and bulls used as corner supports for gateways, we can see a significant move towards a fully sculpted figure, which, however, remains colored and still part of the building. But in Assyria, creating an actual statue seems to have been minimally attempted, while in Egyptian art, we can observe the gradual separation of the sculpted figure from the wall. A walk through the collection in the British Museum clearly illustrates this; it also provides a chance to see the clear evidence of how independent statues evolved from bas-relief: as nearly all of them not only show the characteristic union of limbs with the body found in bas-relief but also have their backs connected from head to foot with a block that replaces the original wall. Greece mirrored these key stages of progress. Like in Egypt and Assyria, the two arts were initially intertwined with each other and their parent, Architecture; they supported Religion and Government. On the friezes of Greek temples, we can see colored bas-reliefs depicting sacrifices, battles, processions, and games—all of which have some religious significance. On the pediments, there are painted sculptures more or less connected with the tympanum, featuring themes of the victories of gods or heroes. Even when statues were clearly separated from the buildings they belonged to, they were still painted; only in the later periods of Greek civilization did sculpture and painting completely differentiate. In Christian art, we can clearly trace a similar rebirth. All early paintings and sculptures across Europe were religious in theme—depicting Christs, crucifixions, virgins, holy families, apostles, and saints. They formed integral parts of church architecture and helped inspire worship, as they still do in Roman Catholic countries. Additionally, early sculptures of Christ on the cross, of virgins, and of saints were painted; recalling the painted madonnas and crucifixes still found in continental churches and along highways makes it evident that painting and sculpture have remained closely connected where they still share ties with their origins. Even when Christian sculpture became somewhat distinct from painting, it still focused on religious and governmental subjects—used for tombs in churches and statues of kings; at the same time, painting, when not purely religious, was used to decorate palaces and, besides depicting royalty, was largely dedicated to sacred stories. Only in very recent times have painting and sculpture become entirely secular arts. Only over the past few centuries has painting been divided into historical, landscape, maritime, architectural, genre, animal, still life, etc., and sculpture diversified regarding the variety of real and ideal subjects it explores.
Strange as it seems then, we find it no less true, that all forms of written language, of painting, and of sculpture, have a common root in the politico-religious decorations of ancient temples and palaces. Little resemblance as they now have, the bust that stands on the console, the landscape that hangs against the wall, and the copy of the Times lying upon the table, are remotely akin; not only in nature, but by extraction. The brazen face of the knocker which the postman has just lifted, is related not only to the woodcuts of the Illustrated London News which he is delivering, but to the characters of the billet-doux which accompanies it. Between the painted window, the prayer-book on which its light falls, and the adjacent monument, there is consanguinity. The effigies on our coins, the signs over shops, the figures that fill every ledger, the coat of arms outside the carriage-panel, and the placards inside the omnibus, are, in common with dolls, blue-books and paper-hangings, lineally descended from the rude sculpture-paintings in which the Egyptians represented the triumphs and worship of their god-kings. Perhaps no example can be given which more vividly illustrates the multiplicity and heterogeneity of the products that in course of time may arise by successive differentiations from a common stock.
Strange as it may seem, we find it true that all forms of written language, painting, and sculpture share a common origin in the political and religious decorations of ancient temples and palaces. Although they look very different now, the bust on the shelf, the landscape painting on the wall, and the copy of the Times on the table are related, not only in nature but also by their origins. The shiny door knocker that the postman has just lifted is related not just to the woodcuts in the Illustrated London News he’s delivering but also to the characters in the love letter that comes with it. There’s a connection between the stained glass window, the prayer book that its light shines on, and the nearby monument. The images on our coins, the signs outside stores, the numbers in every ledger, the coat of arms on the carriage panel, and the posters inside the bus are all, like dolls, blueprints, and wallpaper, directly descended from the primitive sculpture and paintings the Egyptians used to show the triumphs and worship of their god-kings. Perhaps there’s no better example to highlight the variety and diversity of products that can develop over time through gradual differentiation from a common source.
Before passing to other classes of facts, it should be observed that the evolution of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous is displayed not only in the separation of Painting and Sculpture from Architecture and from each other, and in the greater variety of subjects they embody; but it is further shown in the structure of each work. A modern picture or 168statue is of far more heterogeneous nature than an ancient one. An Egyptian sculpture-fresco represents all its figures as on one plane—that is, at the same distance from the eye; and so is less heterogeneous than a painting that represents them as at various distances from the eye. It exhibits all objects as exposed to the same degree of light; and so is less heterogeneous than a painting which exhibits different objects, and different parts of each object, as in different degrees of light. It uses scarcely any but the primary colours, and these in their full intensity; and so is less heterogeneous than a painting which, introducing the primary colours but sparingly, employs an endless variety of intermediate tints, each of heterogeneous composition, and differing from the rest not only in quality but in intensity. Moreover, we see in these earliest works a great uniformity of conception. The same arrangement of figures is perpetually reproduced—the same actions, attitudes, faces, dresses. In Egypt the modes of representation were so fixed that it was sacrilege to introduce a novelty; and indeed it could have been only in consequence of a fixed mode of representation that a system of hieroglyphics became possible. The Assyrian bas-reliefs display parallel characters. Deities, kings, attendants, winged-figures and animals, are severally depicted in like positions, holding like implements, doing like things, and with like expression or non-expression of face. If a palm-grove is introduced, all the trees are of the same height, have the same number of leaves, and are equidistant. When water is imitated, each wave is a counterpart of the rest; and the fish, almost always of one kind, are evenly distributed over the surface. The beards of the kings, the gods, and the winged-figures, are everywhere similar; as are the manes of the lions, and equally so those of the horses. Hair is represented throughout by one form of curl. The king’s beard is quite architecturally built up of compound tiers of uniform curls, alternating with twisted tiers placed in a transverse direction, and arranged with perfect regularity; and the terminal tufts of the bulls’ tails are represented 169in exactly the same manner. Without tracing out analogous facts in early Christian art, in which, though less striking, they are still visible, the advance in heterogeneity will be sufficiently manifest on remembering that in the pictures of our own day the composition is endlessly varied; the attitudes, faces, expressions, unlike; the subordinate objects different in size, form, position, texture; and more or less of contrast even in the smallest details. Or, if we compare an Egyptian statue, seated bolt upright on a block, with hands on knees, fingers outspread and parallel, eyes looking straight forward, and the two sides perfectly symmetrical in every particular, with a statue of the advanced Greek or the modern school, which is asymmetrical in respect of the position of the head, the body, the limbs, the arrangement of the hair, dress, appendages, and in its relations to neighbouring objects, we shall see the change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous clearly manifested.
Before moving on to other types of facts, it's important to note that the transition from uniformity to diversity is evident not just in how Painting and Sculpture have separated from Architecture and from one another, but also in the wider range of subjects they represent. This change is further demonstrated in the structure of each artwork. A modern painting or statue is much more diverse than an ancient one. An Egyptian sculpture-fresco shows all its figures on the same plane—that is, at the same distance from the viewer; thus, it is less diverse than a painting that shows figures at various distances. It displays all objects under the same lighting conditions, making it less diverse than a painting that illustrates various objects and parts of objects in different lighting. It uses mostly primary colors, and these are shown in their full intensity; therefore, it is less diverse than a painting that, while using primary colors sparingly, features a wide range of intermediate shades, each with its own varied composition and differing intensity. Additionally, we observe a strong uniformity of concept in these early works. The same figure arrangements are constantly repeated—the same actions, postures, faces, and clothing. In Egypt, the methods of representation were so rigid that introducing any new elements was seen as sacrilegious; indeed, it was likely due to this strict method that a system of hieroglyphics could exist. The Assyrian bas-reliefs show similar characteristics. Deities, kings, attendants, winged figures, and animals are all depicted in similar poses, holding the same objects, performing similar actions, and displaying similar facial expressions or lack thereof. If a palm grove is included, all the trees are the same height, have the same number of leaves, and are evenly spaced. When water is represented, each wave mirrors the others; and fish, almost always of a single type, are evenly spread across the surface. The beards of the kings, gods, and winged figures are all consistent; so are the manes of the lions and horses. Hair is shown uniformly with one style of curl. The king’s beard is meticulously styled with layers of uniform curls, alternating with twisted layers arranged neatly; similarly, the tufts at the ends of the bulls' tails are depicted in exactly the same way. Without exploring similar aspects in early Christian art, where differences are less pronounced but still present, the shift towards diversity becomes clear when we remember that modern-day pictures feature endless composition variations. The poses, faces, and expressions are distinct; the subordinate elements differ in size, shape, position, and texture, with varying contrasts even in minor details. If we compare an Egyptian statue, sitting straight upright on a block with hands on knees, fingers splayed and parallel, eyes looking straight ahead, and perfectly symmetrical in every detail, with a statue from the advanced Greek or modern schools—which is asymmetrical in the positioning of the head, body, limbs, hair arrangement, clothing, accessories, and its relationship to surrounding objects—we can distinctly see the shift from uniformity to diversity.
§ 51. In the co-ordinate origin and gradual differentiation of Poetry, Music, and Dancing, we have another series of illustrations. Rhythm in speech, rhythm in sound, and rhythm in motion, were in the beginning, parts of the same thing; and have only in process of time become separate things. Among various existing barbarous tribes we find them still united. The dances of savages are accompanied by some kind of monotonous chant, the clapping of hands, the striking of rude instruments: there are measured movements, measured words, and measured tones; and the whole ceremony, usually having reference to war or sacrifice, is of governmental character. In the early records of the historic races we similarly find these three forms of metrical action united in religious festivals. In the Hebrew writings we read that the triumphal ode composed by Moses on the defeat of the Egyptians, was sung to an accompaniment of dancing and timbrels. The Israelites danced and sung “at the inauguration of the golden calf. And as it is generally agreed that this representation 170of the Deity was borrowed from the mysteries of Apis, it is probable that the dancing was copied from that of the Egyptians on those occasions.” There was an annual dance in Shiloh on the sacred festival; and David danced before the ark. Again, in Greece the like relation is everywhere seen: the original type being there, as probably in other cases, a simultaneous chanting and mimetic representation of the life and adventures of the god. The Spartan dances were accompanied by hymns and songs; and in general the Greeks had “no festivals or religious assemblies but what were accompanied with songs and dances”—both of them being forms of worship used before altars. Among the Romans, too, there were sacred dances: the Salian and Lupercalian being named as of that kind. And even in Christian countries, as at Limoges in comparatively recent times, the people have danced in the choir in honour of a saint. The incipient separation of these once united arts from each other and from religion, was early visible in Greece. Probably diverging from dances partly religious, partly warlike, as the Corybantian, came the war-dances proper, of which there were various kinds; and from these resulted secular dances. Meanwhile Music and Poetry, though still united, came to have an existence separate from dancing. The aboriginal Greek poems, religious in subject, were not recited but chanted; and though at first the chant of the poet was accompanied by the dance of the chorus, it ultimately grew into independence. Later still, when the poem had been differentiated into epic and lyric—when it became the custom to sing the lyric and recite the epic—poetry proper was born. As during the same period musical instruments were being multiplied, we may presume that music came to have an existence apart from words. And both of them were beginning to assume other forms besides the religious. Facts having like implications might be cited from the histories of later times and peoples; as the practices of our own early minstrels, who sang to the harp heroic narratives versified 171by themselves to music of their own composition: thus uniting the now separate offices of poet, composer, vocalist, and instrumentalist. But, without further illustration, the common origin and gradual differentiation of Dancing, Poetry, and Music will be sufficiently manifest.
§ 51. In the coordinated beginning and gradual development of Poetry, Music, and Dance, we have another set of examples. Rhythm in speech, rhythm in sound, and rhythm in movement were initially parts of the same experience; they only became distinct over time. Among various existing tribal communities, we still see them united. The dances of these groups are often accompanied by some type of repetitive chant, hand clapping, and the striking of simple instruments: there are measured movements, measured words, and measured sounds; and the entire ritual, usually related to war or sacrifice, has a communal aspect. In the early records of historical cultures, we similarly find these three forms of rhythmic expression combined in religious celebrations. In the Hebrew scriptures, we read that the triumphant song composed by Moses after the defeat of the Egyptians was sung alongside dancing and tambourines. The Israelites danced and sang at the celebration of the golden calf. It is commonly agreed that this depiction of the deity was inspired by the mysteries of Apis, suggesting that the dancing was influenced by that of the Egyptians on similar occasions. There was an annual dance in Shiloh during the sacred festival, and David danced before the ark. In Greece, we see a similar connection everywhere: the original form likely being a simultaneous chant and imitation of the life and adventures of the god. Spartan dances were accompanied by hymns and songs; and generally, the Greeks had “no festivals or religious gatherings without songs and dances”—both being forms of worship performed before altars. Among the Romans, there were sacred dances as well: the Salian and Lupercalian being mentioned as such. Even in Christian countries, such as Limoges in relatively recent times, people have danced in the choir to honor a saint. The early separation of these once-united arts from each other and from religion was apparent early on in Greece. Likely diverging from dances that were partly religious and partly martial, like the Corybantian, came the proper war dances, of which there were various types; and from these developed secular dances. Meanwhile, Music and Poetry, although still connected, began to exist separately from dance. The original Greek poems, being religious in nature, were not recited but chanted; and although initially the poet’s chant was accompanied by the dance of the chorus, it gradually became independent. Later on, when poetry was divided into epic and lyric—when it became customary to sing lyrics and recite epics—true poetry emerged. During the same period, as more musical instruments were created, music began to exist apart from words. Both started to take on forms beyond the religious. Similar instances with related implications can be drawn from the histories of later times and peoples; like the practices of our early minstrels who sang heroic stories they versified themselves to music they created: thus bringing together the now separate roles of poet, composer, vocalist, and instrumentalist. But without further examples, the shared origin and gradual separation of Dance, Poetry, and Music will be clearly evident.
The advance from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous is displayed not only in the separation of these arts from each other and from religion, but also in the multiplied differentiations which each of them afterwards undergoes. Not to dwell upon the numberless kinds of dancing that have, in course of time, come into use; and not to occupy space in detailing the progress of poetry, as seen in the development of the various forms of metre, of rhyme, and of general organization; let us confine our attention to music as a type of the group. As argued by Dr. Burney, and as implied by the customs of still extant barbarous races, the first musical instruments were, without doubt, percussive—sticks, calabashes, tom-toms—and were used simply to mark the time of the dance; and in this constant repetition of the same sound, we see music in its most homogeneous form. The Egyptians had a lyre with three strings. The early lyre of the Greeks had four, constituting their tetrachord. In course of some centuries lyres of seven and eight strings were employed. And, by the expiration of a thousand years, they had advanced to their “great system” of the double octave. Through all which changes there of course arose a greater heterogeneity of melody. Simultaneously there came into use the different modes—Dorian, Ionian, Phrygian, Æolian, and Lydian—answering to our keys: and of these there were ultimately fifteen. As yet, however, there was but little heterogeneity in the time of their music. Instrumental music during this period being merely the accompaniment of vocal music, and vocal music being completely subordinated to words,—the singer being also the poet, chanting his own compositions and making the lengths of his notes agree with the feet of his verses; there 172unavoidably arose a tiresome uniformity of measure, which, as Dr Burney says, “no resources of melody could disguise.” Lacking the complex rhythm obtained by our equal bars and unequal notes, the only rhythm was that produced by the quantity of the syllables, and was of necessity comparatively monotonous. And further, it may be observed that the chant thus resulting, being like recitative, was much less clearly differentiated from ordinary speech than is our modern song. Nevertheless, considering the extended range of notes in use, the variety of modes, the occasional variations of time consequent on changes of metre, and the multiplication of instruments, we see that music had, towards the close of Greek civilization, attained to considerable heterogeneity: not indeed as compared with our music, but as compared with that which preceded it. As yet, however, there existed nothing but melody: harmony was unknown. It was not until Christian church-music had reached some development, that music in parts was evolved; and then it came into existence through a very unobtrusive differentiation. Difficult as it may be to conceive, à priori, how the advance from melody to harmony could take place without a sudden leap, it is none the less true that it did so. The circumstance which prepared the way for it, was the employment of two choirs singing alternately the same air. Afterwards it became the practice (very possibly first suggested by a mistake) for the second choir to commence before the first had ceased; thus producing a fugue. With the simple airs then in use, a partially harmonious fugue might not improbably thus result; and a very partially harmonious fugue satisfied the ears of that age, as we know from still preserved examples. The idea having once been given, the composing of airs productive of fugal harmony would naturally grow up; as in some way it did grow up out of this alternate choir-singing. And from the fugue to concerted music of two, three, four, and more parts, the transition was easy. Without pointing out in detail the increasing complexity that resulted from introducing 173notes of various lengths, from the multiplication of keys, from the use of accidentals, from varieties of time, from modulations and so forth, it needs but to contrast music as it is, with music as it was, to see how immense is the increase of heterogeneity. We see this if, looking at music in its ensemble, we enumerate its many different genera and species—if we consider the divisions into vocal, instrumental, and mixed; and their subdivisions into music for different voices and different instruments—if we observe the many forms of sacred music, from the simple hymn, the chant, the canon, motet, anthem, &c., up to the oratorio; and the still more numerous forms of secular music, from the ballad up to the serenata, from the instrumental solo up to the symphony. Again, the same truth is seen on comparing any one sample of aboriginal music with a sample of modern music—even an ordinary song for the piano; which we find to be relatively highly heterogeneous, not only in respect of the varieties in the pitch and in the length of the notes, the number of different notes sounding at the same instant in company with the voice, and the variations of strength with which they are sounded and sung, but in respect of the changes of key, the changes of time, the changes of timbre of the voice, and the many other modifications of expression. While between the old monotonous dance-chant and a grand opera of our own day, with its endless orchestral complexities and vocal combinations, the contrast in heterogeneity is so extreme that it seems scarcely credible that the one should have been the ancestor of the other.
The shift from uniformity to diversity is evident not only in the way these arts have separated from each other and from religion, but also in the many variations that each has undergone over time. Instead of focusing on the countless types of dance that have emerged, or detailing the evolution of poetry with its different forms of meter, rhyme, and structure, let's focus on music as a representative example. As Dr. Burney suggested, and as seen in the practices of still-existing primitive cultures, the earliest musical instruments were likely percussive—like sticks, gourds, and drums—and were primarily used to keep time for dancing. In this repetitive sound, we see music in its simplest form. The Egyptians had a three-stringed lyre, while the early Greeks had a four-stringed version, known as the tetrachord. Over several centuries, lyres with seven and eight strings were created, and by a thousand years later, they developed their "great system" of the double octave. Throughout these changes, a greater complexity in melody emerged. At the same time, different modes—Dorian, Ionian, Phrygian, Æolian, and Lydian—came into use, corresponding to our modern keys, and eventually totaled fifteen. However, during this period, there was still little variety in the rhythm of their music. Instrumental music mainly accompanied vocal music, with singing completely tied to lyrics—the singer was the poet, reciting their own works and aligning the lengths of their notes with the syllables of their verses. This led to a monotonous uniformity, which, as Dr. Burney pointed out, “no resources of melody could disguise.” Lacking the complex rhythms found in our equal measures and varying note lengths, the only rhythm came from the syllable counts, resulting in a relatively dull sound. Additionally, the resulting chant, resembling recitative, was less distinct from everyday speech compared to modern songs. Nevertheless, considering the broader range of notes, the diversity of modes, occasional rhythm variations due to changing meters, and the increase in instruments, we see that music had achieved significant diversity by the end of Greek civilization—not as much as today's music, but certainly more than what came before it. However, melody was all that existed; harmony hadn't been discovered yet. It wasn't until Christian church music had advanced that music in parts evolved, emerging through a subtle differentiation. Although it might seem surprising to imagine how the leap from melody to harmony occurred without a drastic shift, it did happen. The catalyst for this transition was the practice of two choirs singing the same tune alternately. Eventually, a second choir began singing before the first had finished, creating a fugue. With the simple melodies of the time, a somewhat harmonious fugue could easily arise, and such partially harmonious fugues were enjoyed in that era, as demonstrated by existing examples. Once the concept was introduced, composing melodies that produced fugal harmony naturally followed, as it did emerge from this alternate choir-singing. Transitioning from the fugue to concerted music with two, three, four, or more parts was a simple progression. Without detailing the increasing complexity that arose from introducing notes of various lengths, the expansion of keys, the use of accidentals, varieties of time, modulations, and so on, it suffices to compare music as it is now with music as it was then to see the vast increase in diversity. This becomes clear when we examine music in its entirety and list its many different genres and forms—considering the divisions into vocal, instrumental, and mixed; their subdivisions into music for different voices and instruments; the various kinds of sacred music, ranging from simple hymns and chants to canons, motets, anthems, and the oratorio; and the even more numerous forms of secular music, from ballads to serenades, and from instrumental solos to symphonies. The same truth is evident when comparing a piece of primitive music with a modern one—even a basic piano song, which we find to be relatively complex, not only in terms of pitch and note length variations, the number of different notes played simultaneously with the voice, and the differences in volume of sound and singing, but also in key changes, time variations, changes in vocal timbre, and many other expression modifications. The contrast between the old monotonous dance-chant and a modern grand opera, with its endless orchestral complexities and vocal arrangements, is so extreme that it's hard to believe one descended directly from the other.
§ 52. Were they needed, many further illustrations might be cited. Going back to the early time when the deeds of the god-king, chanted and mimetically represented in dances round his altar, were further narrated in picture-writings on the walls of temples and palaces, and so constituted a rude literature, we might trace the development of Literature through phases in which, as in the Hebrew Scriptures it presents 174in one work, theology, cosmogony, history, biography, civil law, ethics, poetry; through other phases in which, as in the Iliad, the religious, martial, historical, the epic, dramatic, and lyric elements are similarly commingled; down to its present heterogeneous development, in which its divisions and subdivisions are so numerous and varied as to defy complete classification. Or we might track the evolution of Science: beginning with the era in which it was not yet differentiated from Art, and was, in union with Art, the handmaid of Religion; passing through the era in which the sciences were so few and rudimentary, as to be simultaneously cultivated by the same philosophers; and ending with the era in which the genera and species are so numerous that few can enumerate them, and no one can adequately grasp even one genus. Or we might do the like with Architecture, with the Drama, with Dress. But doubtless the reader is already weary of illustrations; and my promise has been amply fulfilled. I believe it has been shown beyond question, that that which the German physiologists have found to be the law of organic development, is the law of all development. The advance from the simple to the complex, through a process of successive differentiations, is seen alike in the earliest changes of the Universe to which we can reason our way back, and in the earliest changes which we can inductively establish; it is seen in the geologic and climatic evolution of the Earth, and of every single organism on its surface; it is seen in the evolution of Humanity, whether contemplated in the civilized individual, or in the aggregation of races; it is seen in the evolution of Society, in respect alike of its political, its religious, and its economical organization; and it is seen in the evolution of all those endless concrete and abstract products of human activity, which constitute the environment of our daily life. From the remotest past which Science can fathom, up to the novelties of yesterday, that in which Evolution essentially consists, is the transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous.
§ 52. If needed, many more examples could be given. Looking back to the early days when the deeds of the god-king were chanted and performed in dances around his altar, and also represented in picture-writings on the walls of temples and palaces, we see a primitive form of literature. We could track the development of Literature through various stages, where, like in the Hebrew Scriptures, it combines theology, cosmogony, history, biography, civil law, ethics, and poetry in a single work; and in other phases, like in the Iliad, where religious, martial, historical, epic, dramatic, and lyrical elements are similarly mixed; down to its current diverse development, where its divisions and subdivisions are so numerous and varied that they resist complete classification. We could also follow the evolution of Science: starting from the time when it was not yet separated from Art, and was, together with Art, a servant of Religion; moving through the period when the sciences were so few and basic that they were explored by the same philosophers; and culminating in the era where the types and categories are so numerous that few can count them, and no one can fully understand even one category. The same could be done with Architecture, Drama, and Fashion. But the reader is likely already tired of examples, and I feel my promise has been fulfilled. I believe it has been clearly demonstrated that what German physiologists have discovered as the law of organic development is the law of all development. The progression from simple to complex, through a series of successive differentiations, is evident both in the earliest changes of the Universe that we can logically trace back to, and in the earliest changes that we can establish inductively; it is visible in the geological and climatic evolution of the Earth and in every single organism on its surface; it is present in the evolution of Humanity, whether viewed in the individual who is civilized or in the collection of races; it is observable in the evolution of Society, considering its political, religious, and economic organization; and it is shown in the evolution of all the endless concrete and abstract products of human activity that make up our daily environment. From the farthest past Science can explore, to the innovations of yesterday, the essence of Evolution is the transformation from the homogeneous into the heterogeneous.
8. The substance of this chapter is nearly identical with the first half of an essay on “Progress: its Law and Cause,” which was originally published in the Westminster Review for April 1857: only a few unimportant additions and alterations have been made. The succeeding chapter, however, in which the subject is continued, is, with the exception of a fragment embodied in it, wholly new.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.This chapter is almost the same as the first half of an essay titled “Progress: its Law and Cause,” which was originally published in the Westminster Review in April 1857; only a few minor additions and changes have been made. The next chapter, however, which continues the topic, is entirely new except for a small part included in it.
9. For detailed proof of these assertions see essay on Manners and Fashion.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.For detailed proof of these claims, check out the essay on Manners and Fashion.
CHAPTER III.
THE LAW OF EVOLUTION, CONTINUED.
§ 53. But now, does this generalization express the whole truth? Does it include all the phenomena of Evolution? and does it exclude all other phenomena? A careful consideration of the facts, will show that it does neither.
§ 53. But now, does this generalization capture the whole truth? Does it cover all the aspects of Evolution? And does it leave out any other phenomena? A thorough examination of the facts will reveal that it does neither.
That there are changes from the less heterogeneous to the more heterogeneous, which do not come within what we call Evolution, is proved in every case of local disease. A portion of the body in which there arises a cancer, or other morbid growth, unquestionably displays a new differentiation. Whether this morbid growth be, or be not, more heterogeneous than the tissues in which it is seated, is not the question. The question is, whether the structure of the organism as a whole, is, or is not, rendered more heterogeneous by the addition of a part unlike every pre-existing part, both in form and composition. And to this question there can be none but an affirmative answer. Again, it might with apparent truth be contended, that the earlier stages of decomposition in a dead body, similarly involve an increase of heterogeneity. Supposing the chemical changes to commence in some parts of the body earlier than in other parts, as they commonly do; and to affect different tissues in different, ways, as they must; it seems to be a necessary admission that the entire body, made up of undecomposed parts and parts decomposed in different ways and degrees, has become more heterogeneous than it was. Though greater homogeneity will be the 176eventual result, the immediate result is the opposite. And yet this immediate result is certainly not evolution. But perhaps of all illustrations the least debatable are those furnished by social disorders and disasters. When in any nation there occurs a rebellion, which, while leaving some provinces undisturbed, developes itself here in secret societies, there in public demonstrations, and elsewhere in actual appeal to arms, leading probably to conflict and bloodshed; it must be admitted that the society, regarded as a whole, has so been rendered more heterogeneous. Or when a dearth causes commercial panic with its entailed bankruptcies, closed factories, discharged operatives, political agitations, food riots, incendiarisms; it is manifest that as, throughout the rest of society, there still exists the ordinary organization displaying the usual phenomena, these new phenomena must be regarded as adding to the complexity previously existing. Nevertheless, it is clear that such changes so far from constituting a further stage of evolution, are steps towards dissolution.
That there are shifts from less diverse to more diverse situations, which don’t fall under what we call Evolution, is evident in every case of localized disease. A part of the body where a cancer or other unhealthy growth develops definitely shows a new differentiation. Whether this unhealthy growth is more diverse than the tissues it's located in isn’t the issue. The issue is whether the overall structure of the organism becomes more diverse due to the addition of a part that is different in both shape and composition from every existing part. And there can only be a yes answer to this question. Again, it could be argued convincingly that the early stages of decomposition in a dead body also show an increase in diversity. If chemical changes start in some parts of the body sooner than in others, as they often do, and affect different tissues in different ways, it seems unavoidable to acknowledge that the whole body, made up of parts that haven’t decomposed and parts that have decomposed differently and to varying degrees, has become more diverse than it was. Although greater uniformity will eventually be the result, the immediate effect is the opposite. However, this immediate effect is definitely not evolution. But perhaps the clearest examples come from social disorders and disasters. When a nation experiences a rebellion that leaves some areas unaffected while developing in others through secret societies, public demonstrations, or outright calls to arms, likely leading to conflict and violence, it must be acknowledged that society as a whole has become more diverse. Or when a shortage causes commercial panic with bankruptcies, factory closures, layoffs, political unrest, food riots, and arson; it’s clear that while the rest of society still shows the usual organization and behaviors, these new phenomena add to the existing complexity. Nevertheless, it’s obvious that such changes, far from being a further step in evolution, are steps toward disintegration.
There is good reason to think then, that the definition arrived at in the last chapter, is an imperfect one. We may suspect, not that the process of evolution is different from the process there described; but that the description did not contain all that it should. The changes above instanced as coming within the formula as it now stands, are so obviously different from the rest, that the inclusion of them implies some oversight—some distinction hitherto overlooked. Such further distinction we shall find really exists.
There’s a solid reason to believe that the definition we reached in the last chapter is not complete. We might doubt that the process of evolution is different from what was described, but rather that the description didn’t include everything it should have. The changes mentioned earlier that fit within the current formula are so clearly different from the others that including them suggests some kind of oversight—some distinction that hasn’t been recognized yet. We will discover that such a further distinction actually exists.
§ 54. At the same time that all evolution is a change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous, it is also a change from the indefinite to the definite. As well as an advance from simplicity to complexity, there is an advance from confusion to order—from undetermined arrangement to determined arrangement. In the process of development, no matter what sphere it is displayed in, there is not only a gradual 177multiplication of unlike parts; but there is a gradual increase in the distinctness with which these parts are marked off from each other. And so is that increase of heterogeneity which characterizes Evolution, distinguished from that increase of heterogeneity which does not. For proof of this, it needs only to reconsider the instances given above. The structural changes constituting a disease, have no such definiteness, either in locality, extent, or outline, as the structural changes constituting development. Though certain morbid growths arise much more commonly in some parts of the body than in others (as warts on the hands, cancer on the breasts, tubercle in the lungs), yet they are not confined to these parts; nor, when found on them, are they anything like so precise in their relative positions as are the normal parts around them. In size, again, they are extremely variable—they bear no such constant proportion to the body as organs do. Their forms, too, are far less specific than organic forms. And they are extremely irregular or confused in their internal structures. That is to say, they are in all respects comparatively indefinite. The like peculiarity may be traced in decomposition. That state of total indefiniteness to which a dead body is finally reduced, is a state towards which the putrefactive changes have tended from their commencement. Each step in the destruction of the organic compounds, is accompanied by a blurring of the minute structure—diminishes its distinctness. From the portions that have undergone most decomposition, there is a gradual transition to the less decomposed portions. And step by step the lines of organization, once so precise, disappear. Similarly with social changes of an abnormal kind. A political outbreak rising finally to a rebellion, tends from the very first to obliterate the specializations, governmental and industrial, which previously existed. The disaffection which originates such an outbreak, itself implies a loosening of those ties by which the citizens are bound up into distinct classes and sub-classes. Agitation, growing into revolutionary meetings, 178shows us a decided tendency towards the fusion of ranks that are usually separated. Acts of open insubordination exhibit a breaking through of those definite limits to individual conduct which were previously observed; and a disappearance of the lines previously existing between those in authority and those beneath them. At the same time, by the arrest of trade, artizans and others lose their occupations; and in so ceasing to be functionally distinguished, become fused into a mass from which the demarcations in great part vanish. And when at last there comes positive insurrection, all magisterial and official powers, all class distinctions, and all industrial differences, at once cease: organized society lapses into an unorganized aggregation of social units. How the like holds true of such social disasters as are entailed by famine, needs not be pointed out. On calling to mind that in cases of this kind the changes are from order towards disorder, it will at once be seen that like the foregoing they are changes from definite arrangements to indefinite arrangements.
§ 54. At the same time that all evolution is a shift from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous, it's also a shift from the indefinite to the definite. Along with moving from simplicity to complexity, there's a progression from confusion to order—from undetermined arrangement to determined arrangement. In the process of development, regardless of the field it occurs in, there’s not only a gradual increase in different parts; but there's also a gradual rise in the clarity with which these parts are set apart from one another. Therefore, this increase in heterogeneity that characterizes evolution is distinct from the increase in heterogeneity that does not. For proof of this, one need only reconsider the examples provided above. The structural changes associated with a disease lack the same definiteness, whether in location, extent, or outline, as the structural changes associated with development. While certain abnormal growths occur much more frequently in specific parts of the body (like warts on the hands, cancer on the breasts, and tubercle in the lungs), they're not restricted to those parts, nor are they nearly as precise in their relative positions as the normal parts surrounding them. In terms of size, they are highly variable—they don't maintain a consistent proportion to the body like organs do. Their shapes are also far less specific than organic forms. Furthermore, they are extremely irregular or confused in their internal structures. In all respects, they are comparatively indefinite. The same unusual characteristic can be seen in decomposition. The state of total indefiniteness that a dead body ultimately reaches is a state toward which the putrefactive changes have been moving since the beginning. Each step in the breakdown of organic compounds is accompanied by a loss of clarity in the minute structure—diminishing its distinctness. From the areas that have decomposed the most, there is a gradual transition to the less decomposed areas. And step by step, the once-clear lines of organization disappear. Similarly, in abnormal social changes. A political uprising that escalates to a rebellion starts from the very beginning to erase the specializations in government and industry that previously existed. The discontent that sparks such an uprising implies a loosening of the ties that bind citizens into distinct classes and sub-classes. Agitation that evolves into revolutionary meetings exhibits a noticeable tendency toward merging ranks that are usually separated. Acts of open defiance show a breakdown of the clear limits to individual behavior that were previously observed, and a fading of the boundaries that existed between those in authority and those below them. Meanwhile, with the halt in trade, artisans and others lose their jobs; and as they stop being functionally distinct, they merge into a mass where the distinctions largely vanish. And when positive insurrection finally occurs, all authoritative and official powers, all class distinctions, and all industrial differences vanish at once: organized society collapses into an unorganized collection of social units. The same applies to social disasters caused by famine, which doesn't need further explanation. By recalling that, in such cases, the changes move from order toward disorder, it becomes clear that, like the previous examples, these are changes from definite arrangements to indefinite arrangements.
Thus then is that increase of heterogeneity which constitutes Evolution, distinguished from that increase of heterogeneity which does not do so. Though in disease and death, individual or social, the earliest modifications may be construed as additions to the heterogeneity previously existing; yet they cannot be construed as additions to the definiteness previously existing. They begin from the very outset to destroy this definiteness; and so, gradually produce a heterogeneity that is indeterminate instead of determinate. Just in the same way that a city, already multiform in its variously arranged structures of various architecture, may be made more multiform by an earthquake, which leaves part of it standing and overthrows other parts in different ways and degrees, and yet is at the same time reduced from definite arrangement to indefinite arrangement; so may organized bodies be made for a time more multiform by changes which are nevertheless disorganizing changes. And in the one case 179as in the other, it is the absence of definiteness which distinguishes the multiformity of regression from the multiformity of progression.
Thus, this increase in diversity that defines Evolution is different from the increase in diversity that doesn't. While in sickness and death, whether individual or societal, the initial changes can be seen as additions to the existing diversity, they cannot be seen as additions to the existing clarity. From the very beginning, they start to undermine this clarity and gradually create a diversity that is undefined instead of defined. Just as a city, already varied in its different architectural styles, can become even more varied by an earthquake, which leaves some structures intact while destroying others in various ways and to different extents, it is still reduced from a clear arrangement to a chaotic one; similarly, organized bodies can become momentarily more varied through changes that are ultimately disorganizing. In both instances, it is the lack of clarity that sets apart the chaotic variety of regression from the structured variety of progression.
If the advance from the indefinite to the definite is an essential characteristic of Evolution, we shall of course find it everywhere displayed; as in the last Chapter we found the advance from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. With a view of showing that it is so, let us now briefly reconsider the same several classes of facts.
If the shift from the indefinite to the definite is a key feature of Evolution, we'll see it present everywhere; just like in the last chapter where we observed the shift from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. To demonstrate this, let's now take a quick look back at the same various classes of facts.
§ 55. Beginning as before with a hypothetical illustration, we have to note that each further stage in the evolution of the Solar System, supposing it to have originated from diffused matter, was an advance towards more definite forms, and times, and forces. At first irregular in shape and with indistinct margins, the attenuated substance, as it concentrated and acquired a rotatory motion, must have assumed the shape of an oblate spheroid; which, with every increase of density, became more specific in general outline, and had its surface more sharply marked off from the surrounding void. At the same time, the constituent portions of nebulous matter, instead of independently moving towards their common centre of gravity from all points, and tending to revolve round it in various planes, as they would at first do, must have had these planes more and more merged into a single plane; and this plane must have gained greater precision as the concentration progressed. To which add that in the gradual establishment of a common and determinate angular velocity, instead of the various and conflicting angular velocities of different parts, we have a further change of like nature. According to the hypothesis, change from indistinct characteristics to distinct ones, was repeated in the evolution of each planet and satellite; and may in them be traced to a much greater extent. A gaseous spheroid is less definitely marked off from the space around it than a fluid spheroid, since it is subject to larger and more rapid undulations of surface, 180and to much greater distortions of general form; and similarly a fluid spheroid, covered as it must be with waves of various magnitudes, is less definite than a solid spheroid. Nor is it only in greater fixity of surface that a planet in its last stage, is distinguished from a planet in its earlier stages. Its general form, too, is more precise. The sphere, to which in the end it very closely approximates, is a perfectly specific figure; while the spheroid, under which figure it previously existed, being infinitely variable in oblateness, is an imperfectly specific figure. And further, a planet having an axis inclined to the plane of its orbit, must, while its form is very oblate, have its plane of rotation greatly disturbed by the attraction of external bodies; whereas its approach to a spherical form, involving a less extreme precessional motion, implies less marked variations in the direction of its axis. Nor is it only in respect of space-relations that the Solar System in general and in detail has become more precise. The like is true of time-relations. During the process of concentration the various portions of the nebulous mass must not only differ more or less from each other in their angular velocities, but each of them must gradually change the period in which it moves round the general axis. In every detached ring however, and in the resulting planet, this progressive alteration ceases: there results a determinate period of revolution. And similarly the time of axial rotation, which, during the formation of each planet, is continually diminishing, becomes at last practically fixed: as in the case of the Earth, whose day is not a second less than it was 2000 years ago. It is scarcely needful to point out that the force-relations have simultaneously become more and more settled. The exact calculations of physical astronomy, show us how definite these force-relations now are; while the great indefiniteness which once characterized them, is implied in the extreme difficulty, if not impossibility, of subjecting the nebular hypothesis to mathematical treatment.
§ 55. Starting again with a hypothetical example, we should observe that each subsequent stage in the development of the Solar System, assuming it started from scattered matter, represented a step towards more defined shapes, times, and forces. Initially irregular in shape with vague edges, the dispersed substance, as it gathered and began to rotate, must have taken on the shape of an oblate spheroid; which, with every increase in density, became more specific in overall outline, and had its surface more sharply defined from the surrounding emptiness. At the same time, the individual parts of the nebulous material, instead of independently moving towards their common center of gravity from all directions and trying to orbit it in various planes, must have had these planes increasingly merged into a single plane; and this plane must have become more precise as the concentration continued. Additionally, as a common and distinct angular velocity was gradually established, instead of the varying and conflicting angular velocities of different parts, we see another similar change. According to the hypothesis, the shift from vague characteristics to clear ones was repeated in the evolution of each planet and moon; and this can be traced to a much greater extent. A gaseous spheroid is less distinctly defined from the space around it than a fluid spheroid, as it is subject to larger and quicker surface undulations, and more significant distortions of shape; similarly, a fluid spheroid, covered with waves of different sizes, is less defined than a solid spheroid. Moreover, it’s not just the increased surface stability that separates a planet in its final stage from one in its earlier stages. Its overall shape is also more exact. The sphere, which it ultimately closely resembles, is a perfectly defined figure; while the spheroid it existed as previously, being infinitely variable in its flatness, is an imperfectly defined figure. Furthermore, a planet with its axis tilted relative to its orbital plane must, while its shape is very oblate, have its plane of rotation significantly disrupted by the pull of external bodies; whereas its approach to a spherical shape, which involves less extreme precessional motion, suggests less marked variations in the direction of its axis. Not only have the spatial relationships of the Solar System become more precise both in general and in detail, but the time relationships have also improved. During the process of concentration, the various parts of the nebulous mass must not only differ somewhat from each other in their angular velocities, but each must also gradually change the period in which it orbits around the general axis. However, in every distinct ring and in the resulting planet, this gradual change comes to an end: a fixed revolution period is established. Similarly, the time of axial rotation, which continually decreases during the formation of each planet, eventually becomes practically stable, as seen in the case of Earth, whose day is not a second shorter than it was 2000 years ago. It’s hardly necessary to point out that the force relationships have also become increasingly stable at the same time. The precise calculations of physical astronomy show us how definite these force relationships are now; while the great uncertainty that once characterized them is indicated by the extreme difficulty, if not impossibility, of applying mathematical treatment to the nebular hypothesis.
181From that originally molten state of the Earth inferable from established geological data—a state in harmony with the nebular hypothesis but inexplicable on any other—the transition to its existing state has been through stages in which the characters became more determinate. Besides being, as above pointed out, comparatively unstable in surface and contour, a fluid spheroid is less definite than a solid spheroid in having no fixed distribution of parts. Currents of molten matter, though kept to certain general circuits by the conditions of equilibrium, cannot in the absence of solid boundaries be precise or permanent in direction: all parts must be in motion with respect to other parts. But a solidification of the surface, even though but partial, is manifestly a step towards the establishment of definite relations of position. In a thin crust however, frequently ruptured as it must be by disturbing forces, and moved by every tidal undulation, such fixity of relative position can be but temporary. Only as the crust slowly increases in thickness, can there arise distinct and settled geographical relations. Observe too that when, on a crust that has cooled to the requisite degree, there begins to precipitate the water floating above as vapour, the water which is precipitated cannot maintain any definiteness either of state or place. Falling on a surface not thick enough to preserve anything beyond slight variations of level, it must form small shallow deposits over areas sufficiently cool to permit condensation; which areas must not only pass insensibly into others that are too hot for this, but must themselves from time to time be so raised in temperature as to drive off the water lying on them. With progressive refrigeration, however,—with an increasing thickness of crust, a consequent formation of larger elevations and depressions, and the condensation of more atmospheric water, there comes an arrangement of parts that is comparatively fixed in both time and space; and the definiteness of state and position increases, until there results such a distribution of continents and oceans as we now see—a distribution 182that is not only topographically precise, but also in its cliff-marked coast-lines presents a more definite division of land from water than could have existed during the period when islands of low elevation had shelving beaches up which the tide ebbed and flowed to great distances. Respecting the characteristics technically classed as geological, we may draw parallel inferences. While the Earth’s crust was thin, mountain-chains were impossibilities: there could not have been long and well-defined axes of elevation, with distinct water-sheds and areas of drainage. Moreover, from small islands admitting of but small rivers, and tidal streams both feeble and narrow, there would result no clearly-marked sedimentary strata. Confused and varying masses of detritus, such as those now found at the mouths of brooks, must have been the prevailing formations. And these could give place to distinct strata, only as there arose continents and oceans, with their great rivers, long coast-lines, and wide-spreading marine currents. How there must simultaneously have resulted more definite meteorological characters, need not be pointed out in detail. That differences of climates and seasons must have grown relatively decided as the heat of the Sun became distinguishable from the proper heat of the Earth; that the establishment through this cause of comparatively constant atmospheric currents, must have similarly produced more specific conditions in each locality; and that these effects must have been aided by increasing permanence in the distribution of land and sea and of ocean currents; are conclusions which are sufficiently obvious.
181Starting from the originally molten state of the Earth, as inferred from established geological data—a state that aligns with the nebular hypothesis but makes no sense in any other context—the Earth transitioned to its current form through stages where characteristics became clearer. A fluid spheroid is less defined than a solid spheroid because it lacks a fixed arrangement of parts, and while currents of molten matter follow general paths due to balance, they can't have a precise or permanent direction without solid boundaries; all parts must be in motion relative to each other. However, when the surface begins to solidify, even partially, this indicates a step toward establishing definite positional relationships. Still, in a thin crust, which is often disrupted and affected by tidal movements, any fixed relative position can only be temporary. Only as the crust gradually thickens can distinct and stable geographical relationships develop. Furthermore, when water vapor starts to condense on a crust that has cooled enough, the precipitated water lacks any definite state or location. It falls on a surface that isn't thick enough to maintain more than slight level variations, resulting in shallow deposits over cooler areas that enable condensation; these spots must seamlessly transition into hotter areas where condensation can’t occur, and they may also heat up at times to evaporate any water present. As the cooling process continues—with a thicker crust, larger landforms, and greater condensation of atmospheric water—a more stable arrangement of parts emerges in both time and space; the clarity of state and position increases, ultimately leading to the distribution of continents and oceans we observe today—a layout that is not only geographically precise but also presents a more distinct separation of land from water compared to the period when low islands had beach fronts where tides would vary greatly. 182In considering the characteristics we technically categorize as geological, we can make similar inferences. When the Earth's crust was thin, mountain ranges could not exist; there couldn't be long, well-defined elevations with distinct watersheds and drainage areas. Additionally, small islands with only minor rivers and weak tidal streams would not result in clearly marked sedimentary layers. Instead, there would have been confused and varying masses of debris, like those currently found at river mouths. Distinct layers could only form as continents and oceans emerged, accompanied by large rivers, lengthy coastlines, and widespread ocean currents. It’s clear that more defined meteorological characteristics must have developed concurrently. As the Sun's heat became distinguishable from the Earth's natural warmth, differences in climate and seasons would have grown more pronounced; this change would also lead to more consistent atmospheric currents, producing more specific conditions in each locale. Furthermore, these effects would have been supported by a more permanent distribution of land and sea and stable ocean currents, which are conclusions that are quite evident.
Let us turn now to the evidence furnished by organic bodies. In place of deductive illustrations like the foregoing, we shall here find numerous illustrations which, as being inductively established, are less open to criticism. The process of mammalian development, for example, will supply us with numerous proofs ready-described by embryologists. The first change which the ovum of a mammal undergoes, after continued segmentation has reduced 183its yelk to a mulberry-like mass, is the appearance of a greater definiteness in the peripheral cells of this mass: each of which acquires a distinct enveloping membrane. These peripheral cells, vaguely distinguished from the internal ones both by their greater completeness and by their minuter subdivision, coalesce to form the blastoderm or germinal membrane. One portion of the blastoderm presently becomes contrasted with the rest, through the accumulation of cells still more subdivided, which, together, form an opaque roundish spot. This area germinativa, as it is called, is not sharply delineated, but shades off gradually into the surrounding parts of the blastoderm; and the area pellucida, subsequently formed in the midst of this germinal area, is similarly without any precise margin. The “primitive trace,” which makes its appearance in the centre of the area pellucida, and is the rudiment of that vertebrate axis which is to be the fundamental characteristic of the mature animal, is shown by its name to be at first indefinite—a mere trace. Beginning as a shallow groove, this becomes slowly more pronounced: its sides grow higher, their summits overlap, and at last unite; and so the indefinite groove passes into a definite tube, forming the vertebral canal. In this vertebral canal the leading divisions of the brain are at first discernible only as slight bulgings; while the vertebræ commence as indistinct modifications of the tissue bounding the canal. Simultaneously, the outer portion of the blastoderm has been undergoing separation from the inner portion: there has been a division into the serous and mucous layers—a division at the outset indistinct, and traceable only about the germinal area, but which insensibly spreads throughout nearly the whole germinal membrane, and becomes definite. From the mucous layer, the development of the alimentary canal proceeds as that of the vertebral canal does from the serous layer. Originally a simple channel along the under surface of the embryonic mass, the intestine is rendered step by step more distinct by the bending down, on each side, of ridges 184which finally join to form a tube—the permanent absorbing surface is by degrees clearly cut off from that temporary absorbing surface of which it was at first a part like all the rest. And in an analogous manner the entire embryo, which at first lies outspread upon the surface of the yelk-sack, gradually rises up from it, and, by the infolding of its ventral surface, becomes a separate mass, connected with the yelk-sack only by a narrow duct. These changes through which the general structure of the embryo is marked out with slowly-increasing precision, are paralleled in the evolution of each organ. The heart is at first a mere aggregation of cells, of which the inner liquify to form the cavity, while the outer are transformed into the walls; and when thus sketched out, the heart is indefinite not only as being unlined by limiting membrane, but also as being but vaguely distinguishable from the great blood-vessels: of which it is little more than a dilatation. By and by the receiving portion of the cavity becomes distinct from the propelling portion. Afterwards there begins to be formed across the ventricle, a septum, which, however, is some time before it completely shuts off the two halves from each other; while the later-formed septum of the auricle remains incomplete during the whole of fœtal life. Again, the liver commences as a multiplication of certain cells in the wall of the intestine. The thickening produced by this multiplication “increases so as to form a projection upon the exterior of the canal;” and at the same time that the organ grows and becomes distinct from the intestine, the channels which permeate it are transformed into ducts having clearly-marked walls. Similarly, by the increase of certain cells of the external coat of the alimentary canal at its upper portion, are produced buds from which the lungs are developed; and these, in their general outlines and detailed structure, acquire distinctness step by step. Changes of this order continue long after birth; and, in the human being, are some of them not completed till middle life. During youth, most of the articular 185surfaces of the bones remain rough and fissured—the calcareous deposit ending irregularly in the surrounding cartilage. But between puberty and the age of thirty, the articular surfaces are finished off by the addition of smooth, hard, sharply-cut “epiphyses.” Thus we may say that during Evolution, an increase of definiteness continues long after there ceases to be any appreciable increase of heterogeneity. And, indeed, there is reason to think that those structural modifications which take place after maturity, ending in old age and death, are modifications of this nature; since they result in a growing rigidity of structure, a consequent restriction of movement and of functional pliability, a gradual narrowing of the limits within which the vital processes go on, ending at length in an organic adjustment too precise—too narrow in its margin of possible variation to permit the requisite adaptation to external changes of condition.
Let’s now look at the evidence provided by living organisms. Instead of the deductive examples we discussed earlier, we’ll find many illustrations here that are less likely to be criticized because they are based on inductive reasoning. For instance, the process of mammalian development offers numerous well-documented proofs from embryologists. The first change that a mammalian egg undergoes, after repetitive cell division reduces its yolk to a mulberry-like mass, is the clearer definition in the outer cells of this mass: each develops a distinct surrounding membrane. These outer cells, which differ from the inner ones by being more complete and more finely divided, come together to form the blastoderm or germinal membrane. One part of the blastoderm soon stands out from the rest due to a buildup of even more divided cells, collectively forming an opaque round spot. This germination area isn't sharply defined but gradually fades into the surrounding blastoderm; the clear zone, which forms in the center of this germinal area, also lacks a precise edge. The “primitive streak,” which appears in the center of the clear area, is the early form of the backbone that will be a key feature of the mature animal, suggesting by its name that it's initially vague—a mere trace. It starts as a shallow groove, which gradually becomes more prominent: its sides rise, their tops overlap, and eventually come together; thus, the vague groove turns into a defined tube, forming the vertebral canal. In this canal, the main sections of the brain are initially noticeable only as slight bulges, while the vertebrae start as indistinct shapes of the tissue surrounding the canal. At the same time, the outer part of the blastoderm separates from the inner part: there's a division into serous and mucous layers—initially unclear, visible only around the germinal area, but gradually spreading throughout almost the entire germinal membrane and becoming distinct. From the mucous layer, the development of the digestive system proceeds just as the vertebral canal develops from the serous layer. Initially, a simple channel runs along the underside of the embryonic mass; the intestine becomes more distinct over time as ridges on either side bend down and eventually join to create a tube—the permanent absorbing surface is gradually separated from the temporary one it was once part of. Similarly, the entire embryo, which initially lies flat on the surface of the yolk sac, gradually rises up from it, and by folding in on its belly, becomes a separate mass connected to the yolk sac only by a narrow duct. These changes that define the embryo's overall structure become more precisely outlined over time, mirroring the development of each organ. The heart starts as just a cluster of cells, with the inner cells liquefying to create the cavity while the outer cells form the walls; when roughly outlined, the heart is vague, lacking a limiting membrane, and isn’t very distinguishable from the large blood vessels—it's little more than an enlargement. Over time, the receiving part of the cavity distinguishes itself from the pumping part. A septum begins to form across the ventricle, but it takes a while before it fully separates the two halves; the septum in the atrium remains incomplete throughout fetal life. The liver begins as a multiplication of certain cells in the intestinal wall. The thickening from this multiplication “grows to create a projection on the exterior of the canal;” as the organ develops and becomes distinct from the intestine, the channels running through it transform into ducts with clearly defined walls. Similarly, the upper part of the digestive canal's outer layer increases in certain cells, producing buds from which the lungs develop; these also become more defined step by step. Changes like this continue long after birth; in humans, some changes aren’t completed until middle age. During childhood, most of the joints in the bones remain rough and cracked—the calcium buildup ends irregularly in the surrounding cartilage. But between puberty and age thirty, the joint surfaces are refined by the addition of smooth, hard, clearly defined “epiphyses.” Thus, we can say that during evolution, the increase in clarity continues long after there's any noticeable increase in complexity. In fact, there are reasons to believe that those structural changes that occur after maturity, which lead to old age and death, are of this nature; they result in increasing rigidity in structure, limiting movement and flexibility in function, and narrowing the range within which vital processes occur, ultimately leading to an organic state that is too rigid—too narrow in its margin for possible variation to allow for necessary adjustments to external changes in conditions.
To demonstrate that the Earth’s Flora and Fauna, regarded either as wholes or in their separate species, have progressed in definiteness, is of course no more possible than it was to demonstrate that they have progressed in heterogeneity: lack of facts being an obstacle to the one conclusion as to the other. If, however, we allow ourselves to reason from the hypothesis, now daily rendered more probable, that every species of organic form up to the most complex, has arisen out of the simplest through the accumulation of modifications upon modifications, just as every individual organic form arises; we shall see that in such case there must have been a progress from the indeterminate to the determinate, both in the particular forms and in the groups of forms. We may set out with the significant fact that many of the lowest living organisms (which are analogous in structure to the germs of all higher ones) are so indefinite in character that it is difficult, if not impossible, to decide whether they are plants or animals. Respecting sundry of them there are unsettled disputes between zoologists and botanists; and it has 186even been proposed to group them into a separate kingdom, forming a common basis to the animal and vegetal kingdoms. Note next that among the Protozoa, extreme indefiniteness of shape is very general. In the shell-less Rhizopods and their allies, not only is the form so irregular as to admit of no description, but it is neither alike in any two individuals nor in the same individual at successive moments. By the aggregation of such creatures, are produced, among other indefinite bodies, the sponges—bodies that are indefinite in size, in contour, in internal arrangement, and in the absence of an external limiting membrane. As further showing the relatively indeterminate character of the simplest organisms, it may be mentioned that their structures vary very greatly with surrounding conditions: so much so that, among the Protozoa and Protophyta, many forms which were once classed as distinct species, and even as distinct genera, are found to be merely varieties of one species. If now we call to mind how precise in their attributes are the highest organisms—how sharply cut their outlines, how invariable their proportions, and how comparatively constant their structures under changed conditions, we cannot deny that greater definiteness is one of their characteristics; and that if they have been evolved out of lower organisms, an increase of definiteness has been an accompaniment of their evolution. That in course of time, species have become more sharply marked off from other species, genera from genera, and orders from orders, is a conclusion not admitting of a more positive establishment than the foregoing; and must, indeed, stand or fall with it. If, however, species and genera and orders have resulted from the process of “natural selection,” then, as Mr. Darwin shows, there must have been a tendency to divergence, causing the contrasts between groups to become more and more pronounced. By the disappearance of intermediate forms, less fitted for special spheres of existence than the extreme forms they connected, the differences between the extreme forms must be rendered 187more decided; and so, from indistinct and unstable varieties, must slowly be produced distinct and stable species. Of which inference it may be remarked, not only that it follows from a process to which the organic creation is of necessity ever subject, but also that it is in harmony with what we know respecting races of men and races of domestic animals.
To show that Earth's plants and animals, whether looked at as whole groups or as separate species, have become more defined, is as impossible as proving that they have become more diverse: the lack of facts hinders both conclusions. However, if we consider the hypothesis, which is becoming increasingly likely, that every organic species, from the simplest to the most complex, has evolved from simpler forms through accumulating modifications—just as every individual organism does—we can see that there must have been progress from the vague to the specific, both in individual forms and groups of forms. We can start with the notable fact that many of the simplest living organisms (which are structurally similar to the germs of all more complex ones) are so vague in nature that it's challenging, if not impossible, to determine if they are plants or animals. There are ongoing debates among zoologists and botanists regarding several of them; it's even been suggested to classify them into a separate kingdom that would serve as a common ground for both the animal and plant kingdoms. Next, consider that among the Protozoa, extreme vagueness in shape is very common. In shell-less Rhizopods and their relatives, not only is the shape so irregular that it can't be accurately described, but it also varies between individuals and even within the same individual at different times. The aggregation of such creatures produces, among other vague bodies, sponges—forms that are indefinite in size, shape, internal structure, and lack an external boundary membrane. Additionally, the relatively vague nature of the simplest organisms is evident in how much their structures can change based on their environment: to the extent that, among the Protozoa and Protophyta, many forms once thought to be distinct species or even separate genera are now recognized as merely varieties of one species. When we think about how precise the attributes are in the most advanced organisms—how clearly defined their shapes, how consistent their proportions, and how relatively stable their structures are under different conditions—we cannot deny that increased clarity is one of their traits; and if they evolved from simpler organisms, then the development of clarity has accompanied that evolution. Over time, species have become more distinctly separated from other species, genera from genera, and orders from orders, a conclusion that cannot be more firmly established than the previous one. This must indeed stand or fall with it. However, if species, genera, and orders have emerged through the process of "natural selection," then, as Mr. Darwin suggests, there must have been a tendency towards divergence, leading to increasingly pronounced differences between groups. As intermediate forms, which are less suited for specific habitats than the extreme forms they connect, disappear, the differences between those extremes become more defined. Thus, from indistinct and unstable varieties, distinct and stable species must gradually emerge. It’s worth noting that not only does this follow from a process to which organic life is continuously subjected, but it also aligns with what we know about human races and breeds of domestic animals.
Evidence that in the course of psychial development, there is a change from the vague to the distinct, may be seen in every nursery. The confusion of the infant’s perceptions is shown by its inability to distinguish persons. The dimness of its ideas of direction and distance, may be inferred from the ill-guided movements of its hands, and from its endeavours to grasp objects far out of reach. Only by degrees does the sense of equilibrium, needful for safe standing and moving, gain the requisite precision. Through the insensible steps that end in comprehensible speech, we may trace an increase in the accuracy with which sounds are discriminated and in the nicety with which they are imitated. And similarly during education, the change is towards the establishment of internal relations more perfectly corresponding to external ones—to exactness in calculations, to a better representation of objects drawn, to a more correct spelling, to a completer conformity to the rules of speech, to clearer ideas respecting the affairs of life. How in the further progress to maturity the law still holds, needs not here be pointed out; more especially as it will presently be shown in treating of the evolution of intelligence during the advance of civilization. The only further fact calling for remark, is, that this increase of mental definiteness is, in some ways, manifested even during the advance from maturity to old age. The habits of life grow more and more fixed; the character becomes less capable of change; the quantity of knowledge previously acquired ceases to have its limits alterable by additions; and the opinions upon every point admit of no modification.
Evidence that, in the course of mental development, there is a shift from the vague to the clear can be seen in every nursery. The confusion of an infant's perceptions is evident in its inability to tell people apart. The unclear understanding of direction and distance can be inferred from its poorly directed hand movements and attempts to grab objects that are out of reach. Only gradually does the sense of balance, necessary for standing and moving safely, achieve the needed precision. Through the gradual steps that lead to understandable speech, we can see an improvement in the ability to distinguish sounds and in the skill of imitating them. Similarly, during education, the change is towards establishing internal connections that better correspond to external ones—such as accuracy in calculations, a more accurate depiction of drawn objects, better spelling, greater adherence to speech rules, and clearer understanding of life's matters. How this principle continues to apply as one matures is not necessary to discuss here, especially since it will be demonstrated when discussing the development of intelligence during civilization’s progress. The only additional point worth mentioning is that this increase in mental clarity is, in some ways, also evident during the transition from maturity to old age. Life habits become more fixed; character becomes less adaptable; the amount of knowledge gained no longer changes with new information; and opinions on various topics become unchangeable.
Still more manifestly do the successive phases through 188which societies pass, display the progress from indeterminate arrangement to determinate arrangement. A wandering tribe of savages, as being fixed neither in its locality nor in the relative positions of its parts, is far less definite than a nation, covering a territory clearly marked out, and formed of individuals grouped together in towns and villages. In such a tribe the social relations are similarly confused and unsettled. Political authority is neither well established nor precise. Distinctions of rank are neither clearly marked nor impassable. “Medicine-men” and “rain-makers” form a class by no means as distinct from the rest of the community as eventually becomes the priesthood they foreshadow. And save in the different occupations of men and women, there are no complete industrial divisions. Only in tribes of considerable size, which have enslaved other tribes, is the economical differentiation decided. Any one of these primitive societies however that developes, becomes step by step more specific. Increasing in size, consequently ceasing to be so nomadic, and restricted in its range by neighbouring tribes, it acquires, after prolonged border warfare, a more settled territorial boundary. The distinction between the royal race and the people, grows so extreme as to amount in the popular apprehension to a difference of nature. The warrior-class attains a perfect separation from classes devoted to the cultivation of the soil or other occupations regarded as servile. And there arises a priesthood that is defined in its rank, its functions, its privileges. This sharpness of definition, growing both greater and more variously exemplified as societies advance to maturity, is extremest in those that have reached their full development or are declining. Of ancient Egypt we read that its social divisions were strongly-marked and its customs rigid. Recent investigations make it more than ever clear, that among the Assyrians and surrounding peoples, not only were the laws unalterable, but even the minor habits, down to those of domestic routine, possessed a sacredness which insured their permanence. In India at the present day, the 189unchangeable distinctions of caste, not less than the constancy in modes of dress, industrial processes, and religious observances, show us how fixed are the arrangements where the antiquity is great. Nor does China with its long-settled political organization, its elaborate and precise conventions, and its unprogressive literature, fail to exemplify the same truth. The successive phases of our own and neighbouring societies, furnish facts somewhat different in kind but similar in meaning. After our leading class-divisions had become tolerably well-established, it was long before they acquired their full precision. Originally, monarchical authority was more baronial, and baronial authority more monarchical, than they afterwards became. Between modern priests and the priests of old times, who while officially teachers of religion were also warriors, judges, architects, there is a marked difference in definiteness of function. And among the people engaged in productive occupations, the like contrast would be found to hold: the industrial office has become more distinct from the military; and its various divisions from each other. A history of our constitution, reminding us how, after prolonged struggles, the powers of King, Lords, and Commons, have been gradually settled, would clearly exhibit analogous changes. Countless facts bearing the like construction would meet us, were we to trace the development of legislation: in the successive stages of which, we should find statutes made more precise in their provisions—more specific in their applications to particular cases. Even at the present time we see that each new law, beginning as a vague proposition, is, in the course of enactment, elaborated into specific clauses; and further that only after its interpretation has been established by judges’ decisions in courts of justice, does it reach its final definiteness. From the history of minor institutions like evidence may be gathered. Religious, charitable, literary, and all other societies, beginning with ends and methods roughly sketched out and easily modifiable, show us how, by 190the accumulation of rules and precedents, the purposes become more distinct and the modes of action more restricted; until at last death often results from a fixity which admits of no adaptation to new conditions. Should it be objected that among civilized nations there are examples of decreasing definiteness, (instance the breaking down of limits between ranks,) the reply is, that such apparent exceptions are the accompaniments of a social metamorphosis—a change from the military or predatory type of social structure, to the industrial or mercantile type, during which the old lines of organization are disappearing and the new ones becoming more marked.
The various stages that societies go through clearly show a move from vague arrangements to more defined structures. A wandering tribe of savages, having no fixed home or clear organization, is much less defined than a nation with a clearly marked territory, made up of individuals living in towns and villages. In such a tribe, social relationships are just as confused and unstable. Political authority isn't well-defined or established. Social ranks aren't clearly marked or rigid. Roles like "medicine-men" and "rain-makers" don't stand out from the rest of the community as clearly as the priesthood that eventually emerges. Aside from the different jobs of men and women, there aren't any significant divisions of labor. Only larger tribes that have conquered others show clear economic differentiation. However, any of these primitive societies that develop will gradually become more specific. As they grow larger and settle more due to neighboring tribes, they establish clearer territorial boundaries after extended conflicts. The divide between the royal class and the general populace becomes so significant that it is perceived as a fundamental difference. The warrior class becomes distinctly separated from those engaged in farming or other labor deemed servile. A more defined priesthood with clear ranks, duties, and privileges emerges. This increasing clarity, becoming both sharper and more varied as societies mature, is most pronounced in those that have fully developed or are in decline. Ancient Egypt is noted for its strong social divisions and rigid customs. Recent studies show that among the Assyrians and nearby cultures, laws were unchangeable, and even everyday habits had a sacred quality that ensured their permanence. In present-day India, the unchanging caste distinctions, along with consistent clothing styles, industrial methods, and religious practices, highlight how ingrained these arrangements are due to their long history. Similarly, China, with its long-standing political structures, precise customs, and stagnant literature, exemplifies this concept. The changing phases of our own and neighboring societies present somewhat different facts but share a similar meaning. Once our main class divisions became fairly well established, it took a long time for them to gain precision. Initially, monarchical power was more baronial, and baronial power was more monarchical than they subsequently became. There's a notable difference in the roles of modern priests compared to ancient priests, who were not only religious leaders but also warriors, judges, and architects. A similar contrast exists among people working in productive roles: the industrial role has become more distinct from military roles, and their various subdivisions have also become more separate. A historical account of our constitution would show how, after long struggles, the powers of the King, Lords, and Commons have gradually been clarified. Numerous facts could illustrate similar developments if we traced the evolution of legislation: in successive stages, we would find laws becoming more precise in their provisions and more specific in their applications to particular cases. Even today, each new law begins as a vague proposal and is refined into specific clauses during enactment; only after judges' decisions in courts establish its interpretation does it reach its final clarity. Evidence can also be drawn from the history of smaller institutions. Religious, charitable, literary, and other societies often start with roughly outlined purposes and methods, which are easily changeable. Through the accumulation of rules and precedents, their aims become clearer and their methods more restricted, often leading to a rigidity that cannot adapt to new conditions. If one argues that there are examples of decreasing definiteness among civilized nations (like the blurring of ranks), it can be countered that these apparent anomalies accompany a social transformation—a shift from a military or predatory social structure to an industrial or commercial one, during which the old organizational lines fade and new ones become clearer.
That all organized results of social action, pass in the course of civilization through parallel phases, is demonstrable. Being, as they are, objective products of subjective processes, they must display corresponding changes; and that they do this, the cases of Language, of Science, of Art, clearly prove.
The organized outcomes of social action go through similar stages as civilization develops, and this can be proven. Since they are objective results of subjective processes, they must show corresponding changes; and the examples of Language, Science, and Art clearly demonstrate this.
If we strike out from our sentences everything but nouns and verbs, we shall perceive how extremely vague is the expression of ideas in undeveloped tongues. When we note how each inflection of a verb or addition by which the case of a noun is marked, serves to limit the conditions of action or of existence, we see that these constituents of speech enable men more precisely to communicate their thoughts. That the application of an adjective to a noun or an adverb to a verb, narrows the class of things or changes indicated, implies that these additional words serve further to define the meaning. And similarly with other parts of speech. The like effect results from the multiplication of words of each order. When the names for objects, and acts, and qualities, are but few, the range of each is proportionately wide, and its meaning therefore unspecific. The similes and metaphors so abundantly used by aboriginal races, are simply vehicles for indirectly and imperfectly conveying ideas, which lack of words disables them from conveying directly 191and perfectly. In contrasting these figurative expressions, interpretable in various senses, with the expressions which we should use in place of them, the increase of exactness which wealth of language gives, is rendered very obvious. Or to take a case from ordinary life, if we compare the speech of the peasant, who, out of his limited vocabulary, can describe the contents of the bottle he carries, only as “doctor’s-stuff” which he has got for his “sick” wife, with the speech of the physician, who tells those educated like himself the particular composition of the medicine, and the particular disorder for which he has prescribed it; we have vividly brought home to us, the precision which language gains by the multiplication of terms. Again, in the course of its evolution, each tongue acquires a further accuracy through processes which fix the meaning of each word. Intellectual intercourse tends gradually to diminish laxity of expression. By and by dictionaries give definitions. And eventually, among the most cultivated, indefiniteness is not tolerated, either in the terms used or in their grammatical combinations. Once more, languages considered as wholes, become gradually more distinct from each other, and from their common parent: as witness in early times the divergence from the same root of two languages so unlike as Greek and Latin, and in later times the development of three Latin dialects into Italian, French, and Spanish.
If we remove everything from our sentences except nouns and verbs, we can see how vague ideas are expressed in less developed languages. When we observe how each change in a verb or the addition of a noun's case clarifies the conditions of action or existence, it shows that these parts of speech help people communicate their thoughts more accurately. The use of an adjective with a noun or an adverb with a verb narrows down the categories of things or changes described, indicating that these extra words help define meaning further. The same applies to other parts of speech. The same effect comes from using more words in each category. When there are only a few words for objects, actions, and qualities, each word can cover a wide range and thus be less specific. The similes and metaphors commonly used by indigenous peoples are simply ways to indirectly and imperfectly express ideas that their limited vocabulary prevents them from conveying directly and accurately. Comparing these figurative expressions, which can be interpreted in many ways, to the precise terms we would use instead highlights how much more exact language becomes with a richer vocabulary. For example, if we compare how a peasant, with a limited vocabulary, describes the contents of the bottle he carries as “doctor’s-stuff” for his “sick” wife, with how a physician, speaking to others like him, details the specific composition of the medicine and the exact illness it’s for, we can clearly see how much more precise language becomes with more terms. Additionally, as languages evolve, each gains greater accuracy through processes that clarify the meaning of each word. Intellectual communication gradually reduces vague expression. Over time, dictionaries provide definitions, and eventually, among the more educated, ambiguity is not accepted, either in the terms used or in their grammatical arrangements. Moreover, as languages develop as a whole, they become progressively more distinct from each other and from their common ancestor, as evidenced in ancient times by the divergence of Greek and Latin from the same root, and later by the evolution of three Latin dialects into Italian, French, and Spanish.
In his “History of the Inductive Sciences,” Dr. Whewell says that the Greeks failed in physical philosophy because their “ideas were not distinct, and appropriate to the facts.” I do not quote this remark for its luminousness; since it would be equally proper to ascribe the indistinctness and inappropriateness of their ideas to the imperfection of their physical philosophy; but I quote it because it serves as good evidence of the indefiniteness of primitive science. The same work and its fellow on “The Philosophy of the Inductive Sciences,” supply other evidences equally good, because equally independent of any such hypothesis as is here to be 192established. Respecting mathematics we have the fact that geometrical theorems grew out of empirical methods; and that these theorems, at first isolated, did not acquire the clearness which complete demonstration gives, until they were arranged by Euclid into a series of dependent propositions. At a later period the same general truth was exemplified in the progress from the “method of exhaustions” and the “method of indivisibles” to the “method of limits;” which is the central idea of the infinitesimal calculus. In early mechanics, too, may be traced a dim perception that action and re-action are equal and opposite; though for ages after, this truth remained unformulated. And similarly, the property of inertia, though not distinctly comprehended until Kepler lived, was vaguely recognized long previously. “The conception of statical force,” “was never presented in a distinct form till the works of Archimedes appeared;” and “the conception of accelerating force was confused, in the mind of Kepler and his contemporaries, and did not become clear enough for purposes of sound scientific reasoning before the succeeding century.” To which specific assertions may be added the general remark, that “terms which originally, and before the laws of motion were fully known, were used in a very vague and fluctuating sense, were afterwards limited and rendered precise.” When we turn from abstract scientific conceptions to the concrete previsions of science, of which astronomy furnishes us with numerous examples, the like contrast is visible. The times at which celestial phenomena will occur, have been predicted with ever-increasing accuracy: errors once amounting to days, have been reduced down to seconds. The correspondence between the real and supposed forms of orbits, has been growing gradually more precise. Originally thought circular, then epicyclical, then elliptical, orbits are now ascertained to be curves which always deviate more or less from perfect ellipses, and which are ever undergoing change. But the general advance of Science in definiteness, is best shown by the contrast between its qualitative 193stage, and its quantitative stage. At first, the facts ascertained were, that between such and such phenomena some connexion existed—that the appearances a and b always occurred together or in succession; but it was neither known what was the nature of the relation between a and b, nor how much of a accompanied so much of b. The development of Science has in part been the reduction of these vague connexions to distinct ones. Most relations have been determined as belonging to the classes mechanical, chemical, thermal, electric, magnetic, &c.; and we have learnt to infer the amounts of the antecedents and consequents from each other with an exactness that becomes ever greater. Were there space to state them, illustrations of this truth might be cited from all departments of physics; but it must suffice here to instance the general progress of chemistry. Besides the conspicuous fact that we have positively ascertained the constituent elements of an immense number of compounds which our ancestors could not analyze, and of a far greater number which they never even saw, there is the still more conspicuous fact that the combining equivalents of these elements are accurately calculated. The beginnings of a like advance from qualitative to quantitative prevision, may be traced even in some of the higher sciences. Physiology shows it in the weighing and measuring of organic products, and of the materials consumed. By Pathology it is displayed in the use of the statistical method of determining the sources of diseases, and the effects of treatment. In Zoology and Botany, the numerical comparisons of Floras and Faunas, leading to specific conclusions respecting their sources and distributions, illustrate it. And in Sociology, questionable as are the conclusions usually drawn from the classified sum-totals of the census, from Board-of-Trade tables, and from criminal returns, it must be admitted that these imply a progress towards more accurate conceptions of social phenomena. That an essential characteristic of advancing Science is increase in definiteness, appears indeed 194almost a truism, when we remember that Science may be described as definite knowledge, in contradistinction to that indefinite knowledge possessed by the uncultured. And if, as we cannot question, Science has, in the slow course of ages, been evolved out of this indefinite knowledge of the uncultured; then, the gradual acquirement of that great definiteness which now distinguishes it, must have been a leading trait in its evolution.
In his “History of the Inductive Sciences,” Dr. Whewell says that the Greeks missed the mark in physical philosophy because their “ideas were not distinct and appropriate to the facts.” I don’t quote this for its brilliance, since it’s just as valid to attribute the confusion and inappropriateness of their ideas to the shortcomings of their physical philosophy; I mention it because it highlights the vagueness of early science. That same work, along with its companion on “The Philosophy of the Inductive Sciences,” provides other equally strong evidence, independent of any hypothesis being proposed here. Regarding mathematics, we see that geometrical theorems originated from practical methods, and these theorems, initially isolated, didn’t achieve the clarity provided by complete proof until Euclid organized them into a series of related propositions. Later on, this same general principle was demonstrated in the shift from the “method of exhaustions” and the “method of indivisibles” to the “method of limits,” which is the core concept of infinitesimal calculus. Early mechanics also shows a faint awareness that action and reaction are equal and opposite, even though this truth remained unarticulated for ages afterwards. Likewise, the principle of inertia, while not clearly understood until Kepler's time, was vaguely recognized long before. The “concept of static force” wasn’t clearly defined until Archimedes’ works appeared, and the “concept of accelerating force was muddled in the minds of Kepler and his contemporaries, not becoming clear enough for sound scientific reasoning until the next century.” We can also add that “terms which originally, and before the laws of motion were fully understood, were used in a very vague and changing manner, were later refined and made precise.” When we shift from abstract scientific ideas to the concrete predictions of science, astronomy offers many examples of this contrast. The timing of celestial events has been predicted with increasing accuracy: errors that once spanned days have now been narrowed down to seconds. The alignment between actual and theoretical orbital shapes has gradually become more accurate. Initially believed to be circular, then epicyclical, and then elliptical, orbits are now understood to be curves that always deviate to some extent from perfect ellipses, and are constantly changing. But the overall progress of Science in clarity is best illustrated by the difference between its qualitative stage and its quantitative stage. In the beginning, our observations showed that there was some connection between certain phenomena—that appearances a and b always occurred together or in sequence; however, the nature of the relationship between a and b was not understood, nor was it known how much of a corresponded to a certain amount of b. The advancement of Science has partly involved turning these vague connections into precise ones. Most relationships are now categorized into mechanical, chemical, thermal, electric, magnetic, etc.; and we've learned to infer the amounts of causes and effects from each other with increasing accuracy. If there were room to elaborate, examples of this reality could be drawn from all areas of physics; but for now, it suffices to mention the general advancement of chemistry. Beyond the obvious fact that we have positively identified the constituent elements of a vast number of compounds that our ancestors couldn’t analyze, and many more they never encountered, there's the even more notable fact that the combining equivalents of these elements are accurately calculated. We can even trace the beginnings of a similar shift from qualitative to quantitative prediction in some of the higher sciences. Physiology demonstrates this through the weighing and measuring of organic products and materials consumed. Pathology displays it through the statistical approach to understanding disease sources and treatment effects. In Zoology and Botany, numerical comparisons of Floras and Faunas lead to specific conclusions about their sources and distributions. In Sociology, although the conclusions typically drawn from the categorized totals of the census, trade tables, and criminal statistics are questionable, it must be acknowledged that they represent progress towards more accurate views of social phenomena. It is indeed almost a truism that a key feature of advancing Science is an increase in clarity, especially when we recognize that Science can be described as definite knowledge, in contrast to the vague knowledge held by the uneducated. And if, as we cannot deny, Science has emerged slowly from this vague understanding of the uneducated, then the gradual achievement of the significant clarity that now characterizes it must have been a central aspect of its development.
The Arts, industrial and æsthetic, furnish illustrations perhaps still more striking. Flint implements of the kind recently found in certain of the later geologic deposits—implements so rude that some have held them to be of natural rather than of artificial origin—show the extreme want of precision in men’s first handyworks. Though a great advance on these is seen in the tools and weapons of existing savage tribes, yet an inexactness in forms and fittings, more than anything else distinguishes such tools and weapons from those of civilized races. In a less degree, the productions of semi-barbarous nations are characterized by like defects. A Chinese junk with all its contained furniture and appliances, nowhere presents a perfectly straight line, a uniform curve, or a true surface. Nor do the utensils and machines of our ancestors fail to exhibit a similar inferiority to our own. An antique chair, an old fireplace, a lock of the last century, or almost any article of household use that has been preserved for a few generations, will prove by contrast how greatly the industrial products of our time excel those of the past in their accuracy. Since planing machines have been invented, it has become possible to produce absolutely straight lines, and surfaces so truly level as to be air-tight when applied to each other. While in the dividing-engine of Troughton, in the micrometer of Whitworth, and in microscopes that show fifty thousand divisions to the inch, we have an exactness as far exceeding that reached in the works of our great-grandfathers, as theirs exceeded that of the aboriginal celt-makers. In the Fine Arts there has 195been a parallel process. From the rudely carved and painted idols of savages, through the early sculptures characterized by limbs having no muscular detail, wooden-looking drapery, and faces devoid of individuality, up to the later statues of the Greeks or some of those now produced, the increased accuracy of representation is conspicuous. Compare the mural paintings of the Egyptians with the paintings of medieval Europe, or these with modern paintings, and the more precise rendering of the appearances of objects is manifest. So too is it with the delineations of fiction and the drama. In the marvellous tales current among Eastern nations, in the romantic legends of feudal Europe, as well as in the mystery-plays and those immediately succeeding them, we see great want of correspondence to the realities of life; not only in the predominance of supernatural events and extremely improbable coincidences, but also in the vaguely-indicated personages, who are nothing more than embodiments of virtue and vice in general, or at best of particular virtues and vices. Through transitions that need not be specified, there has been a progressive diminution, in both fiction and the drama, of whatever is unnatural—whatever does not answer to real life. And now, novels and plays are applauded in proportion to the fidelity with which they exhibit individual characters with their motives and consequent actions; improbabilities, like the impossibilities which preceded them, are disallowed; and there is even an incipient abandonment of those elaborate plots which the realities of life rarely if ever furnish.
The arts, both industrial and aesthetic, provide examples that may be even more striking. Flint tools recently discovered in some of the later geological layers—so primitive that some argue they appear to be natural rather than man-made—demonstrate the lack of precision in early human creations. While there's a significant improvement in the tools and weapons of today’s indigenous tribes, a lack of accuracy in shapes and fittings still sets them apart from those of civilized societies. Similarly, the products of semi-barbarous nations show these flaws, although to a lesser extent. A Chinese junk, with all its furniture and equipment, never displays a perfectly straight line, a consistent curve, or a true surface. The utensils and machines of our ancestors also reveal a similar inferiority compared to ours. An old chair, a vintage fireplace, a lock from the last century, or nearly any household item kept for a few generations will highlight how much the industrial products of our time surpass those of the past in terms of accuracy. With the invention of planing machines, we can now create perfectly straight lines and surfaces so level they can be airtight when combined. In Troughton's dividing-engine, Whitworth's micrometer, and microscopes showing fifty thousand divisions per inch, we achieve a precision that far exceeds what our great-grandfathers accomplished, just as their work was superior to that of the original tool makers. In the Fine Arts, we see a similar development. From the roughly carved and painted idols of early societies, through early sculptures with no muscular detail, stiff drapery, and faces lacking individuality, to the later Greek statues and some contemporary ones, the enhanced accuracy of representation is clear. If we compare the mural paintings of the Egyptians with the art of medieval Europe, and then with modern paintings, the more precise depiction of objects is evident. This trend also applies to fiction and drama. In the fantastical stories from Eastern cultures, the romantic legends of feudal Europe, and in the mystery plays that followed, there's a significant disconnect from real life, not just in the emphasis on supernatural events and improbable coincidences, but also in the vaguely defined characters, who are merely representations of general virtues and vices, or, at best, specific ones. Through various transitions, there's been a steady decrease in both fiction and drama of anything unnatural—anything that doesn’t reflect real life. Nowadays, novels and plays are praised for their accuracy in portraying individual characters with their motives and resulting actions; improbabilities, much like the impossibilities of the past, are no longer accepted; and there’s even a growing move away from those complex plots that real life seldom provides.
Were it needful, it would be easy to accumulate evidences of various other kinds. The progress from myths and legends, extreme in their misrepresentations, to a history that has slowly become, and is still becoming, more accurate; the establishment of settled systematic methods of doing things, instead of the indeterminate ways at first pursued; and the great increase in the number of points on which conflicting opinion has settled down into exact knowledge; 196might severally be used further to exemplify the general truth enunciated. The basis of induction is, however, already sufficiently wide. Proof that all Evolution is from the indefinite to the definite, we find to be not less abundant than proof that all Evolution is from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. The one kind of change is co-extensive with the other—is equally with it exhibited throughout Nature.
If necessary, it would be easy to gather evidence of various kinds. The shift from myths and legends, which often misrepresent the truth, to a history that has gradually become, and is still becoming, more accurate; the establishment of consistent systematic methods as opposed to the uncertain approaches initially taken; and the significant increase in the number of topics where conflicting opinions have settled into definite knowledge; 196could each be used to further illustrate the general truth stated. However, the foundation of induction is already broad enough. Evidence that all evolution moves from the indefinite to the definite is just as abundant as evidence that all evolution moves from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. One type of change is as widespread as the other and is equally represented throughout nature.
§ 56. To form a complete conception of Evolution, we have to contemplate it under yet another aspect. This advance from the indefinite to the definite, is obviously not primary but secondary—is an incidental result attendant on the finishing of certain changes. The transformation of a whole that was originally uniform, into a combination of multiform parts, implies a progressive separation. While this is going on there must be indistinctness. Only as each separated division draws into its general mass those diffused peripheral portions which are at first imperfectly disunited from the peripheral portions of neighbouring divisions, can it acquire anything like a precise outline. And it cannot become perfectly definite until its units are aggregated into a compact whole. That is to say, the acquirement of definiteness is simply a concomitant of complete union of the elements constituting each component division. Thus, Evolution is characterized not only by a continuous multiplication of parts, but also by a growing oneness in each part. And while an advance in heterogeneity results from progressive differentiation, an advance in definiteness results from progressive integration. The two changes are simultaneous; or are rather opposite aspects of the same change. This change, however, cannot be rightly comprehended without looking at both its sides. Let us then once more consider Evolution under its several manifestations; for the purpose of noting how it is throughout a process of integration.
§ 56. To fully understand Evolution, we need to look at it from another angle. This shift from the vague to the clear is clearly not a primary change but a secondary one—it’s a result of completing certain alterations. The transformation of what was once uniform into a mix of different parts requires a gradual separation. During this process, there will be a lack of clarity. Only when each separated section starts to pull in the scattered parts that were initially not clearly distinct from the surrounding sections can it develop a clear outline. It cannot become truly defined until its parts are brought together into a solid whole. In other words, gaining clarity is simply a byproduct of the complete union of the elements that make up each section. Thus, Evolution is marked not only by an ongoing increase in parts, but also by a growing unity in each part. While progress in diversity comes from increasing differences, progress in clarity comes from increasing integration. These two changes happen at the same time; or they are different sides of the same change. However, we can't fully understand this change without considering both aspects. So, let’s take another look at Evolution through its various manifestations to see how it is a continuous process of integration.
The illustrations furnished by the Solar System, supposing 197it to have had a nebular origin, are so obvious as scarcely to need indicating. That as a whole, it underwent a gradual concentration while assuming its present distribution of parts; and that there subsequently took place a like concentration of the matter forming each planet and satellite, is the leading feature of the hypothesis. The process of integration is here seen in its simplest and most decided form.
The examples provided by the Solar System, assuming it originated from a nebula, are so clear that they hardly need to be pointed out. Overall, it experienced a gradual coming together while taking on its current arrangement of components; and a similar gathering of material for each planet and moon occurred later on, which is the main point of the theory. The process of integration is demonstrated here in its most straightforward and definitive form.
Geologic evolution, if we trace it up from that molten state of the Earth’s substance which we are obliged to postulate, supplies us with more varied facts of like meaning. The advance from a thin crust, at first everywhere fissured and moveable, to a crust so solid and thick as to be but now and then very partially dislocated by disturbing forces, exemplifies the unifying process; as does likewise the advance from a surface covered with small patches of land and water, to one divided into continents and oceans—an advance also resulting from the Earth’s gradual solidification. Moreover, the collection of detritus into strata of great extent, and the union of such strata into extensive “systems,” becomes possible only as surfaces of land and water become wide, and subsidences great, in both area and depth; whence it follows that integrations of this order must have grown more pronounced as the Earth’s crust thickened. Different and simpler instances of the process through which mixed materials are separated, and the kindred units aggregated into masses, are exhibited in the detailed structure of the Earth. The phenomena of crystallization may be cited en masse, as showing how the unifications of similar elements take place wherever the conditions permit. Not only do we see this where there is little or no hindrance to the approach of the particles, as in the cases of crystals formed from solutions, or by sublimation; but it is also seen where there are great obstacles to their approach. The flints and the nodules of iron pyrites that are found in chalk, as well as the silicious concretions which occasionally occur in limestone, can be interpreted only as aggregations of atoms of 198silex or sulphuret of iron, originally diffused almost uniformly through the deposit, but gradually collected round certain centres, notwithstanding the solid or semi-solid state of the surrounding matter. Iron-stone as it ordinarily occurs, presents a similar phenomenon to be similarly explained; and what is called bog iron-ore supplies the conditions and the result in still more obvious correlation.
Geologic evolution, if we trace it back from that molten state of the Earth’s material which we have to assume, gives us a wider range of similar facts. The transition from a thin crust, initially cracked and movable everywhere, to a crust so solid and thick that it’s only occasionally disturbed by external forces illustrates this unifying process; the same goes for the shift from a landscape dotted with small areas of land and water to one divided into continents and oceans—this shift also results from the Earth’s gradual solidification. Furthermore, the accumulation of debris into extensive layers and the merging of these layers into large "systems" only becomes possible as land and water surfaces widen and subsidence increases in both area and depth; thus, these types of integrations likely became more pronounced as the Earth’s crust thickened. Different and simpler examples of the process by which mixed materials are sorted, and similar units grouped into masses, can be seen in the Earth’s structure. The phenomenon of crystallization can be cited as showing how similar elements unite wherever the conditions allow. We observe this not only when there is little or no barrier to the particles coming together, such as in crystals formed from solutions or by sublimation, but also when significant obstacles exist. The flints and iron pyrite nodules found in chalk, along with the siliceous concretions that occasionally appear in limestone, can only be understood as groupings of atoms of silicate or iron sulfide, which were originally spread out almost uniformly throughout the deposit but gradually gathered around certain centers, despite the solid or semi-solid state of the surrounding material. Ironstone, as it typically occurs, presents a similar phenomenon that can be explained in the same way; and what is known as bog iron ore provides the conditions and the outcome in an even clearer relation.
During the evolution of an organism, there occurs, as every physiologist knows, not only separation of parts, but coalescence of parts. In the mammalian embryo, the heart, at first a long pulsating blood-vessel, by and by twists upon itself and becomes integrated. The layer of bile-cells constituting the rudimentary liver, do not simply become different from the wall of the intestine in which they at first lie; but they simultaneously diverge from it and consolidate into an organ. The anterior segments of the cerebro-spinal axis, which are at first continuous with the rest, and distinguished only by their larger size, undergo a gradual union; and at the same time the resulting head consolidates into a mass clearly marked off from the rest of the vertebral column. The like process, variously exemplified in other organs, is meanwhile exhibited by the body as a whole; which becomes integrated, somewhat in the same way that the contents of an outspread handkerchief become integrated when its edges are drawn in and fastened to make a bundle. Analogous changes go on long after birth, and continue even up to old age. In the human being that gradual solidification of the bony framework, which, during childhood, is seen in the coalescence of portions of the same bone ossified from different centres, is afterwards seen in the coalescence of bones that were originally distinct. The appendages of the vertebræ unite with the vertebral centres to which they belong—a change not completed until towards thirty. At the same time the epiphyses, formed separately from the main bodies of their respective bones, have their cartilaginous connexions turned into osseous ones—are fused to the masses beneath them. The component 199vertebræ of the sacrum, which remain separate till about the sixteenth year, then begin to unite; and in ten or a dozen years more their union is complete. Still later occurs the coalescence of the coccygeal vertebræ; and there are some other bony unions which are not completed until advanced age. To which add that the increase of density and toughness, going on throughout the tissues in general during life, may be regarded as the formation of a more highly integrated substance. The species of change thus illustrated under its several aspects in the unfolding of the human body, may be traced in all animals. That mode of it which consists in the union of homogeneous parts originally separate, has been described by Milne-Edwards and others, as exhibited in various of the invertebrata; though it does not seem to have been included by them as an essential peculiarity in the process of organic development. We shall, however, be led strongly to suspect that progressive integration should form part of the definition of this process, when we find it displayed not only in tracing up the stages passed through by every embryo, but also in ascending from the lower living creatures to the higher. And here, as in the evolution of individual organisms, it goes on both longitudinally and transversely: under which different forms we may indeed most conveniently consider it. Of longitudinal integration, the sub-kingdom Annulosa supplies abundant examples. Its lower members, such as worms and myriapods, are mostly characterized by the great number of segments composing them: reaching in some cases to several hundreds. But in the higher divisions—crustaceans, insects, and spiders—we find this number reduced down to twenty-two, thirteen, or even fewer; while, accompanying the reduction, there is a shortening or integration of the whole body, reaching its extreme in the crab and the spider. The significance of these contrasts, as bearing upon the general doctrine of Evolution, will be seen when it is pointed out that they are parallel to those which arise during the development of individual Annulosa. In the lobster, the head and 200thorax form one compact box, made by the union of a number of segments which in the embryo were separable. Similarly, the butterfly shows us segments so much more closely united than they were in the caterpillar, as to be, some of them, no longer distinguishable from each other. The Vertebrata again, throughout their successively higher classes, furnish like instances of longitudinal union. In most fishes, and in reptiles that have no limbs, the only segments of the spinal column that coalesce, are those forming the skull. In most mammals and in birds, a variable number of vertebræ become fused together to form the sacrum; and in the higher quadrumana and man, the caudal vertebræ also lose their separate individualities in a single os coccygis. That which we may distinguish as transverse integration, is well illustrated among the Annulosa in the development of the nervous system. Leaving out those most degraded forms which do not present distinct ganglia, it is to be observed that the lower annulose animals, in common with the larvæ of the higher, are severally characterized by a double chain of ganglia running from end to end of the body; while in the more perfectly formed annulose animals, this double chain becomes more or less completely united into a single chain. Mr. Newport has described the course of this concentration as exhibited in insects; and by Rathke it has been traced in crustaceans. During the early stages of the Astacus fluviatilis, or common cray-fish, there is a pair of separate ganglia to each ring. Of the fourteen pairs belonging to the head and thorax, the three pairs in advance of the mouth consolidate into one mass to form the brain, or cephalic ganglion. Meanwhile, out of the remainder, the first six pairs severally unite in the median line, while the rest remain more or less separate. Of these six double ganglia thus formed, the anterior four coalesce into one mass; the remaining two coalesce into another mass; and then these two masses coalesce into one. Here we see longitudinal and transverse integration going on simultaneously; and in the highest 201crustaceans they are both carried still further. The Vertebrata clearly exhibit transverse integration in the development of the generative system. The lowest of the mammalia—the Monotremata—in common with birds, to which they are in many respects allied, have oviducts which towards their lower extremities are dilated into cavities, severally performing in an imperfect way the function of a uterus. “In the Marsupialia there is a closer approximation of the two lateral sets of organs on the median line; for the oviducts converge towards one another and meet (without coalescing) on the median line; so that their uterine dilatations are in contact with each other, forming a true ‘double uterus....’ As we ascend the series of ‘placental’ mammals, we find the lateral coalescence becoming more and more complete.... In many of the Rodentia the uterus still remains completely divided into two lateral halves; whilst in others these coalesce at their lower portions, forming a rudiment of the true ‘body’ of the uterus in the human subject. This part increases at the expense of the lateral ‘cornua’ in the higher herbivora and carnivora; but even in the lower quadrumana the uterus is somewhat cleft at its summit.”[10]
During the development of an organism, as every physiologist knows, there is not only a separation of parts but also a joining of parts. In the mammalian embryo, the heart, initially a long pulsating blood vessel, eventually twists and becomes integrated. The layer of bile cells that makes up the rudimentary liver does not just become distinct from the wall of the intestine where they originally lie; they both move away from it and solidify into an organ. The front segments of the spinal cord, which are initially continuous with the rest and only distinguished by their larger size, gradually unify; at the same time, the resulting head becomes clearly defined from the rest of the vertebral column. This process, similarly shown in other organs, is also displayed by the body as a whole, which becomes integrated in a way reminiscent of how the contents of a spread-out handkerchief come together when its edges are drawn in and tied to form a bundle. Similar changes continue long after birth and even into old age. In humans, that slow solidification of the bony structure, observed in childhood as portions of the same bone fuse from different centers, later appears in the uniting of bones that were initially separate. The extensions of the vertebrae connect with the vertebral centers to which they belong—a change that isn’t finished until around the age of thirty. At the same time, the epiphyses, initially formed separately from the main bodies of their respective bones, have their cartilaginous connections replaced with bony ones—fusing to the masses beneath them. The individual vertebrae of the sacrum, which remain separate until about the sixteenth year, then begin to combine; and in ten or twelve more years, they are fully united. The fusion of the coccygeal vertebrae occurs even later, and some other bony unions aren't completed until later in life. Additionally, the increase in density and toughness occurring throughout the tissues during life can be viewed as the creation of a more integrated substance. The types of change illustrated in various aspects during the development of the human body can be seen in all animals. The process of joining originally separate, similar parts has been described by Milne-Edwards and others as evident in various invertebrates; although it doesn’t appear to have been recognized by them as a key characteristic of the organic development process. However, we are strongly led to suspect that progressive integration should be included in the definition of this process when we observe it not only in tracing the stages undergone by each embryo but also in moving from lower living creatures to higher ones. Here, as in the evolution of individual organisms, it occurs both lengthwise and widthwise: forms under which we may indeed most conveniently consider it. Of longitudinal integration, the sub-kingdom Annulosa provides plenty of examples. Its lower members, such as worms and myriapods, are mostly defined by a large number of segments, sometimes reaching into the hundreds. However, in the higher divisions—crustaceans, insects, and spiders—we see that number reduced to twenty-two, thirteen, or even fewer; alongside this reduction comes a shortening or integration of the entire body, reaching its extreme in the crab and the spider. The significance of these contrasts, in relation to the general doctrine of Evolution, will become clear when it is pointed out that they parallel those arising during the development of individual Annulosa. In the lobster, the head and thorax form a single compact unit, created from several segments that were separable in the embryo. Similarly, in butterflies, we see segments that are far more closely united than they were in the caterpillar, so much so that some of them are no longer distinguishable from one another. The Vertebrata, through their increasingly higher classes, provide similar instances of longitudinal unity. In most fish and limbless reptiles, the only segments of the spinal column that fuse are those that form the skull. In many mammals and birds, a variable number of vertebrae fuse together to create the sacrum; and in higher primates and humans, the tail vertebrae also lose their distinct identities and merge into a single coccyx. What we can label as transverse integration is well demonstrated among the Annulosa in the development of the nervous system. Excluding those very degraded forms lacking distinct ganglia, it’s notable that the lower annulose animals, similar to the larvae of the higher ones, are characterized by a double chain of ganglia extending from one end of the body to the other; while in more developed annulose animals, this double chain becomes more or less completely united into a single chain. Mr. Newport has described the path of this concentration as seen in insects; Rathke has traced it in crustaceans. In the early stages of the Astacus fluviatilis, or common crayfish, there is a pair of separate ganglia for each segment. Of the fourteen pairs belonging to the head and thorax, three pairs in front of the mouth combine to form a single mass known as the brain, or cephalic ganglion. At the same time, out of the rest, the first six pairs come together along the middle line, while the others remain somewhat separated. Of these six double ganglia formed, the first four merge into one mass; the remaining two merge into another mass; and then these two masses come together into one. Here we see longitudinal and transverse integration happening simultaneously; and in the most advanced crustaceans, both are taken even further. The Vertebrata clearly display transverse integration in the development of the reproductive system. The most primitive mammals—the Monotremata—along with birds, with which they share many traits, have oviducts that dilate toward their lower ends into cavities that somewhat imperfectly perform the function of a uterus. “In the Marsupialia, there is a closer alignment of the two lateral sets of organs along the middle line; the oviducts converge toward each other and meet (without merging) on the midline; creating a true ‘double uterus....’ As we rise through the ranks of ‘placental’ mammals, we find the lateral merging becoming more and more complete.... In many of the Rodentia, the uterus still remains fully divided into two lateral halves; while in others, these merge at their lower sections, forming a rudiment of the true ‘body’ of the uterus in humans. This part expands at the expense of the lateral ‘cornua’ in the higher herbivores and carnivores; but even in lower primates, the uterus is somewhat split at its top.”
In the social organism integrative changes are not less clearly and abundantly exemplified. Uncivilized societies display them when wandering families, such as the bushmen show us, unite into tribes of considerable numbers. Among these we see a further progress of like nature everywhere manifested in the subjugation of weaker tribes by stronger ones; and in the subordination of their respective chiefs to the conquering chief. The partial combinations thus resulting, which among aboriginal races are being continually formed and continually broken up, become, among the superior races, both more complete and more permanent. If we trace the metamorphoses through which our own society, or any adjacent one, has passed, we see this unification from time to time 202repeated on a larger scale and with increasing stability. The aggregation of juniors and the children of juniors under elders and the children of elders; the consequent establishment of groups of vassals bound to their respective nobles; the subordination afterwards established of groups of inferior nobles to dukes or earls; and the still later establishment of the kingly power over dukes or earls; are so many instances of increasing consolidation. This process through which petty tenures are combined into feuds, feuds into provinces, provinces into kingdoms, and finally contiguous kingdoms into a single one, slowly completes itself by destroying the original lines of demarcation. And it may be further remarked of the European nations as a whole, that in the tendency to form alliances more or less lasting, in the restraining influences exercised by the several governments over each other, in the system that is gradually establishing itself of settling international disputes by congresses, as well as in the breaking down of commercial barriers and the increasing facilities of communication, we may trace the incipient stage of a European confederation—a still larger integration than any now established. But it is not only in these external unions of groups with groups, and of the compound groups with each other, that the general law is exemplified. It is exemplified also in unions that take place internally, as the groups become more highly organized. These, of which the most conspicuous are commercial in their origin and function, are well illustrated in our own society. We have integrations consequent on the simple growth of adjacent parts performing like functions: as, for instance, the junction of Manchester with its calico-weaving suburbs. We have other integrations that arise when, out of several places producing a particular commodity, one monopolizes more and more of the business, and leaves the rest to dwindle: as witness the growth of the Yorkshire cloth-districts at the expense of those in the west of England; or the absorption by Staffordshire of the pottery-manufacture, and the consequent decay 203of the establishments that once flourished at Worcester, Derby, and elsewhere. And we have those yet other integrations produced by the actual approximation of the similarly-occupied parts: whence result such facts as the concentration of publishers in Paternoster Row; of lawyers in the Temple and neighbourhood; of corn-merchants about Mark Lane; of civil engineers in Great George Street; of bankers in the centre of the city. Industrial combinations that consist, not in the approximation or fusion of parts, but in the establishment of common centres of connexion, are exhibited in the Bank clearing-house and the Railway clearing-house. While of yet another genus are those unions which bring into relation the more or less dispersed citizens who are occupied in like ways: as traders are brought by the Exchange and the Stock-Exchange; and as are professional men by institutes, like those of Civil Engineers, Architects, &c.
In social structures, integrative changes are clearly and abundantly visible. Uncivilized societies show this when nomadic families, like the bushmen, band together into tribes of considerable size. Within these tribes, we see further similarities in the domination of weaker tribes by stronger ones, and in the submission of their leaders to the conquering chief. The temporary groups that form and dissolve among indigenous peoples become, among more advanced societies, both more complete and longer-lasting. If we look at the transformations our own society or any nearby one has gone through, we can see this unification happening on a larger scale and with greater stability. The gathering of juniors and the children of juniors under elders and their children; the resulting establishment of groups of vassals tied to their respective nobles; the later subordination of lesser nobles to dukes or earls; and the subsequent establishment of royal power over dukes or earls are all examples of increasing consolidation. This process, where smaller holdings combine into feudal arrangements, feudal arrangements into provinces, provinces into kingdoms, and ultimately neighboring kingdoms into one, gradually completes itself by erasing the original boundaries. It's also worth noting that across European nations as a whole, we can see a tendency to form more or less lasting alliances, the checks and balances enacted by various governments on each other, the gradual creation of a system to resolve international conflicts through congresses, as well as the dismantling of trade barriers and improved communication, which hint at the early stages of a European confederation—a larger integration than currently exists. But it's not just in the external unions of groups with each other, and of these compound groups, that this general principle is observed. It’s also seen in internal unions as groups become more organized. The most notable examples, which often stem from commercial origins, are clearly illustrated in our own society. We see integrations arising from the simple growth of neighboring parts performing similar functions; for instance, the merging of Manchester with its calico-weaving suburbs. We also see other integrations occurring when one area producing a particular commodity starts to dominate the market, leading others to decline; for example, the expansion of the Yorkshire cloth districts at the expense of those in western England, or Staffordshire taking over pottery production, causing businesses in places like Worcester and Derby to fade away. Additionally, there are integrations that happen due to the physical proximity of similarly working parts, which result in clusters like publishers concentrated in Paternoster Row, lawyers in the Temple and surrounding areas, corn merchants around Mark Lane, civil engineers in Great George Street, and bankers in the city center. Industrial collaborations that consist not of merging or proximity, but of establishing common centers of connection, can be seen in the Bank clearing-house and the Railway clearing-house. Finally, there are unions that connect dispersed citizens engaged in similar occupations, like traders meeting at the Exchange and the Stock Exchange, and professionals gathering through organizations such as those for Civil Engineers, Architects, and others.
Here, as before, it is manifest that a law of Evolution which holds of organisms, must hold too of all objective results of their activity; and that hence Language, and Science, and Art, must not only in the course of their development display increasing heterogeneity and definiteness, but also increasing integration. We shall find this conclusion to be in harmony with the facts.
Here, as before, it's clear that a law of evolution that applies to living things must also apply to all the tangible outcomes of their actions. This means that language, science, and art must not only show more diversity and clarity over time but also greater unity. We will see that this conclusion aligns with the facts.
Among uncivilized races, the many-syllabled terms used for not uncommon objects, as well as the descriptive character of proper names, show us that the words used for the less familiar things are formed by compounding the words used for the more familiar things. This process of composition is sometimes found in its incipient stage—a stage in which the component words are temporarily united to signify some unnamed object, and do not (from lack of frequent use) permanently cohere. But in the majority of inferior languages, the process of “agglutination,” as it is called, has gone far enough to produce considerable stability in the compound words: there is a manifest integration. How small is the degree of this integration, however, when compared with that reached in well-developed 204languages is shown both by the great length of the compound words used for things and acts of constant occurrence, and by the separableness of their elements. Certain North-American tongues very well illustrate this. In a Ricaree vocabulary extending to fifty names of common objects, which in English are nearly all expressed by single syllables, there is not one monosyllabic word; and in the nearly-allied vocabulary of the Pawnees, the names for these same common objects are monosyllabic in but two instances. Things so familiar to these hunting tribes as dog and bow, are, in the Pawnee language, ashakish and teeragish; the hand and the eyes are respectively iksheeree and keereekoo; for day the term is shakoorooeeshairet, and for devil it is tsaheekshkakooraiwah; while the numerals are composed of from two syllables up to five, and in Ricaree up to seven. That the great length of these familiar words implies a low degree of development, and that in the formation of higher languages out of lower there is a progressive integration, which reduces the polysyllables to dissyllables and monosyllables, is an inference fully confirmed by the history of our own language. Anglo-Saxon steorra has been in course of time consolidated into English star, mona into moon, and nama into name. The transition through the intermediate semi-Saxon is clearly traceable. Sunu became in semi-Saxon sune, and in English son: the final e of sune being an evanescent form of the original u. The change from the Anglo-Saxon plural, formed by the distinct syllable as, to our plural formed by the appended consonant s, shows us the same thing: smithas in becoming smiths, and endas in becoming ends, illustrate progressive coalescence. So too does the disappearance of the terminal an in the infinitive mood of verbs; as shown in the transition from the Anglo-Saxon cuman to the semi-Saxon cumme, and to the English come. Moreover the process has been slowly going on, even since what we distinguish as English was formed. In Elizabeth’s time, verbs were still very frequently pluralized by the addition of en—we tell was we 205tellen; and in some rural districts this form of speech may even now be heard. In like manner the terminal ed of the past tense, has united with the word it modifies. Burn-ed has in pronunciation become burnt; and even in writing the terminal t has in some cases taken the place of the ed. Only where antique forms in general are adhered to, as in the church-service, is the distinctness of this inflection still maintained. Further, we see that the compound vowels have been in many cases fused into single vowels. That in bread the e and a were originally both sounded, is proved by the fact that they are still so sounded in parts where old habits linger. We, however, have contracted the pronunciation into bred; and we have made like changes in many other common words. Lastly, let it be noted that where the frequency of repetition is greatest, the process is carried furthest; as instance the contraction of lord (originally laford) into lud in the mouths of Barristers; and still better the coalescence of God be with you into Good bye. Besides exhibiting in this way the integrative process, Language equally exhibits it throughout all grammatical development. The lowest kinds of human speech, having merely nouns and verbs without inflections to them, manifestly permit no such close union of the elements of a proposition as results when the relations are either marked by inflections or by words specially used for purposes of connexion. Such speech is necessarily what we significantly call “incoherent.” To a considerable extent, incoherence is seen in the Chinese language. “If, instead of saying I go to London, figs come from Turkey, the sun shines through the air, we said, I go end London, figs come origin Turkey, the sun shines passage air, we should discourse of the manner of the Chinese.” From this “aptotic” form, there is clear evidence of a transition by coalescence to a form in which the connexions of words are expressed by the addition to them of certain inflectional words. “In Languages like the Chinese,” remarks Dr Latham, “the separate words most in use to express relation may become 206adjuncts or annexes.” To this he adds the fact that “the numerous inflexional languages fall into two classes. In one, the inflexions have no appearance of having been separate words. In the other, their origin as separate words is demonstrable.” From which the inference drawn is, that the “aptotic” languages, by the more and more constant use of adjuncts, gave rise to the “agglutinate” languages, or those in which the original separateness of the inflexional parts can be traced; and that out of these, by further use, arose the “amalgamate” languages, or these in which the original separateness of the inflexional parts can no longer be traced. Strongly corroborative of this inference is the unquestionable fact, that by such a process there have grown out of the amalgamate languages, the “anaptotic” languages; of which our own is the most perfect example—languages in which, by further consolidation, inflexions have almost disappeared, while, to express the verbal relations, certain new kinds of words have been developed. When we see the Anglo-Saxon inflexions gradually lost by contraction during the development of English, and, though to a less degree, the Latin inflexions dwindling away during the development of French, we cannot deny that grammatical structure is modified by integration; and seeing how clearly the earlier stages of grammatical structure are explained by it, we can scarcely doubt that it has been going on from the first. And now mark that in proportion to the degree of the integration above described, is the extent to which integration of another order is shown. Aptotic languages are, as already pointed out, necessarily incoherent—the elements of a proposition cannot be tied into a definite and complete whole. But as fast as coalescence produces inflected words, it becomes possible to unite them into sentences of which the parts are so mutually dependent that no considerable change can be made without destroying the meaning. Yet a further stage in this process may be noted. After the development of those grammatical forms which make definite statements possible, we do not at 207first find them used to express anything beyond statements of a simple kind. A single subject with a single predicate, accompanied by but few qualifying terms, are usually all. If we compare, for instance, the Hebrew scriptures with writings of modern times, a marked difference of aggregation among the groups of words, is visible. In the number of subordinate propositions which accompany the principal one; in the various complements to subjects and predicates; and in the numerous qualifying clauses—all of them united into one complex whole—many sentences in modern composition exhibit a degree of integration not to be found in ancient ones.
Among uncivilized races, the long terms used for fairly common objects, along with the descriptive nature of proper names, show us that the words for less familiar things are created by combining the words for more familiar things. This process of combining sometimes appears in its early stage—where the component words are momentarily joined to signify something unnamed, but do not (due to infrequent use) stick together permanently. However, in most lesser languages, the process of “agglutination,” as it's called, has progressed enough to create considerable stability in the compound words: there is a clear integration. Nonetheless, this integration is quite small compared to what is achieved in well-developed languages, as seen in the lengthy compound words used for common things and actions, and in how separable their elements are. Certain North American languages illustrate this very well. In a Ricaree vocabulary containing about fifty names for common objects, which in English are mostly expressed with single syllables, there's not a single monosyllabic word; and in the closely related Pawnee vocabulary, the names for these same common objects are monosyllabic in only two cases. Objects so familiar to these hunting tribes as dog and bow are, in the Pawnee language, ashakish and teeragish; hand and eyes are iksheeree and keereekoo; for day, the term is shakoorooeeshairet, and for devil, it is tsaheekshkakooraiwah; while the numerals consist of two to five syllables, and in Ricaree, up to seven. The length of these familiar words indicates a low level of development, and that as higher languages evolve from lower ones, there's a progressive integration that reduces the polysyllables to dissyllables and monosyllables, a conclusion supported by the history of our own language. Anglo-Saxon star has gradually been consolidated into the English star, Mona into moon, and name into name. The transition through the intermediate semi-Saxon is clearly observable. Sunu became in semi-Saxon sunglasses, and in English son: the final e of sunglasses being a fleeting form of the original u. The shift from the Anglo-Saxon plural, formed by the distinct syllable as, to our plural formed by the added consonant s, illustrates the same principle: smithas became smiths, and endas became ends, showing progressive merging. The disappearance of the terminal an in the infinitive mood of verbs also illustrates this; as seen in the change from the Anglo-Saxon cuman to semi-Saxon cumme, and to the English come. Moreover, this process has been gradually occurring even since what we now call English was formed. In Elizabeth’s time, verbs were still often pluralized by adding en—we tell was we tellen; and in some rural areas, this speech form may still be heard. In a similar way, the terminal ed of the past tense has merged with the word it modifies. Burn-ed has in pronunciation become burnt; and in writing, the terminal t has taken the place of ed in some cases. Only where old forms are generally retained, like in church services, do we still see the distinctness of this inflection. Additionally, we see that compound vowels have often fused into single vowels. That in bread the e and a were originally both pronounced is evidenced by the fact that they still are in places where old habits persist. However, we've shortened the pronunciation to bred; and we've made similar changes in many other common words. Lastly, it's important to note that where repetition occurs most frequently, the process is carried the furthest; for instance, the contraction of lord (originally laford) into lud in the speech of barristers; and even better, the merging of God be with you into Good bye. Not only does language illustrate this integrative process, but it also shows it across all grammatical development. The simplest forms of human speech, containing only nouns and verbs without inflections, clearly do not allow for a close union of the elements of a proposition, which occurs when the relationships are marked by inflections or words specifically used for connection. Such speech is necessarily what we refer to as “incoherent.” To a significant extent, incoherence can be seen in Chinese. “If, instead of saying I go to London, figs come from Turkey, the sun shines through the air, we said, I go end London, figs come origin Turkey, the sun shines passage air, we would be speaking in a manner akin to Chinese.” From this “aptotic” form, there's evident transition through merging to a form where the connections of words are expressed by adding certain inflectional words to them. “In languages like Chinese,” notes Dr. Latham, “the separate words most frequently used to express relations may become adjuncts or annexes.” He also points out that “the numerous inflectional languages fall into two categories. In one, the inflections show no sign of having been separate words. In the other, their origin as separate words is evident.” The conclusion drawn is that the “aptotic” languages, through more consistent use of adjuncts, led to the “agglutinate” languages, where the original separateness of the inflectional parts can be traced; and from these, further usage gave rise to the “amalgamate” languages, where the original separateness of the inflectional parts can no longer be traced. Strongly supporting this conclusion is the undeniable fact that through this process, “anaptotic” languages have emerged from the amalgamate languages; of which our own is the most refined example—languages in which, due to further consolidation, inflections have nearly disappeared, while certain new types of words have developed to express verbal relations. When we observe the gradual loss of Anglo-Saxon inflections through contraction during the evolution of English, and to a lesser extent, the Latin inflections diminishing during the development of French, we cannot deny that grammatical structure is altered by integration; and considering how clearly the earlier stages of grammatical structure are explained by it, we can hardly doubt that it has been occurring since the beginning. Also note that the degree of integration described above correlates with the extent to which another type of integration manifests. As previously mentioned, aptotic languages are necessarily incoherent—the elements of a proposition cannot be woven into a cohesive and complete whole. However, as merging generates inflected words, it becomes possible to connect them into sentences where the parts are so interdependent that any significant change would alter the meaning. Yet, there's another stage in this process. After establishing those grammatical forms that allow for clear statements, initially, we don't see them used to express anything beyond simple assertions. Usually, there’s just a single subject with a single predicate, accompanied by only a few qualifying terms. If we compare, for example, the Hebrew scriptures with modern writings, a noticeable difference in the aggregation of word groups stands out. In the amount of subordinate propositions accompanying the main one; in the various complements to subjects and predicates; and in the numerous qualifying clauses—all of which are combined into one complex whole—many sentences in modern writing display a level of integration not found in ancient texts.
The history of Science presents facts of the same meaning at every step. Indeed the integration of groups of like entities and like relations, may be said to constitute the most conspicuous part of scientific progress. A glance at the classificatory sciences, shows us not only that the confused aggregations which the vulgar make of natural objects, are differentiated into groups that are respectively more homogeneous, but also that these groups are gradually rendered complete and compact. While, instead of considering all marine creatures as fish, shell-fish, and jelly-fish, Zoology establishes divisions and sub-divisions under the heads Vertebrata, Annulosa, Mollusca, &c.—while in place of the wide and vague assemblage popularly described as “creeping things,” it makes the specific classes Annelida, Myriopoda, Insecta, Arachnida; it at the same time gives to these an increasing consolidation. The several orders and genera of which each consists, are arranged according to their affinities and bound together under common definitions; at the same time that, by extended observation and rigorous criticism, the previously unknown and undetermined forms are integrated with their respective congeners. Nor is the same process less clearly manifested in those sciences which have for their subject-matter, not classified objects, but classified relations. Under one of its chief aspects, the advance of Science is the advance of generalization; and generalization is the 208uniting into groups all like co-existencies and sequences among phenomena. Not only, however, does the colligation of a number of concrete relations into a generalization of the lowest order, exemplify the principle enunciated; but it is again and again exemplified in the colligation of these lowest generalizations into higher ones, and these into still higher ones. Year by year are established certain connexions among orders of phenomena that seem wholly unallied; and these connexions, multiplying and strengthening, gradually bring the seemingly unallied orders under a common bond. When, for example, Humboldt quotes the saying of the Swiss—“it is going to rain because we hear the murmur of the torrents nearer,”—when he remarks the relation between this and an observation of his own, that the cataracts of the Orinoco are heard at a greater distance by night than by day—when he notes the essential parallelism existing between these facts and the fact that the unusual visibility of remote objects is also an indication of coming rain—and when he points out that the common cause of these variations is the smaller hindrance offered to the passage of both light and sound, by media which are comparatively homogeneous, either in temperature or hygrometric state; he helps in bringing under one generalization the phenomena of light and those of sound. Experiment having shown that these conform to like laws of reflection and refraction, the conclusion that they are both produced by undulations gains probability: there is an incipient integration of two great orders of phenomena, between which no connexion was suspected in times past. A still more decided integration has been of late taking place between the once independent sub-sciences of Electricity, Magnetism, and Light. And indeed it must be obvious to those who are familiar with the present state of Science, that there will eventually take place a far wider integration, by which all orders of phenomena will be combined as differently conditioned forms of one ultimate fact.
The history of science shows that the same truths apply at every step. In fact, bringing together groups of similar entities and relationships is one of the most notable aspects of scientific progress. A look at the classification sciences reveals that the chaotic groups that laypeople make out of natural objects are sorted into more homogeneous groups, which become increasingly complete and compact. Instead of lumping all marine creatures together as fish, shellfish, and jellyfish, zoology creates distinct divisions and sub-divisions under categories like Vertebrata, Annulosa, Mollusca, etc. Similarly, rather than viewing the broad and ambiguous category called “creeping things,” it specifies classes such as Annelida, Myriopoda, Insecta, and Arachnida, all while increasing their consolidation. Each of the various orders and genera is arranged by their relationships and defined by common traits; meanwhile, through extended observation and rigorous analysis, previously unknown and unclassified forms are linked with their similar counterparts. This same process is clearly evident in sciences that focus not on classified objects but on classified relationships. One of the main aspects of the advancement of science is the advancement of generalization, which means bringing together all similar co-existing and sequential phenomena. The grouping of several concrete relationships into a basic generalization exemplifies this principle; it occurs repeatedly as these basic generalizations merge into higher generalizations and continue to ascend. Each year, certain connections are made among categories of phenomena that seem completely unrelated, and as these connections multiply and strengthen, they gradually unite these seemingly unrelated categories. For instance, when Humboldt cites the Swiss saying, “it’s going to rain because we can hear the noise of the streams getting closer,” and observes the relation to his own finding that the waterfalls of the Orinoco are heard from farther away at night than during the day, or he notes the significant parallel between this and the fact that unusually clear visibility of distant objects indicates approaching rain, he shows that the common cause of these variations is the lesser obstruction to the passage of both light and sound through media that are relatively uniform in either temperature or humidity; he contributes to unifying light and sound phenomena under one generalization. Experiments have demonstrated that these follow similar laws of reflection and refraction, making it more likely that both are generated by waves: this marks the early integration of two major categories of phenomena that were previously thought to have no connection. Recently, an even more significant integration has occurred among the once separate disciplines of electricity, magnetism, and light. Indeed, it is clear to anyone familiar with the current state of science that a much broader integration will eventually happen, whereby all categories of phenomena will be seen as differently conditioned forms of one ultimate fact.
Nor do the industrial and æsthetic Arts fail to supply us 209with equally conclusive evidence. The progress from rude, small, and simple tools, to perfect, complex, and large machines, illustrates not only a progress in heterogeneity and in definiteness, but also in integration. Among what are classed as the mechanical powers, the advance from the lever to the wheel-and-axle is an advance from a simple agent to an agent made up of several simple ones combined together. On comparing the wheel-and-axle, or any of the machines used in early times with those used now, we find an essential difference to be, that in each of our machines several of the primitive machines are united into one. A modern apparatus for spinning or weaving, for making stockings or lace, contains not simply a lever, an inclined plane, a screw, a wheel-and-axle, united together; but several of each integrated into one complex whole. Again, in early ages, when horse-power and man-power were alone employed, the motive agent was not bound up with the tool moved; but the two have now become in many cases fused together: the fire-box and boiler of a locomotive are combined with the machinery which the steam works. Nor is this the most extreme case. A still more extensive integration is exhibited in every large factory. Here we find a large number of complicated machines, all connected by driving shafts with the same steam-engine—all united with it into one vast apparatus. Contrast the mural decorations of the Egyptians and Assyrians with modern historical paintings, and there becomes manifest a great advance in unity of composition—in the subordination of the parts to the whole. One of these ancient frescoes is in truth made up of a number of pictures that have little mutual dependence. The several figures of which each group consists, show very imperfectly by their attitudes, and not at all by their expressions, the relations in which they stand to each other; the respective groups might be separated with but little loss of meaning; and the centre of chief interest, which should link all parts together, is often inconspicuous. The same trait 210may be noted in the tapestries of medieval days. Representing perhaps a hunting scene, one of these exhibits men, horses, dogs, beasts, birds, trees, and flowers, miscellaneously dispersed: the living objects being variously occupied, and mostly with no apparent consciousness of each other’s proximity. But in the paintings since produced, faulty as many of them are in this respect, there is always a more or less manifest co-ordination of parts—an arrangement of attitudes, expressions, lights, and colours, such as to combine the picture into an organic whole; and the success with which unity of effect is educed from variety of components, is a chief test of merit. In music, progressive integration is displayed in still more numerous ways. The simple cadence embracing but a few notes, which in the chants of savages is monotonously repeated, becomes among civilized races, a long series of different musical phrases combined into one whole; and so complete is the integration, that the melody cannot be broken off in the middle, nor shorn of its final note, without giving us a painful sense of incompleteness. When to the air, a bass, a tenor, and an alto are added; and when to the harmony of different voice-parts there is added an accompaniment; we see exemplified integrations of another order, which grow gradually more elaborate. And the process is carried a stage higher when these complex solos, concerted pieces, choruses, and orchestral effects, are combined into the vast ensemble of a musical drama; of which, be it remembered, the artistic perfection largely consists in the subordination of the particular effects to the total effect. Once more the Arts of literary delineation, narrative and dramatic, furnish us with parallel illustrations. The tales of primitive times, like those with which the story-tellers of the East still daily amuse their listeners, are made up of successive occurrences that are not only in themselves unnatural, but have no natural connexion: they are but so many separate adventures put together without necessary sequence. But in a good modern work of imagination, the events are the proper 211products of the characters working under given conditions; and cannot at will be changed in their order or kind, without injuring or destroying the general effect. And further, the characters themselves, which in early fictions play their respective parts without showing us how their minds are modified by each other or by the events, are now presented to us as held together by complex moral relations, and as acting and re-acting upon each other’s natures.
The industrial and aesthetic Arts also give us clear evidence. The shift from crude, small, and simple tools to sophisticated, complex, and large machines shows not only a move towards diversity and clarity but also towards integration. In what are called mechanical powers, moving from the lever to the wheel-and-axle represents a transition from a simple tool to a tool that combines several simpler ones. When we compare the wheel-and-axle or any of the machines used in ancient times to modern ones, we notice a key difference: our machines combine several primitive machines into one. A modern spinning or weaving machine, for example, doesn't just include a lever, an inclined plane, a screw, and a wheel-and-axle merging together; it integrates multiple versions of each into a single complex unit. In the early years, when only horse-power and human-power were used, the driving force was separate from the tool being operated; now in many cases, the two have become intertwined: the firebox and boiler of a locomotive are linked with the machinery it powers. And that's not even the extreme case. An even greater level of integration is evident in every large factory. There, a multitude of intricate machines are all connected via drive shafts to a single steam engine—all merged into one massive system. If we contrast the mural art of Egyptians and Assyrians with modern historical paintings, we can clearly see a significant improvement in compositional unity—in how the parts relate to the whole. An ancient fresco, for example, consists of several pictures with little connection between them. The figures in each group don’t clearly express their relationships with one another; the groups could be separated without losing much meaning, and the central focus that should connect all parts is often subtle. We can see the same quality in medieval tapestries. A tapestry depicting a hunting scene, for instance, shows men, horses, dogs, animals, birds, trees, and flowers scattered about with the living beings often preoccupied and largely unaware of each other's presence. However, in the paintings produced more recently, albeit flawed in some aspects, there's generally a noticeable coordination of elements—an arrangement of poses, expressions, lighting, and colors that brings the picture together into an organic whole. The ability to create a unified effect from diverse components is a major measure of quality. In music, progressive integration shows up in many ways. The simple sequence of a few notes, which is repetitively chanted by primitive cultures, evolves among more advanced societies into a long series of distinct musical phrases combined into a single piece. The integration is so thorough that if the melody is cut off prematurely or the final note is omitted, it leaves us with a sense of incompleteness. When a bass, tenor, and alto are added to the melody, and an accompaniment supports the harmony of different vocal parts, we see another layer of integration, becoming increasingly intricate. This process reaches a higher level when these complex solos, arranged pieces, choruses, and orchestral elements combine into the grand structure of a musical drama. Importantly, its artistic excellence largely comes from how the specific effects contribute to the overall impact. Moreover, the arts of storytelling and drama provide similar examples. The tales from primitive times, much like those told by modern Eastern storytellers, consist of a series of events that are not only unnatural but also lack a natural connection; they are simply a collection of separate adventures put together randomly. In contrast, a good modern imaginative work has events that emerge naturally from characters acting under specific conditions, and altering their order or type without harm to the overall impact is not feasible. Additionally, in early stories, characters fulfill their roles without revealing how their minds are influenced by each other or by events; now, they are depicted with complex moral connections, actively interacting and affecting each other's natures.
Evolution, then, is in all cases a change from a more diffused or incoherent form, to a more consolidated or coherent form. This proves to be a characteristic displayed equally in those earliest changes which the Universe as a whole is supposed to have undergone, and in those latest changes which we trace in society and the products of social life. Nor is it only that in the development of a planet, of an organism, of a society, of a science, of an art, the process of integration is seen in a more complete aggregation of each whole and of its constituent parts; but it is also shown in an increasing mutual dependence of the parts. Dimly foreshadowed as this mutual dependence is among inorganic phenomena, both celestial and terrestrial, it becomes distinct among organic phenomena. From the lowest living forms upwards, the degree of development is marked by the degree in which the several parts constitute a mutually-dependent whole. The advance from those creatures which live on in each part when cut in pieces, up to those creatures which cannot lose any considerable part without death, nor any inconsiderable part without great constitutional disturbance, is clearly an advance to creatures which are not only more integrated in respect of their solidification, but are also more integrated as consisting of organs that live for and by each other. The like contrast between undeveloped and developed societies, need not be shown in detail: the ever-increasing co-ordination of parts, is conspicuous to all. And it must suffice just to indicate that the same thing holds true of social products: as, for instance, of Science; which has become 212highly integrated not only in the sense that each division is made up of mutually-dependent propositions, but also in the sense that the several divisions are mutually-dependent—cannot carry on their respective investigations without aid from each other.
Evolution, then, is always a shift from a more scattered or disorganized state to a more unified or organized state. This characteristic is evident in both the earliest transformations the Universe is believed to have gone through and the most recent changes we observe in society and its social products. It's not just that in the development of a planet, an organism, a society, a science, or an art, we see a process of integration leading to a more complete combination of each whole and its individual parts; we also observe an increasing interdependence among those parts. While this interdependence is only vaguely suggested in inorganic phenomena, whether celestial or terrestrial, it becomes clear in organic phenomena. From the simplest living forms to more complex ones, the level of development is marked by how well the various parts form a mutually-dependent whole. The progression from beings that can survive after being divided into parts to those that cannot lose any significant part without dying, or even a minor part without serious disruption, indicates an advancement to beings that are not only more solidified but also more integrated, comprising organs that depend on and support each other. The same contrast between underdeveloped and developed societies doesn't need detailed explanation: the increasing coordination of parts is obvious to everyone. It is enough to point out that the same principle applies to social products, such as Science, which has become highly integrated not just in the way that each division consists of interdependent propositions, but also in that the different divisions rely on each other to conduct their respective inquiries.
It seems proper to remark that the generalization here variously illustrated, is akin to one enunciated by Schelling, that Life is the tendency to individuation. Struck by the fact that an aggregative process is traceable throughout nature, from the growth of a crystal up to the development of a man; and by the fact that the wholes resulting from this process, completer in organic than in inorganic bodies, are completest where the vital manifestations are the highest; Schelling concluded that this characteristic was the essential one. According to him, the formation of individual bodies is not incident to Life, but is that in which Life fundamentally consists. This position is, for several reasons, untenable. In the first place, it requires the conception of Life to be extended so as to embrace inorganic phenomena; since in crystallization, and even in the formation of amorphous masses of matter, this tendency to individuation is displayed. Schelling, fully perceiving this, did indeed accept the implication; and held that inorganic bodies had life lower only in degree than that of organic bodies—their degree of life being measured by their degree of individuation. This bold assumption, which Schelling evidently made to save his definition, is inadmissible. Rational philosophy cannot ignore those broad distinctions which the general sense of mankind has established. If it transcends them, it must at the same time show what is their origin; how far only they are valid; and why they disappear from a higher point of view. Note next that the more complete individuality which Schelling pointed out as characterizing bodies having the greatest amount of life, is only one of their structural traits. The greater degree of heterogeneity which they exhibit, is, as we have seen, a 213much more conspicuous peculiarity; and though it might possibly be contended that greater heterogeneity is remotely implied by greater individuality, it must be admitted that in defining Life as the tendency to individuation, no hint is given that the bodies which live most are the most heterogeneous bodies. Moreover it is to be remarked that this definition of Schelling, refers much more to the structures of living bodies than to the processes which constitute Life. Not Life, but the invariable accompaniment of Life, is that which his formula alone expresses. The formation of a completer organic whole, a more fully individuated body, is truly a necessary concomitant of a higher life; and the development of a higher life must therefore be accompanied by a tendency to greater individuation. But to represent this tendency as Life itself, is to mistake an incidental result for an original cause. Life, properly so called, consists of multiform changes united together in various ways; and is not expressed either by an anatomical description of the organism which manifests it, or by a history of the modifications through which such organism has reached its present structure. Yet it is only in such description and such history that the tendency to individuation is seen. Lastly, this definition which Schelling gave of Life is untenable, not only because it refers rather to the organism than to the actions going on in it; but also because it wholly ignores that connexion between the organism and the external world, on which Life depends. All organic processes, physical and psychial, having for their object the maintenance of certain relations with environing agencies and objects; it is impossible that there should be a true definition of Life, in which the environment is not named. Nevertheless, Schelling’s conception was not a baseless one. Though not a truth, it was yet the adumbration of a truth. In defining Life as the tendency to individuation, he had in view that formation of a more compact, complete, and mutually-dependent whole, which, as we have seen, is one characteristic of Evolution in general. His 214error was, firstly, in regarding it as a characteristic of Life, instead of a characteristic of living bodies, displayed, though in a less degree, by other bodies; and, secondly, in regarding it as the sole characteristic of such bodies. It remains only to add, that for expressing this aspect of the process of Evolution, the word integration is for several reasons preferable to the word individuation. Integration is the true antithesis of differentiation; it has not that tacit reference to living bodies which the word individuation cannot be wholly freed from; it expresses the aggregative tendency not only as displayed in the formation of more complete wholes, but also as displayed in the consolidation of the several parts of which such wholes are made up; and it has not the remotest teleological implication. In short, it simply formulates in the most abstract manner, a wide induction untainted by any hypothesis.
It’s worth mentioning that the general idea presented here is similar to one proposed by Schelling, which states that life is the tendency toward individuation. Noticing that there is an aggregative process observable throughout nature, from the growth of a crystal to the development of a human, and that the entities resulting from this process—more complete in organic than inorganic forms—are most complete where vital expressions are highest; Schelling concluded that this feature was the fundamental one. He believed that the formation of individual bodies is not just a part of life, but is actually what life fundamentally consists of. This viewpoint is untenable for several reasons. First, it requires a broader understanding of life to include inorganic phenomena, as this tendency toward individuation is evident in crystallization and even in the formation of amorphous matter. Schelling recognized this and accepted the implication, arguing that inorganic bodies have a lower degree of life compared to organic ones, with their level of life being measured by their degree of individuation. This bold assumption, which Schelling made to defend his definition, is unacceptable. Rational philosophy cannot disregard the clear distinctions that common understanding has established. If it goes beyond these distinctions, it must also explain their origin, how valid they are, and why they disappear from a higher perspective. Next, note that the more complete individuality that Schelling highlighted as a mark of bodies with the most life is only one of their structural traits. The greater degree of diversity they show is, as we've seen, a much more noticeable characteristic; and while one could argue that greater diversity is indirectly linked to greater individuality, it must be acknowledged that defining life as the tendency toward individuation does not suggest that the most living entities are also the most diverse ones. Moreover, it's important to point out that Schelling's definition focuses more on the structures of living bodies than on the processes that create life. The formula he proposed only expresses not life itself, but the constant aspects that accompany life. The formation of a more complete organic whole or a more fully individuated body is indeed a necessary aspect of higher life; thus, the development of a higher life must come with a tendency toward greater individuation. However, to depict this tendency as life itself is to confuse a resulting effect with an original cause. Life, in its true sense, consists of various changes that interconnect in different ways and is not captured through an anatomical description of the organism that displays it, or through a history detailing how such an organism has arrived at its current structure. Yet, it is only through such descriptions and histories that the tendency toward individuation is recognized. Finally, Schelling’s definition of life is flawed, not just because it pertains more to the organism than to the actions within it, but also because it completely overlooks the connection between the organism and the external world that life relies on. All organic processes, both physical and mental, aim to maintain specific relationships with surrounding influences and objects; therefore, a legitimate definition of life cannot exclude the environment. Nonetheless, Schelling's idea wasn’t entirely unfounded. While it may not be a truth, it was still a hint of a truth. In defining life as the tendency toward individuation, he was referencing the creation of a more compact, complete, and interdependent whole, which we have identified as a characteristic of evolution in general. His mistakes were, first, in seeing it as a feature of life rather than as a characteristic of living organisms, which is also evident, albeit to a lesser extent, in other entities; and second, in viewing it as the only characteristic of such bodies. It’s also worth adding that to express this aspect of the evolutionary process, the term integration is preferable to individuation for several reasons. Integration is truly the opposite of differentiation; it avoids the implicit reference to living bodies that the term individuation carries; it reflects the aggregative tendency not only in forming more complete wholes but also in consolidating the various parts that make up those wholes; and it has no distant teleological implications. In short, it simply articulates, in the most abstract way, a broad induction free from any hypothesis.
§ 57. Thus we find that to complete the definition arrived at in the last chapter, much has to be added. What was there alleged is true; but it is not the whole truth. Evolution is unquestionably a change from a homogeneous state to a heterogeneous state; but, as we have seen, there are some advances in heterogeneity which cannot be included in the idea of Evolution. This undue width of the definition, implies the omission of some further peculiarity by which Evolution is distinguished; and this peculiarity we find to be that the more highly developed things become, the more definite they become. Advance from the indefinite to the definite, is as constantly and variously displayed as advance from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous. And we are thus obliged to regard it as an essential characteristic of Evolution. Further analysis, however, shows us that this increase of definiteness is not an independent process; but is rather the necessary concomitant of another process. A very little consideration of the facts proves that a change from the indefinite to the definite, can arise only through a 215completer consolidation of the respective parts, and of the whole which they constitute. And so we find that while Evolution is a transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous, and of the indefinite into the definite, it is also a transformation of the incoherent into the coherent. Along with the differentiation shown in increasing contrasts of parts with each other, there goes on an integration, by which the parts are rendered distinct units, as well as closely united components of one whole. These clauses here added to the definition, are essential ones; not only as being needful to distinguish Evolution from that which is not Evolution, but likewise as being needful to express all which the idea of Evolution includes. Progressive integration with the growing definiteness necessarily resulting from it, is of co-ordinate importance with the progressive differentiation before dwelt upon—nay, from one point of view, may be held of greater importance. For organization, in which what we call Evolution is most clearly and variously displayed, consists even more in the union of many parts into one whole, than in the formation of many parts. The Evolution which we see throughout inorganic nature, is lower than that which organic nature exhibits to us, for the especial reason that the mutual dependence of parts is extremely indefinite, even when traceable at all. In an amorphous mass of matter, you may act mechanically or chemically upon one part without appreciably affecting the other parts. Though their electrical or thermal states may be for the moment altered, their original states are soon resumed. Even in the highest inorganic aggregation—a crystal—the apex may be broken off and leave the rest intact: the only clear evidence of mutual dependence of parts, being, the ability of the crystal to regenerate its apex if replaced in the solution from which it was formed. But the constituent parts of organic bodies can severally maintain their existing states, only while remaining in connexion. Even in the lowest living forms, mutilation cannot be carried beyond a certain point without decomposition ensuing. As we advance through 216the higher up to the highest forms, we see a gradual narrowing of the limits within which the mutilation does not cause destruction: a progressive increase of mutual dependence or integration which is, at the same time, the condition to greater functional perfection. In societies this truth is equally manifest. That the component units slowly segregate into groups of different ranks and occupations, is a fact scarcely more conspicuous than is the fact that these groups are necessary to each other’s existence. And we cannot contemplate the still-progressing division of labour, without seeing that the interdependence becomes ever greater as the evolution becomes higher. It remains only to point out definitely, what has been already implied, that these several forms of change which have been successively described as making up the process of Evolution, are not in reality separate forms of change, but different aspects of the same change. Intrinsically the transformation is one and indivisible. The establishment of differences that become gradually more decided, is evidently but the beginning of an action which cannot be pushed to its extreme without producing definite divisions between the parts, and reducing each part to a separate mass. But with our limited faculties, it is not possible to take in the entire process at one view; nor have we any single terms by which the process can be described. Hence we are obliged to contemplate each of its aspects separately, and to find a separate expression for its characteristic.
§ 57. So, to fully define what we discussed in the last chapter, we need to add a lot more. What was said there is true, but it's not the whole truth. Evolution is definitely a shift from a uniform state to a diverse one; however, as we've seen, there are some developments in diversity that we can't classify as Evolution. This overly broad definition misses some unique feature that distinguishes Evolution, which we find to be that as things become more advanced, they also become more defined. The progression from the vague to the specific is just as noticeable and varied as the shift from the uniform to the diverse. Therefore, we must consider it an essential trait of Evolution. Further analysis shows that this growing clarity isn't an independent process; instead, it goes hand in hand with another process. A little reflection on the facts shows that the shift from the vague to the specific can only happen through a more complete integration of the individual parts and the whole they form. Thus, we see that while Evolution transforms the uniform into the diverse and the vague into the specific, it also transforms the chaotic into the coherent. Along with the differentiation indicated by increased contrasts between parts, there is also an integration that makes the parts distinct entities while keeping them closely connected as a whole. These added clauses to the definition are vital; not only do they distinguish Evolution from what isn't Evolution, but they also express everything that the concept of Evolution includes. The progressive integration that results in growing definiteness is equally important as the progressive differentiation we discussed earlier—indeed, from one perspective, it might be considered even more significant. This is because organization, where what we refer to as Evolution is most clearly and variably displayed, is more about uniting many parts into one whole than merely forming many parts. The Evolution we observe throughout inorganic nature is less advanced than that which organic nature shows us, precisely because the interdependence of parts is minimally defined, even when it can be tracked. In an amorphous mass of matter, you can mechanically or chemically act on one part without significantly affecting the others. Though their electrical or thermal states may temporarily change, their original states are quickly restored. Even in the most complex inorganic structure—a crystal—the apex can be removed while the rest remains intact: the only clear evidence of the interdependence of parts is the crystal’s ability to regenerate its apex if it is returned to the solution from which it was formed. However, the individual parts of living organisms can only maintain their states while remaining connected. Even in the simplest life forms, injury cannot go beyond a certain extent without causing decomposition. As we progress from simpler to more complex forms, we see a gradual narrowing of the limits within which injury does not lead to destruction: a progressive increase in mutual dependence or integration, which simultaneously conditions greater functional perfection. This truth is also clearly seen in societies. The fact that the individual units gradually separate into groups of different ranks and roles is hardly more obvious than the fact that these groups need each other for their existence. We can't consider the ongoing division of labor without recognizing that interdependence grows greater as evolution advances. It only remains to point out clearly what has already been suggested: the various forms of change described as making up the process of Evolution are not actually separate forms of change but different aspects of the same change. Essentially, the transformation is one and indivisible. The establishment of differences that become increasingly clear is just the beginning of an action that can't be taken to its extreme without creating definite divisions between the parts and reducing each part to an independent mass. However, with our limited understanding, it's impossible to grasp the entire process in one view; nor do we have any single terms to describe the process. Hence, we are compelled to examine each aspect separately and find distinct expressions for their characteristics.
Having done this, we are now in a position to frame a true idea of Evolution. Combining these partial definitions we get a complete definition, which may be most conveniently expressed thus—Evolution is a change from an indefinite, incoherent homogeneity, to a definite, coherent heterogeneity; through continuous differentiations and integrations.
Having done this, we are now able to form a true understanding of Evolution. By combining these partial definitions, we arrive at a complete definition, which can be most conveniently expressed as—Evolution is a change from an indefinite, incoherent similarity to a definite, coherent diversity; through continuous differentiations and integrations.
It may perhaps be remarked that the last of these clauses is superfluous; since the differentiation and integration are implied in the first clause. This is true: the transition which 217the first clause specifies, is impossible save through the process specified in the second. Nevertheless, a mere statement of the two extreme stages with which Evolution begins and ends, omitting all reference to changes connecting them, leaves the mind with but an incomplete idea. The idea becomes much more concrete when these changes are described. Hence, though not logically necessary, the second clause of the definition is practically desirable.
It might be noted that the last of these clauses is unnecessary since the differentiation and integration are already covered in the first clause. This is true: the transition that the first clause points out can't happen without the process outlined in the second. However, just stating the two extreme stages that Evolution starts and finishes with, while leaving out the changes that connect them, leaves us with an incomplete understanding. The idea becomes much clearer when these changes are explained. Therefore, even though it’s not logically essential, the second clause of the definition is practically useful.
Before closing the chapter, a few words must be added respecting certain other modes of describing Evolution. Organic bodies, from the changes of which the idea of Evolution has arisen, and to the changes of which alone it is usually applied, are often said to progress from simplicity to complexity. The transformation of the simple into the complex, and of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous, are used as equivalent phrases; or, if any difference is recognized between them, it is to the advantage of the first, which is held to be the more specific. After what has been said, however, it must be obvious that Evolution cannot be thus adequately formulated. No hint is given of that increased definiteness which we have found to be a concomitant of development. Nor is there anything implying the greater mutual dependence of parts. Nevertheless, the brevity of the expression gives it a value for ordinary purposes; and I shall probably hereafter frequently use it, both in those cases where more precise language is not demanded, and in those cases where it indicates the particular aspect of Evolution referred to. Another description frequently given of Evolution, is, that it is a change from the general to the special. The more or less spherical germ from which every organism, animal and vegetal, proceeds, is comparatively general: alike in the sense that in appearance and chemical nature it is very similar to all other germs; and also in the sense that its form is less markedly distinguished from the average forms of objects at large, than is that of the mature organism—a contrast which equally holds of internal structure. But this progress 218from the more general to the more special, is rather a derivative than an original characteristic. An increase of speciality being really an increase in the number of attributes—an addition of traits not possessed by bodies that are in other respects similar—is a necessary result of multiplying differentiations. In other words, general and special are subjective or ideal distinctions involved in our conceptions of classes, rather than objective or real distinctions presented in the bodies classified. Nevertheless, this abstract formula is not without its use. It expresses a fact of much significance; and one which we shall have constantly to refer to when dealing with the relations between organic bodies and their surrounding conditions.
Before wrapping up this chapter, it's important to add a few thoughts on different ways to describe Evolution. Organic beings, which are the basis for the concept of Evolution and to which this idea mainly applies, are often said to move from simplicity to complexity. The transformation from simple to complex and from uniform to diverse are considered equivalent expressions; if there's any distinction made, it's usually in favor of the first, which is viewed as more specific. However, as discussed earlier, it's clear that Evolution cannot be fully captured in this way. There’s no suggestion of the increased specificity that we’ve observed as a part of development. Nor does it reflect the greater interdependence of parts. Still, the concise phrasing holds value for general discussions, and I will likely use it frequently in situations where more precise language isn’t necessary or when it highlights a particular aspect of Evolution. Another common description of Evolution is that it represents a transition from the general to the specific. The somewhat spherical germ from which every organism—both animal and plant—develops is relatively general: it’s similar in appearance and chemical composition to other germs, and its shape is less distinctly different from average objects than that of the mature organism; this is also true for internal structure. However, this shift from the more general to the more specific is more of a derived characteristic than an original one. The increase in specificity is essentially an increase in the number of attributes—adding traits not shared by other similar bodies—which results from various differentiations. In other words, general and specific are subjective or ideal distinctions connected to our understanding of categories, rather than objective or real distinctions found in the classified entities. Nonetheless, this abstract formula has its usefulness. It reflects an important fact that we will need to repeatedly consider when discussing the relationships between organic beings and their environments.
The law of Evolution however, be it expressed in full as above, or in these shorter but less specific phrases, is essentially that which has been exhibited in detail throughout the foregoing pages. So far as we can ascertain, this law is universal. It is illustrated with endless repetition, and in countless ways, wherever the facts are abundant; and where the facts do not suffice for induction, deduction goes far to supply its place. Among all orders of phenomena that lie within the sphere of observation, we see ever going on the process of change above defined; and many significant indications warrant us in believing, that the same process of change went on throughout that remote past which lies beyond the sphere of observation. If we must form any conclusion respecting the general course of things, past, present, and future, the one which the evidence as far as it goes justifies, and the only one for which there is any justification, is, that the change from an indeterminate uniformity to a determinate multiformity which we everywhere see going on, has been going on from the first, and will continue to go on.
The law of Evolution, whether expressed fully as above or in these shorter but less precise phrases, is fundamentally what has been detailed in the previous pages. From what we can determine, this law is universal. It's shown through endless repetition and in countless ways wherever there's enough data; and where the data isn't enough for induction, deduction helps fill in the gaps. Among all types of phenomena we can observe, we constantly see the process of change as defined above; and many telling signs lead us to believe that the same process of change happened throughout the distant past beyond our observation. If we have to draw any conclusion about the overall course of things—past, present, and future—the one that the evidence, as far as it goes, supports, and the only one that has any justification, is that the shift from a vague uniformity to a clear multiformity, which we see happening everywhere, has been occurring from the very beginning and will keep happening.
10. Carpenter’s Prin. of Comp. Phys., p. 617.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Carpenter’s Principles of Comparative Physiology, p. 617.
CHAPTER IV.
The Causes of Evolution.
§ 58. Is this law ultimate or derivative? Must we rest satisfied with the conclusion that throughout all classes of concrete phenomena such is the mode of evolution? Or is it possible for us to ascertain why such is the mode of evolution? May we seek for some all-pervading principle which underlies this all-pervading process? Can we by a further step reduce our empirical generalization to a rational generalization?
§ 58. Is this law final or just a result of something else? Should we be content with the idea that this is how evolution happens in all types of concrete phenomena? Or can we figure out why this is the case? Can we look for some fundamental principle that underlies this widespread process? Is it possible to take our empirical observations and turn them into a rational understanding?
Manifestly this community of result implies community of causation. It may be that of such causation no account can be given, further than that the Unknowable is manifested to us after this manner. Or, it may be, that the mode of manifestation is reducible to simpler ones, from which these many complex consequences follow. Analogy suggests the latter inference. At present, the conclusion that every kind of Evolution is from a state of indefinite incoherent homogeneity to a state of definite coherent heterogeneity, stands in the same position as did the once ultimate conclusion that every kind of organized body undergoes, when dead, a more or less rapid decay. And as, for the various kinds of decomposition through which animal and vegetal products pass, we have now discovered a rationale in the chemical affinities of their constituent elements; so, possibly, this universal transformation of the simple into the complex may be affiliated upon certain simple primordial principles.
Clearly, this community of results implies a shared cause. It’s possible that we can’t explain this cause any further than recognizing that the Unknowable reveals itself to us in this way. Or, it could be that the way it reveals itself can be broken down into simpler forms, from which these many complex outcomes follow. Analogy supports the latter idea. Right now, the conclusion that all types of Evolution move from a state of indefinite, incoherent sameness to a state of definite, coherent diversity is similar to the once widely accepted conclusion that all organized bodies go through a more or less rapid decay after death. Just as we’ve figured out the reasons behind the different types of decomposition that animal and plant products experience through the chemical interactions of their elements, it’s possible that this universal change from the simple to the complex can be linked to certain basic, fundamental principles.
220Such cause or causes of Evolution, may be sought for without in the least assuming that the ultimate mystery can be fathomed. Fully conscious that an absolute solution is for ever beyond us, we may still look for a relative solution—may try to reduce the problem to its lowest terms. Just as it was possible to interpret Kepler’s laws as necessary consequences of the law of gravitation, and then to admit that gravitation transcends analysis; so it may be possible to interpret the law of Evolution as the necessary consequence of some deeper law, beyond which we may nevertheless be unable to go.
220We can look for the causes of Evolution without thinking we can completely understand the ultimate mystery. Even though we know that a perfect solution is always out of reach, we can still aim for a relative solution and try to simplify the problem. Just as we were able to interpret Kepler’s laws as necessary results of the law of gravitation, while acknowledging that gravitation goes beyond full understanding, we might also be able to see the law of Evolution as a necessary result of some deeper law that we might never fully grasp.
§ 59. The probability of common causation, and the possibility of formulating it, being granted, it will be well before going further, to consider what must be the general characteristics of such causation, and in what direction we ought to look for it. We can with certainty predict that be it simple or compound, the cause has a high degree of generality; seeing that it is common to such infinitely varied phenomena: in proportion to the universality of its application must be the abstractness of its character. Whatever be the agency and the conditions under which it acts, we need not expect to see in them an obvious explanation of this or that species of Evolution, because they equally underlie species of Evolution of quite a different order. Determining Evolution of every kind—astronomic, geologic, organic, ethnologic, social, economic, artistic, &c.—they must be concerned with something common to all these; and to see what these possess in common, will therefore be the best method of guiding ourselves towards the desired solution.
§ 59. Given the likelihood of common causation and the possibility of defining it, before we move forward, it's important to consider the general characteristics of such causation and where we should look for it. We can confidently say that whether it's simple or complex, the cause is generally broad; this is evident since it applies to a vast range of phenomena. The more universal its application, the more abstract its nature will be. No matter what the mechanisms or conditions are, we shouldn't expect them to provide a clear explanation for this or that type of Evolution, as they also underpin entirely different types of Evolution. Every kind of determining Evolution—astronomic, geologic, organic, ethnologic, social, economic, artistic, etc.—must be linked to something that all these have in common. Therefore, identifying what they share will be the best way to guide ourselves toward the solution we seek.
The only obvious respect in which all kinds of Evolution are alike, is, that they are modes of change. Every phenomenon to which we apply the term, presents us with a succession of states; and when such succession ceases, we no longer predicate Evolution. Equally in those past forms of it which are more or less hypothetical, and in those forms of it which 221we see going on around, this is the common characteristic. Note next, that the kind of change which constitutes Evolution, is broadly distinguished from change of an equally general kind, in this, that it is change of internal relations instead of change of external relations. All things in motion through space are the subjects of change; but while in this which we call mechanical motion, the relative position as measured from surrounding objects is continually altered, there is not implied any alteration in the positions of the parts of the moving body in respect to each other. Conversely, a body exhibiting what we call Evolution, while it either may or may not display new relations of position to the things around it, must display new relations of position among the parts of which it is made up. Thus we narrow the field of inquiry by recognizing the change in which Evolution consists, as a change in the arrangement of parts: of course using the word parts in its most extended sense, as signifying both ultimate units and masses of such units. Further, we have to remember that this change in the arrangement of parts which constitutes Evolution, is a certain order of such change. As we saw in the last chapter, there is a change in the arrangement of parts which is not Evolution but Dissolution—a destructive change as opposed to a constructive change—a change by which the definite is gradually rendered indefinite, the coherent slowly becomes incoherent, and the heterogeneous eventually lapses into comparative homogeneity. Thus then we reduce that which we have to investigate to its most abstract shape. Our task is to find the cause or causes of a certain order of change that takes place in the arrangement of parts.
The only clear similarity between all types of Evolution is that they represent forms of change. Every phenomenon we refer to by this term shows a series of states, and when that series stops, we no longer consider it Evolution. This common characteristic applies equally to both the past forms of it, which are somewhat hypothetical, and the forms currently observable around us. Also, the type of change that defines Evolution is distinctly different from general change in that it involves changes in internal relationships rather than external ones. All things moving through space experience change; however, in what we call mechanical motion, the relative positions measured from surrounding objects are constantly changing, with no implication of altering the positions of the moving body’s parts in relation to each other. On the other hand, a body demonstrating what we call Evolution must display new relationships of position among its constituent parts, even if it may or may not show new positional relationships with surrounding objects. Thus, we refine our focus by identifying the change that constitutes Evolution as a change in the arrangement of parts: using the term parts in its broadest context, which includes both fundamental units and large aggregates of such units. Furthermore, we need to keep in mind that this change in the arrangement of parts that constitutes Evolution follows a particular order. As we discussed in the last chapter, there is a change in the arrangement of parts that does not qualify as Evolution but rather as Dissolution—a destructive change in contrast to a constructive one—where the specific gradually becomes vague, the coherent slowly turns incoherent, and the diverse ultimately merges into relative uniformity. Thus, we distill our investigation down to its most abstract form. Our goal is to uncover the cause or causes of a specific type of change occurring in the arrangement of parts.
§ 60. Evidently the problem, as thus expressed, brings us face to face with the ultimate elements of phenomena in general. It is impossible to account for a certain change in the arrangement of the parts of any mass, without involving—first, the matter which makes up the parts thus re-arranged; 222next, the motion exhibited during the re-arrangement; and then, the force producing this motion. The problem is a dynamical one; and there can be no truly scientific solution of it, save one given in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force—terms in which all other dynamical problems are expressed and solved.
§ 60. Clearly, this issue, as stated, brings us directly to the fundamental elements of phenomena in general. We can't explain a specific change in the arrangement of the parts of any mass without considering—first, the matter that makes up the parts being rearranged; 222 then, the motion shown during the rearrangement; and finally, the force causing this motion. The problem is a dynamic one; and there’s no truly scientific answer to it, except one expressed in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force—terms that are used to express and solve all other dynamic problems.
The proposal thus to study the question from a purely physical point of view, will most likely, notwithstanding what has been said in the first part of this work, raise in some minds either alarm or prejudice. Having, throughout life, constantly heard the charge of materialism made against those who ascribed the more involved phenomena to agencies like those seen in the simplest phenomena, most persons have acquired a repugnance to such methods of interpretation; and when it is proposed to apply them universally, even though it is premised that the solution they give can be but relative, more or less of the habitual feeling will probably arise. Such an attitude of mind, however, is significant, not so much of a reverence for the Unknown Cause, as of an irreverence for those omnipresent forms in which the Unknown Cause is manifested to us. Men who have not risen above that vulgar conception which unites with Matter the contemptuous epithets “gross” and “brute,” may naturally enough feel dismay at the proposal to reduce the phenomena of Life, of Mind, and of Society, to a level with those which they think so degraded. But whoever remembers that the forms of existence which the uncultivated speak of with so much scorn, are not only shown by the man of science to be the more marvellous in their attributes the more they are investigated, but are also proved to be in their ultimate nature absolutely incomprehensible—as absolutely incomprehensible as sensation, or the conscious something which perceives it—whoever fully realizes this truth, I say, will see that the course proposed does not imply a degradation of the so-called higher, but an elevation of the so-called lower. Perceiving, as he will, that the Materialist and 223Spiritualist controversy is a mere war of words, in which the disputants are equally absurd—each thinking he understands that which it is impossible for any man to understand—he will perceive how utterly groundless is the fear referred to. Being fully convinced that whatever nomenclature is used, the ultimate mystery must remain the same, he will be as ready to formulate all phenomena in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force, as in any other terms; and will rather indeed anticipate, that only in a doctrine which recognizes the Unknown Cause as co-extensive with all orders of phenomena, can there be a consistent Religion, or a consistent Science.
The proposal to examine the issue from a purely physical perspective will likely provoke alarm or bias in some people, despite what was stated in the first part of this work. Having heard accusations of materialism throughout their lives aimed at those who explained complex phenomena through the same principles that explain simpler ones, many individuals have developed an aversion to these methods of interpretation. When it's suggested to apply these principles universally, even with the understanding that the solutions they provide can only be relative, a degree of this ingrained reaction is likely to arise. However, this mindset is not so much about a respect for the Unknown Cause but rather a disrespect for the familiar forms through which this Unknown Cause presents itself to us. People who have not moved beyond the simplistic view that associates Matter with terms like “gross” and “brute” may understandably feel disturbed by the idea of equating the phenomena of Life, Mind, and Society with what they consider degraded. But anyone who recognizes that the aspects of existence that the uneducated ridicule are shown by scientists to be more extraordinary the more they are examined—and are ultimately proven to be completely incomprehensible, just like sensation or the aware entity that experiences it—will understand that the proposed approach does not diminish the so-called higher but instead uplifts the so-called lower. They will realize that the Materialist and Spiritualist debate is just a battle of words, in which both sides are equally absurd, each believing they comprehend what is fundamentally beyond human understanding, and they will see how unfounded this fear really is. Fully convinced that regardless of the terms used, the ultimate mystery remains unchanged, they will be just as willing to describe all phenomena in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force as in any other language. They will indeed expect that only a doctrine that acknowledges the Unknown Cause as present in all forms of phenomena can lead to a coherent Religion or Science.
On the other hand, the conclusion that Evolution, considered under its most abstract form, is a certain change in the arrangement of parts; and that the causes of this change can be expressed only in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force; may in critical minds raise the question—What are Matter, Motion, and Force? Referring back in thought to the reasonings contained in the chapter on “Ultimate Scientific Ideas;” and remembering how it was there shown that absolute knowledge of Matter, Motion, and Force, is impossible; some readers will perhaps conclude that any such interpretation as the one above proposed, must be visionary. It may be asked—How can a comprehensible account of Evolution be given in terms that are themselves incomprehensible?
On the other hand, the conclusion that Evolution, viewed in its most abstract form, is simply a change in the arrangement of parts; and that the reasons for this change can only be described in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force; may lead some critical thinkers to ask—What exactly are Matter, Motion, and Force? Reflecting on the discussions in the chapter about “Ultimate Scientific Ideas;” and recalling that it was shown there that absolute knowledge of Matter, Motion, and Force is impossible; some readers might conclude that any interpretation like the one above must be unrealistic. It may be questioned—How can we provide a clear explanation of Evolution using terms that themselves aren't clear?
Before proceeding, this question must be met. There can be no sound philosophy without clearly defined terms; and as, on the meanings of the terms to be here used, doubts have probably been cast by the reasonings contained in the chapter referred to, such doubts must be removed. If, as was shown, our ideas of things do not correspond with things in themselves, it becomes necessary to inquire in what way they are to be accepted. If they are not absolutely true, then what is the exact meaning of the assertion that they are relatively true? To this question let us now address ourselves.
Before we move forward, we need to address this question. There can be no solid philosophy without well-defined terms; and since doubts may have arisen about the meanings of the terms we’ll use, we need to clear those up. As was shown, if our ideas about things don’t match the things themselves, we must figure out how we should accept them. If they aren’t absolutely true, then what does it really mean to say they are relatively true? Let’s now focus on this question.
CHAPTER V.
SPACE, TIME, MATTER, MOTION, AND FORCE.
§ 61. That sceptical state of mind which the criticisms of Philosophy usually produce, is, in great measure, caused by the misinterpretation of words. A sense of universal illusion ordinarily follows the reading of metaphysics; and is strong in proportion as the argument has appeared conclusive. This sense of universal illusion would probably never have arisen, had the terms used been always rightly construed. Unfortunately, these terms have by association acquired meanings that are quite different from those given to them in philosophical discussions; and the ordinary meanings being unavoidably suggested, there results more or less of that dreamlike idealism which is so incongruous with our instinctive convictions. The word phenomenon and its equivalent word appearance, are in great part to blame for this. In ordinary speech, these are uniformly employed in reference to visual perceptions. Habit, almost, if not quite, disables us from thinking of appearance except as something seen; and though phenomenon has a more generalized meaning, yet we cannot rid it of associations with appearance, which is its verbal equivalent. When, therefore, Philosophy proves that our knowledge of the external world can be but phenomenal—when it concludes that the things of which we are conscious are appearances; it inevitably arouses in us the notion of an illusiveness like that to which our visual perceptions are so liable in comparison with our tactual perceptions. Good pictures 225show us that the aspects of things may be very nearly simulated by colours on canvass. The looking-glass still more distinctly proves how deceptive is sight when unverified by touch. And the frequent cases in which we misinterpret the impressions made on our eyes, and think we see something which we do not see, further shake our faith in vision. So that the implication of uncertainty has infected the very word appearance. Hence, Philosophy, by giving it an extended meaning, leads us to think of all our senses as deceiving us in the same way that the eyes do; and so makes us feel ourselves floating in a world of phantasms. Had phenomenon and appearance no such misleading associations, little, if any, of this mental confusion would result. Or did we in place of them use the term effect, which is equally applicable to all impressions produced on consciousness through any of the senses, and which carries with it in thought the necessary correlative cause, with which it is equally real, we should be in little danger of falling into the insanities of idealism.
§ 61. The skeptical mindset often triggered by critiques of Philosophy is largely due to misunderstandings of words. A sense of universal deception usually follows reading metaphysics and is stronger when the arguments seem convincing. This feeling of universal deception probably wouldn't have emerged if the terms used had always been interpreted correctly. Unfortunately, these terms have taken on meanings through associations that differ significantly from their philosophical definitions; and since the usual meanings are inevitably suggested, we end up experiencing a kind of dreamlike idealism that clashes with our instinctive beliefs. The word phenomenon and its equivalent, appearance, are largely responsible for this. In everyday language, these terms are consistently used to refer to what we see. Habitually, we can almost only think of appearance as something visual; and even though phenomenon has a broader meaning, we can’t separate it from its connections to appearance. Thus, when Philosophy shows that our understanding of the external world can only be phenomenal—that the things we are aware of are just appearances—it inevitably suggests that those appearances are as deceptive as our visual perceptions can be compared to our tactile perceptions. Good paintings demonstrate that the features of things can be closely mimicked by colors on canvas. A mirror more clearly shows how misleading sight can be without confirmation from touch. Plus, the many times we misread what we see and think we perceive something that isn’t there further undermines our trust in vision. So, the idea of uncertainty has contaminated the word appearance. Consequently, Philosophy, by broadening its meaning, leads us to believe that all our senses might deceive us just like our eyes do, making us feel like we’re drifting in a world of illusions. If phenomenon and appearance didn’t have such confusing associations, we would experience little to no mental chaos. Or if we replaced them with the term effect, which fits all impressions we receive through any of the senses and inherently includes the necessary counterpart cause, which is just as real, we would be far less likely to fall into the traps of idealism.
Such danger as there might still remain, would disappear on making a further verbal correction. At present, the confusion resulting from the above misinterpretation, is made greater by an antithetical misinterpretation. We increase the seeming unreality of that phenomenal existence which we can alone know, by contrasting it with a noumenal existence which we imagine would, if we could know it, be more truly real to us. But we delude ourselves with a verbal fiction. What is the meaning of the word real? This is the question which underlies every metaphysical inquiry; and the neglect of it is the remaining cause of the chronic antagonisms of metaphysicians. In the interpretation put on the word real, the discussions of philosophy retain one element of the vulgar conception of things, while they reject all its other elements; and create confusion by the inconsistency. The peasant, on contemplating an object, does not regard that which he contemplates as something in himself, but believes the thing of which he is conscious to be the external 226object—imagines that his consciousness extends to the very place where the object lies: to him the appearance and the reality are one and the same thing. The metaphysician, however, is convinced that consciousness cannot embrace the reality, but only the appearance of it; and so he transfers the appearance into consciousness and leaves the reality outside. This reality left outside of consciousness, he continues to think of much in the same way as the ignorant man thinks of the appearance. Though the reality is asserted to be out of consciousness, yet the realness ascribed to it is constantly spoken of as though it were a knowledge possessed apart from consciousness. It seems to be forgotten that the conception of reality can be nothing more than some mode of consciousness; and that the question to be considered is—What is the relation between this mode and other modes?
Any remaining danger would vanish with one more verbal correction. Right now, the confusion from the previous misunderstanding is made worse by an opposing misinterpretation. We amplify the apparent unreality of the phenomenal existence that we can only know by comparing it to a noumenal existence that we imagine would be more genuinely real to us if we could understand it. However, we are deceiving ourselves with a verbal fantasy. What does the word real mean? This is the core question behind every metaphysical inquiry, and ignoring it is a major reason for the ongoing conflicts among metaphysicians. In how the word real is interpreted, philosophical discussions retain one aspect of the ordinary understanding of things while dismissing all its other aspects, leading to confusion through inconsistency. The farmer, when observing an object, does not see it as something on its own; he believes that the thing he is aware of is the external 226 object—he imagines his consciousness reaches the exact place where the object is located: for him, appearance and reality are the same. The metaphysician, on the other hand, believes that consciousness can only grasp the appearance of reality, not the reality itself; thus, he moves the appearance into consciousness and leaves reality outside. He continues to think of this reality outside consciousness much like an uninformed person thinks of the appearance. Even though reality is said to exist beyond consciousness, the realness attributed to it is often discussed as if it were knowledge that exists independently of consciousness. It's as though it is overlooked that the idea of reality can only be a specific mode of consciousness; and the question that should be considered is—What is the relationship between this mode and other modes?
By reality we mean persistence in consciousness: a persistence that is either unconditional, as our consciousness of space, or that is conditional, as our consciousness of a body while grasping it. The real, as we conceive it, is distinguished solely by the test of persistence; for by this test we separate it from what we call the unreal. Between a person standing before us, and the idea of such a person, we discriminate by our ability to expel the idea from consciousness, and our inability, while looking at him, to expel the person from consciousness. And when in doubt as to the validity or illusiveness of some impression made upon us in the dusk, we settle the matter by observing whether the impression persists on closer observation; and we predicate reality if the persistence is complete. How truly persistence is what we mean by reality, is shown in the fact that when, after criticism has proved that the real as we are conscious of it is not the objectively real, the indefinite notion which we form of the objectively real, is of something which persists absolutely, under all changes of mode, form, or appearance. And the fact that we cannot form even an indefinite notion of the absolutely real, except as the absolutely persistent, clearly implies that 227persistence is our ultimate test of the real as present to consciousness.
By reality, we mean persistence in consciousness: a persistence that is either unconditional, like our awareness of space, or conditional, like our awareness of a body when we hold it. The real, as we understand it, is defined solely by the test of persistence; through this test, we distinguish it from what we refer to as the unreal. For instance, between a person standing in front of us and the idea of such a person, we differentiate by our ability to remove the idea from our consciousness, while we can't remove the person from our consciousness while looking at them. When we're unsure about the truth or illusion of an impression made on us in the dim light, we resolve the uncertainty by seeing if the impression remains when we take a closer look; we consider it real if the persistence is complete. The notion that persistence is what we mean by reality is evident in the fact that when criticism shows that our understanding of the real is not the objectively real, the vague idea we form of the objectively real is of something that persists absolutely, regardless of any changes in mode, form, or appearance. The fact that we cannot even form a vague idea of the absolutely real, except as something that is absolutely persistent, clearly indicates that 227persistence is our ultimate test of what is real as it appears to consciousness.
Reality then, as we think it, being nothing more than persistence in consciousness, the result must be the same to us whether that which we perceive be the Unconditioned itself, or an effect invariably wrought on us by the Unconditioned. If some mode of the Unconditioned uniformly produces some mode of consciousness—if the mode of consciousness so produced, is as persistent as would be such mode of the Unconditioned were it immediately known; it follows that the reality will be to our consciousness as complete in the one case as in the other. Were the Unconditioned itself present in thought, it could but be persistent; and if instead of it, there is present its persistent effect, the resulting consciousness of reality must be exactly the same.
Reality, as we see it, is nothing more than what lingers in our minds. So, it doesn't matter to us whether what we perceive is the Unconditioned itself or just an effect brought about by the Unconditioned. If a certain aspect of the Unconditioned consistently creates a specific awareness—if that awareness is just as persistent as it would be if we immediately understood that aspect of the Unconditioned—then the reality we experience will feel just as complete in either case. If the Unconditioned were present in our thoughts, it could only remain consistent; and if only its persistent effect is present, our perception of reality must be exactly the same.
Hence there may be drawn these conclusions:—First, that we have an indefinite consciousness of an absolute reality transcending relations, which is produced by the absolute persistence in us of something which survives all changes of relation. Second, that we have a definite consciousness of relative reality, which unceasingly persists in us under one or other of its forms, and under each form so long as the conditions of presentation are fulfilled; and that the relative reality, being thus continuously persistent in us, is as real to us as would be the absolute reality could it be immediately known. Third, that thought being possible only under relation, the relative reality can be conceived as such only in connexion with an absolute reality; and the connexion between the two being absolutely persistent in our consciousness, is real in the same sense as the terms it unites are real.
Therefore, we can draw the following conclusions: First, we have an endless awareness of an ultimate reality that goes beyond relationships, created by the constant presence of something in us that survives all changes in those relationships. Second, we have a clear awareness of relative reality, which consistently remains with us in one form or another, as long as the conditions for its presentation are met; and since this relative reality is continuously present in us, it feels as real to us as the absolute reality would if it could be directly experienced. Third, since thought can only exist in relation to something, relative reality can only be understood in connection with absolute reality; and the connection between the two, being constantly present in our consciousness, is real in the same way that the concepts it links are real.
Thus then we may resume, with entire confidence, those realistic conceptions which philosophy at first sight seems to dissipate. Though reality under the forms of our consciousness, is but a conditioned effect of the absolute reality, yet this conditioned effect standing in indissoluble relation with its unconditioned cause, and being equally persistent with it 228so long as the conditions persist, is, to the consciousness supplying those conditions, equally real. The persistent impressions being the persistent results of a persistent cause, are for practical purposes the same to us as the cause itself; and may be habitually dealt with as its equivalents. Somewhat in the same way that our visual perceptions, though merely symbols found to be the equivalents of tactual perceptions, are yet so identified with those tactual perceptions that we actually appear to see the solidity and hardness which we do but infer, and thus conceive as objects what are only the signs of objects; so, on a higher stage, do we deal with these relative realities as though they were absolutes instead of effects of the absolute. And we may legitimately continue so to deal with them as long as the conclusions to which they help us are understood as relative realities and not absolute ones.
So, we can confidently return to those realistic ideas that philosophy seems to challenge at first glance. While reality, as we perceive it, is just a conditioned effect of the absolute reality, this conditioned effect is closely tied to its unconditioned cause and remains just as persistent as long as the conditions persist. For us, those conditions are equally real. The consistent impressions we have are the ongoing results of a consistent cause, and for practical purposes, they are the same as the cause itself; we can regularly treat them as if they are equivalent. Similarly, our visual perceptions, although they are just symbols that represent our tactile experiences, are still so connected to those tactile experiences that we actually seem to perceive solidity and hardness, which we only infer. In this way, we understand these relative realities as if they were absolute, even though they are effects of the absolute. We can continue to approach them this way as long as we recognize that the conclusions we draw from them are relative realities, not absolute ones.
This general conclusion it now remains to interpret specifically, in its application to each of our ultimate scientific ideas.
This general conclusion now needs to be interpreted specifically in relation to each of our core scientific ideas.
§ 62.[11] We think in relations. This is truly the form of all thought; and if there are any other forms, they must be derived from this. We have seen (Chap. iii. Part I.) that the several ultimate modes of being cannot be known or conceived as they exist in themselves; that is, out of relation to our consciousness. We have seen, by analyzing the product of thought, (§ 23,) that it always consists of relations; and cannot include anything beyond the most general of these. On analyzing the process of thought, we found that cognition of the Absolute was impossible, because it presented neither relation, nor its elements—difference and likeness. Further, we found that not only Intelligence but Life itself, consists in the establishment of internal relations in correspondence with external relations. And lastly, it was shown 229that though by the relativity of our thought we are eternally debarred from knowing or conceiving Absolute Being; yet that this very relativity of our thought, necessitates that vague consciousness of Absolute Being which no mental effort can suppress. That relation is the universal form of thought, is thus a truth which all kinds of demonstration unite in proving.
§ 62.[11] We think in relationships. This is truly the foundation of all thought; and if there are any other forms, they must come from this. We've seen (Chap. iii. Part I.) that the different ultimate modes of existence cannot be understood or conceived on their own; that is, outside of relation to our consciousness. We analyzed the product of thought (§ 23) and found that it always consists of relations; it cannot include anything beyond the most general of these. When we examined the thought process, we discovered that understanding the Absolute is impossible because it doesn't present either relation or its components—difference and similarity. Moreover, we found that not only intelligence but life itself consists of creating internal relations that correspond with external relations. Lastly, we showed 229that although our thought’s relativity prevents us from knowing or conceiving Absolute Being, this very relativity of our thought creates that vague awareness of Absolute Being that no mental effort can suppress. That relation is the universal form of thought is a truth that all types of demonstration agree on proving.
By the transcendentalists, certain other phenomena of consciousness are regarded as forms of thought. Presuming that relation would be admitted by them to be a universal mental form, they would class with it two others as also universal. Were their hypothesis otherwise tenable however, it must still be rejected if such alleged further forms are interpretable as generated by the primary form. If we think in relations, and if relations have certain universal forms, it is manifest that such universal forms of relations will become universal forms of our consciousness. And if these further universal forms are thus explicable, it is superfluous, and therefore unphilosophical, to assign them an independent origin. Now relations are of two orders—relations of sequence, and relations of co-existence; of which the one is original and the other derivative. The relation of sequence is given in every change of consciousness. The relation of co-existence, which cannot be originally given in a consciousness of which the states are serial, becomes distinguished only when it is found that certain relations of sequence have their terms presented in consciousness in either order with equal facility; while the others are presented only in one order. Relations of which the terms are not reversible, become recognized as sequences proper; while relations of which the terms occur indifferently in both directions, become recognized as co-existences. Endless experiences, which from moment to moment present both orders of these relations, render the distinction between them perfectly definite; and at the same time generate an abstract conception of each. The abstract of all sequences is Time. The abstract 230of all co-existences is Space. From the fact that in thought, Time is inseparable from sequence, and Space from co-existence, we do not here infer that Time and Space are original conditions of consciousness under which sequences and co-existences are known; but we infer that our conceptions of Time and Space are generated, as other abstracts are generated from other concretes: the only difference being, that the organization of experiences has, in these cases, been going on throughout the entire evolution of intelligence.
By transcendentalists, certain other aspects of consciousness are seen as forms of thought. Assuming they would agree that relation is a universal mental form, they would also categorize two other forms as universal. However, if their theory could be otherwise valid, it still has to be rejected if these additional forms can be understood as arising from the primary form. If we think in terms of relations, and these relations have specific universal forms, it's clear that such universal forms will also become universal forms of our consciousness. And if these additional universal forms can be explained this way, it is unnecessary and therefore unphilosophical to claim they have an independent origin. Now, relations come in two types—sequence relations and co-existence relations. One is original, and the other is derived. The relation of sequence appears in every change of consciousness. The relation of co-existence, which cannot originally be present in a consciousness where states are sequential, only becomes clear when we see that certain relations of sequence can have their elements presented in either order with equal ease; while others only appear in one order. Relations where the elements can't be reversed are recognized as proper sequences, while relations where the elements can occur equally in both directions are recognized as co-existences. Countless experiences that present both types of relations from moment to moment make the distinction between them perfectly clear, simultaneously developing a concept of each. The abstraction of all sequences is Time. The abstraction of all co-existences is Space. From the fact that in thought, Time is inseparable from sequence, and Space from co-existence, we do not conclude that Time and Space are original conditions of consciousness under which sequences and co-existences are perceived. Instead, we infer that our concepts of Time and Space arise as other abstractions do from other concrete experiences: the only difference being that the organization of experiences in these cases has been ongoing throughout the entire evolution of intelligence.
This synthesis is confirmed by analysis. Our consciousness of Space is a consciousness of co-existent positions. Any limited portion of space can be conceived only by representing its limits as co-existing in certain relative positions; and each of its imagined boundaries, be it line or plane, can be thought of in no other way than as made up of co-existent positions in close proximity. And since a position is not an entity—since the congeries of positions which constitute any conceived portion of space, and mark its bounds, are not sensible existences; it follows that the co-existent positions which make up our consciousness of Space, are not co-existences in the full sense of the word (which implies realities as their terms), but are the blank forms of co-existences, left behind when the realities are absent; that is, are the abstracts of co-existences. The experiences out of which, during the evolution of intelligence, this abstract of all co-existences has been generated, are experiences of individual positions as ascertained by touch; and each of such experiences involves the resistance of an object touched, and the muscular tension which measures this resistance. By countless unlike muscular adjustments, involving unlike muscular tensions, different resisting positions are disclosed; and these, as they can be experienced in one order as readily as another, we regard as co-existing. But since, under other circumstances, the same muscular adjustments do not produce contact with resisting positions, there result the same states of consciousness, minus the resistances—blank forms of co-existence from which the co-existent objects before 231experienced are absent. And from a building up of these, too elaborate to be here detailed, results that abstract of all relations of co-existence which we call Space. It remains only to point out, as a thing which we must not forget, that the experiences from which the consciousness of Space arises, are experiences of force. A certain correlation of the muscular forces we ourselves exercise, is the index of each position as originally disclosed to us; and the resistance which makes us aware of something existing in that position, is an equivalent of the pressure we consciously exert. Thus, experiences of forces variously correlated, are those from which our consciousness of Space is abstracted.
This synthesis is confirmed by analysis. Our awareness of Space is an awareness of positions that exist at the same time. Any specific area of space can only be understood by imagining its boundaries as existing in certain relative positions; and each of its imagined edges, whether line or plane, can only be thought of as made up of positions that exist close together. Since a position isn't an entity—because the collection of positions that make up any imagined area of space and define its edges aren't tangible existences—it follows that the positions that make up our awareness of Space are not co-existences in the full sense of the term (which implies real objects), but are the empty forms of co-existences, left behind when the real objects are absent; in other words, they are the abstracts of co-existences. The experiences that led to the development of this abstract of all co-existences, during the evolution of intelligence, are experiences of individual positions recognized by touch; and each of these experiences involves the resistance of a touched object and the muscular tension that measures this resistance. Through countless different muscular adjustments, involving different muscular tensions, various resistant positions are revealed; and since these can be experienced in one order as easily as another, we regard them as co-existing. However, since, under different circumstances, the same muscular adjustments do not result in contact with resistant positions, the same states of consciousness occur, minus the resistances—empty forms of co-existence from which the previously experienced objects are absent. From a complex process too detailed to explain here, this leads to the abstract of all relations of co-existence that we call Space. It is important to emphasize that the experiences from which the awareness of Space arises are experiences of force. A specific correlation of the muscular forces we exert is the indicator of each position as initially revealed to us; and the resistance that makes us aware of something existing in that position is equivalent to the pressure we consciously apply. Thus, experiences of forces that are variously correlated are the basis from which our awareness of Space is formed.
That which we know as Space being thus shown, alike by its genesis and definition, to be purely relative, what are we to say of that which causes it? Is there an absolute Space which relative Space in some sort represents? Is Space in itself a form or condition of absolute existence, producing in our minds a corresponding form or condition of relative existence? These are unanswerable questions. Our conception of Space is produced by some mode of the Unknowable; and the complete unchangeableness of our conception of it simply implies a complete uniformity in the effects wrought by this mode of the Unknowable upon us. But therefore to call it a necessary mode of the Unknowable, is illegitimate. All we can assert is, that Space is a relative reality; that our consciousness of this unchanging relative reality implies an absolute reality equally unchanging in so far as we are concerned; and that the relative reality may be unhesitatingly accepted in thought as a valid basis for our reasonings; which, when rightly carried on, will bring us to truths that have a like relative reality—the only truths which concern us or can possibly be known to us.
That which we understand as Space has been shown, both in its origin and definition, to be completely relative. So, what do we say about what causes it? Is there an absolute Space that relative Space somehow represents? Is Space itself a form or condition of absolute existence, producing a corresponding form or condition of relative existence in our minds? These questions can't be answered. Our understanding of Space comes from some aspect of the Unknowable; the complete consistency of our conception of it just suggests uniformity in the effects this aspect of the Unknowable has on us. However, calling it a necessary aspect of the Unknowable is invalid. All we can say is that Space is a relative reality; our awareness of this unchanging relative reality implies an equally unchanging absolute reality as far as we are concerned; and this relative reality can be confidently accepted in thought as a valid foundation for our reasoning, which, when properly conducted, will lead us to truths that also have a similar relative reality—the only truths that matter to us or can possibly be known to us.
Concerning Time, relative and absolute, a parallel argument leads to parallel conclusions. These are too obvious to need specifying in detail.
Concerning time, both relative and absolute, a similar argument leads to similar conclusions. These are too obvious to need detailed explanation.
232§ 63. Our conception of Matter, reduced to its simplest shape, is that of co-existent positions that offer resistance; as contrasted with our conception of Space, in which the co-existent positions offer no resistance. We think of Body as bounded by surfaces that resist; and as made up throughout of parts that resist. Mentally abstract the co-existent resistances, and the consciousness of Body disappears; leaving behind it the consciousness of Space. And since the group of co-existing resistent positions constituting a portion of matter, is uniformly capable of giving us impressions of resistance in combination with various muscular adjustments, according as we touch its near, its remote, its right, or its left side; it results that as different muscular adjustments habitually indicate different co-existences, we are obliged to conceive every portion of matter as containing more than one resistent position—that is, as occupying Space. Hence the necessity we are under of representing to ourselves the ultimate elements of Matter as being at once extended and resistent: this being the universal form of our sensible experiences of Matter, becomes the form which our conception of it cannot transcend, however minute the fragments which imaginary subdivisions produce. Of these two inseparable elements, the resistance is primary, and the extension secondary. Occupied extension, or Body, being distinguished in consciousness from unoccupied extension, or Space, by its resistance, this attribute must clearly have precedence in the genesis of the idea. Such a conclusion is, indeed, an obvious corollary from that at which we arrived in the foregoing section. If, as was there contended, our consciousness of Space is a product of accumulated experiences, partly our own but chiefly ancestral—if, as was pointed out, the experiences from which our consciousness of Space is abstracted, can be received only through impressions of resistance made upon the organism; the necessary inference is, that experiences of resistance being those from which the conception of Space is generated, the resistance-attribute of Matter must be regarded as primordial and the space-attribute 233as derivative. Whence it becomes manifest that our experience of force, is that out of which the idea of Matter is built. Matter as opposing our muscular energies, being immediately present to consciousness in terms of force; and its occupancy of Space being known by an abstract of experiences originally given in terms of force; it follows that forces, standing in certain correlations, form the whole content of our idea of Matter.
232§ 63. Our understanding of Matter, simplified, is that of positions that exist together and offer resistance; in contrast to our understanding of Space, where these positions do not offer resistance. We think of Body as defined by surfaces that resist, and composed of parts that resist throughout. If we mentally strip away the co-existing resistances, the awareness of Body vanishes, leaving just the awareness of Space. Since the group of co-existing positions that make up a portion of matter consistently gives us impressions of resistance combined with various muscle adjustments, depending on whether we touch its near, remote, right, or left side, we must understand every portion of matter as having more than one resistant position—that is, as taking up Space. Thus, we must envision the basic elements of Matter as both extended and resistant: this reflects our universal experience of Matter, which our understanding cannot surpass, regardless of how small the pieces that imaginary divisions create. Of these two interconnected elements, resistance is primary, and extension is secondary. Occupied extension, or Body, is recognized in consciousness as different from unoccupied extension, or Space, because of its resistance, so this characteristic must logically come first in forming the idea. This conclusion is, in fact, a clear outcome of what we discussed in the previous section. If, as argued there, our awareness of Space results from a buildup of experiences—partly our own and mostly inherited—if, as noted, the experiences we abstract our awareness of Space from can only be gained through impressions of resistance on our organism; the essential conclusion is that as experiences of resistance generate our concept of Space, the resistance attribute of Matter must be seen as fundamental and the space attribute as secondary. Hence, it becomes clear that our experience of force is the foundation upon which the idea of Matter is built. Matter, by opposing our muscle energies, is immediately felt in terms of force; and its occupation of Space is understood through an abstract of experiences originally conveyed in terms of force; thus, forces, related in certain ways, make up the entire content of our idea of Matter. 233
Such being our cognition of the relative reality, what are we to say of the absolute reality? We can only say that it is some mode of the Unknowable, related to the Matter we know, as cause to effect. The relativity of our cognition of Matter is shown alike by the above analysis, and by the contradictions which are evolved when we deal with the cognition as an absolute one (§ 16). But, as we have lately seen, though known to us only under relation, Matter is as real in the true sense of that word, as it would be could we know it out of relation; and further, the relative reality which we know as Matter, is necessarily represented to the mind as standing in a persistent or real relation to the absolute reality. We may therefore deliver ourselves over without hesitation, to those terms of thought which experience has organized in us. We need not in our physical, chemical, or other researches, refrain from dealing with Matter as made up of extended and resistent atoms; for this conception, necessarily resulting from our experiences of Matter, is not less legitimate, than the conception of aggregate masses as extended and resistent. The atomic hypothesis, as well as the kindred hypothesis of an all-pervading ether consisting of molecules, is simply a necessary development of those universal forms which the actions of the Unknowable have wrought in us. The conclusions logically worked out by the aid of these hypotheses, are sure to be in harmony with all others which these same forms involve, and will have a relative truth that is equally complete.
Given our understanding of relative reality, what can we say about absolute reality? We can only describe it as a form of the Unknowable, connected to the Matter we recognize, like cause to effect. The relativity of our understanding of Matter is demonstrated by the analysis above and by the contradictions that arise when we try to treat this understanding as absolute (§ 16). However, as we've just seen, even though we only know Matter in relation, it is just as real in the true sense of the word as if we could know it independently of any relation. Moreover, the relative reality we perceive as Matter must be understood as having a consistent or real relationship with absolute reality. We can, therefore, confidently use the concepts that our experiences have shaped in us. In our physical, chemical, or other investigations, we don’t need to avoid considering Matter as composed of extended and solid atoms; this idea, which stems from our experiences with Matter, is just as valid as the concept of large masses being extended and solid. The atomic theory and the related idea of an all-encompassing ether made up of molecules are simply necessary outcomes of the universal patterns created by the actions of the Unknowable within us. The conclusions logically drawn using these theories will certainly align with all other concepts these same patterns imply, and will possess a relative truth that is equally robust.
§ 64. The conception of Motion as presented or represented 234in the developed consciousness, involves the conceptions of Space, of Time, and of Matter. A something that moves; a series of positions occupied in succession; and a group of co-existent positions united in thought with the successive ones—these are the constituents of the idea. And since, as we have seen, these are severally elaborated from experiences of force as given in certain correlations, it follows that from a further synthesis of such experiences, the idea of Motion is also elaborated. A certain other element in the idea, which is in truth its fundamental element, (namely, the necessity which the moving body is under to go on changing its position), results immediately from the earliest experiences of force. Movements of different parts of the organism in relation to each other, are the first presented in consciousness. These, produced by the action of the muscles, necessitate reactions upon consciousness in the shape of sensations of muscular tension. Consequently, each stretching-out or drawing-in of a limb, is originally known as a series of muscular tensions, varying in intensity as the position of the limb changes. And this rudimentary consciousness of Motion, consisting of serial impressions of force, becomes inseparably united with the consciousness of Space and Time as fast as these are abstracted from further impressions of force. Or rather, out of this primitive conception of Motion, the adult conception of it is developed simultaneously with the development of the conceptions of Space and Time: all three being evolved from the more multiplied and varied impressions of muscular tension and objective resistance. Motion, as we know it, is thus traceable, in common with the other ultimate scientific ideas, to experiences of force.
§ 64. The idea of Motion, as understood in developed consciousness, includes the ideas of Space, Time, and Matter. There’s something that moves; a sequence of positions occupied one after another; and a set of positions that coexist concurrently, connected in thought with the sequential ones—these are the elements of the idea. Since, as we’ve seen, these are each developed from experiences of force as observed in certain correlations, it follows that through a further synthesis of these experiences, the idea of Motion is also formed. A different fundamental element in this idea (specifically, the necessity for the moving body to continually change its position) arises directly from the earliest experiences of force. The movement of different parts of the organism in relation to one another is what first appears in consciousness. These movements, caused by muscle action, lead to reactions in consciousness as sensations of muscular tension. Therefore, each stretch or contraction of a limb is initially experienced as a series of muscular tensions, differing in intensity as the limb’s position changes. This basic awareness of Motion, made up of a sequence of impressions of force, becomes closely linked with the awareness of Space and Time as soon as these ideas are abstracted from further impressions of force. In fact, from this primitive understanding of Motion, the more complex adult understanding develops at the same time that the concepts of Space and Time are formed; all three evolve from the increasingly varied impressions of muscular tension and physical resistance. Thus, Motion, as we know it, can be traced, like other fundamental scientific ideas, back to experiences of force.
That this relative reality answers to some absolute reality, it is needful only for form’s sake to assert. What has been said above, respecting the Unknown Cause which produces in us the effects called Matter, Space, and Time, will apply, on simply changing the terms, to Motion.
That this relative reality corresponds to some absolute reality, it's only necessary for the sake of form to claim. What has been stated above regarding the Unknown Cause that creates in us the effects we refer to as Matter, Space, and Time, will also apply, with just a change of terms, to Motion.
235§ 65. We come down then finally to Force, as the ultimate of ultimates. Though Space, Time, Matter, and Motion, are apparently all necessary data of intelligence, yet a psychological analysis (here indicated only in rude outline) shows us that these are either built up of, or abstracted from, experiences of Force. Matter and Motion, as we know them, are differently conditioned manifestations of Force. Space and Time, as we know them, are disclosed along with these different manifestations of Force as the conditions under which they are presented. Matter and Motion are concretes built up from the contents of various mental relations; while Space and Time are abstracts of the forms of these various relations. Deeper down than these, however, are the primordial experiences of Force, which, as occurring in consciousness in different combinations, supply at once the materials whence the forms of relations are generalized, and the related objects built up. A single impression of force is manifestly receivable by a sentient being devoid of mental forms: grant but sensibility, with no established power of thought, and a force producing some nervous change, will still be presentable at the supposed seat of sensation. Though no single impression of force so received, could itself produce consciousness (which implies relations between different states), yet a multiplication of such impressions, differing in kind and degree, would give the materials for the establishment of relations, that is, of thought. And if such relations differed in their forms as well as in their contents, the impressions of such forms would be organized simultaneously with the impressions they contained. Thus all other modes of consciousness are derivable from experiences of Force; but experiences of Force are not derivable from anything else. Indeed, it needs but to remember that consciousness consists of changes, to see that the ultimate datum of consciousness must be that of which change is the manifestation; and that thus the force by which we ourselves produce changes, 236and which serves to symbolize the cause of changes in general, is the final disclosure of analysis.
235§ 65. We ultimately arrive at Force, as the ultimate foundation. While Space, Time, Matter, and Motion seem to be essential elements of understanding, a psychological analysis (briefly outlined here) reveals that these aspects are either constructed from or derived from our experiences of Force. Matter and Motion, as we understand them, are different expressions of Force under various conditions. Space and Time are revealed alongside these differing expressions of Force as the contexts in which they are perceived. Matter and Motion are tangible elements formed from the contents of various mental relationships, while Space and Time are abstract concepts representing the forms of these relationships. However, beneath all of this lie the fundamental experiences of Force, which, when occurring in consciousness in different combinations, provide both the materials from which relational forms are generalized and the related objects are created. A single experience of force can clearly be sensed by a being without any mental constructs: if there is merely sensitivity, without any established thinking ability, a force causing some nervous response can still be recognized at the supposed point of sensation. Although no single experience of force by itself could create consciousness (which requires relationships between different states), a series of such experiences, varying in type and intensity, would provide the raw materials for establishing relationships, that is, for thought. If these relationships differed in their structures as well as their contents, then the impressions of these structures would be organized at the same time as the impressions they hold. In this way, all other forms of consciousness can be traced back to experiences of Force; however, experiences of Force cannot arise from anything else. In fact, it only takes recognizing that consciousness consists of changes to understand that the most basic element of consciousness must be that which change represents; therefore, the force by which we ourselves create changes, and which symbolizes the general cause of changes, is the ultimate insight of analysis. 236
It is a truism to say that the nature of this undecomposable element of our knowledge is inscrutable. If, to use an algebraic illustration, we represent Matter, Motion, and Force, by the symbols x, y, and z; then, we may ascertain the values of x and y in terms of z; but the value of z can never be found: z is the unknown quantity which must for ever remain unknown; for the obvious reason that there is nothing in which its value can be expressed. It is within the possible reach of our intelligence to go on simplifying the equations of all phenomena, until the complex symbols which formulate them are reduced to certain functions of this ultimate symbol; but when we have done this, we have reached that limit which eternally divides science from nescience.
It's a well-known fact that the essence of this indivisible part of our understanding is mysterious. If we use a math analogy, where we represent Matter, Motion, and Force with the symbols x, y, and z; we can figure out the values of x and y based on z; but we can never determine the value of z: z is the unknown that will always stay unknown; simply because there's nothing that can express its value. We can keep simplifying the equations of all phenomena until the complex symbols that represent them are reduced to certain functions of this ultimate symbol; but once we've done that, we've hit the boundary that forever separates knowledge from ignorance.
That this undecomposable mode of consciousness into which all other modes may be decomposed, cannot be itself the Power manifested to us through phenomena, has been already proved (§ 18). We saw that to assume an identity of nature between the cause of changes as it absolutely exists, and that cause of change of which we are conscious in our own muscular efforts, betrays us into alternative impossibilities of thought. Force, as we know it, can be regarded only as a certain conditioned effect of the Unconditioned Cause—as the relative reality indicating to us an Absolute Reality by which it is immediately produced. And here, indeed, we see even more clearly than before, how inevitable is that transfigured realism to which sceptical criticism finally brings us round. Getting rid of all complications, and contemplating pure Force, we are irresistibly compelled by the relativity of our thought, to vaguely conceive some unknown force as the correlative of the known force. Conditioned effect and unconditioned cause, are here presented in their primordial relation as two sides of the same change; of which we are obliged to regard the conditioned and the unconditioned sides as equally real: the only difference being that the reality of 237the one is made relative by the imposition of the forms and limits of our consciousness, while the reality of the other, in the absence of those forms and limits, remains absolute.
That this fundamental way of thinking, into which all other ways can be broken down, cannot itself be the Power that we observe through phenomena has already been demonstrated (§ 18). We saw that assuming a natural identity between the cause of changes as it exists in reality and the cause of change that we perceive in our own muscular efforts leads us to contradictory thoughts. Force, as we understand it, can only be seen as a specific conditioned effect of the Unconditioned Cause—it's the relative reality that points us to an Absolute Reality from which it is directly produced. Here, we see even more clearly how unavoidable that transformed realism is, to which skeptical criticism ultimately brings us back. By removing all complexities and focusing on pure Force, we are inevitably led by the relativity of our thoughts to vaguely imagine some unknown force as the counterpart to the known force. The conditioned effect and unconditioned cause are shown here in their most fundamental relationship as two sides of the same change; we must consider both the conditioned and unconditioned sides as equally real, the only difference being that the reality of one is made relative by the forms and limits of our consciousness, while the reality of the other, without those forms and limits, remains absolute.
Thus much respecting the nature of our ultimate scientific ideas. Before proceeding to our general inquiry concerning the causes of Evolution, we have still to consider certain ultimate scientific truths.
Thus much regarding the nature of our ultimate scientific ideas. Before moving on to our general investigation into the causes of Evolution, we still need to examine certain fundamental scientific truths.
11. For the psychological conclusions briefly set forth in this and the three sections following it, the justification will be found in the writer’s Principles of Psychology.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.For the psychological conclusions presented here and in the three sections that follow, the reasoning can be found in the writer’s Principles of Psychology.
CHAPTER VI.
The indestructibility of matter.
§ 66. Not because the truth is unfamiliar, is it needful here to say something concerning the indestructibility of Matter; but partly because the symmetry of our argument demands the enunciation of this truth, and partly because the evidence on which it is accepted requires examination. Could it be shown, or could it with any rationality be even supposed, that Matter, either in its aggregates or in its units, ever became non-existent, there would be an end to the inquiry on which we are now setting out. Evolution, considered as a re-arrangement of parts, could not be scientifically explained, if, during its course, any of the parts might arise out of nothing or might lapse into nothing. The question would no longer be one comprehending only the forces and motions by which the re-arrangement is effected; but would involve an incalculable element, and would hence be insoluble. Clearly, therefore, the indestructibility of Matter is an indispensable axiom.
§ 66. It's not necessary to discuss the indestructibility of matter just because the truth is unfamiliar; rather, our argument's structure requires us to state this truth, and the evidence supporting it needs to be examined. If it could be demonstrated, or even reasonably assumed, that matter—whether in large quantities or in individual units—could ever cease to exist, our current inquiry would come to an end. Evolution, seen as a rearrangement of parts, couldn't be scientifically explained if, during the process, any parts could come from nothing or disappear into nothing. The question would then not only involve the forces and motions that cause the rearrangement but would also include an unpredictable element, making it impossible to solve. Clearly, then, the indestructibility of matter is a crucial principle.
So far from being admitted as a self-evident truth, this would, in primitive times, have been rejected as a self-evident error. There was once universally current, a notion that things could vanish into absolute nothing, or arise out of absolute nothing. If we analyze early superstitions, or that faith in magic which was general in later times and even still survives among the uncultured, we find one of its postulates to be, that by some potent spell Matter can be called out of nonentity, and can be made non-existent. If men did not believe 239this in the strict sense of the word (which would imply that the process of creation or annihilation was clearly represented in consciousness), they still believed that they believed it; and how nearly, in their confused thoughts, the one was equivalent to the other, is shown by their conduct. Nor, indeed, have dark ages and inferior minds alone betrayed this belief. The current theology, in its teachings respecting the beginning and end of the world, is clearly pervaded by it; and it may be even questioned whether Shakespeare, in his poetical anticipation of a time when all things should disappear and “leave not a wrack behind,” was not under its influence. The gradual accumulation of experiences however, and still more the organization of experiences, has tended slowly to reverse this conviction; until now, the doctrine that Matter is indestructible has become a common-place. Whatever may be true of it absolutely, we have learnt that relatively to our consciousness, Matter never either comes into existence or ceases to exist. Cases which once gave an apparent support to the illusion that something could come out of nothing, a wider knowledge has one by one cancelled. The comet that is all at once discovered in the heavens and nightly waxes larger, is proved not to be a newly-created body, but a body that was until lately beyond the range of vision. The cloud which in the course of a few minutes forms in the sky, consists not of substance that has just begun to be, but of substance that previously existed in a more diffused and transparent form. And similarly with a crystal or precipitate in relation to the fluid depositing it. Conversely, the seeming annihilations of Matter turn out, on closer observation, to be only changes of state. It is found that the evaporated water, though it has become invisible, may be brought by condensation to its original shape. The discharged fowling-piece gives evidence that though the gunpowder has disappeared, there have appeared in place of it certain gases, which, in assuming a larger volume, have caused the explosion. Not, however, until the rise of quantitative chemistry, could the conclusion 240suggested by such experiences be reduced to a certainty. When, having ascertained not only the combinations into which various substances enter, but also the proportions in which they combine, chemists were enabled to account for the matter that had made its appearance or become invisible, the proof was rendered complete. When, in place of the candle that had slowly burnt away, it was shown that certain calculable quantities of carbonic acid and water had resulted—when it was demonstrated that the joint weight of the carbonic acid and water thus produced, was equal to the weight of the candle plus that of the oxygen uniting with its constituents during combustion; it was put beyond doubt that the carbon and hydrogen forming the candle, were still in existence, and had simply changed their state. And of the general conclusion thus exemplified, the exact analyses daily made, in which the same portion of matter is pursued through numerous transformations and finally separated, furnish never-ceasing confirmations.
So far from being accepted as a self-evident truth, this would have been rejected as a clear error in ancient times. There was once a widely held belief that things could disappear into nothing or come from nothing. If we look at early superstitions, or the belief in magic that was common in later times and still exists among less educated people, we can see that one of its core ideas was that through some powerful spell, matter could be summoned from nothing and made to vanish. Even if people didn’t literally believe this (which would mean having a clear understanding of creation or destruction), they still thought they believed it; and how closely the two ideas were linked in their confused minds is reflected in their behavior. Moreover, this belief hasn’t just been held by less educated minds throughout dark ages. Current theology, with its teachings about the beginning and end of the world, is clearly influenced by it; and one could even argue that Shakespeare, in his poetic prediction of a time when everything would disappear and “leave not a wreck behind,” was under its influence as well. However, the gradual buildup of knowledge and, even more so, the organization of experiences has slowly started to reverse this belief; now, the idea that matter is indestructible is considered a common fact. Regardless of its absolute truth, we’ve learned that from our perspective, matter never truly comes into being or goes out of existence. Situations that once seemed to support the illusion that something could come from nothing have been systematically disproven. The comet that suddenly appears in the sky and gets larger night after night isn’t a newly created object; it’s one that was previously too distant to see. The cloud that forms in just a few minutes isn’t made of new substance but is made up of particles that previously existed in a more spread-out and invisible form. The same applies to a crystal or precipitate concerning the liquid that created it. On the flip side, cases where matter seems to disappear turn out to be merely changes in state. It’s found that evaporated water, even though it’s no longer visible, can return to its original form through condensation. The discharged shotgun shows that while the gunpowder has vanished, certain gases have taken its place, and those gases expanding have caused the explosion. However, it wasn’t until the rise of quantitative chemistry that the conclusions suggested by such observations could be solidified. Once scientists established not only the combinations different substances form but also the precise proportions they mix in, they could clearly account for the matter that appeared or disappeared. For instance, when it was shown that burning a candle produces specific measurable amounts of carbon dioxide and water, proving that the combined weight of the carbon dioxide and water matched the weight of the candle plus the oxygen that joined its components during combustion, it became undeniable that the carbon and hydrogen from the candle were still there, just changed states. The general conclusion illustrated by this example is continuously supported by precise analyses in which the same material is followed through multiple transformations and ultimately isolated.
Such has become the effect of this specific evidence, joined to that general evidence which the continued existence of familiar objects unceasingly gives us; that the indestructibility of Matter is now recognized by many as a truth of which the negation is inconceivable. Habitual experiences being no longer met by any counter-experiences, as they once seemed to be; but these apparent counter-experiences furnishing new proof that Matter exists permanently, even where the senses fail to detect it; it has grown into an axiom of science, that whatever metamorphoses Matter undergoes, its quantity is fixed. The chemist, the physicist, and the physiologist, not only one and all take this for granted, but would severally profess themselves unable to realize any supposition to the contrary.
The impact of this specific evidence, along with the general evidence provided by the constant presence of familiar objects, has led many to acknowledge that the indestructibility of Matter is an undeniable truth. Our usual experiences are no longer contradicted by opposing experiences as they once were; instead, these seemingly opposing experiences offer new proof that Matter exists continuously, even when our senses can’t detect it. It has become a fundamental principle of science that no matter what changes Matter goes through, its quantity remains constant. Chemists, physicists, and physiologists all accept this as a given and would each find it difficult to imagine a scenario that suggests otherwise.
§ 67. This last fact naturally raises the question, whether we have any higher warrant for this fundamental belief, than the warrant of conscious induction. The indestructibility of 241Matter is proved experimentally to be an absolute uniformity within the range of our experience. But absolute uniformities of experience, generate absolute uniformities of thought. Does it not follow, then, that this ultimate truth must be a cognition involved in our mental organization? An affirmative answer we shall find unavoidable.
§ 67. This last fact naturally raises the question of whether we have any stronger justification for this fundamental belief than the justification of conscious induction. The indestructibility of 241 Matter is experimentally shown to be an absolute uniformity within the limits of our experience. However, absolute uniformities of experience lead to absolute uniformities of thought. Does it not follow that this ultimate truth must be a recognition inherent in our mental framework? An affirmative answer seems inevitable.
What is termed the ultimate incompressibility of Matter, is an admitted law of thought. Though it is possible to imagine a piece of matter to be compressed without limit, yet however small the bulk to which we conceive it reduced, it is impossible to conceive it reduced into nothing. While we can represent to ourselves the parts of the matter as indefinitely approximated, and the space occupied as indefinitely decreased, we cannot represent to ourselves the quantity of matter as made less. To do this would imply an imagined disappearance of some of the constituent parts—would imply that some of the constituent parts were in thought compressed into nothing; which is no more possible than the compression of the whole into nothing. Whence it is an obvious corollary, that the total quantity of matter in the Universe, cannot really be conceived as diminished, any more than it can be conceived as increased. Our inability to conceive Matter becoming non-existent, is immediately consequent on the very nature of thought. Thought consists in the establishment of relations. There can be no relation established, and therefore no thought framed, when one of the related terms is absent from consciousness. Hence it is impossible to think of something becoming nothing, for the same reason that it is impossible to think of nothing becoming something—the reason, namely, that nothing cannot become an object of consciousness. The annihilation of Matter is unthinkable for the same reason that the creation of Matter is unthinkable; and its indestructibility thus becomes an à priori cognition of the highest order—not one that results from a long continued registry of experiences gradually organized into an irreversible 242mode of thought; but one that is given in the form of all experiences whatever.
What we refer to as the ultimate incompressibility of matter is a recognized principle of thought. Although we can imagine a piece of matter being compressed infinitely, no matter how small we think it can get, we can't conceive it being reduced to nothing. While we can picture the parts of matter coming closer together and the space it occupies getting smaller, we cannot think of the amount of matter itself being less. To do so would mean imagining that some of its parts have disappeared, which is just as impossible as compressing all of it into nothing. Therefore, it follows that the total amount of matter in the universe cannot truly be thought of as lessened, just as it can't be thought of as increased. Our inability to picture matter becoming non-existent comes from the very nature of thought itself. Thought involves establishing relationships. If one of the related elements is absent from our awareness, no relationship can be formed, and thus, no thought can be constructed. So, it's impossible to think of something turning into nothing, for the same reason it's impossible to think of nothing turning into something—because nothing cannot become an object of awareness. The idea of matter being annihilated is inconceivable for the same reason that the creation of matter is inconceivable; thus, its indestructibility becomes a high-level understanding—not one that comes from a long series of experiences forming a fixed way of thinking, but one that is inherent in all experiences.
Doubtless it will be considered strange that a truth only in modern times accepted as unquestionable, and then only by men of science, should be classed as an à priori truth; not only of equal certainty with those commonly so classed, but of even higher certainty. To set down as a proposition which cannot be thought, one which mankind once universally professed to think, and which the great majority profess to think even now, seems absurd. The explanation is, that in this, as in countless other cases, men have supposed themselves to think what they did not think. As was shown at the outset, the greater part of our conceptions are symbolic. Many of these symbolic conceptions, though rarely developed into real ones, admit of being so developed; and, being directly or indirectly proved to correspond with actualities, are valid. But along with these there pass current others which cannot be developed—cannot by any direct or indirect process be realized in thought; much less proved to correspond with actualities. Not being habitually tested, however, the legitimate and illegitimate symbolic conceptions are confounded together; and supposing themselves to have literally thought, that which they have thought only symbolically, men say they believe propositions of which the terms cannot even be put together in consciousness. Hence the ready acceptance given to sundry hypotheses respecting the origin of the Universe, which yet are absolutely unthinkable. And as before we found the commonly asserted doctrine that Matter was created out of nothing, to have been never really conceived at all, but to have been conceived only symbolically; so here we find the annihilation of Matter to have been conceived only symbolically, and the symbolic conception mistaken for a real one. Possibly it will be objected that the words thought, and belief, and conception, are here employed in new senses; and that it is a misuse of language to say that 243men did not really think that which has nevertheless so profoundly influenced their conduct. It must be confessed that there is an inconvenience in so restricting the meanings of these words. There is no remedy however. Definite conclusions can be reached, only by the use of well-defined terms. Questions touching the validity of any portion of our knowledge, cannot be profitably discussed unless the words knowing, and thinking, have specific interpretations. We must not include under them whatever confused processes of consciousness the popular speech applies them to; but only the distinct processes of consciousness. And if this obliges us to reject a large part of human thinking as not thinking at all, but merely pseudo-thinking, there is no help for it.
It's surely strange that a truth only recently accepted as undeniable, and primarily by scientists, would be categorized as an a priori truth; not just equally certain as those typically classified in this way, but even more certain. To claim that something which humanity once universally believed to think, and which the majority still claim to believe now, cannot be thought is absurd. The explanation is that, in this case, as in many others, people have thought they understood something when they actually did not. As mentioned at the beginning, most of our ideas are symbolic. Many of these symbolic ideas, though rarely developed into concrete ones, can be developed and have been shown, either directly or indirectly, to correspond with reality, making them valid. However, there are also ideas in circulation that cannot be developed or realized in thought; much less can they be shown to correspond with actualities. Because these ideas are not regularly tested, the legitimate and illegitimate symbolic ideas get mixed up; and thinking they have truly comprehended what they've only thought about symbolically, people claim they believe in propositions where the terms can't even be assembled in their minds. This helps explain the easy acceptance of various hypotheses about the origin of the Universe that are actually impossible to comprehend. Just as we previously found that the commonly stated idea that Matter was created from nothing was never truly understood but only conceived symbolically, we now find that the concept of the annihilation of Matter has also only been conceived symbolically, with that symbolic conception mistaken for a real one. There may be a counterargument that the terms thought, belief, and conception are being used in new ways; and that it’s a misuse of language to say that 243 people didn’t really think something that nonetheless influenced their behavior so deeply. It must be acknowledged that there is a drawback in limiting the meanings of these words this way. However, there’s no solution to this issue. Clear conclusions can only be drawn by using precise terms. Questions about the validity of our knowledge cannot be effectively discussed unless knowing and thinking have specific interpretations. We must not include under these terms any confused processes of consciousness that everyday language uses them for, but only distinct processes of consciousness. And if this forces us to dismiss a vast part of human thought as not genuine thinking at all, but merely pseudo-thinking, so be it.
Returning to the general question, we find the results to be:—that we have positive experience of the continued existence of Matter; that the form of our thought renders it impossible for us to have experience of Matter passing into non-existence, since such experience would involve cognition of a relation having one of its terms not representable in consciousness; that hence the indestructibility of Matter is in strictness an à priori truth; that nevertheless, certain illusive experiences, suggesting the notion of its annihilation, have produced in undisciplined minds not only the supposition that Matter could be conceived to become non-existent, but the notion that it did so; but that careful observation, showing the supposed annihilations to have never taken place, has confirmed, à posteriori, the à priori cognition which Psychology shows to result from a uniformity of experience that can never be met by counter-experience.
Returning to the main question, we find the results to be: that we have a clear experience of the continued existence of Matter; that the way we think makes it impossible for us to experience Matter disappearing, since such an experience would involve understanding a relation where one part cannot be represented in our consciousness; that therefore, the indestructibility of Matter is strictly an a priori truth; that nevertheless, certain misleading experiences, suggesting the idea of its destruction, have led some undisciplined minds to not only suppose that Matter could be imagined as becoming non-existent, but also to think that it actually did; however, careful observation, which shows that the supposed destructions never occurred, has confirmed, after the fact, the a priori understanding that Psychology shows results from a consistency of experience that can never be challenged by contradictory experience.
§ 68. The fact, however, which it most concerns us here to observe, is, the nature of the perceptions by which the permanence of Matter is perpetually illustrated to us, and from which Science draws the inference that Matter is indestructible. These perceptions, under all their forms, amount simply to this—that the force which a given quantity of matter exercises, 244remains always the same. This is the proof on which common sense and exact science alike rely. When, for example, somebody known to have existed a few years since is said to exist still, by one who yesterday saw him, his assertion amounts to this—that an object which in past time wrought on his consciousness a certain group of changes, still exists because a like group of changes has been again wrought on his consciousness: the continuance of the power thus to impress him, he holds to prove the continuance of the object. Should some auditor allege a mistake in identity, the witness is admitted to give conclusive proof when he says that he not only saw, but shook hands with this person, and remarked while grasping his hand, that absence of the index finger which was his known peculiarity: the implication being, that an object which through a special combination of forces, produces special tactual impressions, is concluded still to exist while it continues still to do this. Even more clearly do we see that force is our ultimate measure of Matter, in those cases where the shape of the matter has been changed. A piece of gold given to an artizan to be worked into an ornament, and which when brought back appears to be less, is placed in the scales; and if it balances a much smaller weight than it did in its rough state, we infer that much has been lost either in manipulation or by direct abstraction. Here the obvious postulate is, that the quantity of Matter is finally determinable by the quantity of gravitative force it manifests. And this is the kind of evidence on which Science bases its experimentally-established induction that Matter is indestructible. Whenever a piece of substance lately visible and tangible, has been reduced to an invisible, intangible shape, but is proved by the weight of the gas into which it has been transformed to be still existing; the assumption is, that though otherwise insensible to us, the amount of matter is the same, if it still tends towards the Earth with the same force. Similarly, every case in which the weight of an element present in combination, is inferred from the known 245weight of another element which it neutralizes, is a case in which the quantity of matter is expressed in terms of the quantity of chemical force it exerts; and in which this specific chemical force is assumed to be the necessary correlative of a specific gravitative force.
§ 68. The key point we need to focus on here is the nature of the perceptions that constantly demonstrate to us the permanence of Matter, from which Science concludes that Matter is indestructible. These perceptions, in all their forms, simply indicate that the force exerted by a certain quantity of matter remains consistent. This is the evidence that both common sense and precise science depend on. For example, when someone who was known to exist a few years ago is said to still exist by someone who saw him yesterday, their claim means that an object which once caused a specific set of changes in their consciousness still exists because a similar set of changes has once again occurred in their consciousness: they believe the ability to impact them proves the object's continued existence. If someone claims there's a mistake in identity, the witness provides conclusive proof by stating that they not only saw but also shook hands with that person, noting the absence of the index finger, which was a recognized characteristic: the implication being that an object which creates specific tactile impressions through a unique combination of forces is assumed to still exist as long as it continues to do so. We see even more clearly that force is our ultimate measure of Matter in cases where the shape of the matter has changed. A piece of gold given to a craftsman to create an ornament, which, when returned, seems to weigh less, is placed on the scales; if it balances a much lighter weight than it did in its unprocessed state, we conclude that some has been lost either during handling or due to direct removal. Here, the clear assumption is that the quantity of Matter can ultimately be determined by the amount of gravitational force it exhibits. And this is the kind of evidence on which Science grounds its experimentally-supported conclusion that Matter is indestructible. Whenever a piece of material that was recently visible and tangible has been converted into an invisible, intangible form, but is shown by the weight of the gas it has changed into to still exist, the assumption is that even if it is otherwise undetectable to us, the amount of matter remains the same if it still pulls toward the Earth with the same force. Similarly, any instance in which the weight of an element in a compound is inferred from the known weight of another element it neutralizes is a case where the quantity of matter is articulated in terms of the amount of chemical force it exerts; and in which this specific chemical force is believed to be the necessary counterpart to a specific gravitational force.
Thus then by the indestructibility of Matter, we really mean the indestructibility of the force with which Matter affects us. As we become conscious of Matter only through that resistance which it opposes to our muscular energy, so do we become conscious of the permanence of Matter only through the permanence of this resistance; as either immediately or mediately proved to us. And this truth is made manifest not only by analysis of the à posteriori cognition, but equally so by analysis of the à priori one. For that which we cannot conceive to be diminished by the continued compression of Matter, is not its occupancy of space, but its ability to resist.
So, when we talk about the indestructibility of matter, we're really referring to the indestructibility of the force with which matter impacts us. We only become aware of matter through the resistance it offers against our physical efforts, and we understand the permanence of matter only through the ongoing nature of that resistance, whether it's shown to us directly or indirectly. This truth is revealed not just through analyzing our after the fact understanding but also through examining our a priori understanding. What we can't imagine being reduced by the constant compression of matter isn’t its space-filling capacity but its capacity to resist.
CHAPTER VII.
The Flow of Motion.
§ 69. Another general truth of the same order with the foregoing, must here be specified—one which, though not so generally recognized, has yet long been familiar among men of science. The continuity of Motion, like the indestructibility of Matter, is clearly an axiom underlying the very possibility of a rational theory of Evolution. That kind of change in the arrangement of parts, which we have found to constitute Evolution, could not be deductively explained were it possible for Motion either to appear or disappear. If those motions through which the parts pass into a new arrangement, might either proceed from nothing or lapse into nothing, there would be an end to scientific interpretation of them. Each constituent change might as well as not be supposed to begin and end of itself.
§ 69. Another general truth similar to the previous one must be mentioned here—one that, although not as widely recognized, has long been known among scientists. The continuity of Motion, like the indestructibility of Matter, is clearly a fundamental principle that supports the very possibility of a rational theory of Evolution. The kind of change in the arrangement of parts that we have identified as Evolution could not be logically explained if Motion could just start or stop appearing. If the movements that lead to a new arrangement of parts could either come from nothing or vanish into nothing, there would be no scientific way to interpret them. Each individual change could just as well be thought to begin and end on its own.
The axiomatic character of the truth that Motion is continuous, is recognized only after the discipline of exact science has given precision to the conceptions. Aboriginal men, our uneducated population, and even most of the so-called educated, think in an extremely indefinite manner. From careless observations, they pass by careless reasoning, to conclusions of which they do not contemplate the implications—conclusions which they never develope for the purpose of seeing whether they are consistent. Accepting without criticism the dicta of unaided perception, to the effect that surrounding bodies when put in motion soon return to rest, 247the great majority tacitly assume that the motion is actually lost. They do not consider whether the phenomenon can be otherwise interpreted; or whether the interpretation they put on it can be mentally realized. They are content with a colligation of mere appearances. But the establishment of certain facts having quite an opposite implication, led to inquiries which have gradually proved such appearances to be illusive. The discovery that the planets revolve round the Sun with undiminishing speed, raised the suspicion that a moving body, when not interfered with, will go on for ever without change of velocity; and suggested the question whether bodies which lose their motion, do not at the same time communicate as much motion to other bodies. It was a familiar fact that a stone would glide further over a smooth surface, such as ice, presenting no small objects to which it could part with its motion by collision, than over a surface strewn with such small objects; and that a projectile would travel a far greater distance through a rare medium like air, than through a dense medium like water. Thus the primitive notion that moving bodies had an inherent tendency gradually to lose their motion and finally stop—a notion of which the Greeks did not get rid, but which lasted till the time of Galileo—began to give way. It was further shaken by such experiments as those of Hooke, which proved that the spinning of a top continued long in proportion as it was prevented from communicating movement to surrounding matter—experiments which, when repeated with the aid of modern appliances, have shown that in vacuo such rotation, retarded only by the friction of the axis, will continue for nearly an hour. Thus have been gradually dispersed, the obstacles to the reception of the first law of motion;—the law, namely, that when not influenced by external forces, a moving body will go on in a straight line with a uniform velocity. And this law is in our day being merged in the more general one, that Motion, like Matter, is indestructible; and that whatever is lost by any one portion of matter is transferred to 248other portions—a conclusion which, however much at variance it seems with cases of sudden arrest from collision with an immovable object, is yet reconciled with such cases by the discovery that the motion apparently lost continues under new forms, though forms not directly perceptible.
The basic truth that motion is continuous is only fully appreciated once the field of exact science has clarified our understanding of it. Uneducated people, as well as many who consider themselves educated, think in a very vague way. They make careless observations, move to careless reasoning, and arrive at conclusions without considering their implications—conclusions that they never explore to see if they hold up. They take the claims made by their own perceptions at face value, like the idea that objects in motion come to a stop, leading many to tacitly assume that motion is actually lost. They don’t think about whether the phenomenon could have other explanations or whether their interpretation is something they can truly grasp. They settle for a collection of mere appearances. However, the establishment of certain facts that suggest otherwise led to investigations that have slowly revealed these appearances to be misleading. The discovery that planets orbit the Sun at a constant speed raised questions about whether a moving object, when undisturbed, would continue indefinitely without a change in speed. It also prompted questions about whether objects that lose their motion might simultaneously impart that motion to other objects. It was commonly known that a stone would glide further on a smooth surface, like ice, which has few small objects to collide with and impart its motion to, compared to a surface strewn with small objects. Similarly, a projectile travels a much greater distance through a light medium like air rather than a heavy medium like water. Thus, the early idea that moving objects naturally lose their motion and eventually stop—a notion that the Greeks held onto, which lasted until Galileo's time—began to fade. It was further challenged by experiments, like those of Hooke, demonstrating that a spinning top continues for a long time as long as it isn't transferring motion to surrounding materials. When these experiments were repeated with modern methods, it was shown that in a vacuum, such spinning—hampered only by the friction on its axis—can last for nearly an hour. Hence, the barriers to accepting the first law of motion have gradually diminished; this law states that without external forces acting on it, a moving object will continue in a straight line with a consistent velocity. Today, this law is being incorporated into a more general principle: that motion, like matter, cannot be destroyed; whatever is lost by one part of matter is transferred to other portions—a conclusion that, although it might seem contradictory in cases of sudden stopping due to collision with an immovable object, is reconciled by discovering that the motion that appears to be lost continues in different forms, even if those forms are not directly observable.
§ 70. And here it may be remarked of Motion, as it was before of Matter, that its indestructibility is not only to be inductively inferred, but that it is a necessity of thought: its destructibility never having been truly conceived at all, but having always been, as it is now, a mere verbal proposition that cannot be realized in consciousness—a pseud-idea. Whether that absolute reality which produces in us the consciousness we call Motion, be or be not an eternal mode of the Unknowable, it is impossible for us to say; but that the relative reality which we call Motion never can come into existence, or cease to exist, is a truth involved in the very nature of our consciousness. To think of Motion as either being created or annihilated—to think of nothing becoming something, or something becoming nothing—is to establish in consciousness a relation between two terms of which one is absent from consciousness, which is impossible. The very nature of intelligence, negatives the supposition that Motion can be conceived (much less known) to either commence or cease.
§ 70. It can be noted about Motion, just like it was with Matter, that its indestructibility isn’t just something we can infer; it’s a necessity of thought. The idea that it could be destroyed has never truly been understood; it has always been, as it is now, just a verbal proposition that can't be realized in our awareness—a false idea. Whether the absolute reality that gives us the awareness we call Motion is an eternal aspect of the Unknowable or not is something we can't determine. However, the truth that the relative reality we call Motion can never truly come into being or cease to exist is inherent in the very nature of our consciousness. To think of Motion as either being created or destroyed—to think of nothing turning into something, or something turning into nothing—creates a relation in our mind between two concepts where one is missing from our awareness, which is impossible. The very nature of intelligence makes it impossible to conceive (much less know) that Motion can either begin or end.
§ 71. It remains to be pointed out that the continuity of Motion, as well as the indestructibility of Matter, is really known to us in terms of force. That a certain manifestation of force remains for ever undiminished, is the ultimate content of the thought; whether reached à posteriori or à priori.
§ 71. It should be noted that the continuity of motion, along with the indestructibility of matter, is understood in terms of force. The idea that a specific manifestation of force stays constant is the essential point to grasp, whether it is understood after the fact or a priori.
From terrestrial physics let us take the case of sound propagated to a great distance. Whenever we are directly conscious of the causation of sound (namely, when we produce it ourselves), its invariable antecedent is force. The immediate sequence of this force we know to be motion—first, of our 249own organs, and then of the body which we set vibrating. The vibrations so generated we can discern both through the fingers and through the ears; and that the sensations received by the ears are the equivalents of mechanical force communicated to the air, and by it impressed on surrounding objects, we have clear proof when objects are fractured: as windows by the report of a cannon; or a glass vessel by a powerful voice. On what, then, rests the reasoning when, as occasionally happens under favourable circumstances, men on board a vessel a hundred miles from shore, hear the ringing of church-bells on placing their ears in the focus of the main sail; and when it is inferred that atmospheric undulations have traversed this immense distance? Manifestly, the assertion that the motion of the clapper, transformed into the vibrations of the bell, and communicated to the surrounding air, has propagated itself thus far on all sides, diminishing in intensity as the mass of air moved became greater, is based solely upon a certain change produced in consciousness through the ears. The listeners are not conscious of motion; they are conscious of an impression produced on them—an impression which implies a force as its necessary correlative. With force they begin, and with force they end: the intermediate motion being simply inferred. Again, where, as in celestial physics, the continuity of motion is quantitatively proved, the proof is not direct but inferential; and forces furnish the data for the inference. A particular planet can be identified only by its constant power to affect our visual organs in a special way—to impress upon the retina a group of forces standing in a particular correlation. Further, such planet has not been seen to move by the astronomical observer; but its motion is inferred from a comparison of its present position with the position it before occupied. If rigorously examined, this comparison proves to be a comparison between the different impressions produced on him by the different adjustments of the observing instruments. Going a step further back, it turns out that this difference is meaningless until 250shown to correspond with a certain calculated position which the planet must occupy, supposing that no motion has been lost. And if, finally, we examine the implied calculation, we find that it makes allowances for those accelerations and retardations which ellipticity of the orbit involves, as well as those variations of velocity caused by adjacent planets—we find, that is, that the motion is concluded to be indestructible not from the uniform velocity of the planet, but from the constant quantity of motion exhibited when allowance is made for the motion communicated to, or received from, other celestial bodies. And when we ask how this communicated motion is estimated, we discover that the estimate is based upon certain laws of force; which laws, one and all, embody the postulate that force cannot be destroyed. Without the axiom that action and re-action are equal and opposite, astronomy could not make its exact predictions; and we should lack the rigorous inductive proof they furnish that motion can never be lost, but can only be transferred.
From terrestrial physics, let's consider how sound travels over long distances. Whenever we are aware of the source of sound (like when we make it ourselves), the constant factor is force. The immediate result of this force is motion—first, of our own body parts, and then of the object we set into vibration. We can feel these vibrations with our fingers and hear them with our ears; and we have clear evidence that the sounds we hear through our ears are the result of mechanical force transferred to the air, which then affects nearby objects. For example, objects break, like windows from a cannon blast or a glass container from a loud voice. So, why do we sometimes hear church bells ringing while on a ship a hundred miles away when we tune into the sound by cupping our ears near the mainsail? It’s typically assumed that atmospheric waves have traveled that huge distance. Clearly, the claim is that the movement of the bell's clapper turns into vibrations, which are sent through the air in all directions, weakening as they spread through more air. This idea is based solely on a change in our perception through our ears. The listeners don’t sense the motion itself; they perceive an impression—a sensation that inherently suggests force. It starts with force and concludes with force, while the motion in between is merely assumed. Again, in celestial physics, where continuous motion is quantitatively verified, the proof is not direct but inferred; forces provide the data for this inference. A specific planet can only be identified by its consistent ability to affect our sight—by registering a certain pattern of forces on the retina. Furthermore, this planet has not been directly observed moving by astronomers; instead, its motion is inferred by comparing its current position with where it was previously. When we closely examine this comparison, we realize it reflects different impressions created by various adjustments of the observing instruments. If we dig deeper, we find that this difference is meaningless until it matches a calculated position that the planet is expected to occupy, assuming no motion has been lost. And if we scrutinize the implied calculations, we see they account for the accelerations and slowdowns caused by the ellipses of its orbit, as well as speed changes due to nearby planets. In short, we conclude that the motion is considered indestructible not due to the planet moving at a steady speed, but because of the consistent amount of motion shown when we factor in the motion transferred to or from other celestial bodies. When we ask how this communicated motion is measured, we find the estimate relies on certain laws of force—laws that all include the assumption that force cannot be eliminated. Without the principle that action and reaction are equal and opposite, astronomy wouldn’t be able to make precise predictions; we would miss the strict inductive proof that motion can never be lost but only transferred.
Similarly with the à priori conclusion that Motion is continuous. That which defies suppression in thought, is really the force which the motion indicates. The unceasing change of position, considered by itself, may be mentally abolished without difficulty. We can readily imagine retardation and stoppage to result from the action of external bodies. But to imagine this, is not possible without an abstraction of the force implied by the motion. We are obliged to conceive this force as impressed in the shape of re-action on the bodies that cause the arrest. And the motion that is communicated to them, we are compelled to regard, not as directly communicated, but as a product of the communicated force. We can mentally diminish the velocity or space-element of motion, by diffusing the momentum or force-element over a larger mass of matter; but the quantity of this force-element, which we regard as the cause of the motion, is unchangeable in thought.
Similarly, with the a priori conclusion that motion is continuous. What resists being excluded from our thoughts is really the force indicated by the motion. The constant change of position, when considered alone, can easily be imagined as being removed. We can easily picture that slowing down and stopping could result from the actions of external bodies. However, to envision this cannot be done without separating the force implied by the motion. We must think of this force as being exerted in the form of a reaction on the bodies that cause the stop. And the motion transferred to them must be regarded not as being directly transferred, but as a result of the applied force. We can mentally reduce the speed or distance of motion by spreading the momentum or force across a larger mass of matter; but the amount of this force, which we see as the cause of motion, remains constant in our minds.
CHAPTER VIII.
THE POWER OF FORCE.[12]
§ 72. Before taking a first step in the rational interpretation of Evolution, it is needful to recognize, not only the facts that Matter is indestructible and Motion continuous, but also the fact that Force persists. An attempt to assign the causes of Evolution, would manifestly be absurd, if that agency to which the metamorphosis in general and in detail is due, could either come into existence or cease to exist. The succession of phenomena would in such case be altogether arbitrary; and deductive science impossible.
§ 72. Before making the initial move in understanding Evolution rationally, it's essential to acknowledge not only that Matter is indestructible and Motion is continuous, but also that Force is persistent. Trying to identify the causes of Evolution would clearly be foolish if the agency responsible for the changes, both broadly and specifically, could either come into being or disappear. In that scenario, the sequence of events would be completely random, making deductive science impossible.
Here, indeed, the necessity is even more imperative than in the two preceding cases. For the validity of the proofs given that Matter is indestructible and Motion continuous, really depends upon the validity of the proof that Force is persistent. An analysis of the reasoning demonstrated that in both cases, the à posteriori conclusion involves the assumption that unchanged quantities of Matter and Motion are proved by unchanged manifestations of Force; and in the à priori cognition 252we found this to be the essential constituent. Hence, that the quantity of Force remains always the same, is the fundamental cognition in the absence of which these derivative cognitions must disappear.
Here, the need is even more urgent than in the two previous cases. The validity of the evidence that Matter is indestructible and Motion is continuous really relies on the proof that Force is persistent. An analysis of the reasoning shows that in both instances, the after the fact conclusion assumes that constant amounts of Matter and Motion are demonstrated by constant manifestations of Force; and in the a priori understanding, we found this to be the essential element. Therefore, the idea that the quantity of Force always stays the same is the fundamental understanding without which these derivative understandings must vanish.
§ 73. But now on what grounds do we assert the persistence of Force? Inductively we can allege no evidence except such as is presented to us throughout the world of sensible phenomena. No force however, save that of which we are conscious during our own muscular efforts, is immediately known to us. All other force is mediately known through the changes we attribute to it. Since, then, we cannot infer the persistence of Force from our own sensation of it, which does not persist; we must infer it, if it is inferred at all, from the continuity of Motion, and the undiminished ability of Matter to produce certain effects. But to reason thus is manifestly to reason in a circle. It is absurd to allege the indestructibility of Matter, because we find experimentally that under whatever changes of form a given mass of matter exhibits the same gravitation, and then afterwards to argue that gravitation is constant because a given mass of matter exhibits always the same quantity of it. We cannot prove the continuity of Motion by assuming that Force is persistent, and then prove the persistence of Force by assuming that Motion is continuous.
§ 73. But now, on what basis do we claim that Force persists? Inductively, we have no evidence except what is presented to us through the world of sensory experiences. The only force we directly know is the one we feel during our own physical efforts. All other forces are understood indirectly through the changes we attribute to them. Since we can't infer the persistence of Force from our own sensations, which do not last, we must infer it, if at all, from the continuity of Motion and the consistent ability of Matter to produce certain effects. However, reasoning this way is clearly circular. It's unreasonable to claim that Matter is indestructible simply because we find through experiments that a given mass of matter exhibits the same gravitational force regardless of its changes in form, and then afterwards argue that gravitational force is constant because a given mass of matter always shows the same quantity of it. We can't prove the continuity of Motion by assuming that Force is persistent, and then prove the persistence of Force by assuming that Motion is continuous.
The data of both objective and subjective science being involved in this question touching the nature of our cognition that Force is persistent, it will be desirable here to examine it more closely. At the risk of trying the reader’s patience, we must reconsider the reasoning through which the indestructibility of Matter and the continuity of Motion are established; that we may see how impossible it is to arrive by parallel reasoning at the persistence of Force. In all three cases the question is one of quantity:—does the Matter, or Motion, or Force, ever diminish in quantity? Quantitative science implies measurement; and measurement implies a unit of measure. The units of measure from which all others of any exactness are derived, 253are units of linear extension. From these, through the medium of the equal-armed lever or scales, we derive our equal units of weight, or gravitative force. And it is by means of these equal units of extension and equal units of weight, that we make those quantitative comparisons by which the truths of exact science are reached. Throughout the investigations leading the chemist to the conclusion that of the carbon which has disappeared during combustion, no portion has been lost, and that in any compound afterwards formed by the resulting carbonic acid the whole of the original carbon is present, what is his repeatedly assigned proof? That afforded by the scales. In what terms is the verdict of the scales given? In grains—in units of weight—in units of gravitative force. And what is the total content of the verdict? That as many units of gravitative force as the carbon exhibited at first, it exhibits still. The quantity of matter is asserted to be the same, if the number of units of force it counter-balances is the same. The validity of the inference, then, depends entirely upon the constancy of the units of force. If the force with which the portion of metal called a grain-weight, tends towards the Earth, has varied, the inference that Matter is indestructible is vicious. Everything turns on the truth of the assumption that the gravitation of the weights is persistent; and of this no proof is assigned, or can be assigned. In the reasonings of the astronomer there is a like implication; from which we may draw the like conclusion. No problem in celestial physics can be solved without the assumption of some unit of force. This unit need not be, like a pound or a ton, one of which we can take direct cognizance. It is requisite only that the mutual attraction which some two of the bodies concerned exercise at a given distance, should be taken as one; so that the other attractions with which the problem deals, may be expressed in terms of this one. Such unit being assumed, the momenta which the respective masses will generate in each other in a given time, are calculated; and compounding these with the momenta they already have, their places at the 254end of that time are predicted. The prediction is verified by observation. From this, either of two inferences may be drawn. Assuming the masses to be fixed, the motion may be proved to be undiminished; or assuming the motion to be undiminished, the masses may be proved to be fixed. But the validity of one or other inference, depends wholly on the truth of the assumption that the unit of force is unchanged. Let it be supposed that the gravitation of the two bodies towards each other at the given distance, has varied, and the conclusions drawn are no longer true. Nor is it only in their concrete data that the reasonings of terrestrial and celestial physics assume the persistence of Force. They equally assume it in the abstract principle with which they set out; and which they repeat in justification of every step. The equality of action and reaction is taken for granted from beginning to end of either argument; and to assert that action and reaction are equal and opposite, is to assert that Force is persistent. The allegation really amounts to this, that there cannot be an isolated force beginning and ending in nothing; but that any force manifested, implies an equal antecedent force from which it is derived, and against which it is a reaction. Further, that the force so originating cannot disappear without result; but must expend itself in some other manifestation of force, which, in being produced, becomes its reaction; and so on continually. Clearly then the persistence of Force is an ultimate truth of which no inductive proof is possible.
The data from both objective and subjective science involved in this question about the nature of our cognition that Force is persistent requires a closer look. To avoid testing the reader's patience too much, we need to revisit the reasoning that shows the indestructibility of Matter and the continuity of Motion; this way we can understand how impossible it is to reach the conclusion of the persistence of Force through similar reasoning. In all three cases, the question revolves around quantity: does Matter, Motion, or Force ever decrease in quantity? Quantitative science relies on measurement, and measurement requires a unit of measure. The units of measure from which all other precise units are derived are units of length. From these, using the equal-armed lever or scales, we derive equal units of weight, or gravitational force. It is through these equal units of length and weight that we make the quantitative comparisons necessary to reach the truths of exact science. Throughout the experiments leading a chemist to conclude that none of the carbon lost during combustion has vanished, and that all of the original carbon is present in any compounds formed by the resulting carbonic acid, what proof is repeatedly provided? The answer is found in the scales. In what terms is the scales' conclusion expressed? In grains—in units of weight—in units of gravitational force. And what does this conclusion sum up to? That as many units of gravitational force as the carbon originally showed, it still shows. The quantity of matter is claimed to remain the same, as long as the number of force units it counterbalances is unchanged. Thus, the validity of this conclusion entirely hinges on the constancy of the units of force. If the force with which a metal piece known as a grain-weight is pulled towards the Earth has varied, the conclusion that Matter is indestructible is flawed. Everything relies on the truth of the assumption that the gravitational force of the weights remains constant; and no proof is provided—or can be provided—for this. Similarly, in the reasoning of astronomers, there's an underlying implication from which we can draw a similar conclusion. No problem in celestial physics can be solved without assuming some unit of force. This unit doesn't need to be something tangible like a pound or a ton. It's only necessary that the mutual attraction between two of the bodies involved at a given distance is considered as one unit, so that the other forces dealt with in the problem can be expressed in relation to this one. Once this unit is established, the momentum generated between the respective masses in a given time is calculated, and by adding this to their existing momentum, their positions at the end of that time are predicted. This prediction is checked by observation. From this, we can make one of two inferences. Assuming the masses are constant, we can prove that the motion remains unchanged; or, assuming the motion is unchanged, we can prove that the masses are constant. But the validity of either inference completely relies on the assumption that the unit of force has not changed. Let’s say the gravitational force between the two bodies at that given distance has varied, and then the conclusions drawn are no longer accurate. Furthermore, it's not just the concrete data that the reasoning in earthbound and celestial physics assumes the persistence of Force. They equally assume it in the abstract principles on which they begin and justify every step. The equality of action and reaction is taken for granted throughout either argument; and to state that action and reaction are equal and opposite is to say that Force is persistent. Essentially, this means that there can't be a force that starts and ends with nothing; but any manifested force implies an equal prior force from which it originates and against which it reacts. Moreover, that the force originating in this way cannot just vanish without consequences; it must manifest in some other expression of force, which, when produced, becomes its reaction, and this continues indefinitely. Clearly, then, the persistence of Force is a fundamental truth that cannot be proven through induction.
We might indeed be certain, even in the absence of any such analysis as the foregoing, that there must exist some principle which, as being the basis of science, cannot be established by science. All reasoned-out conclusions whatever, must rest on some postulate. As before shown (§ 23), we cannot go on merging derivative truths in those wider and wider truths from which they are derived, without reaching at last a widest truth which can be merged in no other, or derived from no other. And whoever contemplates the relation in which it stands to the truths of science in general, will 255see that this truth transcending demonstration is the persistence of Force.
We can be confident, even without the analysis mentioned earlier, that there must be some principle that serves as the foundation of science, which cannot be defined by science itself. Every reasoned conclusion has to be based on some fundamental assumption. As previously indicated (§ 23), we can't keep combining derived truths into larger and larger truths without ultimately arriving at a fundamental truth that cannot be combined or derived from anything else. Anyone who reflects on its relationship to scientific truths in general will see that this truth, which goes beyond demonstration, is the persistence of Force.
§ 74. But now what is the force of which we predicate persistence? It is not the force we are immediately conscious of in our own muscular efforts; for this does not persist. As soon as an outstretched limb is relaxed, the sense of tension disappears. True, we assert that in the stone thrown or in the weight lifted, is exhibited the effect of this muscular tension; and that the force which has ceased to be present in our consciousness, exists elsewhere. But it does not exist elsewhere under any form cognizable by us. It was proved (§ 18), that though, on raising an object from the ground, we are obliged to think of its downward pull as equal and opposite to our upward pull; and though it is impossible to represent these pulls as equal without representing them as like in kind; yet, since their likeness in kind would imply in the object a sensation of muscular tension, which cannot be ascribed to it, we are compelled to admit that force as it exists out of our consciousness, is not force as we know it. Hence the force of which we assert persistence is that Absolute Force of which we are indefinitely conscious as the necessary correlate of the force we know. Thus, by the persistence of Force, we really mean the persistence of some Power which transcends our knowledge and conception. The manifestations, as occurring either in ourselves or outside of us, do not persist; but that which persists is the Unknown Cause of these manifestations. In other words, asserting the persistence of Force, is but another mode of asserting an Unconditioned Reality, without beginning or end.
§ 74. So what do we mean when we talk about persistence? It’s not about the force we feel in our muscles while exerting effort; that feeling doesn’t last. As soon as we relax an extended limb, the tension disappears. We claim that the stone thrown or the weight lifted shows the impact of that muscular tension, and that the force that’s no longer in our consciousness exists somewhere else. But it doesn't exist anywhere we can perceive in any recognizable form. It was established (§ 18) that when we lift an object from the ground, we have to think of its downward force as equal and opposite to our upward force. Even though we can't visualize these forces as equal without thinking of them as similar, their similarity would suggest that the object feels muscular tension, which we can't assign to it. So we must accept that force, as it exists outside our awareness, is not the same as the force we understand. Therefore, when we talk about the persistence of Force, we’re really referring to that Absolute Force, which we are vaguely aware of as a necessary counterpart to the force we experience. Thus, when we talk about the persistence of Force, we actually mean the persistence of some Power that goes beyond our knowledge and understanding. The occurrences, whether within ourselves or outside, do not last; but what does persist is the Unknown Cause of these occurrences. In simpler terms, asserting the persistence of Force is just another way of asserting an Unconditioned Reality that has no beginning or end.
Thus, quite unexpectedly, we come down once more to that ultimate truth in which, as we saw, Religion and Science coalesce. On examining the data underlying a rational theory of Evolution, we find them all at last resolvable into that datum without which consciousness was shown to be impossible—the continued existence of an Unknowable 256as the necessary correlative of the Knowable. Once commenced, the analysis of the truths taken for granted in scientific inquiries, inevitably brings us down to this deepest truth, in which Common Sense and Philosophy are reconciled.
Thus, quite unexpectedly, we once again arrive at that ultimate truth where, as we observed, Religion and Science merge. When we examine the data supporting a logical theory of Evolution, we find that they ultimately break down into that fundamental fact without which consciousness was shown to be impossible—the ongoing existence of an Unknowable as the essential counterpart of the Knowable. Once we begin analyzing the truths assumed in scientific investigations, we inevitably come back to this deepest truth, where Common Sense and Philosophy are aligned. 256
The arguments and conclusion contained in this and the foregoing three chapters, supply, indeed, the complement to the arguments and conclusion set forth in the preceding part of this work. It was there first shown, by an examination of our ultimate religious ideas, that knowledge of Absolute Being is impossible; and the impossibility of knowing Absolute Being, was also shown by an examination of our ultimate scientific ideas. In a succeeding chapter a subjective analysis proved, that while, by the very conditions of thought, we are prevented from knowing anything beyond relative being; yet that by these very same conditions of thought, an indefinite consciousness of Absolute Being is necessitated. And here, by objective analysis, we similarly find that the axiomatic truths of physical science, unavoidably postulate Absolute Being as their common basis.
The arguments and conclusion presented in this chapter and the three before it provide a necessary complement to the arguments and conclusion outlined in the earlier part of this work. It was first demonstrated there, through an examination of our ultimate religious ideas, that knowing Absolute Being is impossible; the impossibility of understanding Absolute Being was also shown through our ultimate scientific ideas. In a later chapter, a subjective analysis proved that, due to the very nature of thought, we are unable to know anything beyond relative being. However, these same conditions of thought also necessitate an indefinite awareness of Absolute Being. Here, through objective analysis, we similarly find that the fundamental truths of physical science inevitably rely on Absolute Being as their common foundation.
Thus there is even a more profound agreement between Religion and Science than was before shown. Not only are they wholly at one on the negative proposition that the Non-relative cannot be known; but they are wholly at one on the positive proposition that the Non-relative is an actual existence. Both are obliged by the demonstrated untenability of their supposed cognitions, to confess that the Ultimate Reality is incognizable; and yet both are obliged to assert the existence of an Ultimate Reality. Without this, Religion has no subject-matter; and without this, Science, subjective and objective, lacks its indispensable datum. We cannot construct a theory of internal phenomena without postulating Absolute Being; and unless we postulate Absolute Being, or being which persists, we cannot construct a theory of external phenomena.
Thus there is an even deeper agreement between Religion and Science than was previously shown. Not only do they completely agree on the negative idea that the Non-relative cannot be known; but they also completely agree on the positive idea that the Non-relative is a real existence. Both are forced by the obvious flaws in their assumed understandings to admit that Ultimate Reality cannot be known; and yet both are compelled to affirm the existence of an Ultimate Reality. Without this, Religion has no subject matter; and without this, Science—both subjective and objective—lacks its essential basis. We cannot create a theory of internal phenomena without assuming Absolute Being; and unless we assume Absolute Being, or a being that endures, we cannot create a theory of external phenomena.
§ 75. A few words must be added respecting the nature 257of this fundamental consciousness. Already it has been looked at from several points of view; and here it seems needful finally to sum up the results.
§ 75. A few words should be added about the nature 257 of this fundamental awareness. It has already been examined from various perspectives, and here it seems necessary to summarize the findings.
In Chapter IV. we saw that the Unknown Power of which neither beginning nor end can be conceived, is present to us as that unshaped material of consciousness which is shaped afresh in every thought. Our inability to conceive its limitation, is thus simply the obverse of our inability to put an end to the thinking subject while still continuing to think. In the two foregoing chapters, we contemplated this fundamental truth under another aspect. The indestructibility of Matter and the continuity of Motion, we saw to be really corollaries from the impossibility of establishing in thought a relation between something and nothing. What we call the establishment of a relation in thought, is the passage of the substance of consciousness, from one form into another. To think of something becoming nothing, would involve that this substance of consciousness having just existed under a given form, should next assume no form; or should cease to be consciousness. And thus our inability to conceive Matter and Motion destroyed, is our inability to suppress consciousness itself. What, in these two foregoing chapters, was proved true of Matter and Motion, is, à fortiori, true of the Force out of which our conceptions of Matter and Motion are built. Indeed, as we saw, that which is indestructible in matter and motion, is the force they present. And, as we here see, the truth that Force is indestructible, is the obverse of the truth that the Unknown Cause of the changes going on in consciousness is indestructible. So that the persistence of consciousness, constitutes at once our immediate experience of the persistence of Force, and imposes on us the necessity we are under of asserting its persistence.
In Chapter IV, we observed that the Unknown Power, which has no beginning or end that we can grasp, appears to us as the unformed material of consciousness that gets reshaped with every thought. Our difficulty in understanding its limits is simply the consequence of our inability to stop being the thinking subject while still continuing to think. In the previous two chapters, we looked at this fundamental truth from a different angle. We found that the indestructibility of Matter and the continuity of Motion are really linked to the impossibility of establishing any relationship in thought between something and nothing. What we refer to as forming a relationship in thought is the transition of consciousness from one form to another. To imagine something turning into nothing would mean that this substance of consciousness, which just existed in a certain form, would next have no form or would stop being consciousness altogether. Thus, our inability to imagine Matter and Motion being destroyed reflects our inability to eliminate consciousness itself. What was proven true for Matter and Motion in those earlier chapters is, even more so, true for the Force from which our ideas of Matter and Motion are formed. In fact, as we saw, the indestructible aspect of matter and motion is the force they exhibit. And, as we see here, the truth that Force is indestructible corresponds with the truth that the Unknown Cause of the changes occurring in consciousness is also indestructible. Therefore, the persistence of consciousness simultaneously gives us our direct experience of the persistence of Force and requires us to affirm its persistence.
§ 76. Thus, in all ways there is forced on us the fact, that here is an ultimate truth given in our mental constitution. It is not only a datum of science, but it is a datum which even 258the assertion of our nescience involves. Whoever alleges that the inability to conceive a beginning or end of the Universe, is a negative result of our mental structure, cannot deny that our consciousness of the Universe as persistent, is a positive result of our mental structure. And this persistence of the Universe, is the persistence of that Unknown Cause, Power, or Force, which is manifested to us through all phenomena.
§ 76. Therefore, in every way, we are confronted with the fact that there is an ultimate truth inherent in our mental makeup. This is not only a fact of science, but it's a fact that the claim of our ignorance also implies. Anyone who argues that our inability to grasp the beginning or end of the Universe is a negative result of our mental structure cannot deny that our awareness of the Universe as enduring is a positive result of that same mental structure. This persistence of the Universe reflects the persistence of that Unknown Cause, Power, or Force that is revealed to us through all phenomena.
Such then is the foundation of any possible system of positive knowledge. Deeper than demonstration—deeper even than definite cognition—deep as the very nature of mind, is the postulate at which we have arrived. Its authority transcends all other whatever; for not only is it given in the constitution of our own consciousness, but it is impossible to imagine a consciousness so constituted as not to give it. Thought, involving simply the establishment of relations, may be readily conceived to go on while yet these relations have not been organized into the abstracts we call Space and Time; and so there is a conceivable kind of consciousness which does not contain the truths, commonly called à priori, involved in the organization of these forms of relations. But thought cannot be conceived to go on without some element between which its relations may be established; and so there is no conceivable kind of consciousness which does not imply continued existence as its datum. Consciousness without this or that particular form is possible; but consciousness without contents is impossible.
This is the foundation of any possible system of positive knowledge. Deeper than demonstration—deeper even than definite understanding—deep as the very essence of the mind, is the assumption we have reached. Its authority surpasses all others; not only is it rooted in the nature of our consciousness, but it’s impossible to imagine a consciousness that doesn't recognize it. Thought, which simply involves establishing relationships, can easily be imagined to occur even before these relationships are organized into the concepts we call Space and Time. Therefore, there’s a type of consciousness that doesn’t contain the truths commonly referred to as a priori, which are involved in organizing these forms of relationships. However, thought cannot be conceived without some element between which its relationships can be established; thus, there is no imaginable type of consciousness that doesn’t imply continued existence as its basis. Consciousness without this or that specific form is possible; but consciousness without contents is impossible.
The sole truth which transcends experience by underlying it, is thus the persistence of Force. This being the basis of experience, must be the basis of any scientific organization of experiences. To this an ultimate analysis brings us down; and on this a rational synthesis must build up.
The only truth that goes beyond experience by supporting it is the ongoing presence of Force. Since this is the foundation of experience, it must also be the foundation of any scientific organization of experiences. An ultimate analysis leads us to this point, and a rational synthesis has to build upon it.
12. Some two years ago, I expressed to my friend Professor Huxley, my dissatisfaction with the current expression—“Conservation of Force;” assigning as reasons, first, that the word “conservation” implies a conserver and an act of conserving; and, second, that it does not imply the existence of the force before that particular manifestation of it with which we commence. In place of “conservation,” Professor Huxley suggested persistence. This entirely meets the first of the two objections; and though the second may be urged against it, no other word less faulty in this respect can be found. In the absence of a word specially coined for the purpose, it seems the best; and as such I adopt it.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.About two years ago, I shared my dissatisfaction with the term “Conservation of Force” with my friend Professor Huxley. I explained that, first, the word “conservation” suggests the presence of a conserver and an act of conserving; and, second, it doesn’t indicate that the force existed before the specific manifestation we’re talking about. In response, Professor Huxley proposed using persistence. This suggestion addresses my first objection, and while my second point could still be raised against it, I can’t find another term that works better in this regard. Without a term specifically created for this purpose, it seems to be the best option available, and I’m going to use it.
CHAPTER IX.
THE RELATIONSHIP AND EQUALITY OF FORCES.
§ 77. When, to the unaided senses, Science began to add supplementary senses in the shape of measuring instruments, men began to perceive various phenomena which eyes and fingers could not distinguish. Of known forms of force, minuter manifestations became appreciable; and forms of force before unknown were rendered cognizable and measurable. Where forces had apparently ended in nothing, and had been carelessly supposed to have actually done so, instrumental observation proved that effects had in every instance been produced: the forces reappearing in new shapes. Hence there has at length arisen the inquiry whether the force displayed in each surrounding change, does not in the act of expenditure undergo metamorphosis into an equivalent amount of some other force or forces. And to this inquiry experiment is giving an affirmative answer, which becomes day by day more decisive. Grove, Helmholtz, and Meyer, are more than any others to be credited with the clear enunciation of this doctrine. Let us glance at the evidence on which it rests.
§ 77. When science started using measuring instruments to enhance our basic senses, people began to notice various phenomena that our eyes and fingers couldn't distinguish. We became able to perceive smaller manifestations of known forms of force, and previously unknown forms of force became recognizable and measurable. Where forces seemed to have no effect and were thought to have completely dissipated, instrumental observation showed that effects were produced in every case: the forces appeared again in new forms. This has led to the question of whether the force displayed in every change around us transforms into an equivalent amount of other forces when it's used. Experimentation is increasingly confirming this inquiry with more decisive evidence each day. Grove, Helmholtz, and Meyer are particularly credited for clearly stating this idea. Let’s take a look at the evidence supporting it.
Motion, wherever we can directly trace its genesis, we find to pre-exist as some other mode of force. Our own voluntary acts have always certain sensations of muscular tension as their antecedents. When, as in letting fall a relaxed limb, we are conscious of a bodily movement requiring no effort, the explanation is that the effort was exerted in 260raising the limb to the position whence it fell. In this case, as in the case of an inanimate body descending to the Earth, the force accumulated by the downward motion is just equal to the force previously expended in the act of elevation. Conversely, Motion that is arrested produces, under different circumstances, heat, electricity, magnetism, light. From the warming of the hands by rubbing them together, up to the ignition of a railway-brake by intense friction—from the lighting of detonating powder by percussion, up to the setting on fire a block of wood by a few blows from a steam-hammer; we have abundant instances in which heat arises as Motion ceases. It is uniformly found, that the heat generated is great in proportion as the Motion lost is great; and that to diminish the arrest of motion, by diminishing the friction, is to diminish the quantity of heat evolved. The production of electricity by Motion is illustrated equally in the boy’s experiment with rubbed sealing-wax, in the common electrical machine, and in the apparatus for exciting electricity by the escape of steam. Wherever there is friction between heterogeneous bodies, electrical disturbance is one of the consequences. Magnetism may result from Motion either immediately, as through percussion on iron, or mediately as through electric currents previously generated by Motion. And similarly, Motion may create light; either directly, as in the minute incandescent fragments struck off by violent collisions, or indirectly, as through the electric spark. “Lastly, Motion may be again reproduced by the forces which have emanated from Motion; thus, the divergence of the electrometer, the revolution of the electrical wheel, the deflection of the magnetic needle, are, when resulting from frictional electricity, palpable movements reproduced by the intermediate modes of force, which have themselves been originated by motion.”
Motion, whenever we can trace its origin, seems to always come from another kind of force. Our voluntary actions always involve certain sensations of muscular tension beforehand. For instance, when we let a relaxed limb fall, we notice that this movement requires no effort because the effort was already used to raise the limb to the position from which it fell. In this case, as well as when an inanimate object falls to the ground, the force gained by the downward motion is equal to the force that was used to lift it. Additionally, when Motion stops, it produces heat, electricity, magnetism, and light, depending on the circumstances. For example, from warming our hands by rubbing them together to igniting a railway brake from intense friction—from igniting gunpowder by percussion to setting a block of wood on fire with a few blows from a steam hammer—we have plenty of examples where heat is generated when Motion ceases. It’s consistently found that the heat produced is greater when the loss of Motion is significant, and that reducing the halt of motion by decreasing friction results in less heat produced. The generation of electricity from Motion can be demonstrated in a boy’s experiment with rubbed sealing-wax, in common electrical machines, and in devices that create electricity from steam. Whenever there’s friction between different materials, electrical disturbances are one of the outcomes. Magnetism can arise from Motion either directly, like when iron is struck, or indirectly, through electric currents generated by Motion. Similarly, Motion can produce light, either directly, such as in small incandescent particles produced by violent impacts, or indirectly, through an electric spark. Finally, Motion can be recreated by the forces that came from Motion; for example, the movement of an electrometer, the spinning of an electrical wheel, and the deflection of a magnetic needle are all observable movements produced by the electricity generated from friction, which itself originated from motion.
That mode of force which we distinguish as Heat, is now generally regarded by physicists as molecular motion—not motion as displayed in the changed relations of sensible 261masses to each other, but as occurring among the units of which such sensible masses consist. If we cease to think of Heat as that particular sensation given to us by bodies in certain conditions, and consider the phenomena otherwise presented by these bodies, we find that motion, either in them or in surrounding bodies, or in both, is all that we have evidence of. With one or two exceptions which are obstacles to every theory of Heat, heated bodies expand; and expansion can be interpreted only as a movement of the units of a mass in relation to each other. That so-called radiation through which anything of higher temperature than things around it, communicates Heat to them, is clearly a species of motion. Moreover, the evidence afforded by the thermometer that Heat thus diffuses itself, is simply a movement caused in the mercurial column. And that the molecular motion which we call Heat, may be transformed into visible motion, familiar proof is given by the steam-engine; in which “the piston and all its concomitant masses of matter are moved by the molecular dilatation of the vapour of water.” Where Heat is absorbed without apparent result, modern inquiries show that decided though unobtrusive changes are produced: as on glass, the molecular state of which is so far changed by heat, that a polarized ray of light passing through it becomes visible, which it does not do when the glass is cold; or as on polished metallic surfaces, which are so far changed in structure by thermal radiations from objects very close to them, as to retain permanent impressions of such objects. The transformation of Heat into electricity, occurs when dissimilar metals touching each other are heated at the point of contact: electric currents being so induced. Solid, incombustible matter introduced into heated gas, as lime into the oxyhydrogen flame, becomes incandescent; and so exhibits the conversion of Heat into light. The production of magnetism by Heat, if it cannot be proved to take place directly, may be proved to take place indirectly through the medium of electricity. And through the same 262medium may be established the correlation of Heat and chemical affinity—a correlation which is indeed implied by the marked influence that Heat exercises on chemical composition and decomposition.
The way we understand heat today is largely framed by physicists as molecular motion—not just the movement seen in how larger objects relate to one another, but the activity happening among the tiny units that make up those objects. If we shift our perspective and stop viewing heat merely as a sensation we get from certain physical conditions, we realize that the only clear evidence we have is of motion, whether in the objects themselves, in their environment, or in both. With one or two exceptions that challenge every heat theory, heated objects expand, and this expansion can only be understood as the movement of the individual units within a mass relative to each other. That so-called radiation where something hotter than its surroundings transfers heat to them is clearly a form of motion. Furthermore, the thermometer shows that heat spreads by causing movement in the mercury column. We see that the molecular motion we call heat can turn into visible motion, as clearly illustrated by the steam engine, where “the piston and all accompanying masses of matter are moved by the molecular expansion of water vapor.” Where heat is absorbed without visible effects, recent studies have found that subtle yet significant changes occur: for example, glass changes at a molecular level when heated, causing a polarized ray of light passing through it to become visible, which it doesn't do when cold; or polished metal surfaces change structurally due to thermal radiation from nearby hot objects, allowing them to retain impressions of those objects. Heat can be transformed into electricity when different metals in contact are heated at their junction, generating electric currents. Solid, non-flammable materials that are placed in heated gas, like lime in the oxyhydrogen flame, become incandescent, demonstrating the conversion of heat into light. The creation of magnetism from heat, while it may not be directly proven, can be shown to happen indirectly through electricity. Additionally, the relationship between heat and chemical affinity can also be established through electricity, which is suggested by the notable impact heat has on chemical reactions, both composition and decomposition.
The transformations of Electricity into other modes of force, are still more clearly demonstrable. Produced by the motion of heterogeneous bodies in contact, Electricity, through attractions and repulsions, will immediately reproduce motion in neighbouring bodies. Now a current of Electricity generates magnetism in a bar of soft iron; and now the rotation of a permanent magnet generates currents of Electricity. Here we have a battery in which from the play of chemical affinities an electric current results; and there, in the adjacent cell, we have an electric current effecting chemical decomposition. In the conducting wire we witness the transformation of Electricity into heat; while in electric sparks and in the voltaic arc we see light produced. Atomic arrangement, too, is changed by Electricity: as instance the transfer of matter from pole to pole of a battery; the fractures caused by the disruptive discharge; the formation of crystals under the influence of electric currents. And whether, conversely, Electricity be or be not directly generated by re-arrangement of the atoms of matter, it is at any rate indirectly so generated through the intermediation of magnetism.
The transformations of electricity into other forms of energy are even more clearly observable. Electricity is produced by the motion of different bodies in contact, and through attractions and repulsions, it can immediately create motion in nearby objects. Now, a current of electricity generates magnetism in a piece of soft iron, and the rotation of a permanent magnet generates electric currents. Here, we have a battery where the interaction of chemical affinities creates an electric current, and there, in the adjacent cell, an electric current causes chemical decomposition. In the conducting wire, we see electricity transformed into heat, while electric sparks and the voltaic arc produce light. The arrangement of atoms is also altered by electricity; for example, the transfer of matter from one pole to another in a battery, the fractures caused by disruptive discharges, and the formation of crystals under the influence of electric currents. Whether electricity is directly generated by rearranging the atoms of matter or not, it is at least indirectly generated through the interaction with magnetism.
How from Magnetism the other physical forces result, must be next briefly noted—briefly, because in each successive case the illustrations become in great part the obverse forms of those before given. That Magnetism produces motion is the ordinary evidence we have of its existence. In the magneto-electric machine we see a rotating magnet evolving electricity. And the electricity so evolved may immediately after exhibit itself as heat, light, or chemical affinity. Faraday’s discovery of the effect of Magnetism on polarized light, as well as the discovery that change of magnetic state is accompanied by heat, point to further like connexions. 263Lastly, various experiments show that the magnetization of a body alters its internal structure; and that conversely, the alteration of its internal structure, as by mechanical strain, alters its magnetic condition.
How magnetism leads to other physical forces should be briefly mentioned—briefly, because in each case, the examples largely reflect those given before. The typical proof of magnetism's existence is its ability to produce motion. In the magneto-electric machine, we see a rotating magnet generating electricity. This electricity can then immediately appear as heat, light, or a chemical reaction. Faraday's discovery of magnetism's effect on polarized light, as well as the finding that a change in magnetic state is linked to heat, suggests further connections. Lastly, various experiments demonstrate that magnetizing an object changes its internal structure, and conversely, changing its internal structure, such as through mechanical stress, affects its magnetic state. 263
Improbable as it seemed, it is now proved that from Light also may proceed the like variety of agencies. The solar rays change the atomic arrangements of particular crystals. Certain mixed gases, which do not otherwise combine, combine in the sunshine. In some compounds Light produces decomposition. Since the inquiries of photographers have drawn attention to the subject, it has been shown that “a vast number of substances, both elementary and compound, are notably affected by this agent, even those apparently the most unalterable in character, such as metals.” And when a daguerreotype plate is connected with a proper apparatus “we get chemical action on the plate, electricity circulating through the wires, magnetism in the coil, heat in the helix, and motion in the needles.”
Improbable as it seemed, it is now proven that light can also produce a similar variety of effects. The sun's rays alter the atomic structures of certain crystals. Some mixed gases, which don’t normally blend, react when exposed to sunlight. In some compounds, light causes breakdown. Since photographers have started investigating this topic, it has been demonstrated that “a vast number of substances, both elemental and compound, are significantly influenced by this agent, even those that seem the most stable in nature, like metals.” And when a daguerreotype plate is connected to the right equipment, “we observe chemical activity on the plate, electricity flowing through the wires, magnetism in the coil, heat in the helix, and movement in the needles.”
The genesis of all other modes of force from Chemical Action, scarcely needs pointing out. The ordinary accompaniment of chemical combination is heat; and when the affinities are intense, light also is, under fit conditions, produced. Chemical changes involving alteration of bulk, cause motion, both in the combining elements and in adjacent masses of matter: witness the propulsion of a bullet by the explosion of gunpowder. In the galvanic battery we see electricity resulting from chemical composition and decomposition. While through the medium of this electricity, Chemical Action produces magnetism.
The origin of all other forms of force from chemical action is pretty clear. When chemicals combine, heat is usually produced; and if the reactions are strong enough, light can also be generated under the right conditions. Chemical changes that affect the volume of substances cause movement in both the elements that are combining and in nearby masses of matter; for example, the way a bullet is propelled by the explosion of gunpowder. In a galvanic battery, we observe electricity being generated from chemical composition and decomposition. Through this electricity, chemical action creates magnetism.
These facts, the larger part of which are culled from Mr. Grove’s work on “The Correlation of Physical Forces,” show us that each force is transformable, directly or indirectly, into the others. In every change Force undergoes metamorphosis; and from the new form or forms it assumes, may subsequently result either the previous one or any of the rest, in endless variety of order and combination. It is 264further becoming manifest that the physical forces stand not simply in qualitative correlations with each other, but also in quantitative correlations. Besides proving that one mode of force may be transformed into another mode, experiments illustrate the truth that from a definite amount of one, definite amounts of others always arise. Ordinarily it is indeed difficult to show this; since it mostly happens that the transformation of any force is not into some one of the rest but into several of them: the proportions being determined by the ever-varying conditions. But in certain cases, positive results have been reached. Mr. Joule has ascertained that the fall of 772 lbs. through one foot, will raise the temperature of a pound of water one degree of Fahrenheit. The investigations of Dulong, Petit and Neumann, have proved a relation in amount between the affinities of combining bodies and the heat evolved during their combination. Between chemical action and voltaic electricity, a quantitative connexion has also been established: Faraday’s experiments implying that a specific measure of electricity is disengaged by a given measure of chemical action. The well-determined relations between the quantities of heat generated and water turned into steam, or still better the known expansion produced in steam by each additional degree of heat, may be cited in further evidence. Whence it is no longer doubted that among the several forms which force assumes, the quantitative relations are fixed. The conclusion tacitly agreed on by physicists, is, not only that the physical forces undergo metamorphoses, but that a certain amount of each is the constant equivalent of certain amounts of the others.
These facts, most of which are taken from Mr. Grove’s work on “The Correlation of Physical Forces,” show us that each force can be transformed, either directly or indirectly, into the others. In every change, Force undergoes a transformation; and from the new form or forms it takes on, the original form or any other can emerge in countless variations of order and combination. It is 264becoming increasingly clear that physical forces are related not just qualitatively, but also quantitatively. In addition to demonstrating that one type of force can be transformed into another, experiments show that a specific amount of one type results in specific amounts of others. Usually, it’s difficult to demonstrate this clearly, as transformations typically occur into several types rather than just one, with the proportions determined by constantly changing conditions. However, in certain instances, definitive results have been achieved. Mr. Joule discovered that a weight of 772 lbs. falling one foot will raise the temperature of one pound of water by one degree Fahrenheit. Research by Dulong, Petit, and Neumann has established a relationship between the affinities of combined substances and the heat generated during their combination. Moreover, a quantitative relationship has also been identified between chemical reactions and voltaic electricity: Faraday’s experiments suggest that a specific amount of electricity is produced by a given amount of chemical reaction. The well-defined relationships between the amounts of heat produced and the quantity of water converted into steam, or even more, the known expansion that occurs in steam with each additional degree of heat, serve as further evidence. Therefore, it's now widely accepted that among the various forms force can take, the quantitative relationships are stable. The conclusion that physicists generally agree on is that not only do physical forces transform, but a certain quantity of each is the consistent equivalent of particular quantities of the others.
§ 78. Throughout Evolution under all its phases, this truth of course invariably holds. Every successive change or group of changes forming part of it, is of necessity limited by the conditions thus implied. The forces which any step in Evolution exhibits, must be affiliable on the like or unlike forces previously existing; while from the forces so generated 265must thereafter be derived others more or less transformed. And besides recognizing the forces at any time existing, as necessarily linked with those preceding and succeeding them, we must also recognize the amounts of these forces successively manifested as determinate,—as necessarily producing such and such quantities of results, and as necessarily limited to those quantities.
§ 78. Throughout Evolution in all its forms, this truth always applies. Every change or group of changes involved is necessarily bound by the conditions implied. The forces shown in any step of Evolution must be related to the similar or different forces that existed before; and from the forces created, others that are somewhat transformed must be derived. Additionally, while acknowledging the forces at any given time as connected to those that came before and those that will come after, we must also recognize the amounts of these forces that appear as fixed—definitely producing specific quantities of results and being limited to those quantities.
Involved as are the phenomena of Evolution, it is not to be expected that a definite quantitative relation can in each case, or indeed in any case, be shown between the forces expended in successive phases. We have not adequate data for this; and probably shall never have them. The antecedents of the simpler forms of Evolution, belong to a remote past respecting which we can have nothing but inferential knowledge; while the antecedents of the only kind of Evolution which is traceable from beginning to end (namely, that of individual organisms) are too complex to be dealt with by exact methods. Hence we cannot hope to establish equivalence among the successive manifestations of force which each order of Evolution affords. The most we can hope is to establish a qualitative correlation that is indefinitely quantitative—quantitative in so far as involving something like a due proportion between causes and effects. If this can be done, however, some progress will be made towards the solution of our problem. Though it may be beyond our power to show a measurable relation between the force or group of forces which any phase of Evolution displays, and the force or group of forces immediately succeeding it; yet if we can show that there always are antecedent forces, and that the effects they produce always become the antecedents of further ones—if while unable to calculate how much of each change will be produced, we can prove that a change of that kind was necessitated—if we can discern even the vaguest correspondence between the amount of such change and the amount of the pre-existing force; we shall advance a step towards interpreting the transformation of the simple into the complex.
The phenomena of evolution are so intricate that we can't expect to find a clear quantitative relationship between the forces used in different phases, or even in any specific case. We simply don't have enough data for this, and we likely never will. The origins of simpler forms of evolution belong to a distant past where we can only have inferential knowledge; meanwhile, the origins of the only type of evolution we can trace from start to finish (that of individual organisms) are too complex to analyze using exact methods. Therefore, we can't expect to establish an equivalence among the different expressions of force that each order of evolution presents. The best we can achieve is a qualitative correlation that's indefinitely quantitative—meaning it's quantitative insofar as it suggests some kind of appropriate proportion between causes and effects. If we can achieve this, it will help us make progress on our problem. While we may not be able to show a measurable relationship between the forces at any phase of evolution and the forces that follow, if we can demonstrate that there are always preceding forces and that the effects they create become the groundwork for further forces—if we can prove that a change of this kind is necessary, even without calculating how much change will occur—we'll take a step closer to understanding how the simple transforms into the complex.
266With the view of attempting this, let us now reconsider the different types of Evolution awhile since delineated: taking them in the same order as before.
266To try this out, let’s take another look at the different types of Evolution we outlined earlier, following the same order as before.
§ 79. On contemplating our Solar System the first fact which strikes us, is, that all its members are in motion; and that their motion is of a two-fold, or rather of a three-fold, kind. Each planet and satellite has a movement of rotation and a movement of translation; besides the movement through space which all have in common with their rotating primary. Whence this unceasing change of place?
§ 79. When we look at our Solar System, the first thing that stands out is that all its members are in motion, and their motion is two-fold, or more accurately, three-fold. Each planet and moon has a rotation movement and a translation movement, in addition to the movement through space that they all share with their rotating primary. Where does this constant change of position come from?
The hypothesis of Evolution supplies us with an answer. Impossible as it is to assign a reason for the pre-existence of matter in the diffused form supposed; yet assuming its pre-existence in that form, we have in the gravitation of its parts a cause of motion adequate to the results. So far too as the evidence carries us, we can perceive some quantitative relation between the motions produced, and the gravitative forces expended in producing them. The planets formed from that matter which has travelled the shortest distance towards the common centre of gravity, have the smallest velocities: the uniform law being that in advancing from the outermost to the innermost planets, the rate of orbital motion progressively increases. It may indeed be remarked that this is explicable on the teleological hypothesis; since it is a condition to equilibrium. But without dwelling on the fact that this is beside the question, it will suffice to point out that the like cannot be said of the planetary rotations. No such final cause can be assigned for the rapid axial movement of Jupiter and Saturn, or the slow axial movement of Mercury. But if in pursuance of the doctrine of correlation we look for the antecedents of these gyrations which all planets exhibit, the theory of Evolution furnishes us with equivalent ones; and ones which bear manifest quantitative relations to the motions displayed. For the planets that turn on their axes with extreme rapidity, are those having great masses and large 267orbits—those, that is, of which the once diffused elements moved to their centres of gravity through immense spaces, and so acquired high velocities. While, conversely, there has resulted the smallest axial movement where the orbit and the mass are both the smallest.
The theory of Evolution gives us an answer. While it's impossible to define a reason for the existence of matter in the supposed spread-out form, if we assume it did exist that way, the gravitational pull of its parts provides a sufficient cause for motion. From the evidence we have, we can see some quantitative relationship between the motions produced and the gravitational forces used to create them. The planets formed from the matter that traveled the least distance toward the common center of gravity have the slowest velocities: the consistent pattern is that as we move from the outermost to the innermost planets, the speed of their orbital motion increases. It can be noted that this can be explained by the teleological hypothesis since it contributes to equilibrium. However, without focusing on the fact that this is off-topic, it’s enough to highlight that the same cannot be said for the rotations of the planets. No such final cause can be identified for the fast spinning of Jupiter and Saturn, or the slow spin of Mercury. But if we follow the idea of correlation and seek the origins of these rotations that all planets show, the theory of Evolution provides us with relevant ones that clearly relate to the motions observed. For the planets that spin on their axes very quickly are those with large masses and wide orbits—those whose dispersed elements traveled to their centers of gravity across vast distances and thus gained high speeds. Conversely, the slowest axial movement occurs where both the orbit and the mass are the smallest.
“But what,” it may be asked, “has in such case become of all that motion which brought about the aggregation of this diffused matter into solid bodies?” The rotation of each body can be but a residuary result of concentration—a result due to the imperfect balancing of gravitative movements from opposite points towards the common centre. Such gravitative movements from opposite points must in great measure destroy each other. What then has become of these mutually-destroyed motions? The answer which the doctrine of correlation suggests is—they must have been radiated in the form of heat and light. And this answer the evidence, so far as it goes, confirms. Apart from any speculation respecting the genesis of the solar system, the inquiries of geologists lead to the conclusion that the heat of the Earth’s still molten nucleus is but a remnant of the heat which once made molten the entire Earth. The mountainous surfaces of the Moon and of Venus (which alone are near enough to be scrutinized), indicating, as they do, crusts that have, like our own, been corrugated by contraction, imply that these bodies too have undergone refrigeration—imply in each of them a primitive heat, such as the hypothesis necessitates. Lastly, we have in the Sun a still-continued production of this heat and light, which must result from the arrest of diffused matter moving towards a common centre of gravity. Here also, as before, a quantitative relation is traceable. Among the bodies which make up the Solar System, those containing comparatively small amounts of matter whose centripetal motion has been destroyed, have already lost nearly all the produced heat: a result which their relatively larger surfaces have facilitated. But the Sun, a thousand times as great in mass as the largest planet, and 268having therefore to give off an enormously greater quantity of heat and light due to arrest of moving matter, is still radiating with great intensity.
“But what,” one might ask, “happens to all the motion that caused the spread of this matter to come together into solid bodies?” The rotation of each body can only be a leftover result of this concentration—an outcome of the imperfect balancing of gravitational movements from opposite points towards a common center. Such gravitational movements from opposite sides must largely cancel each other out. So, what happens to these canceled motions? The answer suggested by the theory of correlation is that they must have been released as heat and light. And this answer is supported by the available evidence. Setting aside any speculation about the origin of the solar system, geologists’ investigations lead to the conclusion that the heat from the Earth’s still molten core is just a remnant of the heat that once melted the entire Earth. The mountainous surfaces of the Moon and Venus (which are close enough to study) suggest, as ours do, that they too have experienced cooling—implying that each of them once had a primitive heat, as the hypothesis requires. Finally, the Sun continues to generate this heat and light, which must come from the stopping of diffused matter moving toward a common center of gravity. Here again, a quantitative relationship can be seen. Among the bodies that make up the Solar System, those with relatively small amounts of matter and whose centripetal motion has been lost have already given off nearly all their generated heat: a result made easier by their relatively larger surfaces. However, the Sun, which is a thousand times more massive than the largest planet, and therefore has to emit an enormously greater amount of heat and light due to the stopping of moving matter, is still radiating intensely.
Thus we see that when, in pursuance of the doctrine of correlation, we ask whence come the forces which our Solar System displays, the hypothesis of Evolution gives us a proximate explanation. If the Solar System once existed in a state of indefinite, incoherent homogeneity, and has progressed to its present state of definite, coherent heterogeneity; then the Motion, Heat, and Light now exhibited by its members, are interpretable as the correlatives of pre-existing forces; and between them and their antecedents we may discern relations that are not only qualitative, but also rudely quantitative. How matter came to exist under the form assumed, is a mystery which we must regard as ultimate. But grant such a previous form of existence, and the hypothesis of Evolution interpreted by the laws of correlation, explains for us the forces as we now see them.
So, when we consider the doctrine of correlation and ask where the forces of our Solar System come from, the theory of Evolution offers us a plausible explanation. If the Solar System once existed in a state of unclear, disorganized sameness and has evolved into its current state of clear, organized diversity, then the Motion, Heat, and Light we observe from its components can be seen as results of pre-existing forces. We can identify relationships between these forces and their origins that are not only qualitative but also roughly quantitative. How matter came to take on its current form remains a mystery that we must accept as fundamental. However, if we accept such a previous state of existence, the theory of Evolution, when understood through the laws of correlation, helps us explain the forces as we observe them today.
§ 80. If we inquire the origin of those forces which have wrought the surface of our planet into its present shape, we find them traceable to the same primordial source as that just assigned. Assuming the solar system to have been evolved, then geologic changes are either direct or indirect results of the unexpended heat caused by nebular condensation. These changes are commonly divided into igneous and aqueous:—heads under which we may most conveniently consider them.
§ 80. If we look into the origin of the forces that have shaped the Earth's surface into its current form, we can trace them back to the same original source mentioned earlier. If we assume that the solar system developed over time, then geological changes are either direct or indirect results of the leftover heat from nebular condensation. These changes are typically categorized as igneous and aqueous, which are the most convenient headings for our discussion.
All those periodic disturbances which we call earthquakes, all those elevations and subsidences which they severally produce, all those accumulated effects of many such elevations and subsidences exhibited in ocean-basins, islands, continents, table-lands, mountain-chains, and all those formations which are distinguished as volcanic, geologists now regard as modifications of the Earth’s crust produced by the still-molten matter occupying its interior. However untenable 269may be the details of M. Elie de Beaumont’s theory, there is good reason to accept the general proposition that the disruptions and variations of level which take place at intervals on the terrestrial surface, are due to the progressive collapse of the Earth’s solid envelope upon its cooling and contracting nucleus. Even supposing that volcanic eruptions, extrusions of igneous rock, and upheaved mountain-chains, could be otherwise satisfactorily accounted for, which they cannot; it would be impossible otherwise to account for those wide-spread elevations and depressions whence continents and oceans result. The conclusion to be drawn is, then, that the forces displayed in these so-called igneous changes, are derived positively or negatively from the unexpended heat of the Earth’s interior. Such phenomena as the fusion or agglutination of sedimentary deposits, the warming of springs, the sublimation of metals into the fissures where we find them as ores, may be regarded as positive results of this residuary heat; while fractures of strata and alterations of level are its negative results, since they ensue on its escape. The original cause of all these effects is still, however, as it has been from the first, the gravitating movement of the Earth’s matter towards the Earth’s centre; seeing that to this is due both the internal heat itself and the collapse which takes place as it is radiated into space.
All those periodic disturbances we call earthquakes, all the rises and falls they cause, and all the accumulated effects of these shifts seen in ocean basins, islands, continents, plateaus, mountain ranges, and all the volcanic formations are now viewed by geologists as changes in the Earth’s crust caused by the still-molten material in its interior. While the specifics of M. Elie de Beaumont’s theory may be questionable, there’s solid reason to accept the general idea that the disruptions and variations in the Earth’s surface happen because of the gradual collapse of the Earth’s solid shell as its core cools and contracts. Even if there were another satisfactory explanation for volcanic eruptions, the extrusion of molten rock, and the formation of mountain chains (which there isn’t), it would still be impossible to explain the widespread rises and falls that create continents and oceans. The conclusion is that the forces involved in these so-called igneous changes come from the residual heat within the Earth, whether directly or indirectly. Phenomena like the melting or binding of sedimentary deposits, the heating of springs, and the sublimation of metals into the fissures where we find them as ores are positive results of this leftover heat, while the fracturing of rock layers and changes in level are negative results, occurring when this heat escapes. The original cause of all these effects has always been the gravitational movement of the Earth’s matter toward its center, as this is responsible for both the internal heat and the collapse that happens as it radiates away into space.
When we inquire under what forms previously existed the force which works out the geological changes classed as aqueous, the answer is less obvious. The effects of rain, of rivers, of winds, of waves, of marine currents, do not manifestly proceed from one general source. Analysis, nevertheless, proves to us that they have a common genesis. If we ask,—Whence comes the power of the river-current, bearing sediment down to the sea? the reply is,—The gravitation of water throughout the tract which this river drains. If we ask,—How came the water to be dispersed over this tract? the reply is,—It fell in the shape of rain. If we ask,—How came the rain to be in that position whence it fell? the reply is,—The 270vapour from which it was condensed was drifted there by the winds. If we ask,—How came this vapour to be at that elevation? the reply is,—It was raised by evaporation. And if we ask,—What force thus raised it? the reply is,—The sun’s heat. Just that amount of gravitative force which the sun’s heat overcame in raising the atoms of water, is given out again in the fall of those atoms to the same level. Hence the denudations effected by rain and rivers, during the descent of this condensed vapour to the level of the sea, are indirectly due to the sun’s heat. Similarly with the winds that transport the vapours hither and thither. Consequent as atmospheric currents are on differences of temperature (either general, as between the equatorial and polar regions, or special as between tracts of the Earth’s surface of unlike physical characters) all such currents are due to that source from which the varying quantities of heat proceed. And if the winds thus originate, so too do the waves raised by them on the sea’s surface. Whence it follows that whatever changes waves produce—the wearing away of shores, the breaking down of rocks into shingle, sand, and mud—are also traceable to the solar rays as their primary cause. The same may be said of ocean-currents. Generated as the larger ones are by the excess of heat which the ocean in tropical climates continually acquires from the Sun; and generated as the smaller ones are by minor local differences in the quantities of solar heat absorbed; it follows that the distribution of sediment and other geological processes which these marine currents effect, are affiliable upon the force which the sun radiates. The only aqueous agency otherwise originating is that of the tides—an agency which, equally with the others, is traceable to unexpended astronomical motion. But making allowance for the changes which this works, we reach the conclusion that the slow wearing down of continents and gradual filling up of seas, by rain, rivers, winds, waves, and ocean-streams, are the indirect effects of solar heat.
When we ask what factors used to create the force behind geological changes classified as water-related, the answer isn't immediately clear. The impacts of rain, rivers, winds, waves, and ocean currents don't clearly stem from a single source. However, analysis shows us that they share a common origin. If we ask, "Where does the power of the river's current, which carries sediments to the sea, come from?" the answer is, "The gravitational pull of water in the area that the river drains." If we ask, "How did the water come to be spread across this area?" the answer is, "It fell as rain." If we ask, "How did the rain get to that position from which it fell?" the answer is, "The vapor that formed it was carried there by the winds." If we ask, "How did this vapor get to that height?" the answer is, "It was lifted by evaporation." And if we ask, "What force lifted it?" the answer is, "The sun's heat." The amount of gravitational force that the sun's heat overcame to lift the water atoms is released again when those atoms fall back to the same level. Therefore, the erosion caused by rain and rivers as this condensed vapor descends to sea level is indirectly due to the sun's heat. The same applies to the winds that move vapor around. Since atmospheric currents arise from temperature differences (either overall, like between equatorial and polar regions, or specific, like between areas of different physical characteristics), all these currents originate from the source of varying amounts of heat. If the winds originate from this, so do the waves they create on the ocean's surface. Consequently, any changes caused by waves—such as eroding shorelines and breaking rocks into gravel, sand, and mud—can also be traced back to the solar rays as their primary cause. The same can be said for ocean currents. The larger currents are generated by the excess heat that the ocean in tropical regions continuously absorbs from the sun, while the smaller ones are created by local differences in the amounts of solar heat absorbed. Therefore, the distribution of sediment and other geological processes affected by these marine currents can be attributed to the force emitted by the sun. The only other water-related force comes from the tides—this force, like the others, is also linked to unspent astronomical motion. However, taking into account the changes this causes, we conclude that the slow erosion of continents and gradual filling of seas by rain, rivers, winds, waves, and ocean currents are indirect results of solar heat.
271Thus the implication forced on us by the doctrine of correlation, that the forces which have moulded and re-moulded the Earth’s crust must have pre-existed under some other shape, is quite in conformity with the theory of Evolution; since this pre-supposes certain forces that are both adequate to the results, and cannot be expended without producing the results. We see that while the geological changes classed as igneous, result from the still-progressing motion of the Earth’s substance to its centre of gravity; the antagonistic changes classed as aqueous, result from the still-progressing motion of the Sun’s substance towards its centre of gravity—a motion which, transformed into heat and radiated to us, is here re-transformed, directly into motions of the gaseous and liquid matters on the Earth’s surface, and indirectly into motions of the solid matters.
271So the implication of the correlation theory tells us that the forces that have shaped and reshaped the Earth's crust must have existed in some other form before. This idea aligns with the theory of Evolution; it assumes there are certain forces that are strong enough to create the results we see and cannot be spent without leading to those results. We observe that the geological changes classified as igneous arise from the ongoing movement of the Earth’s material toward its center of gravity, while the opposing changes classified as aqueous come from the ongoing movement of the Sun’s material toward its center of gravity. This motion converts into heat and radiates to us, which then transforms again, directly affecting the movements of the gaseous and liquid substances on the Earth’s surface, and indirectly influencing the movements of solid substances.
§ 81. That the forces exhibited in vital actions, vegetal and animal, are similarly derived, is so obvious a deduction from the facts of organic chemistry, that it will meet with ready acceptance from readers acquainted with these facts. Let us note first the physiological generalizations; and then the generalizations which they necessitate.
§ 81. It’s clear that the forces involved in vital actions, both plant and animal, come from the same source. This conclusion is so evident from the facts of organic chemistry that those familiar with these facts will easily accept it. First, let's look at the physiological generalizations, and then the broader generalizations that follow from them.
Plant-life is all directly or indirectly dependant on the heat and light of the sun—directly dependant in the immense majority of plants, and indirectly dependant in plants which, as the fungi, flourish in the dark: since these, growing as they do at the expense of decaying organic matter, mediately draw their forces from the same original source. Each plant owes the carbon and hydrogen of which it mainly consists, to the carbonic acid and water contained in the surrounding air and earth. The carbonic acid and water must, however, be decomposed before their carbon and hydrogen can be assimilated. To overcome the powerful affinities which hold their elements together, requires the expenditure of force; and this force is supplied by the Sun. In what manner the decomposition is effected we do not know. But 272we know that when, under fit conditions, plants are exposed to the Sun’s rays, they give off oxygen and accumulate carbon and hydrogen. In darkness this process ceases. It ceases too when the quantities of light and heat received are greatly reduced, as in winter. Conversely, it is active when the light and heat are great, as in summer. And the like relation is seen in the fact that while plant-life is luxuriant in the tropics, it diminishes in temperate regions, and disappears as we approach the poles. Thus the irresistible inference is, that the forces by which plants abstract the materials of their tissues from surrounding inorganic compounds—the forces by which they grow and carry on their functions, are forces that previously existed as solar radiations.
Plant life depends directly or indirectly on the heat and light of the sun—most plants depend directly, while others, like fungi, thrive in the dark. These fungi grow by consuming decaying organic matter, indirectly deriving their energy from the same original source. Each plant gets the carbon and hydrogen it mainly consists of from the carbon dioxide and water in the surrounding air and soil. However, carbon dioxide and water must be broken down before their carbon and hydrogen can be used. To break the strong bonds holding the elements together requires energy, which comes from the sun. We don't know exactly how the decomposition happens. But we know that when plants are put in sunlight under the right conditions, they release oxygen and collect carbon and hydrogen. This process stops in the dark and also slows down when there is less light and heat, like in winter. In contrast, the process is active when there is plenty of light and heat, like in summer. This is also why plant life is abundant in the tropics, decreases in temperate regions, and disappears as we get closer to the poles. Therefore, it’s clear that the energy that plants use to extract materials for their tissues from surrounding inorganic compounds—the energy that allows them to grow and function—comes from solar radiation.
That animal life is immediately or mediately dependant on vegetal life is a familiar truth; and that, in the main, the processes of animal life are opposite to those of vegetal life is a truth long current among men of science. Chemically considered, vegetal life is chiefly a process of de-oxidation, and animal life chiefly a process of oxidation: chiefly, we must say, because in so far as plants are expenders of force for the purposes of organization, they are oxidizers (as is shown by the exhalation of carbonic acid during the night); and animals, in some of their minor processes, are probably de-oxidizers. But with this qualification, the general truth is that while the plant, decomposing carbonic acid and water and liberating oxygen, builds up the detained carbon and hydrogen (along with a little nitrogen and small quantities of other elements elsewhere obtained) into branches, leaves, and seeds; the animal, consuming these branches, leaves, and seeds, and absorbing oxygen, recomposes carbonic acid and water, together with certain nitrogenous compounds in minor amounts. And while the decomposition effected by the plant, is at the expense of certain forces emanating from the sun, which are employed in overcoming the affinities of carbon and hydrogen for the oxygen united with them; the recomposition effected by the 273animal, is at the profit of these forces, which are liberated during the combination of such elements. Thus the movements, internal and external, of the animal, are re-appearances in new forms of a power absorbed by the plant under the shape of light and heat. Just as, in the manner above explained, the solar forces expended in raising vapour from the sea’s surface, are given out again in the fall of rain and rivers to the same level, and in the accompanying transfer of solid matters; so, the solar forces that in the plant raised certain chemical elements to a condition of unstable equilibrium, are given out again in the actions of the animal during the fall of these elements to a condition of stable equilibrium.
That animal life depends directly or indirectly on plant life is a well-known fact, and it is also widely accepted among scientists that the processes of animal life are largely the opposite of those of plant life. From a chemical perspective, plant life mainly involves de-oxidation, while animal life primarily involves oxidation. We note "mainly" because while plants do use energy to grow, they also act as oxidizers (as indicated by the release of carbon dioxide at night); and animals may act as de-oxidizers in some minor processes. However, aside from this nuance, the general truth is that plants break down carbon dioxide and water, releasing oxygen and building up carbon and hydrogen (along with some nitrogen and trace amounts of other elements) into branches, leaves, and seeds. Animals, in turn, consume these branches, leaves, and seeds, absorb oxygen, and then reform carbon dioxide and water, along with certain nitrogen compounds in smaller quantities. While the breakdown performed by plants relies on the energy from the sun to overcome the bonds between carbon and hydrogen and the oxygen they are combined with, the recombination done by animals benefits from the release of this energy during the combination of those elements. Therefore, the movements—both internal and external—of the animal are essentially new forms of energy absorbed by the plant in the form of light and heat. Similarly, just as the solar energy used to evaporate water from the ocean is released again during rainfall and the movement of rivers back to sea level, the solar forces that in plants elevated certain chemical elements to an unstable state are released again during the animal's processes as these elements return to a stable state.
Besides thus tracing a qualitative correlation between these two great orders of organic activity, as well as between both of them and inorganic agencies, we may rudely trace a quantitative correlation. Where vegetal life is abundant, we usually find abundant animal life; and as we advance from torrid to temperate and frigid climates, the two decrease together. Speaking generally, the animals of each class reach a larger size in regions where vegetation is abundant, than in those where it is sparse. And further, there is a tolerably apparent connexion between the quantity of energy which each species of animal expends, and the quantity of force which the nutriment it absorbs gives out during oxidation.
Besides establishing a qualitative link between these two major forms of organic activity, and between both of them and inorganic factors, we can also identify a rough quantitative relationship. Where plant life is plentiful, we typically find plenty of animal life; and as we move from hot to temperate and cold climates, both tend to decrease together. Generally speaking, animals in each category tend to be larger in areas where vegetation is abundant than in those where it is limited. Additionally, there’s a fairly clear connection between the amount of energy each animal species uses and the amount of energy released from the food it consumes during oxidation.
Certain phenomena of development in both plants and animals, illustrate still more directly the ultimate truth enunciated. Pursuing the suggestion made by Mr. Grove, in the first edition of his work on the “Correlation of the Physical Forces,” that a connexion probably exists between the forces classed as vital and those classed as physical, Dr. Carpenter has pointed out that such a connexion is clearly exhibited during incubation. The transformation of the unorganized contents of an egg into the organized chick, is altogether a question of heat: withhold heat and the process does not commence; supply heat and it goes on while the 274temperature is maintained, but ceases when the egg is allowed to cool. The developmental changes can be completed only by keeping the temperature with tolerable constancy at a definite height for a definite time; that is—only by supplying a definite quantity of heat. In the metamorphoses of insects we may discern parallel facts. Experiments show not only that the hatching of their eggs is determined by temperature, but also that the evolution of the pupa into the imago is similarly determined; and may be immensely accelerated or retarded according as heat is artificially supplied or withheld. It will suffice just to add that the germination of plants presents like relations of cause and effect—relations so similar that detail is superfluous.
Certain developmental phenomena in both plants and animals highlight the ultimate truth expressed. Following Mr. Grove's suggestion in the first edition of his work on the “Correlation of the Physical Forces,” that there’s likely a connection between vital forces and physical forces, Dr. Carpenter points out that this connection is clearly seen during incubation. The transformation of the unorganized contents of an egg into an organized chick is entirely a matter of heat: without heat, the process doesn’t start; with heat, it continues as long as the temperature is kept steady, but stops when the egg cools down. The developmental changes can only be completed if the temperature is maintained at a specific level for a specific duration; that is—only by providing a certain amount of heat. In the metamorphosis of insects, we can see similar facts. Experiments show that not only is the hatching of their eggs determined by temperature, but also the development of the pupa into the adult form is similarly influenced; it can be greatly sped up or slowed down depending on whether heat is artificially provided or withheld. It’s also worth mentioning that the germination of plants shows similar cause-and-effect relationships—relationships so alike that further detail is unnecessary.
Thus then the various changes exhibited to us by the organic creation, whether considered as a whole, or in its two great divisions, or in its individual members, conform, so far as we can ascertain, to the law of correlation. Where, as in the transformation of an egg into a chick, we can investigate the phenomena apart from all complications, we find that the re-arrangement of parts which constitutes evolution, involves expenditure of a pre-existing force. Where it is not, as in the egg or the chrysalis, merely the change of a fixed quantity of matter into a new shape, but where, as in the growing plant or animal, we have an incorporation of matter existing outside, there is still a pre-existing external force at the cost of which this incorporation is effected. And where, as in the higher division of organisms, there remain over and above the forces expended in organization, certain surplus forces expended in movement, these too are indirectly derived from this same pre-existing external force.
Thus, the various changes we see in living organisms, whether we look at the whole, its two major parts, or its individual members, seem to follow the law of correlation as best as we can tell. In cases like the transformation of an egg into a chick, where we can study the phenomena without additional complications, we find that the rearrangement of parts that makes up evolution requires the use of some pre-existing force. When it’s not just about changing a fixed amount of matter into a new form, like with the egg or the chrysalis, but involves a growing plant or animal where matter from outside is added, there’s still a reliance on an external force to make that addition happen. Furthermore, in more complex organisms, beyond the forces used for organization, there are extra forces used for movement, which are also indirectly sourced from that same pre-existing external force.
§ 82. Even after all that has been said in the foregoing part of this work, many will be alarmed by the assertion, that the forces which we distinguish as mental, come within the same generalization. Yet there is no alternative but to make this assertion: the facts which justify, or rather which 275necessitate it, being abundant and conspicuous. They fall into the following groups.
§ 82. Even after everything discussed in the previous part of this work, many will be worried by the claim that the forces we recognize as mental fall under the same generalization. However, we have no choice but to make this claim: the facts that support it, or rather make it necessary, are plentiful and obvious. They can be categorized into the following groups.
All impressions from moment to moment made on our organs of sense, stand in direct correlation with physical forces existing externally. The modes of consciousness called pressure, motion, sound, light, heat, are effects produced in us by agencies which, as otherwise expended, crush or fracture pieces of matter, generate vibrations in surrounding objects, cause chemical combinations, and reduce substances from a solid to a liquid form. Hence if we regard the changes of relative position, of aggregation, or of chemical state, thus arising, as being transformed manifestations of the agencies from which they arise; so must we regard the sensations which such agencies produce in us, as new forms of the forces producing them. Any hesitation to admit that, between the physical forces and the sensations there exists a correlation like that between the physical forces themselves, must disappear on remembering how the one correlation, like the other, is not qualitative only but quantitative. Masses of matter which, by scales or dynamometer, are shown to differ greatly in weight, differ as greatly in the feelings of pressure they produce on our bodies. In arresting moving objects, the strains we are conscious of are proportionate to the momenta of such objects as otherwise measured. Under like conditions the impressions of sounds given to us by vibrating strings, bells, or columns of air, are found to vary in strength with the amount of force applied. Fluids or solids proved to be markedly contrasted in temperature by the different degrees of expansion they produce in the mercurial column, produce in us correspondingly different degrees of the sensation of heat. And similarly unlike intensities in our impressions of light, answer to unlike effects as measured by photometers.
All the impressions we experience moment by moment through our senses directly relate to the physical forces acting on the outside world. The ways we perceive things like pressure, motion, sound, light, and heat are effects created in us by forces that, if released differently, can crush or break apart materials, create vibrations in nearby objects, cause chemical reactions, and change substances from solid to liquid. Therefore, if we see the changes in position, grouping, or chemical state as transformed expressions of the forces that cause them, we should also view the sensations created by these forces in us as new forms of the same forces. Any doubt about the correlation between physical forces and sensations, which mirrors the connection between the physical forces themselves, should vanish when we remember that this correlation is both qualitative and quantitative. Large masses of matter that are significantly different in weight, as shown by scales or dynamometers, produce equally distinct feelings of pressure on our bodies. When stopping moving objects, the sensations we feel are proportional to the momentum of those objects as measured otherwise. Under similar circumstances, the strength of sounds we perceive from vibrating strings, bells, or columns of air varies with the amount of force applied. Fluids or solids that show marked differences in temperature through their varying levels of expansion in a mercury column produce correspondingly different sensations of heat in us. Similarly, different intensities of our light impressions correspond to different effects as measured by photometers.
Besides the correlation and equivalence between external physical forces, and the mental forces generated by them in us under the form of sensations, there is a correlation and 276equivalence between sensations and those physical forces which, in the shape of bodily actions, result from them. The feelings we distinguish as light, heat, sound, odour, taste, pressure, &.c, do not die away without immediate results; but are invariably followed by other manifestations of force. In addition to the excitements of secreting organs, that are in some cases traceable, there arises a contraction of the involuntary muscles, or of the voluntary muscles, or of both. Sensations increase the action of the heart—slightly when they are slight; markedly when they are marked; and recent physiological inquiries imply not only that contraction of the heart is excited by every sensation, but also that the muscular fibres throughout the whole, vascular system, are at the same time more or less contracted. The respiratory muscles, too, are stimulated into greater activity by sensations. The rate of breathing is visibly and audibly augmented both by pleasurable and painful impressions on the nerves, when these reach any intensity. It has even of late been shown that inspiration becomes more frequent on transition from darkness into sunshine,—a result probably due to the increased amount of direct and indirect nervous stimulation involved. When the quantity of sensation is great, it generates contractions of the voluntary muscles, as well as of the involuntary ones. Unusual excitement of the nerves of touch, as by tickling, is followed by almost incontrollable movements of the limbs. Violent pains cause violent struggles. The start that succeeds a loud sound, the wry face produced by the taste of anything extremely disagreeable, the jerk with which the hand or foot is snatched out of water that is very hot, are instances of the transformation of feeling: into motion; and in these cases, as in all others, it is manifest that the quantity of bodily action is proportionate to the quantity of sensation. Even where from pride there is a suppression of the screams and groans expressive of great pain (also indirect results of muscular contraction), we may still see in the clenching of the hands, the knitting of the 277brows, and the setting of the teeth, that the bodily actions developed are as great, though less obtrusive in their results. If we take emotions instead of sensations, we find the correlation and equivalence equally manifest. Not only are the modes of consciousness directly produced in us by physical forces, re-transformable into physical forces under the form of muscular motions and the changes they initiate; but the like is true of those modes of consciousness which are not directly produced in us by the physical forces. Emotions of moderate intensity, like sensations of moderate intensity, generate little beyond excitement of the heart and vascular system, joined sometimes with increased action of glandular organs. But as the emotions rise in strength, the muscles of the face, body, and limbs, begin to move. Of examples may be mentioned the frowns, dilated nostrils, and stampings of anger; the contracted brows, and wrung hands, of grief; the smiles and leaps of joy; and the frantic struggles of terror or despair. Passing over certain apparent, but only apparent, exceptions, we see that whatever be the kind of emotion, there is a manifest relation between its amount, and the amount of muscular action induced: alike from the erect carriage and elastic step of exhilaration, up to the dancings of immense delight, and from the fidgetiness of impatience up to the almost convulsive movements accompanying great mental agony. To these several orders of evidence must be joined the further one, that between our feelings and those voluntary motions into which they are transformed, there comes the sensation of muscular tension, standing in manifest correlation with both—a correlation that is distinctly quantitative: the sense of strain varying, other things equal, directly as the quantity of momentum generated.
Besides the relationship and equivalence between external physical forces and the mental forces they generate in us as sensations, there’s a relationship and equivalence between sensations and the physical forces that result in bodily actions. The feelings we categorize as light, heat, sound, smell, taste, pressure, etc., don’t fade away without immediate results; instead, they are always followed by other expressions of force. In addition to the stimulation of secretory organs, which can sometimes be traced, there is a contraction of the involuntary muscles or the voluntary muscles, or both. Sensations increase the heart's activity—slightly for mild sensations, significantly for strong ones; and recent physiological studies suggest that every sensation stimulates heart contractions and that the muscular fibers throughout the entire vascular system are also contracted to some degree. The respiratory muscles are also energized into greater action by sensations. The rate of breathing visibly and audibly increases with both pleasurable and painful nerve stimuli when they reach a certain intensity. It has even recently been shown that breathing becomes more frequent when transitioning from darkness to sunlight, likely due to the heightened direct and indirect nervous stimulation involved. When the sensation level is high, it prompts contractions of both voluntary and involuntary muscles. Unusual stimulation of the touch nerves, like tickling, leads to nearly uncontrollable limb movements. Intense pain results in intense struggles. The jump after a loud sound, the grimace from tasting something very unpleasant, and the reflex to pull a hand or foot out of extremely hot water are examples of feelings transforming into movement; in these instances, as in all others, it’s clear that the amount of physical action correlates with the amount of sensation. Even when someone suppresses screams and groans from severe pain due to pride (which are also indirect results of muscle contraction), we can still observe in the clenching of hands, furrowing of brows, and gritting of teeth that the physical actions are significant, though less visible in their outcomes. If we consider emotions instead of sensations, the relationship and equivalence are equally clear. Not only do the states of consciousness we experience from physical forces convert back into physical forces in the form of muscle movements and the changes they cause, but the same applies to those states of consciousness that are not directly caused by physical forces. Emotions of moderate intensity, like sensations of moderate intensity, tend to generate little beyond excitement in the heart and vascular system, sometimes coupled with increased activity of glandular organs. However, as the emotions intensify, the muscles in the face, body, and limbs begin to engage. Examples include the frowning, flaring nostrils, and stomping of anger; the furrowed brows and wringing hands of grief; the smiles and leaps of joy; and the frantic movements of fear or despair. Ignoring some apparent but misleading exceptions, we can see that regardless of the type of emotion, there’s a clear relationship between its intensity and the level of muscle activity it produces: from the upright posture and lively step of happiness to the exuberant dances of extreme joy and from the restless movements of impatience to the almost convulsive actions accompanying profound mental distress. To this range of evidence, we must add another aspect: between our feelings and the voluntary movements they inspire lies the sensation of muscular tension, which is clearly correlated with both—a correlation that is quantitatively distinct: the sense of strain varies directly with the amount of momentum created, other factors being equal.
“But how,” it may be asked, “can we interpret by the law of correlation the genesis of those thoughts and feelings which, instead of following external stimuli, arise spontaneously? Between the indignation caused by an insult, and the 278loud sounds or violent acts that follow, the alleged connexion may hold; but whence come the crowd of ideas and the mass of feelings that expend themselves in these demonstrations? They are clearly not equivalents of the sensations produced by the words on the ears; for the same words otherwise arranged, would not have caused them. The thing said bears to the mental action it excites, much the same relation that the pulling of a trigger bears to the subsequent explosion—does not produce the power, but merely liberates it. Whence then arises this immense amount of nervous energy which a whisper or a glance may call forth?” The reply is, that the immediate correlates of these and other such modes of consciousness, are not to be found in the agencies acting on us externally, but in certain internal agencies. The forces called vital, which we have seen to be correlates of the forces called physical, are the immediate sources of these thoughts and feelings; and are expended in producing them. The proofs of this are various. Here are some of them. It is a conspicuous fact that mental action is contingent on the presence of a certain nervous apparatus; and that, greatly obscured as it is by numerous and involved conditions, a general relation may be traced between the size of this apparatus and the quantity of mental action as measured by its results. Further, this apparatus has a particular chemical constitution on which its activity depends; and there is one element in it between the amount of which and the amount of function performed, there is an ascertained connexion: the proportion of phosphorus present in the brain being the smallest in infancy, old age and idiotcy, and the greatest during the prime of life. Note next, that the evolution of thought and emotion varies, other things equal, with the supply of blood to the brain. On the one hand, a cessation of the cerebral circulation, from arrest of the heart’s action, immediately entails unconsciousness. On the other hand, excess of cerebral circulation (unless it is such as to cause undue pressure) results in an excitement 279rising finally to delirium. Not the quantity only, but also the condition of the blood passing through the nervous system, influences the mental manifestations. The arterial currents must be duly aerated, to produce the normal amount of cerebration. At the one extreme, we find that if the blood is not allowed to exchange its carbonic acid for oxygen, there results asphyxia, with its accompanying stoppage of ideas and feelings. While at the other extreme, we find that by the inspiration of nitrous oxide, there is produced an excessive, and indeed irrepressible, nervous activity. Besides the connexion between the development of the mental forces and the presence of sufficient oxygen in the cerebral arteries, there is a kindred connexion between the development of the mental forces and the presence in the cerebral arteries of certain other elements. There must be supplied special materials for the nutrition of the nervous centres, as well as for their oxidation. And how what we may call the quantity of consciousness, is, other things equal, determined by the constituents of the blood, is unmistakably seen in the exaltation that follows when certain chemical compounds, as alcohol and the vegeto-alkalies, are added to it. The gentle exhilaration which tea and coffee create, is familiar to all; and though the gorgeous imaginations and intense feelings of happiness produced by opium and hashish, have been experienced by few, (in this country at least,) the testimony of those who have experienced them is sufficiently conclusive. Yet another proof that the genesis of the mental energies is immediately dependent on chemical change, is afforded by the fact, that the effete products separated from the blood by the kidneys, vary in character with the amount of cerebral action. Excessive activity of mind is habitually accompanied by the excretion of an unusual quantity of the alkaline phosphates. Conditions of abnormal nervous excitement bring on analogous effects. And the “peculiar odour of the insane,” implying as it does morbid products in the perspiration, shows a connexion between 280insanity and a special composition of the circulating fluids—a composition which, whether regarded as cause or consequence, equally implies correlation of the mental and the physical forces. Lastly we have to note that this correlation too, is, so far as we can trace it, quantitative. Provided the conditions to nervous action are not infringed on, and the concomitants are the same, there is a tolerably constant ratio between the amounts of the antecedents and consequents. Within the implied limits, nervous stimulants and anæsthetics produce effects on the thoughts and feelings, proportionate to the quantities administered. And conversely, where the thoughts and feelings form the initial term of the relation, the degree of reaction on the bodily energies is great, in proportion as they are great: reaching in extreme cases a total prostration of physique.
"But how," one might ask, "can we understand through the law of correlation the origin of those thoughts and feelings that, instead of being triggered by external stimuli, arise spontaneously? There may be a connection between the anger caused by an insult and the loud sounds or violent actions that follow, but where do the multitude of ideas and the flood of feelings that emerge in these demonstrations come from? They clearly aren’t direct responses to the sensations caused by the words; after all, the same words in a different order wouldn’t have produced the same reaction. What is said relates to the mental response it triggers much like pulling a trigger relates to the subsequent explosion—it doesn’t create the energy, but merely releases it. So, where does this huge amount of nervous energy, which can be sparked by just a whisper or a glance, come from?" The answer is that the immediate correlates of these and similar modes of consciousness are not found in external influences but in certain internal processes. The so-called vital forces, which we've established are correlated with physical forces, are the primary sources of these thoughts and feelings and are spent in generating them. There are various pieces of evidence for this. Here are some of them. It's a well-known fact that mental activity depends on the existence of a certain nervous system; and although its functioning is significantly affected by numerous complex conditions, a general relationship can be observed between the size of this system and the amount of mental activity as measured by its outcomes. Moreover, this system has a specific chemical makeup that determines its activity, and there is a known correlation between one of its elements and the function performed: phosphorus levels in the brain are lowest in infancy, old age, and mental deficiency, while they are highest during young adulthood. Next, note that the development of thought and emotion varies, all else being equal, with the amount of blood supplied to the brain. On one hand, if blood circulation in the brain ceases due to heart failure, unconsciousness follows immediately. On the other hand, too much blood flow in the brain (unless it cause undue pressure) can lead to excitement that escalates into delirium. Not only the amount but also the condition of the blood circulating through the nervous system affects mental functions. The blood must be adequately oxygenated to support normal cognitive activity. At one extreme, if the blood isn’t able to exchange carbon dioxide for oxygen, asphyxiation occurs, resulting in a halt of ideas and feelings. At the other extreme, inhaling nitrous oxide leads to an excessive, even uncontrollable, surge of nervous energy. In addition to the connection between mental force development and sufficient oxygen in the brain arteries, there is a similar link between mental force development and the presence of certain other elements in those arteries. Special materials must be provided for the nourishment of the nervous centers, as well as for their oxidation. The way the "quantity of consciousness" is determined, all things being equal, by the components of the blood is clearly seen in the heightened state that follows the introduction of certain chemical compounds, such as alcohol and certain plant alkaloids. The mild exhilaration created by tea and coffee is well known; and while the vivid imaginations and intense feelings of happiness brought on by opium and hashish have been experienced by fewer people (at least in this country), the accounts of those who have experienced them are quite convincing. Another piece of evidence that the origin of mental energy is directly influenced by chemical change comes from the fact that the waste products filtered from the blood by the kidneys differ based on the level of brain activity. High mental activity is usually associated with an unusual amount of alkaline phosphates being excreted. Abnormal states of nervous excitement can lead to similar results. Furthermore, the "distinct odor of the insane," which indicates the presence of abnormal products in perspiration, illustrates a connection between insanity and a specific composition of circulating fluids—a composition that implies a correlation between mental and physical forces, whether viewed as a cause or an effect. Lastly, we should note that this correlation is, as far as we can trace it, quantitative. Provided the conditions for nervous action are not violated and the accompanying elements are the same, there is a fairly constant ratio between the amounts of the initial factors and their outcomes. Within the stated limits, both stimulants and anesthetics produce mental effects that correspond to the doses given. Conversely, when thoughts and feelings initiate the connection, the degree of bodily reaction is significant, proportionate to the intensity of those thoughts and feelings, potentially leading to complete physical exhaustion in extreme cases.
Various classes of facts thus unite to prove that the law of metamorphosis, which holds among the physical forces, holds equally between them and the mental forces. Those modes of the Unknowable which we call motion, heat, light, chemical affinity, &c., are alike transformable into each other, and into those modes of the Unknowable which we distinguish as sensation, emotion, thought: these, in their turns, being directly or indirectly re-transformable into the original shapes. That no idea or feeling arises, save as a result of some physical force expended in producing it, is fast becoming a common place of science; and whoever duly weighs the evidence will see, that nothing but an overwhelming bias in favour of a pre-conceived theory, can explain its non-acceptance. How this metamorphosis takes place—how a force existing as motion, heat, or light, can become a mode of consciousness—how it is possible for aerial vibrations to generate the sensation we call sound, or for the forces liberated by chemical changes in the brain to give rise to emotion—these are mysteries which it is impossible to fathom. But they are not profounder mysteries than the transformations of the physical forces into each other. 281They are not more completely beyond our comprehension than the natures of Mind and Matter. They have simply the same insolubility as all other ultimate questions. We can learn nothing more than that here is one of the uniformities in the order of phenomena.
Various types of facts come together to show that the law of metamorphosis, which applies to physical forces, also applies between them and mental forces. Those forms of the Unknowable that we refer to as motion, heat, light, chemical affinity, etc., can be transformed into each other, as well as into those forms of the Unknowable that we categorize as sensation, emotion, and thought. In turn, these can also be directly or indirectly transformed back into their original forms. The idea that no thought or feeling arises without some physical force acting to create it is becoming widely accepted in science. Anyone who carefully examines the evidence will see that only a strong bias toward a preconceived theory could explain its rejection. How this metamorphosis occurs—how a force manifested as motion, heat, or light can become a mode of consciousness—how aerial vibrations can create the sensation we call sound, or how the forces released by chemical changes in the brain can produce emotions—these remain mysteries that are impossible to fully understand. However, they are not more perplexing than the transformations of physical forces into one another. They are not any less completely beyond our understanding than the concepts of Mind and Matter. They simply share the same unsolvable nature as all ultimate questions. All we can really learn is that this is one of the consistent patterns in the order of phenomena. 281
§ 83. Of course if the law of correlation and equivalence holds of the forces we class as vital and mental, it must hold also of those which we class as social. Whatever takes place in a society is due to organic or inorganic agencies, or to a combination of the two—results either from the undirected physical forces around, from these physical forces as directed by men, or from the forces of the men themselves. No change can occur in its organization, its modes of activity, or the effects it produces on the face of the Earth, but what proceeds, mediately or immediately, from these. Let us consider first the correlation between the phenomena which societies display, and the vital phenomena.
§ 83. Obviously, if the law of correlation and equivalence applies to the forces we identify as vital and mental, it should also apply to those we consider social. Everything that happens in a society is a result of either organic or inorganic influences, or a mix of both—stemming either from the uncontrolled physical forces around us, from those forces as directed by people, or from the forces within the people themselves. No change can happen in its structure, its ways of functioning, or the impact it has on the planet without arising, directly or indirectly, from these. Let's first examine the relationship between the phenomena that societies exhibit and vital phenomena.
Social power and life varies, other things equal, with the population. Though different races, differing widely in their fitness for combination, show us that the forces manifested in a society are not necessarily proportionate to the number of people; yet we see that under given conditions, the forces manifested are confined within the limits which the number of people imposes. A small society, no matter how superior the character of its members, cannot exhibit the same quantity of social action as a large one. The production and distribution of commodities must be on a comparatively small scale. A multitudinous press, a prolific literature, or a massive political agitation, is not possible. And there can be but a small total of results in the shape of art-products and scientific discoveries. The correlation of the social with the physical forces through the intermediation of the vital ones, is, however, most clearly shown in the different amounts of activity displayed by the same society according as its members are supplied with different amounts of force 282from the external world. In the effects of good and bad harvests, we yearly see this relation illustrated. A greatly deficient yield of wheat is soon followed by a diminution of business. Factories are worked half-time, or close entirely; railway traffic falls; retailers find their sales much lessened; house-building is almost suspended; and if the scarcity rises to famine, a thinning of the population still more diminishes the industrial vivacity. Conversely, an unusually abundant harvest, occurring under conditions not otherwise unfavourable, both excites the old producing and distributing agencies and sets up new ones. The surplus social energy finds vent in speculative enterprises. Capital seeking investment carries out inventions that have been lying unutilized. Labour is expended in opening new channels of communication. There is increased encouragement to those who furnish the luxuries of life and minister to the æsthetic faculties. There are more marriages, and a greater rate of increase in population. Thus the social organism grows larger, more complex, and more active. When, as happens with most civilized nations, the whole of the materials for subsistence are not drawn from the area inhabited, but are partly imported, the people are still supported by certain harvests elsewhere grown at the expense of certain physical forces. Our own cotton-spinners and weavers supply the most conspicuous instance of a section in one nation living, in great part, on imported commodities, purchased by the labour they expend on other imported commodities. But though the social activities of Lancashire are due chiefly to materials not drawn from our own soil, they are none the less evolved from physical forces elsewhere stored up in fit forms and then brought here.
Social power and life vary, all else being equal, with the population size. Although different races, which vary greatly in their ability to work together, show us that the forces in a society aren’t necessarily proportional to the number of people, we still see that, under certain conditions, the forces displayed are limited by the population size. A small society, no matter how exceptional its members are, can’t show the same level of social activity as a larger one. The production and distribution of goods must be on a smaller scale. A large press, thriving literature, or significant political activism is simply not possible. Additionally, the total output in terms of art and scientific discoveries will be minimal. The relationship between social and physical forces through the mediation of vital ones is most clearly demonstrated by the varying levels of activity in the same society depending on how much external energy its members receive. This relationship is illustrated annually by the impact of good and bad harvests. A significant drop in wheat production quickly leads to a downturn in business. Factories might operate part-time or shut down completely; railway traffic declines; retailers see a significant reduction in sales; construction almost halts; and if the shortage reaches famine levels, the further reduction in population leads to even less industrial activity. On the flip side, an unusually abundant harvest, occurring under favorable conditions, invigorates existing production and distribution systems and creates new ones. The surplus social energy channels into speculative ventures. Capital looking for investment brings to life inventions that have been unused. Labor is invested in creating new communication routes. There’s more support for those providing life’s luxuries and appealing to aesthetic tastes. There are more marriages and a faster population growth rate. As a result, the social organism becomes larger, more complex, and more active. When, as is the case in most developed nations, not all essential resources come from the area inhabited, but are partly imported, the population still relies on certain crops grown elsewhere, using specific physical forces. The cotton spinners and weavers in our country clearly exemplify a sector that relies heavily on imported goods purchased with the labor earned from other imported products. However, while the social activities in Lancashire largely depend on materials not sourced from our own land, they still arise from physical forces obtained from elsewhere and brought here.
If we ask whence come these physical forces from which, through the intermediation of the vital forces, the social forces arise, the reply is of course as heretofore—the solar radiations. Based as the life of a society is on animal and vegetal products; and dependent as these animal and vegetal 283products are on the light and heat of the sun; it follows that the changes going on in societies are effects of forces having a common origin with those which produce all the other orders of changes that have been analyzed. Not only is the force expended by the horse harnessed to the plough, and by the labourer guiding it, derived from the same reservoir as is the force of the falling cataract and the roaring hurricane; but to this same reservoir are eventually traceable those subtler and more complex manifestations of force which humanity, as socially embodied, evolves. The assertion is a startling one, and by many will be thought ludicrous; but it is an unavoidable deduction which cannot here be passed over.
If we ask where these physical forces come from, which, through the mediation of vital forces, give rise to social forces, the answer remains the same as before—solar radiation. Since the life of a society is based on animal and plant products, and these products depend on the sun's light and heat, it follows that the changes in societies are effects of forces that share a common origin with those producing all the other types of changes we've analyzed. Not only is the energy used by the horse pulling the plow, and by the worker guiding it, sourced from the same reservoir as the energy from a crashing waterfall and a howling hurricane, but the more subtle and complex expressions of force that humanity embodies socially can ultimately be traced back to this same reservoir. This assertion may seem shocking to many and might even be considered ridiculous; however, it is an unavoidable conclusion that cannot be overlooked.
Of the physical forces that are directly transformed into social ones, the like is to be said. Currents of air and water, which before the use of steam were the only agencies brought in aid of muscular effort for the performance of industrial processes, are, as we have seen, generated by the heat of the sun. And the inanimate power that now, to so vast an extent, supplements human labour, is similarly derived. The late George Stephenson was one of the first to recognize the fact that the force impelling his locomotive, originally emanated from the sun. Step by step we go back—from the motion of the piston to the evaporation of the water; thence to the heat evolved during the oxidation of coal; thence to the assimilation of carbon by the plants of whose imbedded remains coal consists; thence to the carbonic acid from which their carbon was obtained; and thence to the rays of light that de-oxidized this carbonic acid. Solar forces millions of years ago expended on the Earth’s vegetation, and since locked up beneath its surface, now smelt the metals required for our machines, turn the lathes by which the machines are shaped, work them when put together, and distribute the fabrics they produce. And in so far as economy of labour makes possible the support of a larger population; gives a surplus of human power that would else be absorbed in manual occupations; and so facilitates the development of 284higher kinds of activity; it is clear that these social forces which are directly correlated with physical forces anciently derived from the sun, are only less important than those whose correlates are the vital forces recently derived from it.
Of the physical forces that are directly transformed into social ones, the same can be said. Air and water currents, which were the only tools that assisted muscle power in industrial processes before steam was used, are generated by the sun's heat. The inanimate power that now significantly supports human labor also comes from the same source. The late George Stephenson was one of the first to recognize that the force driving his locomotive originally came from the sun. We can trace this back step by step—from the motion of the piston to the evaporation of water; then to the heat produced from burning coal; then to the carbon absorption by the plants that formed coal; then to the carbon dioxide from which that carbon was derived; and finally to the sunlight that de-oxidized this carbon dioxide. Solar energy, which was stored in Earth’s vegetation millions of years ago and is now trapped beneath the surface, now melts the metals needed for our machines, powers the lathes that shape these machines, operates them once they’re assembled, and distributes the products they create. As labor efficiency allows for the support of a larger population and provides surplus human energy that would otherwise be used in manual work, it also fosters the growth of higher-level activities. It's clear that these social forces, which are directly linked to physical forces derived from the sun long ago, are only slightly less important than those linked to the vital forces derived from it more recently.
§ 84. Regarded as an induction, the doctrine set forth in this chapter will most likely be met by a demurrer. Many who admit that among physical phenomena at least, the correlation of forces is now established, will probably say that inquiry has not yet gone far enough to enable us to predicate equivalence. And in respect of the forces classed as vital, mental, and social, the evidence assigned, however little to be explained away, they will consider by no means conclusive even of correlation, much less of equivalence.
§ 84. Seen as an introduction, the ideas presented in this chapter will likely face a legal objection. Many who acknowledge that at least among physical phenomena, the connection between forces is now recognized, will probably argue that the investigation hasn't progressed enough to confidently state equivalence. Regarding the forces categorized as vital, mental, and social, the evidence provided, no matter how difficult to dismiss, will be viewed as far from definitive in terms of correlation, let alone equivalence.
To those who think thus, it must now however be pointed out, that the universal truth above illustrated under its various aspects, is a necessary corollary from the persistence of force. Setting out with the proposition that force can neither come into existence, nor cease to exist, the several foregoing general conclusions inevitably follow. Each manifestation of force can be interpreted only as the effect of some antecedent force: no matter whether it be an inorganic action, an animal movement, a thought, or a feeling. Either this must be conceded, or else it must be asserted that our successive states of consciousness are self-created. Either mental energies, as well as bodily ones, are quantitatively correlated to certain energies expended in their production, and to certain other energies which they initiate; or else nothing must become something and something must become nothing. The alternatives are, to deny the persistence of force, or to admit that every physical and psychial change is generated by certain antecedent forces, and that from given amounts of such forces neither more nor less of such physical and psychial changes can result. And since the persistence of force, being a datum of consciousness, cannot be denied, its unavoidable corollary must be accepted. This corollary cannot indeed be 285made more certain by accumulating illustrations. The truth as arrived at deductively, cannot be inductively confirmed. For every one of such facts as those above detailed, is established only through the indirect assumption of that persistence of force, from which it really follows as a direct consequence. The most exact proof of correlation and equivalence which it is possible to reach by experimental inquiry, is that based on measurement of the forces expended and the forces produced. But, as was shown in the last chapter, any such process of measurement implies the use of some unit of force which is assumed to remain constant; and for this assumption there can be no warrant but that it is a corollary from the persistence of force. How then can any reasoning based on this corollary, prove the equally direct corollary that when a given quantity of force ceases to exist under one form, an equal quantity must come into existence under some other form or forms? Clearly the à priori truth expressed in this last corollary, cannot be more firmly established by any à posteriori proofs which the first corollary helps us to.
For those who think this way, it should now be pointed out that the universal truth illustrated above, in its various forms, is a necessary result of the persistence of force. Starting with the idea that force cannot be created or destroyed, the conclusions drawn earlier naturally follow. Every manifestation of force can only be understood as the effect of some prior force, whether it's an inorganic action, an animal movement, a thought, or a feeling. We must either accept this or claim that our changing states of consciousness are self-created. This means that both mental and physical energies are quantitatively linked to certain energies used in their creation and to other energies they generate; otherwise, nothing becomes something, and something becomes nothing. The options are to reject the persistence of force or to accept that every physical and mental change is caused by specific prior forces, and that from given amounts of these forces, only certain amounts of physical and mental changes can occur. Since the persistence of force is a fundamental principle of our awareness, it cannot be denied, and its unavoidable consequence must be accepted. This consequence cannot be made any more certain by adding more examples. The truth reached through deduction cannot be confirmed through induction. Each fact mentioned earlier is established only through the indirect acknowledgment of the persistence of force, from which it actually follows as a direct result. The most precise evidence of correlation and equivalence obtained through experimental inquiry is based on measuring the forces used and the forces produced. However, as shown in the last chapter, any such measurement process relies on a consistent unit of force, assumed to remain unchanged; this assumption can only be supported by the persistence of force. So, how can any reasoning based on this corollary prove the equally direct conclusion that when a specific quantity of force ceases to exist in one form, an equal quantity must come into existence in another form or forms? Clearly, the a priori truth expressed in this last conclusion cannot be more firmly established by any a posteriori evidence that the first conclusion assists us with.
“What then,” it may be asked, “is the use of these investigations by which the correlation and equivalence of forces is sought to be established as an inductive truth? Surely it will not be alleged that they are useless. Yet if this correlation cannot be made more certain by them than it is already, does not their uselessness necessarily follow?” No. They are of value as disclosing the many particular implications which the general truth does not specify. They are of value as teaching us how much of one mode of force is the equivalent of so much of another mode. They are of value as determining under what conditions each metamorphosis occurs. And they are of value as leading us to inquire in what shape the remnant of force has escaped, when the apparent results are not equivalent to the cause.
“What then,” one might ask, “is the purpose of these investigations aimed at establishing the relationship and equivalence of forces as an inductive reality? Surely nobody would claim they're useless. However, if they can't make this relationship any clearer than it already is, doesn't that imply they are pointless?” Not at all. They are valuable for revealing many specific implications that the general truth does not explain. They help us understand how much of one type of force is equivalent to a certain amount of another type. They are useful for determining the conditions under which each transformation takes place. And they prompt us to question in what form the remaining force has escaped when the observable results don't align with the cause.
CHAPTER X.
DIRECTION OF MOVEMENT.
§ 85. The Absolute Cause of changes, inclusive of those constituting Evolution, is not less incomprehensible in respect of the unity or duality of its action, than in all other respects. We cannot decide between the alternative suppositions, that phenomena are due to the variously-conditioned workings of a single force, and that they are due to the conflict of two forces. Whether, as some contend, everything is explicable on the hypothesis of universal pressure, whence what we call tension results differentially from inequalities of pressure in opposite directions; or whether, as might be with equal propriety contended, things are to be explained on the hypothesis of universal tension, from which pressure is a differential result; or whether, as most physicists hold, pressure and tension everywhere co-exist; are questions which it is impossible to settle. Each of these three suppositions makes the facts comprehensible, only by postulating an inconceivability. To assume a universal pressure, confessedly requires us to assume an infinite plenum—an unlimited space full of something which is everywhere pressed by something beyond; and this assumption cannot be mentally realized. That universal tension is the immediate agency to which phenomena are due, is an idea open to a parallel and equally fatal objection. And however verbally intelligible may be the proposition that pressure and tension everywhere co-exist, yet we cannot truly 287represent to ourselves one ultimate unit of matter as drawing another while resisting it.
§ 85. The ultimate cause of changes, including those that make up Evolution, is just as hard to understand regarding whether it acts as a single force or two forces, as it is in other aspects. We can't choose between the ideas that phenomena are the result of a single force acting in different ways or that they're caused by a struggle between two forces. Whether, as some argue, everything can be explained by the idea of universal pressure, which creates what we call tension due to unequal pressures in opposite directions; or whether, with equal validity, we can argue that everything should be explained by the idea of universal tension, from which pressure is a result; or whether, as most physicists believe, pressure and tension exist everywhere together; are questions that we simply can't resolve. Each of these three ideas makes the facts understandable only if we accept some inconceivable notion. To assume a universal pressure requires us to accept an infinite plenum—an endless space filled with something that's being pressed by something from beyond; and this idea cannot truly be grasped mentally. The belief that universal tension is the direct cause of phenomena also faces similar and equally serious objections. And although the idea that pressure and tension coexist everywhere may sound reasonable, we cannot realistically imagine one ultimate unit of matter pulling on another while also resisting it.
Nevertheless, this last belief is one which we are compelled to entertain. Matter cannot be conceived except as manifesting forces of attraction and repulsion. Body is distinguished in our consciousness from Space, by its opposition to our muscular energies; and this opposition we feel under the two-fold form of a cohesion that hinders our efforts to rend, and a resistance that hinders our efforts to compress. Without resistance there can be merely empty extension. Without cohesion there can be no resistance. Probably this conception of antagonistic forces, is originally derived from the antagonism of our flexor and extensor muscles. But be this as it may, we are obliged to think of all objects as made up of parts that attract and repel each other; since this is the form of our experience of all objects.
Nevertheless, this final belief is one that we have to accept. Matter can only be understood as showing forces of attraction and repulsion. We recognize a body as separate from Space because it opposes our muscular movements; we experience this opposition in two ways: as a cohesion that makes it hard to tear apart, and as a resistance that makes it hard to compress. Without resistance, there would just be empty space. Without cohesion, there would be no resistance. This idea of opposing forces probably comes from the way our flexor and extensor muscles work against each other. Regardless, we must think of all objects as made up of parts that attract and repel one another, since this is how we experience all objects.
By a higher abstraction results the conception of attractive and repulsive forces pervading space. We cannot dissociate force from occupied extension, or occupied extension from force; because we have never an immediate consciousness of either in the absence of the other. Nevertheless, we have abundant proof that force is exercised through what appears to our senses a vacuity. Mentally to represent this exercise, we are hence obliged to fill the apparent vacuity with a species of matter—an etherial medium. The constitution we assign to this etherial medium, however, like the constitution we assign to solid substance, is necessarily an abstract of the impressions received from tangible bodies. The opposition to pressure which a tangible body offers to us, is not shown in one direction only, but in all directions; and so likewise is its tenacity. Suppose countless lines radiating from its centre on every side, and it resists along each of these lines and coheres along each of these lines. Hence the constitution of those ultimate units through the instrumentality of which phenomena are interpreted. Be they atoms of ponderable matter or molecules of ether, the properties we 288conceive them to possess are nothing else than these perceptible properties idealized. Centres of force attracting and repelling each other in all directions, are simply insensible portions of matter having the endowments common to sensible portions of matter—endowments of which we cannot by any mental effort divest them. In brief, they are the invariable elements of the conception of matter, abstracted from its variable elements—size, form, quality, &c. And so to interpret manifestations of force which cannot be tactually experienced, we use the terms of thought supplied by our tactual experiences; and this for the sufficient reason that we must use these or none.
Through a higher level of abstraction, we can understand the concept of attractive and repulsive forces that fill space. We can't separate force from the space it occupies, or that space from the force itself, because we never have a clear awareness of one without the other. However, we have plenty of evidence that force acts through what seems to our senses like emptiness. To mentally visualize this action, we need to fill this apparent emptiness with some kind of matter—an etheric medium. The structure we give to this etheric medium, much like the structure we assign to solid substances, is necessarily a representation of the impressions we receive from tangible objects. The resistance to pressure that a tangible object presents isn’t shown in just one direction, but in all directions, and the same goes for its cohesion. Imagine countless lines extending outward from its center in every direction; it resists along each of these lines and holds together along each of these lines. This leads to the structure of the fundamental units that help us interpret phenomena. Whether they are atoms of solid matter or molecules of ether, the properties we imagine them to have are simply these visible properties idealized. Centers of force that attract and repel each other in every direction are merely imperceptible pieces of matter that have the same qualities as perceptible pieces of matter—qualities we cannot detach from them through any mental effort. In short, they are the constant elements of our concept of matter, separated from its changing elements—size, shape, quality, etc. To understand forces that we can’t physically experience, we use the ideas we gain from our tactile experiences, and we do this because we have to use these ideas or none at all.
After all that has been before shown, and after the hint given above, it needs scarcely be said that these universally co-existent forces of attraction and repulsion, must not be taken as realities, but as our symbols of the reality. They are the forms under which the workings of the Unknowable are cognizable by us—modes of the Unconditioned as presented under the conditions of our consciousness. But while knowing that the ideas thus generated in us are not absolutely true, we may unreservedly surrender ourselves to them as relatively true; and may proceed to evolve a series of deductions having a like relative truth.
Given everything that has been discussed so far, and the hint provided above, it hardly needs to be said that these universally present forces of attraction and repulsion should not be viewed as absolute realities, but rather as our symbols of reality. They are the frameworks through which the workings of the Unknowable are perceivable to us—ways of the Unconditioned as experienced within the limits of our awareness. However, while acknowledging that the ideas generated in us are not entirely true, we can fully embrace them as relatively true; and we can go ahead and develop a series of deductions that possess a similar relative truth.
§ 86. From universally co-existent forces of attraction and repulsion, there result certain laws of direction of all movement. Where attractive forces alone are concerned, or rather are alone appreciable, movement takes place in the direction of their resultant; which may, in a sense, be called the line of greatest traction. Where repulsive forces alone are concerned, or rather are alone appreciable, movement takes place along their resultant; which is usually known as the line of least resistance. And where both attractive and repulsive forces are concerned, or are appreciable, movement takes place along the resultant of all the tractions and resistances. Strictly speaking, this last is the sole law; since, by the 289hypothesis, both forces are everywhere in action. But very frequently the one kind of force is so immensely in excess that the effect of the other kind may be left out of consideration. Practically we may say that a body falling to the Earth, follows the line of greatest traction; since, though the resistance of the air must, if the body be irregular, cause some divergence from this line, (quite perceptible with feathers and leaves,) yet ordinarily the divergence is so slight that we may omit it. In the same manner, though the course taken by the steam from an exploding boiler, differs somewhat from that which it would take were gravitation out of the question; yet, as gravitation affects its course infinitesimally, we are justified in asserting that the escaping steam follows the line of least resistance. Motion then, we may say, always follows the line of greatest traction, or the line of least resistance, or the resultant of the two: bearing in mind that though the last is alone strictly true, the others are in many cases sufficiently near the truth for practical purposes.
§ 86. From the universally existing forces of attraction and repulsion, certain laws of movement direction result. When only attractive forces are at play, or rather when they are the only ones we can clearly see, movement occurs in the direction of their combined effect, which can be referred to as the line of greatest traction. When only repulsive forces are relevant, or rather when they alone are noticeable, movement takes place along their combined effect, typically known as the line of least resistance. When both attractive and repulsive forces are relevant, or noticeable, movement occurs along the combined effect of all the attractions and resistances. Technically, this last point is the only law; since, by assumption, both forces are active everywhere. However, often one kind of force is so overwhelmingly strong that the other can be ignored. Practically, we can say that a body falling to the Earth follows the line of greatest traction; since, although air resistance may cause some deviation from this line (which is quite noticeable with feathers and leaves), ordinarily the deviation is so minor that we can overlook it. Similarly, while the path taken by steam from an exploding boiler differs somewhat from what it would be without gravity, since gravity affects its path only slightly, we can assert that the escaping steam follows the line of least resistance. Therefore, we can say that motion always follows the line of greatest traction, or the line of least resistance, or the combined effect of both: keeping in mind that while the last point is the only one that is strictly true, the others are often close enough to the truth for practical purposes.
Movement set up in any direction is itself a cause of further movement in that direction, since it is the embodiment of a surplus force in that direction. This holds equally with the transit of matter through space, the transit of matter through matter, and the transit through matter of any kind of vibration. In the case of matter moving through space, this principle is expressed in the law of inertia—a law on which the calculations of physical astronomy are wholly based. In the case of matter moving through matter, we trace the same truth under the familiar experience that any breach made by one solid through another, or any channel formed by a fluid through a solid, becomes a route along which, other things equal, subsequent movements of like nature take place. And in the case of motion passing through matter under the form of an impulse communicated from part to part, the facts of magnetization go to show that the establishment of undulations along certain lines, determines their continuance along those lines.
Movement in any direction causes more movement in that same direction because it reflects an excess of force pushing that way. This is true for the movement of objects through space, for objects moving through other objects, and for any kind of vibration passing through matter. When it comes to objects moving through space, this principle is outlined in the law of inertia, which is the foundation for the calculations in physical astronomy. With objects moving through each other, we can see the same principle in the everyday experience of how a solid pushing through another solid, or a liquid flowing through a solid, creates a pathway that makes future similar movements more likely. Additionally, when motion transfers through matter as an impulse from one part to another, the phenomena of magnetization demonstrate that the creation of waves along specific paths leads to their continuation along those paths.
290It further follows from the conditions, that the direction of movement can rarely if ever be perfectly straight. For matter in motion to pursue continuously the exact line in which it sets out, the forces of attraction and repulsion must be symmetrically disposed around its path; and the chances against this are infinitely great. The impossibility of making an absolutely true edge to a bar of metal—the fact that all which can be done by the best mechanical appliances, is to reduce the irregularities of such an edge to amounts that cannot be perceived without magnifiers—sufficiently exemplifies how, in consequence of the unsymmetrical distribution of forces around the line of movement, the movement is rendered more or less indirect. It may be well to add that in proportion as the forces at work are numerous and varied, the curve a moving body describes is necessarily complex: witness the contrast between the flight of an arrow and the gyrations of a stick tossed about by breakers.
290It also follows from the conditions that the direction of movement can rarely, if ever, be perfectly straight. For an object in motion to follow the exact line it started on, the forces pulling and pushing must be evenly distributed around its path; and the chances of that happening are incredibly slim. The impossibility of creating a perfectly straight edge on a metal bar—the fact that even the best machines can only make the imperfections of such an edge too small to see without magnification—illustrates how, due to the uneven distribution of forces around the movement path, the movement becomes more or less indirect. It’s also worth mentioning that as the number and variety of forces at play increase, the curve that a moving object traces out becomes necessarily more complex: consider the difference between the flight of an arrow and the chaotic movements of a stick tossed around by waves.
We have now to trace these laws of direction of movement throughout the process of Evolution, under its various forms. We have to note how every change in the arrangement of parts, takes place along the line of greatest traction, of least resistance, or of their resultant; how the setting up of motion along a certain line, becomes a cause of its continuance along that line; how, nevertheless, change of relations to external forces, always renders this line indirect; and how the degree of its indirectness increases with every addition to the number of influences at work.
We now need to follow these laws of movement direction throughout the process of evolution in its different forms. We should observe how every change in the arrangement of parts happens along the path of greatest traction, least resistance, or their combination; how initiating movement in a certain direction causes it to continue along that path; and how changes in relation to external forces always make this path indirect. Additionally, the degree of this indirectness increases with every new influence involved.
§ 87. If we assume the first stage in nebular condensation to be the precipitation into flocculi of denser matter previously diffused through a rarer medium, (a supposition both physically justified, and in harmony with certain astronomical observations,) we shall find that nebular motion is interpretable in pursuance of the above general laws. Each portion of such vapour-like matter must begin to move towards the common 291centre of gravity. The tractive forces which would of themselves carry it in a straight line to the centre of gravity, are opposed by the resistant forces of the medium through which it is drawn. The direction of movement must be the resultant of these—a resultant which, in consequence of the unsymmetrical form of the flocculus, must be a curve directed, not to the centre of gravity, but towards one side of it. And it may be readily shown that in an aggregation of such flocculi, severally thus moving, there must, by composition of forces, eventually result a rotation of the whole nebula in one direction.
§ 87. If we assume the first stage in nebular condensation is the gathering of denser matter into clumps from a more diffuse medium (a theory that's both physically sound and aligns with certain astronomical observations), we can interpret nebular motion according to these general laws. Each part of this vapor-like matter must start moving toward the common center of gravity. The forces that would normally pull it in a straight line toward the center of gravity are countered by the resistance of the medium it's moving through. The direction of movement will be the result of these opposing forces—a direction that, due to the irregular shape of the clump, will curve toward one side of the center of gravity rather than directly toward it. It's easy to demonstrate that in a collection of such clumps, each moving in this way, the combination of forces will ultimately lead to a rotation of the entire nebula in one direction.
Merely noting this hypothetical illustration for the purpose of showing how the law applies to the case of nebular evolution, supposing it to have taken place, let us pass to the phenomena of the Solar System as now exhibited. Here the general principles above set forth are every instant exemplified. Each planet and satellite has a momentum which would, if acting alone, carry it forward in the direction it is at any instant pursuing. This momentum hence acts as a resistance to motion in any other direction. Each planet and satellite, however, is drawn by a force which, if unopposed, would take it in a straight line towards its primary. And the resultant of these two forces is that curve which it describes—a curve manifestly consequent on the unsymmetrical distribution of the forces around its path. This path, when more closely examined, supplies us with further illustrations. For it is not an exact circle or ellipse; which it would be were the tangential and centripetal forces the only ones concerned. Adjacent members of the Solar System, ever varying in their relative positions, cause what we call perturbations; that is, slight divergences in various directions from that circle or ellipse which the two chief forces would produce. These perturbations severally show us in minor degrees, how the line of movement is the resultant of all the forces engaged; and how this line becomes more complicated in proportion as the forces are multiplied. If instead of the motions of the 292planets and satellites as wholes, we consider the motions of their parts, we meet with comparatively complex illustrations. Every portion of the Earth’s substance in its daily rotation, describes a curve which is in the main a resultant of that resistance which checks its nearer approach to the centre of gravity, that momentum which would carry it off at a tangent, and those forces of gravitation and cohesion which keep it from being so carried off. If this axial motion be compounded with the orbital motion, the course of each part is seen to be a much more involved one. And we find it to have a still greater complication on taking into account that lunar attraction which mainly produces the tides and the precession of the equinoxes.
Just a quick note about this hypothetical example to illustrate how the law relates to nebular evolution, assuming it happened, let's move on to the phenomena of the Solar System as we see it now. The general principles mentioned are constantly demonstrated here. Each planet and satellite has momentum that would, if acting alone, propel it forward in the direction it’s currently heading. This momentum acts as a resistance to movement in any other direction. However, each planet and satellite is also pulled by a force that, if there were no opposition, would take it in a straight line toward its primary. The combination of these two forces creates the curve it follows—a curve that clearly results from the uneven distribution of forces around its path. When we take a closer look at this path, it gives us more insights. It’s not a perfect circle or ellipse, which it would be if only the tangential and centripetal forces were at play. The varying positions of nearby members of the Solar System create what we call perturbations; these are slight deviations in different directions from the circle or ellipse that the two main forces would produce. These perturbations show us, in smaller ways, how the line of movement results from all the forces involved, becoming more complicated as the number of forces increases. If, instead of looking at the motions of the planets and satellites as whole entities, we examine the motions of their individual parts, we find much more complex examples. Every part of the Earth, in its daily rotation, describes a curve that mainly results from the resistance holding it back from getting closer to the center of gravity, the momentum that would push it away at a tangent, and the gravitational and cohesive forces that prevent it from doing so. When we combine this axial motion with the orbital motion, the path of each part becomes even more complicated. It becomes increasingly complex when we consider the lunar attraction that primarily causes the tides and the precession of the equinoxes.
§ 88. We come next to terrestrial changes: present ones as observed, and past ones as inferred by geologists. Let us set out with the hourly-occurring alterations in the Earth’s atmosphere; descend to the slower alterations in progress on its surface; and then to the still slower ones going on beneath.
§ 88. Next, let’s look at changes on Earth: the changes happening right now, as observed, and those from the past, as inferred by geologists. We’ll start with the hourly changes in the Earth’s atmosphere; move on to the slower changes happening on its surface; and then to the even slower changes occurring beneath.
Masses of air, absorbing heat from surfaces warmed by the sun, expand, and so lessen the weight of the atmospheric columns of which they are parts. Hence they offer to adjacent atmospheric columns, diminished lateral resistance; and these, moving in the directions of the diminished resistance, displace the expanded air; while this, pursuing an upward course, displays a motion along that line in which there is least pressure. When again, by the ascent of such heated masses from extended areas like the torrid zone, there is produced at the upper surface of the atmosphere, a protuberance beyond the limits of equilibrium—when the air forming this protuberance begins to overflow laterally towards the poles; it does so because, while the tractive force of the Earth is nearly the same, the lateral resistance is greatly diminished. And throughout the course of each current thus generated, as well as throughout the course of each counter-current flowing: into the vacuum that is left, the direction is always the resultant 293of the Earth’s tractive force and the resistance offered by the surrounding masses of air: modified only by conflict with other currents similarly determined, and by collision with prominences on the Earth’s crust. The movements of water, in both its gaseous and liquid states, furnish further examples. In conformity with the mechanical theory of heat, it may be shown that evaporation is the escape of particles of water in the direction of least resistance; and that as the resistance (which is due to the pressure of the water diffused in a gaseous state) diminishes, the evaporation increases. Conversely, that rushing together of particles called condensation, which takes place when any portion of atmospheric vapour has its temperature much lowered, may be interpreted as a diminution of the mutual pressure among the condensing particles, while the pressure of surrounding particles remains the same; and so is a motion taking place in the direction of lessened resistance. In the course followed by the resulting rain-drops, we have one of the simplest instances of the joint effect of the two antagonist forces. The Earth’s attraction, and the resistance of atmospheric currents ever varying in direction and intensity, give as their resultants, lines which incline to the horizon in countless different degrees and undergo perpetual variations. More clearly still is the law exemplified by these same rain-drops when they reach the ground. In the course they take while trickling over its surface, in every rill, in every larger stream, and in every river, we see them descending as straight as the antagonism of surrounding objects permits. From moment to moment, the motion of water towards the Earth’s centre is opposed by the solid matter around and under it; and from moment to moment its route is the resultant of the lines of greatest traction and least resistance. So far from a cascade furnishing, as it seems to do, an exception, it furnishes but another illustration. For though all solid obstacles to a vertical fall of the water are removed, yet the water’s horizontal momentum is an obstacle; and the parabola in which the stream leaps from the projecting 294ledge, is generated by the combined gravitation and momentum. It may be well just to draw attention to the degree of complexity here produced in the line of movement by the variety of forces at work. In atmospheric currents, and still more clearly in water-courses (to which might be added ocean-streams), the route followed is too complex to be defined, save as a curve of three dimensions with an ever varying equation.
Masses of air absorb heat from sun-warmed surfaces, causing them to expand, which reduces the weight of the atmospheric columns they belong to. As a result, they provide less lateral resistance to nearby atmospheric columns. These columns move toward the areas of less resistance, displacing the expanded air, which rises while following the path of least pressure. When heated air masses ascend from large areas like the tropics, they create a bulge at the top of the atmosphere that goes beyond equilibrium limits. This bulge overflows sideways toward the poles because, while the Earth's pull is nearly constant, the lateral resistance significantly decreases. Throughout the movement of these currents and the counter-currents that fill the resulting vacuum, the direction is always a combination of the Earth’s gravitational pull and the resistance from surrounding air masses, occasionally modified by interactions with other currents and obstacles on the Earth’s surface. The movements of water, whether in gas or liquid form, provide additional examples. According to the mechanical theory of heat, evaporation happens as water particles escape in the direction of least resistance; as the resistance (caused by the pressure of water in a gaseous state) decreases, evaporation increases. Conversely, when any part of atmospheric vapor cools significantly, the resulting condensation can be seen as a decrease in the mutual pressure among the condensing particles, while the surrounding particles’ pressure remains constant, leading to motion in the direction of reduced resistance. The path of the resulting raindrops is one of the simplest examples of the combined effect of these opposing forces. The Earth’s gravity and the resistance from atmospheric currents, which constantly change in direction and strength, create resultant paths that tilt toward the horizontal at countless angles and continuously vary. This principle is even clearer when the raindrops hit the ground. As they trickle down across surfaces, we observe them moving as directly as the surrounding obstacles allow. At every moment, the water's downward motion toward the Earth’s center is resisted by solid materials around it; thus, its path is the result of the areas of greatest pull and least resistance. Instead of being an exception, a waterfall provides yet another example. While all solid barriers to a vertical drop are removed, the water’s horizontal momentum still creates an obstacle, and the parabolic path of the water as it cascades off an edge results from the interplay of gravity and momentum. It's important to note the complexity introduced in the movement's trajectory by the variety of forces acting on it. In atmospheric currents and, even more clearly, in water flows (including ocean currents), the paths taken are too intricate to be described except as three-dimensional curves with continuously changing equations.
The Earth’s solid crust undergoes changes that supply another group of illustrations. The denudation of lands and the depositing of the removed sediment in new strata at the bottoms of seas and lakes, is a process throughout which motion is obviously determined in the same way as is that of the water effecting the transport. Again, though we have no direct inductive proof that the forces classed as igneous, expend themselves along lines of least resistance; yet what little we know of them is in harmony with the belief that they do so. Earthquakes continually revisit the same localities, and special tracts undergo for long periods together successive elevations or subsidences,—facts which imply that already-fractured portions of the Earth’s crust are those most prone to yield under the pressure caused by further contractions. The distribution of volcanoes along certain lines, as well as the frequent recurrence of eruptions from the same vents, are facts of like meaning.
The Earth's solid crust experiences changes that provide another set of examples. The wearing away of land and the depositing of the eroded sediment into new layers at the bottoms of seas and lakes is a process where movement is clearly influenced in the same way as the water that facilitates the transportation. Additionally, even though we lack direct proof that the forces categorized as igneous act along paths of least resistance, what little we understand about them aligns with the idea that they do. Earthquakes frequently strike the same areas, and specific regions go through prolonged periods of uplift or sinking—facts that suggest that already-fractured parts of the Earth's crust are more likely to give way under the pressure caused by further contractions. The arrangement of volcanoes along certain paths, along with the repeated eruptions from the same vents, supports this idea.
§ 89. That organic growth takes place in the direction of least resistance, is a proposition that has been set forth and illustrated by Mr. James Hinton, in the Medico-Chirurgical Review for October, 1858. After detailing a few of the early observations which led him to this generalization, he formulates it thus:—
§ 89. Organic growth happens in the direction of least resistance, a concept introduced and explained by Mr. James Hinton in the Medico-Chirurgical Review for October 1858. After describing some of the initial observations that led him to this conclusion, he puts it this way:—
“Organic form is the result of motion.”
"Organic shape comes from movement."
“Motion takes the direction of least resistance.”
“Motion follows the path of least resistance.”
“Therefore organic form is the result of motion in the direction of least resistance.”
“Therefore, organic form comes from movement towards the path of least resistance.”
295After an elucidation and defence of this position, Mr. Hinton proceeds to interpret, in conformity with it, sundry phenomena of development. Speaking of plants he says:—
295After explaining and defending this position, Mr. Hinton goes on to interpret various development phenomena in line with it. When discussing plants, he states:—
“The formation of the root furnishes a beautiful illustration of the law of least resistance, for it grows by insinuating itself, cell by cell, through the interstices of the soil; it is by such minute additions that it increases, winding and twisting whithersoever the obstacles it meets in its path determine, and growing there most, where the nutritive materials are added to it most abundantly. As we look on the roots of a mighty tree, it appears to us as if they had forced themselves with giant violence into the solid earth. But it is not so; they were led on gently, cell added to cell, softly as the dews descended, and the loosened earth made way. Once formed, indeed, they expand with an enormous power, but the spongy condition of the growing radicles utterly forbids the supposition that they are forced into the earth. Is it not probable, indeed, that the enlargement of the roots already formed may crack the surrounding soil, and help to make the interstices into which the new rootlets grow?” * * *
“The way roots form is a great example of the law of least resistance. They grow by working their way through the gaps in the soil, cell by cell. It’s these tiny additions that help them grow, twisting and turning wherever they face obstacles, and thriving most where the nutrients are most plentiful. When we look at the roots of a massive tree, it might seem like they forced their way into the earth with great force. But that’s not the case; they were gently led forward, adding cell by cell, just as softly as dew falls and the loosened soil gives way. Once established, they do expand with incredible force, but the soft condition of the growing root tips completely rules out the idea that they are being shoved into the ground. Isn’t it likely that as the roots enlarge, they crack the surrounding soil, helping to create the gaps where new rootlets can grow?” * * *
“Throughout almost the whole of organic nature the spiral form is more or less distinctly marked. Now, motion under resistance takes a spiral direction, as may be seen by the motion of a body rising or falling through water. A bubble rising rapidly in water describes a spiral closely resembling a corkscrew, and a body of moderate specific gravity dropped into water may be seen to fall in a curved direction, the spiral tendency of which may be distinctly observed. * * * In this prevailing spiral form of organic bodies, therefore, it appears to me, that there is presented a strong prima facie case for the view I have maintained. * * * The spiral form of the branches of many trees is very apparent, and the universally spiral arrangement of the leaves around the stem of plants needs only to be referred to. * * * The heart commences as a spiral turn, 296and in its perfect form a manifest spiral may be traced through the left ventricle, right ventricle, right auricle, left auricle and appendix. And what is the spiral turn in which the heart commences but a necessary result of the lengthening, under a limit, of the cellular mass of which it then consists?” * * *
“Throughout almost all of organic nature, the spiral shape is clearly evident. Motion against resistance tends to follow a spiral path, as shown by the movement of an object rising or falling through water. A bubble quickly rising in water moves in a spiral pattern that looks much like a corkscrew, and an object with moderate density dropped into water can be seen falling in a curved path, clearly showing its spiral tendency. * * * In this widespread spiral form of organic bodies, it seems to me that there is a strong at first glance case for the perspective I have argued. * * * The spiral shape of the branches of many trees is quite obvious, and the common spiral arrangement of leaves around the stem of plants speaks for itself. * * * The heart starts as a spiral shape, and in its complete form, a clear spiral can be traced through the left ventricle, right ventricle, right atrium, left atrium, and appendix. And what is the spiral shape in which the heart begins but a necessary outcome of the elongation, within limits, of the cellular mass from which it is formed?” * * *
“Every one must have noticed the peculiar curling up of the young leaves of the common fern. The appearance is as if the leaf were rolled up, but in truth this form is merely a phenomenon of growth. The curvature results from the increase of the leaf, it is only another form of the wrinkling up, or turning at right angles by extension under limit.”
“Everyone has probably noticed how the young leaves of the common fern curl up. It looks like the leaf is rolled up, but really, this shape is just a growth phenomenon. The curvature comes from the leaf growing, and it’s just another way of wrinkling or bending at right angles as it extends within limits.”
“The rolling up or imbrication of the petals in many flower-buds is a similar thing; at an early period the small petals may be seen lying side by side, afterwards growing within the capsule, they become folded round one another.” * * *
“The way the petals roll up or overlap in many flower buds is similar. Early on, you can see the small petals lying next to each other; later, as they grow inside the capsule, they fold over one another.” * * *
“If a flower-bud be opened at a sufficiently early period, the stamens will be found as if moulded in the cavity between the pistil and the corolla, which cavity the antlers exactly fill; the stalks lengthen at an after period. I have noticed also in a few instances, that in those flowers in which the petals are imbricated, or twisted together, the pistil is tapering as growing up between the petals; in some flowers which have the petals so arranged in the bud as to form a dome (as the hawthorn; e. g.), the pistil is flattened at the apex, and in the bud occupies a space precisely limited by the stamens below, and the enclosing petals above and at the sides. I have not, however, satisfied myself that this holds good in all cases.”
“If a flower bud opens early enough, the stamens appear to be shaped within the space between the pistil and the petals, which is completely filled by the stamens; the stems grow longer later on. I've also noticed that in some flowers where the petals are overlapping or twisted together, the pistil narrows as it grows between the petals; in certain flowers that have petals arranged in a dome shape (like the hawthorn, for example), the pistil is flattened at the top and occupies a space that is clearly defined by the stamens below and the surrounding petals above and on the sides. However, I haven't been able to confirm that this is true in all cases.”
Without endorsing all Mr. Hinton’s illustrations, to some of which exception might be taken, his conclusion may be accepted as a large instalment of the truth. It is, however, to be remarked, that in the case of organic growth, as in all other cases, the line of movement is in strictness the resultant of tractive and resistant forces; and that the tractive forces here form so considerable an element 297that the formula is scarcely complete without them. The shapes of plants are manifestly modified by gravitation: the direction of each branch is not what it would have been were the tractive force of the Earth absent; and every flower and leaf is somewhat altered in the course of development by the weight of its parts. Though in animals such effects are less conspicuous, yet the instances in which flexible organs have their directions in great measure determined by gravity, justify the assertion that throughout the whole organism the forms of parts must be affected by this force.
Without agreeing with all of Mr. Hinton's examples, some of which might be challenged, his conclusion can be seen as a significant contribution to the truth. However, it's important to note that in the case of organic growth, just like in all other situations, the direction of movement is strictly the result of driving and resisting forces; and the driving forces here are such a substantial factor that the explanation is hardly complete without them. The shapes of plants are clearly influenced by gravity: the direction of each branch wouldn’t be the same if the Earth's pulling force didn’t exist; and every flower and leaf is somewhat changed during development by the weight of its parts. Although such effects are less obvious in animals, the examples where flexible organs have their directions largely shaped by gravity support the idea that throughout the entire organism, the shapes of parts must be influenced by this force.
The organic movements which constitute growth, are not, however, the only organic movements to be interpreted. There are also those which constitute function. And throughout these the same general principles are discernible. That the vessels along which blood, lymph, bile, and all the secretions, find their ways, are channels of least resistance, is a fact almost too conspicuous to be named as an illustration. Less conspicuous, however, is the truth, that the currents setting along these vessels are affected by the tractive force of the Earth: witness varicose veins; witness the relief to an inflamed part obtained by raising it; witness the congestion of head and face produced by stooping. And in the fact that dropsy in the legs gets greater by day and decreases at night, while, conversely, that œdematous fullness under the eyes common in debility, grows worse during the hours of reclining and decreases after getting up, shows us how the transudation of fluid through the walls of the capillaries, varies according as change of position changes the effect of gravity in different parts of the body.
The organic processes that drive growth aren’t the only ones that need to be understood. There are also those that make up function. Throughout these processes, the same basic principles are evident. It’s almost too obvious to mention that the pathways through which blood, lymph, bile, and all the secretions travel are the paths of least resistance. However, less obvious is the fact that the flow within these pathways is influenced by the Earth’s gravitational pull: consider varicose veins; consider the relief for an inflamed area when it’s elevated; consider the swelling of the head and face when bending over. The fact that swelling in the legs worsens during the day and lessens at night, while the puffiness under the eyes associated with weakness increases while lying down and decreases after getting up, illustrates how the movement of fluid through the walls of the capillaries changes based on body position and the effects of gravity in different areas.
It may be well in passing just to note the bearing of the principle on the development of species. From a dynamic point of view, “natural selection” is the evolution of Life along lines of least resistance. The multiplication of any kind of plant or animal in localities that are favourable to it, is a growth where the antagonistic forces are less than elsewhere. And the preservation of varieties that succeed better than their 298allies in coping with surrounding conditions, is the continuance of vital movement in those directions where the obstacles to it are most eluded.
It’s worth mentioning how this principle affects the development of species. From a dynamic perspective, “natural selection” is how life evolves along paths of least resistance. The increase of any type of plant or animal in favorable environments is a growth where opposing forces are weaker than in other areas. Additionally, the survival of varieties that perform better than their peers in dealing with surrounding conditions represents the ongoing movement of life in directions where obstacles are easiest to avoid.
§ 90. Throughout the phenomena of mind the law enunciated is not so readily established. In a large part of them, as those of thought and emotion, there is no perceptible movement. Even in sensation and volition, which show us in one part of the body an effect produced by a force applied to another part, the intermediate movement is inferential rather than visible. Such indeed are the difficulties that it is not possible here to do more than briefly indicate the proofs which might be given did space permit.
§ 90. In the study of the mind, the principles are not easily established. In many cases, like those involving thought and emotion, there’s no noticeable motion. Even in sensation and will, where we see an effect in one part of the body caused by force applied to another part, the intermediate movement is more inferred than visible. These challenges are so significant that it's not possible to provide more than a brief outline of the evidence that might be presented if there were enough space.
Supposing the various forces throughout an organism to be previously in equilibrium, then any part which becomes the seat of a further force, added or liberated, must be one from which the force, being resisted by smaller forces around, will initiate motion towards some other part of the organism. If elsewhere in the organism there is a point at which force is being expended, and which so is becoming minus a force which it before had, instead of plus a force which it before had not, and thus is made a point at which the re-action against surrounding forces is diminished; then, manifestly, a motion taking place between the first and the last of these points is a motion along the line of least resistance. Now a sensation implies a force added to, or evolved in, that part of the organism which is its seat; while a mechanical movement implies an expenditure or loss of force in that part of the organism which is its seat. Hence if, as we find to be the fact, motion is habitually propagated from those parts of an organism to which the external world adds forces in the shape of nervous impressions, to those parts of an organism which react on the external world through muscular contractions, it is simply a fulfilment of the law above enunciated. From this general conclusion we may pass to a more special one. When there is anything in the circumstances of an animal’s life, involving 299that a sensation in one particular place is habitually followed by a contraction in another particular place—when there is thus a frequently-repeated motion through the organism between these places; what must be the result as respects the line along which the motions take place? Restoration of equilibrium between the points at which the forces have been increased and decreased, must take place through some channel. If this channel is affected by the discharge—if the obstructive action of the tissues traversed, involves any reaction upon them, deducting from their obstructive power; then a subsequent motion between these two points will meet with less resistance along this channel than the previous motion met with; and will consequently take this channel still more decidedly. If so, every repetition will still further diminish the resistance offered by this route; and hence will gradually be formed between the two a permanent line of communication, differing greatly from the surrounding tissue in respect of the ease with which force traverses it. We see, therefore, that if between a particular impression and a particular motion associated with it, there is established a connexion producing what is called reflex action, the law that motion follows the line of least resistance, and that, if the conditions remain constant, resistance in any direction is diminished by motion occurring in that direction, supplies an explanation. Without further details it will be manifest that a like interpretation may be given to the succession of all other nervous changes. If in the surrounding world there are objects, attributes, or actions, that usually occur together, the effects severally produced by them in the organism will become so connected by those repetitions which we call experience, that they also will occur together. In proportion to the frequency with which any external connexion of phenomena is experienced, will be the strength of the answering internal connexion of nervous states. Thus there will arise all degrees of cohesion among nervous states, as there are all degrees of commonness among the surrounding co-existences and sequences 300that generate them: whence must result a general correspondence between associated ideas and associated actions in the environment.[13]
Assuming that the various forces within an organism are initially balanced, when any part experiences an additional or released force, it must be a part that is being resisted by smaller forces around it, causing it to start moving toward another part of the organism. If there’s another area in the organism where force is being used, leading to a decrease in that area’s previous force instead of an increase, this area will have reduced reactivity against surrounding forces. Therefore, any movement occurring between these two points is along the path of least resistance. A sensation means a force is added to or generated in that specific part of the organism, while a mechanical motion indicates an expenditure or loss of force in that specific area. Thus, as we discover to be true, motion is typically transferred from the parts of an organism where external forces, in the form of nerve signals, are added to those parts that respond to the outside world through muscle contractions. This simply demonstrates the previously stated law. From this general conclusion, we can move to a more specific one. When the conditions in an animal’s life often involve a sensation in one specific area followed by a contraction in another specific area—leading to frequent movement through the organism between these points—what will happen regarding the path along which these motions occur? There must be a restoration of equilibrium between the points where forces have increased and decreased through some channel. If this channel is affected by the discharge—if the tissue's obstructive action involved results in some reaction that reduces their obstructive power—then the next motion between these two points will encounter less resistance along this channel than the previous motion did, and will thus take this route even more decisively. As a result, each repetition will further reduce the resistance offered by this path, eventually establishing a lasting route between the two points that significantly differs from the surrounding tissue in terms of how easily force can move through it. Therefore, if a connection is formed between a specific impression and the related motion, resulting in what's called reflex action, the law that motion follows the path of least resistance, and that, if conditions remain unchanged, resistance in any direction decreases with movement in that direction, provides an explanation. Without getting into more details, it’s clear that a similar interpretation can be applied to the sequence of all other nerve changes. If there are objects, attributes, or actions in the external world that usually occur together, the individual effects they produce in the organism will become linked through those repetitions known as experience, causing them to also occur together. The more frequently any external phenomenon is experienced together, the stronger the corresponding internal connection of nerve states will be. This will create varying degrees of connection among nerve states, just as there are varying degrees of commonality among the surrounding coexistences and sequences that generate them, resulting in a general correspondence between associated ideas and associated actions in the environment.
The relation between emotions and actions may be similarly construed. As a first illustration let us observe what happens with emotions that are undirected by volitions. These, like feelings in general, expend themselves in generating organic changes, and chiefly in muscular contractions. As was pointed out in the last chapter, there result movements of the involuntary and voluntary muscles, that are great in proportion as the emotions are strong. It remains here to be pointed out, however, that the order in which these muscles are affected is explicable only on the principle above set forth. Thus, a pleasurable or painful state of mind of but slight intensity, does little more than increase the pulsations of the heart. Why? For the reason that the relation between nervous excitement and vascular contraction, being common to every genus and species of feeling, is the one of most frequent repetition; that hence the nervous connexion is, in the way above shown, the one which offers the least resistance to a discharge; and is therefore the one along which a feeble force produces motion. A sentiment or passion that is somewhat stronger, affects not only the heart but the muscles of the face, and especially those around the mouth. Here the like explanation applies; since these muscles, being both comparatively small, and, for purposes of speech, perpetually used, offer less resistance than other voluntary muscles to the nerve-motor force. By a further increase of emotion the respiratory and vocal muscles become perceptibly excited. Finally, under strong passion, the muscles in general of the trunk and limbs are violently contracted. Without saying that the facts can be thus interpreted in all their details (a 301task requiring data impossible to obtain) it may be safely said that the order of excitation is from muscles that are small and frequently acted on, to those which are larger and less frequently acted on. The single instance of laughter, which is an undirected discharge of feeling that affects first the muscles round the mouth, then those of the vocal and respiratory apparatus, then those of the limbs, and then those of the spine;[14] suffices to show that when no special route is opened for it, a force evolved in the nervous centres produces motion along channels which offer the least resistance, and if it is too great to escape by these, produces motion along channels offering successively greater resistance.
The connection between emotions and actions can be understood in a similar way. To illustrate, let’s look at what occurs with emotions that aren’t guided by conscious decisions. These, like feelings in general, result in physical changes, mainly in muscle contractions. As mentioned in the last chapter, movements of both involuntary and voluntary muscles are more intense when the emotions are strong. It's important to note the sequence in which these muscles are affected, which can only be explained by the principle stated earlier. For example, a mild pleasurable or painful feeling mostly just causes an increase in heart rate. Why? Because the link between nervous excitement and blood vessel contraction is common to every type of feeling, making it the most frequently observed; thus, this nervous connection offers the least resistance to a release and allows a weak force to create motion. A somewhat stronger feeling impacts not just the heart but also the facial muscles, particularly those around the mouth. The same reasoning applies here, since these muscles are smaller and constantly used for speech, offering less resistance than other voluntary muscles to the nerve-motor energy. With even greater emotion, the muscles involved in breathing and speaking become noticeably stimulated. Ultimately, with intense passion, the muscles throughout the torso and limbs contract powerfully. While we can’t detail every aspect of these phenomena (doing so would require data that’s difficult to gather), it’s safe to say that the order of muscle activation goes from smaller, frequently used muscles to larger, less often used ones. The example of laughter, a spontaneous discharge of emotion that first engages the muscles around the mouth, followed by those in the vocal and respiratory systems, then the limbs, and finally the spine, illustrates that when no specific path is available, energy generated in the nervous system moves along the paths that offer the least resistance, and if that energy is too strong to escape through these channels, it moves through increasingly resistant pathways.
Probably it will be thought impossible to extend this reasoning so as to include volitions. Yet we are not without evidence that the transition from special desires to special muscular acts, conforms to the same principle. It may be shown that the mental antecedents of a voluntary movement, are antecedents which temporarily make the line along which this movement takes place, the line of least resistance. For a volition, suggested as it necessarily is by some previous thought connected with it by associations that determine the transition, is itself a representation of the movements that are willed, and of their sequences. But to represent in consciousness certain of our own movements, is partially to arouse the sensations accompanying such movements, inclusive of those of muscular tension—is partially to excite the appropriate motor-nerves and all the other nerves implicated. That is to say, the volition is itself an incipient discharge along a line which previous experiences have rendered a line of least resistance. And the passing of volition into action is simply a completion of the discharge.
It’s probably thought impossible to expand this reasoning to include voluntary actions. However, we do have evidence that the shift from specific desires to specific muscle movements follows the same principle. It can be demonstrated that the mental triggers of a voluntary movement are triggers that temporarily make the path taken by this movement the easiest one. A voluntary action, as it necessarily arises from a previous thought connected to it through associations that dictate the transition, represents the movements we intend to make and their sequences. Representing certain movements in our consciousness partially activates the sensations related to those movements, including feelings of muscle tension—partially exciting the relevant motor nerves and all other involved nerves. In other words, the intention is itself a preliminary discharge along a path that prior experiences have made the easiest route. The transition from intention to action is simply the completion of that discharge.
One corollary from this must be noted before proceeding; namely, that the particular set of muscular movements by which any object of desire is reached, are movements implying 302the smallest total of forces to be overcome. As each feeling generates motion along the line of least resistance, it is tolerably clear that a group of feelings, constituting a more or less complex desire, will generate motion along a series of lines of least resistance. That is to say, the desired end will be achieved with the smallest expenditure of effort. Should it be objected that through want of knowledge or want of skill, a man often pursues the more laborious of two courses, and so overcomes a larger total of opposing forces than was necessary; the reply is, that relatively to his mental state the course he takes is that which presents the fewest difficulties. Though there is another which in the abstract is easier, yet his ignorance of it, or inability to adopt it, is, physically considered, the existence of an insuperable obstacle to the discharge of his energies in that direction. Experience obtained by himself, or communicated by others, has not established in him such channels of nervous communication as are required to make this better course the course of least resistance to him.
One important point to note before moving on is that the specific set of muscle movements used to reach any desired object involves the smallest total amount of forces to overcome. Since each feeling creates motion along the path of least resistance, it’s clear that a combination of feelings, making up a more or less complex desire, will lead to motion along several paths of least resistance. This means that the desired outcome will be achieved with the least amount of effort. If someone argues that due to a lack of knowledge or skill, a person often chooses the more difficult of two options and thus faces a larger total of opposing forces than necessary, the response is that, relative to his mental state, the path he chooses presents the fewest obstacles. While there may be another option that is theoretically easier, his ignorance of it or inability to pursue it serves as a significant barrier to directing his energies in that direction. The experience he has gained, whether personally or shared by others, has not created the necessary pathways for nervous communication that would make this better option the path of least resistance for him.
§ 91. As in individual animals, inclusive of man, motion follows lines of least resistance, it is to be inferred that among aggregations of men, the like will hold good. The changes in a society, being due to the joint actions of its members, the courses of such changes will be determined as are those of all other changes wrought by composition of forces.
§ 91. Just like in individual animals, including humans, motion tends to follow the easiest paths. Therefore, it's reasonable to assume that the same applies to groups of people. The changes within a society occur because of the collective actions of its members, and the direction of these changes will be shaped in the same way as all other changes caused by the combination of forces.
Thus when we contemplate a society as an organism, and observe the direction of its growth, we find this direction to be that in which the average of opposing forces is the least. Its units have energies to be expended in self-maintenance and reproduction. These energies are met by various environing energies that are antagonistic to them—those of geological origin, those of climate, of wild animals, of other human races with whom they are at enmity or in competition. And the tracts the society spreads over, are those in which there is the smallest total antagonism. Or, reducing 303the matter to its ultimate terms, we may say that these social units have jointly and severally to preserve themselves and their offspring from those inorganic and organic forces which are ever tending to destroy them (either indirectly by oxidation and by undue abstraction of heat, or directly by bodily mutilation); that these forces are either counteracted by others which are available in the shape of food, clothing, habitations, and appliances of defence, or are, as far as may be, eluded; and that population spreads in whichever directions there is the readiest escape from these forces, or the least exertion in obtaining the materials for resisting them, or both. For these reasons it happens that fertile valleys where water and vegetal produce abound, are early peopled. Sea-shores, too, supplying a large amount of easily-gathered food, are lines along which mankind have commonly spread. The general fact that, so far as we can judge from the traces left by them, large societies first appeared in those tropical regions where the fruits of the earth are obtainable with comparatively little exertion, and where the cost of maintaining bodily heat is but slight, is a fact of like meaning. And to these instances may be added the allied one daily furnished by emigration; which we see going on towards countries presenting the fewest obstacles to the self-preservation of individuals, and therefore to national growth. Similarly with that resistance to the movements of a society which neighbouring societies offer. Each of the tribes or nations inhabiting any region, increases in numbers until it outgrows its means of subsistence. In each there is thus a force ever pressing outwards on to adjacent areas—a force antagonized by like forces in the tribes or nations occupying those areas. And the ever-recurring wars that result—the conquests of weaker tribes or nations, and the over-running of their territories by the victors, are instances of social movements taking place in the directions of least resistance. Nor do the conquered peoples, when they escape extermination or enslavement, fail to show us 304movements that are similarly determined. For migrating as they do to less fertile regions—taking refuge in deserts or among mountains—moving in a direction where the resistance to social growth is comparatively great; they still do this only under an excess of pressure in all other directions: the physical obstacles to self-preservation they encounter, being really less than the obstacles offered by the enemies from whom they fly.
So, when we think of society as an organism and look at how it grows, we see that its growth happens in the direction where the average opposing forces are the weakest. The members of society have energy for self-sustenance and reproduction, and this energy is challenged by various external forces—like those from geology, climate, wild animals, or other human groups they’re in conflict or competition with. The areas where society expands are those with the least overall opposition. To put it simply, these social groups need to protect themselves and their offspring from both inorganic and organic forces that constantly threaten to destroy them (whether indirectly through oxidation and loss of heat, or directly through physical harm). These threats are either countered by resources like food, clothing, shelter, and tools for defense, or avoided as much as possible. Population grows in directions where escaping these threats is easiest, or where it requires the least effort to gather what’s needed to resist them, or both. For these reasons, fertile valleys with plenty of water and vegetation are populated early on. Coastal areas, which offer a lot of easily accessible food, are also places where humans tend to spread. The general observation that large societies first developed in tropical regions, where resources are readily available and the cost to maintain body heat is low, supports this idea. We can add the example of emigration, which shows people moving to places with the fewest challenges to their survival, and consequently to the growth of their nations. Similarly, the neighboring societies resist the movements of a society. Each tribe or nation grows until it surpasses its means of subsistence. There’s a constant outward force pressing into nearby areas, met by similar forces from the tribes or nations already there. The frequent wars, conquests of weaker tribes, and the takeover of their lands by stronger ones are examples of social changes heading towards the path of least resistance. The conquered populations, when they manage to avoid extermination or enslavement, also show movements shaped by similar pressures. They migrate to less fertile areas—seeking refuge in deserts or mountains—moving toward places where resistance to growth is relatively high, but they do this only because the pressure in all other directions is even greater: the physical challenges to their survival are less than the threats posed by their enemies.
Internal social movements may also be thus interpreted. Localities naturally fitted for producing particular commodities—that is, localities in which such commodities are got at the least cost of force—that is, localities in which the desires for these commodities meet with the least resistance; become localities especially devoted to the obtainment of these commodities. Where soil and climate render wheat a profitable crop, or a crop from which the greatest amount of life-sustaining power is gained by a given quantity of effort, the growth of wheat becomes the dominant industry. Where wheat cannot be economically produced, oats, or rye, or maize, or rice, or potatoes, is the agricultural staple. Along sea-shores men support themselves with least effort by catching fish; and hence choose fishing as an occupation. And in places that are rich in coal or metallic ores, the population, finding that labour devoted to the raising of these materials brings a larger return of food and clothing than when otherwise directed, becomes a population of miners. This last instance introduces us to the phenomena of exchange; which equally illustrate the general law. For the practice of barter begins as soon as it facilitates the fulfilment of men’s desires, by diminishing the exertion needed to reach the objects of those desires. When instead of growing his own corn, weaving his own cloth, sewing his own shoes, each man began to confine himself to farming, or weaving, or shoemaking; it was because each found it more laborious to make everything he wanted, than to make a great quantity of one thing and barter the surplus for the rest: by exchange, each 305procured the necessaries of life without encountering so much resistance. Moreover, in deciding what commodity to produce, each citizen was, as he is at the present day, guided in the same manner. For besides those local conditions which determine whole sections of a society towards the industries easiest for them, there are also individual conditions and individual aptitudes which to each citizen render certain occupations preferable; and in choosing those forms of activity which their special circumstances and faculties dictate, these social units are severally moving towards the objects of their desires in the directions which present to them the fewest obstacles. The process of transfer which commerce pre-supposes, supplies another series of examples. So long as the forces to be overcome in procuring any necessary of life in the district where it is consumed, are less than the forces to be overcome in procuring it from an adjacent district, exchange does not take place. But when the adjacent district produces it with an economy that is not out-balanced by cost of transit—when the distance is so small and the route so easy that the labour of conveyance plus the labour of production is less than the labour of production in the consuming district, transfer commences. Movement in the direction of least resistance is also seen in the establishment of the channels along which intercourse takes place. At the outset, when goods are carried on the backs of men and horses, the paths chosen are those which combine shortness with levelness and freedom from obstacles—those which are achieved with the smallest exertion. And in the subsequent formation of each highway, the course taken is that which deviates horizontally from a straight line so far only as is needful to avoid vertical deviations entailing greater labour in draught. The smallest total of obstructive forces determines the route, even in seemingly exceptional cases; as where a detour is made to avoid the opposition of a landowner. All subsequent improvements, ending in macadamized roads, canals, and railways, which reduce the antagonism 306of friction and gravity to a minimum, exemplify the same truth. After there comes to be a choice of roads between one point and another, we still see that the road chosen is that along which the cost of transit is the least: cost being the measure of resistance. Even where, time being a consideration, the more expensive route is followed, it is so because the loss of time involves loss of force. When, division of labour having been carried to a considerable extent and means of communication made easy, there arises a marked localization of industries, the relative growths of the populations devoted to them may be interpreted on the same principle. The influx of people to each industrial centre, as well as the rate of multiplication of those already inhabiting it, is determined by the payment for labour; that is—by the quantity of commodities which a given amount of effort will obtain. To say that artisans flock to places where, in consequence of facilities for production, an extra proportion of produce can be given in the shape of wages; is to say that they flock to places where there are the smallest obstacles to the support of themselves and families. Hence, the rapid increase of number which occurs in such places, is really a social growth at points where the opposing forces are the least.
Internal social movements can also be understood this way. Areas that are naturally suited for producing certain goods—meaning areas where these goods can be obtained with the least amount of effort—become specialized in acquiring those goods. Where soil and climate make wheat a viable crop, or where it yields the most life-sustaining energy for a certain amount of effort, wheat farming becomes the main industry. Where wheat can't be profitably grown, oats, rye, maize, rice, or potatoes become the staple crops. By the sea, people find it easiest to catch fish for sustenance, leading them to choose fishing as a livelihood. In regions rich in coal or metals, the population becomes miners, as they discover that labor spent extracting these resources provides more food and clothing than when directed elsewhere. This last example leads us to the concept of exchange, which illustrates this general principle. Bartering starts as soon as it makes fulfilling people's needs easier by reducing the effort required to obtain what they want. Instead of growing all their own corn, weaving their own fabric, and making their own shoes, people began to focus on specific tasks, finding it less labor-intensive to produce a large quantity of one item and trade the surplus for other necessities. Through exchange, individuals can acquire the essentials of life with less friction. Additionally, when deciding what to produce, individuals are guided in the same way as today. Beyond the local conditions influencing entire sectors of society towards the easiest industries, there are also individual circumstances and aptitudes that make certain jobs more attractive to each person. By selecting activities dictated by their unique circumstances and skills, these individuals are pursuing their goals along paths that present the least resistance. The transfer process that commerce relies on provides more examples. As long as the effort needed to obtain any essential good in the place of consumption is less than what’s required to get it from a nearby area, exchange doesn’t happen. However, when a nearby area offers it at a lower cost than the effort of transport—when the distance is short and the route easy, making the combined effort of transporting and producing less than the effort needed in the consuming area—exchange begins. The principle of moving towards the least resistance is also evident in establishing trade routes. Initially, when goods are carried by people and animals, the chosen paths are those that are the shortest, flattest, and least obstructed—those requiring the least effort. In building highways, the route taken is adjusted only as much as necessary to avoid steep areas that would require more effort to haul goods. The route is determined by the least total of obstructive forces, even in seemingly unique cases, like when a detour is made to avoid a landowner's opposition. All subsequent enhancements, resulting in paved roads, canals, and railways that minimize friction and gravity resistance, reflect the same principle. After there are choices of routes between two points, the selected route is still the one with the lowest transport cost: cost being a measure of resistance. Even when the more expensive route is chosen because time is a factor, it’s because saving time means conserving effort. When labor has been significantly divided and communication becomes easy, marked industrial localization occurs. The growth of populations in these centers can be explained by the same principle. The influx of people into each industrial hub, as well as the rate at which those already there multiply, is determined by the pay for labor—which refers to the quantity of goods that can be obtained with a given amount of effort. To say that workers gather in areas offering better production conditions and higher wages is to say they move to places where there are fewer obstacles to their livelihoods and those of their families. Therefore, the rapid population increase in such areas is truly a social expansion occurring where opposing forces are minimized.
Nor is the law less clearly to be traced in those functional changes daily going on. The flow of capital into businesses yielding the largest returns; the buying in the cheapest market and selling in the dearest; the introduction of more economical modes of manufacture; the development of better agencies for distribution; and all those variations in the currents of trade that are noted in our newspapers and telegrams from hour to hour; exhibit movement taking place in directions where it is met by the smallest total of opposing forces. For if we analyze each of these changes—if instead of interest on capital we read surplus of products which remains after maintenance of labourers; if we so interpret large interest or large surplus to imply labour expended with 307the greatest results; and if labour expended with the greatest results means muscular action so directed as to evade obstacles as far as possible; we see that all these commercial phenomena are complicated motions set up along lines of least resistance.
The law can also be seen in the daily functional changes happening around us. Money flows into businesses that provide the highest returns; purchasing occurs at the lowest prices while selling happens at the highest; more efficient manufacturing methods are introduced; better distribution channels are developed; and all the fluctuations in trade that our newspapers and telegrams report every hour show movement occurring in directions with the least opposing forces. If we break down each of these changes—if we replace interest on capital with the surplus of products left after paying workers; if we interpret large interest or a significant surplus as work done with the best results; and if we understand that work resulting in the best outcomes means physical effort directed to avoid obstacles as much as possible—we realize that all these commercial activities are complex movements following paths of least resistance.
Objections of two opposite kinds will perhaps be made to these sociological applications of the law. By some it may be said that the term force as here used, is used metaphorically—that to speak of men as impelled in certain directions by certain desires, is a figure of speech and not the statement of a physical fact. The reply is, that the foregoing illustrations are to be interpreted literally, and that the processes described are physical ones. The pressure of hunger is an actual force—a sensation implying some state of nervous tension; and the muscular action which the sensation prompts is really a discharge of it in the shape of bodily motion—a discharge which, on analyzing the mental acts involved, will be found to follow lines of least resistance. Hence the motions of a society whose members are impelled by this or any other desire, are actually, and not metaphorically, to be understood in the manner shown. An opposite objection may possibly be, that the several illustrations given are elaborated truisms; and that the law of direction of motion being once recognized, the fact that social movements, in common with all others, must conform to it, follows inevitably. To this it may be rejoined, that a mere abstract assertion that social movements must do this, would carry no conviction to the majority; and that it is needful to show how they do it. For social evolution to be interpreted after the method proposed, it is requisite that such generalisations as those of political economy shall be reduced to equivalent propositions expressed in terms of force and motion.
Objections of two opposite kinds might be raised regarding these sociological applications of the law. Some may argue that the term force, as used here, is metaphorical—that describing people as impelled in certain directions by certain desires is just a figure of speech and not a true physical fact. The response is that the examples provided should be taken literally, and that the processes described are physical ones. The feeling of hunger is a real force—a sensation indicating a state of nervous tension; and the muscular action that this sensation triggers is actually a release of that tension in the form of physical movement—a release that, when analyzing the mental actions involved, will follow the path of least resistance. Therefore, the actions of a society whose members are driven by this or any other desire should be understood in the way described, not as a metaphor. An opposing objection might be that the examples given are just elaborated truisms; and that once we recognize that the direction of motion follows a certain law, it naturally follows that social movements, like all others, must adhere to it. In response, one could say that a simple abstract claim that social movements must behave this way wouldn’t convince most people; it’s essential to demonstrate how they do so. For social evolution to be understood in the proposed manner, it’s necessary to translate general principles like those of political economy into equivalent statements expressed in terms of force and motion.
Social movements of these various orders severally conform to the two derivative principles named at the outset. In the first place we may observe how, once set up in given directions, such movements, like all others, tend to continue in 308these directions. A commercial mania or panic, a current of commodities, a social custom, a political agitation, or a popular delusion, maintains its course for a long time after its original source has ceased; and requires antagonistic forces to arrest it. In the second place it is to be noted that in proportion to the complexity of social forces is the tortuousness of social movements. The involved series of muscular contractions gone through by the artizan, that he may get the wherewithal to buy a loaf lying at the baker’s next door, show us how extreme becomes the indirectness of motion when the agencies at work become very numerous—a truth still better illustrated by the more public social actions; as those which end in bringing a successful man of business, towards the close of his life, into parliament.
Social movements of different kinds align with the two main principles mentioned earlier. First, we can see that once these movements are initiated in certain directions, they tend to keep going along those paths, just like any other movement. Whether it's a commercial craze or panic, a flow of goods, a social habit, a political movement, or a widespread belief, they continue for a long time even after their original drivers have disappeared; it often takes opposing forces to stop them. Second, it's important to point out that the more complex the social forces are, the more convoluted the social movements become. The complicated series of muscle movements that a worker goes through just to earn enough money to buy a loaf of bread next door illustrates how indirect the efforts can get when there are many factors in play—this truth is even clearer in more public social actions, like what it takes for a successful businessperson to end up in parliament later in life. 308
§ 92. And now of the general truth set forth in this chapter, as of that dealt with in the last, let us ask—what is our ultimate evidence? Must we accept it simply as an empirical generalization? or is it to be established as a corollary from a still deeper truth? The reader will anticipate the answer. We shall find it deducible from that datum of consciousness which underlies all science.
§ 92. Now, regarding the overall truth presented in this chapter, similar to what was discussed in the previous one, let's ask—what is our final proof? Do we have to accept it just as an empirical generalization? Or is it to be proven as a conclusion from an even deeper truth? The reader might already guess the answer. We will discover that it can be derived from the fundamental aspect of consciousness that forms the basis of all science.
Suppose several tractive forces, variously directed, to be acting on a given body. By what is known among mathematicians as the composition of forces, there may be found for any two of these, a single force of such amount and direction as to produce on the body an exactly equal effect. If in the direction of each of them there be drawn a straight line, and if the lengths of these two straight lines be made proportionate to the amounts of the forces; and if from the end of each line there be drawn a line parallel to the other, so as to complete a parallelogram; then the diagonal of this parallelogram represents the amount and direction of a force that is equivalent to the two. Such a resultant force, as it is called, may be found for any pair of forces throughout the group. Similarly, for any pair of such resultants a single 309resultant may be found. And by repeating this course, all of them may be reduced to two. If these two are equal and opposite—that is, if there is no line of greatest traction, motion does not take place. If they are opposite but not equal, motion takes place in the direction of the greater. And if they are neither equal nor opposite, motion takes place in the direction of their resultant. For in either of these cases there is an unantagonized force in one direction. And this residuary force that is not neutralized by an opposing one, must move the body in the direction in which it is acting. To assert the contrary is to assert that a force can be expended without effect—without generating an equivalent force; and by so implying that force can cease to exist, this involves a denial of the persistence of force. It needs scarcely be added that if in place of tractions we take resistances, the argument equally holds; and that it holds also where both tractions and resistances are concerned. Thus the law that motion follows the line of greatest traction, or the line of least resistance, or the resultant of the two, is a necessary deduction from that primordial truth which transcends proof.
Suppose several forces pulling in different directions are acting on a given object. Mathematicians refer to the method of combining forces to determine a single force that can produce the same effect on the object as any two of these forces. If we draw a straight line in the direction of each of these forces and make the lengths of these lines proportional to the strength of the forces, and then draw lines parallel to each from the end of the other to complete a parallelogram, the diagonal of this parallelogram represents the magnitude and direction of a force that is equivalent to the two combined. This resultant force can be found for any pair of forces in the group. Likewise, for any pair of resultants, a single resultant can also be determined. By repeating this process, all forces can be simplified down to two. If these two forces are equal and opposite—meaning there’s no dominant force in any direction—there will be no motion. If they are opposite but not equal, motion will occur in the direction of the stronger force. If they are neither equal nor opposite, motion will occur in the direction of their resultant. In either case, there is an unopposed force in one direction. This leftover force that is unbalanced by an opposing force must move the object in the direction it is acting. To suggest otherwise would imply that a force can be exerted without any effect—without producing an equal force, which essentially denies the existence of force itself. It should be noted that if we replace pulls with resistance, the same argument applies; and it also holds true when both pulls and resistance are considered. Therefore, the principle that motion follows the path of greatest pull, the path of least resistance, or the resultant of both, is a fundamental truth that is beyond proof.
Reduce the proposition to its simplest form, and it becomes still more obviously consequent on the persistence of force. Suppose two weights suspended over a pulley or from the ends of an equal-armed lever; or better still—suppose two men pulling against each other. In such cases we say that the heavier weight will descend, and that the stronger man will draw the weaker towards him. But now, if we are asked how we know which is the heavier weight or the stronger man; we can only reply that it is the one producing motion in the direction of its pull. Our only evidence of excess of force is the movement it produces. But if of two opposing tractions we can know one as greater than the other only by the motion it generates in its own direction, then the assertion that motion occurs in the direction of greatest traction is a truism. When, going a step further back, we seek a warrant 310for the assumption that of the two conflicting forces, that is the greater which produces motion in its own direction, we find no other than the consciousness that such part of the greater force as is unneutralized by the lesser, must produce its effect—the consciousness that this residuary force cannot disappear, but must manifest itself in some equivalent change—the consciousness that force is persistent. Here too, as before, it may be remarked that no amount of varied illustrations, like those of which this chapter mainly consists, can give greater certainty to the conclusion thus immediately drawn from the ultimate datum of consciousness. For in all cases, as in the simple ones just given, we can identify the greatest force only by the resulting motion. It is impossible for us ever to get evidence of the occurrence of motion in any other direction than that of the greatest force; since our measure of relative greatness among forces is their relative power of generating motion. And clearly, while the comparative greatness of forces is thus determined, no multiplication of instances can add certainty to a law of direction of movement which follows immediately from the persistence of force.
Reduce the idea to its simplest form, and it becomes even more obvious that it relies on the persistence of force. Imagine two weights hanging over a pulley or at the ends of an equal-arm lever; or even better—imagine two people pulling against each other. In these situations, we say that the heavier weight will drop and that the stronger person will pull the weaker one toward them. But if we are asked how we know which weight is heavier or which person is stronger, we can only say it’s the one causing motion in the direction of their pull. Our only proof of greater force is the movement it creates. If, of two opposing pulls, we can only identify the greater one by the motion it produces in its own direction, then saying that motion happens in the direction of the strongest pull is obvious. When we consider, again, the justification for assuming that of the two conflicting forces, the one that causes motion in its own direction is greater, the only justification we find is the awareness that the part of the greater force not canceled out by the lesser must produce an effect—the awareness that this remaining force cannot vanish but must show itself in some change—awareness that force is persistent. Here, too, as before, it’s important to note that no amount of different examples, like those in this chapter, can provide more certainty to the conclusion drawn from the primary data of consciousness. In all cases, as in the simple examples provided, we can only identify the greatest force through the resulting motion. We can never get evidence of motion happening in any direction other than that of the greatest force since our measure of how great forces are relative to each other is their ability to generate motion. And clearly, while the relative size of forces is determined this way, no number of examples can add certainty to a rule about the direction of movement that follows directly from the persistence of force.
From this same primordial truth, too, may be deduced the principle that motion once set up along any line, becomes itself a cause of subsequent motion along that line. The mechanical axiom that, if left to itself, matter moving in any direction will continue in that direction with undiminished velocity, is but an indirect assertion of the persistence of force; since it is an assertion that the force manifested in the transfer of a body along a certain length of a certain line in a certain time, cannot disappear without producing some equal manifestation—a manifestation which, in the absence of conflicting forces, must be a further transfer in the same direction at the same velocity. In the case of matter traversing matter the like inference is necessitated. Here indeed the actions are much more complicated. A liquid that follows a certain channel through or over a solid, as water along the Earth’s surface, loses part of its motion in the shape 311of heat, through friction and collision with the matters forming its bed. A further amount of its motion may be absorbed in overcoming forces which it liberates; as when it loosens a mass which falls into, and blocks up, its channel. But after these deductions by transformation into other modes of force, any further deduction from the motion of the water is at the expense of a reaction on the channel, which by so much diminishes its obstructive power: such reaction being shown in the motion acquired by the detached portions which are carried away. The cutting out of river-courses is a perpetual illustration of this truth. Still more involved is the case of motion passing through matter by impulse from part to part; as a nervous discharge through animal tissue. Some chemical change may be wrought along the route traversed, which may render it less fit than before for conveying a current. Or the motion may itself be in part metamorphosed into some obstructive form of force; as in metals, the conducting power of which is, for the time, decreased by the heat which the passage of electricity itself generates. The real question is, however, what structural modification, if any, is produced throughout the matter traversed, apart from incidental disturbing forces—apart from everything but the necessary resistance of the matter: that, namely, which results from the inertia of its units. If we confine our attention to that part of the motion which, escaping transformation, continues its course, then it is a corollary from the persistence of force that as much of this remaining motion as is taken up in changing the positions of the units, must leave these by so much less able to obstruct subsequent motion in the same direction.
From this same fundamental truth, we can also deduce the principle that once motion starts along a particular path, it in turn causes further motion along that same path. The mechanical principle that, if left alone, matter moving in any direction will keep moving in that direction at the same speed is simply a way of affirming the persistence of force; it asserts that the force shown in moving something along a specific distance in a certain timeframe cannot just vanish without creating some equal effect—an effect that, in the absence of opposing forces, must mean a continued movement in the same direction at the same speed. When it comes to matter moving through other matter, the same inference applies, though the actions here are more complex. For instance, a liquid moving through or over a solid, like water on the Earth's surface, loses some of its motion as heat due to friction and collisions with the materials it flows over. Additionally, some of its motion can be spent overcoming forces it creates; like when it dislodges a mass that falls into and blocks its path. However, after these transformations, any additional loss from the motion of the water results in a reaction on the bed it moves over, which decreases its resistance: this reaction is evident in the motion gained by the separated fragments that get carried away. The cutting of river paths is a constant example of this truth. The situation becomes even more complicated when motion transfers through matter by impact from one part to another; similar to a nerve signal traveling through animal tissue. Some chemical changes might occur along the way, making the pathway less suitable for conveying a current. Or some of the motion might change into a form of obstructive force; for example, in metals, their ability to conduct is temporarily reduced by the heat generated during the flow of electricity. The main question, though, is what structural changes, if any, happen in the substance being passed through, aside from incidental disturbing forces—everything except the necessary resistance of the matter itself, which comes from the inertia of its individual units. If we focus on that part of the motion which, avoiding transformation, keeps going, then it follows from the persistence of force that the amount of this remaining motion used for changing the positions of the units must leave those units less capable of hindering further motion in the same direction.
Thus in all the changes heretofore and at present displayed by the Solar System; in all those that have gone on and are still going on in the Earth’s crust; in all processes of organic development and function; in all mental actions and the effects they work on the body; and in all modifications of structure and activity in societies; the implied movements are 312of necessity determined in the manner above set forth. Every alteration in the arrangement of parts, constituting Evolution under each of its phases, must conform to this universal principle. Wherever we see motion, its direction must be that of the greatest force. And wherever we see the greatest force to be acting in a given direction, in that direction motion must ensue.
So, in all the changes that have happened and are currently happening in the Solar System; in everything that's been going on and is still happening in the Earth's crust; in all processes of organic development and function; in all mental actions and their effects on the body; and in all changes in structure and activity within societies; the underlying movements are 312inevitably determined in the way mentioned above. Every change in the arrangement of parts, which constitutes Evolution in all its forms, must follow this universal principle. Wherever we observe motion, its direction must be towards the greatest force. And wherever the greatest force is acting in a specific direction, motion must occur in that direction.
13. This paragraph is a re-statement, somewhat amplified, of an idea set forth in the Medico-Chirurgical Review for January, 1859 (pp. 189 and 190); and contains the germ of the intended fifth part of the Principles of Psychology, which was withheld for the reasons given in the preface to that work.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.This paragraph is a restatement, slightly expanded, of a concept presented in the Medico-Chirurgical Review from January 1859 (pp. 189 and 190); and it includes the foundation of the planned fifth part of the Principles of Psychology, which was omitted for the reasons explained in the preface to that work.
14. For details see a paper on “The Physiology of Laughter,” published in Macmillan’s Magazine for March 1860.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.For more information, check out a paper titled “The Physiology of Laughter,” published in Macmillan’s Magazine in March 1860.
CHAPTER XI.
The beat of movement.
§ 93. When the pennant of a vessel lying becalmed first shows the coming breeze, it does so by gentle undulations that travel from its fixed to its free end. Presently the sails begin to flap; and their blows against the mast increase in rapidity as the breeze rises. Even when, being fully bellied out, they are in great part steadied by the strain of the yards and cordage, their free edges tremble with each stronger gust. And should there come a gale, the jar that is felt on laying hold of the shrouds shows that the rigging vibrates; while the rush and whistle of the wind prove that in it, also, rapid undulations are generated. Ashore the conflict between the current of air and the things it meets results in a like rhythmical action. The leaves all shiver in the blast; each branch oscillates; and every exposed tree sways to and fro. The blades of grass and dried bents in the meadows, and still better the stalks in the neighbouring corn-fields, exhibit the same rising and falling movement. Nor do the more stable objects fail to do the like, though in a less manifest fashion; as witness the shudder that may be felt throughout a house during the paroxysms of a violent storm. Streams of water produce in opposing objects the same general effects as do streams of air. Submerged weeds growing in the middle of a brook, undulate from end to end. Branches brought down by the last flood, and left entangled at the bottom 314where the current is rapid, are thrown into a state of up and down movement that is slow or quick in proportion as they are large or small; and where, as in great rivers like the Mississippi, whole trees are thus held, the name “sawyers,” by which they are locally known, sufficiently describes the rhythm produced in them. Note again the effect of the antagonism between the current and its channel. In shallow places, where the action of the bottom on the water flowing over it is visible, we see a ripple produced—a series of undulations. And if we study the action and re-action going on between the moving fluid and its banks, we still find the principle illustrated, though in a different way. For in every rivulet, as in the mapped-out course of every great river, the bends of the stream from side to side throughout its tortuous course constitute a lateral undulation—an undulation so inevitable that even an artificially straightened channel is eventually changed into a serpentine one. Analogous phenomena may be observed where the water is stationary and the solid matter moving. A stick drawn laterally through the water with much force, proves by the throb which it communicates to the hand that it is in a state of vibration. Even where the moving body is massive, it only requires that great force should be applied to get a sensible effect of like kind: instance the screw of a screw-steamer, which instead of a smooth rotation falls into a rapid rhythm that sends a tremor through the whole vessel. The sound which results when a bow is drawn over a violin-string, shows us vibrations produced by the movement of a solid over a solid. In lathes and planing machines, the attempt to take off a thick shaving causes a violent jar of the whole apparatus, and the production of a series of waves on the iron or wood that is cut. Every boy in scraping his slate-pencil finds it scarcely possible to help making a ridged surface. If you roll a ball along the ground or over the ice, there is always more or less up and down movement—a movement that is visible while the velocity is considerable, but becomes too 315small and rapid to be seen by the unaided eye as the velocity diminishes. However smooth the rails, and however perfectly built the carriages, a railway-train inevitably gets into oscillations, both lateral and vertical. Even where moving matter is suddenly arrested by collision, the law is still illustrated; for both the body striking and the body struck are made to tremble; and trembling is rhythmical movement. Little as we habitually observe it, it is yet certain that the impulses our actions impress from moment to moment on surrounding objects, are propagated through them in vibrations. It needs but to look through a telescope of high power, to be convinced that each pulsation of the heart gives a jar to the whole room. If we pass to motions of another order—those namely which take place in the etherial medium—we still find the same thing. Every fresh discovery confirms the hypothesis that light consists of undulations. The rays of heat, too, are now found to have a like fundamental nature; their undulations differing from those of light only in their comparative length. Nor do the movements of electricity fail to furnish us with an illustration; though one of a different order. The northern aurora may often be observed to pulsate with waves of greater brightness; and the electric discharge through a vacuum shows us by its stratified appearance that the current is not uniform, but comes in gushes of greater and lesser intensity. Should it be said that at any rate there are some motions, as those of projectiles, which are not rhythmical, the reply is, that the exception is apparent only; and that these motions would be rhythmical if they were not interrupted. It is common to assert that the trajectory of a cannon ball is a parabola; and it is true that (omitting atmospheric resistance) the curve described differs so slightly from a parabola that it may practically be regarded as one. But, strictly speaking, it is a portion of an extremely eccentric ellipse, having the Earth’s centre of gravity for its remoter focus; and but for its arrest by the substance of the Earth, the cannon ball would travel 316round that focus and return to the point whence it started; again to repeat this slow rhythm. Indeed, while seeming at first sight to do the reverse, the discharge of a cannon furnishes one of the best illustrations of the principle enunciated. The explosion produces violent undulations in the surrounding air. The whizz of the shot, as it flies towards its mark, is due to another series of atmospheric undulations. And the movement to and from the Earth’s centre, which the cannon ball is beginning to perform, being checked by solid matter, is transformed into a rhythm of another order; namely, the vibration which the blow sends through neighbouring bodies.[15]
§ 93. When the flag of a ship at rest first indicates the arrival of a breeze, it does so with gentle movements that travel from its fixed end to its free end. Soon the sails start to flap, and their impacts against the mast become more frequent as the wind strengthens. Even when the sails are fully filled and are mostly steady due to the tension of the yards and rigging, their free edges still quiver with each stronger gust. And if a strong wind arrives, the jolt felt when gripping the shrouds shows that the rigging vibrates; while the sound and rush of the wind indicate that rapid movements are generated within it as well. On land, the struggle between the wind and the objects it encounters creates a similar rhythmic action. Leaves tremble in the gust; each branch sways; and every exposed tree rocks back and forth. The blades of grass and dried plants in the meadows, and especially the stalks in the nearby cornfields, display the same rising and falling motion. Even the more stable objects join in, though in a less noticeable way; for instance, the shudder felt throughout a house during the violent bursts of a storm. Streams of water cause similar effects in opposing objects as streams of air do. Weeds submerged in the center of a stream undulate from end to end. Branches knocked down by the last flood and left tangled at the bottom where the current is swift move up and down at a pace that varies depending on their size; and in large rivers like the Mississippi, entire trees caught in the currents are known locally as "sawyers," aptly describing the rhythm produced in them. Again, consider the effect of the struggle between the current and its channel. In shallow areas, where we can see how the bottom interacts with the flowing water, we observe ripples forming—a series of undulations. And if we examine the interactions between the moving water and its banks, we find similar principles at play, albeit differently. For in every stream, much like the defined paths of major rivers, the bends of the water from side to side create lateral undulations—an oscillation so inevitable that even channels that are straightened artificially eventually curve into serpentine shapes. Similar phenomena can be seen where the water is still and the solid matter moves. A stick drawn forcefully through the water demonstrates its vibration through the pulse it sends to the hand. Even when a large object is in motion, it only takes a great force to produce noticeable vibrations: for example, the screw of a screw-steamer doesn't rotate smoothly but engages in a rapid rhythm that sends vibrations throughout the entire vessel. The sound produced when a bow is drawn across a violin string illustrates the vibrations generated by a solid over a solid. In lathes and planing machines, attempting to take a thick shave results in a violent jolt of the entire machine, creating a series of waves on the iron or wood being cut. Every child knows that scraping a slate pencil inevitably creates a ridged surface. If you roll a ball on the ground or over ice, there’s always some up and down movement—visible when going fast, but too small and quick to see with the naked eye as speed decreases. No matter how smooth the tracks or how perfectly built the train, a railway train inevitably oscillates both sideways and vertically. Even when moving objects suddenly stop due to a collision, the principle is still evident; both the object striking and the one being struck vibrate, which is rhythmic movement. Although we don't typically notice it, it's clear that the impacts of our actions are transferred to surrounding objects through vibrations. It only takes a high-powered telescope to realize that each heartbeat creates a jolt felt throughout the room. If we switch to another type of motion—those that occur in the ether— we find the same concept. Every new discovery supports the idea that light is made up of undulations. Rays of heat are also now understood to share a similar fundamental nature, their undulations differing from those of light only in their wavelength. The movements of electricity provide yet another example, but of a different kind. The northern lights can often be seen pulsing with waves of varying brightness; and electric discharge through a vacuum shows its stratified appearance, indicating that the current is not uniform, but rather comes in bursts of greater and lesser intensity. If it is argued that some movements, such as those of projectiles, are not rhythmic, the response is that this exception is only apparent; these movements would be rhythmic if not interrupted. It's commonly stated that a cannonball follows a parabolic trajectory; and while it’s true that, disregarding air resistance, the path deviates very little from a parabola, it actually traces a part of a highly eccentric ellipse, with the Earth’s center of gravity as one of its foci; and if it weren't for hitting the ground, the cannonball would orbit around that focus, returning to where it started and repeating this slow rhythm. In fact, while it may initially seem counterintuitive, the firing of a cannon is one of the best illustrations of this principle. The explosion creates violent undulations in the surrounding air. The whistling sound of the shot flying towards its target results from another set of atmospheric undulations. And the vertical movement the cannonball begins to make towards the Earth's center is interrupted by solid matter, transforming into a different kind of rhythm—the vibrations that the impact sends through nearby objects.[15]
Rhythm is very generally not simple but compound. There are usually at work various forces, causing undulations differing in rapidity; and hence it continually happens that besides the primary rhythms there are secondary rhythms, produced by the periodic coincidence and antagonism of the primary ones. Double, triple, and even quadruple rhythms, are thus generated. One of the simplest instances is afforded by what in acoustics are known as “beats:” recurring intervals of sound and silence which are perceived when two notes of nearly the same pitch are struck together; and which are due to the alternate correspondence and antagonism of the atmospheric waves. In like manner the various phenomena due to what is called interference of light, severally result from the periodic agreement and disagreement of etherial undulations—undulations which, by alternately intensifying and neutralizing each other, produce intervals of increased and diminished light. On the sea-shore may be noted sundry instances of compound rhythm. We have that of the tides, in which the daily rise and fall undergoes a fortnightly increase and decrease, due to the alternate coincidence and antagonism of the solar and lunar 317attractions. We have again that which is perpetually furnished by the surface of the sea: every large wave bearing smaller ones on its sides, and these still smaller ones; with the result that each flake of foam, along with the portion of water bearing it, undergoes minor ascents and descents of several orders while it is being raised and lowered by the greater billows. A quite different and very interesting example of compound rhythm, occurs in the little rills which, at low tide, run over the sand out of the shingle banks above. Where the channel of one of these is narrow, and the stream runs strongly, the sand at the bottom is raised into a series of ridges corresponding to the ripple of the water. On watching for a short time, it will be seen that these ridges are being raised higher and the ripple growing stronger; until at length, the action becoming violent, the whole series of ridges is suddenly swept away, the stream runs smoothly, and the process commences afresh. Instances of still more complex rhythms might be added; but they will come more appropriately in connexion with the several forms of Evolution, hereafter to be dealt with.
Rhythm is generally not simple but complex. Various forces are usually at play, causing waves that differ in speed; and so it often happens that alongside the main rhythms, there are secondary rhythms created by the periodic agreement and conflict of the primary ones. This results in double, triple, and even quadruple rhythms. One of the simplest examples is found in acoustics, known as “beats”: the recurring intervals of sound and silence perceived when two notes of nearly the same pitch are played together, caused by the alternating agreement and conflict of the atmospheric waves. Similarly, the different phenomena from what's called light interference arise from the periodic alignment and misalignment of ethereal waves—waves that alternately amplify and neutralize one another, creating areas of increased and decreased light. On the beach, you can see various examples of compound rhythm. There’s the rhythm of the tides, where the daily rise and fall experiences a fortnightly increase and decrease due to the alternating alignment and conflict of the sun's and moon's gravitational pulls. We also observe this in the surface of the sea: every large wave carries smaller ones on its sides, which in turn carry even smaller ones. This results in each piece of foam, together with the water supporting it, experiencing minor ups and downs of various orders while it is lifted and lowered by the larger waves. A different and very interesting example of compound rhythm occurs in the small streams that run over the sand from the shingle banks during low tide. When the channel of one of these is narrow and the stream flows strongly, the sand at the bottom is shaped into a series of ridges that match the ripples of the water. If you watch for a bit, you’ll see these ridges getting higher and the ripples getting stronger; until eventually, the action becomes intense, and the whole series of ridges is suddenly washed away, the stream runs smoothly, and the process starts all over again. There are even more complex rhythms that could be mentioned, but they will be more suitably connected to the various forms of Evolution, which will be discussed later.
From the ensemble of the facts as above set forth, it will be seen that rhythm results wherever there is a conflict of forces not in equilibrium. If the antagonist forces at any point are balanced, there is rest; and in the absence of motion there can of course be no rhythm. But if instead of a balance there is an excess of force in one direction—if, as necessarily follows, motion is set up in that direction; then for that motion to continue uniformly in that direction, it is requisite that the moving matter should, notwithstanding its unceasing change of place, present unchanging relations to the sources of force by which its motion is produced and opposed. This however is impossible. Every further transfer through space must alter the ratio between the forces concerned—must increase or decrease the predominance of one force over the other—must prevent uniformity of movement. And if the movement cannot be uniform, then, in the absence of acceleration 318or retardation continued through infinite time and space, (results which cannot be conceived) the only alternative is rhythm.
From the collection of facts mentioned above, it’s clear that rhythm occurs whenever there is a conflict between forces that aren't balanced. If the opposing forces are balanced at any point, there is stillness; and without motion, there can obviously be no rhythm. However, if there’s an imbalance—if one force is stronger and motion is initiated in that direction—then for that motion to keep going steadily, the moving object must, despite its constant change of location, maintain consistent relationships with the sources of force that create and oppose its motion. This is, however, impossible. Every further movement through space must change the balance between the involved forces—must increase or decrease the dominance of one force over the other—thereby preventing consistent movement. If the movement can’t be steady, then, in the absence of acceleration or deceleration continuing infinitely through time and space (which is inconceivable), the only option left is rhythm. 318
A secondary conclusion must not be omitted. In the last chapter we saw that motion is never absolutely rectilinear; and here it remains to be added that, as a consequence, rhythm is necessarily incomplete. A truly rectilinear rhythm can arise only when the opposing forces are in exactly the same line; and the probabilities against this are infinitely great. To generate a perfectly circular rhythm, the two forces concerned must be exactly at right angles to each other, and must have exactly a certain ratio; and against this the probabilities are likewise infinitely great. All other proportions and directions of the two forces will produce an ellipse of greater or less eccentricity. And when, as indeed always happens, above two forces are engaged, the curve described must be more complex; and cannot exactly repeat itself. So that in fact throughout nature, this action and re-action of forces never brings about a complete return to a previous state. Where the movement is very involved, and especially where it is that of some aggregate whose units are partially independent, anything like a regular curve is no longer traceable; we see nothing more than a general oscillation. And on the completion of any periodic movement, the degree in which the state arrived at differs from the state departed from, is usually marked in proportion as the influences at work are numerous.
A secondary conclusion shouldn't be overlooked. In the last chapter, we saw that motion is never completely straight; and here it's important to note that, as a result, rhythm is inevitably incomplete. A perfectly straight rhythm can only happen when the opposing forces are perfectly aligned; the odds against this are extremely high. To create a perfectly circular rhythm, the two forces involved must be at right angles to each other and must have a specific ratio; the odds against this are also extremely high. Any other proportions and directions of the two forces will result in an ellipse with varying degrees of eccentricity. And when, as always happens, more than two forces are at play, the curve formed will be more complex and cannot repeat itself perfectly. So, in reality, throughout nature, this interaction of forces never leads to a complete return to a previous state. When the movement is highly complex, especially in a system where some units are somewhat independent, we can't trace a regular curve anymore; all we observe is a general oscillation. At the end of any periodic movement, the extent to which the state reached differs from the initial state is typically greater the more influences are at work.
§ 94. That spiral arrangement so general among the more diffused nebulæ—an arrangement which must be assumed by matter moving towards a centre of gravity through a resisting medium—shows us the progressive establishment of revolution, and therefore of rhythm; in those remote spaces which the nebulæ occupy. Double stars, moving round common centres of gravity in periods some of which are now ascertained, exhibit settled rhythmical actions in distant parts 319of our sidereal system. And another fact which, though of a different order, has a like general significance, is furnished by variable stars—stars which alternately brighten and fade.
§ 94. The spiral pattern commonly found in more widely spread nebulae— a pattern that must exist when matter moves toward a center of gravity through a resisting medium—demonstrates the gradual formation of revolution and, consequently, rhythm in those distant regions that the nebulae occupy. Binary stars, orbiting around shared centers of gravity with some periods now confirmed, show consistent rhythmic behavior in far reaches of our star system. Additionally, another observation with a similar overarching significance comes from variable stars—stars that brighten and dim alternately. 319
The periodicities of the planets, satellites, and comets, are so familiar that it would be inexcusable to name them, were it not needful here to point out that they are so many grand illustrations of this general law of movement. But besides the revolutions of these bodies in their orbits (all more or less excentric) and their rotations on their axes, the Solar System presents us with various rhythms of a less manifest and more complex kind. In each planet and satellite there is the revolution of the nodes—a slow change in the position of the orbit-plane, which after completing itself commences afresh. There is the gradual alteration in the length of the axis major of the orbit; and also of its excentricity: both of which are rhythmical alike in the sense that they alternate between maxima and minima, and in the sense that the progress from one extreme to the other is not uniform, but is made with fluctuating velocity. Then, too, there is the revolution of the line of apsides, which in course of time moves round the heavens—not regularly, but through complex oscillations. And further we have variations in the directions of the planetary axes—that known as nutation, and that larger gyration which, in the case of the Earth, causes the precession of the equinoxes. These rhythms, already more or less compound, are compounded with each other. Such an instance as the secular acceleration and retardation of the moon, consequent on the varying excentricity of the Earth’s orbit, is one of the simplest. Another, having more important consequences, results from the changing direction of the axes of rotation in planets whose orbits are decidedly excentric. Every planet, during a certain long period, presents more of its northern than of its southern hemisphere to the sun at the time of its nearest approach to him; and then again, during a like period, presents more of its southern hemisphere than of its northern—a recurring coincidence 320which, though causing in some planets no sensible alterations of climate, involves in the case of the Earth an epoch of 21,000 years, during which each hemisphere goes through a cycle of temperate seasons, and seasons that are extreme in their heat and cold. Nor is this all. There is even a variation of this variation. For the summers and winters of the whole Earth become more or less strongly contrasted, as the excentricity of its orbit increases and decreases. Hence during increase of the excentricity, the epochs of moderately contrasted seasons and epochs of strongly contrasted seasons, through which alternately each hemisphere passes, must grow more and more different in the degrees of their contrasts; and contrariwise during decrease of the excentricity. So that in the quantity of light and heat which any portion of the Earth receives from the sun, there goes on a quadruple rhythm: that of day and night; that of summer and winter; that due to the changing position of the axis at perihelion and aphelion, taking 21,000 years to complete; and that involved by the variation of the orbit’s excentricity, gone through in millions of years.
The cycles of the planets, moons, and comets are so well-known that it would be silly to list them, unless it's necessary here to emphasize that they serve as great examples of this overall law of motion. But in addition to the paths these bodies take in their orbits (which are all somewhat elliptical) and their spins on their axes, the Solar System shows us various rhythms that are less obvious and more intricate. Each planet and moon has the movement of the nodes—a slow shift in the position of the orbit's plane, which starts over once it completes its cycle. There are gradual changes in the length of the major axis of the orbit, as well as in its eccentricity: both follow a rhythm in the way that they alternate between highs and lows, and the transition from one extreme to the other isn't consistent but occurs at varying speeds. Additionally, there's the movement of the line of apsides, which over time shifts in the sky—not in a regular way, but through complex fluctuations. Moreover, we experience variations in the directions of the planetary axes, known as nutation, and a larger oscillation that, in the case of Earth, leads to the precession of the equinoxes. These rhythms, which are already somewhat complex, combine with one another. A simple example is the steady acceleration and deceleration of the moon, resulting from the changing eccentricity of Earth’s orbit. Another, with more significant consequences, stems from the changing direction of the axes of rotation in planets with notably eccentric orbits. Each planet, over a long period, shows more of its northern than its southern hemisphere to the sun when it gets closest to him; and then, during a similar period, shows more of its southern hemisphere than its northern—a recurring pattern that, while not causing noticeable climate changes in some planets, involves a 21,000-year cycle for Earth. During this time, each hemisphere experiences a cycle of mild seasons and extremes of heat and cold. But that's not all. There's also a fluctuation of this fluctuation. As the eccentricity of Earth's orbit increases and decreases, the summers and winters of the entire planet become notably distinct. So, during an increase in eccentricity, the periods of moderately different seasons and strongly different seasons that each hemisphere goes through will become increasingly diverse in their contrasts; and the opposite happens during a decrease in eccentricity. Therefore, regarding the amount of light and heat any part of the Earth receives from the sun, there's a fourfold rhythm: that of day and night; that of summer and winter; that related to the shifting position of the axis at perihelion and aphelion, which takes 21,000 years to complete; and that involved by the variation in the orbit’s eccentricity, which happens over millions of years.
§ 95. Those terrestrial processes whose dependence on the solar heat is direct, of course exhibit a rhythm that corresponds to the periodically changing amount of heat which each part of the Earth receives. The simplest, though the least obtrusive, instance is supplied by the magnetic variations. In these there is a diurnal increase and decrease, an annual increase and decrease, and a decennial increase and decrease; the latter answering to a period during which the solar spots become alternately abundant and scarce: besides which known variations there are probably others corresponding with the astronomical cycles just described. More obvious examples are furnished by the movements of the ocean and the atmosphere. Marine currents from the equator to the poles above, and from the poles to the equator beneath, show us an unceasing backward and forward motion throughout this vast 321mass of water—a motion varying in amount according to the seasons, and compounded with smaller like motions of local origin. The similarly-caused general currents in the air, have similar annual variations similarly modified. Irregular as they are in detail, we still see in the monsoons and other tropical atmospheric disturbances, or even in our own equinoctial gales and spring east winds, a periodicity sufficiently decided. Again, we have an alternation of times during which evaporation predominates with times during which condensation predominates: shown in the tropics by strongly marked rainy seasons and seasons of drought, and in the temperate zones by corresponding changes of which the periodicity, though less definite, is still traceable. The diffusion and precipitation of water, besides the slow alternations answering to different parts of the year, furnish us with examples of rhythm of a more rapid kind. During wet weather, lasting, let us say, over some weeks, the tendency to condense, though greater than the tendency to evaporate, does not show itself in continuous rain; but the period is made up of rainy days and days that are wholly or partially fair. Nor is it in this rude alternation only that the law is manifested. During any day throughout this wet weather a minor rhythm is traceable; and especially so when the tendencies to evaporate and to condense are nearly balanced. Among mountains this minor rhythm and its causes may be studied to great advantage. Moist winds, which do not precipitate their contained water in passing over the comparatively warm lowlands, lose so much heat when they reach the cold mountain peaks, that condensation rapidly takes place. Water, however, in passing from the gaseous to the fluid state, gives out a considerable amount of heat; and hence the resulting clouds are warmer than the air that precipitates them, and much warmer than the high rocky surfaces round which they fold themselves. Hence in the course of the storm, these high rocky surfaces are raised in temperature, partly by radiation from the enwrapping cloud, 322partly by contact of the falling rain-drops. Giving off more heat than before, they no longer lower so greatly the temperature of the air passing over them; and so cease to precipitate its contained water. The clouds break; the sky begins to clear; and a gleam of sunshine promises that the day is going to be fine. But the small supply of heat which the cold mountain’s sides have received, is soon lost: especially when the dispersion of the clouds permits free radiation into space. Very soon, therefore, these elevated surfaces, becoming as cold as at first, (or perhaps even colder in virtue of the evaporation set up,) begin again to condense the vapour in the air above; and there comes another storm, followed by the same effects as before. In lowland regions this action and reaction is usually less conspicuous, because the contrast of temperatures is less marked. Even here, however, it may be traced; and that not only on showery days, but on days of continuous rain; for in these we do not see uniformity: always there are fits of harder and gentler rain that are probably caused as above explained.
§ 95. The natural processes on Earth that are directly influenced by solar heat show a rhythm that matches the varying amounts of heat each part of the Earth receives. The simplest, though least noticeable, example is magnetic variations. These show a daily increase and decrease, an annual increase and decrease, and a decadal increase and decrease; the last one corresponds to a period where solar spots alternate between being abundant and scarce. Besides these known variations, there are likely others that correspond to the astronomical cycles mentioned earlier. More apparent examples are found in the movements of the ocean and the atmosphere. Ocean currents flow from the equator to the poles above and from the poles to the equator below, creating a constant back-and-forth motion across this vast body of water—this motion changes with the seasons and is combined with smaller, local movements. Similarly, the general air currents have annual variations that are also modified in a similar way. Despite their irregularities, monsoons and other tropical atmospheric disturbances, along with our own equinoctial gales and spring east winds, show a clear periodicity. Again, we see cycles where evaporation is dominant alternating with periods where condensation prevails: in the tropics, this is illustrated by distinct rainy seasons and dry seasons, while in temperate zones, there are corresponding changes with less clear but still noticeable periodicity. The distribution and precipitation of water, in addition to the slow changes over the year, offer examples of a more rapid rhythm. During wet weather, for instance, lasting several weeks, the tendency to condense, while stronger than the tendency to evaporate, does not result in continuous rain; instead, it consists of rainy days and days that are completely or partially dry. This law is evident not only in this rough alternation. Throughout any day during such wet weather, a smaller rhythm can be traced, especially when the tendencies to evaporate and condense are nearly equal. In mountainous regions, this smaller rhythm and its causes can be studied very effectively. Moist winds that do not release their moisture while passing over warmer lowland areas lose so much heat when reaching cold mountain peaks that condensation occurs rapidly. Water, however, when changing from gas to liquid, releases a considerable amount of heat; thus, the resulting clouds are warmer than the air around them and much warmer than the cold rocky surfaces they surround. Consequently, during a storm, these rocky surfaces warm up due to radiation from the surrounding clouds and contact with falling raindrops. Since they release more heat than they absorb, they stop cooling the air above them as much and, therefore, stop causing the moisture in the air to condense. The clouds dissipate, the sky begins to clear, and a ray of sunshine suggests that the day will turn out nice. However, the small amount of heat gained by the cold mountain sides is quickly lost, particularly when the clouds disperse, allowing for free radiation into space. Very soon, these high elevations cool down again to their original temperature (or perhaps become even colder due to the evaporation that occurs) and start to condense the vapor in the air above, leading to another storm, which results in the same effects as before. In lowland areas, this back-and-forth action is often less noticeable because the temperature contrasts are less pronounced. Even so, it can still be observed, not just on rainy days but also on days of steady rain; there we don’t see uniformity: there are always periods of heavier and lighter rain that likely result from the previously explained processes.
Of course these meteorologic rhythms involve something corresponding to them in the changes wrought by wind and water on the Earth’s surface. Variations in the quantities of sediment brought down by rivers that rise and fall with the seasons, must cause variations in the resulting strata—alternations of colour or quality in the successive laminæ. Beds formed from the detritus of shores worn down and carried away by the waves, must similarly show periodic differences answering to the periodic winds of the locality. In so far as frost influences the rate of denudation, its recurrence is a factor in the rhythm of sedimentary deposits. And the geological changes produced by glaciers and icebergs must similarly have their alternating periods of greater and less intensity.
Of course, these weather patterns relate to the changes caused by wind and water on the Earth's surface. Fluctuations in the amount of sediment carried by rivers that rise and fall with the seasons must lead to variations in the resulting layers—differences in color or quality in the successive layers. Beds formed from the debris of shores worn down and moved by the waves must also display periodic changes reflecting the local winds. As frost affects the rate of erosion, its recurrence plays a role in the rhythm of sedimentary deposits. And the geological changes caused by glaciers and icebergs must also have their alternating periods of more and less intensity.
There is evidence also that modifications in the Earth’s crust due to igneous action have a certain periodicity. Volcanic eruptions are not continuous but intermittent, and as 323far as the data enable us to judge, have a certain average rate of recurrence; which rate of recurrence is complicated by rising into epochs of greater activity and falling into epochs of comparative quiescence. So too is it with earthquakes and the elevations or depressions caused by them. At the mouth of the Mississippi, the alternation of strata gives decisive proof of successive sinkings of the surface, that have taken place at tolerably equal intervals. Everywhere, in the extensive groups of conformable strata that imply small subsidences recurring with a certain average frequency, we see a rhythm in the action and reaction between the Earth’s crust and its molten contents—a rhythm compounded with those slower ones shown in the termination of groups of strata, and the commencement of other groups not conformable to them. There is even reason for suspecting a geological periodicity that is immensely slower and far wider in its effects; namely, an alternation of those vast upheavals and submergencies by which continents are produced where there were oceans, and oceans where there were continents. For supposing, as we may fairly do, that the Earth’s crust is throughout of tolerably equal thickness, it is manifest that such portions of it as become most depressed below the average level, must have their inner surfaces most exposed to the currents of molten matter circulating within, and will therefore undergo a larger amount of what may be called igneous denudation; while, conversely, the withdrawal of the inner surfaces from these currents where the Earth’s crust is most elevated, will cause a thickening more or less compensating the aqueous denudation going on externally. Hence those depressed areas over which the deepest oceans lie, being gradually thinned beneath and not covered by much sedimentary deposit above, will become areas of least resistance, and will then begin to yield to the upward pressure of the Earth’s contents; whence will result, throughout such areas, long-continued elevations, ceasing only when the reverse state of things has been brought about. Whether this speculation 324be well or ill founded, does not however affect the general conclusion. Apart from it we have sufficient evidence that geologic processes are rhythmical.
There’s also evidence that changes in the Earth’s crust caused by volcanic activity happen in a somewhat periodic way. Volcanic eruptions aren't constant, but occur in bursts, and as far as the data allows us to assess, they follow a certain average recurrence rate; this rate is influenced by cycles of increased activity and periods of relative calm. The same applies to earthquakes and the ground shifts that come with them. At the mouth of the Mississippi, the layering of rocks provides clear proof of a series of subsidence events that have occurred at fairly regular intervals. Across the broad groups of layered rock that suggest minor subsidence happening with some average frequency, we observe a pattern in the interaction between the Earth’s crust and its molten interior—a pattern that combines with the slower changes evidenced by the end of one group of layers and the start of new ones that don’t match up with them. There’s even reason to think there’s a much slower geological cycle with effects that are far-reaching; this refers to the shifts between massive uplifts and submergences that create continents from oceans and vice versa. If we assume, which is reasonable, that the Earth’s crust has a fairly uniform thickness, it becomes clear that the parts of it that sink the most below average levels will have their inner surfaces more exposed to the molten material flowing beneath, and will thus experience greater igneous erosion; conversely, parts of the crust that rise highest will pull away from these currents, leading to a thickening that somewhat counters the erosion happening on the surface. As a result, those low-lying areas lying beneath the deepest oceans, which get gradually worn away from below and aren't significantly covered by sediment on top, will become the least resistant spots, making them likely to respond to the upward pressure from the Earth’s interior; this will lead to prolonged uplifting in those areas, continuing until the opposite situation develops. Whether this theory is accurate or not doesn't change the overall conclusion. We have enough evidence to indicate that geological processes are rhythmic.
§ 96. Perhaps nowhere are the illustrations of rhythm so numerous and so manifest as among the phenomena of life. Plants do not, indeed, usually show us any decided periodicities, save those determined by day and night and by the seasons. But in animals we have a great variety of movements in which the alternation of opposite extremes goes on with all degrees of rapidity. The swallowing of food is effected by a wave of constriction passing along the œsophagus; its digestion is accompanied by a muscular action of the stomach that is also undulatory; and the peristaltic motion of the intestines is of like nature. The blood obtained from this food is propelled not in a uniform current but in pulses; and it is aerated by lungs that alternately contract and expand. All locomotion results from oscillating movements: even where it is apparently continuous, as in many minute forms, the microscope proves the vibration of cilia to be the agency by which the creature is moved smoothly forwards.
§ 96. Perhaps nowhere are the examples of rhythm as numerous and clear as in the phenomena of life. Plants don’t usually show us any distinct patterns, except for those determined by day and night and the seasons. But in animals, we observe a wide variety of movements where the alternation of opposite extremes happens at all different speeds. The act of swallowing food is achieved by a wave of constriction that moves along the esophagus; its digestion involves a muscle action in the stomach that is also wave-like; and the peristaltic motion of the intestines is similar. The blood derived from this food is pushed not in a steady flow but in pulses, and it is oxygenated by lungs that alternately contract and expand. All movement comes from oscillating actions: even when it seems continuous, like in many tiny organisms, the microscope reveals that the vibration of cilia is what allows the creature to move smoothly forward.
Primary rhythms of the organic actions are compounded with secondary ones of longer duration. These various modes of activity have their recurring periods of increase and decrease. We see this in the periodic need for food, and in the periodic need for repose. Each meal induces a more rapid rhythmic action of the digestive organs; the pulsation of the heart is accelerated; and the inspirations become more frequent. During sleep, on the contrary, these several movements slacken. So that in the course of the twenty-four hours, those small undulations of which the different kinds of organic action are constituted, undergo one long wave of increase and decrease, complicated with several minor waves. Experiments have shown that there are still slower rises and falls of functional activity. Waste and assimilation are not balanced by every meal, but 325one or other maintains for some time a slight excess; so that a person in ordinary health is found to undergo an increase and decrease of weight during recurring intervals of tolerable equality. Besides these regular periods there are still longer and comparatively irregular ones; namely, those alternations of greater and less vigour, which even healthy people experience. So inevitable are these oscillations that even men in training cannot be kept stationary at their highest power, but when they have reached it begin to retrograde. Further evidence of rhythm in the vital movements is furnished by invalids. Sundry disorders are named from the intermittent character of their symptoms. Even where the periodicity is not very marked, it is mostly traceable. Patients rarely if ever get uniformly worse; and convalescents have usually their days of partial relapse or of less decided advance.
The main rhythms of our body's functions are combined with longer-lasting secondary rhythms. These different activities have their own cycles of increase and decrease. We notice this in our regular need for food and rest. Each meal triggers a quicker rhythm in the digestive system; the heartbeat speeds up; and breathing becomes more frequent. Conversely, during sleep, these various movements slow down. Over the course of twenty-four hours, the small fluctuations that make up different bodily actions go through one longer wave of increase and decrease, mixed with various smaller waves. Experiments have shown that there are even slower fluctuations in functional activity. Waste and absorption are not balanced out by every meal, so one or the other tends to have a slight excess for some time; as a result, a healthy person usually experiences a fluctuation in weight over repeated intervals that are fairly consistent. In addition to these regular cycles, there are longer and more erratic patterns, such as the variations in energy levels that even healthy individuals encounter. These ups and downs are so common that even trained athletes can't maintain their peak performance indefinitely; after reaching their highest level, they start to decline. Further proof of rhythm in vital functions can be seen in patients. Different illnesses are named for the intermittent nature of their symptoms. Even when the periodicity isn't very obvious, it's often still noticeable. Patients rarely get worse in a steady fashion, and those recovering often have days of partial setbacks or less noticeable progress.
Aggregates of living creatures illustrate the general truth in other ways. If each species of organism be regarded as a whole, it displays two kinds of rhythm. Life as it exists in all the members of such species, is an extremely complex kind of movement, more or less distinct from the kinds of movement which constitutes life in other species. In each individual of the species, this extremely complex kind of movement begins, rises to its climax, declines, and ceases in death. And every successive generation thus exhibits a wave of that peculiar activity characterizing the species as a whole. The other form of rhythm is to be traced in that variation of number which each tribe of animals and plants is ever undergoing. Throughout the unceasing conflict between the tendency of a species to increase and the antagonistic tendencies, there is never an equilibrium: one always predominates. In the case even of a cultivated plant or domesticated animal, where artificial means are used to maintain the supply at a uniform level, we still see that oscillations of abundance and scarcity cannot be avoided. And among the creatures uncared for by man, such oscillations 326are usually more marked. After a race of organisms has been greatly thinned by enemies or lack of food, its surviving members become more favourably circumstanced than usual. During the decline in their numbers their food has grown relatively more abundant; while their enemies have diminished from want of prey. The conditions thus remain for some time favourable to their increase; and they multiply rapidly. By and by their food is rendered relatively scarce, at the same time that their enemies have become more numerous; and the destroying influences being thus in excess, their number begins to diminish again. Yet one more rhythm, extremely slow in its action, may be traced in the phenomena of Life, contemplated under their most general aspect. The researches of palæontologists show, that there have been going on, during the vast period of which our sedimentary rocks bear record, successive changes of organic forms. Species have appeared, become abundant, and then disappeared. Genera, at first constituted of but few species, have for a time gone on growing more multiform; and then have begun to decline in the number of their subdivisions; leaving at last but one or two representatives, or none at all. During longer epochs whole orders have thus arisen, culminated, and dwindled away. And even those wider divisions containing many orders have similarly undergone a gradual rise, a high tide, and a long-continued ebb. The stalked Crinoidea, for example, which, during the carboniferous epoch, became abundant, have almost disappeared: only a single species being extant. Once a large family of molluscs, the Brachiopoda have now become rare. The shelled Cephalopods, at one time dominant among the inhabitants of the ocean, both in number of forms and of individuals, are in our day nearly extinct. And after an “age of reptiles,” there has come an age in which reptiles have been in great measure supplanted by mammals. Whether these vast rises and falls of different kinds of life ever undergo anything approaching to repetitions, (which they may possibly do in correspondence with those 327vast cycles of elevation and subsidence that produce continents and oceans,) it is sufficiently clear that Life on the Earth has not progressed uniformly, but in immense undulations.
Aggregates of living creatures show the same general truth in different ways. If we look at each species of organism as a whole, it displays two types of rhythm. Life as it exists in all members of a species involves a very complex kind of movement, which is somewhat different from the movement that characterizes life in other species. In each individual of the species, this complex movement begins, reaches its peak, declines, and ends in death. Every successive generation thus demonstrates a wave of the unique activity that defines the species as a whole. The other type of rhythm can be seen in the changing numbers that each group of animals and plants continuously undergoes. In the ongoing struggle between a species' tendency to grow and the opposing forces, there is never a balance; one always outweighs the other. Even in the case of a cultivated plant or domesticated animal, where artificial methods are used to keep supply consistent, we still observe that fluctuations between abundance and scarcity are unavoidable. Among creatures not influenced by humans, these fluctuations tend to be even more pronounced. After a population has significantly decreased due to predators or food shortages, the surviving individuals find themselves in more favorable conditions than usual. During the decline, their food has become relatively more abundant, while their enemies have decreased due to a lack of prey. These conditions remain favorable for a while, allowing them to multiply rapidly. Eventually, their food becomes relatively scarce, and at the same time, their enemies increase in numbers; as the destructive forces become more dominant, their population starts to decrease again. Another much slower rhythm can be observed in the phenomena of life when viewed broadly. Research by paleontologists indicates that over the vast periods recorded in our sedimentary rocks, there have been successive changes in organic forms. Species have emerged, thrived, and then vanished. Genera, initially consisting of a few species, have expanded and then started to decline in their variety; eventually, only one or two representatives remain, or none at all. Over longer timeframes, entire orders have arisen, reached their peak, and faded away. Even broader categories that include many orders have similarly experienced gradual increases, peaks, and prolonged declines. For instance, the stalked Crinoidea, which thrived during the carboniferous period, are now nearly extinct, with only one species still alive. Once a large family of mollusks, the Brachiopoda are now rare. The shelled Cephalopods, which once dominated the oceans in both diversity and population, are close to extinction today. After an “age of reptiles,” we now see an age in which mammals have largely replaced reptiles. Whether these significant rises and falls in different types of life ever come close to repeating, which they might do in sync with the vast cycles of geological changes creating continents and oceans, it is clear that life on Earth has not progressed steadily, but rather in massive fluctuations.
§ 97. It is not manifest that the changes of consciousness are in any sense rhythmical. Yet here, too, analysis proves both that the mental state existing at any moment is not uniform, but is decomposable into rapid oscillations; and also that mental states pass through longer intervals of increasing and decreasing intensity.
§ 97. It's not clear that changes in consciousness are rhythmic in any way. However, analysis shows that the mental state at any given moment isn’t consistent but can be broken down into quick fluctuations; it also demonstrates that mental states go through longer periods of rising and falling intensity.
Though while attending to any single sensation, or any group of related sensations constituting the consciousness of an object, we seem to remain for the time in a persistent and homogeneous condition of mind, a careful self-examination shows that this apparently unbroken mental state is in truth traversed by a number of minor states, in which various other sensations and perceptions are rapidly presented and disappear. From the admitted fact that thinking consists in the establishment of relations, it is a necessary corollary that the maintenance of consciousness in any one state to the entire exclusion of other states, would be a cessation of thought, that is, of consciousness. So that any seemingly continuous feeling, say of pressure, really consists of portions of that feeling perpetually recurring after the momentary intrusion of other feelings and ideas—quick thoughts concerning the place where it is felt, the external object producing it, its consequences, and other things suggested by association. Thus there is going on an extremely rapid departure from, and return to, that particular mental state which we regard as persistent. Besides the evidence of rhythm in consciousness which direct analysis thus affords, we may gather further evidence from the correlation between feeling and movement. Sensations and emotions expend themselves in producing muscular contractions. If a sensation or emotion were strictly continuous, there would be a continuous discharge along those motor nerves acted upon. But so far as experiments with artificial stimuli enable us to judge, a continuous discharge along the nerve leading to a muscle, 328does not contract it: a broken discharge is required—a rapid succession of shocks. Hence muscular contraction pre-supposes that rhythmic state of consciousness which direct observation discloses. A much more conspicuous rhythm, having longer waves, is seen during the outflow of emotion into dancing, poetry, and music. The current of mental energy that shows itself in these modes of bodily action, is not continuous, but falls into a succession of pulses. The measure of a dance is produced by the alternation of strong muscular contractions with weaker ones; and, save in measures of the simplest order such as are found among barbarians and children, this alternation is compounded with longer rises and falls in the degree of muscular excitement. Poetry is a form of speech which results when the emphasis is regularly recurrent; that is, when the muscular effort of pronunciation has definite periods of greater and less intensity—periods that are complicated with others of like nature answering to the successive verses. Music, in still more various ways, exemplifies the law. There are the recurring bars, in each of which there is a primary and a secondary beat. There is the alternate increase and decrease of muscular strain, implied by the ascents and descents to the higher and lower notes—ascents and descents composed of smaller waves, breaking the rises and falls of the larger ones, in a mode peculiar to each melody. And then we have, further, the alternation of piano and forte passages. That these several kinds of rhythm, characterizing æsthetic expression, are not, in the common sense of the word, artificial, but are intenser forms of an undulatory movement habitually generated by feeling in its bodily discharge, is shown by the fact that they are all traceable in ordinary speech; which in every sentence has its primary and secondary emphases, and its cadence containing a chief rise and fall complicated with subordinate rises and falls; and which is accompanied by a more or less oscillatory action of the limbs when the emotion is great. Still longer undulations may be observed by every one, in himself and in others, on occasions of extreme 329pleasure or extreme pain. Note, in the first place, that pain having its origin in bodily disorder, is nearly always perceptibly rhythmical. During hours in which it never actually ceases, it has its variations of intensity—fits or paroxysms; and then after these hours of suffering there usually come hours of comparative ease. Moral pain has the like smaller and larger waves. One possessed by intense grief does not utter continuous moans, or shed tears with an equable rapidity; but these signs of passion come in recurring bursts. Then after a time during which such stronger and weaker waves of emotion alternate, there comes a calm—a time of comparative deadness; to which again succeeds another interval, when dull sorrow rises afresh into acute anguish, with its series of paroxysms. Similarly in great delight, especially as manifested by children who have its display less under control, there are visible variations in the intensity of feeling shown—fits of laughter and dancing about, separated by pauses in which smiles, and other slight manifestations of pleasure, suffice to discharge the lessened excitement. Nor are there wanting evidences of mental undulations greater in length than any of these—undulations which take weeks, or months, or years, to complete themselves. We continually hear of moods which recur at intervals. Very many persons have their epochs of vivacity and depression. There are periods of industry following periods of idleness; and times at which particular subjects or tastes are cultivated with zeal, alternating with times at which they are neglected. Respecting which slow oscillations, the only qualification to be made is, that being affected by numerous influences, they are comparatively irregular.
Although when we focus on a single sensation or a related group of sensations that make up our awareness of an object, it seems like we stay in a consistent and stable state of mind for the time being, a closer self-examination reveals that this seemingly uninterrupted mental state is actually crossed by numerous smaller states where various other sensations and perceptions quickly appear and disappear. Since it’s widely accepted that thinking is about forming connections, it follows that maintaining consciousness in one state while completely disregarding others would mean stopping thought altogether—essentially halting consciousness. Therefore, any feeling that seems continuous, like pressure, is actually made up of recurring segments of that feeling, always interrupted by fleeting feelings and ideas—quick thoughts about where it’s felt, the object causing it, its effects, and other related thoughts. So, there’s a very rapid cycle of leaving and returning to that specific mental state that we consider persistent. Beyond the evidence of rhythm in consciousness that direct analysis provides, we can find more evidence in the relationship between feeling and movement. Sensations and emotions lead to muscle contractions. If a sensation or emotion were truly continuous, there would be a constant discharge along the motor nerves involved. But to the best of our understanding from experiments with artificial stimuli, a continuous discharge along the nerve leading to a muscle does not cause it to contract: a broken discharge is needed—a quick series of shocks. Thus, muscle contraction presupposes that rhythmic state of consciousness which direct observation reveals. A much more evident rhythm, with longer waves, is visible during emotional expressions like dancing, poetry, and music. The flow of mental energy evident in these physical actions isn’t continuous but occurs in a series of pulses. The rhythm of a dance is created by alternating strong muscle contractions with weaker ones; and except for the simplest rhythms found among children and primitive cultures, this alternation is combined with longer increases and decreases in muscle excitement. Poetry emerges when emphasis recurs regularly; in other words, when the effort of pronunciation features definite periods of greater and lesser intensity—periods that are further complicated by others of a similar nature corresponding to successive verses. Music illustrates this law in even more varied ways. There are repeating measures, each containing a primary and secondary beat. There’s the alternating increase and decrease of muscular strain indicated by the rise and fall to higher and lower notes—those rises and falls are made up of smaller waves that interrupt the larger ones in a way unique to each melody. Then there’s also the alternation of soft and loud passages. The fact that these various forms of rhythm, defining aesthetic expression, are not artificial in the usual sense but rather more intense forms of a wave-like movement habitually produced by feeling in its physical release, is evidenced by their presence in everyday speech; where every sentence has its primary and secondary stresses and a rhythm with a main rise and fall layered with smaller rises and falls, often accompanied by a more or less oscillatory movement of the limbs when the emotion is intense. Even longer waves can be observed by everyone in themselves and others during moments of extreme happiness or severe pain. Notably, pain, stemming from physical disorder, is almost always perceptibly rhythmic. Even when it doesn’t completely stop for hours, it has variations in intensity—fits or spasms; and after those painful hours, there are usually times of relative ease. Emotional pain has similar smaller and larger waves. Someone experiencing deep grief doesn’t let out continuous moans or shed tears at a steady pace; instead, these signs of distress appear in repeating bursts. After a time filled with these stronger and weaker emotional waves, there is a calm—a period of relative numbness; followed by another phase when dull sadness rises again into acute anguish, bringing its series of spasms. Likewise, in great joy, especially as shown by children who have it less under control, you can see fluctuations in the intensity of feeling displayed—bursts of laughter and dancing, separated by pauses that allow for smiles and other slight signs of pleasure to release the remaining excitement. Additionally, there are greater mental waves that take weeks, months, or even years to complete. We often hear about moods that recur at intervals. Many people experience cycles of liveliness and depression. There are times of productivity after periods of inactivity; and phases where particular subjects or interests are pursued with enthusiasm, alternating with times when they’re neglected. The only caveat regarding these slow oscillations is that, influenced by numerous factors, they tend to be relatively irregular.
§ 98. In nomadic societies the changes of place, determined as they usually are by exhaustion or failure of the supply of food, are periodic; and in many cases show a recurrence answering to the seasons. Each tribe that has become in some degree fixed in its locality, goes on increasing, 330till under the pressures of unsatisfied desires, there results migration of some part of it to a new region—a process repeated at intervals. From such excesses of population, and such successive waves of migration, come conflicts with other tribes; which are also increasing and tending to diffuse themselves. This antagonism, like all others, results not in an uniform motion, but in an intermittent one. War, exhaustion, recoil—peace, prosperity, and renewed aggression:—see here the alternation more or less discernible in the military activities of both savage and civilized nations. And irregular as is this rhythm, it is not more so than the different sizes of the societies, and the extremely involved causes of variation in their strengths, would lead us to anticipate.
§ 98. In nomadic societies, changes of location, usually driven by food shortages or exhaustion, happen periodically and often align with the seasons. Each tribe that settles in a specific area tends to grow until unfulfilled desires push some members to migrate to a new region—this process occurs repeatedly over time. From these population surges and ongoing migrations come conflicts with other tribes, which are also growing and spreading. This opposition, like all others, doesn’t result in a steady progression but rather in an erratic one. War, fatigue, withdrawal—followed by peace, prosperity, and renewed aggression—illustrates the fluctuating military activities of both primitive and advanced nations. This irregular pattern is no more chaotic than the varying sizes of societies and the complex reasons behind their differences in strength would suggest.
Passing from external to internal changes, we meet with this backward and forward movement under many forms. In the currents of commerce it is especially conspicuous. Exchange during early times is almost wholly carried on at fairs, held at long intervals in the chief centres of population. The flux and reflux of people and commodities which each of these exhibits, becomes more frequent as national development leads to greater social activity. The more rapid rhythm of weekly markets begins to supersede the slow rhythm of fairs. And eventually the process of exchange becomes at certain places so active, as to bring about daily meetings of buyers and sellers—a daily wave of accumulation and distribution of cotton, or corn, or capital. If from exchange we turn to production and consumption, we see undulations, much longer indeed in their periods, but almost equally obvious. Supply and demand are never completely adapted to each other; but each of them from time to time in excess, leads presently to an excess of the other. Farmers who have one season produced wheat very abundantly, are disgusted with the consequent low price; and next season, sowing a much smaller quantity, bring to market a deficient crop; whence follows a converse effect. Consumption undergoes parallel undulations that need not be specified. 331The balancing of supplies between different districts, too, entails analogous oscillations. A place at which some necessary of life is scarce, becomes a place to which currents of it are set up from other places where it is relatively abundant; and these currents from all sides lead to a wave of accumulation where they meet—a glut: whence follows a recoil—a partial return of the currents. But the undulatory character of these actions is perhaps best seen in the rises and falls of prices. These, given in numerical measures which may be tabulated and reduced to diagrams, show us in the clearest manner how commercial movements are compounded of oscillations of various magnitudes. The price of consols or the price of wheat, as thus represented, is seen to undergo vast ascents and descents whose highest and lowest points are reached only in the course of years. These largest waves of variation are broken by others extending over periods of perhaps many months. On these again come others having a week or two’s duration. And were the changes marked in greater detail, we should have the smaller undulations that take place each day, and the still smaller ones which brokers telegraph from hour to hour. The whole outline would show a complication like that of a vast ocean-swell, on whose surface there rise large billows, which themselves bear waves of moderate size, covered by wavelets, that are roughened by a minute ripple. Similar diagrammatic representations of births, marriages, and deaths, of disease, of crime, of pauperism, exhibit involved conflicts of rhythmical motions throughout society under these several aspects.
When we look at changes from the outside in, we notice a back-and-forth movement coming in many forms. This is especially noticeable in trade. In earlier times, exchanges mostly happened at fairs, which took place at long intervals in major population centers. The flow of people and goods at these fairs becomes more frequent as national growth leads to increased social activity. The faster pace of weekly markets starts to replace the slower pace of fairs. Eventually, some places see exchanges happening so often that buyers and sellers meet daily—a constant wave of buying and selling of items like cotton, corn, or capital. If we shift our focus from trading to production and consumption, we observe longer cycles, but they are just as clear. Supply and demand never completely align; when one is in excess, it eventually leads to an excess of the other. Farmers who produce a lot of wheat one season are frustrated by the low prices that follow, so the next season they plant much less, resulting in a shortage and, in turn, higher prices. Consumption reflects similar ups and downs that don’t need detailing. The balancing of supplies between different areas also creates similar fluctuations. A place where a necessity is scarce becomes a destination for goods from areas where they are abundant, leading to a buildup or "glut," which then causes a partial return of those goods. The fluctuating nature of these activities is perhaps most evident in the rise and fall of prices. Representing these prices in numerical terms that can be organized into tables and graphs shows clearly how commercial activities are made up of various oscillations. The price of government bonds or wheat, as illustrated, experiences huge highs and lows that only occur over years. These larger waves are interrupted by smaller ones that may last several months. These are then followed by even shorter changes lasting a week or two. If we looked at more detailed changes, we would see daily fluctuations and even smaller ones that brokers transmit hour by hour. The overall pattern would resemble the complexity of a vast ocean swell, with large waves that carry medium-sized waves, topped by smaller ripples. Similar graphical representations of births, marriages, deaths, diseases, crime, and poverty reveal intricate conflicts of rhythmic movements throughout society in these various aspects.
There are like characteristics in social changes of a more complex kind. Both in England and among continental nations, the action and reaction of political progress have come to be generally recognized. Religion, besides its occasional revivals of smaller magnitude, has its long periods of exaltation and depression—generations of belief and self-mortification, following generations of indifference and laxity. There are poetical epochs, and epochs in which the sense of the 332beautiful seems almost dormant. Philosophy, after having been awhile predominant, lapses for a long season into neglect; and then again slowly revives. Each science has its eras of deductive reasoning, and its eras when attention is chiefly directed to collecting and colligating facts. And how in such minor but more obtrusive phenomena as those of fashion, there are ever going on oscillations from one extreme to the other, is a trite observation.
There are similar characteristics in social changes that are more complex. Both in England and in other countries, the effects of political progress have become widely acknowledged. Religion, aside from its occasional smaller revivals, experiences long periods of highs and lows—generations filled with belief and self-denial, followed by generations of indifference and looseness. There are eras of poetry, and times when the appreciation for beauty seems nearly absent. Philosophy, after being prominent for a while, often falls into neglect for long stretches; then it gradually comes back to life. Each science has its periods of logical reasoning and times when the focus is mainly on gathering and organizing facts. And in less significant but more visible trends like fashion, there are always shifts from one extreme to another, which is a well-worn observation.
As may be foreseen, social rhythms well illustrate the irregularity that results from combination of many causes. Where the variations are those of one simple element in national life, as the supply of a particular commodity, we do indeed witness a return, after many involved movements, to a previous condition—the price may become what it was before: implying a like relative abundance. But where the action is one into which many factors enter, there is never a recurrence of exactly the same state. A political reaction never brings round just the old form of things. The rationalism of the present day differs widely from the rationalism of the last century. And though fashion from time to time revives extinct types of dress, these always re-appear with decided modifications.
As we can expect, social rhythms show the irregularity that comes from a mix of many causes. When the changes involve just one simple aspect of national life, like the supply of a specific product, we can see a return—after several complex movements—back to a previous state; the price might go back to what it was before, suggesting a similar level of abundance. But when the situation involves many factors, there's never a return to exactly the same condition. A political reaction never brings back the exact old order. The rationalism of today is very different from the rationalism of the last century. And while fashion occasionally revives past styles of clothing, they always come back with significant changes.
§ 99. The universality of this principle suggests a question like that raised in foregoing cases. Rhythm being manifested in all forms of movement, we have reason to suspect that it is determined by some primordial condition to action in general. The tacit implication is that it is deducible from the persistence of force. This we shall find to be the fact.
§ 99. The universality of this principle raises a question similar to those discussed in previous cases. Since rhythm appears in all kinds of movement, we have reason to think that it is influenced by some fundamental condition of action overall. The underlying suggestion is that it can be derived from the constant presence of force. We will find this to be true.
When the prong of a tuning-fork is pulled on one side by the finger, a certain extra tension is produced among its cohering particles; which resist any force that draws them out of their state of equilibrium. As much force as the finger exerts in pulling the prong aside, so much opposing force is brought into play among the cohering particles. Hence, when the prong is liberated, it is urged back by a force equal 333to that used in deflecting it. When, therefore, the prong reaches its original position, the force impressed on it during its recoil, has generated in it a corresponding amount of momentum—an amount of momentum nearly equivalent, that is, to the force originally impressed (nearly, we must say, because a certain portion has gone in communicating motion to the air, and a certain other portion has been transformed into heat). This momentum carries the prong beyond the position of rest, nearly as far as it was originally drawn in the reverse direction; until at length, being gradually used up in producing an opposing tension among the particles, it is all lost. The opposing tension into which the expended momentum has been transformed, then generates a second recoil; and so on continually—the vibration eventually ceasing only because at each movement a certain amount of force goes in creating atmospheric and etherial undulations. Now it needs but to contemplate this repeated action and reaction, to see that it is, like every action and reaction, a consequence of the persistence of force. The force exerted by the finger in bending the prong cannot disappear. Under what form then does it exist? It exists under the form of that cohesive tension which it has generated among the particles. This cohesive tension cannot cease without an equivalent result. What is its equivalent result? The momentum generated in the prong while being carried back to its position of rest. This momentum too—what becomes of it? It must either continue as momentum, or produce some correlative force of equal amount. It cannot continue as momentum, since change of place is resisted by the cohesion of the parts; and thus it gradually disappears by being transformed into tension among these parts. This is re-transformed into the equivalent momentum; and so on continuously. If instead of motion that is directly antagonized by the cohesion of matter, we consider motion through space, the same truth presents itself under another form. Though here no opposing force seems at work, and therefore 334no cause of rhythm is apparent, yet its own accumulated momentum must eventually carry the moving body beyond the body attracting it; and so must become a force at variance with that which generated it. From this conflict, rhythm necessarily results as in the foregoing case. The force embodied as momentum in a given direction, cannot be destroyed; and if it eventually disappears, it re-appears in the reaction on the retarding body; which begins afresh to draw the now arrested mass back from its aphelion. The only conditions under which there could be absence of rhythm—the only conditions, that is, under which there could be a continuous motion through space in the same straight line for ever, would be the existence of an infinity void of everything but the moving body. And neither of these conditions can be represented in thought. Infinity is inconceivable; and so also is a motion which never had a commencement in some pre-existing source of power. Thus, then, rhythm is a necessary characteristic of all motion. Given the coexistence everywhere of antagonist forces—a postulate which, as we have seen, is necessitated by the form of our experience—and rhythm is an inevitable corollary from the persistence of force.
When a tuning fork's prong is pulled to one side with a finger, it creates extra tension among its particles, which resist any force that tries to pull them from their balanced state. The amount of force the finger uses to pull the prong aside is matched by an equal opposing force among the particles. So, when the prong is released, it is pushed back by a force equal to what was used to pull it. As the prong returns to its original position, the force applied during its recoil generates a corresponding amount of momentum—an amount almost equal to the original force (almost, because part of it transfers to the air and some turns into heat). This momentum makes the prong swing past its resting position, nearly as far as it was initially pulled in the opposite direction, until it gradually dissipates into tension among the particles. This tension, created from the expended momentum, then triggers a second recoil; and this process continues—the vibration eventually stopping only because some force is lost in creating waves in the air and ether. If we consider this repeated action and reaction, it's clear that it is a result of the persistence of force. The force applied by the finger in bending the prong cannot just vanish. In what form does it remain? It exists as the cohesive tension created among the particles. This cohesive tension cannot end without an equal result. What is that equal result? The momentum generated in the prong as it returns to rest. And what happens to this momentum? It must either remain as momentum or generate some equivalent force. It can't remain as momentum since the parts resist movement due to cohesion; thus, it gradually dissipates as tension among these parts. This is re-transformed into the equivalent momentum, and the cycle continues. If we look at motion through space instead of motion resisted by the cohesion of matter, we find the same truth in a different form. Even though there doesn't seem to be an opposing force and, therefore, no apparent cause for rhythm, the accumulated momentum must ultimately carry the moving body beyond the attracting body, creating a force that contradicts the one that generated it. This conflict results in rhythm, just like in the previous case. The force as momentum in a certain direction cannot be destroyed; and if it eventually fades, it re-emerges in the reaction on the body that's resisting, which starts to pull the now stopped mass back from its farthest point. The only circumstances in which rhythm could be absent—the only conditions in which something could move continuously through space in a straight line forever—would require an infinite void with nothing but the moving object. And neither of these scenarios can be imagined. Infinity is unimaginable; so is a motion that never began from some existing source of power. Thus, rhythm is a necessary feature of all motion. Given the coexistence of opposing forces everywhere—a basic assumption dictated by our experiences—rhythm is an unavoidable result of the persistence of force.
Hence, throughout that re-arrangement of parts which constitutes Evolution, we must nowhere expect to see the change from one position of things to another, effected by continuous movement in the same direction. Be it in that kind of Evolution which the inorganic creation presents, or in that presented by the organic creation, we shall everywhere find a periodicity of action and reaction—a backward and forward motion, of which progress is a differential result.
Hence, throughout that re-arrangement of parts which constitutes Evolution, we must not expect to see the change from one situation to another happening through continuous movement in the same direction. Whether it's in the kind of Evolution shown by the inorganic world or the organic world, we will always find a pattern of action and reaction—a back and forth motion, of which progress is a differing outcome.
15. After having for some years supposed myself alone in the belief that all motion is rhythmical, I discovered that my friend Professor Tyndall also held this doctrine.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.After thinking for several years that I was the only one who believed that all motion is rhythmic, I found out that my friend Professor Tyndall shared this belief too.
CHAPTER XII.
THE ESSENTIAL CONDITIONS FOR EVOLUTION.
§ 100. One more preliminary is needful before proceeding. We have still to study the conditions under which alone, Evolution can take place.
§ 100. One more preliminary step is necessary before moving forward. We still need to examine the conditions under which Evolution can happen.
The process to be interpreted is, as already said, a certain change in the arrangement of parts. That increase of heterogeneity commonly displayed throughout Evolution, is not an increase in the number of kinds of ultimate or undecomposable units which an aggregate contains; but it is a change in the distribution of such units. If it be assumed that what we call chemical elements, are absolutely simple (which is, however, an hypothesis having no better warrant than the opposite one); then it must be admitted that in respect to the number of kinds of matter contained in it, the Earth is not more heterogeneous at present than it was at first—that in this respect, it would be as heterogeneous were all its undecomposable parts uniformly mixed, as it is now, when they are arranged and combined in countless different ways. But the increase of heterogeneity with which we have to deal, and of which alone our senses can take cognizance, is that produced by the passage from unity of distribution to variety of distribution. Given an aggregate consisting of several orders of primitive units that are unchangeable; then, these units may be so uniformly dispersed among each other, that any portion of the mass shall be like any other portion in its sensible properties; 336or they may be so segregated, simply and in endless combinations, that the various portions of the mass shall not be like each other in their sensible properties. A transformation of one of these arrangements into the other, is that which constitutes Evolution. We have to analyze the process through which structural uniformity becomes structural multiformity—to ascertain how the originally equal relations of position among the mixed units, pass into relations of position that are more and more unequal, and more and more numerous in their kinds of inequality; and how this takes place throughout all the ascending grades of compound units, until we come even to those of which societies are made up.
The process we're talking about, as mentioned earlier, involves a specific change in how parts are arranged. The increase in diversity commonly observed in Evolution isn’t actually about an increase in the number of basic or indivisible units that a collection contains; instead, it’s about how those units are distributed. If we assume that what we call chemical elements are completely simple (which is a theory with no stronger evidence than the opposite viewpoint), we must acknowledge that when it comes to the number of types of matter the Earth contains, it is no more diverse now than it was initially. In this sense, it would be just as diverse if all of its indivisible parts were mixed evenly as it is now, where they are arranged and combined in countless ways. However, the increase in diversity we need to focus on, which our senses can perceive, is the shift from a single arrangement to a variety of arrangements. If we have a collection made up of different kinds of basic units that don’t change, those units can be spread evenly among each other, making any part of the mass similar in its observable properties; or they can be grouped in countless different combinations, so that the various parts of the mass are not similar in their observable properties. Changing one of these arrangements to another is what we define as Evolution. We need to analyze how uniform structures evolve into varied structures—specifically, how the originally equal positions among the mixed units change into positions that are increasingly unequal and diverse; and how this occurs across all the higher levels of combined units, right up to those that societies are formed from.
Change in the relations of position among the component units, simple or complex, being the phenomenon we have to interpret; we must first inquire what are the circumstances which prevent its occurrence, and what are the circumstances which facilitate it.
Change in the relationships among the component units, whether simple or complex, is the phenomenon we need to understand. We must first investigate what circumstances prevent it from happening and what circumstances make it easier for it to happen.
§ 101. The constituents of an aggregate cannot be re-arranged, unless they are moveable: manifestly, they must not be so firmly bound together that the incident force fails to alter their positions. No bodies are, indeed, possessed of this absolute rigidity; since an incident force in being propagated through a body, always produces temporary alterations in the relative positions of its units, if not permanent alterations. It is true also, that even permanent re-arrangements of the units may be thus wrought throughout the interiors of comparatively dense masses, without any outward sign: as happens with certain crystals, which, on exposure to sunlight, undergo molecular changes so great as to alter their planes of cleavage. Nevertheless, since total immobility of the parts must totally negative their re-arrangement; and since that comparative immobility which we see in very coherent matter, is a great obstacle to re-arrangement; it is self-evident that Evolution can be exhibited in any considerable 337degree, only where there is comparative mobility of parts. On the other hand, those definite distributive changes which constitute Evolution, cannot be extensively or variously displayed, where the mobility of the parts is extreme. In liquids, the cohesion of the units is so slight that there is no permanency in their relations of position to each other. Such re-arrangement as any incident force generates, is immediately destroyed again by the momentum of the constituents moved; and so, nothing but that temporary heterogeneity seen in circulating currents, can be produced. The like still more obviously holds of gases. Thus, while the theoretical limits between which Evolution is possible, are absolute immobility of parts and absolute mobility of parts; we may say that practically, Evolution cannot go on to any considerable extent where the mobility is very great or very little. A few examples will facilitate the realization of this truth.
§ 101. The components of an aggregate can't be rearranged unless they are movable. Clearly, they shouldn't be so tightly bound together that the applied force fails to change their positions. No objects have this complete rigidity; when a force moves through a body, it always causes temporary shifts in the relative positions of its parts, if not permanent ones. It's also true that even permanent rearrangements of the parts can occur within relatively dense masses without any visible signs, as seen in certain crystals that undergo molecular changes when exposed to sunlight, altering their cleavage planes. However, since total immobility of the parts would completely prevent rearrangement, and that relative immobility seen in very solid matter poses a significant barrier to rearrangement, it's clear that evolution can occur to any significant degree only where there is some mobility of parts. Conversely, the specific distributive changes that represent evolution cannot be widely or variably demonstrated when the mobility of the parts is excessive. In liquids, the cohesion among the units is so weak that their positional relationships lack permanence. Any rearrangement caused by an external force is quickly undone by the momentum of the moved components, resulting in only the temporary heterogeneity observed in flowing currents. This holds even more clearly for gases. Thus, while the theoretical boundaries for possible evolution lie between complete immobility and complete mobility of parts, we can practically state that evolution cannot significantly progress when mobility is either very high or very low. A few examples will help illustrate this point.
The highest degrees of Evolution are found in semi-solid bodies, or bodies that come midway between the two extremes specified. Even semi-solid bodies of the inorganic class, exhibit the segregation of mixed units with comparative readiness: witness the fact to which attention was first drawn by Mr. Babbage, that when the pasty mixture of ground flints and kaolin, prepared for the manufacture of porcelain, is kept some time, it becomes gritty and unfit for use, in consequence of the particles of silica separating themselves from the rest, and uniting together in grains; or witness the fact known to every housewife, that in long-kept currant-jelly the sugar takes the shape of imbedded crystals. While throughout the immense majority of the semi-solid bodies, namely, the organic bodies, the proclivity to a re-arrangement of parts is so comparatively great, as to be usually taken for a distinctive characteristic of them. Among organic bodies themselves, we may trace contrasts having a like significance. It is an accepted generalization that, other things equal, the rate of Evolution is greatest where the plasticity is most 338marked. In that portion of an egg which displays the formative processes during the early stages of incubation, the changes of arrangement are more rapid than those which an equal portion of the body of a hatched chick undergoes. As may be inferred from their respective powers to acquire habits and aptitudes, the structural modifiability of a child is greater than that of an adult man; and the structural modifiability of an adult man is greater than that of an old man: contrasts which are accompanied by corresponding contrasts in the densities of the tissues; since the ratio of water to solid matter diminishes with advancing age. The most decisive proof, however, is furnished by those marked retardations or arrests of organic change, that take place when the tissues suffer a great loss of water. Certain of the lower animals, as the Rotifera, may be rendered apparently lifeless by desiccation, and will yet revive when wetted: as their substance passes from the fluid-solid to the solid state, it ceases to be the seat of those changes which constitute functional activity and cause structural advance; and such changes recommence as their substance passes from the solid to the fluid-solid state. Analogous instances occur among much higher animals. When the African rivers which it inhabits are dried up, the Lepidosiren remains torpid in the hardened mud, until the return of the rainy season brings water. Humboldt states that during the summer drought, the alligators of the Pampas lie buried in a state of suspended animation beneath the parched surface, and struggle up out of the earth as soon as it becomes humid. Now though we have no proof that these partial arrests of vital activity, are consequent on the reduction of the fluid-solid tissues to a more solid form; yet their occurrence along with a cessation in the supply of water, is reason for suspecting that this is the case. And similarly, though in the more numerous instances where loss of water leads to complete arrest of vital activity, we are unable to say that the immediate cause is a stoppage of molecular changes that results from a diminution of molecular 339mobility; yet it seems not improbable that this is the rationale of death by thirst.
The highest levels of evolution are found in semi-solid substances or those that fall between the two extremes outlined. Even semi-solid inorganic substances show the separation of mixed components quite easily. For example, Mr. Babbage pointed out that when a pasty mix of ground flints and kaolin, made for porcelain production, is left for some time, it becomes gritty and unusable because silica particles separate and cluster together into grains. Similarly, every housewife knows that sugar forms embedded crystals in currant jelly that has been stored for a long time. In the vast majority of semi-solid substances, particularly organic ones, the tendency to rearrange parts is so strong that it's often seen as a defining feature. Among organic substances, we can observe contrasts that are similarly significant. It's generally accepted that, all else being equal, the rate of evolution is highest where plasticity is most pronounced. In the part of an egg that undergoes formative processes in the early stages of incubation, the rearrangements happen faster than in an equal portion of a chick's body that has already hatched. As we can infer from their ability to develop skills and habits, a child's structural adaptability is greater than that of an adult man, and an adult man's adaptability is greater than that of an elderly man. These contrasts are accompanied by corresponding differences in tissue densities, as the ratio of water to solid matter decreases with age. The strongest evidence, however, comes from the noticeable slowdowns or halts in organic change that happen when tissues lose a significant amount of water. Certain lower animals, like the *Rotifera*, can appear lifeless when dehydrated but revive when rehydrated. As their substance shifts from a fluid-solid to a solid state, it stops undergoing the changes that signify functional activity and structural growth. These changes restart as their substance transitions back from solid to fluid-solid. Similar examples occur in higher animals. When the African rivers they inhabit dry up, the *Lepidosiren* becomes inactive in hardened mud until the rainy season brings water. Humboldt notes that during summer droughts, alligators in the Pampas stay buried in a state of suspended animation beneath the dry soil, emerging as soon as it becomes moist. While we have no proof that these temporary halts in vital activity are due to the fluid-solid tissues becoming more solid, their occurrence alongside a lack of water suggests this might be the case. Similarly, although in many instances where water loss completely halts vital activity we can't definitively say that the immediate cause is a stop in molecular changes due to decreased molecular mobility, it seems likely that this could explain death by dehydration.
Probably few will expect to find this same condition to Evolution, illustrated in aggregates so widely different in kind as societies. Yet even here it may be shown that no considerable degree of Evolution is exhibited, where there is either great mobility of the parts, or great immobility of them. In such tribes as those inhabiting Australia, we see extremely little cohesion among the units: there is neither that partial fixity of relative positions which results from the commencement of agriculture, nor that partial fixity of relative positions implied by the establishment of social grades. And along with this want of cohesion, we find an absence of permanent differentiations. Conversely, in societies of the oriental type, where accumulated traditions, laws, and usages, and long-fixed class-arrangements, exercise great restraining power over individual actions, we find Evolution almost stopped. Through the medium of institutions and opinions, the forces brought to bear on each unit by the rest, are so great as to prevent the units from sensibly yielding to forces tending to re-arrange them. The condition most favourable to increase of social heterogeneity, is a medium coherence among the parts—a moderate facility of change in the relations of citizens, joined with a moderate resistance to such change—a considerable freedom of individual actions, qualified by a considerable restraint over individual actions—a certain attachment to pre-established arrangements, and a certain readiness to be impelled by new influences into new arrangements—a compromise between fixity and unfixity such as that which we, perhaps as much as any nation, exhibit.
Probably few will expect to find this same condition of evolution in such vastly different types of societies. Yet even here, it can be shown that significant evolution does not occur when there is either extreme mobility among the parts or extreme stability. In tribes like those in Australia, there's very little cohesion among the individuals: there's neither the partial stability of positions that comes with the start of agriculture nor the partial stability of positions suggested by the creation of social classes. Along with this lack of cohesion, we see a lack of permanent differentiation. On the other hand, in societies of the eastern type, where accumulated traditions, laws, and customs, along with long-established class structures, significantly restrict individual actions, evolution almost comes to a halt. Through institutions and beliefs, the influence each member feels from the rest is so strong that it prevents any significant change. The condition most conducive to increasing social diversity is a medium level of cohesion among the parts—a moderate ease of change in relationships among citizens, combined with a moderate resistance to such changes—a good amount of personal freedom balanced by some constraints on individual actions—a certain attachment to established arrangements, along with a readiness to be influenced by new ideas into new arrangements—a compromise between stability and change that we, perhaps more than any nation, demonstrate.
§ 102. Another condition to Evolution, of the same order as the last though of a different genus, must be noted. We have found that permanent re-arrangement among the units of an aggregate, can take place only when they have neither 340extreme immobility nor extreme mobility. The mobility and immobility thus far considered (at least in all aggregates except social ones) are those due to mechanical cohesion. There is, however, what we must call chemical cohesion, which also influences the mobility of the units, and consequently the re-arrangement of them. Manifestly, if two or more kinds of units contained in any aggregate, are united by powerful affinities, an incident force, failing to destroy their cohesions, will not cause such various re-arrangements as it would, could it produce new chemical combinations as well as new mechanical adjustments. On the other hand, chemical affinities that are easily overcome, must be favourable to multiplied re-arrangements of the units.
§ 102. Another condition for evolution, similar to the previous one but of a different type, needs to be noted. We've discovered that a permanent re-arrangement among the elements of a group can only happen when they have neither extreme immobility nor extreme mobility. The types of mobility and immobility we've discussed so far (at least in all groups except social ones) are due to mechanical cohesion. However, there’s also what we should refer to as chemical cohesion, which influences the mobility of the units and, consequently, their re-arrangement. Clearly, if two or more types of units within any group are connected by strong affinities, an external force that does not break their cohesion will not lead to as many diverse re-arrangements as it would if it could create new chemical combinations alongside new mechanical adjustments. Conversely, chemical affinities that can be easily overcome must encourage multiple re-arrangements of the units.
This condition, as well as the preceding one, is fulfilled in the highest degree, by those aggregates which most variously display the transformation of the uniform into the multiform. Organic bodies are on the average distinguished from inorganic bodies, by the readiness with which the compounds they consist of undergo decomposition, and recomposition: the chemical cohesions of their components are so comparatively small, that small incident forces suffice to overcome them and cause transpositions of the components. Further, between the two great divisions of organisms, we find a contrast in the degree of Evolution co-existing with a contrast in the degree of chemical modifiability. As a class, the nitrogenous compounds are peculiarly unstable; and, speaking generally, these are present in much larger quantities in animal tissues than they are in vegetal tissues; while, speaking generally, animals are much more heterogeneous than plants.
This condition, as well as the previous one, is met to the highest degree by those collections that most diversely show the change from the uniform to the varied. Organic bodies are typically recognized as distinct from inorganic bodies by how easily the compounds they are made of can break down and recombine. The chemical bonds between their components are relatively weak, so even small external forces are enough to break them and rearrange the components. Moreover, between the two major groups of organisms, we see a difference in the level of evolution alongside a difference in the level of chemical adaptability. As a category, nitrogenous compounds are particularly unstable, and generally speaking, they are found in much larger amounts in animal tissues than in plant tissues; at the same time, animals tend to be much more diverse than plants.
Under this head it may be well also to point out that, other things equal, the structural variety which is possible in any aggregate, must bear a relation to the number of kinds of units contained in the aggregate. A body made up of units of one order, cannot admit of so many different re-arrangements, 341as one made up of units of two orders. And each additional order of units must increase, in a geometrical proportion, the number of re-arrangements that may be made.
Under this topic, it's also important to note that, all else being equal, the variety of structure possible in any group is related to the number of different types of units within that group. A body composed of units of one type can't have as many different arrangements as one made up of units of two types. Each additional type of unit must increase, in a geometric way, the number of arrangements that can be formed. 341
§ 103. Yet one more condition to be specified, is the state of agitation in which the constituents of an aggregate are kept. A familiar expedience will introduce us to this condition. When a vessel has been filled to the brim with loose fragments, shaking the vessel causes them to settle down into less space, so that more may be put in. And when among these fragments, there are some of much greater specific gravity than the rest, these will, in the course of a prolonged shaking, find their way to the bottom. What now is the meaning of these two results, when expressed in general terms? We have a group of units acted on by an incident force—the attraction of the Earth. So long as these units are not agitated, this incident force produces no changes in their relative positions; agitate them, and immediately their loose arrangement passes into a more compact arrangement. Again, so long as they are not agitated, the incident force cannot separate the heavier units from the lighter; agitate them, and immediately the heavier units begin to segregate. By these illustrations, a rude idea will be conveyed of the effect which vibration has in facilitating those re-arrangements which constitute Evolution. What here happens with visible units subject to visible oscillations, happens also with invisible units subject to invisible oscillations.
§ 103. Yet another important condition to mention is the level of agitation among the components of a group. A common example will lead us into this condition. When a container is filled to the top with loose pieces, shaking it allows them to compress into a smaller space, making room for more. And when some of these pieces are much denser than the others, over time, they will settle at the bottom. What do these two outcomes mean in general terms? We have a collection of units being acted on by an external force—the pull of the Earth. As long as these units are not agitated, this external force causes no changes in their positions relative to one another; when agitated, their loose arrangement shifts into a denser configuration. Similarly, while they remain unshaken, the external force cannot separate the heavier units from the lighter ones; when agitated, the heavier units start to separate. These examples convey a basic understanding of how vibration helps facilitate the rearrangements that drive Evolution. What occurs with visible units experiencing visible movements also applies to invisible units undergoing invisible movements.
One or two cases in which these oscillations are of mechanical origin, may first be noted. When a bar of steel is suspended in the magnetic meridian, and repeatedly so struck as to send vibrations through it, it becomes magnetized: the magnetic force of the Earth, which does not permanently affect it while undisturbed, alters its internal state when a mechanical agitation is propagated among its particles; and the alteration is believed by physicists, to be a molecular re-arrangement. 342It may be fairly objected that this re-arrangement is hypothetical; and did the fact stand alone, it would be of little worth. It gains significance, however, when joined with the fact that in the same substance, long-continued mechanical vibrations are followed by molecular re-arrangements that are abundantly visible. A piece of iron which, when it leaves the workshop, is fibrous in structure, will become crystalline if exposed to a perpetual jar. Though the polar forces mutually exercised by the atoms, fail to change their disorderly arrangement into an orderly arrangement while the atoms are relatively quiescent, these forces produce this change when the atoms are kept in a state of intestine disturbance.
One or two examples of mechanical oscillations can be noted. When a steel bar is hung in the magnetic meridian and struck repeatedly to create vibrations, it becomes magnetized. The Earth's magnetic force, which doesn't permanently affect it when undisturbed, changes its internal state when mechanical agitation spreads through its particles; physicists believe this change is a molecular re-arrangement. 342 It can be reasonably argued that this re-arrangement is hypothetical, and if it were the only evidence, it would hold little value. However, it becomes significant when linked to the fact that in the same material, prolonged mechanical vibrations lead to molecular re-arrangements that are clearly observable. A piece of iron that is fibrous in structure when it leaves the workshop will become crystalline if subjected to continuous jolting. Although the polar forces that atoms exert on each other do not transform their disordered arrangement into an ordered one while the atoms are relatively still, these forces bring about this change when the atoms are kept in a state of constant disturbance.
But the effects which visible oscillations and oscillations sensible to touch, have in facilitating the re-arrangement of parts by an incident force, are insignificant compared with the effects which insensible oscillations have in aiding such change of structure. It is a doctrine now generally accepted among men of science, that the particles of tangible matter, as well as the particles of ether, undulate. As interpreted in conformity with this doctrine, the heat of a body is simply its state of molecular motion. A mass which feels cold, is one having but slight molecular motion, and conveying but slight molecular motion to the surrounding medium or to the hand touching it. A mass hot enough to radiate a sensible warmth, is one of which the more violently agitated molecules, communicate increased undulations to the surrounding ethereal medium; while the burn inflicted by it on the skin, is the expression of increased undulations of the organic molecules. Such further heat as produces softening and a consequent distortion of the mass, is an agitation so much augmented that the units can no longer completely maintain their relative positions. Fusion is an agitation so extreme, that the relative positions of the units are changeable with ease. When, finally, at a still higher temperature, the liquid is transformed into a gas, the explanation 343is, that the oscillations are so violent as to overbalance that force which held the units in close contiguity—so violent as to keep the units at those relatively great distances apart to which they are now thrown. Since the establishment of the correlation between heat and motion first gave probability to this hypothesis, it has been receiving various confirmations—especially by recent remarkable discoveries respecting the absorption of heat by gases. Prof. Tyndall has proved that the quantity of heat which any gas takes up from rays of heat passing through it, has a distinct relation to the complexity of the atoms composing the gas. The simple gases abstract but little; the gases composed of binary atoms abstract, say in round numbers, a hundred times as much; while the gases composed of atoms severally containing three, four, or more simple ones, abstract something like a thousand times as much. These differences Prof. Tyndall regards as due to the different abilities of the different atoms to take up, in the increase of their own undulations, those undulations of the ethereal medium which constitute heat—an interpretation in perfect accordance with the late results of spectrum-analysis; which go to show that the various elementary atoms, when in an aeriform state, intercept those luminiferous vibrations of the ether which are in unison or harmony with their own. And since it holds of solid as of gaseous matters, that those consisting of simple units transmit heat far more readily than those consisting of complex units; we get confirmation of the inference otherwise reached, that the units of matter in whatever state of aggregation they exist, oscillate, and that variations of temperature are variations in the amounts of their oscillations.
But the effects of visible oscillations and oscillations that can be felt by touch in helping rearrange parts due to an external force are minor compared to the effects that invisible oscillations have in facilitating such structural changes. It's a widely accepted belief among scientists that both solid matter particles and ether particles oscillate. In line with this belief, the heat of an object is simply its state of molecular motion. A mass that feels cold has little molecular motion and transmits minimal molecular motion to the surrounding environment or to the hand touching it. A mass hot enough to radiate noticeable warmth is one where the more violently stirred molecules send increased undulations to the surrounding ether; the burn it inflicts on the skin represents the heightened undulations of organic molecules. Additional heat that causes softening and distortion of the mass results in agitation so intensified that the units can no longer maintain their relative positions. Fusion is an agitation so intense that the relative positions of the units can change easily. Finally, at even higher temperatures, when a liquid turns into gas, the explanation is that the oscillations are so vigorous that they overpower the force keeping the units close together—so intense that they keep the units at the relatively large distances they are now apart. Since establishing the connection between heat and motion first made this hypothesis plausible, it has received various confirmations—especially from recent remarkable discoveries about how gases absorb heat. Prof. Tyndall has shown that the amount of heat a gas absorbs from passing heat rays has a specific relation to the complexity of the atoms that make up the gas. Simple gases absorb very little; gases made of two atoms absorb about a hundred times more; while gases made of atoms that contain three, four, or more simple atoms absorb roughly a thousand times as much. Prof. Tyndall believes these differences are due to the varying abilities of different atoms to increase their own oscillations by absorbing undulations from the ether that constitute heat—an interpretation that aligns perfectly with recent results from spectrum analysis, which indicate that different elementary atoms, when in a gaseous state, intercept those light vibrations of the ether that resonate with their own. And since the same is true for solid and gaseous materials—that those made of simple units transmit heat much more readily than those made of complex units—we gain additional support for the conclusion that the units of matter, regardless of their state of aggregation, oscillate, and that changes in temperature correspond to changes in the amounts of their oscillations.
Proceeding on this hypothesis, which it would be out of place here to defend at greater length, we have now to note how the re-arrangement of parts is facilitated by these insensible vibrations, as we have seen it to be by sensible vibrations. One or two cases of physical re-arrangement may first be noted. When some molten glass is dropped into 344water, and when its outside is thus, by sudden solidification, prevented from partaking in that contraction which the subsequent cooling of the inside tends to produce; the units are left in such a state of tension, that the mass flies into fragments if a small portion of it be broken off. But now, if this mass be kept for a day or two at a considerable heat, though a heat not sufficient to alter its form or produce any sensible diminution of hardness, this extreme brittleness disappears: the component particles being thrown into greater agitation, the tensile forces are enabled to re-arrange them into a state of equilibrium. An illustration of another order is furnished by the subsidence of fine precipitates. These sink down very slowly from solutions that are cold; while warm solutions deposit them with comparative rapidity. That is to say, an increase of molecular vibration throughout the mass, allows the suspended particles to separate more readily from the particles of fluid. The effect of heat on chemical re-arrangement is so familiar, that examples are scarcely needed. Be the substances concerned gaseous, liquid, or solid, it equally holds that their chemical unions and disunions are aided by a rise of temperature. Affinities which do not suffice to effect the re-arrangement of mixed units that are in a state of feeble agitation, suffice to effect it when the agitation is raised to a certain point. And so long as this molecular motion is not great enough to prevent those chemical cohesions which the affinities tend to produce, increase of it gives increased facility of chemical re-arrangement.
Following this hypothesis, which I won't elaborate on here, we now need to observe how the re-arrangement of parts is aided by these subtle vibrations, just as we've seen with noticeable vibrations. A couple of examples of physical re-arrangement can first be highlighted. When some molten glass is dropped into 344water, the outside solidifies quickly, preventing it from contracting like the inside, which cools down later. This leaves the units under tension, causing the mass to shatter if a small piece is broken off. However, if this mass is kept at a relatively high temperature for a day or two—without enough heat to change its shape or noticeably reduce its hardness—this extreme brittleness goes away. The particles become more agitated, allowing the tensile forces to rearrange them into a state of balance. Another example is the settling of fine precipitates. These settle very slowly from cold solutions, while warm solutions allow them to settle down much faster. In other words, an increase in molecular vibration throughout the mixture helps the suspended particles separate more easily from the fluid. The impact of heat on chemical re-arrangement is so well-known that specific examples are rarely needed. Whether the substances involved are gases, liquids, or solids, it remains true that higher temperatures facilitate their chemical bonds forming and breaking. Affinities that aren't strong enough to rearrange mixed units in a state of low agitation become effective once the agitation reaches a certain level. As long as this molecular motion isn't too intense to disrupt the chemical connections that the affinities promote, increasing it enhances the ease of chemical re-arrangement.
This condition, in common with the preceding ones, is fulfilled most completely in those aggregates which exhibit the phenomena of Evolution in the highest degree; namely, the organic aggregates. And throughout the various orders and states of these, we find minor contrasts showing the relation between amount of molecular vibration and activity of the metamorphic changes. Such contrasts may be arranged in the several following groups. Speaking generally, the phenomena of Evolution are manifested in a much lower 345degree throughout the vegetal kingdom than throughout the animal kingdom; and speaking generally, the heat of plants is less than that of animals. Among plants themselves, the organic changes vary in rate as the temperature varies. Though light is the agent which effects those molecular changes causing vegetal growth, yet we see that in the absence of heat, such changes are not effected: in winter there is enough light, but the heat being insufficient, plant-life is suspended. That this is the sole cause of the suspension, is proved by the fact that at the same season, plants contained in hot-houses, where they receive even a smaller amount of light, go on producing leaves and flowers. A comparison of the several divisions of the animal kingdom with each other, shows among them parallel relations. Regarded as a whole, vertebrate animals are higher in temperature than invertebrate ones; and they are as a whole higher in organic activity and development. Between subdivisions of the vertebrata themselves, like differences in the state of molecular vibration, accompany like differences in the degree of evolution. The least heterogeneous of the vertebrata are the fishes; and in most cases, the heat of fishes is nearly the same as that of the water in which they swim: only some of them being decidedly warmer. Though we habitually speak of reptiles as cold-blooded; and though they have not much more power than fishes of maintaining a temperature above that of their medium; yet since their medium (which is, in the majority of cases, the air of warm climates) is on the average warmer than the medium inhabited by fishes, the temperature of the class of reptiles is higher than that of the class of fishes; and we see in them a correspondingly higher complexity. The much more active molecular agitation in mammals and birds, is associated with a considerably greater multiformity of structure and a very much greater vivacity. And though birds, which are hotter blooded than mammals, do not show us a greater multiformity; yet, judging from their apparently greater locomotive powers, we may 346infer more rapid functional changes, which, equally with structural changes, imply molecular re-arrangement. The most instructive contrasts, however, are those presented by the same organic aggregates at different temperatures. Thus we see that ova undergoing development, must be kept more or less warm—that in the absence of a certain molecular vibration, the re-arrangement of parts does not go on. We see, again, that in hybernating animals, loss of heat carried to a particular point, results in extreme retardation of the organic changes. Yet further, we see that in animals which do not hybernate, as in man, prolonged exposure to extreme cold, produces an irresistible tendency to sleep (which implies a lowering of the functional activity); and then, if the abstraction of heat continues, this sleep ends in death, or arrest of functional activity. Lastly, we see that when the temperature is lowered till the contained water solidifies, there is a stoppage not only of those molecular re-arrangements which constitute life and development, but also of those molecular re-arrangements which constitute decomposition.
This condition, like the previous ones, is most fully realized in aggregates that show the phenomena of Evolution to a great extent; specifically, the organic aggregates. Throughout the various orders and states of these, we observe minor contrasts that reveal the relationship between the level of molecular vibration and the activity of metamorphic changes. These contrasts can be grouped in several ways. Generally speaking, the phenomena of Evolution are exhibited to a much lesser degree in the plant kingdom than in the animal kingdom; and overall, plants are cooler than animals. Among plants, the rate of organic changes varies with temperature. Although light drives the molecular changes necessary for plant growth, we find that without sufficient heat, these changes do not occur: in winter, there is plenty of light, but with inadequate heat, plant life halts. This is confirmed by the fact that, during the same season, plants in greenhouses, which receive even less light, continue to produce leaves and flowers. A comparison of the various branches of the animal kingdom reveals similar relationships. Vertebrate animals are generally warmer than invertebrate ones, and they tend to have higher levels of organic activity and development. Among the different subdivisions of vertebrates, similar degrees of evolution coincide with similar states of molecular vibration. The least diverse vertebrates are fish, whose body temperatures typically match that of the water they swim in, with only a few being noticeably warmer. While we usually describe reptiles as cold-blooded and they do not have much ability to maintain a temperature above their environment, since their environment (mostly warm air) is generally warmer than the water habitats of fish, reptiles have a higher average temperature and a correspondingly higher complexity. Mammals and birds, with their more active molecular agitation, show significantly greater structural diversity and liveliness. Although birds have a higher body temperature than mammals, they do not exhibit greater diversity; however, judging by their apparent superior ability to move, we can infer that they undergo more rapid functional changes, which, like structural changes, suggest molecular re-arrangement. The most revealing contrasts are those presented by the same organic aggregates at different temperatures. For example, developing eggs need to be maintained at a certain warmth; without a specific level of molecular vibration, the re-arrangement of parts cannot take place. Additionally, in hibernating animals, a certain loss of heat leads to a significant slowing down of organic changes. Furthermore, in non-hibernating animals, such as humans, prolonged exposure to extreme cold triggers an overwhelming desire to sleep (which indicates a drop in functional activity); if heat loss continues, this sleep can result in death or a complete halt in functional activity. Finally, when the temperature drops low enough for the water inside organisms to freeze, not only do the molecular re-arrangements that represent life and development cease, but so do those processes that lead to decomposition.
Evidently then, both sensible and insensible agitations among the components of an aggregate, facilitate any re-distributions to which there may be a tendency. When that rhythmic change in the relative positions of the units which constitutes vibration, is considerable, the relative positions of the units more readily undergo permanent changes through the action of incident forces.
Clearly, both noticeable and subtle movements among the parts of a whole make it easier for any shifts to happen. When the rhythmic change in the arrangement of the units, which we call vibration, is significant, the arrangement of the units is more likely to experience lasting changes due to external forces.
§ 104. These special conditions to Evolution, are clearly but different forms of one general condition. The abstract proposition, that a permanent re-arrangement of units is possible only when they have neither absolute immobility nor absolute mobility with respect to each other, we saw to be practically equivalent to the proposition, that extreme cohesion and extreme want of cohesion among the units are unfavourable to Evolution. Be this cohesion or want of cohesion 347that which physically characterizes the matter as we ordinarily know it; be it that cohesion or want of cohesion distinguished as chemical; or be it that cohesion or want of cohesion consequent on the degree of molecular vibration; matters not, in so far as the general conclusion is concerned. Inductively as well as deductively, we find that the genesis of such permanent changes in the relative positions of parts, as can be effected without destroying the continuity of the aggregate, implies a medium stability in the relative positions of the parts: be this stability physical, chemical, or that which varies with the state of agitation. And as might be anticipated à priori, it is proved à posteriori, that this re-arrangement of parts goes on most actively in those aggregates whose units are moderately influenced by all these forces which affect their mobility.
§ 104. These special conditions of Evolution are clearly different forms of one general condition. The basic idea that a permanent rearrangement of units is only possible when they have neither complete immobility nor complete mobility with respect to each other is practically equivalent to the idea that extreme cohesion and extreme lack of cohesion among the units hinder Evolution. Whether this cohesion or lack of cohesion physically characterizes matter as we usually know it, or if we identify it as chemical cohesion or lack thereof, or if it's linked to the degree of molecular vibration, it doesn’t change the overall conclusion. Both inductively and deductively, we find that the emergence of such permanent changes in the relative positions of parts, which can occur without disrupting the continuity of the whole, requires a moderate stability in the relative positions of those parts—whether that stability is physical, chemical, or varies with the state of agitation. As one might expect a priori, it is confirmed after the fact that this rearrangement of parts occurs most actively in those aggregates where the units are moderately affected by all these forces that influence their mobility.
Here also may properly be added the remark, that to effect these changes in the relative positions of parts, the incident forces must range within certain limits. It is wholly a question of the ratio between those agencies which hold the units in their positions, and those agencies which tend to change their positions. Having given intensities in the powers that oppose re-arrangement, there need proportionate intensities in the powers that work re-arrangement. As there must be neither too great nor too little cohesion; so there must be neither too little nor too great amounts of the influences antagonistic to cohesion. While a slight mechanical strain produces no lasting alterations in the relative positions of parts, an excessive mechanical strain causes disruption—causes so great an alteration in the relative positions of parts as to destroy their union in one aggregate. While a very feeble chemical affinity brought to bear on the associated units, fails to work any re-arrangement of them; a chemical affinity that is extremely intense, destroys their structural continuity, and reduces such complex re-arrangements as have been made, to comparatively simple ones. And while in the absence of adequate thermal undulations, the units 348have not freedom enough to obey the re-arranging influences impressed on them, the incidence of violent thermal undulations gives them such extreme freedom that they break their connexions, and the aggregate lapses into a liquid or gaseous form.
Here, it's important to note that in order to make these changes in the positions of parts, the forces involved must stay within certain limits. It all comes down to the balance between the forces that keep the units in place and those that attempt to change their positions. If there are certain strengths in the forces that resist re-arrangement, there should also be proportional strengths in the forces that encourage it. Just as there can't be too strong or too weak of cohesion, there can't be too weak or too strong of the forces working against cohesion. A small mechanical strain doesn’t usually cause lasting changes in the positions of parts, but too much mechanical strain leads to disruption, causing such a significant shift in their positions that they lose their connection as a whole. Similarly, a very weak chemical affinity acting on the connected units doesn’t lead to any re-arrangement, while an extremely strong chemical affinity breaks their structural continuity, simplifying any complex re-arrangements that had occurred. Additionally, without sufficient thermal fluctuations, the units lack the freedom to respond to the re-arranging influences acting on them, but when faced with intense thermal fluctuations, they gain so much freedom that they break their connections, and the whole system turns into a liquid or gas.
On the one hand, therefore, the statical forces which uphold the state of aggregation must not be so great as wholly to prevent those changes of relative position among the units which the dynamical forces tend to produce; and, on the other hand, the dynamical forces must not be so great as wholly to overcome the statical forces, and destroy the state of aggregation. The excess of the dynamical forces must be sufficient to produce Evolution, but not sufficient to produce Dissolution.
On one hand, the static forces that maintain the state of aggregation shouldn't be so strong that they completely stop the changes in relative position among the units that the dynamic forces aim to create; on the other hand, the dynamic forces shouldn't be so powerful that they entirely overpower the static forces and ruin the state of aggregation. The dynamic forces need to be strong enough to drive Evolution, but not so strong that they cause Dissolution.
§ 105. And now we are naturally introduced to a consideration which, though it does not come quite within the limits of this chapter as expressed in its title, may yet be more conveniently dealt with here than elsewhere. Hitherto we have studied the metamorphosis of things, only as exhibited in the changed distribution of matter. It remains to look at it as exhibited in the changed distribution of motion. The definition of Evolution in its material aspect, has to be supplemented by a definition of Evolution in its dynamical aspect.
§ 105. Now we naturally move on to a topic that, while it doesn't completely fit within the boundaries of this chapter as stated in its title, might be more conveniently addressed here than elsewhere. Up to this point, we have examined the transformation of things only in terms of how matter is redistributed. We now need to consider it in terms of how motion is redistributed. The definition of Evolution regarding its material aspect needs to be expanded with a definition of Evolution concerning its dynamic aspect.
On inquiring the source of the sensible motions seen in every kind of Evolution, we find them all traceable to insensible motions; either of that tangible matter which we perceive as constituting the objects around us, or of that intangible matter which we infer as occupying space. A brief reconsideration of the facts will make this obvious. The formation of celestial bodies, supposing it caused by the union of dispersed units, must, from the beginning, have involved a diminished motion of these units with respect to each other; and such motion as each resulting body acquired, must previously have existed in the motions of its units. If concrete matter 349has arisen by the aggregation of diffused matter, then concrete motion has arisen by the aggregation of diffused motion. That which now exists as the movement of masses, implies the cessation of an equivalent molecular movement. Those transpositions of matter which constitute geological changes, are clearly referable to the same source. As before shown, the denudation of lands and deposit of new strata, are effected by water in the course of its descent from the clouds to the sea, or during the arrest of those undulations produced on it by winds; and, as before shown, the elevation of water to the height whence it fell, is due to solar heat, as is also the genesis of those aerial currents which drift it about when evaporated and agitate its surface when condensed. That is to say, the molecular motion of the etherial medium, is transformed into the motion of gases, thence into the motion of liquids, and thence into the motion of solids—stages in each of which, successively, a certain amount of molecular motion is lost and an equivalent motion of masses produced. If we seek the origin of vital movements, we soon reach a like conclusion. The actinic rays issuing from the Sun, enable the plant to reduce special elements existing in gaseous combination around it, to a solid form,—enable the plant, that is, to grow and carry on its functional changes. And since growth, equally with circulation of sap, is a mode of sensible motion, while those rays which have been expended in generating it consist of insensible motions, we have here, too, a transformation of the kind alleged. Animals, derived as their forces are, directly or indirectly, from plants, carry this transformation a step further. The automatic movements of the viscera, together with the voluntary movements of the limbs and body at large, arise at the expense of certain molecular movements throughout the nervous and muscular tissues; and these originally arose at the expense of certain other molecular movements propagated by the Sun to the Earth; so that both the structural and functional motions which organic Evolution displays, are motions of aggregates generated by 350the arrested motions of units. Even with the aggregates of these aggregates the same rule holds. For among associated men, the progress is ever towards a merging of individual actions in the actions of corporate bodies. An undeveloped society is composed of members between whom there is little concert: they fulfil their several wants without mutual aid; and only on occasions of aggression or defence, act together—occasions on which their combination, small as it is in extent, frequently fails because it is so imperfect. In the course of civilization, however, co-operation becomes step by step more decided. As tribes grow into nations, there result larger aggregates, each of which has a joint political life—a common policy and movement with respect to other aggregates. Legislative and administrative progress, involves an increase in the number of restraining agents brought into united and simultaneous action. In military organization, we see an advance from small undisciplined hordes of armed men, to vast bodies of regular troops, so drilled that the movements of the units are entirely subordinated to the movements of the masses. Nor does industrial development fail to show parallel changes. Beginning with independent workers, and passing step by step to the employment of several assistants by one master, there has ever been, and still is, a progress towards the co-operation of greater masses of labourers in the same establishment, and towards the union of capitalists into more numerous and larger companies: in both which kinds of combined action, equivalent amounts of individual action disappear. Under all its forms, then, Evolution, considered dynamically, is a decrease in the relative movements of parts, and an increase in the relative movements of wholes—using the words parts and wholes in their widest senses. From the infinitesimal motions of those infinitesimal units composing the etherial medium, to the larger though still insensible motions of the larger though still insensible units composing gaseous, fluid, and solid matter, and thence to the visible motions of visible aggregates, 351the advance is from molecular motion to the motion of masses.
When we investigate the source of the noticeable movements seen in every type of Evolution, we find they all trace back to imperceptible movements; either of the tangible matter we understand as making up the objects around us or of the intangible matter we assume to occupy space. A quick review of the facts will make this clear. The formation of celestial bodies, if caused by the merging of dispersed units, must have involved a reduction in the motion of these units in relation to one another from the very beginning; and the motion that each resulting body acquired must have existed beforehand in the motions of its units. If solid matter has arisen from the aggregation of scattered matter, then solid motion has come from the aggregation of scattered motion. The movements we now see as the motion of large masses imply the stopping of an equivalent molecular movement. The shifts of matter that make up geological changes clearly originate from the same source. As previously shown, the erosion of land and the deposition of new layers are caused by water as it flows from the clouds to the sea or during the pauses in the waves produced by the wind. Moreover, as stated earlier, the raising of water to the height it fell from is due to solar heat, which also creates the air currents that move it around when it evaporates and stir its surface when it condenses. In other words, the molecular motion of the ether medium is converted into the movement of gases, then into the movement of liquids, and finally into the movement of solids—each stage losing a certain amount of molecular motion while generating an equivalent motion of masses. If we look for the source of vital movements, we quickly arrive at a similar conclusion. The actinic rays from the Sun enable plants to convert specific elements in the surrounding gaseous mix into solid forms—allowing plants to grow and carry out their various functions. Since growth, like the circulation of sap, is a kind of noticeable motion, while those rays that have been used to generate it consist of imperceptible motions, we again see a transformation of the kind mentioned. Animals, deriving their energy directly or indirectly from plants, take this transformation a step further. The automatic movements of the organs, along with the voluntary movements of limbs and the body as a whole, come at the expense of certain molecular movements throughout the nervous and muscular tissues; and these originally arose from other molecular movements transmitted by the Sun to the Earth. Thus, both the structural and functional motions displayed by organic Evolution are motions of aggregates generated by the halted motions of units. Even among the aggregates of these aggregates, the same principle applies. Among associated individuals, progress always moves toward a blending of personal actions within the actions of groups. An undeveloped society is made up of members who have little coordination: they satisfy their individual needs without helping each other; and only in situations of attack or defense do they act collectively—situations when their combination, despite its small scale, often fails because it is so ineffective. However, as civilization progresses, cooperation becomes increasingly definite. As tribes develop into nations, larger aggregates emerge, each having a shared political life—a common policy and movement regarding other aggregates. Legislative and administrative advancements involve an increase in the number of regulating agents working together in coordinated action. In military organization, we observe a shift from small, undisciplined groups of armed men to large groups of regular troops, trained so that the movements of individual units are entirely subordinated to the movements of the masses. Similarly, industrial development shows corresponding changes. Starting with independent workers and gradually moving toward employing several assistants by a single master, there has always been—and continues to be—a trend toward greater cooperation among larger groups of laborers within the same workplace and the unification of capitalists into more numerous and larger companies: in both cases, equivalent amounts of individual action diminish. So, in all its forms, Evolution, viewed dynamically, represents a decrease in the relative movements of individual parts and an increase in the relative movements of wholes—using the terms parts and wholes in their broadest meanings. From the tiny motions of the infinitesimal units that make up the ether medium to the larger yet still imperceptible motions of the bigger, still imperceptible units that make up gaseous, liquid, and solid matter, and then to the visible motions of visible aggregates, the progression moves from molecular motion to mass motion.
But now what of the converse process? If the foregoing proposition is true, then a change from the motion of masses to molecular motion, is the opposite to Evolution—is Dissolution. Is this so? Of inorganic dissolution we have but little experience; or at least, our experience of it is on too small a scale to exhibit it as the antithesis of Evolution. We know, indeed, that when solids are dissolved in liquids, their dissolution implies increased movements of their units, at the expense of diminished movements among the units of their solvents; and we know that when a liquid evaporates, its dissipation or dissolution similarly implies greater relative movements of the units, and decrease of such combined movement as they before had. But since these small aggregates of inorganic matter, do not exhibit the phenomena of Evolution, save in the form of simple integration; so they do not exhibit the phenomena of dissolution, save in the form of simple disintegration. Of organic dissolution, however, our experience suffices to show that it is a decrease of combined motion, and an increase in the motion of uncombined parts. The gradual cessation of functions, vegetal or animal, is a cessation of the sensible movements of fluids and solids. In animals, the impulsions of the body from place to place, first cease; presently the limbs cannot be stirred; later still the respiratory actions stop; finally the heart becomes stationary, and, with it, the circulating fluids. That is, the transformation of molecular motion into the motion of masses, comes to an end. What next takes place? We cannot say that sensible movements are transformed into insensible movements; for sensible movements no longer exist. Nevertheless, the process of decay involves an increase of insensible movements; since this is far greater in the gases generated by decomposition, than it is in the fluid-solid matters generating them. Indeed, it might be contended that as, during Dissolution, there is a change from the vibration 352of large compound atoms to the vibration of small and comparatively simple ones, the process is strictly antithetical to that of Evolution. In conformity with the now current conception lately explained, each of the highly complex chemical units composing an organic body, possesses a rhythmic movement—a movement in which its many component units jointly partake. When decomposition breaks up these highly complex atoms, and their constituents assume a gaseous form, there is both an increase of molecular motion implied by the diffusion, and a further increase implied by the resolving of such motions as the aggregate atoms possessed, into motions of their constituent atoms. So that in organic dissolution we have, first, an end put to that transformation of the motion of units into the motion of aggregates, which constitutes Evolution, dynamically considered; and we have also, though in a subtler sense, a transformation of the motion of aggregates into the motion of units. The formula equally applies to the dissolution of a society. When social ties, be they governmental or industrial, are destroyed, the combined actions of citizens lapse into uncombined actions. Those general forces which restrained individual doings, having disappeared, the only remaining restraints are those separately exercised by individuals on each other. There are no longer any of the joint operations by which men satisfy their wants; and, in so far as they can, they satisfy their wants by separate operations. That is to say, the movement of parts replaces the movement of wholes.
But what about the reverse process? If the previous statement is true, then a shift from the movement of masses to molecular motion is the opposite of Evolution—it’s Dissolution. Is that correct? We don’t have much experience with inorganic dissolution; or at least, our experience is too limited to show it as the opposite of Evolution. We know that when solids dissolve in liquids, their dissolution means increased movement of their units at the expense of decreased movement among the units of the solvents. And when a liquid evaporates, its dissipation or dissolution similarly suggests greater relative movements of the units, leading to a decrease in the combined movement they had before. However, since these small aggregates of inorganic matter don’t show the phenomena of Evolution, except as simple integration, they also don’t show the phenomena of dissolution, apart from simple disintegration. As for organic dissolution, our experience indicates that it leads to a decrease in combined motion and an increase in the motion of uncombined parts. The gradual stopping of functions, whether vegetative or animal, means a halt in the observable movements of fluids and solids. In animals, the ability to move from place to place ceases first; soon the limbs can’t be moved; respiratory actions stop later; and finally, the heart becomes still, along with the circulating fluids. In other words, the transformation of molecular motion into the movement of masses comes to an end. What happens next? We can’t say that observable movements transform into unobservable movements because observable movements no longer exist. However, the process of decay involves an increase in unobservable movements, as this increase is much greater in the gases produced by decomposition than in the fluid-solid materials that generate them. Indeed, one could argue that during Dissolution, there’s a shift from the vibration of large compound atoms to the vibration of smaller, simpler ones, making it strictly the opposite of Evolution. According to the now common understanding explained earlier, each of the complex chemical units that make up an organic body has a rhythmic movement—a movement involving all its many component units. When decomposition breaks these complex atoms apart and their components turn into gas, there’s an increase in molecular motion due to diffusion, as well as a further increase resulting from the breakdown of the motions of the aggregate atoms into the motions of their constituent atoms. So in organic dissolution, we see first an end to the transformation of the motion of units into the motion of aggregates, which constitutes Evolution in a dynamic sense, and also, in a subtler way, a transformation from the motion of aggregates to the motion of units. This same principle applies to the dissolution of a society. When social ties, whether governmental or industrial, break down, the combined actions of citizens fall apart into uncombined actions. The general forces that used to constrain individual actions vanish, leaving only individual self-restraints. There are no longer any joint efforts by which people meet their needs; instead, they try to meet their needs through individual actions. In other words, the movement of parts replaces the movement of wholes.
Under its dynamical aspect then, Evolution, so far as we can trace it, is a change from molecular motion to the motion of masses; while Dissolution, so far as we can trace it, is a change from the motion of masses to molecular motion.
Under its dynamic aspect then, Evolution, as far as we can trace it, is a change from molecular motion to the motion of larger bodies; while Dissolution, as far as we can trace it, is a change from the motion of larger bodies to molecular motion.
§ 106. To these abstract definitions may be added concrete ones. Besides an integration of motions corresponding to the integration of masses, Evolution involves an increase in 353the multiformity of the motions, corresponding to the increase in the multiformity of the masses. If, contemplating it as materially displayed, we find Evolution to consist in the change from an indefinite, homogeneous distribution of parts to a definite, heterogeneous distribution of parts; then, contemplating Evolution as dynamically displayed, it consists in a change from indefinite, homogeneous motions to definite, heterogeneous motions.
§ 106. Along with these abstract definitions, we can also include concrete ones. In addition to integrating motions that correspond with the integration of masses, Evolution entails an increase in the variety of motions, which matches the increase in the variety of the masses. If we look at Evolution as it is materially represented, we see it as a shift from an undefined, uniform distribution of parts to a clear, varied distribution of parts; when we look at Evolution through a dynamic lens, it represents a shift from undefined, uniform motions to clear, varied motions.
This change takes place under the form of an increased variety of rhythms. We have already seen that all motion is rhythmical, from the infinitesimal vibrations of infinitesimal molecules, up to those vast oscillations between perihelion and aphelion performed by vast celestial bodies. And as the contrast between these extreme cases suggests, a multiplication of rhythms must accompany a multiplication in the degrees and modes of aggregation, and in the relations of the aggregated masses to incident forces. The degree or mode of aggregation will not, indeed, affect the rate or extent of rhythm where the incident force increases as the aggregate increases, which is the case with gravitation: here the only cause of variation in rhythm, is difference of relation to the incident forces; as we see in a pendulum, which, though unaffected in its movements by a change in the weight of the bob, alters its rate of oscillation when taken to the equator. But in all cases where the incident forces do not vary as the masses, every new order of aggregation initiates a new order of rhythm: witness the conclusion drawn from the recent researches into radiant heat and light, that the atoms of different gases have different rates of undulation. So that increased multiformity in the arrangement of matter, has necessarily generated increased multiformity of rhythm; both through increased variety in the sizes and forms of aggregates, and through increased variety in their relations to the forces which move them. The advancing heterogeneity of motion, thus entailed by advancing heterogeneity in the distribution of matter, does not, however, 354end here. Besides multiplication in the kinds of rhythm, there is a progressing complexity in their combinations. As there arise wholes composed of heterogeneous parts, each of which has its own rhythm, there must arise compound rhythms proportionately heterogeneous. We before saw that this is visible even in the cyclical perturbations of the Solar System—simple as are its structure and movements. And when we contemplate highly-developed organic bodies, we find the complication of rhythms so great, that it defies definite analysis, and from moment to moment works out in resultants that are incalculable.
This change happens through a greater variety of rhythms. We've already noted that all motion is rhythmic, from the tiny vibrations of minuscule molecules to the large oscillations of massive celestial bodies as they move between perihelion and aphelion. The contrast between these extremes indicates that more rhythms must come with a greater variety of ways things are organized and how those groups relate to external forces. The level or type of organization doesn't impact the speed or extent of rhythm when the external force increases with the size of the aggregate, like with gravity. Here, the only factor that changes the rhythm is the varying relationship to the external forces, as seen in a pendulum that remains unaffected by changes in the weight of its bob but alters its swinging speed when moved to the equator. However, in situations where the external forces don't change in proportion to the masses, every new order of organization brings about a new order of rhythm. For example, recent studies in radiant heat and light show that atoms of different gases have different undulation rates. Thus, a more complex arrangement of matter has inevitably led to a more complex rhythm, both through increased variety in the sizes and shapes of aggregates and through greater differences in their relationships to the forces acting on them. The growing diversity of motion that's brought about by the uneven distribution of matter doesn't stop here. In addition to a greater number of rhythms, there's also an increasing complexity in how they combine. As we have wholes made from different parts, each with its own rhythm, we will see compound rhythms that are just as varied. We've previously noted that this complexity can even be seen in the cyclical disruptions of the Solar System, despite its relatively simple structure and movements. When we look at highly developed organic bodies, we find such a high level of rhythmic complexity that it defies precise analysis, resulting in unpredictable outcomes from moment to moment.
This conception of Evolution forms a needful complement to that on which we have hitherto chiefly dwelt. To comprehend the phenomena in their entirety, we have to contemplate both the increasing multiformity of parts, and the increasing multiformity of the actions simultaneously assumed by these parts. At the same time that there are differentiations and integrations of the matter, there are differentiations and integrations of its motion. And this increasingly heterogeneous distribution of motion, constitutes Evolution functionally considered; as distinguished from that increasingly heterogeneous distribution of matter, which constitutes Evolution structurally considered. While of course, Dissolution exhibits the transition to a reverse distribution, both structurally and functionally.
This idea of Evolution is an essential addition to what we've primarily focused on so far. To fully understand the phenomena, we need to look at both the growing diversity of parts and the growing diversity of the actions these parts take on simultaneously. While there are differences and integrations in the matter, there are also differences and integrations in its motion. This increasingly diverse distribution of motion defines Evolution functionally; as opposed to the increasingly diverse distribution of matter, which defines Evolution structurally. Naturally, Dissolution shows the shift to a reverse distribution, both structurally and functionally.
§ 107. One other preliminary must be set down. When specifically interpreting Evolution, we shall have to consider under their concrete forms, the various resolutions of force that follow its conflict with matter. Here it will be well to contemplate such resolutions under their most general or abstract forms.
§ 107. One other preliminary must be noted. When specifically interpreting Evolution, we need to consider the different ways force resolves when it interacts with matter. It will be useful to look at these resolutions in their most general or abstract forms.
Any incident force is primarily resolvable or divisible into its effective and non-effective portions. In mechanical impact, the entire momentum of a striking body is never communicated to the body struck: even under those most favourable 355conditions in which the striking body loses all its sensible motion, there still remains with it a portion of the original momentum, under the shape of that insensible motion produced among its particles by the collision. Of the light or heat falling on any mass, a part, more or less considerable, is reflected; and only the remaining part works molecular changes in the mass. Next it is to be noted that the effective force, is itself divisible into the temporarily effective and the permanently effective. The units of an aggregate acted on, may undergo those rhythmical changes of relative position which constitute increased vibration, as well as other changes of relative position which are not from instant to instant neutralized by opposite ones. Of these, the first, disappearing in the shape of radiating undulations, leave the molecular arrangement as it originally was; while the second conduce to that re-arrangement constituting Evolution. Yet a further distinction has to be made. The permanently effective force works out changes of relative position of two kinds—the insensible and the sensible. The insensible transpositions among the units are those constituting what we call chemical composition and decomposition; and it is these which we recognize as the qualitative differences that arise in an aggregate. The sensible transpositions are such as result when certain of the units, instead of being put into different relations with their immediate neighbours, are carried away from them and united together elsewhere.
Any incident force can mainly be divided into its effective and non-effective parts. In mechanical impact, the total momentum of a striking object is never fully transferred to the object being struck: even in the best conditions where the striking object loses all its noticeable motion, it still retains some of the original momentum in the form of imperceptible motion created among its particles due to the collision. Of the light or heat that hits any mass, a portion, whether large or small, is reflected; only the remaining portion causes molecular changes in the mass. Next, it should be noted that the effective force can be further divided into temporarily effective and permanently effective. The units of an aggregate being acted upon may experience rhythmic changes in their relative positions, leading to increased vibration, as well as other changes in relative position that are not canceled out from moment to moment by opposing forces. Of these, the first type fades away as radiating waves and leaves the molecular arrangement unchanged, while the second type contributes to the re-arrangement that constitutes Evolution. Additionally, a further distinction must be made. The permanently effective force brings about changes in relative position of two kinds—the insensible and the sensible. The insensible rearrangements among the units are those that result in what we call chemical composition and decomposition; these are what we recognize as the qualitative differences that emerge in an aggregate. The sensible rearrangements occur when some of the units are not just repositioned with their immediate neighbors but are moved away from them and joined together elsewhere.
Concerning these divisions and sub-divisions of any force affecting an aggregate, the fact which it chiefly concerns us to observe, is, that they are complementary to each other. Of the whole incident force, the effective must be that which remains after deducting the non-effective. The two parts of the effective force must vary inversely as each other: where much of it is temporarily effective, little of it can be permanently effective; and vice versâ. Lastly, the permanently effective force, being expended in working both the insensible 356re-arrangements which constitute chemical modification, and the sensible re-arrangements which result in structure, must generate of either kind an amount that is great or small in proportion as it has generated a small or great amount of the other.
Regarding these divisions and subdivisions of any force affecting an aggregate, what we mainly need to note is that they complement each other. Of the total incident force, the effective portion must be what’s left after removing the non-effective part. The two components of the effective force must vary inversely: when a lot of it is temporarily effective, only a little can be permanently effective, and vice versa. Finally, the permanently effective force, being used to carry out both the invisible rearrangements that lead to chemical changes and the visible rearrangements that result in structure, must produce either kind in an amount that is large or small depending on whether it has created a small or large amount of the other.
§ 108. And now of the propositions grouped together in this chapter, it may be well to remark that, in common with foregoing propositions, they have for their warrant the fundamental truth with which our synthesis set out.
§ 108. And now regarding the propositions grouped together in this chapter, it’s worth noting that, similar to the earlier propositions, they are supported by the fundamental truth with which our synthesis began.
That when a given force falls on any aggregate, the permanently effective part of it will produce an amount of re-arrangement that is inversely proportional to the cohesion existing among the parts of the aggregate, is demonstrable à priori. Whether the cohesion be mechanical or chemical, or whether it be temporarily modified by a changed degree of molecular vibration, matters not to the general conclusion. In all these cases it follows from the persistence of force, that in proportion as the units offer great resistance to alteration in their relative positions, must the amount of motion which a given force impresses on them be small. The proposition is in fact an identical one; since the cohesion of units is known to be great or small, only by the smallness or greatness of the re-arrangement which a given incident force produces.
When a certain force acts on a group of parts, the part of it that has a lasting effect will cause a level of re-arrangement that is inversely related to the cohesion among the parts of that group, which is evident a priori. It doesn’t matter whether the cohesion is mechanical or chemical, or if it is temporarily altered by changes in molecular vibration; the general conclusion remains the same. In all these situations, it follows from the persistence of force that the more resistance the units offer to changes in their positions, the less motion a given force will impart to them. This proposition is essentially the same; since the cohesion of units is recognized as strong or weak solely by the extent of the re-arrangement that a given force causes.
The continuity of motion we found to be a corollary from the persistence of force; and from the continuity of motion, it follows that molecular motion and the motion of masses can be respectively increased only at each other’s expense. Hence, if in the course of Evolution there arises a motion of masses that did not before exist, there must have ceased an equivalent molecular motion; and if in the course of Dissolution there arises a molecular motion that did not before exist, an equivalent motion of masses must have disappeared.
The continuity of motion is a result of the persistence of force; and from the continuity of motion, it follows that molecular motion and the motion of masses can increase only at each other’s expense. Therefore, if during Evolution a new motion of masses arises that didn’t exist before, an equivalent molecular motion must have stopped; and if during Dissolution a new molecular motion arises that didn’t exist before, an equivalent motion of masses must have disappeared.
Equally necessary is the conclusion that the several results of the force expended on any aggregate, must be complementary 357to each other. It is not less obviously a corollary from the persistence of force, that of the whole incident force the effective is the part which remains after deducting the non-effective; than it is, that of the effective force, whatever does not work permanent results, works temporary results, and that such amount of the permanently effective force as is not absorbed in producing insensible re-arrangements, will produce sensible re-arrangements.
Equally important is the conclusion that the various results of the force applied to any group must complement each other. It is equally clear, as a consequence of the persistence of force, that the effective part of the total applied force is what remains after subtracting the non-effective part; just as it is true that the effective force, which does not lead to lasting results, generates temporary results, and that the portion of the permanently effective force that isn't used to create negligible rearrangements will produce noticeable rearrangements. 357
CHAPTER XIII.
THE INSTABILITY OF THE HOMOGENEOUS.[16]
§ 109. Thus far our steps towards the interpretation of Evolution have been preparatory. We have dealt with the factors of the process, rather than the process itself. After the ultimate truth that, Matter, Motion, and Force, as cognizable by human intelligence, can neither come into existence nor cease to exist, we have considered certain other ultimate truths concerning the modes in which Force and Motion are manifested during the changes they produce in Matter. Now we have to study the changes themselves. We have here to analyze that re-arrangement in the parts of Matter, which occurs under the influence of Force, that is unchangeable in quantity though changeable in form, through the medium of Motion taking place rhythmically along lines of least resistance. The proposition which comes first in logical order, is, that some re-arrangement must result; and this proposition may be best dealt with under the more specific shape, that the condition of homogeneity is a condition of unstable equilibrium.
§ 109. Up to this point, our exploration of Evolution has been mostly preparatory. We've focused on the factors involved in the process rather than the process itself. After establishing the fundamental truth that Matter, Motion, and Force, as understood by human intelligence, cannot come into existence or cease to exist, we’ve looked at other key truths regarding how Force and Motion are expressed during the changes they cause in Matter. Now, we need to examine the changes themselves. We will analyze the rearrangement of Matter's components that occurs under the influence of Force, which remains constant in quantity but varies in form, facilitated by Motion moving rhythmically along paths of least resistance. The first logical proposition is that some kind of rearrangement must occur; this idea is best articulated through the more specific statement that a state of homogeneity is a state of unstable equilibrium.
First, as to the meaning of the terms; respecting which some readers may need explanation. The phrase unstable equilibrium is one used in mechanics to express a balance of forces of such kind, that the interference of any further force, however minute, will destroy the arrangement previously 359subsisting; and bring about a totally different arrangement. Thus, a stick poised on its lower end is in unstable equilibrium: however exactly it may be placed in a perpendicular position, as soon as it is left to itself it begins, at first imperceptibly, to lean on one side, and with increasing rapidity falls into another attitude. Conversely, a stick suspended from its upper end is in stable equilibrium: however much disturbed, it will return to the same position. The proposition is, then, that the state of homogeneity, like the state of the stick poised on its lower end, is one that cannot be maintained. Let us take a few illustrations.
First, regarding the meaning of the terms; some readers might need clarification. The phrase unstable equilibrium is a concept from mechanics that describes a balance of forces that, if disturbed by even the smallest additional force, will disrupt the existing arrangement and lead to a completely different one. For example, a stick balanced on its lower end is in unstable equilibrium: no matter how perfectly it is positioned upright, once it's left on its own, it starts to lean to one side, initially imperceptibly, and then falls into a different position more quickly. On the other hand, a stick hanging from its upper end is in stable equilibrium: no matter how much it is disturbed, it will return to the same position. The point is that a state of homogeneity, like the balanced stick on its lower end, is one that cannot be sustained. Let’s look at a few examples.
Of mechanical ones the most familiar is that of the scales. If they be accurately made, and not clogged by dirt or rust, it is impossible to keep a pair of scales perfectly balanced: eventually one scale will descend and the other ascend—they will assume a heterogeneous relation. Again, if we sprinkle over the surface of a fluid a number of equal-sized particles, having an attraction for each other, they will, no matter how uniformly distributed, by and by concentrate irregularly into one or more groups. Were it possible to bring a mass of water into a state of perfect homogeneity—a state of complete quiescence, and exactly equal density throughout—yet the radiation of heat from neighbouring bodies, by affecting differently its different parts, would inevitably produce inequalities of density and consequent currents; and would so render it to that extent heterogeneous. Take a piece of red-hot matter, and however evenly heated it may at first be, it will quickly cease to be so: the exterior, cooling faster than the interior, will become different in temperature from it. And the lapse into heterogeneity of temperature, so obvious in this extreme case, takes place more or less in all cases. The action of chemical forces supplies other illustrations. Expose a fragment of metal to air or water, and in course of time it will be coated with a film of oxide, carbonate, or other compound: that is—its outer parts will become unlike its inner parts. Usually the heterogeneity 360produced by the action of chemical forces on the surfaces of masses, is not striking; because the changed portions are soon washed away, or otherwise removed. But if this is prevented, comparatively complex structures result. Quarries of trap-rock contain some striking examples. Not unfrequently a piece of trap may be found reduced, by the action of the weather, to a number of loosely-adherent coats, like those of an onion. Where the block has been quite undisturbed, we may trace the whole series of these, from the angular, irregular outer one, through successively included ones in which the shape becomes gradually rounded, ending finally in a spherical nucleus. On comparing the original mass of stone with this group of concentric coats, each of which differs from the rest in form, and probably in the state of decomposition at which it has arrived, we get a marked illustration of the multiformity to which, in lapse of time, a uniform body may be brought by external chemical action. The instability of the homogeneous is equally seen in the changes set up throughout the interior of a mass, when it consists of units that are not rigidly bound together. The atoms of a precipitate never remain separate, and equably distributed through the fluid in which they make their appearance. They aggregate either into crystalline grains, each containing an immense number of atoms, or they aggregate into flocculi, each containing a yet larger number; and where the mass of fluid is great, and the process prolonged, these flocculi do not continue equidistant, but break up into groups. That is to say, there is a destruction of the balance at first subsisting among the diffused particles, and also of the balance at first subsisting among the groups into which these particles unite. Certain solutions of non-crystalline substances in highly volatile liquids, exhibit in the course of half an hour a whole series of changes that are set up in the alleged way. If for example a little shell-lac-varnish (made by dissolving shell-lac in coal-naphtha until it is of the consistence of cream) be poured on a piece of paper, 361the surface of the varnish will shortly become marked by polygonal divisions, which, first appearing round the edge of the mass, spread towards its centre. Under a lense these irregular polygons of five or more sides, are seen to be severally bounded by dark lines, on each side of which there are light-coloured borders. By the addition of matter to their inner edges, the borders slowly broaden, and thus encroach on the areas of the polygons; until at length there remains nothing but a dark spot in the centre of each. At the same time the boundaries of the polygons become curved; and they end by appearing like spherical sacs pressed together; strangely simulating (but only simulating) a group of nucleated cells. Here a rapid loss of homogeneity is exhibited in three ways:—First, in the formation of the film, which is the seat of these changes; second, in the formation of the polygonal sections into which this film divides; and third, in the contrast that arises between the polygonal sections round the edge, where they are small and early formed, and those in the centre which are larger and formed later.
One of the most well-known mechanical examples is scales. If they are made accurately and kept free from dirt or rust, it's still impossible to keep a pair of scales perfectly balanced; eventually one side will drop while the other rises, creating an uneven relationship. Similarly, if we sprinkle equal-sized particles over a fluid, and these particles are attracted to each other, they will eventually clump together into one or more uneven groups, regardless of their initial distribution. Even if it were possible to have a mass of water that is perfectly homogeneous—completely still and with equal density throughout—the heat emitted from nearby objects would create temperature differences that affect various parts of the water differently, leading to changes in density and currents, making it somewhat heterogeneous. Take a piece of hot material; no matter how evenly heated it is at first, it won't stay that way. The outside cools faster than the inside, resulting in a temperature difference. This shift toward temperature inconsistency, which is obvious in this extreme example, happens to some extent in all cases. The effects of chemical forces provide other examples. If you expose a piece of metal to air or water, over time it will develop a coating of oxide, carbonate, or other compounds: this means the outer parts become different from the inner parts. Typically, the changes caused by chemical forces on the surfaces of materials aren't very noticeable because the altered parts are quickly washed away or removed. But if that doesn't happen, more complex structures can form. Quarries of trap rock present striking examples. Often, a piece of trap rock can be found weathered into layers, similar to an onion's skin. When a block has remained completely undisturbed, we can observe a series of these layers, starting from the angular, irregular outer layer and moving through progressively rounded ones, finally ending with a spherical core. When we compare the original rock with this set of concentric layers, each differing in shape and likely in their level of decomposition, it illustrates clearly how a uniform body can become multiform over time due to external chemical actions. The instability of the homogeneous can also be seen in the changes that occur within a mass made of units that aren't tightly bound together. The atoms in a precipitate don't stay separate and evenly distributed in the fluid where they form. They come together either into crystalline grains containing many atoms or into larger clumps, called flocculi, and when the fluid mass is large and the process lasts a long time, these flocculi don't remain spaced evenly but instead break into groups. In other words, the balance that existed among the dispersed particles is lost, as well as the balance among the groups that form from those particles. Certain solutions of non-crystalline substances in highly volatile liquids show a series of changes in about half an hour that illustrate this concept. For example, if you pour a bit of shell-lac varnish (made by dissolving shell-lac in coal naphtha until it thickens to the consistency of cream) onto a piece of paper, the surface of the varnish will soon be marked by polygonal shapes that initially form at the edges and then move toward the center. Under a microscope, these irregular polygons with five or more sides are seen to be bordered by dark lines, with lighter colored edges on either side. As matter gathers at their inner edges, the borders gradually widen, encroaching on the polygon areas until only a dark spot remains in the center of each. Meanwhile, the edges of the polygons become curved, ending up looking like spherical sacs pressed together, oddly resembling (but only resembling) a bunch of nucleated cells. This rapid loss of homogeneity occurs in three ways: first, through the formation of the film where these changes happen; second, in the creation of the polygonal sections that form in the film; and third, in the contrast between the smaller, earlier formed polygonal sections at the edges and the larger, later formed ones in the center.
The instability thus variously illustrated is obviously consequent on the fact, that the several parts of any homogeneous aggregation are necessarily exposed to different forces—forces that differ either in kind or amount; and being exposed to different forces they are of necessity differently modified. The relations of outside and inside, and of comparative nearness to neighbouring sources of influence, imply the reception of influences that are unlike in quantity or quality, or both; and it follows that unlike changes will be produced in the parts thus dissimilarly acted upon.
The instability shown here clearly results from the fact that the different parts of any uniform collection are exposed to various forces—forces that vary either in type or intensity. Because they face different forces, they are inevitably affected in different ways. The relationship between the outside and the inside, as well as their proximity to nearby sources of influence, suggests that they will receive influences that differ in quantity or quality, or both; thus, it follows that these varying influences will lead to different changes in the parts that are affected differently.
For like reasons it is manifest that the process must repeat itself in each of the subordinate groups of units that are differentiated by the modifying forces. Each of these subordinate groups, like the original group, must gradually, in obedience to the influences acting upon it, lose its balance of parts—must pass from a uniform into a multiform state. And so on continuously. Whence indeed it is clear 362that not only must the homogeneous lapse into the non-homogeneous, but that the more homogeneous must tend ever to become less homogeneous. If any given whole, instead of being absolutely uniform throughout, consist of parts distinguishable from each other—if each of these parts, while somewhat unlike other parts, is uniform within itself; then, each of them being in unstable equilibrium, it follows that while the changes set up within it must render it multiform, they must at the same time render the whole more multiform than before. The general principle, now to be followed out in its applications, is thus somewhat more comprehensive than the title of the chapter implies. No demurrer to the conclusions drawn, can be based on the ground that perfect homogeneity nowhere exists; since, whether that state with which we commence be or be not one of perfect homogeneity, the process must equally be towards a relative heterogeneity.
For similar reasons, it's clear that the process must repeat itself in each of the smaller groups of units that are affected by varying forces. Each of these smaller groups, like the original group, must gradually lose its balance of parts in response to the influences acting on it, transitioning from a uniform state to a diverse one. This cycle continues endlessly. 362 Thus, it's evident that not only must the uniform turn into the non-uniform, but that the more uniform must continually strive to become less uniform. If any overall group consists of parts that can be distinguished from one another—if each of these parts, while somewhat different from others, is uniform within itself—then, each of them being in an unstable state, it follows that while the changes within it must make it more diverse, they must also make the whole more diverse than before. The general principle to be examined in its various applications is therefore somewhat broader than the title of the chapter suggests. Any objections to the conclusions drawn cannot be based on the claim that perfect uniformity doesn’t exist; since, whether the initial state we start with is or isn’t one of perfect uniformity, the process will still lead toward relative diversity.
§ 110. The stars are distributed with a three-fold irregularity. There is first the marked contrast between the plane of the milky way and other parts of the heavens, in respect of the quantities of stars within given visual areas. There are secondary contrasts of like kind in the milky way itself, which has its thick and thin places; as well as throughout the celestial spaces in general, which are much more closely strewn in some regions than in others. And there is a third order of contrasts produced by the aggregation of stars into small clusters. Besides this heterogeneity of distribution of the stars in general, considered without distinction of kinds, a further such heterogeneity is disclosed when they are classified by their differences of colour, which doubtless answer to differences of physical constitution. While the yellow stars are found in all parts of the heavens, the red and blue stars are not so: there are wide regions in which both red and blue stars are rare; there are regions in which the blue occur in considerable numbers, and there are other regions in which the red are comparatively abundant. 363Yet one more irregularity of like significance is presented by the nebulæ,—aggregations of matter which, whatever be their nature, most certainly belong to our sidereal system. For the nebulæ are not dispersed with anything like uniformity; but are abundant around the poles of the galactic circle and rare in the neighbourhood of its plane. No one will expect that anything like a definite interpretation of this structure can be given on the hypothesis of Evolution, or any other hypothesis. The most that can be looked for is some reason for thinking that irregularities, not improbably of these kinds, would occur in the course of Evolution, supposing it to have taken place. Any one called on to assign such reason might argue, that if the matter of which stars and all other celestial bodies consist, be assumed to have originally existed in a diffused form throughout a space far more vast even than that which our sidereal system now occupies, the instability of the homogeneous would negative its continuance in that state. In default of an absolute balance among the forces with which the dispersed particles acted on each other (which could not exist in any aggregation having limits) he might show that motion and consequent changes of distribution would necessarily result. The next step in the argument would be that in matter of such extreme tenuity and feeble cohesion there would be motion towards local centres of gravity, as well as towards the general centre of gravity; just as, to use a humble illustration, the particles of a precipitate aggregate into flocculi at the same time that they sink towards the earth. He might urge that in the one case as in the other, these smallest and earliest local aggregations must gradually divide into groups, each concentrating to its own centre of gravity,—a process which must repeat itself on a larger and larger scale. In conformity with the law that motion once set up in any direction becomes itself a cause of subsequent motion in that direction, he might further infer that the heterogeneities thus set up would tend ever to become more 364pronounced. Established mechanical principles would justify him in the conclusion that the motions of these irregular masses of slightly aggregated nebular matter towards their common centre of gravity must be severally rendered curvelinear, by the resistance of the medium from which they were precipitated; and that in consequence of the irregularities of distribution already set up, such conflicting curvelinear motions must, by composition of forces, end in a rotation of the incipient sidereal system. He might without difficulty show that the resulting centrifugal force must so far modify the process of general aggregation, as to prevent anything like uniform distribution of the stars eventually formed—that there must arise a contrast such as we see between the galactic circle and the rest of the heavens. He might draw the further not unwarrantable inference, that differences in the process of local concentration would probably result from the unlikeness between the physical conditions existing around the general axis of rotation and those existing elsewhere. To which he might add, that after the formation of distinct stars, the ever-increasing irregularities of distribution due to continuance of the same causes would produce that patchiness which distinguishes the heavens in both its larger and smaller areas. We need not here however commit ourselves to such far-reaching speculations. For the purposes of the general argument it is needful only to show, that any finite mass of diffused matter, even though vast enough to form our whole sidereal system, could not be in stable equilibrium; that in default of absolute sphericity, absolute uniformity of composition, and absolute symmetry of relation to all forces external to it; its concentration must go on with an ever-increasing irregularity; and that thus the present aspect of the heavens is not, so far as we can judge, incongruous with the hypothesis of a general evolution consequent on the instability of the homogeneous.
§ 110. The stars are spread out in three distinct irregular patterns. First, there’s a clear difference between the plane of the Milky Way and other parts of the sky in terms of how many stars can be seen in specific areas. There are also secondary contrasts within the Milky Way itself, which has both dense and sparse regions; and in the broader celestial spaces, some areas are much more densely packed with stars than others. A third type of contrast is created by the grouping of stars into small clusters. Beyond this general unevenness in star distribution, which doesn’t differentiate between types, there’s a greater variation when they are classified by their colors, which likely correspond to differences in their physical makeup. While yellow stars are found all over the sky, red and blue stars are not as widespread: there are large areas where both red and blue stars are scarce; some regions have a significant number of blue stars, and others have a relatively high occurrence of red stars. 363Another kind of irregularity of similar importance is presented by the nebulae—clusters of matter that, regardless of their nature, definitely belong to our sidereal system. The nebulae are not distributed uniformly; they are plentiful near the poles of the galactic circle and scarce near its plane. No one should expect a clear explanation of this structure based on the theory of evolution or any other theory. The best we can anticipate is some reasoning to believe that irregularities, probably of these kinds, would emerge during the process of evolution, assuming it occurred. Anyone asked to provide such reasoning might argue that if the matter of which stars and all other celestial bodies are made originally existed in a diffused form across a space even larger than that now occupied by our sidereal system, then the instability of the uniform would negate its persistence in that state. In the absence of a perfect balance among the forces acting on the scattered particles (which couldn’t exist in any limited aggregation), it could be shown that motion and consequent changes in distribution would have to occur. The next step in the argument would be that in matter so extremely thin and with weak cohesion, there would be motion toward local centers of gravity, as well as toward the general center of gravity; just as, to use a simple illustration, the particles of a precipitate clump together as they sink toward the earth. It could be suggested that, similarly, these smallest and earliest local groupings would gradually divide into clusters, each focusing on its own center of gravity—a process that would repeat on larger and larger scales. Following the principle that once motion is initiated in any direction it becomes a cause for subsequent motion in that direction, it could also be inferred that the resulting irregularities would tend to become more pronounced. Established mechanical principles would support the conclusion that the movements of these irregular clusters of slightly aggregated nebular matter toward their common center of gravity must be curved due to the resistance from the medium from which they were formed; and as a result of the irregular distributions already established, these conflicting curved motions must, through the composition of forces, lead to a rotation of the emerging sidereal system. It would not be difficult to demonstrate that the resulting centrifugal force must significantly alter the process of general aggregation, preventing any sort of uniform distribution of the stars that ultimately form—leading to the contrast we observe between the galactic circle and the rest of the sky. One could reasonably infer that differences in the process of local concentration would likely arise from the differences in physical conditions near the main axis of rotation compared to those found elsewhere. Furthermore, after distinct stars formed, the increasingly irregular distributions caused by the continuance of the same factors would create the patchiness observed in the sky across both large and small areas. However, we don’t need to delve into such extensive speculations here. For the purposes of the overall argument, it suffices to show that any finite mass of diffused matter, even if large enough to make up our entire sidereal system, could not be in stable equilibrium; that without perfect sphericity, complete uniformity of composition, and absolute symmetry with all external forces, its concentration must proceed with increasing irregularity; and thus, the current appearance of the heavens is not, to the best of our judgment, inconsistent with the idea of a general evolution arising from the instability of the homogeneous.
Descending to that more limited form of the nebular hypothesis which regards the solar system as having resulted 365by gradual concentration; and assuming this concentration to have advanced so far as to produce a rotating spheroid of nebulous matter; let us consider what further consequence the instability of the homogeneous necessitates. Having become oblate in figure, unlike in the densities of its centre and surface, unlike in their temperatures, and unlike in the velocities with which its parts move round their common axis, such a mass can no longer be called homogeneous; and therefore any further changes exhibited by it as a whole, can illustrate the general law, only as being changes from a more homogeneous to a less homogeneous state. Changes of this kind are to be found in the transformations of such of its parts as are still homogeneous within themselves. If we accept the conclusion of Laplace, that the equatorial portion of this rotating and contracting spheroid will at successive stages acquire a centrifugal force great enough to prevent any nearer approach to the centre round which it rotates, and will so be left behind by the inner parts of the spheroid in its still-continued contraction; we shall find, in the fate of the detached ring, a fresh exemplification of the principle we are following out. Consisting of gaseous matter, such a ring, even if absolutely uniform at the time of its detachment, cannot continue so. To maintain its equilibrium there must be an almost perfect uniformity in the action of all external forces upon it (almost, we must say, because the cohesion, even of extremely attenuated matter, might suffice to neutralize very minute disturbances); and against this the probabilities are immense. In the absence of equality among the forces, internal and external, acting on such a ring, there must be a point or points at which the cohesion of its parts is less than elsewhere—a point or points at which rupture will therefore take place. Laplace assumed that the ring would rupture at one place only; and would then collapse on itself. But this is a more than questionable assumption—such at least I know to be the opinion of an authority second to none among those now living. So 366vast a ring, consisting of matter having such feeble cohesion, must break up into many parts. Nevertheless, it is still inferrable from the instability of the homogeneous, that the ultimate result which Laplace predicted would take place. For even supposing the masses of nebulous matter into which such a ring separated, were so equal in their sizes and distances as to attract each other with exactly equal forces (which is infinitely improbable); yet the unequal action of external disturbing forces would inevitably destroy their equilibrium—there would be one or more points at which adjacent masses would begin to part company. Separation once commenced, would with ever-accelerating speed lead to a grouping of the masses. And obviously a like result would eventually take place with the groups thus formed; until they at length aggregated into a single mass.
Descending to a more specific version of the nebular hypothesis, which views the solar system as having formed through gradual concentration, let's assume this concentration has progressed to the point of creating a rotating spheroid of nebulous matter. We need to consider what further consequences arise from the instability of the homogeneous. Once it becomes oblate in shape, with differing densities at its center and surface, varying temperatures, and different velocities of rotation around its common axis, this mass can no longer be considered homogeneous. Therefore, any subsequent changes in its entirety can only illustrate the general principle as changes from a more homogeneous state to a less homogeneous one. Such changes can be observed in the transformations of its parts that remain homogeneous within themselves. If we accept Laplace's conclusion that the equatorial part of this rotating and contracting spheroid will reach a centrifugal force strong enough to prevent it from moving closer to the center, it will lag behind the inner sections of the spheroid as it continues to contract. In examining the fate of the detached ring, we can see a fresh example of the principle we are exploring. Composed of gaseous matter, this ring, even if perfectly uniform at the moment of detachment, cannot remain so. To maintain its balance, there must be nearly perfect uniformity in the action of all external forces acting on it (nearly, because even the cohesion of highly dispersed matter could neutralize very slight disturbances); however, the odds against this are immense. Since the forces acting on such a ring—both internal and external—are not equal, there will inevitably be a point or points where the cohesion of its parts is weaker than in other areas, leading to rupture. Laplace suggested that the ring would only break at one point and then collapse in on itself. However, this assumption is highly questionable, as many experts would agree. Such an enormous ring, comprised of matter with weak cohesion, must break into many pieces. Nonetheless, it can still be inferred from the instability of the homogeneous that the ultimate outcome Laplace predicted will occur. Even if the pieces of nebulous matter into which the ring separates were equal in size and distance, attracting each other with exactly equal forces (which is extremely unlikely), the unequal influence of external forces would eventually disrupt their balance—inevitably leading to one or more points where adjacent masses would begin to separate. Once separation begins, it would accelerate, causing the masses to group together, and clearly, a similar outcome would occur with the groups formed, until they eventually merged into a single mass.
Leaving the region of speculative astronomy, let us consider the Solar System as it at present exists. And here it will be well, in the first place, to note a fact which may be thought at variance with the foregoing argument—namely, the still-continued existence of Saturn’s rings; and especially of the internal nebulous ring lately discovered. To the objection that the outer rings maintain their equilibrium, the reply is that the comparatively great cohesion of liquid or solid substance would suffice to prevent any slight tendency to rupture from taking effect. And that a nebulous ring here still preserves its continuity, does not really negative the foregoing conclusion; since it happens under the quite exceptional influence of those symmetrically disposed forces which the external rings exercise on it. Here indeed it deserves to be noted, that though at first sight the Saturnian system appears at variance with the doctrine that a state of homogeneity is one of unstable equilibrium, it does in reality furnish a curious confirmation of this doctrine. For Saturn is not quite concentric with his rings; and it has been proved mathematically that were he and his rings concentrically 367situated, they could not remain so: the homogeneous relation being unstable, would gravitate into a heterogeneous one. And this fact serves to remind us of the allied one presented throughout the whole Solar System. All orbits, whether of planets or satellites, are more or less excentric—none of them are perfect circles; and were they perfect circles they would soon become ellipses. Mutual perturbations would inevitably generate excentricities. That is to say, the homogeneous relations would lapse into heterogeneous ones.
Leaving the realm of speculative astronomy, let's take a look at the Solar System as it currently exists. First, it's important to note a fact that might seem contradictory to the previous discussion—specifically, the ongoing existence of Saturn’s rings, especially the newly discovered inner nebulous ring. In response to the concern that the outer rings maintain their balance, the answer lies in the significant cohesion of either liquid or solid material, which is enough to prevent any minor inclination towards rupture. The fact that a nebulous ring continues to exist doesn't contradict the earlier conclusion; it actually happens under the unique influence of the symmetrically arranged forces exerted by the outer rings. It's worth noting that while at first glance the Saturnian system seems to contradict the idea that a state of homogeneity represents an unstable balance, it actually provides an interesting confirmation of this idea. Saturn isn’t perfectly centered with its rings, and it's been mathematically shown that if he and his rings were perfectly concentric, they couldn't stay that way: the stable homogeneous relationship would eventually shift into a heterogeneous one. This serves as a reminder of a related observation throughout the whole Solar System. All orbits, whether of planets or satellites, are somewhat eccentric—none of them are perfect circles; if they were, they would quickly become ellipses. Mutual disturbances would inevitably create eccentricities. In other words, homogeneous relationships would transition into heterogeneous ones.
§ 111. Already so many references have been made to the gradual formation of a crust over the originally incandescent Earth, that it may be thought superfluous again to name it. It has not, however, been before considered in connexion with the general principle under discussion. Here then it must be noted as a necessary consequence of the instability of the homogeneous. In this cooling down and solidification of the Earth’s surface, we have one of the simplest, as well as one of the most important, instances, of that change from a uniform to a multiform state which occurs in any mass through exposure of its different parts to different conditions. To the differentiation of the Earth’s exterior from its interior thus brought about, we must add one of the most conspicuous differentiations which the exterior itself afterwards undergoes, as being similarly brought about. Were the conditions to which the surface of the Earth is exposed, alike in all directions, there would be no obvious reason why certain of its parts should become permanently unlike the rest. But being unequally exposed to the chief external centre of force—the Sun—its main divisions become unequally modified: as the crust thickens and cools, there arises that contrast, now so decided, between the polar and equatorial regions.
§ 111. There have already been so many references to the gradual formation of a crust over the originally molten Earth that it might seem unnecessary to mention it again. However, it hasn’t been considered in connection with the general principle we are discussing. Therefore, it’s important to note that this is a necessary consequence of the instability of the homogeneous. In the cooling and solidification of the Earth’s surface, we have one of the simplest and most significant examples of the change from a uniform to a diverse state, which occurs in any mass when different parts are exposed to different conditions. To the differentiation of the Earth’s exterior from its interior that has resulted, we must also mention one of the most noticeable differentiations that the exterior undergoes later, which occurs in a similar way. If the conditions that the Earth’s surface is exposed to were the same in all directions, there would be no clear reason why some parts should become permanently different from the rest. But because it is unevenly exposed to the main external force—the Sun—its major divisions become modified in unequal ways: as the crust thickens and cools, a clear contrast arises between the polar and equatorial regions.
Along with these most marked physical differentiations of the Earth, which are manifestly consequent on the instability of the homogeneous, there have been going on numerous 368chemical differentiations, admitting of similar interpretation. Without raising the question whether, as some think, the so-called simple substances are themselves compounded of unknown elements (elements which we cannot separate by artificial heat, but which existed separately when the heat of the Earth was greater than any which we can produce),—without raising this question, it will suffice the present purpose to show how, in place of that comparative homogeneity of the Earth’s crust, chemically considered, which must have existed when its temperature was high, there has arisen, during its cooling, an increasing chemical heterogeneity: each element or compound, being unable to maintain its homogeneity in presence of various surrounding affinities, having fallen into heterogeneous combinations. Let us contemplate this change somewhat in detail. There is every reason to believe that at an extreme heat, the bodies we call elements cannot combine. Even under such heat as can be generated artificially, some very strong affinities yield; and the great majority of chemical compounds are decomposed at much lower temperatures. Whence it seems not improbable that, when the Earth was in its first state of incandescence, there were no chemical combinations at all. But without drawing this inference, let us set out with the unquestionable fact that the compounds which can exist at the highest temperatures, and which must therefore have been the first formed as the Earth cooled, are those of the simplest constitutions. The protoxides—including under that head the alkalies, earths, &c.—are, as a class, the most fixed compounds known: the majority of them resisting decomposition by any heat we can generate. These, consisting severally of one atom of each component element, are combinations of the simplest order—are but one degree less homogeneous than the elements themselves. More heterogeneous than these, more decomposable by heat, and therefore later in the Earth’s history, are the deutoxides, tritoxides, peroxides, &c.; in which two, three, four, or more atoms of 369oxygen are united with one atom of metal or other base. Still less able to resist heat, are the salts; which present us with compound atoms each made up of five, six, seven, eight, ten, twelve, or more atoms, of three, if not more, kinds. Then there are the hydrated salts, of a yet greater heterogeneity, which undergo partial decomposition at much lower temperatures. After them come the further-complicated supersalts and double salts, having a stability again decreased; and so throughout. After making a few unimportant qualifications demanded by peculiar affinities, I believe no chemist will deny it to be a general law of these inorganic combinations that, other things equal, the stability decreases as the complexity increases. And then when we pass to the compounds that make up organic bodies, we find this general law still further exemplified: we find much greater complexity and much less stability. An atom of albumen, for instance, consists of 482 ultimate atoms of five different kinds. Fibrine, still more intricate in constitution, contains in each atom, 298 atoms of carbon, 49 of nitrogen, 2 of sulphur, 228 of hydrogen, and 92 of oxygen—in all, 660 atoms; or, more strictly speaking—equivalents. And these two substances are so unstable as to decompose at quite moderate temperatures; as that to which the outside of a joint of roast meat is exposed. Possibly it will be objected that some inorganic compounds, as phosphuretted hydrogen and chloride of nitrogen, are more decomposable than most organic compounds. This is true. But the admission may be made without damage to the argument. The proposition is not that all simple combinations are more fixed than all complex ones. To establish our inference it is necessary only to show that, as an average fact, the simple combinations can exist at a higher temperature than the complex ones. And this is wholly beyond question. Thus it is manifest that the present chemical heterogeneity of the Earth’s surface has arisen by degrees as the decrease of heat has permitted; and that it has shown itself in three forms—first, in the multiplication of chemical 370compounds; second, in the greater number of different elements contained in the more modern of these compounds; and third, in the higher and more varied multiples in which these more numerous elements combine.
Along with these significant physical differences on Earth, which clearly stem from the instability of the uniform, there have also been many chemical differences that can be interpreted in a similar way. Without questioning whether, as some believe, the so-called simple substances are actually made up of unknown elements (elements that we can't separate with artificial heat but existed separately when the Earth was hotter than anything we can create)—without addressing this question, it suffices for our current purpose to illustrate how, instead of the comparative uniformity of the Earth’s crust, chemically speaking, that must have existed when its temperature was high, there has arisen, during its cooling, an increasing chemical diversity: each element or compound, unable to maintain its uniformity in the presence of various surrounding affinities, has fallen into diverse combinations. Let’s explore this change in a bit more detail. There is every reason to think that at extreme heat, the substances we call elements cannot combine. Even under the highest heat we can generate artificially, some strong affinities break down; and most chemical compounds decompose at much lower temperatures. This makes it seem likely that, when the Earth was in its initial state of being extremely hot, there were no chemical combinations at all. But rather than drawing this conclusion, let’s start with the undeniable fact that the compounds that can exist at the highest temperatures, and that must have formed first as the Earth cooled, are those with the simplest structures. The protoxides—including things like alkalis and earths—are, as a group, the most stable compounds known: most resist decomposition from any heat we can produce. These, each consisting of one atom of each component element, are combinations of the simplest kind—only one degree less uniform than the elements themselves. More complex than these, more easily decomposed by heat, and therefore formed later in the Earth’s history, are the deutoxides, tritoxides, peroxides, etc.; in which two, three, four, or more atoms of oxygen are combined with one atom of a metal or other base. Even less able to withstand heat are the salts, which consist of compound atoms made up of five, six, seven, eight, ten, twelve, or more atoms, often from three or more different kinds. Next are the hydrated salts, with even more complexity, which decompose partially at much lower temperatures. After that come the more complicated supersalts and double salts, which again have decreased stability; and this pattern continues. After making a few minor adjustments due to specific affinities, I believe no chemist would deny that it is a general rule among these inorganic combinations that, all else being equal, stability decreases as complexity increases. And when we move to the compounds that make up organic bodies, we see this general rule further illustrated: we encounter much greater complexity and much less stability. For example, one atom of albumen consists of 482 ultimate atoms of five different types. Fibrine, even more complex in structure, contains in each atom 298 atoms of carbon, 49 of nitrogen, 2 of sulfur, 228 of hydrogen, and 92 of oxygen—in total, 660 atoms; or, more strictly speaking—equivalents. These two substances are so unstable that they decompose at relatively moderate temperatures, like the temperature the surface of a roast meat joint is exposed to. Some might argue that certain inorganic compounds, such as phosphine and nitrogen chloride, are more easily decomposed than most organic compounds. This is true. But this acknowledgment does not undermine the argument. The claim is not that all simple combinations are more stable than all complex ones. To support our conclusion, it is necessary only to show that, on average, simple combinations can exist at higher temperatures than complex ones. And this is completely indisputable. Thus, it is clear that the current chemical diversity of the Earth’s surface has developed gradually as the temperature has decreased; and that it has manifested in three ways—first, in the proliferation of chemical compounds; second, in the greater variety of different elements found in the more recent of these compounds; and third, in the higher and more varied multiples in which these increased elements combine.
Without specifying them, it will suffice just to name the meteorologic processes eventually set up in the Earth’s atmosphere, as further illustrating the alleged law. They equally display that destruction of a homogeneous state which results from unequal exposure to incident forces.
Without going into specifics, it's enough to mention the meteorological processes that occur in the Earth's atmosphere, as they further demonstrate the supposed law. They also show the breakdown of a uniform state that happens due to uneven exposure to external forces.
§ 112. Take a mass of unorganized but organizable matter—either the body of one of the lowest living forms, or the germ of one of the higher. Consider its circumstances. Either it is immersed in water or air, or it is contained within a parent organism. Wherever placed, however, its outer and inner parts stand differently related to surrounding agencies—nutriment, oxygen, and the various stimuli. But this is not all. Whether it lies quiescent at the bottom of the water or on the leaf of a plant; whether it moves through the water preserving some definite attitude; or whether it is in the inside of an adult; it equally results that certain parts of its surface are more exposed to surrounding agencies than other parts—in some cases more exposed to light, heat, or oxygen, and in others to the maternal tissues and their contents. Hence must follow the destruction of its original equilibrium. This may take place in one of two ways. Either the disturbing forces may be such as to overbalance the affinities of the organic elements, in which case there result those changes which are known as decomposition; or, as is ordinarily the case, such changes are induced as do not destroy the organic compounds, but only modify them: the parts most exposed to the modifying forces being most modified. To elucidate this, suppose we take a few cases.
§ 112. Take a mass of unorganized but organizable matter—either the body of one of the simplest living forms or the germ of one of the more complex ones. Consider its situation. It could be in water or air, or inside a parent organism. Wherever it is placed, its outer and inner parts are affected differently by surrounding factors—nutrients, oxygen, and various stimuli. But that's not all. Whether it lies still at the bottom of the water or on a plant leaf; whether it moves through the water with some specific orientation; or whether it is inside an adult; certain parts of its surface will be more exposed to surrounding factors than others—some being more exposed to light, heat, or oxygen, and others to maternal tissues and their contents. As a result, its original balance will be disturbed. This can happen in one of two ways. Either the disturbing forces may overpower the attractions of the organic elements, leading to what we call decomposition; or, as is usually the case, changes occur that don’t destroy the organic compounds but only alter them: the parts most exposed to the changing forces are modified the most. To explain this further, let’s consider a few examples.
Note first what appear to be exceptions. Certain minute animal forms present us either with no appreciable differentiations or with differentiations so obscure as to be made out 371with great difficulty. In the Rhizopods, the substance of the jelly-like body remains throughout life unorganized, even to the extent of having no limiting membrane; as is proved by the fact that the thread-like processes protruded by the mass, coalesce on touching each other. Whether or not the nearly allied Amœba, of which the less numerous and more bulky processes do not coalesce, has, as lately alleged, something like a cell-wall and a nucleus, it is clear that the distinction of parts is very slight; since particles of food pass bodily into the inside through any part of the periphery, and since when the creature is crushed to pieces, each piece behaves as the whole did. Now these cases, in which there is either no contrast of structure between exterior and interior or very little, though seemingly opposed to the above inference, are really very significant evidences of its truth. For what is the peculiarity of this division of the Protozoa? Its members undergo perpetual and irregular changes of form—they show no persistent relation of parts. What lately formed a portion of the interior is now protruded, and, as a temporary limb, is attached to some object it happens to touch. What is now a part of the surface will presently be drawn, along with the atom of nutriment sticking to it, into the centre of the mass. Either the relations of inner and outer have no permanent existence, or they are very slightly marked. But by the hypothesis, it is only because of their unlike positions with respect to modifying forces, that the originally like units of a living mass become unlike. We must therefore expect no established differentiation of parts in creatures which exhibit no established differences of position in their parts; and we must expect extremely little differentiation of parts where the differences of position are but little determined—which is just what we find. This negative evidence is borne out by positive evidence. When we turn from these proteiform specks of living jelly to organisms having an unchanging distribution of substance, we find differences of tissue corresponding to differences of relative position. In all 372the higher Protozoa, as also in the Protophyta, we meet with a fundamental differentiation into cell-membrane and cell-contents; answering to that fundamental contrast of conditions implied by the terms outside and inside. On passing from what are roughly classed as unicellular organisms, to the lowest of those which consist of aggregated cells, we equally observe the connection between structural differences and differences of circumstance. Negatively, we see that in the sponge, permeated throughout by currents of sea-water, the indefiniteness of organization corresponds with the absence of definite unlikeness of conditions: the peripheral and central portions are as little contrasted in structure as in exposure to surrounding agencies. While positively, we see that in a form like the Thalassicolla, which, though equally humble, maintains its outer and inner parts in permanently unlike circumstances, there is displayed a rude structure obviously subordinated to the primary relations of centre and surface: in all its many and important varieties, the parts exhibit a more or less concentric arrangement.
Note first what seem to be exceptions. Certain tiny animal forms show either no noticeable differences or differences so subtle that they are hard to detect. In Rhizopods, the jelly-like body's substance stays unorganized throughout its life, even lacking a defining membrane; this is evident because the thread-like extensions from the mass merge when they come into contact. Whether or not the closely related Amœba, which has less numerous and bulkier extensions that do not merge, has something resembling a cell wall and a nucleus, the distinction of parts is very minimal; since bits of food pass directly into the inside through any part of the outer layer, and when the creature is smashed, each piece behaves just like the whole. These cases, which show little to no structural difference between the outside and inside, even though they seem to contradict the earlier conclusion, actually provide strong evidence of its validity. What is unique about this division of Protozoa? Its members constantly and irregularly change shape—they do not have a consistent relationship of parts. What was once part of the interior is now sticking out and temporarily attached to whatever it touches. What is currently part of the surface will soon be drawn, along with any food particle sticking to it, into the center of the mass. Either the relationship between the inner and outer parts does not exist in a permanent way, or it is very lightly defined. But according to the hypothesis, it’s only because of their different positions regarding modifying forces that the originally similar units of a living mass become distinct. Therefore, we should not expect any fixed differentiation of parts in creatures that do not show fixed positional differences; and we should expect minimal differentiation of parts where positional differences are only slightly defined—which is exactly what we observe. This negative evidence is supported by positive evidence. When we move from these shapeshifting specks of living jelly to organisms with a stable distribution of substance, we find tissue differences corresponding to differences in relative position. In all higher Protozoa, as well as in Protophyta, we encounter a fundamental differentiation into cell membrane and cell contents, corresponding to the basic contrast of conditions implied by the terms outside and inside. Moving from what are roughly classified as unicellular organisms to the simplest of those made up of aggregated cells, we also see the link between structural differences and differences in circumstances. Negatively, we observe that in the sponge, which is permeated throughout by currents of seawater, the lack of organization corresponds with the absence of definite differences in conditions: the outer and inner parts are as little contrasted in structure as they are in exposure to surrounding influences. Positively, we see that in a form like Thalassicolla, which, though equally humble, maintains its outer and inner parts in consistently different conditions, there is a rough structure that clearly aligns with the primary relationships of center and surface: in all its many important variations, the parts show a more or less concentric arrangement.
After this primary modification, by which the outer tissues are differentiated from the inner, the next in order of constancy and importance is that by which some part of the outer tissues is differentiated from the rest; and this corresponds with the almost universal fact that some part of the outer tissues is more exposed to certain environing influences than the rest. Here, as before, the apparent exceptions are extremely significant. Some of the lowest vegetal organisms, as the Hematococci and Protococci, evenly imbedded in a mass of mucus, or dispersed through the Arctic snow, display no differentiations of surface; the several parts of their surfaces being subjected to no definite contrasts of conditions. Ciliated spheres such as the Volvox have no parts of their periphery unlike other parts; and it is not to be expected that they should have; since, as they revolve in all directions, they do not, in traversing the water, permanently expose any part to special conditions. But when we come to organisms 373that are either fixed, or while moving preserve definite attitudes, we no longer find uniformity of surface. The most general fact which can be asserted with respect to the structures of plants and animals, is, that however much alike in shape and texture the various parts of the exterior may at first be, they acquire unlikenesses corresponding to the unlikenesses of their relations to surrounding agencies. The ciliated germ of a Zoophyte, which, during its locomotive stage, is distinguishable only into outer and inner tissues, no sooner becomes fixed, than its upper end begins to assume a different structure from its lower. The disc-shaped gemmæ of the Marchantia, originally alike on both surfaces, and falling at random with either side uppermost, immediately begin to develop rootlets on the under side, and stomata on the upper side: a fact proving beyond question, that this primary differentiation is determined by this fundamental contrast of conditions.
After this main change, which separates the outer tissues from the inner ones, the next most consistent and important change is when part of the outer tissues becomes distinct from the rest. This matches the widespread fact that some sections of the outer tissues are more exposed to specific environmental influences than others. Here, as before, the apparent exceptions are very telling. Some of the lowest plant organisms, like the Hematococci and Protococci, which are either embedded in a mass of mucus or spread through Arctic snow, show no differentiation of surface; all parts of their surfaces face the same conditions. Ciliated spheres like the Volvox have no parts on their edges that differ from the others; and we can't expect them to because, as they rotate in all directions, they don't permanently expose any part to unique conditions while moving through the water. However, when we look at organisms that are either fixed or maintain specific positions while moving, we no longer see uniformity in surface. The most general statement we can make about the structures of plants and animals is that, no matter how similar in shape and texture the external parts may seem initially, they develop differences according to how they relate to surrounding influences. The ciliated germ of a zoophyte, which during its early stage can only be identified as having outer and inner tissues, starts to develop different structures at the upper end as soon as it becomes fixed. The disc-shaped gemmæ of the Marchantia, initially similar on both sides and landing randomly with either side up, quickly begin to grow rootlets on the underside and stomata on the upper side: this clearly shows that this initial differentiation is driven by the fundamental differences in conditions.
Of course in the germs of higher organisms, the metamorphoses immediately due to the instability of the homogeneous, are soon masked by those due to the assumption of the hereditary type. Such early changes, however, as are common to all classes of organisms, and so cannot be ascribed to heredity, entirely conform to the hypothesis. A germ which has undergone no developmental modifications, consists of a spheroidal group of homogeneous cells. Universally, the first step in its evolution is the establishment of a difference between some of the peripheral cells and the cells which form the interior—some of the peripheral cells, after repeated spontaneous fissions, coalesce into a membrane; and by continuance of the process this membrane spreads until it speedily invests the entire mass, as in mammals, or, as in birds, stops short of that for some time. Here we have two significant facts. The first is, that the primary unlikeness arises between the exterior and the interior. The second is, that the change which thus initiates development, does not take place simultaneously over the whole exterior; but commences at one 374place, and gradually involves the rest. Now these facts are just those which might be inferred from the instability of the homogeneous. The surface must, more than any other part, become unlike the centre, because it is most dissimilarly conditioned; and all parts of the surface cannot simultaneously exhibit this differentiation, because they cannot be exposed to the incident forces with absolute uniformity. One other general fact of like implication remains. Whatever be the extent of this peripheral layer of cells, or blastoderm as it is called, it presently divides into two layers—the serous and mucous; or, as they have been otherwise called, the ectoderm and the endoderm. The first of these is formed from that portion of the layer which lies in contact with surrounding agents; and the second of them is formed from that portion of the layer which lies in contact with the contained mass of yelk. That is to say, after the primary differentiation, more or less extensive, of surface from centre, the resulting superficial portion undergoes a secondary differentiation into inner and outer parts—a differentiation which is clearly of the same order with the preceding, and answers to the next most marked contrast of conditions.
Of course, in the embryos of higher organisms, the changes that happen because of the instability of the uniform are quickly hidden by those resulting from the establishment of the hereditary type. However, early changes that are common to all types of organisms—which cannot be attributed to heredity—completely fit the hypothesis. An embryo that has not undergone any developmental changes consists of a spherical group of uniform cells. Generally, the first step in its development is the creation of a difference between some of the outer cells and the cells that make up the interior—some of the outer cells, after repeated spontaneous divisions, merge to form a membrane; and as this process continues, the membrane spreads until it quickly surrounds the entire mass, as in mammals, or, as in birds, stops short of that for a while. Here, we have two important facts. The first is that the initial difference arises between the outside and the inside. The second is that the change that starts development does not happen at the same time across the entire outside; it begins at one point and gradually affects the rest. Now, these facts are exactly what one might expect from the instability of the uniform. The surface must, more than any other part, become different from the center because it is in the most varied conditions; and not all parts of the surface can show this differentiation at the same time because they cannot all be exposed to outside forces uniformly. One other general fact of similar implication remains. Regardless of how extensive this outer layer of cells, or blastoderm as it’s called, is, it soon divides into two layers—the serous and mucous; or, as they are sometimes called, the ectoderm and endoderm. The first of these is formed from the part of the layer that is in contact with the surrounding environment; and the second is formed from the part of the layer that is in contact with the contained mass of yolk. In other words, after the initial differentiation, which can be more or less extensive, of the surface from the center, the resulting outer portion undergoes a secondary differentiation into inner and outer parts—a differentiation that is clearly of the same nature as the preceding one, reflecting the next most significant contrast of conditions.
But, as already hinted, this principle, understood in the simple form here presented, supplies no key to the detailed phenomena of organic development. It fails entirely to explain generic and specific peculiarities; and indeed leaves us equally in the dark respecting those more important distinctions by which families and orders are marked out. Why two ova, similarly exposed in the same pool, should become the one a fish, and the other a reptile, it cannot tell us. That from two different eggs placed under the same hen, should respectively come forth a duckling and a chicken, is a fact not to be accounted for on the hypothesis above developed. We have here no alternative but to fall back upon the unexplained principle of hereditary transmission. The capacity possessed by an unorganized germ of unfolding 375into a complex adult, which repeats ancestral traits in the minutest details, and that even when it has been placed in conditions unlike those of its ancestors, is a capacity we cannot at present understand. That a microscopic portion of seemingly structureless matter should embody an influence of such kind, that the resulting man will in fifty years after become gouty or insane, is a truth which would be incredible were it not daily illustrated. Should it however turn out, as we shall hereafter find reason for suspecting, that these complex differentiations which adults exhibit, are themselves the slowly accumulated and transmitted results of a process like that seen in the first changes of the germ; it will follow that even those embryonic changes due to hereditary influence, are remote consequences of the alleged law. Should it be shown that the slight modifications wrought during life on each adult, and bequeathed to offspring along with all like preceding modifications, are themselves unlikenesses of parts that are produced by unlikenesses of conditions; then it will follow that the modifications displayed in the course of embryonic development, are partly direct consequences of the instability of the homogeneous, and partly indirect consequences of it. To give reasons for entertaining this hypothesis, however, is not needful for the justification of the position here taken. It is enough that the most conspicuous differentiations which incipient organisms universally display, correspond to the most marked differences of conditions to which their parts are subject. It is enough that the habitual contrast between outside and inside, which we know is produced in inorganic masses by unlikeness of exposure to incident forces, is strictly paralleled by the first contrast that makes its appearance in all organic masses.
But, as mentioned earlier, this principle, understood in the straightforward way it's presented here, doesn't really explain the complex details of how organisms develop. It completely fails to account for the unique traits of different species, and it still leaves us puzzled about the important distinctions that separate families and orders. Why would two eggs, placed in the same pond, result in one becoming a fish and the other a reptile? That’s something it can't explain. Similarly, the fact that two different eggs under the same hen can hatch into a duckling and a chicken cannot be clarified by the theory we've discussed. We're left no choice but to revert to the still-mysterious idea of hereditary transmission. The ability of a simple germ to develop into a complex adult, replicating its ancestors' features in minute detail—even when it's in conditions different from those of its ancestors—is something we don’t fully grasp. The idea that a tiny part of seemingly basic matter can influence a person to develop conditions like gout or insanity in just fifty years seems unbelievable, but we see it happening every day. However, if it turns out, as we might suspect later, that the complex differences seen in adults are the result of a gradual accumulation and inheritance similar to what happens in the early changes of the germ, then it could mean that even those embryonic changes influenced by heredity are ultimately far-off effects of this proposed law. If we demonstrate that the slight changes occurring in each adult during their life, which are passed down to their offspring along with all previous variations, are unique features influenced by different conditions, it would suggest that the changes seen during embryonic development are partly direct consequences of the instability of the uniform, and partly indirect consequences as well. Nevertheless, providing reasons to support this hypothesis isn’t necessary to defend the stance we've taken here. It’s sufficient that the most obvious differences seen in early organisms directly align with the most noticeable differences in the conditions affecting their parts. It’s enough that the consistent contrast between the outside and inside that we know is produced in inorganic materials by different exposures to physical forces is mirrored by the initial contrast that appears in all organic materials.
It remains to point out that in the assemblage of organisms constituting a species, the principle enunciated is equally traceable. We have abundant materials for the induction that each species will not remain uniform, but is ever becoming to some extent multiform; and there is ground for the 376deduction that this lapse from homogeneity to heterogeneity is caused by the subjection of its members to unlike sets of circumstances. The fact that in every species, animal and vegetal, the individuals are never quite alike; joined with the fact that there is in every species a tendency to the production of differences marked enough to constitute varieties; form a sufficiently wide basis for the induction. While the deduction is confirmed by the familiar experience that varieties are most numerous and decided where, as among cultivated plants and domestic animals, the conditions of life depart from the original ones, most widely and in the most numerous ways. Whether we regard “natural selection” as wholly, or only in part, the agency through which varieties are established, matters not to the general conclusion. For as the survival of any variety proves its constitution to be in harmony with a certain aggregate of surrounding forces—as the multiplication of a variety and the usurpation by it of an area previously occupied by some other part of the species, implies different effects produced by such aggregate of forces on the two, it is clear that this aggregate of forces is the real cause of the differentiation—it is clear that if the variety supplants the original species in some localities but not in others, it does so because the aggregate of forces in the one locality is unlike that in the other—it is clear that the lapse of the species from a state of homogeneity to a state of heterogeneity arises from the exposure of its different parts to different aggregates of forces.
It’s important to note that within a group of organisms that make up a species, this principle can also be observed. We have plenty of evidence to suggest that each species won’t stay the same but is continually becoming somewhat diverse; and there’s a basis for concluding that this shift from uniformity to diversity is due to the members being subjected to different sets of circumstances. The fact that in every species, both animal and plant, individuals are never exactly the same, combined with the fact that there’s a tendency within each species to create noticeable differences that lead to varieties, provides a solid foundation for this conclusion. This is further supported by the common observation that varieties are most abundant and distinct where, as in cultivated plants and domesticated animals, living conditions diverge most greatly and in the most varied ways from the originals. Whether we see “natural selection” as the sole or partial mechanism through which these varieties arise doesn’t change the overall conclusion. Because the survival of any variety indicates that its makeup aligns with a specific set of surrounding factors—just as the increase of a variety and its takeover of an area previously held by another part of the species suggests that these factors impact the two differently—it is clear that these factors are the true cause of diversity. It’s clear that if a variety replaces the original species in some places but not in others, it’s because the surrounding factors in those places are different. It’s clear that the transition of the species from a homogeneous state to a heterogeneous one stems from exposing its different parts to varying sets of forces.
§ 113. Among mental phenomena it is difficult to establish the alleged law without an analysis too extensive for the occasion. To show satisfactorily how states of consciousness, originally homogeneous, become heterogeneous through differences in the changes wrought by different forces, would require us carefully to trace out the organization of early experiences. Were this done it would become manifest that the development of intelligence, is, under one of its chief 377aspects, a dividing into separate classes, the unlike things previously confounded together in one class—a formation of sub-classes and sub-sub-classes, until the once confused aggregate of objects known, is resolved into an aggregate which unites extreme heterogeneity among its multiplied groups, with complete homogeneity among the members of each group. If, for example, we followed, through ascending grades of creatures, the genesis of that vast structure of knowledge acquired by sight, we should find that in the first stage, where eyes suffice for nothing beyond the discrimination of light from darkness, the only possible classifications of objects seen, must be those based on the manner in which light is obstructed, and the degree in which it is obstructed. We should find that by such undeveloped visual organs, the shadows traversing the rudimentary retina would be merely distinguished into those of the stationary objects which the creature passed during its own movements, and those of the moving objects which came near the creature while it was at rest; and that so the extremely general classification of visible things into stationary and moving, would be the earliest formed. We should find that whereas the simplest eyes are not fitted to distinguish between an obstruction of light caused by a small object close to, and an obstruction caused by a large object at some distance, eyes a little more developed must be competent to such a distinction; whence must result a vague differentiation of the class of moving objects, into the nearer and the more remote. We should find that such further improvements in vision as those which make possible a better estimation of distances by adjustment of the optic axes, and those which, through enlargement and subdivision of the retina, make possible the discrimination of shapes, must have the effects of giving greater definiteness to the classes already formed, and of sub-dividing these into smaller classes, consisting of objects less unlike. And we should find that each additional refinement of the perceptive organs, must similarly lead to a multiplication of divisions 378and a sharpening of the limits of each division. In every infant might be traced the analogous transformation of a confused aggregate of impressions of surrounding objects, not recognized as differing in their distances, sizes, and shapes, into separate classes of objects unlike each other in these and various other respects. And in the one case as in the other, it might be shown that the change from this first indefinite, incoherent and comparatively homogeneous consciousness, to a definite, coherent, and heterogeneous one, is due to differences in the actions of incident forces on the organism. These brief indications of what might be shown, did space permit, must here suffice. Probably they will give adequate clue to an argument by which each reader may satisfy himself that the course of mental evolution offers no exception to the general law. In further aid of such an argument, I will here add an illustration that is comprehensible apart from the process of mental evolution as a whole.
§ 113. It’s challenging to confirm the suggested law among mental phenomena without delving into an analysis that's too extensive for this occasion. To effectively demonstrate how states of consciousness, which initially start out uniform, become varied due to different forces at play would require a thorough examination of early experiences. If we did this, it would become clear that the development of intelligence, in one of its main aspects, involves breaking down previously mixed categories into distinct classes—creating subclasses and further subdivisions—until the initially confused collection of known objects is transformed into a collection that combines extreme diversity among its numerous groups, with complete sameness among the members of each group. For instance, if we traced the development of the extensive knowledge gained through sight across different species, we would discover that at the earliest stage, where eyes can only tell light from darkness, the only way to classify seen objects would be based on how light is blocked and to what extent. We would see that with such basic visual organs, the shadows that move across their rudimentary retinas would only be classified into those from stationary objects that the creature passed by and those from moving objects that approached it while it was still. Thus, the initial broad classification of visible things into stationary and moving would be the first to form. We would find that while the simplest eyes can’t differentiate between light obstruction caused by a small nearby object and that caused by a large distant object, slightly more developed eyes would be able to make that distinction, leading to a vague classification of moving objects into near and far. We would also see that further improvements in vision, like better distance estimation through adjusting the optic axes and enhancements to the retina that allow for shape recognition, would clarify the already established classes and subdivide them into smaller classes of less different objects. Each additional enhancement in perceptual organs would similarly result in more divisions and clearer boundaries of each division. In every infant, we could trace a similar transformation from a mixed collection of impressions of surrounding objects—initially unrecognized as different in distance, size, and shape—into distinct classes of objects that differ in those and other ways. In both cases, it could be shown that the shift from this initial vague, incoherent, and mostly uniform consciousness to a specific, coherent, and varied one results from differences in how external forces interact with the organism. These brief pointers on what could be shown, given adequate space, must suffice here. They likely provide enough insight for each reader to understand that the process of mental evolution does not deviate from the general law. To further support this argument, I will add an example that can be understood independently of the overall process of mental evolution.
It has been remarked (I am told by Coleridge, though I have been unable to find the passage) that with the advance of language, words which were originally alike in their meanings acquire unlike meanings—a change which he expresses by the formidable word “desynonymization.” Among indigenous words this loss of equivalence cannot be clearly shown; because in them the divergencies of meaning began before the dawn of literature. But among words that have been coined, or adopted from other languages, since the writing of books commenced, it is demonstrable. In the old divines, miscreant is used in its etymological sense of unbeliever; but in modern speech it has entirely lost this sense. Similarly with evil-doer and malefactor: exactly synonymous as these are by derivation, they are no longer synonymous by usage: by a malefactor we now understand a convicted criminal, which is far from being the acceptation of evil-doer. The verb produce, bears in Euclid its primary meaning—to prolong, or draw out; but the now largely developed meanings of produce have little in 379common with the meanings of prolong, or draw out. In the Church of England liturgy, an odd effect results from the occurrence of prevent in its original sense—to come before, instead of its modern specialized sense—to come before with the effect of arresting. But the most conclusive cases are those in which the contrasted words consist of the same parts differently combined; as in go under and undergo. We go under a tree, and we undergo a pain. But though, if analytically considered, the meanings of these expressions would be the same were the words transposed, habit has so far modified their meanings that we could not without absurdity speak of undergoing a tree and going under a pain. Countless such instances might be brought to show that between two words which are originally of like force, an equilibrium cannot be maintained. Unless they are daily used in exactly equal degrees, in exactly similar relations (against which there are infinite probabilities), there necessarily arises a habit of associating one rather than the other with particular acts, or objects. Such a habit, once commenced, becomes confirmed; and gradually their homogeneity of meaning disappears. In each individual we may see the tendency which inevitably leads to this result. A certain vocabulary and a certain set of phrases, distinguish the speech of each person: each person habitually uses certain words in places where other words are habitually used by other persons; and there is a continual recurrence of favourite expressions. This inability to maintain a balance in the use of verbal symbols, which characterizes every man, characterizes, by consequence, aggregates of men; and the desynonymization of words is the ultimate effect.
It has been noted (I hear from Coleridge, though I can't find the exact passage) that as language evolves, words that used to have similar meanings develop different meanings—a change he refers to with the complicated term "desynonymization." With native words, this loss of equivalence isn’t easy to illustrate since the differences in meaning began before literature existed. However, for words that have been created or borrowed from other languages since books started being written, it's clear. In older religious texts, miscreant is used in its original meaning of unbeliever; but in modern language, that meaning is completely gone. The same goes for evil-doer and malefactor: while they are exactly synonymous in their origins, they are no longer synonymous in usage. Today, malefactor means a convicted criminal, which is different from how evil-doer is understood. The verb produce in Euclid carries its original meaning—to prolong or draw out; however, the now widely developed meanings of produce have little in common with prolong or draw out. In the Church of England liturgy, an interesting effect arises from the use of prevent in its original sense—to come before—instead of its modern specialized meaning—to come before with the effect of stopping. But the most compelling examples are where contrasted words are made of the same parts arranged differently, like go under and undergo. We go under a tree, and we undergo a pain. Yet, if we analyze them, the meanings would be the same if the words were swapped; however, usage has so altered their meanings that it would be absurd to say undergoing a tree and going under a pain. Countless examples could be cited to show that between two words with originally similar meanings, a balance cannot be maintained. Unless they are used daily in equal amounts and similar contexts (which is highly unlikely), people begin to routinely associate one word over the other with specific actions or objects. This habit, once formed, becomes established; and gradually their shared meanings fade apart. Each person shows a tendency that inevitably leads to this outcome. A specific vocabulary and set of phrases distinguish how each person speaks: individuals typically use certain words in situations where others use different words; and there’s a repeated use of favored expressions. This struggle to maintain equilibrium in using verbal symbols, which defines every individual, also characterizes groups of people; and the desynonymization of words is the final result.
Should any difficulty be felt in understanding how these mental changes exemplify a law of physical transformations that are wrought by physical forces, it will disappear on contemplating acts of mind as nervous functions. It will be seen that each loss of equilibrium above instanced, is a loss of functional equality between some two elements of the nervous 380system. And it will be seen that, as in other cases, this loss of functional equality is due to differences in the incidence of forces.
Should any difficulty arise in understanding how these mental changes represent a principle of physical transformations caused by physical forces, it will fade when considering mental acts as nervous functions. It will become clear that each instance of loss of equilibrium mentioned above is a loss of functional equality between two elements of the nervous 380system. Moreover, it will be evident that, as in other situations, this loss of functional equality results from differences in how forces are applied.
§ 114. Masses of men, in common with all other masses, show a like proclivity similarly caused. Small combinations and large societies equally manifest it; and in the one, as in the other, both governmental and industrial differentiations are initiated by it. Let us glance at the facts under these two heads.
§ 114. Groups of people, like all other groups, show a similar tendency caused by the same factors. Both small organizations and large societies display this, and in both cases, it leads to both government and industrial divisions. Let’s take a look at the facts in these two areas.
A business partnership, balanced as the authorities of its members may theoretically be, practically becomes a union in which the authority of one partner is tacitly recognized as greater than that of the other or others. Though the shareholders have given equal powers to the directors of their company, inequalities of power soon arise among them; and usually the supremacy of some one director grows so marked, that his decisions determine the course which the board takes. Nor in associations for political, charitable, literary, or other purposes, do we fail to find a like process of division into dominant and subordinate parties; each having its leader, its members of less influence, and its mass of uninfluential members. These minor instances in which unorganized groups of men, standing in homogeneous relations, may be watched gradually passing into organized groups of men standing in heterogeneous relations, give us the key to social inequalities. Barbarous and civilized communities are alike characterized by separation into classes, as well as by separation of each class into more important and less important units; and this structure is manifestly the gradually-consolidated result of a process like that daily exemplified in trading and other combinations. So long as men are constituted to act on one another, either by physical force or by force of character, the struggles for supremacy must finally be decided in favour of some one; and the difference once commenced must tend to become ever more marked. Its unstable equilibrium being destroyed, 381the uniform must gravitate with increasing rapidity into the multiform. And so supremacy and subordination must establish themselves, as we see they do, throughout the whole structure of a society, from the great class-divisions pervading its entire body, down to village cliques, and even down to every posse of school-boys. Probably it will be objected that such changes result, not from the homogeneity of the original aggregations, but from their non-homogeneity—from certain slight differences existing among their units at the outset. This is doubtless the proximate cause. In strictness, such changes must be regarded as transformations of the relatively homogeneous into the relatively heterogeneous. But it is abundantly clear that an aggregation of men, absolutely alike in their endowments, would eventually undergo a similar transformation. For in the absence of perfect uniformity in the lives severally led by them—in their occupations, physical conditions, domestic relations, and trains of thought and feeling—there must arise differences among them; and these must finally initiate social differentiations. Even inequalities of health caused by accidents, must, by entailing inequalities of physical and mental power, disturb the exact balance of mutual influences among the units; and the balance once disturbed, must inevitably be lost. Whence, indeed, besides seeing that a body of men absolutely homogeneous in their governmental relations, must, like all other homogeneous bodies, become heterogeneous, we also see that it must do this from the same ultimate cause—unequal exposure of its parts to incident forces.
A business partnership, no matter how equal the authority of its members might seem in theory, often turns into a situation where one partner's authority is implicitly accepted as stronger than that of the others. Even though shareholders give equal powers to the directors of their company, power imbalances quickly emerge among them; typically, one director's dominance becomes so clear that their decisions dictate the direction of the board. In groups for political, charitable, literary, or other initiatives, we also see a similar pattern of division into dominant and subordinate roles; each group has its leader, members with less influence, and a larger group of those without influence. These smaller examples of unorganized individuals, sharing similar roles, gradually becoming organized groups with diverse roles, provide us insight into social inequalities. Both primitive and developed communities are marked by class separation, as well as the division of each class into more significant and less significant units; this structure is clearly the result of a process similar to what we observe in business and other collaborations. As long as people are capable of influencing one another, whether through physical force or personality, conflicts for superiority will ultimately favor someone; and once this difference starts, it will likely become more pronounced. Once the fragile balance is disrupted, the uniform will increasingly shift into a diverse state. Thus, dominance and subordination will establish themselves throughout society, from the major class divisions that permeate its structure, down to local cliques, and even among groups of school children. It may be argued that such changes happen not because of the similarity of the initial groups, but because of their differences—some slight variations among their members from the start. This is certainly a contributing factor. Technically, these changes should be seen as transformations from relatively similar to relatively different. However, it is clear that a group of people who are completely alike in their characteristics would eventually experience a similar transformation. For in the absence of complete uniformity in their lifestyles—including their jobs, physical conditions, family situations, and ways of thinking and feeling—differences will arise; and these will eventually lead to social distinctions. Even health inequalities caused by accidents can create differences in physical and mental abilities, disrupting the balance of mutual influence among the members; and once that balance is disrupted, it will inevitably be lost. Therefore, we see that even a group of people who are completely uniform in their governance must, like all uniform groups, become diverse, and this would happen due to the same ultimate reason—unequal exposure of its members to outside influences.
The first industrial divisions of societies are much more obviously due to unlikenesses of external circumstances. Such divisions are absent until such unlikenesses are established. Nomadic tribes do not permanently expose any groups of their members to special local conditions; nor does a stationary tribe, when occupying only a small area, maintain from generation to generation marked contrasts in the local conditions of its members; and in such tribes there are 382no decided economical differentiations. But a community which, growing populous, has overspread a large tract, and has become so far settled that its members live and die in their respective districts, keeps its several sections in different physical circumstances; and then they no longer remain alike in their occupations. Those who live dispersed continue to hunt or cultivate the earth; those who spread to the sea-shore fall into maritime occupations; while the inhabitants of some spot chosen, perhaps for its centrality, as one of periodical assemblage, become traders, and a town springs up. Each of these classes undergoes a modification of character consequent on its function, and better fitting it to its function. Later in the process of social evolution these local adaptations are greatly multiplied. A result of differences in soil and climate, is that the rural inhabitants in different parts of the kingdom have their occupations partially specialized; and become respectively distinguished as chiefly producing cattle, or sheep, or wheat, or oats, or hops, or cyder. People living where coal-fields are discovered are transformed into colliers; Cornishmen take to mining because Cornwall is metalliferous; and the iron-manufacture is the dominant industry where ironstone is plentiful. Liverpool has assumed the office of importing cotton, in consequence of its proximity to the district where cotton goods are made; and for analogous reasons, Hull has become the chief port at which foreign wools are brought in. Even in the establishment of breweries, of dye-works, of slate-quarries, of brickyards, we may see the same truth. So that both in general and in detail, the specializations of the social organism which characterize separate districts, primarily depend on local circumstances. Those divisions of labour which under another aspect were interpreted as due to the setting up of motion in the directions of least resistance (§ 91), are here interpreted as due to differences in the incident forces; and the two interpretations are quite consistent with each other. For that which in each case determines the direction 383of least resistance, is the distribution of the forces to be overcome; and hence unlikenesses of distribution in separate localities, entails unlikenesses in the course of human action in those localities—entails industrial differentiations.
The first divisions of industries in societies are clearly due to differences in external circumstances. These divisions do not exist until these differences are established. Nomadic tribes don't typically expose any groups of their members to specific local conditions, and a stationary tribe that occupies a small area doesn’t maintain significant contrasts in local conditions across generations; as a result, there are no clear economic differences in such tribes. However, a community that grows in population, spreads over a large area, and becomes settled so that its members live and die in their respective districts experiences different physical conditions across its sections. This leads to varied occupations. Those who live widely scattered continue to hunt or farm the land, while those who move to the seaside take on maritime jobs. In contrast, inhabitants of a chosen central location for gatherings become traders, leading to the development of a town. Each of these groups undergoes changes in character based on their roles, which makes them better suited to what they do. As social evolution progresses, these local adaptations multiply significantly. Due to differences in soil and climate, rural residents across different regions of the kingdom specialize in their occupations, becoming known for producing cattle, sheep, wheat, oats, hops, or cider. People living in areas where coal is found become coal miners; residents of Cornwall turn to mining because it has mineral resources; and where ironstone is abundant, iron manufacturing becomes the primary industry. Liverpool has taken on the role of importing cotton because it is close to the area where cotton goods are produced; similarly, Hull has become the main port for importing foreign wool. We can observe the same reality in the establishment of breweries, dye works, slate quarries, and brickyards. Thus, both generally and specifically, the occupations that define different regions primarily rely on local circumstances. Those divisions of labor, which can also be viewed as resulting from movement along the paths of least resistance, are here understood as being caused by differences in the external forces at play; the two interpretations are completely consistent. The factor that decides the direction of least resistance in each case is the distribution of the forces to be overcome, which means that variations in distribution across different locations lead to differences in human actions in those areas—resulting in industrial specializations.
§ 115. In common with the general truths set forth in preceding chapters, the instability of the homogeneous is demonstrable à priori. It, like each of them, is a corollary from the persistence of force. Already this has been tacitly implied by assigning unlikeness in the exposure of its part to surrounding agencies, as the reason why a uniform mass loses its uniformity. But here it will be proper to expand this tacit implication into definite proof.
§ 115. Like the general truths presented in previous chapters, the instability of the homogeneous can be shown a priori. It, like each of those truths, follows from the persistence of force. This has already been indirectly suggested by pointing out that the differences in how its parts are affected by surrounding forces is why a uniform mass loses its uniformity. However, it's important to clarify this indirect suggestion into clear proof.
On striking a mass of matter with such force as either to indent it or make it fly to pieces, we see both that the blow affects differently its different parts, and that the differences are consequent on the unlike relations of its parts to the force impressed. The part with which the striking body comes in contact, receiving the whole of the communicated momentum, is driven in towards the centre of the mass. It thus compresses and tends to displace the more centrally situated portions of the mass. These, however, cannot be compressed or thrust out of their places without pressing on all surrounding portions. And when the blow is violent enough to fracture the mass, we see, in the radial dispersion of its fragments, that the original momentum, in being distributed throughout it, has been divided into numerous minor momenta, unlike in their directions. We see that these directions are determined by the positions of the parts with respect to each other, and with respect to the point of impact. We see that the parts are differently affected by the disruptive force, because they are differently related to it in their directions and attachments—that the effects being the joint products of the cause and the conditions, cannot be alike in parts which are differently conditioned. A body on which radiant heat is falling, exemplifies this truth still more 384clearly. Taking the simplest case (that of a sphere) we see that while the part nearest to the radiating centre receives the rays at right angles, the rays strike the other parts of the exposed side at all angles from 90° down to 0°. Again, the molecular vibrations propagated through the mass from the surface which receives the heat, must proceed inwards at angles differing for each point. Further, the interior parts of the sphere affected by the vibrations proceeding from all points of the heated side, must be dissimilarly affected in proportion as their positions are dissimilar. So that whether they be on the recipient area, in the middle, or at the remote side, the constituent atoms are all thrown into states of vibration more or less unlike each other.
When you hit a mass of matter with enough force to either dent it or shatter it, you notice that the impact affects the different parts in different ways, and these differences stem from the varying positions of these parts in relation to the applied force. The part that comes into contact with the striking object receives all of the momentum and is pushed inward toward the center of the mass. This compresses and tends to move the portions of the mass that are more centrally located. However, these inner portions can't be compressed or pushed out of place without affecting all the surrounding parts. When the blow is strong enough to break the mass apart, we see that the original momentum is spread out among the fragments, resulting in multiple smaller moments that have different directions. The directions of these fragments depend on their relative positions and their location to the point of impact. The different parts respond to the disruptive force in varied ways because they relate to the force differently in terms of their directions and attachments. The effects, being the combined result of the cause and the conditions, cannot be the same in parts that are in different conditions. A body receiving radiant heat further illustrates this point. In the simplest example, a sphere, the part nearest to the heat source receives the rays directly, while other parts of the exposed side receive them at various angles ranging from 90° to 0°. Additionally, the molecular vibrations passing through the mass from the heated surface move inward at different angles for each point. The inner parts of the sphere, influenced by vibrations from all areas of the heated side, will also be affected differently based on their positions. Therefore, whether located at the area receiving heat, in the center, or on the far side, the constituent atoms will all enter states of vibration that are more or less different from each other.
But now, what is the ultimate meaning of the conclusion that a uniform force produces different changes throughout a uniform mass, because the parts of the mass stand in different relations to the force? Fully to understand this, we must contemplate each part as simultaneously subject to other forces—those of gravitation, of cohesion, of molecular motion, &c. The effect wrought by an additional force, must be a resultant of it and the forces already in action. If the forces already in action on two parts of any aggregate, are different in their directions, the effects produced on these two parts by like forces must be different in their directions. Why must they be different? They must be different because such unlikeness as exists between the two sets of factors, is made by the presence in the one of some specially-directed force that is not present in the other; and that this force will produce an effect, rendering the total result in the one case unlike that in the other, is a necessary corollary from the persistence of force. Still more manifest does it become that the dissimilarly-placed parts of any aggregate must be dissimilarly modified by an incident force, when we remember that the quantities of the incident force to which they are severally subject, are not equal, as above supposed; but are nearly always very unequal. The outer parts of masses are usually 385alone exposed to chemical actions; and not only are their inner parts shielded from the affinities of external elements, but such affinities are brought to bear unequally on their surfaces; since chemical action sets up currents through the medium in which it takes place, and so brings to the various parts of the surface unequal quantities of the active agent. Again, the amounts of any external radiant force which the different parts of an aggregate receive, are widely contrasted: we have the contrast between the quantity falling on the side next the radiating centre, and the quantity, or rather no quantity, falling on the opposite side; we have contrasts in the quantities received by differently-placed areas on the exposed side; and we have endless contrasts between the quantities received by the various parts of the interior. Similarly when mechanical force is expended on any aggregate, either by collision, continued pressure, or tension, the amounts of strain distributed throughout the mass are manifestly unlike for unlike positions. But to say the different parts of an aggregate receive different quantities of any incident force, is to say that their states are modified by it in different degrees—is to say that if they were before homogeneous in their relations they must be rendered to a proportionate extent heterogeneous; since, force being persistent, the different quantities of it falling on the different parts, must work in them different quantities of effect—different changes. Yet one more kindred deduction is required to complete the argument. We may, by parallel reasoning, reach the conclusion that, even apart from the action of any external force, the equilibrium of a homogeneous aggregate must be destroyed by the unequal actions of its parts on each other. That mutual influence which produces aggregation (not to mention other mutual influences) must work different effects on the different parts; since they are severally exposed to it in unlike amounts and directions. This will be clearly seen on remembering that the portions of which the whole is made up, may be severally regarded as minor wholes; that on each of 386these minor wholes, the action of the entire aggregate then becomes an external incident force; that such external incident force must, as above shown, work unlike changes in the parts of any such minor whole; and that if the minor wholes are severally thus rendered heterogeneous, the entire aggregate is rendered heterogeneous.
But now, what is the ultimate meaning of the conclusion that a uniform force produces different changes throughout a uniform mass, because the parts of the mass are in different relations to the force? To fully understand this, we need to consider each part as being simultaneously affected by other forces—like gravity, cohesion, molecular motion, etc. The effect of an additional force must be the result of that force and the ones already at play. If the forces acting on two parts of any whole are different in their directions, the effects produced on these two parts by similar forces must also differ in their directions. Why must they be different? They have to be different because the distinct characteristics that exist between the two sets of factors are caused by the presence in one of a specifically directed force that isn’t in the other; and since this force will produce an effect, making the total result in one case unlike the other, this is a necessary result of the persistence of force. It becomes even clearer that the differently positioned parts of any whole must be affected differently by an external force when we remember that the quantities of the external force to which they are subjected are not equal, as previously assumed, but are almost always very unequal. The outer parts of masses are usually the only ones exposed to chemical actions; not only are their inner parts shielded from the attraction of external elements, but those attractions are applied unequally on their surfaces. This is because chemical action creates currents through the medium it occurs in, thereby delivering unequal amounts of the active agent to various parts of the surface. Further, the amounts of any external radiant force received by different parts of a whole are highly contrasting: there’s a difference between the quantity hitting the side facing the radiating center and the little or no quantity hitting the opposite side; there are also differences in the amounts received by differently positioned areas on the exposed side; and endless differences exist between the amounts received by various parts of the interior. Similarly, when mechanical force is applied to any aggregate, whether through collision, sustained pressure, or tension, the levels of strain throughout the mass are evidently different for different positions. But to say the different parts of an aggregate receive different amounts of any external force means that their states are modified by it to varying degrees—it means if they were previously uniform in their relations they must be made proportionately heterogeneous; since, because force is persistent, the different amounts of it acting on the various parts must create different effects—different changes. However, one more related conclusion is necessary to round out the argument. We can arrive at the conclusion that, even without the impact of any external force, the equilibrium of a uniform aggregate must be disrupted by the unequal actions of its parts on each other. That mutual influence that leads to aggregation (not to mention other mutual influences) must create different effects on the different parts, since they are each exposed to it in unequal amounts and directions. This becomes clear when we consider that the parts making up the whole can be seen as smaller wholes; that the action of the entire aggregate on each of these smaller wholes becomes an external force; that as previously mentioned, this external force must create different changes in the parts of any of these smaller wholes; and that if the smaller wholes are thus rendered heterogeneous, the whole aggregate is rendered heterogeneous too.
The instability of the homogeneous is thus deducible from that primordial truth which underlies our intelligence. One stable homogeneity only, is hypothetically possible. If centres of force, absolutely uniform in their powers, were diffused with absolute uniformity through unlimited space, they would remain in equilibrium. This however, though a verbally intelligible supposition, is one that cannot be represented in thought; since unlimited space is inconceivable. But all finite forms of the homogeneous—all forms of it which we can know or conceive, must inevitably lapse into heterogeneity. In three several ways does the persistence of force necessitate this. Setting external agencies aside, each unit of a homogeneous whole must be differently affected from any of the rest by the aggregate action of the rest upon it. The resultant force exercised by the aggregate on each unit, being in no two cases alike in both amount and direction, and usually not in either, any incident force, even if uniform in amount and direction, cannot produce like effects on the units. And the various positions of the parts in relation to any incident force, preventing them from receiving it in uniform amounts and directions, a further difference in the effects wrought on them is inevitably produced.
The instability of a uniform system comes from the fundamental truth that underlies our understanding. Only one type of stable uniformity is theoretically possible. If forces that are completely uniform in their strengths were spread evenly throughout limitless space, they would stay in balance. However, while this idea makes sense in words, it can't be fully grasped because limitless space is beyond comprehension. All finite forms of uniformity—any we can know or imagine—will inevitably break down into differences. This happens in three distinct ways due to the nature of force. Ignoring outside influences, each part of a uniform whole will be affected differently by the combined actions of the others. The total force acting on each part won't be the same in both strength and direction, and usually not in either aspect. Consequently, even if an external force is consistent in strength and direction, it cannot produce similar effects on the individual parts. Furthermore, the different positions of each part relative to any external force prevent them from experiencing that force uniformly, leading to even more varied effects.
One further remark is needed. To the conclusion that the changes with which Evolution commences, are thus necessitated, remains to be added the conclusion that these changes must continue. The absolutely homogeneous must lose its equilibrium; and the relatively homogeneous must lapse into the relatively less homogeneous. That which is true of any total mass, is true of the parts into which it segregates. The uniformity of each such part must 387as inevitably be lost in multiformity, as was that of the original whole; and for like reasons. And thus the continued changes which characterize Evolution, in so far as they are constituted by the lapse of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous, and of the less heterogeneous into the more heterogeneous, are necessary consequences of the persistence of force.
One more thing needs to be said. In addition to the conclusion that the changes with which Evolution begins are necessary, we must add that these changes must keep happening. The completely uniform has to lose its balance; and the relatively uniform must break down into something that is relatively less uniform. What’s true for any total mass is also true for the parts into which it separates. The uniformity of each part must 387inevitably be lost in diversity, just like the original whole did; and for the same reasons. Therefore, the ongoing changes that define Evolution, as they are driven by the shift from the uniform to the diverse, and from the less diverse to the more diverse, are necessary outcomes of the persistence of force.
16. The idea developed in this chapter originally formed part of an article on “Transcendental Physiology,” published in 1857. See Essays, pp. 279–290.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.The concept discussed in this chapter was originally part of an article on “Transcendental Physiology,” published in 1857. See Essays, pp. 279–290.
CHAPTER XIV.
EFFECTS MULTIPLICATION.
§ 116. To the cause of increasing complexity set forth in the last chapter, we have in this chapter to add another. Though secondary in order of time, it is scarcely secondary in order of importance. Even in the absence of the cause already assigned, it would necessitate a change from the homogeneous to the heterogeneous; and joined with it, it makes this change both more rapid and more involved. To come in sight of it, we have but to pursue a step further, that conflict between force and matter already delineated. Let us do this.
§ 116. Along with the increasing complexity discussed in the last chapter, we need to add another factor in this chapter. While it comes later in the timeline, it is hardly less important. Even without the previously mentioned cause, this factor would still lead to a shift from uniformity to diversity; together with the previous cause, it makes this transition both faster and more complicated. To understand this better, we only need to delve a bit deeper into the conflict between force and matter that we've already outlined. Let's proceed with that.
When a uniform aggregate is subject to a uniform force, we have seen that its constituents, being differently conditioned, are differently modified. But while we have contemplated the various parts of the aggregate as thus undergoing unlike changes, we have not yet contemplated the unlike changes simultaneously produced on the various parts of the incident force. These must be as numerous and important as the others. Action and re-action being equal and opposite, it follows that in differentiating the parts on which it falls in unlike ways, the incident force must itself be correspondingly differentiated. Instead of being as before, a uniform force, it must thereafter be a multiform force—a group of dissimilar forces. A few illustrations will make this truth manifest.
When a uniform group is subjected to an even force, we have seen that its components, being in different conditions, are affected differently. However, while we have looked at the various parts of the group undergoing these different changes, we have not yet considered the different effects that the force itself produces on the various parts it impacts. These effects must be just as numerous and significant as the changes in the components. Since action and reaction are equal and opposite, it follows that as the force acts differently on different parts, the force itself must also be modified accordingly. Instead of remaining a uniform force, it will become a diverse set of forces—a collection of dissimilar forces. A few examples will illustrate this point clearly.
389A single force is divided by conflict with matter into forces that widely diverge. In the case lately cited, of a body shattered by violent collision, besides the change of the homogeneous mass into a heterogeneous group of scattered fragments, there is a change of the homogeneous momentum into a group of momenta, heterogeneous in both amounts and directions. Similarly with the forces we know as light and heat. After the dispersion of these by a radiating body towards all points, they are re-dispersed towards all points by the bodies on which they fall. Of the Sun’s rays, issuing from him on every side, some few strike the Moon. These being reflected at all angles from the Moon’s surface, some few of them strike the Earth. By a like process the few which reach the Earth are again diffused through surrounding space. And on each occasion, such portions of the rays as are absorbed instead of reflected, undergo refractions that equally destroy their parallelism. More than this is true. By conflict with matter, a uniform force is in part changed into forces differing in their directions; and in part it is changed into forces differing in their kinds. When one body is struck against another, that which we usually regard as the effect, is a change of position or motion in one or both bodies. But a moment’s thought shows that this is a very incomplete view of the matter. Besides the visible mechanical result, sound is produced; or, to speak accurately, a vibration in one or both bodies, and in the surrounding air: and under some circumstances we call this the effect. Moreover, the air has not simply been made to vibrate, but has had currents raised in it by the transit of the bodies. Further, if there is not that great structural change which we call fracture, there is a disarrangement of the particles of the two bodies around their point of collision; amounting in some cases to a visible condensation. Yet more, this condensation is accompanied by disengagement of heat. In some cases a spark—that is, light—results, from the incandescence of a portion struck 390off; and occasionally this incandescence is associated with chemical combination. Thus, by the original mechanical force expended in the collision, at least five, and often more, different kinds of forces have been produced. Take, again, the lighting of a candle. Primarily, this is a chemical change consequent on a rise of temperature. The process of combination having once been set going by extraneous heat, there is a continued formation of carbonic acid, water, &c.—in itself a result more complex than the extraneous heat that first caused it. But along with this process of combination there is a production of heat; there is a production of light; there is an ascending column of hot gases generated; there are currents established in the surrounding air. Nor does the decomposition of one force into many forces end here. Each of the several changes worked becomes the parent of further changes. The carbonic acid formed, will by and by combine with some base; or under the influence of sunshine give up its carbon to the leaf of a plant. The water will modify the hygrometric state of the air around; or, if the current of hot gases containing it come against a cold body, will be condensed: altering the temperature, and perhaps the chemical state, of the surface it covers. The heat given out melts the subjacent tallow, and expands whatever it warms. The light, falling on various substances, calls forth from them reactions by which it is modified; and so divers colours are produced. Similarly even with these secondary actions, which may be traced out into ever-multiplying ramifications, until they become too minute to be appreciated. Universally, then, the effect is more complex than the cause. Whether the aggregate on which it falls be homogeneous or otherwise, an incident force is transformed by the conflict into a number of forces that differ in their amounts, or directions, or kinds; or in all these respects. And of this group of variously-modified forces, each ultimately undergoes a like transformation.
389A single force is split apart by interference with matter into various forces that can be quite different. In the recently mentioned case of a body that gets smashed in a violent collision, not only does the uniform mass turn into a varied collection of scattered pieces, but the uniform momentum also breaks into a range of momenta that vary in both strength and direction. The same applies to forces we call light and heat. After they are spread out by a radiating body in all directions, they are then spread out again by the surfaces they hit. Some of the Sun’s rays, radiating outward in all directions, hit the Moon. These rays reflect off the Moon’s surface at all angles, and a few manage to strike the Earth. In a similar way, those rays that reach the Earth are again dispersed throughout the surrounding space. Each time this happens, portions of the rays that get absorbed instead of reflected are refracted, which also disrupts their parallel nature. Even more is true. Through interaction with matter, a uniform force is partially transformed into forces that differ in direction, and partially into forces that vary in type. When one body collides with another, what we usually view as the result is a change in position or motion of one or both bodies. But if we think for a moment, we see this is a very limited perspective. Besides the visible mechanical outcome, sound is created; or more accurately, a vibration occurs in one or both bodies and the surrounding air, and in certain situations we consider this the effect. Moreover, the air doesn’t just vibrate but has currents stirred up by the movement of the bodies. If there isn’t a significant structural change like a fracture, the particles of the two bodies around the point of impact become disarranged, sometimes leading to visible condensation. Furthermore, this condensation is often accompanied by the release of heat. In some instances, a spark—meaning light—emerges from the incandescence of a part that gets struck off; and occasionally, this incandescence is linked to a chemical reaction. Thus, from the original mechanical force used in the collision, at least five, and often more, different types of forces are generated. Take, for example, lighting a candle. Essentially, this is a chemical change that occurs due to an increase in temperature. Once the process of combination starts due to external heat, there is a continuous production of carbonic acid, water, etc.—which is itself a more complex result than the external heat that initiated it. Along with this process of combination, heat is produced; light is generated; an upward flow of hot gases is created; and currents are established in the air around it. The breakdown of one force into many doesn’t stop here. Each of the various changes leads to further changes. The carbonic acid produced will eventually combine with some base or, under sunlight, release its carbon to a plant’s leaf. The water can alter the humidity of the air around it or, if the current of hot gases containing it meets a cold surface, it will condense, changing the temperature and possibly the chemical state of that surface. The heat released melts the underlying tallow and expands whatever it warms. The light, when it falls on different substances, triggers reactions that modify it, resulting in various colors. This process of secondary actions can branch out into countless subdivisions until they become so intricate that they go unnoticed. Overall, the effect is more complicated than the cause. Whether the aggregate it encounters is uniform or not, an incident force is altered by conflict into a variety of forces that differ in strength, direction, or type; or in all these aspects. Each of these variously modified forces ultimately undergoes a similar transformation.
Let us now mark how the process of evolution is furthered 391by this multiplication of effects. An incident force decomposed by the reactions of a body into a group of unlike forces—a uniform force thus reduced to a multiform force—becomes the cause of a secondary increase of multiformity in the body which decomposes it. In the last chapter we saw that the several parts of an aggregate are differently modified by any incident force. It has just been shown that by the reactions of the differently modified parts, the incident force itself must be divided into differently modified parts. Here it remains to point out that each differentiated division of the aggregate, thus becomes a centre from which a differentiated division of the original force is again diffused. And since unlike forces must produce unlike results, each of these differentiated forces must produce, throughout the aggregate, a further series of differentiations. This secondary cause of the change from homogeneity to heterogeneity, obviously becomes more potent in proportion as the heterogeneity increases. When the parts into which any evolving whole has segregated itself, have diverged widely in nature, they will necessarily react very diversely on any incident force—they will divide an incident force into so many strongly contrasted groups of forces. And each of them becoming the centre of a quite distinct set of influences, must add to the number of distinct secondary changes wrought throughout the aggregate. Yet another corollary must be added. The number of unlike parts of which an aggregate consists, as well as the degree of their unlikeness, is an important factor in the process. Every additional specialized division is an additional centre of specialized forces. If a uniform whole, in being itself made multiform by an incident force, makes the incident force multiform; if a whole consisting of two unlike sections, divides an incident force into two unlike groups of multiform forces; it is clear that each new unlike section must be a further source of complication among the forces at work throughout the mass—a further source of heterogeneity. The multiplication of 392effects must proceed in geometrical progression. Each stage of evolution must initiate a higher stage.
Let’s now observe how the process of evolution is advanced 391by this increase in effects. An external force, broken down by the reactions of an object into a variety of distinct forces—a uniform force transforming into a diverse force—becomes the source of a secondary rise in diversity within the object that breaks it down. In the last chapter, we noted that the various parts of a whole are affected differently by any external force. It has been demonstrated that due to the reactions of these differently modified parts, the external force itself must also be divided into differently modified components. Now, it’s important to point out that each differentiated division of the whole then becomes a center from which a differentiated version of the original force is spread. And since different forces must yield different outcomes, each of these differentiated forces will produce, across the whole, another series of differentiations. This secondary cause of the shift from uniformity to diversity clearly becomes more powerful as diversity increases. When the parts into which any evolving whole have separated themselves greatly differ in nature, they will inevitably react very differently to any external force—they will split an external force into several strongly contrasting groups of forces. And each of them, becoming the center of a distinctly different set of influences, must contribute to the number of unique secondary changes seen throughout the whole. Another point should be made. The number of unlike parts that make up a whole, as well as the level of their differences, is a crucial factor in this process. Each additional specialized division represents an additional center of specialized forces. If a uniform whole, when changed into a diverse one by an external force, makes that external force diverse; if a whole made up of two unlike sections divides an external force into two unlike groups of diverse forces; it’s clear that each new unlike section must be another source of complexity among the forces at play throughout the mass—a further source of diversity. The increase in 392effects must follow a geometric progression. Each stage of evolution must lead to a higher stage.
§ 117. The force of aggregation acting on irregular masses of rare matter, diffused through a resisting medium, will not cause such masses to move in straight lines to their common centre of gravity; but, as before said, each will take a curvilinear path, directed to one or other side of the centre of gravity. All of them being differently conditioned, gravitation will impress on each a motion differing in direction, in velocity, and in the degree of its curvature—uniform aggregative force will be differentiated into multiform momenta. The process thus commenced, must go on till it produces a single mass of nebulous matter; and these independent curvilinear motions must result in a movement of this mass round its axis: a simultaneous condensation and rotation in which we see how two effects of the aggregative force, at first but slightly divergent, become at last widely differentiated. A gradual increase of oblateness in this revolving spheroid, must take place through the joint action of these two forces, as the bulk diminishes and the rotation grows more rapid; and this we may set down as a third effect. The genesis of heat, which must accompany augmentation of density, is a consequence of yet another order—a consequence by no means simple; since the various parts of the mass, being variously condensed, must be variously heated. Acting throughout a gaseous spheroid, of which the parts are unlike in their temperatures, the forces of aggregation and rotation must work a further series of changes: they must set up circulating currents, both general and local. At a later stage light as well as heat will be generated. Thus without dwelling on the likelihood of chemical combinations and electric disturbances, it is sufficiently manifest that, supposing matter to have originally existed in a diffused state, the once uniform force which caused its aggregation, must have become gradually divided into different forces; and that each further stage of complication 393in the resulting aggregate, must have initiated further subdivisions of this force—a further multiplication of effects, increasing the previous heterogeneity.
§ 117. The force of aggregation acting on uneven clumps of rare matter, spread out through a resistant medium, won't make these clumps move in straight lines toward their common center of gravity; instead, as mentioned earlier, each will follow a curved path, leaning to one side or the other of the center of gravity. Since each clump is in a different condition, gravity will impart different motions to each one, varying in direction, speed, and curvature—uniform aggregative force will break down into multiple momenta. This process must continue until it forms a single mass of nebulous matter, and these individual curved motions will lead to a movement of this mass around its axis: a simultaneous condensation and rotation where we see how two effects of the aggregative force, initially slightly different, become significantly distinct. A gradual increase in flattening of this rotating spheroid will happen due to the combined action of these two forces, as the mass gets smaller and the rotation speeds up; we can consider this a third effect. The generation of heat, which must accompany an increase in density, is a result of another kind—a not-so-simple consequence; since different parts of the mass, being condensed to varying degrees, must heat up differently. As this gaseous spheroid consists of parts with different temperatures, the forces of aggregation and rotation must create another series of changes: they will establish circulating currents, both general and specific. Later on, both light and heat will also be produced. So, without getting into the potential for chemical reactions and electrical disturbances, it’s clear that if matter originally existed in a dispersed state, the initially uniform force that caused its aggregation must have gradually split into different forces; and that each new stage of complexity in the resulting aggregate must have prompted further subdivisions of this force—a further multiplication of effects, increasing the previous diversity. 393
This section of the argument may however be adequately sustained, without having recourse to any such hypothetical illustrations as the foregoing. The astronomical attributes of the Earth, will even alone suffice our purpose. Consider first the effects of its momentum round its axis. There is the oblateness of its form; there is the alternation of day and night; there are certain constant marine currents; and there are certain constant aërial currents. Consider next the secondary series of consequences due to the divergence of the Earth’s plane of rotation from the plane of its orbit. The many differences of the seasons, both simultaneous and successive, which pervade its surface, are thus caused. External attraction acting on this rotating oblate spheroid with inclined axis, produces the motion called nutation, and that slower and larger one from which follows the precession of the equinoxes, with its several sequences. And then by this same force are generated the tides, aqueous and atmospheric.
This part of the argument can be adequately supported without relying on hypothetical examples like the ones mentioned earlier. The Earth's astronomical features alone are enough for our purpose. First, think about the effects of its rotation around its axis. There’s the flattened shape of the Earth; the alternation of day and night; the consistent ocean currents; and the steady air currents. Next, consider the secondary effects caused by the difference between the Earth’s rotation plane and the plane of its orbit. The various seasonal changes, both at the same time and over time, across its surface are a result of this. External forces acting on this rotating, flattened sphere with a tilted axis create a motion called nutation, along with a slower, larger movement that leads to the precession of the equinoxes and its various consequences. Additionally, this same force produces the tides, both in water and in the atmosphere.
Perhaps, however, the simplest way of showing the multiplication of effects among phenomena of this order, will be to set down the influences of any member of the Solar System on the rest. A planet directly produces in neighbouring planets certain appreciable perturbations, complicating those otherwise produced in them; and in the remoter planets it directly produces certain less visible perturbations. Here is a first series of effects. But each of the perturbed planets is itself a source of perturbations—each directly affects all the others. Hence, planet A having drawn planet B out of the position it would have occupied in A’s absence, the perturbations which B causes are different from what they would else have been; and similarly with C, D, E, &c. Here then is a secondary series of effects: far more numerous though far smaller in their amounts. As these indirect perturbations must to some extent modify the movements of each planet, 394there results from them a tertiary series; and so on continually. Thus the force exercised by any planet works a different effect on each of the rest; this different effect is from each as a centre partially broken up into minor different effects on the rest; and so on in ever multiplying and diminishing waves throughout the entire system.
Maybe the easiest way to demonstrate how effects multiply among these kinds of phenomena is to outline the influences that any member of the Solar System has on the others. A planet directly causes noticeable disturbances in neighboring planets, adding complexity to those already existing; and in the more distant planets, it produces some less obvious disturbances. This is the first series of effects. But each of the affected planets also generates disturbances—each one has a direct impact on all the others. So, when planet A pulls planet B from where it would have been if A weren't there, the disturbances that B causes will be different from what they would have been otherwise; and the same goes for C, D, E, etc. This creates a secondary series of effects that are much more numerous, although smaller in magnitude. Since these indirect disturbances must somewhat alter the movements of each planet, 394 this leads to a tertiary series of effects, and so on continuously. Thus, the influence exerted by any planet produces a different impact on each of the others; this different impact is from each planet as a center that is partially broken into smaller varying impacts on the rest; and this continues in ever-increasing and decreasing waves throughout the entire system.
§ 118. If the Earth was formed by the concentration of diffused matter, it must at first have been incandescent; and whether the nebular hypothesis be accepted or not, this original incandescence of the Earth must now be regarded as inductively established—or, if not established, at least rendered so probable that it is a generally admitted geological doctrine. Several results of the gradual cooling of the Earth—as the formation of a crust, the solidification of sublimed elements, the precipitation of water, &c., have been already noticed—and I here again refer to them merely to point out that they are simultaneous effects of the one cause, diminishing heat. Let us now, however, observe the multiplied changes afterwards arising from the continuance of this one cause. The Earth, falling in temperature, must contract. Hence the solid crust at any time existing, is presently too large for the shrinking nucleus; and being unable to support itself, inevitably follows the nucleus. But a spheroidal envelope cannot sink down into contact with a smaller internal spheroid, without disruption: it will run into wrinkles, as the rind of an apple does when the bulk of its interior decreases from evaporation. As the cooling progresses and the envelope thickens, the ridges consequent on these contractions must become greater; rising ultimately into hills and mountains; and the later systems of mountains thus produced must not only be higher, as we find them to be, but they must be longer, as we also find them to be. Thus, leaving out of view other modifying forces, we see what immense heterogeneity of surface arises from the one cause, loss of heat—a heterogeneity which the telescope shows us to be paralleled on the Moon, where aqueous 395and atmospheric agencies have been absent. But we have yet to notice another kind of heterogeneity of surface, similarly and simultaneously caused. While the Earth’s crust was still thin, the ridges produced by its contraction must not only have been small, but the tracts between them must have rested with comparative smoothness on the subjacent liquid spheroid; and the water in those arctic and antarctic regions where it first condensed, must have been evenly distributed. But as fast as the crust grew thicker and gained corresponding strength, the lines of fracture from time to time caused in it, necessarily occurred at greater distances apart; the intermediate surfaces followed the contracting nucleus with less uniformity; and there consequently resulted larger areas of land and water. If any one, after wrapping an orange in wet tissue paper, and observing both how small are the wrinkles and how evenly the intervening spaces lie on the surface of the orange, will then wrap it in thick cartridge-paper, and note both the greater height of the ridges and the larger spaces throughout which the paper does not touch the orange, he will realize the fact, that as the Earth’s solid envelope thickened, the areas of elevation and depression became greater. In place of islands more or less homogeneously scattered over an all-embracing sea, there must have gradually arisen heterogeneous arrangements of continent and ocean, such as we now know. This double change in the extent and in the elevation of the lands, involved yet another species of heterogeneity—that of coast-line. A tolerably even surface raised out of the ocean will have a simple, regular sea-margin; but a surface varied by table-lands and intersected by mountain-chains, will, when raised out of the ocean, have an outline extremely irregular, alike in its leading features and in its details. Thus endless is the accumulation of geological and geographical results slowly brought about by this one cause—the escape of the Earth’s primitive heat.
§ 118. If the Earth was formed by the concentration of spread-out matter, it must have initially been extremely hot; and regardless of whether we accept the nebular hypothesis, this early heat of the Earth is now generally considered to be established—or, if not fully established, at least seen as so likely that it's widely recognized in geology. Several effects from the Earth gradually cooling—like the formation of a crust, the solidifying of vaporized elements, the accumulation of water, etc.—have already been mentioned. I refer to them again here just to highlight that they are all simultaneous effects of a single cause: decreasing heat. Now, let’s look at the multiple changes that occur as a result of this one ongoing cause. The Earth, cooling down, must contract. Consequently, the solid crust at any given time becomes too large for the shrinking core; unable to support itself, it ultimately follows the core down. However, a spherical shell can’t simply collapse into contact with a smaller inner spheroid without breaking apart: it will wrinkle, similar to how the skin of an apple does when its interior shrinks due to evaporation. As cooling continues and the outer layer thickens, the ridges resulting from these contractions will grow larger, eventually forming hills and mountains; and the newer mountain ranges created in this way must not only be taller, as we observe, but also longer, which is consistent with our findings. Thus, aside from other influencing forces, we see immense variations in surface arise from the single cause of heat loss—a variation that telescopes reveal to exist on the Moon, where there are no water or atmospheric influences. However, we also need to recognize another kind of surface variation, caused similarly and concurrently. While the Earth’s crust was still thin, the ridges resulting from its contraction were likely small, and the areas in between them probably remained relatively smooth on the underlying liquid sphere; the water in those polar regions where it first accumulated would have been evenly distributed. But as the crust thickened and became stronger, the lines of fracture that occurred over time would inevitably happen at greater distances apart; the surfaces in between followed the contracting core with less uniformity, leading to larger areas of land and water. If someone wraps an orange in wet tissue paper and observes how small the wrinkles are and how evenly the spaces lie on the surface of the orange, then wraps it in thick cardboard and notes the greater height of the ridges and the larger gaps throughout where the paper doesn't touch the orange, they will understand that as the Earth’s solid outer layer thickened, the areas of elevation and depression became more pronounced. Instead of islands scattered over a vast sea, diverse arrangements of land and ocean, like what we now know, would have gradually developed. This dual change in the extent and elevation of the lands also brought about another type of variation: that of coastlines. A fairly even surface rising out of the ocean will have a simple, regular shoreline; but a surface marked by plateaus and intersected by mountain ranges will, when elevated from the ocean, have an extremely irregular outline, both in its main features and details. Thus, the accumulation of geological and geographical results slowly brought about by this one cause—the loss of the Earth’s original heat—is endless.
When we pass from the agency which geologists term igneous, 396to aqueous and atmospheric agencies, we see a like ever-growing complication of effects. The denuding actions of air and water have, from the beginning, been modifying every exposed surface: everywhere working many different changes. As already shown (§ 80) the original source of those gaseous and fluid motions which effect denudation, is the solar heat. The transformation of this into various modes of force, according to the nature and condition of the matter on which it falls, is the first stage of complication. The sun’s rays, striking at all angles a sphere, that from moment to moment presents and withdraws different parts of its surface, and each of them for a different time daily throughout the year, would produce a considerable variety of changes even were the sphere uniform. But falling as they do on a sphere surrounded by an atmosphere in some parts of which wide areas of cloud are suspended, and which here unveils vast tracts of sea, there of level land, there of mountains, there of snow and ice, they initiate in its several parts countless different movements. Currents of air of all sizes, directions, velocities, and temperatures, are set up; as are also marine currents similarly contrasted in their characters. In this region the surface is giving off water in the state of vapour; in that, dew is being precipitated; and in the other rain is descending—differences that arise from the ever-changing ratio between the absorption and radiation of heat in each place. At one hour, a rapid fall in temperature leads to the formation of ice, with an accompanying expansion throughout the moist bodies frozen; while at another, a thaw unlocks the dislocated fragments of these bodies. And then, passing to a second stage of complication, we see that the many kinds of motion directly or indirectly caused by the sun’s rays, severally produce results that vary with the conditions. Oxidation, drought, wind, frost, rain, glaciers, rivers, waves, and other denuding agents effect disintegrations that are determined in their amounts and qualities by local circumstances. Acting upon a tract of granite, such agents here work scarcely an 397appreciable effect; there cause exfoliations of the surface, and a resulting heap of débris and boulders; and elsewhere, after decomposing the feldspar into a white clay, carry away this with the accompanying quartz and mica, and deposit them in separate beds, fluviatile and marine. When the exposed land consists of several unlike formations, sedimentary and igneous, changes proportionably more heterogeneous are wrought. The formations being disintegrable in different degrees, there follows an increased irregularity of surface. The areas drained by different rivers being differently constituted, these rivers carry down to the sea unlike combinations of ingredients; and so sundry new strata of distinct composition arise. And here indeed we may see very simply illustrated, the truth, that the heterogeneity of the effects increases in a geometrical progression, with the heterogeneity of the object acted upon. A continent of complex structure, presenting many strata irregularly distributed, raised to various levels, tilted up at all angles, must, under the same denuding agencies, give origin to immensely multiplied results: each district must be peculiarly modified; each river must carry down a distinct kind of detritus; each deposit must be differently distributed by the entangled currents, tidal and other, which wash the contorted shores; and every additional complication of surface must be the cause of more than one additional consequence. But not to dwell on these, let us, for the fuller elucidation of this truth in relation to the inorganic world, consider what would presently follow from some extensive cosmical revolution—say the subsidence of Central America. The immediate results of the disturbance would themselves be sufficiently complex. Besides the numberless dislocations of strata, the ejections of igneous matter, the propagation of earthquake vibrations thousands of miles around, the loud explosions, and the escape of gases, there would be the rush of the Atlantic and Pacific Oceans to supply the vacant space, the subsequent recoil of enormous waves, which would traverse both these oceans and produce 398myriads of changes along their shores, the corresponding atmospheric waves complicated by the currents surrounding each volcanic vent, and the electrical discharges with which such disturbances are accompanied. But these temporary effects would be insignificant compared with the permanent ones. The complex currents of the Atlantic and Pacific would be altered in directions and amounts. The distribution of heat achieved by these currents would be different from what it is. The arrangement of the isothermal lines, not only on the neighbouring continents, but even throughout Europe, would be changed. The tides would flow differently from what they do now. There would be more or less modification of the winds in their periods, strengths, directions, qualities. Rain would fall scarcely anywhere at the same times and in the same quantities as at present. In short, the meteorological conditions thousands of miles off, on all sides, would be more or less revolutionized. In these many changes, each of which comprehends countless minor ones, the reader will see the immense heterogeneity of the results wrought out by one force, when that force expends itself on a previously complicated area; and he will readily draw the corollary that from the beginning the complication has advanced at an increasing rate.
When we move from the processes that geologists call igneous to those related to water and air, we see a growing complexity of effects. The wearing away caused by air and water has been changing every exposed surface from the start, creating many different alterations everywhere. As already explained (§ 80), the original source of the gas and fluid movements that cause erosion is solar heat. The conversion of this heat into various forms of energy, depending on the type and condition of the material it hits, is the first level of complexity. The sun’s rays hitting a sphere from all angles, which constantly shows and hides different parts of its surface, each for varying durations throughout the year, would create a significant variety of changes, even if the sphere were uniform. However, since they strike a sphere surrounded by an atmosphere that sometimes has large areas of cloud, while at other times revealing extensive sea, flat land, mountains, and snow and ice, they kickstart countless diverse movements in its different parts. There are air currents of various sizes, directions, speeds, and temperatures, just like there are marine currents with contrasting characteristics. In one area, the surface is releasing water as vapor; in another, dew is forming; and elsewhere, rain is falling—differences that stem from the constantly changing balance of heat absorption and radiation in each spot. At one moment, a sharp drop in temperature leads to ice formation, which causes expansion in the frozen moisture; at another, a thaw releases the fractured pieces of those materials. Then, moving to a second stage of complexity, we see that the numerous types of motion, whether directly or indirectly caused by the sun’s rays, each produce different outcomes based on local conditions. Processes like oxidation, dryness, wind, frost, rain, glaciers, rivers, waves, and other erosion agents cause disintegrations that vary in quantity and quality based on specific local factors. When these agents act on a patch of granite, they might barely create any noticeable effect; in another area, they might cause surface peeling and a resulting pile of debris and boulders; and in yet another, after breaking down feldspar into white clay, they could transport this along with quartz and mica, depositing them in separate river and marine beds. When the exposed land consists of various formations, both sedimentary and igneous, the changes become even more diverse. Since the formations can be broken down to differing extents, an increased irregularity of surface develops. The areas drained by different rivers are composed differently, causing these rivers to carry unique combinations of materials, resulting in various new layers with distinct compositions. This clearly illustrates the truth that the diversity of effects increases geometrically with the diversity of the objects being acted upon. A continent with a complex structure, featuring many layers unevenly distributed, raised to different heights, and tilted at various angles, must produce dramatically multiplied results from the same erosion processes: each area will be uniquely shaped; each river will carry a specific kind of debris; each deposition will be distributed differently due to the swirling tidal and other currents along the twisted shorelines; and every added complexity of surface will lead to more than one extra outcome. To further clarify this truth in relation to the inorganic world, consider what might happen from a significant cosmic event—like the sinking of Central America. The immediate aftermath of such a disturbance would be extremely complex. In addition to countless dislocations of layers, the expulsion of molten material, the spread of earthquake vibrations thousands of miles away, loud explosions, and gas releases, there would be a rush from the Atlantic and Pacific Oceans to fill the empty space, the subsequent rebound of massive waves that would travel through both oceans and create countless changes along their shores, the related atmospheric waves along with the currents around each volcanic vent, and the electrical discharges that accompany such disturbances. However, these temporary effects would be insignificant compared to the lasting ones. The complex currents of the Atlantic and Pacific would change in direction and intensity. The heat distribution achieved by these currents would be different. The arrangement of temperature lines, not just on nearby continents but even across Europe, would be altered. Tides would flow differently than they currently do. The winds would be modified in terms of timing, strength, direction, and qualities. Rain would fall at different times and in different amounts than it does now. In short, the weather conditions thousands of miles away on all sides would undergo some level of revolution. In these many changes, each encompassing countless smaller ones, you can see the enormous variety of results produced by a single force when it acts on an already complex area, and you can easily conclude that the complexity has been growing at an increasing rate from the beginning.
§ 119. We have next to trace throughout organic evolution, this same all-pervading principle. And here, where the transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous was first observed, the production of many changes by one cause is least easy to demonstrate. The development of a seed into a plant, or an ovum into an animal, is so gradual; while the forces which determine it are so involved, and at the same time so unobtrusive; that it is difficult to detect the multiplication of effects which is elsewhere so obvious. Nevertheless, by indirect evidence we may establish our proposition; spite of the lack of direct evidence.
§ 119. Next, we need to track this same all-encompassing principle throughout organic evolution. Here, where we first observed the transformation from the uniform to the diverse, it’s least clear how many changes arise from a single cause. The development of a seed into a plant, or an egg into an animal, happens so gradually, and the forces driving these changes are so complex and subtle, that it’s hard to notice the multiplication of effects that is so clear in other cases. However, through indirect evidence, we can support our argument despite the lack of direct proof.
Observe, first, how numerous are the changes which any 399marked stimulus works on an adult organism—a human being, for instance. An alarming sound or sight, besides impressions on the organs of sense and the nerves, may produce a start, a scream, a distortion of the face, a trembling consequent on general muscular relaxation, a burst of perspiration, an excited action of the heart, a rush of blood to the brain, followed possibly by arrest of the heart’s action and by syncope; and if the system be feeble, an illness with its long train of complicated symptoms may set in. Similarly in cases of disease. A minute portion of the small-pox virus introduced into the system, will, in a severe case, cause, during the first stage, rigors, heat of skin, accelerated pulse, furred tongue, loss of appetite, thirst, epigastric uneasiness, vomiting, headache, pains in the back and limbs, muscular weakness, convulsions, delirium, &c.; in the second stage, cutaneous eruption, itching, tingling, sore throat, swelled fauces, salivation, cough, hoarseness, dyspnœa, &c.; and in the third stage, œdematous inflammations, pneumonia, pleurisy, diarrhœa, inflammation of the brain, ophthalmia, erysipelas, &c.: each of which enumerated symptoms is itself more or less complex. Medicines, special foods, better air, might in like manner be instanced as producing multiplied results. Now it needs only to consider that the many changes thus wrought by one force on an adult organism, must be partially paralleled in an embryo-organism, to understand how here also the production of many effects by one cause is a source of increasing heterogeneity. The external heat and other agencies which determine the first complications of the germ, will, by acting on these, superinduce further complications; on these still higher and more numerous ones; and so on continually: each organ as it is developed, serving, by its actions and reactions on the rest, to initiate new complexities. The first pulsations of the fœtal heart must simultaneously aid the unfolding of every part. The growth of each tissue, by taking from the blood special proportions of elements, must modify the constitution of the blood; and so must 400modify the nutrition of all the other tissues. The distributive actions, implying as they do a certain waste, necessitate an addition to the blood of effete matters, which must influence the rest of the system, and perhaps, as some think, initiate the formation of excretory organs. The nervous connections established among the viscera must further multiply their mutual influences. And so with every modification of structure—every additional part and every alteration in the ratios of parts. Still stronger becomes the proof when we call to mind the fact, that the same germ may be evolved into different forms according to circumstances. Thus, during its earlier stages, every embryo is sexless—becomes either male or female as the balance of forces acting on it determines. Again, it is well-known that the larva of a working-bee will develop into a queen-bee, if, before a certain period, its food be changed to that on which the larvæ of queen-bees are fed. Even more remarkable is the case of certain entozoa. The ovum of a tape-worm, getting into the intestine of one animal, unfolds into the form of its parent; but if carried into other parts of the system, or into the intestine of some unlike animal, it becomes one of the sac-like creatures, called by naturalists Cysticerci, or Cœnuri, or Echinococci—creatures so extremely different from the tape-worm in aspect and structure, that only after careful investigations have they been proved to have the same origin. All which instances imply that each advance in embryonic complication results from the action of incident forces on the complication previously existing. Indeed, the now accepted doctrine of epigenesis necessitates the conclusion that organic evolution proceeds after this manner. For since it is proved that no germ, animal or vegetal, contains the slightest rudiment, trace, or indication of the future organism—since the microscope has shown us that the first process set up in every fertilized germ is a process of repeated spontaneous fissions, ending in the production of a mass of cells, not one of which exhibits any special character; there seems no 401alternative but to conclude that the partial organization at any moment subsisting in a growing embryo, is transformed by the agencies acting on it into the succeeding phase of organization, and this into the next, until, through ever-increasing complexities, the ultimate form is reached. Thus, though the subtlety of the forces and the slowness of the metamorphosis, prevent us from directly tracing the genesis of many changes by one cause, throughout the successive stages which every embryo passes through; yet, indirectly, we have strong evidence that this is a source of increasing heterogeneity. We have marked how multitudinous are the effects which a single agency may generate in an adult organism; that a like multiplication of effects must happen in the unfolding organism, we have inferred from sundry illustrative cases; further, it has been pointed out that the ability which like germs have to originate unlike forms, implies that the successive transformations result from the new changes superinduced on previous changes; and we have seen that structureless as every germ originally is, the development of an organism out of it is otherwise incomprehensible. Doubtless we are still in the dark respecting those mysterious properties which make the germ, when subject to fit influences, undergo the special changes beginning this series of transformations. All here contended is, that given a germ possessing these mysterious properties, the evolution of an organism from it depends, in part, on that multiplication of effects which we have seen to be a cause of evolution in general, so far as we have yet traced it.
Look first at how many changes any marked stimulus causes in an adult organism—a human being, for example. An alarming sound or sight can trigger reactions such as a flinch, a scream, facial distortion, trembling from overall muscle relaxation, sweating, a racing heart, a rush of blood to the brain, potentially leading to cardiac arrest and fainting. If the system is weak, this could trigger a long illness with various complicated symptoms. The same goes for diseases. A tiny amount of the smallpox virus introduced into the system can lead to severe symptoms during the first stage, like chills, fever, fast pulse, coated tongue, loss of appetite, thirst, stomach discomfort, vomiting, headaches, pain in the back and limbs, muscle weakness, convulsions, delirium, etc. In the second stage, symptoms might include skin rash, itching, tingling, sore throat, swollen throat, drooling, coughing, hoarseness, shortness of breath, etc. In the third stage, complications can involve swelling and inflammation, pneumonia, pleurisy, diarrhea, brain inflammation, eye infections, erysipelas, etc. Each of these symptoms is complex in itself. Medicines, special diets, and cleaner air could similarly produce numerous effects. Now, just consider that the various changes caused by one force in an adult organism must, to some degree, also occur in an embryo. This helps us see how one cause can create many effects, leading to increased complexity. The external heat and other factors that determine the first complications of the germ will induce further complications by acting on these initial ones; this process continues, with each newly formed organ interacting with the others and generating new complexities. The first beats of the fetal heart must aid in developing every part. The growth of each tissue, by extracting specific elements from the blood, must change the blood's composition and, in turn, affect the nutrition of all other tissues. The actions of distribution imply a certain waste, requiring an influx of waste materials into the blood, which affects the entire system and possibly initiates the formation of excretory organs. The nervous connections formed among the organs further increase their interactions. And this dynamic applies to every structural modification—each additional part and every change in part ratios. The proof becomes even stronger when we remember that the same germ can develop into different forms based on circumstances. For instance, during its early stages, every embryo is initially sexless, becoming either male or female based on the balance of forces acting on it. Additionally, it's well-known that if the larva of a worker bee is fed differently before a certain period, it will develop into a queen bee. Even more striking is the case of certain parasites. The egg of a tapeworm, when it enters the intestine of one animal, develops into the form of its parent; however, if it ends up in a different part of the body or in the intestine of a different animal, it becomes one of the sac-like creatures, known to scientists as Cysticerci, Cœnuri, or Echinococci—these are so different in appearance and structure from the tapeworm that only thorough investigation reveals their common origin. All these examples suggest that each advancement in embryonic complexity arises from the impact of various forces on the complexity that already exists. Indeed, the now-accepted theory of epigenesis leads us to conclude that organic evolution unfolds in this way. Since it's established that no germ, whether animal or plant, contains any hint or trace of the future organism—and the microscope has shown us that the first process initiated in every fertilized germ is a series of spontaneous divisions that produce a mass of cells, none of which have any specific characteristics—it seems unavoidable to conclude that the partial organization present in a growing embryo is transformed by the forces acting on it into the next phase of organization, and this continues until, through increasingly complex changes, the final form is reached. Thus, while the subtlety of the forces and the gradual nature of the transformations make it difficult for us to directly trace the genesis of many changes caused by one factor throughout the successive stages of every embryo, we do have strong indirect evidence that this is a source of increased complexity. We have noted how numerous the effects of a single factor can be in an adult organism; we’ve inferred that a similar multiplication of effects occurs in a developing organism from various illustrative examples; furthermore, it has been pointed out that the capacity of similar germs to give rise to dissimilar forms implies that the successive transformations arise from new changes superimposed on earlier changes; and we have observed that, since every germ starts as structureless, the development of an organism from it is otherwise incomprehensible. Undoubtedly, we remain unclear about the mysterious properties that enable the germ, when subjected to suitable influences, to undergo the specific changes initiating this series of transformations. What has been argued here is that given a germ with these mysterious properties, the evolution of an organism from it is partly dependent on the multiplication of effects we have seen to be a cause of evolution in general, based on what we have observed so far.
When, leaving the development of single plants and animals, we pass to that of the Earth’s flora and fauna, the course of the argument again becomes clear and simple. Though, as before admitted, the fragmentary facts Palæontology has accumulated, do not clearly warrant us in saying that, in the lapse of geologic time, there have been evolved more heterogeneous organisms, and more heterogeneous assemblages of organisms; yet we shall now see that there 402must ever have been a tendency towards these results. We shall find that the production of many effects by one cause, which, as already shown, has been all along increasing the physical heterogeneity of the Earth, has further necessitated an increasing heterogeneity in its flora and fauna, individually and collectively. An illustration will make this clear. Suppose that by a series of upheavals, occurring, as they are now known to do, at long intervals, the East Indian Archipelago were to be raised into a continent, and a chain of mountains formed along the axis of elevation. By the first of these upheavals, the plants and animals inhabiting Borneo, Sumatra, New Guinea, and the rest, would be subjected to slightly-modified sets of conditions. The climate in general would be altered in temperature, in humidity, and in its periodical variations; while the local differences would be multiplied. These modifications would affect, perhaps inappreciably, the entire flora and fauna of the region. The change of level would produce additional modifications; varying in different species, and also in different members of the same species, according to their distance from the axis of elevation. Plants, growing only on the sea-shore in special localities, might become extinct. Others, living only in swamps of a certain humidity, would, if they survived at all, probably undergo visible changes of appearance. While more marked alterations would occur in some of the plants that spread over the lands newly raised above the sea. The animals and insects living on these modified plants, would themselves be in some degree modified by change of food, as well as by change of climate; and the modification would be more marked where, from the dwindling or disappearance of one kind of plant, an allied kind was eaten. In the lapse of the many generations arising before the next upheaval, the sensible or insensible alterations thus produced in each species, would become organized—in all the races that survived there would be a more or less complete adaptation to the new conditions. The next upheaval would superinduce 403further organic changes, implying wider divergences from the primary forms; and so repeatedly. Now however let it be observed that this revolution would not be a substitution of a thousand modified species for the thousand original species; but in place of the thousand original species there would arise several thousand species, or varieties, or changed forms. Each species being distributed over an area of some extent, and tending continually to colonize the new area exposed, its different members would be subject to different sets of changes. Plants and animals migrating towards the equator would not be affected in the same way with others migrating from it. Those which spread towards the new shores, would undergo changes unlike the changes undergone by those which spread into the mountains. Thus, each original race of organisms would become the root from which diverged several races, differing more or less from it and from each other; and while some of these might subsequently disappear, probably more than one would survive in the next geologic period: the very dispersion itself increasing the chances of survival. Not only would there be certain modifications thus caused by changes of physical conditions and food; but also in some cases other modifications caused by changes of habit. The fauna of each island, peopling, step by step, the newly-raised tracts, would eventually come in contact with the faunas of other islands; and some members of these other faunas would be unlike any creatures before seen. Herbivores meeting with new beasts of prey, would, in some cases, be led into modes of defence or escape differing from those previously used; and simultaneously the beasts of prey would modify their modes of pursuit and attack. We know that when circumstances demand it, such changes of habit do take place in animals; and we know that if the new habits become the dominant ones, they must eventually in some degree alter the organization. Observe now, however, a further consequence. There must arise not simply a tendency towards the differentiation 404of each race of organisms into several races; but also a tendency to the occasional production of a somewhat higher organism. Taken in the mass, these divergent varieties, which have been caused by fresh physical conditions and habits of life, will exhibit alterations quite indefinite in kind and degree; and alterations that do not necessarily constitute an advance. Probably in most cases the modified type will be not appreciably more heterogeneous than the original one. But it must now and then occur, that some division of a species, falling into circumstances which give it rather more complex experiences, and demand actions somewhat more involved, will have certain of its organs further differentiated in proportionately small degrees—will become slightly more heterogeneous. Hence, there will from time to time arise an increased heterogeneity both of the Earth’s flora and fauna, and of individual races included in them. Omitting detailed explanations, and allowing for the qualifications which cannot here be specified, it is sufficiently clear that geological mutations have all along tended to complicate the forms of life, whether regarded separately or collectively. That multiplication of effects which has been a part-cause of the transformation of the Earth’s crust from the simple into the complex, has simultaneously led to a parallel transformation of the Life upon its surface.[17]
When we shift our focus from the development of individual plants and animals to that of Earth's plants and animals as a whole, the argument becomes clear and straightforward again. Although it's acknowledged that the incomplete facts gathered by paleontology don't definitively support the claim that, over geological time, more diverse organisms and more varied groups of organisms have evolved, we will now see that there has always been a tendency toward these outcomes. We will discover that the production of multiple effects from a single cause, which has been continuously increasing the physical diversity of Earth, has also necessitated a growing diversity in its flora and fauna, both individually and collectively. To clarify this, let’s consider an example. Suppose a series of upheavals, happening at long intervals, were to raise the East Indian Archipelago into a continent and form a mountain range along the elevation's axis. During the first upheaval, the plants and animals living in Borneo, Sumatra, New Guinea, and elsewhere would be exposed to slightly different conditions. The overall climate would change in temperature, humidity, and seasonal variations, while local differences would increase. These changes would likely affect the entire flora and fauna of the area, even if subtly. The change in elevation would lead to more modifications, varying by species and even by individual members of the same species, depending on their distance from the elevation axis. Some plants that only grow along specific shorelines might go extinct, while others that live only in certain swamp conditions would likely change visibly if they survived at all. Meanwhile, more significant changes would occur in plants that spread across the newly raised lands. The animals and insects that depend on these altered plants would be affected by changes in food sources and climate, causing further modifications, especially when a dwindling plant type leads to increased consumption of a related plant. Over many generations before the next upheaval, the noticeable or subtle changes that occur in each species would become established; all surviving races would exhibit a degree of adaptation to the new conditions. The next upheaval would bring about additional organic changes, resulting in greater differences from the original forms, and this cycle would continue. However, it’s important to note that this evolution wouldn't involve simply replacing a thousand modified species for the original thousand; rather, there would be many thousands of species, varieties, or altered forms arising in place of the original thousand. Each species would spread across a broad area and continually try to colonize the newly exposed land, subjecting different members to various changes. Plants and animals moving toward the equator would experience different effects than those migrating away from it. Those that spread to the new shores would undergo changes distinct from those of creatures moving into the mountains. Thus, each original species would branch out, leading to several races that differ to varying degrees from the original and from each other; while some might eventually disappear, likely more than one would survive into the next geological period, as this very dispersal would increase their survival chances. There would not only be specific modifications from changes in physical conditions and food but also, in some cases, modifications from changes in behaviors. The fauna on each island, gradually populating the newly elevated areas, would eventually interact with faunas from other islands, and some of these newcomers would be unlike any creatures previously seen. Herbivores encountering new predators might adopt different defense or escape strategies from those previously used; simultaneously, the predators would alter their hunting and attacking methods. We know that when required, animals can change their habits, and if these new habits become dominant, they will eventually lead to some degree of organizational change. Now, observe another consequence. There must emerge not just a tendency for each species to differentiate into multiple races, but also a tendency for the occasional emergence of a somewhat more advanced organism. In large groups, these divergent varieties, shaped by new physical conditions and lifestyle habits, will exhibit changes that are broad in kind and degree, not necessarily indicating progress. Most of the time, the modified type will not be significantly more diverse than the original. However, there will occasionally be instances where a particular division of a species, encountering circumstances that offer it more complex experiences and require more intricate actions, will have certain organs differentiated, albeit in small degrees, becoming slightly more diverse. Consequently, there will periodically be an increase in the diversity of both Earth's flora and fauna, as well as the individual races within them. Without going into detailed explanations and acknowledging the nuances this summary cannot cover, it's apparent that geological changes have consistently contributed to the complexity of life forms, whether considered individually or collectively. The range of effects contributing to the transformation of Earth's crust from simple to complex has simultaneously driven a parallel transformation of the life on its surface.
The deduction here drawn from the established truths of 405geology and the general laws of life, gains immensely in weight on finding it to be in harmony with an induction drawn from direct experience. Just that divergence of many races from one race, which we inferred must have been continually occurring during geologic time, we know to have occurred during the pre-historic and historic periods, in man and domestic animals. And just that multiplication of effects which we concluded must have been instrumental to the first, we see has in a great measure wrought the last. Single causes, as famine, pressure of population, war, have periodically led to further dispersions of mankind and of dependent creatures: each such dispersion initiating new modifications, new varieties of type. Whether all the human races be or be not derived from one stock, philology makes it clear that whole groups of races, now easily distinguishable from each other, were originally one race—that the diffusion of one race into different climates and conditions of existence has produced many altered forms of it. Similarly with domestic animals. Though in some cases (as that of dogs) community of origin will perhaps be disputed, yet in other cases (as that of the sheep or the cattle of our own country) it will not be questioned that local differences of climate, food, and treatment, have transformed one original breed into numerous breeds, now become so far distinct as to produce unstable hybrids. Moreover, through the complication of effects flowing from single causes, we here find, what we before inferred, not only an increase of general heterogeneity, but also of special heterogeneity. While of the divergent divisions and subdivisions of the human race, many have undergone changes not constituting an advance; others have become decidedly more heterogeneous. The civilized European departs more widely from the vertebrate archetype than does the savage.
The conclusion drawn from the established facts of 405geology and the general laws of life is significantly stronger when it aligns with conclusions based on direct experience. The divergence of many races from a single race, which we suggested has been happening throughout geological time, is something we know has taken place during both pre-historic and historic periods in humans and domesticated animals. The various factors we believed contributed to this initial divergence have largely driven the latter changes as well. Single causes, like famine, population pressure, and war, have repeatedly caused further dispersals of humans and dependent species, with each dispersal leading to new modifications and varieties. Whether all human races come from one ancestor or not, language studies show that distinct groups of races, which are currently easy to tell apart, originally came from one race—diffusion of this race into different climates and living conditions has resulted in many altered forms. The same goes for domestic animals. While the shared origin of some species (like dogs) might be debated, in other cases (like sheep or cattle in our own country), it is widely accepted that local differences in climate, food, and care have transformed one original breed into many breeds that are now so distinct that they can produce unstable hybrids. Furthermore, due to the complex effects stemming from single causes, we confirm what we previously suggested: not only is there an increase in general diversity, but also in specific diversity. Among the various divisions and subdivisions of the human race, some have changed in ways that don't represent progress, while others have become significantly more diverse. The civilized European deviates more from the vertebrate archetype than the primitive individual does.
§ 120. A sensation does not expend itself in arousing some single state of consciousness; but the state of consciousness aroused is made up of various represented sensations connected 406by co-existence, or sequence with the presented sensation. And that, in proportion as the grade of intelligence is high, the number of ideas suggested is great, may be readily inferred. Let us, however, look at the proof that here too, each change is the parent of many changes; and that the multiplication increases in proportion as the area affected is complex.
§ 120. A sensation doesn't only trigger one specific state of awareness; instead, the awareness that it triggers consists of various sensations that are linked either by happening at the same time or by their order compared to the presented sensation. It’s easy to see that as intelligence increases, the number of ideas that come to mind also increases. Let's examine the evidence that, in this case as well, each change leads to multiple changes, and that the increase happens more significantly when the area involved is more complex. 406
Were some hitherto unknown bird, driven say by stress of weather from the remote north, to make its appearance on our shores, it would excite no speculation in the sheep or cattle amid which it alighted: a perception of it as a creature like those constantly flying about, would be the sole interruption of that dull current of consciousness which accompanies grazing and rumination. The cow-herd, by whom we may suppose the exhausted bird to be presently caught, would probably gaze at it with some slight curiosity, as being unlike any he had before seen—would note its most conspicuous markings, and vaguely ponder on the questions, where it came from, and how it came. The village bird-stuffer would have suggested to him by the sight of it, sundry forms to which it bore a little resemblance; would receive from it more numerous and more specific impressions respecting structure and plumage; would be reminded of various instances of birds brought by storms from foreign parts—would tell who found them, who stuffed them, who bought them. Supposing the unknown bird taken to a naturalist of the old school, interested only in externals, (one of those described by the late Edward Forbes, as examining animals as though they were merely skins filled with straw,) it would excite in him a more involved series of mental changes: there would be an elaborate examination of the feathers, a noting of all their technical distinctions, with a reduction of these perceptions to certain equivalent written symbols; reasons for referring the new form to a particular family, order, and genus would be sought out and written down; communications with the secretary of some society, or editor of some journal, would follow; and probably there would be not a few thoughts about the addition 407of the ii to the describer’s name, to form the name of the species. Lastly, in the mind of a comparative anatomist, such a new species, should it happen to have any marked internal peculiarity, might produce additional sets of changes—might very possibly suggest modified views respecting the relationships of the division to which it belonged; or, perhaps, alter his conceptions of the homologies and developments of certain organs; and the conclusions drawn might not improbably enter as elements into still wider inquiries concerning the origin of organic forms.
If some unknown bird, maybe pushed south by bad weather from the far north, showed up on our shores, it wouldn’t spark much curiosity among the sheep or cattle where it landed. They’d just see it as another creature, like those that constantly fly around, barely interrupting their dull awareness while grazing and chewing. The cowherd who might catch sight of the tired bird would probably look at it with mild interest, noting its unique features and vaguely wondering where it came from and how it got there. The local taxidermist, on seeing it, would think of various birds it resembled, notice more detailed aspects of its structure and feathers, remember different accounts of birds blown in from afar, and recount who found them, stuffed them, and bought them. If the unknown bird was taken to a traditional naturalist, who only cared about external appearances (like those described by the late Edward Forbes, who examined animals as if they were just skins stuffed with straw), it would trigger a more complex set of thoughts: a detailed analysis of the feathers, noting all their specific differences, and translating these observations into written symbols; looking for reasons to classify it into a particular family, order, and genus; corresponding with the secretary of some society or an editor of a journal; and likely considering how to add the appropriate suffix to the describer's name to label the species. Lastly, in the mind of a comparative anatomist, if this new species had distinct internal traits, it could lead to even more changes in thought — possibly reshaping ideas about how its group relates to others or changing views on how certain organs developed; and the conclusions drawn might even contribute to broader questions about the origins of living forms.
From ideas let us turn to emotions. In a young child, a father’s anger produces little else than vague fear—a disagreeable sense of impending evil, taking various shapes of physical suffering or deprivation of pleasures. In elder children, the same harsh words will arouse additional feelings: sometimes a sense of shame, of penitence, or of sorrow for having offended; at other times, a sense of injustice, and a consequent anger. In the wife, yet a further range of feelings may come into existence—perhaps wounded affection, perhaps self-pity for ill-usage, perhaps contempt for groundless irritability, perhaps sympathy for some suffering which the irritability indicates, perhaps anxiety about an unknown misfortune which she thinks has produced it. Nor are we without evidence that among adults, the like differences of development are accompanied by like differences in the number of emotions that are aroused, in combination or rapid succession—the lower natures being characterized by that impulsiveness which results from the uncontrolled action of a few feelings; and the higher natures being characterized by the simultaneous action of many secondary feelings, modifying those first awakened.
From ideas, let’s move on to emotions. In a young child, a father’s anger mainly brings about vague fear—a discomforting sense of looming danger, manifesting in various forms of physical pain or loss of enjoyment. In older children, the same harsh words will trigger additional feelings: sometimes a sense of shame, regret, or sorrow for having upset someone; other times, a feeling of injustice, and resulting anger. In a wife, there may be an even wider range of feelings—maybe hurt feelings, self-pity for being mistreated, disdain for unfounded irritability, sympathy for some underlying suffering indicated by the irritability, or anxiety about an unknown misfortune she thinks may have caused it. We also see that among adults, similar differences in emotional development are linked to corresponding differences in the number of emotions stirred up, whether in combination or quick succession—the more basic personalities being marked by impulsiveness due to the unchecked influence of a few feelings, while the more complex personalities are defined by the simultaneous engagement of many secondary feelings that modify those first triggered.
Possibly it will be objected that the illustrations here given, are drawn from the functional changes of the nervous system, not from its structural changes; and that what is proved among the first, does not necessarily hold among the last. This must be admitted. Those, however, who recognize the 408truth that the structural changes are the slowly accumulated results of the functional changes, will readily draw the corollary, that a part-cause of the evolution of the nervous system, as of other evolution, is this multiplication of effects which becomes ever greater as the development becomes higher.
It's possible that someone might argue that the examples provided here are based on the functional changes of the nervous system rather than its structural changes and that what is demonstrated in the first case doesn't necessarily apply to the latter. This is a valid point. However, those who understand that structural changes are the gradual results of functional changes will quickly infer that a partial cause of the evolution of the nervous system, just like in other forms of evolution, is this increasing number of effects that grow larger as development progresses.
§ 121. If the advance of Man towards greater heterogeneity in both body and mind, is in part traceable to the production of many effects by one cause, still more clearly may the advance of Society towards greater heterogeneity be so explained. Consider the growth of an industrial organization. When, as must occasionally happen, some individual of a tribe displays unusual aptitude for making an article of general use (a weapon, for instance) which was before made by each man for himself, there arises a tendency towards the differentiation of that individual into a maker of weapons. His companions (warriors and hunters all of them) severally wish to have the best weapons that can be made; and are therefore certain to offer strong inducements to this skilled individual to make weapons for them. He, on the other hand, having both an unusual faculty, and an unusual liking, for making weapons (the capacity and the desire for any occupation being commonly associated), is predisposed to fulfil these commissions on the offer of adequate rewards: especially as his love of distinction is also gratified. This first specialization of function, once commenced, tends ever to become more decided. On the side of the weapon-maker, continued practice gives increased skill—increased superiority to his products. On the side of his clients, cessation of practice entails decreased skill. Thus the influences that determine this division of labour grow stronger in both ways: this social movement tends ever to become more decided in the direction in which it was first set up; and the incipient heterogeneity is, on the average of cases, likely to become permanent for that generation, if no longer. Such a process, besides differentiating the social mass into two parts, 409the one monopolizing, or almost monopolizing, the performance of a certain function, and the other having lost the habit, and in some measure the power, of performing that function, has a tendency to initiate other differentiations. The advance described implies the introduction of barter: the maker of weapons has, on each occasion, to be paid in such other articles as he agrees to take in exchange. Now he will not habitually take in exchange one kind of article, but many kinds. He does not want mats only, or skins, or fishing-gear; but he wants all these; and on each occasion will bargain for the particular things he most needs. What follows? If among the members of the tribe there exist any slight differences of skill in the manufacture of these various things, as there are almost sure to do, the weapon-maker will take from each one the thing which that one excels in making: he will exchange for mats with him whose mats are superior, and will bargain for the fishing-gear of whoever has the best. But he who has bartered away his mats or his fishing-gear, must make other mats or fishing-gear for himself; and in so doing must, in some degree, further develop his aptitude. Thus it results that the small specialities of faculty possessed by various members of the tribe will tend to grow more decided. If such transactions are from time to time repeated, these specializations may become appreciable. And whether or not there ensue distinct differentiations of other individuals into makers of particular articles, it is clear that incipient differentiations take place throughout the tribe: the one original cause produces not only the first dual effect, but a number of secondary dual effects, like in kind but minor in degree. This process, of which traces may be seen among groups of school-boys, cannot well produce a lasting distribution of functions in an unsettled tribe; but where there grows up a fixed and multiplying community, such differentiations become permanent, and increase with each generation. An addition to the number of citizens, involving a greater demand for every commodity, intensifies the 410functional activity of each specialized person or class; and this renders the specialization more definite where it already exists, and establishes it where it is but nascent. By increasing the pressure on the means of subsistence, a larger population again augments these results; since every individual is forced more and more to confine himself to that which he can do best, and by which he can gain most. And this industrial progress, by aiding future production, opens the way for further growth of population, which reacts as before. Presently, under the same stimuli, new occupations arise. Competing workers, severally aiming to produce improved articles, occasionally discover better processes or better materials. In weapons and cutting-tools, the substitution of bronze for stone entails on him who first makes it, a great increase of demand—so great an increase that he presently finds all his time occupied in making the bronze for the articles he sells, and is obliged to depute the fashioning of these articles to others; and eventually the making of bronze, thus gradually differentiated from a pre-existing occupation, becomes an occupation by itself. But now mark the ramified changes which follow this change. Bronze soon replaces stone, not only in the articles it was first used for, but in many others; and so affects the manufacture of them. Further, it affects the processes which such improved utensils subserve, and the resulting products—modifies buildings, carvings, dress, personal decorations. Yet again, it sets going sundry manufactures which were before impossible, from lack of a material fit for the requisite tools. And all these changes react on the people—increase their manipulative skill, their intelligence, their comfort—refine their habits and tastes.
§ 121. If humanity's move towards greater diversity in both body and mind is partly due to multiple effects arising from one cause, then society's move towards greater diversity can be explained even more clearly. Think about the growth of industrial organization. When, as sometimes happens, an individual in a tribe shows unusual talent for creating a commonly used item (like a weapon), which everyone used to make for themselves, a tendency develops for that person to become a dedicated weapon maker. His fellow tribespeople (who are all warriors and hunters) want the best weapons available, so they will offer strong incentives for this skilled individual to make weapons for them. The weapon maker, having both a talent and a passion for his craft (since skills and desires are usually linked), is inclined to take on these commissions in exchange for adequate rewards, especially since it satisfies his desire for recognition. Once this specialization begins, it tends to become more pronounced. The weapon maker improves his skills through practice, resulting in higher quality products, while his clients lose their ability through lack of practice. Thus, the forces driving this division of labor grow stronger in both directions: this social movement increasingly solidifies in the original direction, and the initial diversity is likely to become a lasting feature for that generation, if not longer. Such a process, besides splitting society into two groups—one that almost completely handles a specific function and another that has lost the practice and, to some degree, the ability to fulfill that function—tends to spur other differentiations. The advancement described here includes the introduction of barter: the weapon maker must be compensated with various items that he agrees to accept in exchange. He won't just want one type of item; instead, he will want many different things. He doesn't just want mats or skins or fishing gear; he wants all of it and will negotiate for whatever he needs most at the moment. What happens next? If there are minor differences in skill among tribe members when making these various items, which is likely, the weapon maker will choose the best mats, skins, or fishing gear based on who makes them best. However, those who trade away their mats or fishing gear will have to create more for themselves, leading them to develop their skills further. This way, the small specializations each tribe member has will become more defined. If these exchanges happen repeatedly, these specializations may become noticeable. Whether or not this leads to distinct individuals specializing in particular goods, it’s evident that initial differences emerge throughout the tribe: the single original cause not only produces the first dual effect but also creates several secondary dual effects that are similar in nature but smaller in scale. This process, observable among groups of schoolboys, may not lead to a lasting distribution of functions in an unsettled tribe, but as a stable and growing community develops, such differentiations become permanent and increase with each generation. An increase in the number of citizens leads to a greater demand for every commodity, enhancing the functional output of each specialized person or class; this sharpens existing specializations and establishes new ones that are just beginning. By increasing the pressure on resources, a larger population pushes individuals to focus more on what they can do best and earn the most from. This industrial progress, by facilitating future production, paves the way for further population growth, which, in turn, cycles back into the system. Soon, under these same pressures, new jobs emerge. Competing workers, each aiming to produce improved goods, sometimes discover better processes or materials. In the case of weapons and cutting tools, switching from stone to bronze greatly increases demand for those who first utilize it—so much so that they soon find all their time consumed with making bronze for the items they sell and have to delegate the crafting of those items to others; eventually, making bronze, which gradually differentiates from existing trades, becomes its own occupation. But take note of the far-reaching changes triggered by this shift. Bronze quickly replaces stone, not only for the items it was first introduced for but also for many others, affecting how those items are made. Furthermore, it influences the processes that these improved tools are used for and the resulting products, altering buildings, carvings, clothing, and personal adornments. Additionally, it sparks various manufacturing efforts that were impossible before due to the lack of suitable materials for the necessary tools. All these changes enhance the people's skills, intelligence, and comfort, refining their habits and tastes.
It is out of the question here to follow through its successive complications, this increasing social heterogeneity that results from the production of many effects by one cause. But leaving the intermediate phases of social development, let us take an illustration from its passing phase. To trace the effects of steam-power, in its manifold applications to 411mining, navigation, and manufactures, would carry us into unmanageable detail. Let us confine ourselves to the latest embodiment of steam-power—the locomotive engine. This, as the proximate cause of our railway-system, has changed the face of the country, the course of trade, and the habits of the people. Consider, first, the complicated sets of changes that precede the making of every railway—the provisional arrangements, the meetings, the registration, the trial-section, the parliamentary survey, the lithographed plans, the books of reference, the local deposits and notices, the application to Parliament, the passing Standing-Orders Committee, the first, second, and third readings: each of which brief heads indicates a multiplicity of transactions, and the further development of sundry occupations, (as those of engineers, surveyors, lithographers, parliamentary agents, share-brokers,) and the creation of sundry others (as those of traffic-takers, reference-takers). Consider, next, the yet more marked changes implied in railway construction—the cuttings, em-bankings, tunnellings, diversions of roads; the building of bridges and stations; the laying down of ballast, sleepers, and rails; the making of engines, tenders, carriages, and wagons: which processes, acting upon numerous trades, increase the importation of timber, the quarrying of stone, the manufacture of iron, the mining of coal, the burning of bricks; institute a variety of special manufactures weekly advertised in the Railway Times; and call into being some new classes of workers—drivers, stokers, cleaners, plate-layers, &c. &c. Then come the changes, more numerous and involved still, which railways in action produce on the community at large. The organization of every business is more or less modified: ease of communication makes it better to do directly what was before done by proxy; agencies are established where previously they would not have paid; goods are obtained from remote wholesale houses instead of near retail ones; and commodities are used which distance once rendered inaccessible. The rapidity and small cost of carriage, tend to specialize 412more than ever the industries of different districts—to confine each manufacture to the parts in which, from local advantages, it can be best carried on. Economical distribution equalizes prices, and also, on the average, lowers prices: thus bringing divers articles within the means of those before unable to buy them, and so increasing their comforts and improving their habits. At the same time the practice of travelling is immensely extended. Classes who before could not afford it, take annual trips to the sea; visit their distant relations; make tours; and so we are benefited in body, feelings, and intellect. The more prompt transmission of letters and of news produces further changes—makes the pulse of the nation faster. Yet more, there arises a wide dissemination of cheap literature through railway book-stalls, and of advertisements in railway carriages: both of them aiding ulterior progress. And the innumerable changes here briefly indicated are consequent on the invention of the locomotive engine. The social organism has been rendered more heterogeneous, in virtue of the many new occupations introduced, and the many old ones further specialized; prices in all places have been altered; each trader has, more or less, modified his way of doing business; and every person has been affected in his actions, thoughts, emotions.
It's not possible to adequately follow all the complex developments here, the growing social diversity that comes from many effects stemming from one cause. But moving past the intermediate stages of social progress, let’s look at an example from its current state. Examining the effects of steam power in its many uses in mining, transportation, and manufacturing would lead us into overwhelming detail. So, let's focus on the latest development of steam power—the locomotive engine. As a direct cause of our railway system, it has transformed the landscape, trade routes, and people's lifestyles. First, consider the complicated series of changes that happen before each railway is constructed—the planning, meetings, approvals, trial sections, parliamentary reviews, printed plans, reference materials, local notices, applications to Parliament, and the various readings. Each of these points indicates a multitude of transactions and the further growth of various jobs (like engineers, surveyors, lithographers, parliamentary agents, share brokers) and the creation of new roles (like traffic controllers, reference clerks). Next, reflect on the even more significant changes involved in building railways—the excavations, embankments, tunnels, road diversions; the construction of bridges and stations; the laying of ballast, ties, and tracks; the manufacturing of engines, tenders, carriages, and freight cars. These processes impact numerous trades, boost the demand for timber, stone quarrying, iron production, coal mining, and brick making; create a variety of specialized products frequently advertised in the Railway Times; and introduce new categories of workers—drivers, stokers, cleaners, track layers, etc. Then there are the even more varied and interconnected changes that operational railways bring to society at large. The organization of every business is slightly altered: improved communication allows us to do things directly that were once done indirectly; agencies are created where they weren't previously viable; goods are sourced from distant wholesale suppliers instead of nearby retailers; and products that were once out of reach due to distance are now accessible. The speed and low cost of transportation encourage the specialization of industries across different regions—limiting each product to the locations where, due to local benefits, it can be best produced. Efficient distribution levels prices and generally lowers them, making various items affordable for those who couldn't purchase them before, thereby enhancing their comfort and improving their living conditions. At the same time, the frequency of travel has greatly increased. Groups that previously couldn't afford it now take yearly trips to the coast, visit distant relatives, go on tours, and so we benefit physically, emotionally, and intellectually. The quicker delivery of letters and news produces further changes—accelerating the heartbeat of the nation. Additionally, there’s a wide spread of affordable literature through railway book stalls and advertisements in train carriages, both contributing to further advancements. The countless changes briefly outlined here are all a result of the invention of the locomotive engine. The social structure has become more diverse due to the many new jobs created and the further specialization of existing ones; prices everywhere have shifted; each trader has somewhat adjusted their business practices; and everyone has been impacted in their actions, thoughts, and feelings.
The only further fact demanding notice, is, that we here see more clearly than ever, that in proportion as the area over which any influence extends, becomes heterogeneous, the results are in a yet higher degree multiplied in number and kind. While among the primitive tribes to whom it was first known, caoutchouc caused but few changes, among ourselves the changes have been so many and varied that the history of them occupies a volume. Upon the small, homogeneous community inhabiting one of the Hebrides, the electric telegraph would produce, were it used, scarcely any results; but in England the results it produces are multitudinous.
The only additional point worth noting is that we can see more clearly than ever that as the area influenced by anything becomes diverse, the outcomes are significantly increased in both number and variety. While in the early tribes where it was first discovered, rubber caused only a few changes, here the changes have been so numerous and diverse that their history takes up an entire volume. In a small, uniform community on one of the Hebrides, the electric telegraph would create hardly any results if it were used; but in England, the results it generates are countless.
Space permitting, the synthesis might here be pursued 413in relation to all the subtler products of social life. It might be shown how, in Science, an advance of one division presently advances other divisions—how Astronomy has been immensely forwarded by discoveries in Optics, while other optical discoveries have initiated Microscopic Anatomy, and greatly aided the growth of Physiology—how Chemistry has indirectly increased our knowledge of Electricity, Magnetism, Biology, Geology—how Electricity has reacted on Chemistry and Magnetism, developed our views of Light and Heat, and disclosed sundry laws of nervous action. In Literature the same truth might be exhibited in the still-multiplying forms of periodical publications that have descended from the first newspaper, and which have severally acted and reacted on other forms of literature and on each other; or in the bias given by each book of power to various subsequent books. The influence which a new school of Painting (as that of the pre-Raphaelites) exercises on other schools; the hints which all kinds of pictorial art are deriving from Photography; the complex results of new critical doctrines; might severally be dwelt on as displaying the like multiplication of effects. But it would needlessly tax the reader’s patience to detail, in their many ramifications, these various changes: here become so involved and subtle as to be followed with some difficulty.
If there's enough space, we could explore how this synthesis relates to all the more intricate aspects of social life. We could illustrate how advancements in one area of Science typically lead to progress in others—how developments in Astronomy have significantly benefited from breakthroughs in Optics, while other discoveries in optics have sparked progress in Microscopic Anatomy and greatly enhanced the understanding of Physiology. We could also show how Chemistry has indirectly enriched our understanding of Electricity, Magnetism, Biology, and Geology—how Electricity has influenced Chemistry and Magnetism, expanded our knowledge of Light and Heat, and revealed various laws of nervous function. In Literature, we can see the same principle reflected in the ever-growing range of periodical publications that have emerged from the very first newspaper, each of which has influenced and interacted with other forms of literature. Furthermore, the impact that powerful new books have on the creation of subsequent works can be highlighted. The effects that a new Painting movement (like the Pre-Raphaelites) has on other artistic schools, the ways different forms of visual art are inspired by Photography, and the complicated outcomes of new critical theories could all be explored as examples of this multiplying effect. However, it would be overly taxing for the reader to go into detail about these many interconnected changes, as they have become intricate and subtle enough to be somewhat challenging to follow.
§ 122. After the argument which closed the last chapter, a parallel one seems here scarcely required. For symmetry’s sake, however, it will be proper briefly to point out how the multiplication of effects, like the instability of the homogeneous, is a corollary from the persistence of force.
§ 122. After the discussion that wrapped up the last chapter, a similar one doesn’t really seem necessary here. Still, for the sake of balance, it makes sense to briefly highlight how the increase of effects, just like the instability of the same kind, is a consequence of the continuity of force.
Things which we call different are things which react in different ways; and we can know them as different only by the differences in their reactions. When we distinguish bodies as hard and soft, rough and smooth, we simply mean that certain like muscular forces expended on them are followed by unlike sets of sensations—unlike re-active forces. 414Objects that are classed as red, blue, yellow, &c., are objects that decompose light in strongly-contrasted ways; that is, we know contrasts of colour as contrasts in the changes produced in a uniform incident force. Manifestly, any two things which do not work unequal effects on consciousness, either by unequally opposing our own energies, or by impressing our senses with unequally modified forms of certain external energies, cannot be distinguished by us. Hence the proposition that the different parts of any whole must react differently on a uniform incident force, and must so reduce it to a group of multiform forces, is in essence a truism. A further step will reduce this truism to its lowest terms.
Things that we call different are things that respond in different ways; we can identify them as different only by observing how they react. When we describe objects as hard or soft, rough or smooth, we mean that similar forces applied to them result in different sensations—different reactive forces. 414Objects classified as red, blue, yellow, etc., are those that break down light in distinctly different ways; in other words, we perceive color contrasts as changes in a consistent incoming force. Clearly, any two things that do not produce different effects on our awareness, whether by opposing our energies unevenly or by affecting our senses with differently altered forms of certain external energies, cannot be recognized as distinct by us. Therefore, the idea that different parts of any whole must react in diverse ways to a consistent incoming force, thereby transforming it into a variety of forces, is basically a given. A further examination will simplify this idea to its most basic form.
When, from unlikeness between the effects they produce on consciousness, we predicate unlikeness between two objects, what is our warrant? and what do we mean by the unlikeness, objectively considered? Our warrant is the persistence of force. Some kind or amount of change has been wrought in us by the one, which has not been wrought by the other. This change we ascribe to some force exercised by the one which the other has not exercised. And we have no alternative but to do this, or to assert that the change had no antecedent; which is to deny the persistence of force. Whence it is further manifest that what we regard as the objective unlikeness is the presence in the one of some force, or set of forces, not present in the other—something in the kinds or amounts or directions of the constituent forces of the one, which those of the other do not parallel. But now if things or parts of things which we call different, are those of which the constituent forces differ in one or more respects; what must happen to any like forces, or any uniform force, falling on them? Such like forces, or parts of a uniform force, must be differently modified. The force which is present in the one and not in the other, must be an element in the conflict—must produce its equivalent reaction; and must so affect the total reaction. To say otherwise is to say that 415this differential force will produce no effect; which is to say that force is not persistent.
When we recognize differences in the effects that two objects have on our consciousness, what justifies that assessment? And what do we mean by that difference when we look at it objectively? Our justification lies in the persistence of force. One object brings about some kind of change in us that the other does not. We attribute this change to a force exerted by the first object that the second object has not exerted. We have no choice but to do this, or to claim that the change happened without any cause, which would mean denying the persistence of force. It then becomes clear that our perception of objective difference is simply the presence of some force, or group of forces, in one object that isn’t in the other—something about the type, amount, or direction of the forces in one that the other does not match. Now, if we define different things or parts of things as those with constituent forces that differ in one or more ways, what happens when similar forces, or a uniform force, act on them? Those similar forces, or parts of a uniform force, must be modified in different ways. The force present in one object but not in the other must contribute to the overall conflict—it must cause its own equivalent reaction and must influence the total reaction. To suggest otherwise implies that this differential force will have no effect, which would mean that force isn’t persistent.
I need not develop this corollary further. It manifestly follows that a uniform force, falling on a uniform aggregate, must undergo dispersion; that falling on an aggregate made up of unlike parts, it must undergo dispersion from each part, as well as qualitative differentiations; that in proportion as the parts are unlike, these qualitative differentiations must be marked; that in proportion to the number of the parts, they must be numerous; that the secondary forces so produced, must undergo further transformations while working equivalent transformations in the parts that change them; and similarly with the forces they generate. Thus the conclusions that a part-cause of Evolution is the multiplication of effects; and that this increases in geometrical progression as the heterogeneity becomes greater; are not only to be established inductively, but are deducible from the deepest of all truths.
I don't need to elaborate on this point any further. It's clear that a consistent force acting on a consistent mass will spread out; when it acts on a mass made up of different parts, it will spread out from each part and create qualitative differences. The more different the parts are, the more pronounced these qualitative differences will be. The greater the number of parts, the more numerous these differences will be. The secondary forces created will undergo further changes while causing equivalent changes in the parts that transform them; the same goes for the forces they generate. Therefore, it's evident that one of the driving forces of Evolution is the multiplication of effects, and that this occurs at an increasing rate as diversity rises. These conclusions can be established through observation and are also derived from fundamental truths.
17. Had this paragraph, first published in the Westminster Review in 1857, been written after the appearance of Mr. Darwin’s work on The Origin of Species, it would doubtless have been otherwise expressed. Reference would have been made to the process of “natural selection,” as greatly facilitating the differentiations described. As it is, however, I prefer to let the passage stand in its original shape: partly because it seems to me that these successive changes of conditions would produce divergent varieties or species, apart from the influence of “natural selection” (though in less numerous ways as well as less rapidly); and partly because I conceive that in the absence of these successive changes of conditions, “natural selection” would effect comparatively little. Let me add that though these positions are not enunciated in The Origin of Species, yet a mutual friend gives me reason to think that Mr. Darwin would coincide in them; if he did not indeed consider them as tacitly implied in his work.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.If this paragraph, first published in the Westminster Review in 1857, had been written after Mr. Darwin’s work on The Origin of Species came out, it would have been expressed differently. It would have mentioned the process of “natural selection” as a major factor in the differentiations described. However, I prefer to keep the passage in its original form: partly because I believe that these successive changes in conditions would lead to different varieties or species, even without the influence of “natural selection” (although in fewer ways and at a slower pace); and partly because I think that without these successive changes in conditions, “natural selection” would have a relatively minor effect. I should add that while these positions aren’t explicitly stated in The Origin of Species, a mutual friend suggests that Mr. Darwin would agree with them, if he didn’t view them as implied in his work.
CHAPTER XV.
Differentiation and Integration.
§ 123. The general interpretation of Evolution is far from being completed in the preceding chapters. We must contemplate its changes under yet another aspect, before we can form a definite conception of the process constituted by them. Though the laws already set forth, furnish a key to the re-arrangement of parts which Evolution exhibits, in so far as it is an advance from the uniform to the multiform; they furnish no key to this re-arrangement in so far as it is an advance from the indefinite to the definite. On studying the actions and re-actions everywhere going on, we have found it to follow inevitably from a certain primordial truth, that the homogeneous must lapse into the heterogeneous, and that the heterogeneous must become more heterogeneous; but we have not discovered why the differently-affected parts of any simple whole, become clearly marked off from each other, at the same time that they become unlike. Thus far no reason has been assigned why there should not ordinarily arise a vague chaotic heterogeneity, in place of that orderly heterogeneity displayed in Evolution. It still remains to find out the cause of that integration of parts which accompanies their differentiation—that gradually-completed segregation of like units into a group, distinctly separated from neighbouring groups which are severally made up of other kinds of units. The rationale will be conveniently introduced by a 417few instances in which we may watch this segregative process taking place.
§ 123. The overall understanding of Evolution is still incomplete from the previous chapters. We need to look at its changes from another perspective before we can form a clear idea of the process involved. While the laws we've discussed provide insight into how parts of Evolution are rearranged as it transitions from the uniform to the diverse, they don’t explain how this rearrangement happens as it moves from the vague to the specific. In observing the various actions and reactions, we've found that it follows an undeniable truth: the uniform must break into the diverse, and the diverse must become even more diverse. However, we haven't figured out why the different affected parts of a simple whole become clearly defined from each other while they also become different. So far, no explanation has been given for why there isn't typically a vague chaotic diversity instead of the organized diversity we see in Evolution. We still need to uncover what causes the integration of parts that comes with their differentiation—this gradual separation of similar units into a group that is distinctly set apart from neighboring groups made up of different types of units. We can introduce the reasoning behind this with a few examples where we can observe this segregation process happening.
When towards the end of September, the trees are gaining their autumn colours, and we are hoping shortly to see a further change increasing still more the beauty of the landscape, we are not uncommonly disappointed by the occurrence of an equinoxial gale. Out of the mixed mass of foliage on each branch, the strong current of air carries away the decaying and brightly-tinted leaves, but fails to detach those which are still green. And while these last, frayed and seared by long-continued beatings against each other, and the twigs around them, give a sombre colour to the woods, the red and yellow and orange leaves are collected together in ditches and behind walls and in corners where eddies allow them to settle. That is to say, by the action of that uniform force which the wind exerts on both kinds, the dying leaves are picked out from among their still living companions and gathered in places by themselves. Again, the separation of particles of different sizes, as dust and sand from pebbles, may be similarly effected; as we see on every road in March. And from the days of Homer downwards, the power of currents of air, natural and artificial, to part from one another units of unlike specific gravities, has been habitually utilized in the winnowing of chaff from wheat. In every river we see how the mixed materials carried down, are separately deposited—how in rapids the bottom gives rest to nothing but boulders and pebbles; how where the current is not so strong, sand is let fall; and how, in still places, there is a sediment of mud. This selective action of moving water, is commonly applied in the arts to obtain masses of particles of different degrees of fineness. Emery, for example, after being ground, is carried by a slow current through successive compartments; in the first of which the largest grains subside; in the second of which the grains that reach the bottom before the water has escaped, are somewhat smaller; in the third smaller still; 418until in the last there are deposited only those finest particles which fall so slowly through the water, that they have not previously been able to reach the bottom. And in a way that is different though equally significant, this segregative effect of water in motion, is exemplified in the carrying away of soluble from insoluble matters—an application of it hourly made in every laboratory. The effects of the uniform forces which aerial and aqueous currents exercise, are paralleled by those of uniform forces of other orders. Electric attraction will separate small bodies from large, or light bodies from heavy. By magnetism, grains of iron may be selected from among other grains; as by the Sheffield grinder, whose magnetized gauze mask filters out the steel-dust which his wheel gives off, from the stone-dust that accompanies it. And how the affinity of any agent acting differently on the components of a given body, enables us to take away some component and leave the rest behind, is shown in almost every chemical experiment.
When late September rolls around and the trees are changing into their autumn colors, we often look forward to witnessing a further transformation that enhances the beauty of the landscape. However, we're frequently disappointed by the arrival of an equinoxial storm. The strong winds whip through the mixed foliage on each branch, sweeping away the decaying, vividly colored leaves but leaving the still green ones intact. While these remaining leaves, worn and damaged from long-lasting collisions with each other and the surrounding twigs, give the woods a gloomy tone, the red, yellow, and orange leaves are collected into ditches, behind walls, and in corners where the wind allows them to settle. In other words, the wind’s uniform force picks out the dying leaves among their living counterparts and gathers them in separate spots. Similarly, it’s like how particles of different sizes can be separated—like dust and sand from pebbles—as we see on every road in March. Since the days of Homer, the ability of air currents, both natural and artificial, to separate materials of differing specific gravities has been regularly used for winnowing chaff from wheat. In every river, we observe how mixed materials are deposited separately—how in rapids, only boulders and pebbles rest on the bottom; how where the current is milder, sand settles down; and how, in still waters, mud accumulates. This selective action of moving water is commonly applied in various trades to isolate particles of different sizes. For example, emery is ground and then transported by a gentle current through several compartments, where in the first, the largest grains sink; in the second, the grains that reach the bottom before the water has flowed out are slightly smaller; in the third, they are even smaller; 418 until the last compartment, where only the finest particles remain that fall so slowly through the water they haven’t had a chance to reach the bottom yet. In a different but equally notable way, the action of moving water is illustrated in how it can separate soluble materials from insoluble ones—something done every hour in every laboratory. The impacts of uniform forces from air and water currents are similar to those from other types of uniform forces. Electric attraction can distinguish smaller bodies from larger ones or lighter ones from heavier ones. Magnetism can extract grains of iron from other particles, as seen with the Sheffield grinder, whose magnetized gauze filter catches the steel dust produced by the wheel while allowing the stone dust to pass through. Additionally, the way an agent interacts differently with the parts of a single substance allows us to remove certain components while leaving others intact, which is evident in almost every chemical experiment.
What now is the general truth here variously presented? How are these several facts and countless similar ones, to be expressed in terms that embrace them all? In each case we see in action a force which may be regarded as simple or uniform—fluid motion in a certain direction at a certain velocity; electric or magnetic attraction of a given amount; chemical affinity of a particular kind: or rather, in strictness, the acting force is compounded of one of these and certain other uniform forces, as gravitation, etc. In each case we have an aggregate made up of unlike units—either atoms of different substances combined or intimately mingled, or fragments of the same substance of different sizes, or other constituent parts that are unlike in their specific gravities, shapes, or other attributes. And in each case these unlike units, or groups of units, of which the aggregate consists, are, under the influence of some resultant force acting indiscriminately on them all, separated from each other—segregated into minor aggregates, each consisting of units that are 419severally like each other and unlike those of the other minor aggregates. Such being the common aspect of these changes, let us look for the common interpretation of them.
What’s the general truth being presented here in different ways? How can we express these various facts and countless similar ones in terms that cover them all? In each situation, we see a force that can be viewed as simple or uniform—like fluid motion in a specific direction at a certain speed, electric or magnetic attraction of a specific magnitude, or a certain type of chemical affinity. More accurately, the acting force is a combination of one of these and other uniform forces, such as gravity, etc. Each time, we have a collection made up of different units—either atoms of various substances that are mixed together or pieces of the same substance in different sizes, or other different components that vary in specific gravity, shape, or other characteristics. In each case, these different units, or groups of units, which make up the collection, are separated from one another under the influence of some overall force acting randomly on them all—segregated into smaller collections, each consisting of units that are alike within themselves but different from those in the other smaller collections. Given this common appearance of these changes, let’s seek a common interpretation of them.
In the chapter on “The Instability of the Homogeneous,” it was shown that a uniform force falling on any aggregate, produces unlike modifications in its different parts—turns the uniform into the multiform and the multiform into the more multiform. The transformation thus wrought, consists of either insensible or sensible changes of relative position among the units, or of both—either of those molecular re-arrangements which we call chemical, or of those larger transpositions which are distinguished as mechanical, or of the two united. Such portion of the permanently effective force as reaches each different part, or differently-conditioned part, may be expended in modifying the mutual relations of its constituents; or it may be expended in moving the part to another place; or it may be expended partially in the first and partially in the second. Hence, so much of the permanently effective force as does not work the one kind of effect, must work the other kind. It is manifest that if of the permanently effective force which falls on some compound unit of an aggregate, little, if any, is absorbed in re-arranging the ultimate components of such compound unit, much or the whole, must show itself in motion of such compound unit to some other place in the aggregate; and conversely, if little or none of this force is absorbed in generating mechanical transposition, much or the whole must go to produce molecular alterations. What now must follow from this? In cases where none or only part of the force generates chemical re-distributions, what physical re-distributions must be generated? Parts that are similar to each other will be similarly acted on by the force; and will similarly react on it. Parts that are dissimilar will be dissimilarly acted on by the force; and will dissimilarly react on it. Hence the permanently effective incident force, when wholly or partially transformed into mechanical motion 420of the units, will produce like motions in units that are alike, and unlike motions in units that are unlike. If then, in an aggregate containing two or more orders of mixed units, those of the same order will be moved in the same way, and in a way that differs from that in which units of other orders are moved, the respective orders must segregate. A group of like things on which are impressed motions that are alike in amount and direction, must be transferred as a group to another place, and if they are mingled with some group of other things, on which the motions impressed are like each other, but unlike those of the first group in amount or direction or both, these other things must be transferred as a group to some other place—the mixed aggregate must undergo a simultaneous differentiation and integration.
In the chapter on “The Instability of the Homogeneous,” it was demonstrated that a uniform force applied to any collection leads to different changes in its various parts—transforming the uniform into the diverse and the diverse into even more diverse. This transformation consists of either subtle or noticeable changes in the relative positions of the components, or both—either those molecular rearrangements we call chemical, or the larger shifts identified as mechanical, or a combination of the two. The portion of the ongoing effective force that reaches each different part, or part with different conditions, may be used to alter the relationships among its constituents; or it might be used to move that part to another location; or it could be spent partly on the first and partly on the second. Therefore, any part of the effective force that doesn’t produce one type of effect must contribute to the other type. It’s clear that if little to none of the effective force impacting a complex unit of an aggregate is used to rearrange the basic components of that unit, then a significant amount, or all of it, must manifest as movement of that unit to another place in the aggregate; conversely, if little or none of this force is used to create mechanical movement, then a significant amount, or all of it, must be directed towards molecular changes. What follows from this? In situations where none or only some of the force creates chemical redistributions, what physical redistributions must occur? Similar parts will be equally affected by the force and will respond similarly. Dissimilar parts will be affected differently by the force and will react in different ways. Thus, the effective force, when entirely or partially converted into mechanical motion of the units, will create similar motions in like units and different motions in unlike units. Therefore, in an aggregate containing two or more orders of mixed units, those of the same order will be moved similarly and in a way that differs from how units of other orders are moved, leading to the segregation of respective orders. A group of similar items, upon which similar motions are imposed in terms of both magnitude and direction, must be collectively moved to another location, and if they are mixed with another group of different items, with similar motions among themselves but differing from the first group in terms of magnitude or direction or both, then these other items must also be collectively moved to another place—the mixed aggregate must undergo simultaneous differentiation and integration.
In further elucidation of this process, it will be well here to set down a few instances in which we may see that, other things equal, the definiteness of the separation is in proportion to the definiteness of the difference between the units. Take a handful of any pounded substance, containing fragments of all sizes; and let it fall to the ground while a gentle breeze is blowing. The large fragments will be collected together on the ground almost immediately under the hand; somewhat smaller fragments will be carried a little to the leeward; still smaller ones a little further; and those minute particles which we call dust, will be drifted a long way before they reach the earth: that is, the integration is indefinite where the difference among the fragments is indefinite, though the divergence is greatest where the difference is greatest. If, again, the handful be made up of quite distinct orders of units—as pebbles, coarse sand, and dust—these will, under like conditions, be segregated with comparative definiteness: the pebbles will drop almost vertically; the sand will fall in an inclined direction, and deposit itself within a tolerably circumscribed space beyond the pebbles; while the dust will be blown almost horizontally to a great distance. A case in which another kind of force 421comes into play, will still better illustrate this truth. Through a mixed aggregate of soluble and insoluble substances, let water slowly percolate. There will in the first place be a distinct parting of the substances that are the most widely contrasted in their relations to the acting forces: the soluble will be carried away; the insoluble will remain behind. Further, some separation, though a less definite one, will be effected among the soluble substances; since the first part of the current will remove the most soluble substances in the largest amounts, and after these have been all dissolved, the current will still continue to bring out the remaining less soluble substances. Even the undissolved matters will have simultaneously undergone a certain segregation; for the percolating fluid will carry down the minute fragments from among the large ones, and will deposit those of small specific gravity in one place, and those of great specific gravity in another. To complete the elucidation we must glance at the obverse fact; namely, that mixed units which differ but slightly, are moved in but slightly-different ways by incident forces, and can therefore be separated only by such adjustments of the incident forces as allow slight differences to become appreciable factors in the result. This truth is made manifest by antithesis in the instances just given; but it may be made much more manifest by a few such instances as those which chemical analysis supplies in abundance. The parting of alcohol from water by distillation is a good one. Here we have atoms consisting of oxygen and hydrogen, mingled with atoms consisting of oxygen, hydrogen, and carbon. The two orders of atoms have a considerable similarity of nature: they similarly maintain a fluid form at ordinary temperatures; they similarly become gaseous more and more rapidly as the temperature is raised; and they boil at points not very far apart. Now this comparative likeness of the atoms is accompanied by difficulty in segregating them. If the mixed fluid is unduly heated, much water distils over with the alcohol: it is only within a narrow range 422of temperature, that the one set of atoms are driven off rather than the others; and even then not a few of the others accompany them. The most interesting and instructive example, however, is furnished by certain phenomena of crystallization. When several salts that have little analogy of constitution, are dissolved in the same body of water, they are separated without much trouble, by crystallization: their respective units moved towards each other, as physicists suppose, by polar forces, segregate into crystals of their respective kinds. The crystals of each salt do, indeed, usually contain certain small amounts of the other salts present in the solution—especially when the crystallization has been rapid; but from these other salts they are severally freed by repeated resolutions and crystallizations. Mark now, however, that the reverse is the case when the salts contained in the same body of water are chemically homologous. The nitrates of baryta and lead, or the sulphates of zinc, soda, and magnesia, unite in the same crystals; nor will they crystallize separately if these crystals be dissolved afresh, and afresh crystallized, even with great care. On seeking the cause of this anomaly, chemists found that such salts were isomorphous—that their atoms, though not chemically identical, were identical in the proportions of acid, base, and water, composing them, and in their crystalline forms: whence it was inferred that their atoms are nearly alike in structure. Thus is clearly illustrated the truth, that units of unlike kinds are differentiated and integrated with a readiness proportionate to the degree of their unlikeness. In the first case we see that being dissimilar in their forms, but similar in so far as they are soluble in water of a certain temperature, the atoms segregate, though imperfectly. In the second case we see that the atoms, having not only the likeness implied by solubility in the same menstruum, but also a great likeness of structure, do not segregate—are differentiated and integrated only under quite special conditions, and then very incompletely. That is, the incident force of mutual polarity impresses unlike 423motions on the mixed units in proportion as they are unlike; and therefore, in proportion as they are unlike, tends to deposit them in separate places.
In further explaining this process, it’s helpful to outline a few examples that show that, all else being equal, the clarity of separation corresponds to how distinct the differences are between the units. Take a handful of any crushed substance with fragments of all sizes and let it fall to the ground while a gentle breeze is blowing. The larger fragments will gather immediately under your hand; somewhat smaller pieces will be blown a little downwind; even smaller ones will be carried a bit further; and those tiny particles we call dust will be blown far away before they hit the ground. This means that the integration is vague where the differences among the fragments are vague, even though the separation is most pronounced where the differences are greatest. If, however, the handful contains clearly distinct types of units—like pebbles, coarse sand, and dust—these will be sorted out with relative clarity under similar conditions: the pebbles will drop almost straight down; the sand will fall at an angle and settle in a reasonably defined area beyond the pebbles; while the dust will be blown almost horizontally over a great distance. Another situation can illustrate this point even better: if you let water slowly seep through a mixture of soluble and insoluble substances, you will first see a clear separation of the substances that are most different in their responses to the acting forces: the soluble ones will be carried away while the insoluble ones will stay put. Moreover, there will be some separation, although less distinct, among the soluble substances; the initial part of the flow will remove the most soluble substances in greater quantities, and after those are dissolved, the flow will continue to carry out the remaining less soluble substances. Even the undissolved materials will experience some segregation because the flowing liquid will carry down the smaller fragments among the larger ones, depositing lighter particles in one spot and heavier particles in another. To complete this explanation, we must consider the opposite fact: mixed units that differ only slightly are moved in only slightly different ways by external forces, and can therefore be separated only by adjustments of these forces that make minor differences noticeable in the result. This truth is illustrated by contrasting the previous examples, but it is made much clearer by looking at a few instances provided abundantly by chemical analysis. For example, separating alcohol from water through distillation is one. In this case, we have atoms made of oxygen and hydrogen mixed with atoms that include oxygen, hydrogen, and carbon. The two types of atoms are quite similar: they both maintain a liquid state at normal temperatures, they both become gaseous at increasing rates as the temperature rises, and they boil at temperatures that are not far apart. This similarity among the atoms makes them difficult to separate. If the mixed liquid is heated too much, a lot of water distills along with the alcohol; it’s only within a narrow temperature range that one set of atoms can be driven off more than the others, and even then, some of the other atoms will still come along with them. However, the most interesting and informative example comes from certain crystallization phenomena. When several salts with little structural similarity are dissolved in the same water, they separate quite easily during crystallization: their respective units, as physicists believe, are drawn towards each other by polar forces, forming crystals of their own kinds. Each salt’s crystals usually contain some trace amounts of the other salts from the solution—especially if the crystallization was rapid—but these impurities can be removed through repeated dissolving and crystallizing. Now, however, note that it’s the opposite with salts that are chemically similar. The nitrates of barium and lead, or the sulfates of zinc, soda, and magnesium, combine in the same crystals and will not crystallize separately even with repeated dissolving and crystallizing, no matter how careful you are. When chemists looked into why this happens, they discovered that these salts were isomorphic—meaning their atoms, while not chemically identical, were identical in the proportions of acid, base, and water that make them up, as well as in their crystalline forms. It was concluded that their atoms are very similar in structure. Thus, it clearly shows that units of different types are differentiated and integrated more easily the more they differ from each other. In the first case, we see that the atoms, while different in form, are similar enough in being soluble in a certain temperature of water that they segregate, though imperfectly. In the second case, we see that the atoms, not only sharing the similarity of solubility in the same solvent but also having a very similar structure, do not segregate—differentiating and integrating only under very specific conditions, and then very incompletely. In other words, the force of mutual polarity creates different motions in mixed units in proportion to how distinct they are, and thus, the more they differ, the more likely they are to settle in separate locations.
There is a converse cause of segregation, which it is needless here to treat of with equal fulness. If different units acted on by the same force, must be differently moved; so, too, must units of the same kind be differently moved by different forces. Supposing some group of units forming part of a homogeneous aggregate, are unitedly exposed to a force that is unlike in amount or direction to the force acting on the rest of the aggregate; then this group of units will separate from the rest, provided that, of the force so acting on it, there remains any portion not dissipated in molecular vibrations, nor absorbed in producing molecular re-arrangements. After all that has been said above, this proposition needs no defence.
There is an opposing cause of segregation that doesn't need to be discussed in detail here. If different units affected by the same force must move differently, then units of the same kind must also move differently when acted upon by different forces. If a group of units that are part of a uniform whole is subjected to a force that differs in strength or direction from the force acting on the rest of the whole, this group of units will separate from the rest, as long as some portion of the force acting on it isn’t lost to molecular vibrations or absorbed in creating molecular rearrangements. After everything mentioned above, this statement doesn’t need any further justification.
Before ending our preliminary exposition, a complementary truth must be specified; namely, that mixed forces are segregated by the reaction of uniform matters, just as mixed matters are segregated by the action of uniform forces. Of this truth a complete and sufficient illustration is furnished by the dispersion of refracted light. A beam of light, made up of ethereal undulations of different orders, is not uniformly deflected by a homogeneous refracting body; but the different orders of undulations it contains, are deflected at different angles: the result being that these different orders of undulations are separated and integrated, and so produce what we know as the colours of the spectrum. A segregation of another kind occurs when rays of light traverse an obstructing medium. Those rays which consist of comparatively short undulations, are absorbed before those which consist of comparatively long ones; and the red rays, which consist of the longest undulations, alone penetrate when the obstruction is very great. How, conversely, there is produced a separation of like forces by the reaction of unlike matters, is also made manifest by the phenomena of 424refraction: since adjacent and parallel beams of light, falling on, and passing through, unlike substances, are made to diverge.
Before we wrap up our initial discussion, we need to highlight an additional point: mixed forces are separated by the reaction of uniform substances, just as mixed substances are separated by the action of uniform forces. A clear and sufficient example of this is seen in the dispersion of refracted light. A beam of light, which consists of ethereal waves of different frequencies, is not deflected uniformly by a uniform refracting material; instead, the different frequencies within it are bent at different angles. As a result, these varying frequencies are separated and combined, leading to what we recognize as the colors of the spectrum. Another type of separation occurs when light rays pass through a blocking medium. Rays with relatively short wavelengths are absorbed before those with longer wavelengths; ultimately, the red rays, which have the longest wavelengths, are the only ones that penetrate through a significant obstruction. Conversely, the separation of similar forces due to the reaction of dissimilar substances is also evident in refraction: adjacent and parallel light beams, when striking and passing through different materials, are caused to spread apart.
§ 124. On the assumption of their nebular origin, stars and planets exemplify that cause of material integration last assigned—the action of unlike forces on like units.
§ 124. Assuming they originated from nebulae, stars and planets show that the cause of material integration most recently identified is the influence of different forces on similar units.
In a preceding chapter (§ 110) we saw that if matter ever existed in a diffused form, it could not continue uniformly distributed, but must break up into masses. It was shown that in the absence of a perfect balance of mutual attractions among atoms dispersed through unlimited space, there must arise breeches of continuity throughout the aggregate formed by them, and a concentration of it towards centres of dominant attraction. Where any such breech of continuity occurs, and the atoms that were before adjacent separate from each other; they do so in consequence of a difference in the forces to which they are respectively subject. The atoms on the one side of the breech are exposed to a certain surplus attraction in the direction in which they begin to move; and those on the other to a surplus attraction in the opposite direction. That is, the adjacent groups of like units are exposed to unlike resultant forces; and accordingly separate and integrate.
In the previous chapter (§ 110), we observed that if matter ever existed in a dispersed state, it couldn't stay evenly spread out and would eventually break into chunks. It was demonstrated that without a perfect balance of attraction between atoms scattered across infinite space, there would be interruptions in continuity within the mass they create, and it would naturally clump together around points of stronger attraction. Whenever such an interruption happens, and atoms that were previously next to each other start to separate, it’s because they are influenced by different forces. The atoms on one side of the interruption experience a greater attraction in the direction they’re moving, while those on the other side feel a greater attraction pulling them in the opposite direction. In other words, the neighboring groups of similar units are subjected to different resultant forces, leading them to separate and come together.
The formation and detachment of a nebulous ring, illustrates the same general principle. To conclude, as Laplace did, that the equatorial portion of a rotating nebulous spheroid, will, during concentration, acquire a centrifugal force sufficient to prevent it from following the rest of the contracting mass, is to conclude that such portions will remain behind as are in common subject to a certain differential force. The line of division between the ring and the spheroid, must be a line inside of which the aggregative force is greater than the force resisting aggregation; and outside of which the force resisting aggregation is greater than the aggregative force. Hence the alleged process 425conforms to the law that among like units, separation and integration is produced by the action of unlike forces.
The creation and separation of a hazy ring demonstrates the same basic principle. To conclude, as Laplace did, that the equatorial part of a spinning nebulous spheroid will, during its tightening phase, gain a centrifugal force strong enough to keep it from following the rest of the shrinking mass is to say that those parts will fall behind due to being affected by a specific differential force. The boundary between the ring and the spheroid must be a point where the force attracting things together is stronger than the force resisting this attraction; and outside of which the force resisting aggregation is stronger than the force bringing things together. Therefore, the described process complies with the law that separation and integration among similar units are driven by the influence of different forces. 425
Astronomical phenomena do not furnish any other than these hypothetical examples. In its present comparatively settled condition, the Solar System exhibits no direct evidence of progressing integration: unless indeed under the insignificant form of the union of meteoric masses with the Earth, and, occasionally perhaps, of cometary matter with the Sun.
Astronomical phenomena only provide these hypothetical examples. In its currently stable state, the Solar System shows no direct evidence of ongoing integration, except for the minor instances of meteoric masses merging with the Earth and, occasionally, maybe, cometary material coming together with the Sun.
§ 125. Those geologic changes usually classed as aqueous, display under numerous forms the segregation of unlike units by a uniform incident force. On sea-shores, the waves are ever sorting-out and separating the mixed materials against which they break. From each mass of fallen cliff, the rising and ebbing tide carries away all those particles which are so small as to remain long suspended in the water; and, at some distance from shore, deposits them in the shape of fine sediment. Large particles, sinking with comparative rapidity, are accumulated into beds of sand near low water-mark. The coarse grit and small pebbles collect together on the incline up which the breakers rush. And on the top lie the larger stones and boulders. Still more specific segregations may occasionally be observed. Flat pebbles, produced by the breaking down of laminated rock, are sometimes separately collected in one part of a shingle bank. On this shore the deposit is wholly of mud; on that it is wholly of sand. Here we find a sheltered cove filled with small pebbles almost of one size; and there, in a curved bay one end of which is more exposed than the other, we see a progressive increase in the massiveness of the stones as we walk from the less exposed to the more exposed end. Indeed, our sedimentary strata form one vast series of illustrations of the alleged law. Trace the history of each deposit, and we are quickly led down to the fact, that mixed fragments of matter, differing in their sizes or weights, are, 426when exposed to the momentum and friction of water, joined with the attraction of the Earth, selected from each other, and united into groups of comparatively like fragments. We see that, other things equal, the separation is definite in proportion as the differences of the units are marked; and that, under the action of the same aggregate of forces, the most widely unlike units are most widely removed from each other.
§ 125. The geological changes often categorized as aquatic show various forms of separation of different units through a consistent force. At the shore, waves constantly sort and mix the materials they crash against. From every chunk of fallen cliff, the rising and falling tide takes away particles small enough to stay suspended in the water for a long time and deposits them as fine sediment farther out. Larger particles sink more quickly and gather into beds of sand near the low tide mark. Coarse grit and small pebbles collect on the slope where the waves rush up. And above them lie the larger stones and boulders. More specific separations can sometimes be observed. Flat pebbles created from crumbling layered rock can collect in one area of a shingle bank. On this shore, the deposit is made entirely of mud; on that one, it's all sand. Here, we find a sheltered cove filled with small pebbles of nearly the same size; there, in a curved bay where one end is more exposed, we notice a gradual increase in the size of the stones as we walk from the less exposed end to the more exposed end. In fact, our sedimentary layers provide a vast array of examples of this principle. By tracing the history of each deposit, we quickly realize that mixed fragments of matter, differing in size or weight, are, 426 when subjected to water's momentum and friction, alongside Earth's gravitational pull, sorted apart and grouped into clusters of similar fragments. We see that, all else being equal, the separation is clearer when the differences among the units are pronounced; and that, under the influence of the same combined forces, the most dissimilar units are the most distanced from each other.
Among igneous changes we do not find so many examples of the process described. When specifying the conditions to Evolution, it was pointed out (§ 104) that molecular vibration exceeding a certain intensity, does not permit those integrations which result from the action of minor differential forces. Nevertheless, geological phenomena of this order are not barren of illustrations. Where the mixed matters composing the Earth’s crust have been raised to a very high temperature, segregation habitually takes place as the temperature diminishes. Sundry of the substances that escape in a gaseous form from volcanoes, sublime into crystals on coming against cool surfaces; and solidifying, as these substances do, at different temperatures, they are deposited at different parts of the crevices through which they are emitted together. The best illustration, however, is furnished by the changes that occur during the slow cooling of igneous rock. When, through one of the fractures from time to time made in the solid shell which forms the Earth’s crust, a portion of the molten nucleus is extruded; and when this is cooled with comparative rapidity, through free radiation and contact with cold masses; it forms a substance known as trap or basalt—a substance that is uniform in texture, though made up of various ingredients. But when, not escaping through the superficial strata, such a portion of the molten nucleus is slowly cooled, it becomes what we know as granite: the mingled particles of quartz, feldspar, and mica, being kept for a long time in a fluid and semi-fluid state—a state of comparative mobility—undergo those 427changes of position which the forces impressed on them by their fellow units necessitate. Having time in which to generate the requisite motions of the atoms, the differential forces arising from mutual polarity, segregate the quartz, feldspar, and mica, into crystals. How completely this is dependent on the long-continued agitation of the mixed particles, and consequent long-continued mobility by small differential forces, is proved by the fact that in granite dykes, the crystals in the centre of the mass, where the fluidity or semi-fluidity continued for a longer time, are much larger than those at the sides, where contact with the neighbouring rock caused more rapid cooling and solidification.
Among igneous changes, we don't see as many examples of the process described. When discussing the conditions for Evolution, it was noted (§ 104) that molecular vibration beyond a certain intensity prevents the integrations resulting from the influence of smaller differential forces. Still, geological phenomena of this type do have some examples. When the mixed materials in the Earth’s crust are heated to very high temperatures, segregation often occurs as the temperature drops. Various substances that are released as gases from volcanoes crystallize when they come into contact with cooler surfaces; and as these substances solidify at different temperatures, they get deposited in various parts of the cracks through which they are released. However, the best example comes from the changes that happen during the slow cooling of igneous rock. When a portion of the molten core is pushed through one of the cracks that occasionally form in the solid shell of the Earth's crust, and when this portion cools relatively quickly due to free radiation and contact with cold materials, it creates a substance known as trap or basalt — a substance that's uniform in texture, though made up of various components. But when a portion of the molten core cools slowly without escaping through the surface layers, it becomes what we know as granite: the mixed particles of quartz, feldspar, and mica are kept in a fluid and semi-fluid state for a long time—allowing for relative mobility—enabling them to undergo positional changes due to the forces exerted by their neighboring units. Given enough time to generate the necessary atomic movements, the differential forces from mutual polarity segregate the quartz, feldspar, and mica into crystals. The extent to which this process relies on the prolonged agitation of the mixed particles and the continued mobility caused by small differential forces is evident from the fact that in granite dykes, the crystals in the center of the mass, where the fluidity or semi-fluidity lasted longer, are significantly larger than those at the edges, where contact with surrounding rock led to quicker cooling and solidification.
§ 126. The actions going on throughout an organism are so involved and subtle, that we cannot expect to identify the particular forces by which particular integrations are effected. Among the few instances admitting of tolerably definite interpretation, the best are those in which mechanical pressures and tensions are the agencies at work. We shall discover several on studying the bony frame of the higher animals.
§ 126. The processes happening within an organism are so complex and delicate that we can't expect to identify the specific forces responsible for different integrations. Among the few examples that can be clearly understood, the best ones involve mechanical pressures and tensions as the active agents. We'll find several of these when we study the skeletal structure of higher animals.
The vertebral column of a man, is subject, as a whole, to certain general strains—the weight of the body, together with the reactions involved by all considerable muscular efforts; and in conformity with this, it has a certain general integration. At the same time, being exposed to different forces in the course of those lateral bendings which the movements necessitate, its parts retain a certain separateness. And if we trace up the development of the vertebral column from its primitive form of a cartilaginous cord in the lowest fishes, we see that, throughout, it maintains an integration corresponding to the unity of the incident forces, joined with a division into segments corresponding to the variety of the incident forces. Each segment, considered apart, exemplifies the truth more simply. A vertebra is not a single bone, but consists of a central mass with sundry appendages or processes; and in rudimentary types of vertebræ, 428those appendages are quite separate from the central mass, and, indeed, exist before it makes its appearance. But these several independent bones, constituting a primitive spinal segment, are subject to a certain aggregate of forces which agree more than they differ: as the fulcrum to a group of muscles habitually acting together, they perpetually undergo certain reactions in common. And accordingly, we see that in the course of development they gradually coalesce. Still clearer is the illustration furnished by spinal segments that become fused together where they are together exposed to some predominant strain. The sacrum consists of a group of vertebræ firmly united. In the ostrich and its congeners there are from seventeen to twenty sacral vertebræ; and besides being confluent with each other, these are confluent with the iliac bones, which run on each side of them. If now we assume these vertebræ to have been originally separate, as they still are in the embryo bird; and if we consider the mechanical conditions to which they must in such case have been exposed; we shall see that their union results in the alleged way. For through these vertebræ the entire weight of the body is transferred to the legs: the legs support the pelvic arch; the pelvic arch supports the sacrum; and to the sacrum is articulated the rest of the spine, with all the limbs and organs attached to it. Hence, if separate, the sacral vertebræ must be held firmly together by strongly-contracted muscles; and must, by implication, be prevented from partaking in those lateral movements which the other vertebræ undergo—they must be subject to a common strain, while they are preserved from strains which would affect them differently; and so they fulfil the conditions under which integration occurs. But the cases in which cause and effect are brought into the most obvious relation, are supplied by the limbs. The metacarpal bones (those which in man support the palm of the hand) are separate from each other in the majority of mammalia: the separate actions of the toes entailing on them slight amounts of 429separate movements. This is not so however in the ox-tribe and the horse-tribe. In the ox-tribe, only the middle metacarpals (third and fourth) are developed; and these, attaining massive proportions, coalesce to form the cannon bone. In the horse-tribe, the integration is what we may distinguish as indirect: the second and fourth metacarpals are present only as rudiments united to the sides of the third, while the third is immensely developed; thus forming a cannon bone which differs from that of the ox in being a single cylinder, instead of two cylinders fused together. The metatarsus in these quadrupeds exhibits parallel changes. Now each of these metamorphoses occurs where the different bones grouped together have no longer any different functions, but retain only a common function. The feet of oxen and horses are used solely for locomotion—are not put like those of unguiculate mammals to purposes which involve some relative movements of the metacarpals. Thus there directly or indirectly results a single mass of bone where the incident force is single. And for the inference that these facts have a causal connexion, we find confirmation throughout the entire class of birds; in the wings and legs of which, like integrations are found under like conditions. While this sheet is passing through the press, a fact illustrating this general truth in a yet more remarkable manner, has been mentioned to me by Prof. Huxley; who kindly allows me to make use of it while still unpublished by him. The Glyptodon, an extinct mammal found fossilized in South America, has long been known as a large uncouth creature allied to the Armadillo, but having a massive dermal armour consisting of polygonal plates closely fitted together so as to make a vast box, inclosing the body in such way as effectually to prevent it from being bent, laterally or vertically, in the slightest degree. This bony box, which must have weighed several hundred-weight, was supported on the spinous processes of the vertebræ, and on the adjacent bones of the pelvic and thoracic arches. And 430the significant fact now to be noted, is, that here, where the trunk vertebræ were together exposed to the pressure of this heavy dermal armour, at the same time that, by its rigidity, they were preserved from all relative movements, the entire series of them were united into one solid, continuous bone.
The spinal column of a man is, overall, subject to certain general stresses—like the body’s weight and the reactions involved in significant muscle use; because of this, it has a general integration. At the same time, due to various forces during the lateral bends the movements require, its parts maintain a degree of separateness. If we trace the development of the spinal column from its primitive state as a cartilage cord in the simplest fish, we see that it consistently retains an integration that aligns with the unity of the forces acting on it, paired with a segmentation that corresponds to the diversity of those forces. Each segment, when considered individually, illustrates this concept more simply. A vertebra isn’t just one bone; it’s made up of a central mass with various appendages or processes. In primitive types of vertebrae, those appendages are quite separate from the central mass and, in fact, exist before the central mass appears. However, these independent bones that make up a primitive spinal segment are influenced by a certain combination of forces that are more similar than different: like a fulcrum to a group of muscles that usually work together, they constantly undergo shared reactions. Consequently, we see that during development, they gradually merge. A clearer example is provided by spinal segments that fuse together where they face a predominant force. The sacrum consists of a group of vertebrae that are firmly united. In the ostrich and similar birds, there are between seventeen and twenty sacral vertebrae; and in addition to being fused with each other, they also fuse with the iliac bones on each side. If we assume these vertebrae were originally separate, as they are in the embryo bird, and consider the mechanical conditions they would have faced, we can understand how their union occurs. The entire weight of the body is transferred through these vertebrae to the legs: the legs support the pelvic arch, which supports the sacrum, to which the rest of the spine, along with all the limbs and organs, is attached. So, if they were separate, the sacral vertebrae would need to be held tightly together by well-contracted muscles and would therefore be prevented from engaging in the lateral movements experienced by other vertebrae—they must undergo a common strain while being shielded from different strains; thus fulfilling the conditions for integration. However, the strongest examples of the relationship between cause and effect come from the limbs. The metacarpal bones (which in humans support the palm of the hand) are mostly separate from each other in most mammals, allowing for the individual movements of the toes, which result in slight separate movements. This isn’t the case for the ox and horse families. In the ox family, only the middle metacarpals (third and fourth) develop; and these, becoming significantly large, merge to form the cannon bone. In the horse family, the integration is what we can consider indirect: the second and fourth metacarpals are only rudimentary, connected to the sides of the third, while the third is greatly developed; thus forming a cannon bone that differs from that of the ox in being a single cylinder rather than two fused cylinders. The metatarsus in these quadrupeds shows similar changes. Each of these transformations occurs where the grouped bones no longer have differing functions but share a common one. The feet of oxen and horses are used solely for locomotion and don’t take on purposes that would require different movements between the metacarpals, as is the case with clawed mammals. Therefore, a single solid mass of bone emerges where a single force acts. The idea that these facts are causally connected is supported throughout the entire class of birds; similar integrations are found in their wings and legs under comparable conditions. While this paper is being printed, a fact that demonstrates this general truth even more strikingly was shared with me by Prof. Huxley, who generously allows me to use it before it’s published. The Glyptodon, an extinct mammal discovered in fossils in South America, has long been recognized as a large, awkward creature related to the Armadillo, but it had a massive dermal armor made of polygonal plates tightly fitted together, creating a large box that entirely encased the body, effectively preventing any lateral or vertical bending. This bony box, which must have weighed several hundred pounds, was supported by the spinous processes of the vertebrae and the neighboring bones of the pelvic and thoracic structures. The key point to note is that here, where the trunk vertebrae were subjected to the pressure of this heavy armor and, simultaneously, because of its rigidity, were kept from relative movements, the entire series of them fused into one solid, continuous bone.
The formation and maintenance of a species, considered as an assemblage of similar organisms, is interpretable in an analogous way. We have already seen that in so far as the members of a species are subject to different sets of incident forces, they are differentiated, or divided into varieties. And here it remains to add that in so far as they are subject to like sets of incident forces, they are integrated, or reduced to, and kept in, the state of a uniform aggregate. For by the process of “natural selection,” there is a continual purification of each species from those individuals which depart from the common type in ways that unfit them for the conditions of their existence. Consequently, there is a continual leaving behind of those individuals which are in all respects fit for the conditions of their existence; and are therefore very nearly alike. The circumstances to which any species is exposed, being, as we before saw, an involved combination of incident forces; and the members of the species having mixed with them some that differ more than usual from the average structure required for meeting these forces; it results that these forces are constantly separating such divergent individuals from the rest, and so preserving the uniformity of the rest—keeping up its integrity as a species. Just as the changing autumn leaves are picked out by the wind from among the green ones around them, or just as, to use Prof. Huxley’s simile, the smaller fragments pass through the sieve while the larger are kept back; so, the uniform incidence of external forces affects the members of a group of organisms similarly in proportion as they are similar, and differently in proportion as they are different; and thus is ever segregating the like by parting the unlike from them. Whether these separated members are killed off, as mostly 431happens, or whether, as otherwise happens, they survive and multiply into a distinct variety, in consequence of their fitness to certain partially unlike conditions, matters not to the argument. The one case conforms to the law, that the unlike units of an aggregate are differentiated and integrated when uniformly subject to the same incident forces; and the other to the converse law, that the like units of an aggregate are differentiated and integrated when subject to different incident forces. And on consulting Mr. Darwin’s remarks on divergence of character, it will be seen that the segregations thus caused tend ever to become more definite.
The way a species forms and stays together, seen as a group of similar organisms, can be understood in a similar way. We've already noted that as species members face different sets of external forces, they become distinct, or split into varieties. It's also important to mention that as they encounter similar sets of external forces, they come together, or are united, creating and maintaining a uniform group. Through the process of "natural selection," each species continuously sheds individuals that don’t fit the common characteristics necessary for survival. As a result, those that are best suited for their environment get left behind and are very similar to each other. The conditions a species faces are a complex mix of external forces; when individuals that differ significantly from the average structure needed to cope with these forces mix in, these forces consistently push those divergent individuals away from the rest, preserving the uniformity of the species. Just like the wind separates changing autumn leaves from the green ones around them, or as Professor Huxley described, where smaller particles pass through a sieve while larger ones are held back; similarly, uniform external forces affect group members based on their similarities or differences, continually separating the alike by distinguishing the unlike. Whether the separated individuals die off, which often happens, or survive and evolve into a distinct variety due to their adaptation to slightly different conditions doesn’t change the argument. One scenario aligns with the principle that unlike units in a group differentiate and unite when faced with the same external forces, while the other illustrates that similar units differentiate and unite when experiencing different external forces. Referring to Mr. Darwin’s comments on character divergence will show that the divisions caused this way tend to become more distinct over time.
§ 127. Mental evolution under one of its leading aspects, we found to consist in the formation of groups of like objects and like relations—a differentiation of the various things originally confounded together in one assemblage, and an integration of each separate order of things into a separate group (§ 113). Here it remains to point out that while unlikeness in the incident forces is the cause of such differentiations, likeness in the incident forces is the cause of such integrations. For what is the process through which classifications are established? At first, in common with the uninitiated, the botanist recognizes only such conventional divisions as those which agriculture has established—distinguishes a few vegetables and cereals, and groups the rest together into the one miscellaneous aggregate of wild plants. How do these wild plants become grouped in his mind into orders, genera, and species? Each plant he examines yields him a certain complex impression. Every now and then he picks up a plant like one before seen; and the recognition of it is the production in him of a like connected group of sensations, by a like connected group of attributes. That is to say, there is produced throughout the nerves concerned, a combined set of changes, similar to a combined set of changes before produced. Considered analytically, each such combined set of changes is a combined set of molecular 432modifications wrought in the affected part of the organism. On every repetition of the impression, a like combined set of molecular modifications is superposed on the previous ones, and makes them greater: thus generating an internal idea corresponding to these similar external objects. Meanwhile, another kind of plant produces in the brain of the botanist another set of combined changes or molecular modifications—a set which does not agree with and deepen the one we have been considering, but disagrees with it; and by repetition of such there is generated a different idea answering to a different species. What now is the nature of this process expressed in general terms? On the one hand there are the like and unlike things from which severally emanate the groups of forces by which we perceive them. On the other hand, there are the organs of sense and percipient centres, through which, in the course of observation, these groups of forces pass. In passing through these organs of sense and percipient centres, the like groups of forces are segregated, or separated from the unlike groups of forces; and each such differentiated and integrated series of groups of forces, answering to an external genus or species, constitutes a state of consciousness which we call our idea of the genus or species. We before saw that as well as a separation of mixed matters by the same force, there is a separation of mixed forces by the same matter; and here we may further see that the unlike forces so separated, work unlike structural changes in the aggregate that separates them—structural changes each of which thus represents, and is equivalent to, the integrated series of motions that has produced it.
§ 127. Mental evolution in one of its main aspects consists of forming groups of similar objects and relationships—differentiating various things that were originally mixed together and integrating each distinct category into its own group (§ 113). It's important to highlight that while differences in the influencing forces lead to these differentiations, similarities in the influencing forces lead to integrations. So, how are classifications established? Initially, like the inexperienced, a botanist only recognizes conventional divisions established by agriculture—distinguishing a few vegetables and grains while grouping the rest into a vague collection of wild plants. How does he categorize these wild plants into orders, genera, and species in his mind? Each plant he studies provides a complex impression. Now and then, he encounters a plant that resembles one he has seen before; recognizing it evokes a similar connected group of sensations and a related set of attributes. In other words, a combined set of changes occurs throughout the relevant nerves, similar to a previous set of changes. Analyzed, each combined set of changes indicates a series of molecular modifications in the affected part of the organism. Every time the impression occurs, a similar set of molecular modifications layers onto the previous ones, enriching them and creating an internal idea that represents these similar external objects. Meanwhile, a different type of plant produces a different set of combined changes in the botanist's brain—a set that doesn't align with or build upon the earlier impression but counters it; with repeated encounters, a different idea emerges corresponding to a different species. What is this process, in general terms? On one side, we have the similar and dissimilar things that generate the groups of forces we use to perceive them. On the other side, we have our senses and perception centers, through which these groups of forces travel during observation. As these forces move through our senses and perception centers, the similar groups are separated from the dissimilar groups. Each differentiated and integrated series of these forces, corresponding to an external genus or species, creates a state of consciousness that we refer to as our idea of that genus or species. We previously noted that there is not only a separation of mixed matters by the same force, but also a separation of mixed forces by the same matter; we can see that the dissimilar forces that are separated induce different structural changes in the aggregate that separates them—each structural change representing and equivalent to the integrated series of movements that caused it.
By a parallel process, the connexions of co-existence and sequence among impressions, become differentiated and integrated simultaneously with the impressions themselves. When two phenomena that have been experienced in a given order, are repeated in the same order, those nerves which before were affected by the transition are again affected; and such molecular modification as they received 433from the first motion propagated through them, is increased by this second motion along the same route. Each such motion works a structural alteration, which, in conformity with the general law set forth in Chapter X., involves a diminution of the resistance to all such motions that afterwards occur. The integration of these successive motions (or more strictly, the permanently effective portions of them expended in overcoming resistance) thus becomes the cause of, and the measure of, the mental connexion between the impressions which the phenomena produce. Meanwhile, phenomena that are recognized as different from these, being phenomena that therefore affect different nervous elements, will have their connexions severally represented by motions along other routes; and along each of these other routes, the nervous discharges will severally take place with a readiness proportionate to the frequency with which experience repeats the connexion of phenomena. The classification of relations must hence go on pari passu with the classification of the related things. In common with the mixed sensations received from the external world, the mixed relations it presents, cannot be impressed on the organism without more or less segregation of them resulting. And through this continuous differentiation and integration of changes or motions, which constitutes nervous function, there is gradually wrought that differentiation and integration of matter, which constitutes nervous structure.
By a similar process, the connections between co-existence and the sequence of impressions become distinct and integrated at the same time as the impressions themselves. When two experiences that occur in a specific order are repeated in that same order, the nerves that were previously affected by the shift are affected again; and the molecular changes they underwent from the initial motion are intensified by this second motion along the same pathway. Each motion causes a structural change, which, according to the general principle outlined in Chapter X, leads to a reduction in resistance to all subsequent motions of that kind. The integration of these successive motions (or more accurately, the parts of them that effectively help overcome resistance) thus becomes both the cause of and the measure of the mental connection between the impressions created by the phenomena. Meanwhile, phenomena recognized as distinct from these will impact different nervous elements, leading to their own connections represented by motions along other pathways; and along each of these pathways, the neural responses will occur with a readiness related to how often the connection of phenomena is experienced. Therefore, the classification of relationships must proceed pari passu with the classification of the related things. Just like the mixed sensations coming from the external world, the mixed relationships it presents cannot be processed by the organism without some degree of segregation occurring. Through this ongoing differentiation and integration of changes or motions that make up nervous function, a gradual differentiation and integration of matter occurs, which forms nervous structure.
§ 128. In social evolution, the collecting together of the like and the separation of the unlike, by incident forces, is primarily displayed in the same manner as we saw it to be among groups of inferior creatures. The human races tend to differentiate and integrate, as do races of other living forms. Of the forces which effect and maintain the segregations of mankind, may first be named those external ones which we class as physical conditions. The climate and food that are favourable to an indigenous people, are more or 434less detrimental to a people of different bodily constitution, coming from a remote part of the Earth. In tropical regions the northern races cannot permanently exist: if not killed off in the first generation, they are so in the second; and, as in India, can maintain their footing only by the artificial process of continuous immigration and emigration. That is to say, the external forces acting equally on the inhabitants of a given locality, tend to expel all who are not of a certain type; and so to keep up the integration of those who are of that type. Though elsewhere, as among European nations, we see a certain amount of permanent intermixture, otherwise brought about, we still see that this takes place between races of not very different types, that are naturalized to not very different conditions. The other forces conspiring to produce these national integrations, are those mental ones which show themselves in the affinities of men for others like themselves. Emigrants usually desire to get back among their own people; and where their desire does not take effect, it is only because the restraining ties are too great. Units of one society who are obliged to reside in another, very generally form colonies in the midst of that other—small societies of their own. Races which have been artificially severed, show strong tendencies to re-unite. Now though these integrations that result from the mutual affinities of kindred men, do not seem interpretable as illustrations of the general principle above enunciated, they really are thus interpretable. When treating of the direction of motion (§ 91), it was shown that the actions performed by men for the satisfaction of their wants, were always motions along lines of least resistance. The feelings characterizing a member of a given race, are feelings which get complete satisfaction only among other members of that race—a satisfaction partly derived from sympathy with those having like feelings, but mainly derived from the adapted social conditions which grow up where such feelings prevail. When, therefore, 435a citizen of any nation is, as we see, attracted towards others of his nation, the rationale is, that certain agencies which we call desires, move him in the direction of least resistance. Human motions, like all other motions, being determined by the distribution of forces, it follows that such integrations of races as are not produced by incident external forces, are produced by forces which the units of the races exercise on each other.
§ 128. In social evolution, the gathering of similar groups and the separation of different ones, driven by external forces, is primarily seen in the same way as it is among lower forms of life. Human races tend to differentiate and integrate, just like other living species. Of the factors that create and sustain the divisions among people, the first to mention are the external ones we classify as physical conditions. The climate and food that are suited for a native population can be harmful to a group with a different physical makeup from a distant part of the world. In tropical areas, northern races cannot survive long-term; if they don't die off in the first generation, they likely will in the second. In places like India, they can only maintain a presence through continuous immigration and emigration. This means that external forces acting on the people in a specific location tend to drive away all who don't fit a certain profile, thereby maintaining the integration of those who do. While in other regions, like among European nations, we see some degree of lasting mixing occurring in different ways, this typically happens between groups that are not very different from each other and that have adapted to similar conditions. The other forces promoting national integrations are the mental ones, reflected in people's affinity for others like themselves. Emigrants usually want to return to their own communities; when they can't, it's usually because the bonds holding them in place are too strong. Members of one society living in another often form colonies within that society—small communities of their own. Races that have been artificially separated often exhibit strong tendencies to re-unite. Although these integrations resulting from the mutual affinities of related people might not seem to demonstrate the general principle mentioned earlier, they actually do. When discussing the direction of motion (§ 91), it was shown that the actions individuals take to satisfy their needs always follow paths of least resistance. The feelings defining a person from a particular race find complete satisfaction only among fellow members of that race—this satisfaction partly comes from empathy with those who share similar feelings, but mainly from the adapted social conditions that arise where such feelings are common. Therefore, when a citizen of any nation is drawn to others from that nation, the reason is that certain forces we call desires push him toward paths of least resistance. Since human movements, like all other movements, are determined by the distribution of forces, it follows that the integrations of races not caused by external factors are driven by the interactions the members of those races have with one another.
During the development of each society, we see analogous segregations caused in analogous ways. A few of them result from minor natural affinities; but those most important ones which constitute political and industrial organization, result from the union of men in whom similarities have been produced by education—using education in its widest sense, as comprehending all processes by which citizens are moulded to special functions. Men brought up to bodily labour, are men who have had wrought in them a certain likeness—a likeness which, in respect of their powers of action, obscures and subordinates their natural differences. Those trained to brain-work, have acquired a certain other community of character which makes them, as social units, more like each other than like those trained to manual occupations. And there arise class-integrations answering to these superinduced likenesses. Much more definite integrations take place among the much more definitely assimilated members of any class who are brought up to the same calling. Even where the necessities of their work forbid concentration in one locality, as among artizans happens with masons and brick-layers, and among traders happens with the retail distributors, and among professionals happens with the medical men; there are not wanting Operative Builders Unions, and Grocers Societies, and Medical Associations, to show that these artificially-assimilated citizens become integrated as much as the conditions permit. And where, as among the manufacturing classes, the functions discharged do not require the dispersion of the citizens thus artificially assimilated, 436there is a progressive aggregation of them in special localities; and a consequent increase in the definiteness of the industrial divisions. If now we seek the causes of these integrations, considered as results of force and motion, we find ourselves brought to the same general principle as before. This likeness generated in any class or subclass by training, is an aptitude acquired by its members for satisfying their wants in like ways. That is, the occupation to which each man has been brought up, has become to him, in common with those similarly brought up, a line of least resistance. Hence under that pressure which determines all men to activity, these similarly-modified social units are similarly affected, and tend to take similar courses. If then there be any locality which, either by its physical peculiarities or by peculiarities wrought on it during social evolution, is rendered a place where a certain kind of industrial action meets with less resistance than elsewhere; it follows from the law of direction of motion that those social units who have been moulded to this kind of industrial action, will move towards this place, or become integrated there. If, for instance, the proximity of coal and iron mines to a navigable river, gives to Glasgow a certain advantage in the building of iron ships—if the total labour required to produce the same vessel, and get its equivalent in food and clothing, is less there than elsewhere; a concentration of iron-ship builders is produced at Glasgow: either by keeping there the population born to iron-ship building; or by immigration of those elsewhere engaged in it; or by both—a concentration that would be still more marked did not other districts offer counter-balancing facilities. The principle equally holds where the occupation is mercantile instead of manufacturing. Stock-brokers cluster together in the city, because the amount of effort to be severally gone through by them in discharging their functions, and obtaining their profits, is less there than in other localities. A place of exchange having once been established, becomes a place where the resistance to be overcome 437by each is less than elsewhere; and the pursuit of the course of least resistance by each, involves their aggregation around this place.
During the growth of each society, we see similar divisions happening in similar ways. Some of these come from minor natural affinities, but the most significant ones that create political and industrial organization result from the connection between people who share similarities shaped by education—using education in its broadest sense to include all processes that prepare citizens for specific roles. People trained for physical labor develop a certain likeness, which, regarding their abilities, can obscure and minimize their natural differences. Those educated for mental work acquire another kind of shared character, making them more similar to each other as social units than to those trained for manual jobs. Class integrations arise based on these induced similarities. More distinct integrations occur among more closely aligned members of any class who have the same occupation. Even when the nature of their work prevents them from concentrating in one location, as seen with masons and bricklayers among artisans, retailers among traders, and doctors among professionals, there are still Operative Builders Unions, Grocers Societies, and Medical Associations showing that these socially adapted citizens become integrated as much as conditions allow. In the case of manufacturing classes, where the functions performed do not require the dispersion of these socially molded citizens, there is a growing concentration of them in specific areas, resulting in clearer industrial divisions. If we now look for the causes of these integrations, viewed as outcomes of force and motion, we arrive at the same general principle as before. This similarity created in any class or subclass through training represents an ability gained by its members to meet their needs in similar ways. The occupation each person has been trained for becomes, for them and those similarly trained, the path of least resistance. Therefore, under the pressure that drives all people to take action, these similarly modified social units respond similarly and tend to follow similar paths. If a location—due to its physical traits or changes brought about by social evolution—becomes a place where a certain type of industrial activity faces less resistance than elsewhere, then according to the principle of motion direction, those social units molded for this kind of industrial action will move toward this place or integrate there. For instance, if the proximity of coal and iron mines to a navigable river gives Glasgow an advantage in building iron ships—if the total effort needed to produce the same ship and acquire its equivalent in food and clothing is lower there than in other places—a concentration of iron shipbuilders occurs in Glasgow, either by keeping the population born into iron shipbuilding there or through immigration from elsewhere engaged in it, or both—a concentration that would be even more pronounced if other areas didn’t provide counterbalancing advantages. This principle also applies where the occupation is mercantile instead of manufacturing. Stockbrokers gather in the city because the effort required by each to fulfill their roles and earn profits is lower there than in other areas. Once a trade zone is established, it becomes a location where the obstacles each faces are less than elsewhere, and the pursuit of the path of least resistance by each leads to their clustering around this spot.
Of course, with units so complicated as those which constitute a society, and with forces so involved as those which move them, the resulting differentiations and integrations must be far more entangled, or far less definite, than those we have hitherto considered. But though there may be pointed out many anomalies which at first sight seem inconsistent with the alleged law, a closer study shows that they are but subtler illustrations of it. For men’s likenesses being of various kinds, lead to various order of integration. There are likenesses of disposition, likenesses of taste, likenesses produced by intellectual culture, likenesses that result from class-training, likenesses of political feeling; and it needs but to glance round at the caste-divisions, the associations for philanthropic, scientific, and artistic purposes, the religious parties and social cliques; to see that some species of likeness among the component members of each body determines their union. Now these different integrations, by traversing each other, and often by their indirect antagonism, more or less obscure each other; and prevent any one kind of integration from becoming complete. Hence the anomalies referred to. But if this cause of incompleteness be duly borne in mind, social segregations will be seen to conform entirely to the same principle as all other segregations. Analysis will show that either by external incident forces, or by what we may in a sense regard as mutual polarity, there are ever being produced in society integrations of those units which have either a natural likeness or a likeness generated by training.
Of course, with units as complex as those that make up a society, and with forces as intertwined as those that drive them, the resulting differences and connections must be much more complicated, or much less clear, than those we’ve looked at before. While there may be many anomalies that initially seem inconsistent with the stated law, a closer examination reveals that they are just more subtle examples of it. Since people share similarities of various kinds, this leads to different types of integration. There are similarities in temperament, preferences, education, social class, and political views; just by looking around at the social classes, associations for charity, science, and art, as well as religious groups and social circles, it's clear that certain types of similarity among members of each group drive their cohesion. These different integrations interweave with each other, and often through their indirect opposition, they can obscure one another and prevent any single type of integration from being complete. This explains the anomalies mentioned earlier. However, if we keep this cause of incompleteness in mind, social groupings can be seen as completely aligned with the same principle as all other groupings. An analysis will show that whether through external forces or what we might consider a kind of mutual attraction, society is constantly forming integrations among those units that share a natural similarity or one cultivated through training.
§ 129. Can the general truth thus variously illustrated be deduced from the persistence of force, in common with foregoing ones? Probably the exposition at the beginning of the chapter will have led most readers to conclude that it can be so deduced.
§ 129. Can the general truth illustrated in various ways be drawn from the persistence of force, similar to previous examples? Most likely, the explanation at the start of the chapter will have led most readers to think it can be drawn that way.
438The abstract propositions involved are these:—First, that like units, subject to a uniform force capable of producing motion in them, will be moved to like degrees in the same direction. Second, that like units if exposed to unlike forces capable of producing motion in them, will be differently moved—moved either in different directions or to different degrees in the same direction. Third, that unlike units if acted on by a uniform force capable of producing motion in them, will be differently moved—moved either in different directions or to different degrees in the same direction. Fourth, that the incident forces themselves must be affected in analogous ways: like forces falling on like units must be similarly modified by the conflict; unlike forces falling on like units must be dissimilarly modified; and like forces falling on unlike units must be dissimilarly modified. These propositions admit of reduction to a still more abstract form. They all of them amount to this:—that in the actions and reactions of force and matter, an unlikeness in either of the factors necessitates an unlikeness in the effects; and that in the absence of unlikeness in either of the factors the effects must be alike.
438The abstract ideas here are these:—First, similar units, when subjected to a consistent force that can cause motion, will move in the same direction to similar extents. Second, similar units exposed to different forces capable of causing motion will move differently—either in different directions or to varying extents in the same direction. Third, different units acted upon by a consistent force that can produce motion will move differently—either in different directions or to varying extents in the same direction. Fourth, the forces themselves must also be affected in similar ways: similar forces acting on similar units must be similarly altered by the interaction; different forces acting on similar units must be altered in different ways; and similar forces acting on different units must also be altered in different ways. These ideas can be simplified even further. They all essentially convey this:—in the interactions between force and matter, any difference in either factor leads to different effects; and in the absence of any difference in either factor, the effects must be the same.
When thus generalized, the immediate dependence of these propositions on the persistence of force, becomes obvious. Any two forces that are not alike, are forces which differ either in their amounts or directions or both; and by what mathematicians call the resolution of forces, it may be proved that this difference is constituted by the presence in the one of some force not present in the other. Similarly, any two units or portions of matter which are unlike in size, weight, form, or other attribute, can be known by us as unlike only through some unlikeness in the forces they impress on our consciousness; and hence this unlikeness also, is constituted by the presence in the one of some force or forces not present in the other. Such being the common nature of these unlikenesses, what is the inevitable corollary? Any unlikeness in the incident forces, where the things acted on are alike, must generate a difference between the effects; since otherwise, 439the differential force produces no effect, and force is not persistent. Any unlikeness in the things acted on, where the incident forces are alike, must generate a difference between the effects; since otherwise, the differential force whereby these things are made unlike, produces no effect, and force is not persistent. While, conversely, if the forces acting and the things acted on, are alike, the effects must be alike; since otherwise, a differential effect can be produced without a differential cause, and force is not persistent.
When generalized, the immediate connection between these statements and the persistence of force becomes clear. Any two forces that are different must vary in either their amounts, directions, or both. Mathematicians can prove through force resolution that this difference arises because one force has something that the other lacks. Similarly, when we perceive two units or portions of matter as different in size, weight, shape, or any other characteristic, we recognize this difference through the distinct forces they exert on our awareness; thus, this difference also arises from some force or forces present in one but not in the other. Given that this is the common nature of these differences, what is the unavoidable conclusion? Any difference in the forces affecting similar objects will create a variation in the results; otherwise, the differential force has no effect, indicating that force is not persistent. Any difference in the objects being affected, while the forces are the same, must also produce a difference in the results; otherwise, the differential force that creates this uniqueness produces no effect, meaning force is not persistent. Conversely, if both the forces acting and the objects being acted upon are the same, the outcomes must also be the same; otherwise, a different effect could happen without a different cause, suggesting that force is not persistent.
Thus these general truths being necessary implications of the persistence of force, all the re-distributions above traced out as characterizing Evolution in its various phases, are also implications of the persistence of force. Such portions of the permanently effective forces acting on any aggregate, as produce sensible motions in its parts, cannot but work the segregations which we see take place. If of the mixed units making up such aggregate, those of the same kind have like motions impressed on them by a uniform force, while units of another kind are moved by this uniform force in ways more or less unlike the ways in which those of the first kind are moved, the two kinds must separate and integrate. If the units are alike and the forces unlike, a division of the differently affected units is equally necessitated. Thus there inevitably arises the demarcated grouping which we everywhere see. By virtue of this segregation that grows ever more decided while there remains any possibility of increasing it, the change from uniformity to multiformity is accompanied by a change from indistinctness in the relations of parts to distinctness in the relations of parts. As we before saw that the transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous is inferrable from that ultimate truth which transcends proof; so we here see, that from this same truth is inferrable the transformation of an indefinite homogeneity into a definite heterogeneity.
Thus, these general truths being necessary implications of the persistence of force, all the distributions outlined above that characterize evolution in its various phases are also implications of the persistence of force. The portions of the permanently effective forces acting on any whole that produce noticeable movements in its parts can’t help but create the separations we observe. If the mixed units constituting such a whole have similar motions caused by a uniform force, while units of another type are influenced by this uniform force in ways that differ more or less from those of the first type, the two types will inevitably separate and integrate. If the units are similar and the forces different, a division of the differently affected units is equally necessary. Thus, a clear grouping arises that we see everywhere. Because of this segregation, which becomes increasingly pronounced as long as there is any chance of increasing it, the shift from uniformity to diversity is accompanied by a change from vague to clear relations among the parts. As we previously noted that the transformation of the homogeneous into the heterogeneous is inferred from that ultimate truth which transcends proof; here we see that from the same truth, we can infer the transformation of an indefinite homogeneity into a definite heterogeneity.
CHAPTER XVI.
Equilibrium.
§ 130. And now towards what do these changes tend? Will they go on for ever? or will there be an end to them? Can things increase in heterogeneity through all future time? or must there be a degree which the differentiation and integration of Matter and Motion cannot pass? Is it possible for this universal metamorphosis to proceed in the same general course indefinitely? or does it work towards some ultimate state, admitting no further modification of like kind? The last of these alternative conclusions is that to which we are inevitably driven. Whether we watch concrete processes, or whether we consider the question in the abstract, we are alike taught that Evolution has an impassable limit.
§ 130. So what are these changes aimed at? Will they continue forever? Or will they eventually stop? Can things keep becoming more different over time? Or is there a point beyond which the differentiation and integration of Matter and Motion can't go? Is it possible for this universal change to continue in the same general direction indefinitely? Or is it moving toward some final state that won’t allow further changes of the same kind? The last option is the conclusion we can’t escape. Whether we observe specific processes or think about the question in general, we learn that Evolution has a definite limit.
The re-distributions of matter that go on around us, are ever being brought to conclusions by the dissipation of the motions which effect them. The rolling stone parts with portions of its momentum to the things it strikes, and finally comes to rest; as do also, in like manner, the various things it has struck. Descending from the clouds and trickling over the Earth’s surface till it gathers into brooks and rivers, water, still running towards a lower level, is at last arrested by the resistance of other water that has reached the lowest level. In the lake or sea thus formed, every agitation raised by a wind or the immersion of a solid body, propagates itself around in waves that diminish as they widen, and gradually 441become lost to observation in motions communicated to the atmosphere and the matter on the shores. The impulse given by a player to the harp-string, is transformed through its vibrations into aerial pulses; and these, spreading on all sides, and weakening as they spread, soon cease to be perceptible; and finally die away in generating thermal undulations that radiate into space. Equally in the cinder that falls out of the fire, and in the vast masses of molten lava ejected by a volcano, we see that the molecular agitation known to us as heat, disperses itself by radiation; so that however great its amount, it inevitably sinks at last to the same degree as that existing in surrounding bodies. And if the actions observed be electrical or chemical, we still find that they work themselves out in producing sensible or insensible movements, that are dissipated as before; until quiescence is eventually reached. The proximate rationale of the process exhibited under these several forms, lies in the fact dwelt on when treating of the Multiplication of Effects, that motions are ever being decomposed into divergent motions, and these into re-divergent motions. The rolling stone sends off the stones it hits in directions differing more or less from its own; and they do the like with the things they hit. Move water or air, and the movement is quickly resolved into radiating movements. The heat produced by pressure in a given direction, diffuses itself by undulations in all directions; and so do the light and electricity similarly generated. That is to say, these motions undergo division and subdivision; and by continuance of this process without limit, they are, though never lost, gradually reduced to insensible motions.
The redistribution of matter happening around us constantly comes to an end through the dissipation of the motions that cause them. A rolling stone loses some of its momentum to the objects it hits and eventually stops; this also happens to the various things it has impacted. Water descends from the clouds and trickles over the Earth’s surface until it collects into brooks and rivers. While still moving towards a lower level, it is ultimately stopped by the resistance of other water that has reached the lowest point. In the resulting lake or sea, any disturbance caused by wind or a solid object creates waves that spread out and weaken, gradually becoming undetectable as they transmit motion into the atmosphere and the matter at the shores. The force imparted by a player on a harp string turns into sound waves through its vibrations; these waves spread out in all directions, losing strength until they’re no longer noticeable and eventually dissipate as thermal waves that radiate into space. Similarly, in the cinders that fall from a fire and in the large amounts of molten lava expelled by a volcano, we observe that the molecular movement we know as heat spreads out through radiation; no matter how much there is, it ultimately equalizes with the temperature of surrounding bodies. Even when dealing with electrical or chemical actions, we find they produce observable or barely noticeable movements that dissipate just the same until everything eventually settles. The underlying reason for these processes, as discussed in the section on the Multiplication of Effects, is that motions are constantly breaking down into different directions, and these further decompose into new movements. A rolling stone sends off the stones it hits in varying directions, and they do the same with whatever they strike. When we move water or air, that movement quickly results in radiating motions. Heat generated by pressure in one direction spreads out in all directions, and so do similarly produced light and electricity. In other words, these motions divide and subdivide; through this endless process, they never disappear but are gradually reduced to imperceptible movements.
In all cases then, there is a progress toward equilibration. That universal co-existence of antagonist forces which, as we before saw, necessitates the universality of rhythm, and which, as we before saw, necessitates the decomposition of every force into divergent forces, at the same time necessitates the ultimate establishment of a balance. Every motion 442being motion under resistance, is continually suffering deductions; and these unceasing deductions finally result in the cessation of the motion.
In every situation, there is a move towards balance. This universal coexistence of opposing forces, which we discussed earlier, requires a universal rhythm, and also leads to the breakdown of every force into opposing forces. At the same time, it leads to the eventual establishment of a balance. Every motion, being a motion against resistance, continually faces losses; and these ongoing losses ultimately lead to the stopping of the motion. 442
The general truth thus illustrated under its simplest aspect, we must now look at under those more complex aspects it usually presents throughout Nature. In nearly all cases, the motion of an aggregate is compound; and the equilibration of each of its components, being carried on independently, does not affect the rest. The ship’s bell that has ceased to vibrate, still continues those vertical and lateral oscillations caused by the ocean-swell. The water of the smooth stream on whose surface have died away the undulations caused by the rising fish, moves as fast as before onward to the sea. The arrested bullet travels with undiminished speed round the Earth’s axis. And were the rotation of the Earth destroyed, there would not be implied any diminution of the Earth’s movement with respect to the Sun and other external bodies. So that in every case, what we regard as equilibration is a disappearance of some one or more of the many movements which a body possesses, while its other movements continue as before. That this process may be duly realized and the state of things towards which it tends fully understood, it will be well here to cite a case in which we may watch this successive equilibration of combined movements more completely than we can do in those above instanced. Our end will best be served, not by the most imposing, but by the most familiar example. Let us take that of the spinning top. When the string which has been wrapped round a top’s axis is violently drawn off, and the top falls on to the table, it usually happens that besides the rapid rotation, two other movements are given to it. A slight horizontal momentum, unavoidably impressed on it when leaving the handle, carries it away bodily from the place on which it drops; and in consequence of its axis being more or less inclined, it falls into a certain oscillation, described by the expressive though inelegant word—“wabbling.” 443These two subordinate motions, variable in their proportions to each other and to the chief motion, are commonly soon brought to a close by separate processes of equilibration. The momentum which carries the top bodily along the table, resisted somewhat by the air, but mainly by the irregularities of the surface, shortly disappears; and the top thereafter continues to spin on one spot. Meanwhile, in consequence of that opposition which the axial momentum of a rotating body makes to any change in the plane of rotation, (so beautifully exhibited by the gyroscope,) the “wabbling” diminishes; and like the other is quickly ended. These minor motions having been dissipated, the rotatory motion, interfered with only by atmospheric resistance and the friction of the pivot, continues some time with such uniformity that the top appears stationary: there being thus temporarily established a condition which the French mathematicians have termed equilibrium mobile. It is true that when the axial velocity sinks below a certain point, new motions commence, and increase till the top falls; but these are merely incidental to a case in which the centre of gravity is above the point of support. Were the top, having an axis of steel, to be suspended from a surface adequately magnetized, all the phenomena described would be displayed, and the moving equilibrium having been once arrived at, would continue until the top became motionless, without any further change of position. Now the facts which it behoves us here to observe, are these. First, that the various motions which an aggregate possesses are separately equilibrated: those which are smallest, or which meet with the greatest resistance, or both, disappearing first; and leaving at last, that which is greatest, or meets with least resistance, or both. Second, that when the aggregate has a movement of its parts with respect to each other, which encounters but little external resistance, there is apt to be established an equilibrium mobile. Third, that this moving equilibrium eventually lapses into complete equilibrium.
The fundamental idea we just discussed, in its simplest form, now needs to be examined in the more complicated ways it typically appears in nature. In most cases, the movement of a group is multifaceted; and the balancing of each individual part happens independently, without influencing the others. A ship's bell that has stopped vibrating still carries on with the vertical and side-to-side movements caused by ocean waves. The water in a calm stream, which no longer shows the ripples from splashing fish, continues to flow as quickly as it did before towards the sea. A bullet that has been stopped still travels around the Earth's axis at the same speed. Additionally, if the Earth's rotation were to suddenly stop, it wouldn't change the Earth’s motion in relation to the Sun and other celestial bodies. Therefore, in each case, what we see as balancing is simply the cessation of one or more of the various movements a body has, while its other movements remain unchanged. To better understand this process and the state it leads to, let's look at a situation where we can observe the gradual balancing of combined movements more clearly than in those mentioned earlier. A simple and familiar example will serve us best. Let's consider a spinning top. When the string wrapped around the top’s axis is suddenly pulled away, causing the top to fall onto the table, it typically receives, in addition to its rapid spinning, two other movements. A slight horizontal force, unintentionally applied as it leaves the handle, pushes it away from the spot where it lands; and because its axis is tilted to varying degrees, it swings back and forth in a manner described by the term "wobbling." These two secondary movements, which vary in their relationship to each other and to the primary motion, are generally quickly damped out through separate balancing processes. The force that moves the top along the table, slightly resisted by the air and more so by the surface irregularities, dissipates quickly, leaving the top to spin in place. Meanwhile, due to the resistance that the axis movement of a spinning object presents against any alteration in its rotational plane—beautifully demonstrated by the gyroscope—the "wobbling" decreases and, like the other, soon ends. Once these minor movements have faded, the spinning motion, affected only by air resistance and the friction of its pivot, continues for a while so steadily that the top looks like it's standing still: thus creating a temporary state known by French mathematicians as *équilibre mobile*. It's important to note that when the spinning speed falls below a certain threshold, new movements begin and intensify until the top falls; however, these are merely additional factors that arise when the center of gravity is above the support point. If the top were made with a steel axis and suspended from a sufficiently magnetized surface, all the previously described phenomena would occur, and the moving balance, once established, would persist until the top became motionless without any further position change. Now, the key points we need to observe are these. First, the various movements an aggregate possesses are balanced separately: the smallest movements, those facing the most resistance, or both of these, disappear first, leaving the largest or least resisted movements remaining. Second, when the aggregate has internal movement among its parts that encounters little external resistance, a *équilibre mobile* tends to form. Third, this moving equilibrium eventually transitions into complete equilibrium.
444Fully to comprehend the process of equilibration, is not easy; since we have simultaneously to contemplate various phases of it. The best course will be to glance separately at what we may conveniently regard as its four different orders. The first order includes the comparatively simple motions, as those of projectiles, which are not prolonged enough to exhibit their rhythmical character; but which, being quickly divided and subdivided into motions communicated to other portions of matter, are presently dissipated in the rhythm of ethereal undulations. In the second order, comprehending the various kinds of vibration or oscillation as usually witnessed, the motion is used up in generating a tension which, having become equal to it or momentarily equilibrated with it, thereupon produces a motion in the opposite direction, that is subsequently equilibrated in like manner: thus causing a visible rhythm, that is, however, soon lost in invisible rhythms. The third order of equilibration, not hitherto noticed, obtains in those aggregates which continually receive as much motion as they expend. The steam engine (and especially that kind which feeds its own furnace and boiler) supplies an example. Here the force from moment to moment dissipated in overcoming the resistance of the machinery driven, is from moment to moment replaced from the fuel; and the balance of the two is maintained by a raising or lowering of the expenditure according to the variation of the supply: each increase or decrease in the quantity of steam, resulting in a rise or fall of the engine’s movement, such as brings it to a balance with the increased or decreased resistance. This, which we may fitly call the dependent moving equilibrium, should be specially noted; since it is one that we shall commonly meet with throughout various phases of Evolution. The equilibration to be distinguished as of the fourth order, is the independent or perfect moving equilibrium. This we see illustrated in the rhythmical motions of the Solar System; which, being resisted only by a medium of inappreciable 445density, undergo no sensible diminution in such periods of time as we can measure.
444Understanding the process of equilibration is not easy because we have to look at various phases of it at once. The best approach is to separate it into what we can consider as four different orders. The first order involves relatively simple motions, like those of projectiles, which don't last long enough to show their rhythmic nature. However, they quickly break down into movements that are transferred to other parts of matter and are soon dissipated in the rhythm of ethereal waves. In the second order, which includes the different types of vibrations or oscillations we usually observe, the motion is used to create tension that, once equalized or briefly balanced, produces a motion in the opposite direction, which is then balanced in a similar way. This creates a visible rhythm, though it quickly disappears into invisible rhythms. The third order of equilibration, which has not been previously recognized, occurs in systems that continuously receive as much motion as they use. A steam engine, particularly one that fuels its own furnace and boiler, serves as an example. In this case, the energy dissipated while overcoming the machine's resistance is constantly replenished by the fuel. The balance between the two is maintained by adjusting the expenditure according to the fuel supply variations. Each increase or decrease in the steam produced results in a rise or fall in the engine's movement, bringing it into balance with the changing resistance. This can be aptly called the dependent moving equilibrium and is something we will commonly encounter in various stages of Evolution. The fourth order of equilibration is known as the independent or perfect moving equilibrium. This is illustrated by the rhythmic motions of the Solar System, which, experiencing resistance only from a medium of negligible density, show no significant reduction over the time periods we can measure. 445
All these kinds of equilibration may, however, from the highest point of view, be regarded as different modes of one kind. For in every case the balance arrived at is relative, and not absolute—is a cessation of the motion of some particular body in relation to a certain point or points, involving neither the disappearance of the relative motion lost, which is simply transformed into other motions, nor a diminution of the body’s motions with respect to other points. Thus understanding equilibration, it manifestly includes that equilibrium mobile, which at first sight seems of another nature. For any system of bodies exhibiting, like those of the Solar System, a combination of balanced rhythms, has this peculiarity;—that though the constituents of the system have relative movements, the system as a whole has no movement. The centre of gravity of the entire group remains fixed. Whatever quantity of motion any member of it has in any direction, is from moment to moment counter-balanced by an equivalent motion in some other part of the group in an opposite direction; and so the aggregate matter of the group is in a state of rest. Whence it follows that the arrival at a state of moving equilibrium, is the disappearance of some movement which the aggregate had in relation to external things, and a continuance of those movements only which the different parts of the aggregate have in relation to each other. Thus generalizing the process, it becomes clear that all forms of equilibration are intrinsically the same; since in every aggregate, it is the centre of gravity only that loses its motion: the constituents always retaining some motion with respect to each other—the motion of molecules if none else.
All these types of equilibration can, from the highest perspective, be seen as different ways of the same thing. In each case, the balance reached is relative and not absolute; it represents a halt in the motion of a specific body relative to certain points. This doesn’t mean the relative motion that’s lost disappears completely—it simply transforms into other movements—and it doesn’t imply a decrease in the body’s movements concerning other points. Therefore, when we consider equilibration, it clearly includes mobile equilibrium, which might initially appear to be different. Any system of bodies, like those in the Solar System, that shows a combination of balanced rhythms has this unique aspect: while the parts of the system have relative movements, the system itself does not move. The center of gravity for the whole group remains fixed. Regardless of the amount of motion any member has in one direction, it is continually counteracted by an equivalent motion in another part of the group moving in the opposite direction, keeping the entire group at rest. From this, it follows that reaching a state of moving equilibrium means the disappearance of certain movement the whole system had concerning external things, while the movements that the different parts have relative to each other continue. Thus, by generalizing this process, it becomes clear that all forms of equilibration are fundamentally the same; within every aggregate, only the center of gravity loses its motion, while the components still retain some movement relative to one another—if nothing else, the motion of molecules.
Those readers who happen to bear in mind a proposition concerning the functional characteristics of Evolution, which was set forth in Chapter XII, will probably regard it as wholly at variance with that set forth in this Chapter. It 446was there alleged that throughout Evolution, integration of matter is accompanied by integration of such motion as the matter previously had; and that thus there is a transformation of diffused motion into aggregated motion, parallel to the transformation of diffused matter into aggregated matter. Here however, it is asserted that every aggregate motion is constantly undergoing diffusion—every integrated motion undergoing perpetual disintegration. And so the motion of masses, which before was said gradually to arise out of molecular motion, is here said to be gradually lost in molecular motion. Doubtless these statements, if severally accepted without qualification, are contradictory. Neither of them, however, expresses the whole truth. Each needs the other as its indispensable complement. It is quite true, as before alleged, that there goes on an integration of motion corresponding to the integration of matter; and that this essential characteristic of Evolution, functionally considered, is clearly displayed in proportion as the Evolution is active. But the disintegration of motion, which, as we before saw, constitutes Dissolution, functionally considered, is all along going on; and though at first it forms but a small deduction from the change constituting Evolution, it gradually becomes equal to it, and eventually exceeding it, entails reverse changes. The aggregation of matter never being complete, but leaving behind less aggregated or unaggregated matter, in the shape of liquid, aeriform, or ethereal media; it results that from the beginning, the integrated motion of integrated masses, is ever being obstructed by these less integrated or unintegrated media. So that though while the integration of matter is rapidly going on, there is an increase of integrated motion, spite of the deductions thus continually made from it, there comes a time when the integration of matter and consequently of motion, ceases to increase, or increases so slowly that the deductions counterbalance it; and thenceforth these begin to decrease it, and, by its perpetual diffusion, to bring about a relative 447equilibration. From the beginning, the process of Evolution is antagonized by a process of Dissolution; and while the first for a long time predominates, the last finally arrests and reverses it.
Readers who remember a point about the functional features of Evolution mentioned in Chapter XII might see it as completely different from what's discussed in this Chapter. It was stated that throughout Evolution, the integration of matter goes hand-in-hand with the integration of the motion that matter previously had, leading to a shift from dispersed motion to concentrated motion, just as matter shifts from being dispersed to aggregated. However, this Chapter claims that every aggregated motion is constantly breaking down—every integrated motion is in a state of continual disintegration. So, while previously it was suggested that mass motion gradually emerges from molecular motion, it now states that mass motion gradually disappears into molecular motion. It's clear that if we accept these statements individually and without nuance, they contradict each other. However, neither statement captures the full truth; each one needs the other as an essential complement. It's indeed correct, as previously mentioned, that the integration of motion accompanies the integration of matter, and this key feature of Evolution is clearly shown as its activity increases. But the breakdown of motion, which we previously recognized as Dissolution, is continuously happening; and while initially it accounts for a small decrease in the changes associated with Evolution, it eventually equals it and can even surpass it, leading to reverse changes. The aggregation of matter is never completely finished, leaving behind less aggregated or unaggregated matter in the form of liquids, gases, or ether; this means that from the start, the integrated motion of integrated masses is always hindered by these less integrated or non-integrated media. So, while the integration of matter progresses quickly and integrated motion increases despite the ongoing deductions, a point is reached when the integration of matter—and therefore of motion—stops increasing or grows so slowly that the deductions match it. From then on, these deductions begin to decrease it, and through continuous diffusion, create a state of relative balance. From the outset, the Evolution process is countered by a process of Dissolution; and while Evolution dominates for a long time, Dissolution ultimately halts and reverses it.
Returning from this parenthetical explanation, we must now especially note two leading truths brought out by the foregoing exposition: the one concerning the ultimate, or rather the penultimate, state of motion which the processes described tend to bring about; the other concerning the concomitant distribution of matter. This penultimate state of motion is the moving equilibrium; which, as we have seen, tends to arise in an aggregate having compound motions, as a transitional state on the way towards complete equilibrium. Throughout Evolution of all kinds, there is a continual approximation to, and more or less complete maintenance of, this moving equilibrium. As in the Solar System there has been established an independent moving equilibrium—an equilibrium such that the relative motions of the constituent parts are continually so counter-balanced by opposite motions, that the mean state of the whole aggregate never varies; so is it, though in a less distinct manner, with each form of dependent moving equilibrium. The state of things exhibited in the cycles of terrestrial changes, in the balanced functions of organic bodies that have reached their adult forms, and in the acting and re-acting processes of fully-developed societies, is similarly one characterized by compensating oscillations. The involved combination of rhythms seen in each of these cases, has an average condition which remains practically constant during the deviations ever taking place on opposite sides of it. And the fact which we have here particularly to observe, is, that as a corollary from the general law of equilibration above set forth, the evolution of every aggregate must go on until this equilibrium mobile is established; since, as we have seen, an excess of force which the aggregate possesses in any direction, must eventually be expended in overcoming resistances to change in that 448direction: leaving behind only those movements which compensate each other, and so form a moving equilibrium. Respecting the structural state simultaneously reached, it must obviously be one presenting an arrangement of forces that counterbalance all the forces to which the aggregate is subject. So long as there remains a residual force in any direction—be it excess of a force exercised by the aggregate on its environment, or of a force exercised by its environment on the aggregate, equilibrium does not exist; and therefore the re-distribution of matter must continue. Whence it follows that the limit of heterogeneity towards which every aggregate progresses, is the formation of as many specializations and combinations of parts, as there are specialized and combined forces to be met.
Returning from this side note, we should now pay special attention to two key truths highlighted by the earlier explanation: one regarding the final, or more accurately, the second-to-last state of motion that the processes described aim to achieve; the other about the related distribution of matter. This second-to-last state of motion is the moving equilibrium, which, as we've noted, tends to emerge from a collection that has combined motions, serving as a transitional phase towards complete equilibrium. In all kinds of evolution, there's a constant movement toward, and more or less consistent maintenance of, this moving equilibrium. Just as the Solar System has established an independent moving equilibrium—one where the relative motions of its parts are continually balanced by opposing motions, ensuring that the overall state remains stable; so too, although in a less clear manner, does each type of dependent moving equilibrium. The state of affairs presented in the cycles of Earth's changes, in the balanced functions of organisms that have matured, and in the dynamics of fully-developed societies, is similarly characterized by compensating fluctuations. The complex combination of rhythms seen in each of these situations maintains an average state that stays practically constant despite ongoing deviations in either direction. And the key point we need to note here is that, as a result of the general law of equilibration mentioned earlier, the evolution of every aggregate must continue until this balance mobile is achieved; because, as we've discussed, any excess force that the aggregate has in a given direction must eventually be used to overcome resistances to change in that direction: leaving only those movements that balance each other out, thereby forming a moving equilibrium. Regarding the structural state that is simultaneously reached, it is clear that it must represent an arrangement of forces that balance all the forces acting on the aggregate. As long as there is any residual force in any direction—whether it's a surplus of force exerted by the aggregate on its surroundings, or a force exerted by the surroundings on the aggregate—equilibrium does not exist, and thus the redistribution of matter must continue. It follows that the ultimate state of heterogeneity toward which every aggregate moves is the formation of as many specializations and combinations of parts as there are specialized and combined forces to be addressed.
§ 131. Those successively changed forms which, if the nebular hypothesis be granted, must have arisen during the evolution of the Solar System, were so many transitional kinds of moving equilibrium; severally giving place to more permanent kinds on the way towards complete equilibration. Thus the assumption of an oblate spheroidal figure by condensing nebulous matter, was the assumption of a temporary and partial moving equilibrium among the component parts—a moving equilibrium that must have slowly grown more settled, as local conflicting movements were dissipated. In the formation and detachment of the nebulous rings, which, according to this hypothesis, from time to time took place, we have instances of progressive equilibration ending in the establishment of a complete moving equilibrium. For the genesis of each such ring, implies a perfect balancing of that aggregative force which the whole spheroid exercises on its equatorial portion, by that centrifugal force which the equatorial portion has acquired during previous concentration: so long as these two forces are not equal, the equatorial portion follows the contracting mass; but as soon as the second force has increased up to an 449equality with the first, the equatorial portion can follow no further, and remains behind. While, however, the resulting ring, regarded as a whole connected by forces with external wholes, has reached a state of moving equilibrium; its parts are not balanced with respect to each other. As we before saw (§ 110) the probabilities against the maintenance of an annular form by nebulous matter, are immense: from the instability of the homogeneous, it is inferrable that nebulous matter so distributed must break up into portions; and eventually concentrate into a single mass. That is to say, the ring must progress towards a moving equilibrium of a more complete kind, during the dissipation of that motion which maintained its particles in a diffused form: leaving at length a planetary body, attended perhaps by a group of minor bodies, severally having residuary relative motions that are no longer resisted by sensible media; and there is thus constituted an equilibrium mobile that is all but absolutely perfect.[18]
§ 131. The various forms that changed over time, assuming we accept the nebular hypothesis, must have emerged during the development of the Solar System, representing different types of moving equilibrium; each giving way to more stable forms as the system moved closer to complete balance. For instance, when nebulous matter condensed into an oblate spheroid, it reflected a temporary and partial moving equilibrium among its parts—a state that gradually became more stable as conflicting local movements were dissipated. In the formation and separation of the nebulous rings, which this hypothesis suggests occurred periodically, we see examples of progressive equilibration leading to the establishment of a complete moving equilibrium. The creation of each ring indicates a perfect balance between the aggregative force that the entire spheroid exerts on its equatorial section and the centrifugal force that this equatorial section gained during earlier concentrations. As long as these two forces are not equal, the equatorial part moves along with the contracting mass; however, once the second force equals the first, the equatorial part can no longer keep up and stays behind. While the resulting ring, viewed as a whole connected by forces with larger structures, reaches a state of moving equilibrium, its individual parts are not balanced with respect to one another. As we observed earlier (§ 110), the odds against nebulous matter maintaining a ring shape are incredibly high: due to the instability of uniformity, it can be inferred that such distributed nebulous matter will break apart into smaller pieces; eventually merging into a single mass. In other words, the ring must evolve toward a more complete form of moving equilibrium as the motion keeping its particles dispersed dissipates, ultimately resulting in a planetary body, possibly accompanied by a group of smaller bodies, each having leftover relative motions no longer resisted by significant media; thus, an balance mobile that is nearly absolutely perfect is established.[18]
Hypothesis aside, the principle of equilibration is still perpetually illustrated in those minor changes of state which the Solar System is undergoing. Each planet, satellite, and comet, exhibits to us at its aphelion a momentary equilibrium 450between that force which urges it further away from its primary, and that force which retards its retreat; since the retreat goes on until the last of these forces exactly counterpoises the first. In like manner at perihelion a converse equilibrium is momentarily established. The variation of each orbit in size, in eccentricity, and in the position of its plane, has similarly a limit at which the forces producing change in the one direction, are equalled by those antagonizing it; and an opposite limit at which an opposite arrest takes place. Meanwhile, each of these simple perturbations, as well as each of the complex ones resulting from their combination, exhibits, besides the temporary equilibration at each of its extremes, a certain general equilibration of compensating deviations on either side of a mean state. That the moving equilibrium thus constituted, tends, in the course of indefinite time, to lapse into a complete equilibrium, by the gradual decrease of planetary motions and eventually integration of all the separate masses composing the Solar System, is a belief suggested by certain observed cometary retardations, and entertained by some of high authority. The received opinion that the appreciable diminution in the period of Encke’s comet, implies a loss of momentum caused by resistance of the ethereal medium, commits astronomers who hold it, to the conclusion that this same resistance must cause a loss of planetary motions—a loss which, infinitesimal though it may be in such periods as we can measure, will, if indefinitely continued, bring these motions to a close. Even should there be, as Sir John Herschel suggests, a rotation of the ethereal medium in the same direction with the planets, this arrest, though immensely postponed, would not be absolutely prevented. Such an eventuality, however, must in any case be so inconceivably remote as to have no other than a speculative interest for us. It is referred to here, simply as illustrating the still-continued tendency towards complete equilibrium, through the still-continued 451dissipation of sensible motion, or transformation of it into insensible motion.
Hypothesis aside, the principle of equilibration is still constantly demonstrated in the minor changes of state that the Solar System is experiencing. Each planet, moon, and comet shows us a momentary balance at its farthest point from the sun, where one force pushes it away from its primary body, and another force slows its retreat; this retreat continues until these forces perfectly balance each other. Similarly, at its closest point to the sun, a reverse balance is temporarily established. The variation in each orbit's size, shape, and position has a limit where the forces causing change in one direction are matched by the opposing forces, and another limit where a different halt occurs. Meanwhile, each of these simple disruptions, as well as the complex ones resulting from their interactions, shows, besides the temporary balance at each extreme, a general balance of compensating deviations on either side of a mean state. That this moving equilibrium tends, over an indefinite period, to transition into a complete equilibrium—due to the gradual slowdown of planetary motions and eventually the merging of all the distinct masses that make up the Solar System—is a belief suggested by some observed delays in comets and held by certain respected authorities. The common view that the noticeable decrease in Encke’s comet’s period indicates a loss of momentum caused by resistance from the ethereal medium leads astronomers who accept this belief to conclude that this same resistance must also cause a loss of planetary motions—a loss that, even though it may be tiny within measurable timescales, will ultimately, if continued indefinitely, stop these motions altogether. Even if, as Sir John Herschel suggests, the ethereal medium rotates in the same direction as the planets, this halt, although greatly delayed, would not be entirely avoided. However, such an event would be so unimaginably far off that it holds no more than speculative interest for us. It is mentioned here simply to illustrate the ongoing tendency towards complete equilibrium, through the ongoing dissipation of noticeable motion or its transformation into imperceptible motion.
But there is another species of equilibration going on in
the Solar System, with which we are more nearly concerned—the
equilibration of that molecular motion known as heat.
The tacit assumption hitherto current, that the Sun can continue
to give off an undiminished amount of light and heat
through all future time, is fast being abandoned. Involving
as it does, under a disguise, the conception of power produced
out of nothing, it is of the same order as the belief that
misleads perpetual-motion schemers. The spreading recognition
of the truth that force is persistent, and that consequently
whatever force is manifested under one shape must
previously have existed under another shape, is carrying with
it a recognition of the truth that the force known to us in
solar radiations, is the changed form of some other force of
which the Sun is the seat; and that by the gradual dissipation
of these radiations into space, this other force is being
slowly exhausted. The aggregative force by which the Sun’s
substance is drawn to his centre of gravity, is the only one
which established physical laws warrant us in suspecting to be
the correlate of the forces thus emanating from him: the only
source of a known kind that can be assigned for the insensible
motions constituting solar light and heat, is the sensible motion
which disappears during the progressing concentration of the
Sun’s substance. We before saw it to be a corollary from the
nebular hypothesis, that there is such a progressing concentration
of the Sun’s substance. And here remains to be added the
further corollary, that just as in the case of the smaller members
of the Solar System, the heat generated by concentration,
long ago in great part radiated into space, has left only a central
residue that now escapes but slowly; so in the case of that immensely
larger mass forming the Sun, the immensely greater
quantity of heat generated and still in process of rapid diffusion,
must, as the concentration approaches its limit, diminish in
452amount, and eventually leave only an inappreciable internal
remnant. With or without the accompaniment of
that hypothesis of nebular condensation, whence, as we see,
it naturally follows, the doctrine that the Sun is gradually
losing his heat, has now gained considerable currency; and
calculations have been made, both respecting the amount of
heat and light already radiated, as compared with the amount
that remains, and respecting the period during which active
radiation is likely to continue. Prof. Helmholtz estimates,
that since the time when, according to the nebular hypothesis,
the matter composing the Solar System extended to the orbit
of Neptune, there has been evolved by the arrest of sensible
motion, an amount of heat 454 times as great as that which
the Sun still has to give out. He also makes an approximate
estimate of the rate at which this remaining 1
454th is being
diffused: showing that a diminution of the Sun’s diameter to
the extent of 1
10,000, would produce heat, at the present rate,
for more than 2000 years; or in other words, that a contraction
of 1
20,000,000 of his diameter, suffices to generate the
amount of light and heat annually emitted; and that thus, at
the present rate of expenditure, the Sun’s diameter will diminish
by something like 1
20 in the lapse of the next million
years.[19] Of course these conclusions are not to be considered
as more than rude approximations to the truth. Until quite
recently, we have been totally ignorant of the Sun’s chemical
composition; and even now have obtained but a superficial
knowledge of it. We know nothing of his internal structure;
and it is quite possible (probable, I believe,) that the
assumptions respecting central density, made in the foregoing
estimates, are wrong. But no uncertainty in the data on
which these calculations proceed, and no consequent error in
the inferred rate at which the Sun is expending his reserve
of force, militates against the general proposition that this
453reserve of force is being expended; and must in time be exhausted.
Though the residue of undiffused motion in the Sun,
may be much greater than is above concluded; though the
rate of radiation cannot, as assumed, continue at a uniform
rate, but must eventually go on with slowly-decreasing
rapidity; and though the period at which the Sun will cease
to afford us adequate light and heat, is very possibly far more
distant than above implied; yet such a period must some
time be reached, and this is all which it here concerns us
to observe.
But there’s another type of balance happening in the Solar System that’s more relevant to us—the balance of the molecular motion we call heat. The idea that the Sun can keep shining with the same amount of light and heat forever is quickly being abandoned. This notion implies that power can be created from nothing, similar to the beliefs that mislead people chasing perpetual motion. The growing understanding that force is conserved leads us to recognize that the force we see in solar radiation is just a transformed version of another force that the Sun holds; as this radiation gradually dissipates into space, that other force is slowly being depleted. The pulling force that keeps the Sun's material drawn toward its center of gravity is the only one that established physical laws suggest might correlate with the energy being emitted from it: the only known source that can explain the invisible movements that make up solar light and heat is the visible motion that disappears as the Sun's material concentrates. We’ve already established, based on the nebular hypothesis, that the Sun’s material is indeed concentrating. Additionally, just like with the smaller bodies in the Solar System, the heat generated by this concentration has mostly radiated into space, leaving only a small central residue that now escapes slowly; so, in the case of the much larger mass of the Sun, the even greater quantity of heat generated and still being rapidly released must, as the concentration nears its limit, decrease in amount and eventually leave only a negligible internal remnant.
With or without the idea of nebular condensation, the theory that the Sun is gradually losing its heat has gained significant acceptance; calculations have been done comparing the amount of heat and light already radiated to what remains, as well as the timeframe during which active radiation is likely to last. Professor Helmholtz estimates that since the time when, according to the nebular hypothesis, the matter that makes up the Solar System reached the orbit of Neptune, enough heat has been generated from the halting of visible motion to equal 454 times what the Sun still has left to emit. He gives a rough estimate of the rate at which this remaining 1
454th is being released: showing that a decrease of the Sun's diameter by 1
10,000 would produce heat, at the current rate, for over 2000 years; or, in other words, that a contraction of 20 million of its diameter is enough to generate the annual amount of light and heat emitted; and thus, at the current rate of expenditure, the Sun’s diameter is expected to shrink by about 1
20 over the next million years.[19] Of course, these conclusions should be regarded only as rough estimates of the truth. Until very recently, we knew nothing about the Sun’s chemical makeup, and even now we only have a superficial understanding of it. We have no idea about its internal structure; it’s quite likely (even probable) that the assumptions regarding central density used in the earlier estimates are incorrect. However, any uncertainty in the data that these calculations are based on, and any subsequent error in the estimated rate at which the Sun is using up its reserve of energy, doesn’t undermine the overall idea that this reserve of energy is being depleted; and must eventually be exhausted. Even if the amount of undiffused motion in the Sun is much greater than estimated; even if the rate of radiation cannot, as assumed, stay constant, and will eventually decrease; and even if the time when the Sun will no longer provide us with sufficient light and heat is likely much further away than suggested, that time will eventually come, and that’s all we need to recognize here.
Thus while the Solar System, if evolved from diffused matter, has illustrated the law of equilibration in the establishment of a complete moving equilibrium; and while, as at present constituted, it illustrates the law of equilibration in the balancing of all its movements; it also illustrates this law in the processes which astronomers and physicists infer are still going on. That motion of masses produced during Evolution, is being slowly re-diffused in molecular motion of the ethereal medium; both through the progressive integration of each mass, and the resistance to its motion through space. Infinitely remote as may be the state when all the motions of masses shall be transformed into molecular motion, and all the molecular motion equilibrated; yet such a state of complete integration and complete equilibration, is that towards which the changes now going on throughout the Solar System inevitably tend.
Thus, while the Solar System, if formed from dispersed matter, demonstrates the law of equilibration in achieving a complete moving balance; and while, as it currently exists, it shows the law of equilibration in balancing all its movements; it also exemplifies this law in the processes that astronomers and physicists believe are still occurring. The motion of masses generated during evolution is gradually being re-dispersed into the molecular motion of the ethereal medium, both through the ongoing integration of each mass and the resistance to its movement through space. Although it may seem infinitely distant when all the motions of masses will be converted into molecular motion, and all molecular motion will be balanced; such a state of complete integration and total equilibration is the direction in which the changes currently happening throughout the Solar System are inevitably heading.
§ 132. A spherical figure is the one which can alone equilibrate the forces of mutually-gravitating atoms. If the aggregate of such atoms has a rotatory motion, the form of equilibrium becomes a spheroid of greater or less oblateness, according to the rate of rotation; and it has been ascertained that the Earth is an oblate spheroid, diverging just as much from sphericity as is requisite to counterbalance the centrifugal force consequent on its velocity round its axis. That is to say, during the evolution of the Earth, there has been reached a complete equilibrium of those forces which affect its general 454outline. The only other process of equilibration which the Earth as a whole can exhibit, is the loss of its axial motion; and that any such loss is going on, we have no direct evidence. It has been contended, however, by Prof. Helmholtz, that inappreciable as may be its effect within known periods of time, the friction of the tidal wave must be slowly diminishing the Earth’s rotatory motion, and must eventually destroy it. Now though it seems an oversight to say that the Earth’s rotation can thus be destroyed, since the extreme effect, to be reached only in infinite time by such a process, would be an extension of the Earth’s day to the length of a lunation; yet it seems clear that this friction of the tidal wave is a real cause of decreasing rotation. Slow as its action is, we must recognize it as exemplifying, under another form, the universal progress towards equilibrium.
§ 132. A spherical shape is the only one that can balance the forces of atoms that attract each other due to gravity. If a collection of these atoms is spinning, the shape of balance becomes a spheroid that is more or less flattened, depending on the speed of rotation; it has been determined that the Earth is an oblate spheroid, deviating from a perfect sphere just enough to counteract the centrifugal force caused by its rotation around its axis. This means that over the course of the Earth's development, a complete balance of the forces affecting its overall shape has been achieved. The only other way the Earth as a whole can reach equilibrium is by losing its rotation; however, we have no direct evidence that this loss is happening. Professor Helmholtz has argued that although its impact may be small over known time periods, the friction from the tidal wave must be gradually reducing the Earth's rotational speed, and it will eventually stop it. While it seems unlikely that the Earth's rotation could be completely eliminated in this way, as the greatest effect would only occur over an infinite time scale, resulting in a day length equal to a lunar cycle; it is clear that tidal wave friction is a genuine factor in slowing down rotation. Despite its slow pace, we must acknowledge it as an example of the ongoing movement toward equilibrium in a different form.
It is needless to point out, in detail, how those movements which the Sun’s rays generate in the air and water on the Earth’s surface, and through them in the Earth’s solid substance,[20] one and all teach the same general truth. Evidently the winds and waves and streams, as well as the denudations and depositions they effect, perpetually illustrate on a grand scale, and in endless modes, that gradual dissipation of motions described in the first section; and the consequent tendency towards a balanced distribution of forces. Each of these sensible motions, produced directly or indirectly by integration of those insensible motions communicated from the Sun, becomes, as we have seen, divided and subdivided into motions less and less sensible; until it is finally reduced to insensible motions, and radiated from the Earth in the shape of thermal undulations. In their totality, these complex 455movements of aerial, liquid, and solid matter on the Earth’s crust, constitute a dependent moving equilibrium. As we before saw, there is traceable throughout them an involved combination of rhythms. The unceasing circulation of water from the ocean to the land, and from the land back to the ocean, is a type of these various compensating actions; which, in the midst of all the irregularities produced by their mutual interferences, maintain an average. And in this, as in other equilibrations of the third order, we see that the power from moment to moment in course of dissipation, is from moment to moment renewed from without: the rises and falls in the supply, being balanced by rises and falls in the expenditure; as witness the correspondence between the magnetic variations and the cycle of the solar spots. But the fact it chiefly concerns us to observe, is, that this process must go on bringing things ever nearer to complete rest. These mechanical movements, meteorologic and geologic, which are continually being equilibrated, both temporarily by counter-movements and permanently by the dissipation of such movements and counter-movements, will slowly diminish as the quantity of force received from the Sun diminishes. As the insensible motions propagated to us from the centre of our system become feebler, the sensible motions here produced by them must decrease; and at that remote period when the solar heat has ceased to be appreciable, there will no longer be any appreciable re-distributions of matter on the surface of our planet.
It’s unnecessary to elaborate on how the movements caused by the Sun’s rays in the air and water on Earth’s surface, and through them in the Earth’s solid material,[20] all teach the same fundamental truth. Clearly, the winds, waves, and streams, along with the erosion and deposition they create, continually illustrate on a grand scale, and in countless ways, the gradual dissipation of motions described in the first section; and the resulting tendency toward a balanced distribution of forces. Each of these visible movements, directly or indirectly resulting from the integration of those invisible motions transferred from the Sun, becomes, as we have observed, divided and subdivided into motions that are less and less noticeable; until it is ultimately diminished to invisible motions and radiated from Earth in the form of thermal waves. Together, these complex movements of air, water, and solid matter on Earth’s surface create a dependent moving balance. As we saw earlier, there is a complex combination of rhythms throughout these movements. The ongoing circulation of water from the ocean to the land, and back again, exemplifies these various compensating actions that maintain an average despite all the irregularities caused by their interactions. In this, as in other third-order equilibrations, we see that the energy being dissipated at any moment is continuously replenished from external sources: the fluctuations in supply are balanced by fluctuations in expenditure, as shown by the correlation between magnetic variations and the solar spots cycle. However, the main point for us to note is that this process must continue bringing things closer to complete stillness. These mechanical movements, including meteorological and geological ones, which are constantly being balanced, both temporarily through counter-movements and permanently through the dissipation of such movements and counter-movements, will slowly diminish as the amount of energy received from the Sun decreases. As the invisible motions coming from the center of our system weaken, the visible motions produced by them here must lessen; and at that distant time when the solar heat is no longer significant, there will be no noticeable redistribution of matter on the surface of our planet.
Thus from the highest point of view, all terrestrial changes are incidents in the course of cosmical equilibration. It was before pointed out, (§ 80) that of the incessant alterations which the Earth’s crust and atmosphere undergo, those which are not due to the still-progressing motion of the Earth’s substance towards its centre of gravity, are due to the still-progressing motion of the Sun’s substance towards its centre of gravity. Here it is to be remarked, that this continuance of integration in the Earth and in the Sun, is a continuance of 456that transformation of sensible motion into insensible motion which we have seen ends in equilibration; and that the arrival in each case at the extreme of integration, is the arrival at a state in which no more sensible motion remains to be transformed into insensible motion—a state in which the forces producing integration and the forces opposing integration, have become equal.
Thus, from the highest perspective, all changes on Earth are events in the process of cosmic balance. It was previously mentioned, (§ 80) that of the constant changes that the Earth's crust and atmosphere experience, those that aren't caused by the ongoing movement of the Earth's material toward its center of gravity are caused by the ongoing movement of the Sun's material toward its center of gravity. It's important to note that this continued integration in both the Earth and the Sun represents a continued transformation of visible motion into invisible motion, which we've seen ultimately leads to balance. The point of reaching the maximum level of integration in each case represents a state where no visible motion remains to be transformed into invisible motion—a state where the forces causing integration and the forces resisting integration have become equal.
§ 133. Every living body exhibits, in a four-fold form, the process we are tracing out—exhibits it from moment to moment in the balancing of mechanical forces; from hour to hour in the balancing of functions; from year to year in the changes of state that compensate changes of condition; and finally in the complete arrest of vital movements at death. Let us consider the facts under these heads.
§ 133. Every living body shows, in a four-fold way, the process we are exploring—displaying it moment to moment in the balancing of mechanical forces; hour to hour in the balancing of functions; year to year in the changes of state that adjust to changes in condition; and finally in the total stop of vital movements at death. Let’s examine the facts under these topics.
The sensible motion constituting each visible action of an organism, is soon brought to a close by some adverse force within or without the organism. When the arm is raised, the motion given to it is antagonized partly by gravity and partly by the internal resistances consequent on structure; and its motion, thus suffering continual deduction, ends when the arm has reached a position at which the forces are equilibrated. The limits of each systole and diastole of the heart, severally show us a momentary equilibrium between muscular strains that produce opposite movements; and each gush of blood requires to be immediately followed by another, because the rapid dissipation of its momentum would otherwise soon bring the mass of circulating fluid to a stand. As much in the actions and re-actions going on among the internal organs, as in the mechanical balancing of the whole body, there is at every instant a progressive equilibration of the motions at every instant produced. Viewed in their aggregate, and as forming a series, the organic functions constitute a dependent moving equilibrium—a moving equilibrium, of which the motive power is ever being dissipated through the special equilibrations just exemplified, and is ever 457being renewed by the taking in of additional motive power. Food is a store of force which continually adds to the momentum of the vital actions, as much as is continually deducted from them by the forces overcome. All the functional movements thus maintained, are, as we have seen, rhythmical (§ 96); by their union compound rhythms of various lengths and complexities are produced; and in these simple and compound rhythms, the process of equilibration, besides being exemplified at each extreme of every rhythm, is seen in the habitual preservation of a constant mean, and in the re-establishment of that mean when accidental causes have produced divergence from it. When, for instance, there is a great expenditure of motion through muscular activity, there arises a re-active demand on those stores of latent motion which are laid up in the form of consumable matter throughout the tissues: increased respiration and increased rapidity of circulation, are instrumental to an extra genesis of force, that counter-balances the extra dissipation of force. This unusual transformation of molecular motion into sensible motion, is presently followed by an unusual absorption of food—the source of molecular motion; and in proportion as there has been a prolonged draft upon the spare capital of the system, is there a tendency to a prolonged rest, during which that spare capital is replaced. If the deviation from the ordinary course of the functions has been so great as to derange them, as when violent exertion produces loss of appetite and loss of sleep, an equilibration is still eventually effected. Providing the disturbance is not such as to overturn the balance of the functions, and destroy life (in which case a complete equilibration is suddenly effected), the ordinary balance is by and by re-established: the returning appetite is keen in proportion as the waste has been large; while sleep, sound and prolonged, makes up for previous wakefulness. Not even in those extreme cases where some excess has wrought a derangement that is never wholly rectified, is there an exception to the general law; for in such cases the cycle of the functions is, after a time, equilibrated about a new 458mean state, which thenceforth becomes the normal state of the individual. Thus, among the involved rhythmical changes constituting organic life, any disturbing force that works an excess of change in some direction, is gradually diminished and finally neutralized by antagonistic forces; which thereupon work a compensating change in the opposite direction, and so, after more or less of oscillation, restore the medium condition. And this process it is, which constitutes what physicians call the vis medicatrix naturæ. The third form of equilibration displayed by organic bodies, is a necessary sequence of that just illustrated. When through a change of habit or circumstance, an organism is permanently subject to some new influence, or different amount of an old influence, there arises, after more or less disturbance of the organic rhythms, a balancing of them around the new average condition produced by this additional influence. As temporary divergences of the organic rhythms are counteracted by temporary divergences of a reverse kind; so there is an equilibration of their permanent divergences by the genesis of opposing divergences that are equally permanent. If the quantity of motion to be habitually generated by a muscle, becomes greater than before, its nutrition becomes greater than before. If the expenditure of the muscle bears to its nutrition, a greater ratio than expenditure bears to nutrition in other parts of the system; the excess of nutrition becomes such that the muscle grows. And the cessation of its growth is the establishment of a balance between the daily waste and the daily repair—the daily expenditure of force, and the amount of latent force daily added. The like must manifestly be the case with all organic modifications consequent on change of climate or food. This is a conclusion which we may safely draw without knowing the special re-arrangements that effect the equilibration. If we see that a different mode of life is followed, after a period of functional derangement, by some altered condition of the system—if we see that this altered condition, becoming by and by established, continues 459without further change; we have no alternative but to say, that the new forces brought to bear on the system, have been compensated by the opposing forces they have evoked. And this is the interpretation of the process which we call adaptation. Finally, each organism illustrates the law in the ensemble of its life. At the outset it daily absorbs under the form of food, an amount of force greater than it daily expends; and the surplus is daily equilibrated by growth. As maturity is approached, this surplus diminishes; and in the perfect organism, the day’s absorption of potential motion balances the day’s expenditure of actual motion. That is to say, during adult life, there is continuously exhibited an equilibration of the third order. Eventually, the daily loss, beginning to out-balance the daily gain, there results a diminishing amount of functional action; the organic rhythms extend less and less widely on each side of the medium state; and there finally results that complete equilibration which we call death.
The sensible movement that makes up every visible action of an organism is quickly brought to a halt by some opposing force, whether inside or outside the organism. When the arm is lifted, its motion is resisted partly by gravity and partly by internal structural resistance; and this motion, continually reduced, stops when the arm is in a position where the forces are balanced. Each systole and diastole of the heart shows us a momentary balance between conflicting muscular strains that create opposing movements; and every pulse of blood needs to be quickly followed by another because if its momentum quickly dissipates, the flow of circulating fluid will grind to a halt. Whether it's the activities and reactions happening among the internal organs or the mechanical balancing of the whole body, there is a constant, progressive balancing of motions at every moment. Viewed together, and as a series, the organic functions create a dependent moving balance—a moving balance, where the driving force is constantly being drained through the specific balances just discussed while being renewed by the intake of additional energy. Food serves as a source of energy that continually boosts the momentum of vital actions, just as it is continuously being reduced by the forces being worked against. All these functional movements, as we have seen, are rhythmic; by combining, they create complex rhythms of various lengths and intricacies; and within these simple and complex rhythms, the process of balance, apart from being shown at each extreme of every rhythm, is evident in the habitual maintenance of a consistent average, and in the restoration of that average when unexpected factors cause deviation from it. For example, when there is a significant expenditure of energy through muscle activity, there is a reactive demand on the reserves of latent energy stored as consumable matter throughout the tissues: increased breathing and faster circulation help generate extra energy to counterbalance the additional energy loss. This unusual conversion of molecular energy into visible motion is quickly followed by an increased intake of food—the source of molecular energy; and to the degree that there has been a sustained draw on the system's spare reserves, there is a tendency to require a longer rest, during which those reserves are replenished. If the disruption from the normal function has been so severe that it disturbs them, as when intense exertion leads to a loss of appetite and sleep, a balance is still eventually restored. As long as the disturbance isn't enough to completely upset the balance of functions and endanger life (in which case complete balance is suddenly achieved), the usual balance will eventually be re-established: the regained appetite is sharper the more significant the loss has been; while deep and extended sleep compensates for any previous wakefulness. Even in extreme cases where some excess has caused a disturbance that is never entirely corrected, there is no exception to the general rule; rather, in such cases, the cycle of functions will, after some time, stabilize around a new average state, which then becomes the individual's new normal state. Therefore, among the complex rhythmic changes that define organic life, any disruptive force that causes an excess of change in one direction is gradually lessened and ultimately neutralized by opposing forces, which then induce a compensating change in the opposite direction, and so, after some fluctuation, restore the average condition. This process is what doctors refer to as the *vis medicatrix naturæ*. The third form of balance shown by organic bodies is a necessary consequence of that which was just described. When, due to a change in habits or circumstances, an organism is permanently influenced by a new factor or a different level of an old factor, after some disturbance in the organic rhythms, they balance out around the new average condition created by this new influence. Just as temporary disruptions of the organic rhythms are counteracted by temporary disruptions in the opposite direction, there is also a balance of their permanent divergences through the creation of opposing divergences that are also permanent. If a muscle is required to generate more energy than before, its nutrition increases accordingly. If the muscle's energy expenditure compared to its nutrition is higher than other parts of the system, this excess in nutrition leads to muscle growth. The cessation of this growth signals a balance between daily energy losses and daily repairs—the daily energy expenditure and the daily addition of latent energy. The same logic applies to all organic changes resulting from alterations in climate or diet. This is a conclusion we can confidently draw without knowing the specific rearrangements that create this balance. When we observe that a different lifestyle, after a period of functional disruption, results in some altered state of the system—if we see this altered state becoming established without further change; we have no choice but to conclude that the new forces acting on the system have been counterbalanced by the opposing forces they triggered. This is our understanding of the process we call *adaptation*. Finally, each organism exemplifies this law in the *ensemble* of its life. Initially, it absorbs more energy in the form of food than it expends each day; the surplus is balanced out by growth. As maturity approaches, this surplus decreases; and in a fully developed organism, the daily absorption of potential energy exactly balances the daily expenditure of actual energy. This means that during adult life, a continuous display of the third-order balance is evident. Eventually, as daily losses begin to exceed daily gains, there is a reduction in functional activity; the organic rhythms fluctuate less and less on either side of the average state; and eventually, this leads to the complete balance we refer to as death.
The ultimate structural state accompanying that ultimate functional state towards which an organism tends, both individually and as a species, may be deduced from one of the propositions set down in the opening section of this chapter. We saw that the limit of heterogeneity is arrived at whenever the equilibration of any aggregate becomes complete—that the re-distribution of matter can continue so long only as there continues any motion unbalanced. Whence we found it to follow that the final structural arrangements, must be such as will meet all the forces acting on the aggregate, by equivalent antagonist forces. What is the implication in the case of organic aggregates; the equilibrium of which is a moving one? We have seen that the maintenance of such a moving equilibrium, requires the habitual genesis of internal forces corresponding in number, directions, and amounts to the external incident forces—as many inner functions, single or combined, as there are single or combined outer actions to be met. But functions are the correlatives of organs; amounts 460of functions are, other things equal, the correlatives of sizes of organs; and combinations of functions the correlatives of connections of organs. Hence the structural complexity accompanying functional equilibration, is definable as one in which there are as many specialized parts as are capable, separately and jointly, of counteracting the separate and joint forces amid which the organism exists. And this is the limit of organic heterogeneity; to which man has approached more nearly than any other creature.
The ultimate structural state that goes along with the ultimate functional state an organism strives for, both as individuals and as a species, can be inferred from one of the ideas presented in the first section of this chapter. We observed that the limit of diversity is reached when the balance of any group becomes complete—that the redistribution of matter can only continue as long as there is any unbalanced motion. From this, we concluded that the final structural arrangements must be such that they respond to all the forces acting on the group with equivalent opposing forces. What does this mean for organic groups, whose balance is dynamic? We have seen that maintaining such a dynamic equilibrium requires the regular creation of internal forces that match the external forces in number, direction, and magnitude—as many internal functions, whether alone or in combination, as there are external actions to address. But functions relate to organs; the quantity of functions typically relates to the size of organs; and combinations of functions relate to how organs are connected. Therefore, the structural complexity that comes with functional balance is defined as one that has as many specialized parts as are needed, both individually and together, to counteract the various internal and external forces that the organism faces. This is the limit of organic diversity, which humans have approached more closely than any other creature.
Groups of organisms display this universal tendency towards a balance very obviously. In § 96, every species of plant and animal was shown to be perpetually undergoing a rhythmical variation in number—now from abundance of food and absence of enemies rising above its average; and then by a consequent scarcity of food and abundance of enemies being depressed below its average. And here we have to observe that there is thus maintained an equilibrium between the sum of those forces which result in the increase of each race, and the sum of those forces which result in its decrease. Either limit of variation is a point at which the one set of forces, before in excess of the other, is counterbalanced by it. And amid these oscillations produced by their conflict, lies that average number of the species at which its expansive tendency is in equilibrium with surrounding repressive tendencies. Nor can it be questioned that this balancing of the preservative and destructive forces which we see going on in every race, must necessarily go on. Since increase of number cannot but continue until increase of mortality stops it; and decrease of number cannot but continue until it is either arrested by fertility or extinguishes the race entirely.
Groups of living organisms clearly show a universal tendency to maintain balance. In § 96, it was demonstrated that every species of plant and animal constantly experiences rhythmic changes in population—sometimes increasing above average due to plenty of food and few predators, and at other times decreasing below average due to limited food and an abundance of predators. It’s important to note that this creates a balance between the forces that drive the growth of each species and those that drive its decline. Each limit of change represents a point where one set of forces, previously stronger, is balanced by the other. Within these fluctuations caused by their interactions lies the average population of the species, where its growth potential balances out the surrounding limiting factors. It's also undeniable that this balancing act between preserving and destructive forces is ongoing in every species. Population growth will continue until an increase in mortality interrupts it, while a population decrease will persist until it is either halted by reproductive increases or leads to the species’ complete extinction.
§ 134. The equilibrations of those nervous actions which constitute what we know as mental life, may be classified in like manner with those which constitute what we distinguish 461as bodily life. We may deal with them in the same order.
§ 134. The balancing of those nervous actions that make up what we understand as mental life can be categorized similarly to those that comprise what we refer to as bodily life. We can address them in the same sequence. 461
Each pulse of nervous force from moment to moment generated, (and it was shown in § 97 that nervous currents are not continuous but rhythmical) is met by counteracting forces; in overcoming which it is dispersed and equilibrated. When tracing out the correlation and equivalence of forces, we saw that each sensation and emotion, or rather such part of it as remains after the excitation of associated ideas and feelings, is expended in working bodily changes—contractions of the involuntary muscles, the voluntary muscles, or both; as also in a certain stimulation of secreting organs. That the movements thus initiated are ever being brought to a close by the opposing forces they evoke, was pointed out above; and here it is to be observed that the like holds with the nervous changes thus initiated. Various facts prove that the arousing of a thought or feeling, always involves the overcoming of a certain resistance: instance the fact that where the association of mental states has not been frequent, a sensible effort is needed to call up the one after the other; instance the fact that during nervous prostration there is a comparative inability to think—the ideas will not follow one another with the habitual rapidity; instance the converse fact that at times of unusual energy, natural or artificial, the friction of thought becomes relatively small, and more numerous, more remote, or more difficult connections of ideas are formed. That is to say, the wave of nervous energy each instant generated, propagates itself throughout body and brain, along those channels which the conditions at the instant render lines of least resistance; and spreading widely in proportion to its amount, ends only when it is equilibrated by the resistances it everywhere meets. If we contemplate mental actions us extending over hours and days, we discover equilibrations analogous to those hourly and daily established among the bodily functions. In the one case as in the other, there are 462rhythms which exhibit a balancing of opposing forces at each extreme, and the maintenance of a certain general balance. This is seen in the daily alternation of mental activity and mental rest—the forces expended during the one being compensated by the forces acquired during the other. It is also seen in the recurring rise and fall of each desire: each desire reaching a certain intensity, is equilibrated either by expenditure of the force it embodies, in the desired actions, or, less completely, in the imagination of such actions: the process ending in that satiety, or that comparative quiescence, forming the opposite limit of the rhythm. And it is further manifest under a two-fold form, on occasions of intense joy or grief: each paroxysm of passion, expressing itself in vehement bodily actions, presently reaches an extreme whence the counteracting forces produce a return to a condition of moderate excitement; and the successive paroxysms finally diminishing in intensity, end in a mental equilibrium either like that before existing, or partially differing from it in its medium state. But the species of mental equilibration to be more especially noted, is that shown in the establishment of a correspondence between relations among our states of consciousness and relations in the external world. Each outer connection of phenomena which we are capable of perceiving, generates, through accumulated experiences, an inner connection of mental states; and the result towards which this process tends, is the formation of a mental connection having a relative strength that answers to the relative constancy of the physical connection represented. In conformity with the general law that motion pursues the line of least resistance, and that, other things equal, a line once taken by motion is made a line that will be more readily pursued by future motion; we have seen that the ease with which nervous impressions follow one another, is, other things equal, great in proportion to the number of times they have been repeated together in experience. Hence, corresponding to such an invariable relation as that between the resistance of an object and some extension possessed 463by it, there arises an indissoluble connection in consciousness; and this connection, being as absolute internally as the answering one is externally, undergoes no further change—the inner relation is in perfect equilibrium with the outer relation. Conversely, it hence happens that to such uncertain relations of phenomena as that between clouds and rain, there arise relations of ideas of a like uncertainty; and if, under given aspects of the sky, the tendencies to infer fair or foul weather, correspond to the frequencies with which fair or foul weather follow such aspects, the accumulation of experiences has balanced the mental sequences and the physical sequences. When it is remembered that between these extremes there are countless orders of external connections having different degrees of constancy, and that during the evolution of intelligence there arise answering internal associations having different degrees of cohesion; it will be seen that there is a progress towards equilibrium between the relations of thought and the relations of things. This equilibration can end only when each relation of things has generated in us a relation of thought, such that on the occurrence of the conditions, the relation in thought arises as certainly as the relation in things. Supposing this state to be reached (which however it can be only in infinite time) experience will cease to produce any further mental evolution—there will have been reached a perfect correspondence between ideas and facts; and the intellectual adaptation of man to his circumstances will be complete. The like general truths are exhibited in the process moral of adaptation; which is a continual approach to equilibrium between the emotions and the kinds of conduct necessitated by surrounding conditions. The connections of feelings and actions, are determined in the same way as the connections of ideas: just as repeating the association of two ideas, facilitates the excitement of the one by the other; so does each discharge of feeling into action, render the subsequent discharge of such feeling into such action more easy. Hence it happens that if an individual is placed 464permanently in conditions which demand more action of a special kind than has before been requisite, or than is natural to him—if the pressure of the painful feelings which these conditions entail when disregarded, impels him to perform this action to a greater extent—if by every more frequent or more lengthened performance of it under such pressure, the resistance is somewhat diminished; then, clearly, there is an advance towards a balance between the demand for this kind of action and the supply of it. Either in himself, or in his descendants continuing to live under these conditions, enforced repetition must eventually bring about a state in which this mode of directing the energies will be no more repugnant than the various other modes previously natural to the race. Hence the limit towards which emotional modification perpetually tends, and to which it must approach indefinitely near (though it can absolutely reach it only in infinite time) is a combination of desires that correspond to all the different orders of activity which the circumstances of life call for—desires severally proportionate in strength to the needs for these orders of activity; and severally satisfied by these orders of activity. In what we distinguish as acquired habits, and in the moral differences of races and nations produced by habits that are maintained through successive generations, we have countless illustrations of this progressive adaptation; which can cease only with the establishment of a complete equilibrium between constitution and conditions.
Each pulse of nervous energy generated moment by moment (and it was shown in § 97 that nervous currents aren't continuous but rhythmic) is met with opposing forces; when it overcomes these forces, it is dispersed and balanced out. In examining the relationship and equivalence of forces, we noted that every sensation and emotion—more specifically, the portion that remains after the activation of related ideas and feelings—is expended in causing physical changes—contractions of involuntary muscles, voluntary muscles, or both; as well as in stimulating secreting organs. It was mentioned earlier that the movements initiated by these sensations are continuously neutralized by the opposing forces they generate; and it's important to note that the same applies to the nervous changes that arise. Various facts demonstrate that triggering a thought or feeling always requires overcoming a certain degree of resistance: for example, if the association of mental states hasn't occurred frequently, it takes noticeable effort to bring one thought after another; during times of nervous exhaustion, there’s a relative inability to think—the ideas don’t flow as quickly as usual; conversely, during periods of unusual energy, whether natural or artificial, the friction of thought is relatively minimal, allowing for more numerous, more distant, or more complex connections between ideas to form. That is to say, the wave of nervous energy generated each moment spreads throughout the body and brain along the paths that the circumstances at that moment create as the routes of least resistance; and it disperses broadly in proportion to its strength, only ending when it is balanced by the resistances it encounters everywhere. If we consider mental actions extending over hours and days, we discover equilibrations similar to those established among bodily functions every hour and day. In both cases, there are rhythms showing a balance of opposing forces at each extreme, maintaining a certain overall balance. This is observed in the daily rhythm of mental activity and rest—the energy spent during one is balanced by the energy restored during the other. It’s also seen in the recurring rise and fall of each desire: each desire, reaching a certain intensity, is balanced either by the force used in pursuing the desired actions or, less completely, in envisioning those actions. This process culminates in a sense of satiety or a relatively calm state, representing the opposite limit of the rhythm. It is further evident in two forms during intense joy or grief: each episode of passion, expressed through strong physical actions, eventually reaches a peak from which opposing forces induce a return to a condition of moderate excitement; and the successive episodes, ultimately lessening in intensity, conclude in a mental balance that either resembles the previous state or partially differs from it in its average condition. However, the particular type of mental balance worth noting is that which establishes a correspondence between the relationships among our conscious states and the relationships in the outside world. Each external connection of phenomena we can perceive generates, through accumulated experience, an inner connection of mental states; and this process aims at forming a mental connection that has a strength relative to the consistency of the physical connection it represents. In line with the general principle that motion follows the path of least resistance, and that a line taken by motion tends to be followed by future motions under similar conditions, we have seen that the ease with which nervous impressions succeed one another is greater, all else being equal, in proportion to the number of times they've been paired in experience. Thus, corresponding to an unchanging relationship like that between an object's resistance and its extension, an unbreakable connection emerges in consciousness; and this connection, being just as absolute internally as the matching one is externally, undergoes no further change—the internal relationship is in perfect balance with the external relationship. Conversely, this leads to uncertain relationships of phenomena, like that between clouds and rain, generating uncertain relationships of ideas as well; if, under certain sky conditions, the tendencies to predict good or bad weather overlap with the frequencies of good or bad weather following such conditions, then the accumulation of experiences balances the mental sequences with the physical ones. When we remember that between these extremes, there's a multitude of external connections with varying degrees of constancy, and that as intelligence evolves, corresponding internal associations with differing cohesion arise, it becomes clear that there's progress toward equilibrium between thought relationships and external relationships. This balance can only be achieved when each relationship of things generates a corresponding thought relationship such that, under the right conditions, the thought relationship emerges as certainly as the relationship in the tangible world. Assuming this state is achieved (which can only occur over infinite time), experience will halt any further mental evolution—achieving a perfect alignment between ideas and facts; thus, the intellectual adaptation of humans to their circumstances will be complete. Similar overarching truths are evident in the moral process of adaptation, which is a continual move toward equilibrium between emotions and the types of behavior required by surrounding conditions. The connections between feelings and actions are determined just like the connections between ideas: just as repeatedly associating two ideas makes it easier to activate one through the other, so does each release of feeling into action make the subsequent release of that feeling into that action easier. Hence, if someone is put in situations that require more action of a particular type than has been needed before or is natural to them—if the strain of the painful feelings that arise when these conditions are ignored pushes them to perform this action more frequently—if the resistance is somewhat lowered with each more frequent or prolonged performance, then it's clear there's a move toward a balance between the demand for this type of action and its supply. Whether in the individual or in their descendants who continue living under these conditions, enforced repetition will eventually result in a state in which this way of channeling energy is no less acceptable than the various other methods previously natural to the species. Therefore, the limit toward which emotional modification constantly strives—and to which it will approach ever closer, though it can only reach it absolutely in infinite time—is a combination of desires that aligns with all the different types of activity that life’s circumstances require—desires proportionate in strength to the needs for these activities and equally satisfied by these forms of activity. In what we recognize as acquired habits and in the moral distinctions of races and nations shaped by habits maintained across generations, we have countless examples of this ongoing adaptation, which can only cease with the establishment of complete equilibrium between constitution and conditions.
Possibly some will fail to see how the equilibrations described in this section, can be classed with those preceding them; and will be inclined to say that what are here set down as facts, are but analogies. Nevertheless such equilibrations are as truly physical as the rest. To show this fully, would require a more detailed analysis than can now be entered on. For the present it must suffice to point out, as before (§ 82), that what we know subjectively as states of 465consciousness, are, objectively, modes of force; that so much feeling is the correlate of so much motion; that the performance of any bodily action is the transformation of a certain amount of feeling into its equivalent amount of motion; that this bodily action is met by forces which it is expended in overcoming; and that the necessity for the frequent repetition of this action, implies the frequent recurrence of forces to be so overcome. Hence the existence in any individual of an emotional stimulus that is in equilibrium with certain external requirements, is literally the habitual production of a certain specialized portion of nervous energy, equivalent in amount to a certain order of external resistances that are habitually met. And thus the ultimate state, forming the limit towards which Evolution carries us, is one in which the kinds and quantities of mental energy daily generated and transformed into motions, are equivalent to, or in equilibrium with, the various orders and degrees of surrounding forces which antagonize such motions.
Some people might not see how the equilibrations discussed in this section relate to those mentioned earlier and might argue that what’s listed here as facts are just analogies. However, these equilibrations are just as physical as the others. To fully demonstrate this would require a more detailed analysis than we can provide right now. For now, it’s enough to point out, as stated before (§ 82), that what we experience subjectively as states of consciousness are, objectively, modes of force; that a certain amount of feeling correlates with a certain amount of motion; that performing any physical action transforms a specific amount of feeling into an equivalent amount of motion; that this physical action is met with forces that it must overcome; and that the need to frequently repeat this action indicates the regular presence of forces that need to be overcome. Therefore, the emotional stimulus present in an individual that is balanced with specific external demands is essentially the consistent production of a particular amount of nervous energy, equivalent to a certain level of external resistances that are regularly faced. Ultimately, the state we are evolving toward is one in which the types and amounts of mental energy generated and transformed into motions daily are equal to, or in balance with, the various types and degrees of surrounding forces that oppose such motions.
§ 135. Each society taken as a whole, displays the process of equilibration in the continuous adjustment of its population to its means of subsistence. A tribe of men living on wild animals and fruits, is manifestly, like every tribe of inferior creatures, always oscillating about that average number which the locality can support. Though by artificial production, and by successive improvements in artificial production, a superior race continually alters the limit which external conditions put to population; yet there is ever a checking of population at the temporary limit reached. It is true that where the limit is being so rapidly changed as among ourselves, there is no actual stoppage: there is only a rhythmical variation in the rate of increase. But in noting the causes of this rhythmical variation—in watching how, during periods of abundance, the proportion of marriages increases, and how it decreases during periods of scarcity; it will be seen that the 466expansive force produces unusual advance whenever the repressive force diminishes, and vice versâ; and thus there is as near a balancing of the two as the changing conditions permit.
§ 135. Every society as a whole shows the process of balancing as it continuously adjusts its population to its means of survival. A tribe of people living off wild animals and fruits is clearly, like every tribe of lower creatures, always fluctuating around the average number that the area can support. Although a superior race constantly changes the limits imposed on population by external conditions through artificial production and ongoing improvements in that production, there is always some restriction on population at the temporary limit reached. It’s true that in situations where the limit is changing rapidly, like in our case, there is no actual halt; there’s just a rhythmic variation in the rate of growth. But by observing the causes of this rhythmic variation—seeing how, during times of plenty, the number of marriages goes up and how it goes down during times of scarcity—it becomes clear that the expanding force creates an unusual surge whenever the repressive force lessens, and vice versa; thus, there is a balancing act between the two as close as changing conditions allow.
The internal actions constituting social functions, exemplify the general principle no less clearly. Supply and demand are continually being adjusted throughout all industrial processes; and this equilibration is interpretable in the same way as preceding ones. The production and distribution of a commodity, is the expression of a certain aggregate of forces causing special kinds and amounts of motion. The price of this commodity, is the measure of a certain other aggregate of forces expended by the labourer who purchases it, in other kinds and amounts of motion. And the variations of price represent a rhythmical balancing of these forces. Every rise or fall in the rate of interest, or change in the value of a particular security, implies a conflict of forces in which some, becoming temporarily predominant, cause a movement that is presently arrested or equilibrated by the increase of opposing forces; and amid these daily and hourly oscillations, lies a more slowly-varying medium, into which the value ever tends to settle; and would settle but for the constant addition of new influences. As in the individual organism so in the social organism, functional equilibrations generate structural equilibrations. When on the workers in any trade there comes an increased demand, and when in return for the increased supply, there is given to them an amount of other commodities larger than was before habitual—when, consequently, the resistances overcome by them in sustaining life are less than the resistances overcome by other workers; there results a flow of other workers into this trade. This flow continues until the extra demand is met, and the wages so far fall again, that the total resistance overcome in obtaining a given amount of produce, is as great in this newly-adopted occupation as in the occupations whence it drew recruits. The occurrence of motion along lines of least resistance, was before shown to necessitate the growth 467of population in those places where the labour required for self-maintenance is the smallest; and here we further see that those engaged in any such advantageous locality, or advantageous business, must multiply till there arises an approximate balance between this locality or business and others accessible to the same citizens. In determining the career of every youth, we see an estimation by parents of the respective advantages offered by all that are available, and a choice of the one which promises best; and through the consequent influx into trades that are at the time most profitable, and the withholding of recruits from over-stocked trades, there is insured a general equipoise between the power of each social organ and the function it has to perform.
The internal actions that make up social functions clearly illustrate the overall principle. Supply and demand are constantly being adjusted in all industrial processes, and this balancing act can be understood similarly to previous examples. The production and distribution of a commodity reflect a specific combination of forces that create particular types and amounts of movement. The price of this commodity represents another set of forces put forth by the worker buying it, in different types and amounts of movement. Fluctuations in price indicate a rhythmic balancing of these forces. Every rise or fall in interest rates or changes in the value of a specific security suggest a struggle of forces where some temporarily take the lead, causing a movement that is soon stopped or balanced out by the increase of opposing forces. Amid these daily and hourly changes, there exists a more slowly changing average that the value tends to settle into, which would stabilize if not for the ongoing introduction of new influences. Just as in individual organisms, in social organisms, functional balances lead to structural balances. When there’s an increased demand for workers in a particular trade, and in exchange for the increased supply, they receive a larger quantity of other commodities than they previously did—meaning the challenges they face to sustain their lives are less than those overcome by workers in other fields—this results in an influx of workers into that trade. This migration continues until the additional demand is fulfilled, and wages drop to a point where the overall challenges faced in obtaining a certain amount of goods are similar in this new occupation as in the ones that previously attracted new workers. The movement along paths of least resistance necessitates population growth in places where the labor needed for self-support is minimal. Here, we also observe that those in a favorable location or advantageous business must multiply until a balance is reached between that location or business and others accessible to the same people. When determining the future of every young person, parents evaluate the respective advantages of all available options and choose the one that seems most promising. Through this resulting influx into currently profitable trades and the lack of new workers in oversaturated trades, a general balance is maintained between the ability of each social organ and its function.
The various industrial actions and re-actions thus continually alternating, constitute a dependent moving equilibrium like that which is maintained among the functions of an individual organism. And this dependent moving equilibrium parallels those already contemplated, in its tendency to become more complete. During early stages of social evolution, while yet the resources of the locality inhabited are unexplored, and the arts of production undeveloped, there is never anything more than a temporary and partial balancing of such actions, under the form of acceleration or retardation of growth. But when a society approaches the maturity of that type on which it is organized, the various industrial activities settle down into a comparatively constant state. Moreover, it is observable that advance in organization, as well as advance in growth, is conducive to a better equilibrium of industrial functions. While the diffusion of mercantile information is slow, and the means of transport deficient, the adjustment of supply to demand is extremely imperfect: great over-production of each commodity followed by great under-production, constitute a rhythm having extremes that depart very widely from the mean state in which demand and supply are equilibrated. But when good roads are made, and there is a rapid diffusion of 468printed or written intelligence, and still more when railways and telegraphs come into existence—when the periodical fairs of early days lapse into weekly markets, and these into daily markets; there is gradually produced a better balance of production and consumption. Extra demand is much more quickly followed by augmented supply; and the rapid oscillations of price within narrow limits on either side of a comparatively uniform mean, indicate a near approach to equilibrium. Evidently this industrial progress has for its limit, that which Mr. Mill has called “the stationary state.” When population shall have become dense over all habitable parts of the globe; when the resources of every region have been fully explored; and when the productive arts admit of no further improvements; there must result an almost complete balance, both between the fertility and mortality of each society, and between its producing and consuming activities. Each society will exhibit only minor deviations from its average number, and the rhythm of its industrial functions will go on from day to day and year to year with comparatively insignificant perturbations. This limit, however, though we are inevitably advancing towards it, is indefinitely remote; and can never indeed be absolutely reached. The peopling of the Earth up to the point supposed, cannot take place by simple spreading. In the future, as in the past, the process will be carried on rhythmically, by waves of emigration from new and higher centres of civilization successively arising; and by the supplanting of inferior races by the superior races they beget; and the process so carried on must be extremely slow. Nor does it seem to me that such an equilibration will, as Mr. Mill suggests, leave scope for further mental culture and moral progress; but rather that the approximation to it must be simultaneous with the approximation to complete equilibrium between man’s nature and the conditions of his existence.
The various industrial actions and reactions constantly alternate, creating a dependent moving equilibrium similar to that found in the functions of an individual organism. This dependent moving equilibrium is like those previously discussed, as it tends to become more complete. In the early stages of social evolution, while the resources of the area are still unexplored and production methods are not yet developed, there’s only a temporary and partial balance of these actions, manifesting as acceleration or retardation of growth. However, as a society reaches the maturity appropriate to its organization, different industrial activities stabilize into a relatively constant state. It’s also noticeable that improvements in organization and growth help achieve a better balance of industrial functions. When the spread of market information is slow and transportation options are limited, the alignment of supply with demand is highly imperfect: significant overproduction of goods is often followed by significant underproduction, creating a rhythm with extremes that diverge greatly from the mean state where supply and demand are balanced. But once good roads are established, information spreads quickly through printed or written means, and even more so when railways and telegraphs are introduced—when the periodic fairs of the past give way to weekly markets and those to daily markets—a better alignment of production and consumption gradually emerges. Extra demand is responded to much more swiftly with increased supply, and the quick fluctuations in prices within narrow ranges on either side of a relatively stable average indicate a near approach to equilibrium. Clearly, this industrial progress has a limit, which Mr. Mill referred to as “the stationary state.” When the population becomes dense across all habitable areas of the planet, when every region's resources have been fully explored, and when production methods can’t be improved any further, there will be an almost complete balance between fertility and mortality in each society, as well as between its production and consumption activities. Each society will show only minor variations from its average population, and the rhythm of its industrial functions will continue day by day and year by year with relatively insignificant fluctuations. However, this limit, although we are inevitably moving toward it, is indefinitely distant and can never truly be reached. The population of the Earth up to this point cannot occur by just spreading out. In the future, as in the past, this process will happen rhythmically, in waves of emigration from new and advanced centers of civilization that arise successively, and by the replacement of inferior races by the superior ones they produce; and this ongoing process will be very gradual. I also don’t think that this equilibration will, as Mr. Mill suggests, allow room for further intellectual or moral development; rather, it seems that approaching this state must coincide with a similar approach to complete balance between human nature and the conditions of existence.
One other kind of social equilibration has still to be considered:—that 469which results in the establishment of governmental institutions, and which becomes complete as these institutions fall into harmony with the desires of the people. There is a demand and supply in political affairs as in industrial affairs; and in the one case as in the other, the antagonist forces produce a rhythm which, at first extreme in its oscillations, slowly settles down into a moving equilibrium of comparative regularity. Those aggressive impulses inherited from the pre-social state—those tendencies to seek self-satisfaction regardless of injury to other beings, which are essential to a predatory life, constitute an anti-social force, tending ever to cause conflict and eventual separation of citizens. Contrariwise, those desires whose ends can be achieved only by union, as well as those sentiments which find satisfaction through intercourse with fellow-men, and those resulting in what we call loyalty, are forces tending to keep the units of a society together. On the one hand, there is in each citizen, more or less of resistance against all restraints imposed on his actions by other citizens: a resistance which, tending continually to widen each individual’s sphere of action, and reciprocally to limit the spheres of action of other individuals, constitutes a repulsive force mutually exercised by the members of a social aggregate. On the other hand, the general sympathy of man for man, and the more special sympathy of each variety of man for others of the same variety, together with sundry allied feelings which the social state gratifies, act as an attractive force, tending ever to keep united those who have a common ancestry. And since the resistances to be overcome in satisfying the totality of their desires when living separately, are greater than the resistances to be overcome in satisfying the totality of their desires when living together, there is a residuary force that prevents their separation. Like all other opposing forces, those exerted by citizens on each other, are ever producing alternating movements, which, at first extreme, undergo a gradual diminution on the way to ultimate equilibrium. 470In small, undeveloped societies, marked rhythms result from these conflicting tendencies. A tribe whose members have held together for a generation or two, reaches a size at which it will not hold together; and on the occurrence of some event causing unusual antagonism among its members, divides. Each primitive nation, depending largely for its continued union on the character of its chief, exhibits wide oscillations between an extreme in which the subjects are under rigid restraint, and an extreme in which the restraint is not enough to prevent disorder. In more advanced nations of like type, we always find violent actions and reactions of the same essential nature—“despotism tempered by assassination,” characterizing a political state in which unbearable repression from time to time brings about a bursting of all bonds. In this familiar fact, that a period of tyranny is followed by a period of license and vice versâ, we see how these opposing forces are ever equilibrating each other; and we also see, in the tendency of such movements and counter-movements to become more moderate, how the equilibration progresses towards completeness. The conflicts between Conservatism (which stands for the restraints of society over the individual) and Reform (which stands for the liberty of the individual against society), fall within slowly approximating limits; so that the temporary predominance of either, produces a less marked deviation from the medium state. This process, now so far advanced among ourselves that the oscillations are comparatively unobtrusive, must go on till the balance between the antagonist forces approaches indefinitely near perfection. For, as we have already seen, the adaptation of man’s nature to the conditions of his existence, cannot cease until the internal forces which we know as feelings are in equilibrium with the external forces they encounter. And the establishment of this equilibrium, is the arrival at a state of human nature and social organization, such that the individual has no desires but those which may be satisfied without exceeding 471his proper sphere of action, while society maintains no restraints but those which the individual voluntarily respects. The progressive extension of the liberty of citizens, and the reciprocal removal of political restrictions, are the steps by which we advance towards this state. And the ultimate abolition of all limits to the freedom of each, save those imposed by the like freedom of all, must result from the complete equilibration between man’s desires and the conduct necessitated by surrounding conditions.
One more type of social balance needs to be considered: 469the one that leads to the establishment of government institutions, which becomes complete as these institutions align with the people's desires. There's a demand and supply in politics just like in business, and in both cases, opposing forces create a rhythm that initially swings wildly but gradually settles into a moving equilibrium of relative stability. The aggressive impulses inherited from our pre-social state—those tendencies to seek self-interest at the expense of others, which are essential for a predatory lifestyle—create an anti-social force that tends to cause conflict and eventual separation among citizens. On the flip side, those desires that can only be fulfilled through unity, alongside feelings that are satisfied through interaction with others, and those sentiments that lead to what we call loyalty, are forces that work to keep members of society together. On one side, each citizen has a degree of resistance against restraints imposed by others: a resistance that constantly aims to broaden each person's freedom while limiting the freedoms of others, creating a repulsive force experienced among members of a social group. On the other side, the general empathy people have for one another, combined with the more specific empathy that different groups have for their own kind, along with various feelings that the social state satisfies, act as an attractive force that works to unite those of common heritage. And because the obstacles to fulfilling their desires while living separately are greater than those when living together, there’s a leftover force that prevents their separation. Like all opposing forces, those exerted by citizens on each other create alternating movements, which, while initially extreme, gradually lessen as they approach ultimate balance. 470In smaller, less developed societies, distinct rhythms emerge from these conflicting tendencies. A tribe that has stayed together for a generation or two reaches a size where it can no longer hold together, and when something happens that causes unusual animosity among its members, it splits apart. Each primitive nation, heavily reliant on the character of its leader for its continued unity, shows significant swings between a state where subjects are under strict control and one where the lack of control leads to chaos. In more advanced nations of a similar type, we consistently see intense actions and reactions of the same essential nature—“tyranny softened by assassination,” characterizing a political situation where unbearable oppression occasionally results in a breakdown of all restraints. In this well-known pattern, where a period of oppression is followed by a period of freedom and vice versa, we see how these opposing forces are constantly balancing one another; and we can also observe, in the tendency of these movements and counter-movements to become more moderate, how the balancing progresses toward completion. The conflicts between Conservatism (which supports societal restraints on the individual) and Reform (which advocates for individual freedom against society) fall within slowly narrowing limits; thus, the temporary dominance of either leads to a less significant departure from the average state. This process, which has advanced so far among us that the fluctuations are relatively subtle, must continue until the balance between opposing forces approaches near perfection. For, as we’ve already noted, the adaptation of human nature to the conditions of existence cannot stop until the internal forces we know as feelings are in balance with the external forces they encounter. Establishing this balance means reaching a state of human nature and social organization where the individual has no desires other than those that can be fulfilled without exceeding his proper range of actions, while society imposes no restraints other than those that the individual voluntarily respects. The progressive expansion of individual freedoms, and the reciprocal removal of political limitations, are the steps we take toward this state. The ultimate elimination of all limits on the freedom of each person, except those imposed by the equal freedom of all, must result from the complete balancing between human desires and the actions necessitated by the surrounding conditions.
Of course in this case, as in the preceding ones, there is thus involved a limit to the increase of heterogeneity. A few pages back, we reached the conclusion that each advance in mental evolution, is the establishment of some further internal action, corresponding to some further external action—some additional connection of ideas or feelings, answering to some before unknown or unantagonized connection of phenomena. We inferred that each such new function, involving some new modification of structure, implies an increase of heterogeneity; and that thus, increase of heterogeneity must go on, while there remain any outer relations affecting the organism which are unbalanced by inner relations. Whence we saw it to follow that increase of heterogeneity can come to an end only as equilibration is completed. Evidently the like must simultaneously take place with society. Each increment of heterogeneity in the individual, must directly or indirectly involve, as cause or consequence, some increment of heterogeneity in the arrangements of the aggregate of individuals. And the limit to social complexity can be arrived at, only with the establishment of the equilibrium, just described, between social and individual forces.
Sure, in this case, just like in the earlier ones, there is a limit to the increase of diversity. A few pages back, we concluded that every step forward in mental evolution represents the establishment of some new internal action that corresponds to some new external action—some additional connection of ideas or feelings that responds to previously unknown or unchallenged connections of phenomena. We inferred that each new function, which involves some new modification of structure, implies an increase in diversity; and that this increase must continue as long as there are external relationships affecting the organism that aren't balanced by internal ones. Therefore, we saw that the increase in diversity can only end when equilibrium is achieved. Clearly, the same must happen within society. Each increase in diversity within an individual must, directly or indirectly, involve, as cause or effect, some increase in diversity in the structure of the collective of individuals. The limit to social complexity can only be reached with the establishment of the equilibrium described between social and individual forces.
§ 136. Here presents itself a final question, which has probably been taking a more or less distinct shape in the minds of many, while reading this chapter. “If Evolution of every kind, is an increase in complexity of structure and function 472that is incidental to the universal process of equilibration—if equilibration, passing through the gradually-perfected forms of moving equilibrium, must end in complete rest; what is the fate towards which all things tend? If the bodies constituting our Solar System are slowly dissipating the forces they possess—if the Sun is losing his heat at a rate which, though insignificant as stated in terms of our chronology, will tell in millions of years—if geologic and meteorologic processes cannot but diminish in activity as the Sun’s radiations diminish—if with the diminution of these radiations there must also go on a diminution in the quantity of vegetal and animal existence—if Man and Society, however high the degree of evolution at which they arrive, are similarly dependent on this supply of force that is gradually coming to an end—if thus the highest, equally with the lowest, terrestrial life, must eventually dwindle and disappear; are we not manifestly progressing towards omnipresent death? And have we thus to contemplate, as the out-come of things, a universe of extinct suns round which circle planets devoid of life?”
§ 136. A final question arises that many readers may have been considering while going through this chapter. “If Evolution, in all its forms, is about an increase in complexity of structure and function that comes about through the overall process of balancing—if balancing, moving through increasingly refined states of equilibrium, must ultimately lead to total stillness; what is the fate that everything is moving toward? If the bodies in our Solar System are gradually losing the forces they have—if the Sun is losing heat at a rate that, while small when considering our timeline, will have significant effects over millions of years—if geological and meteorological processes can only become less active as the Sun's radiations decrease—if this decline in radiation must also lead to a decrease in the amount of plant and animal life—if humanity and society, no matter how advanced they become, rely on this finite source of energy that is slowly running out—if thus both the highest and lowest forms of life on earth must eventually fade and vanish; are we not clearly moving toward universal death? And should we accept that the end result is a universe filled with extinct suns, around which orbit lifeless planets?”
That such a state must be the proximate end of the processes everywhere going on, seems beyond doubt. But the further question tacitly involved, whether this state will continue eternally, is quite a different one. To give a positive answer to this further question would be quite illegitimate; since to affirm any proposition into which unlimited time enters as one of the terms, is to affirm a proposition of which one term cannot be represented in consciousness—is to affirm an unthinkable proposition. At a first glance it may appear that the reverse conclusion must be equally illegitimate; and that so the question is altogether insoluble. But further consideration will show that this is not true. So long as the terms to which we confine our reasonings are finite, the finite conclusions reached are not necessarily illegitimate. Though, if the general argument, when carried out, left no apparent escape from the inference that the state of rest to 473which Evolution is carrying things, must, when arrived at, last for ever, this inference would be invalid, as transcending the scope of human intelligence; yet if, on pushing further the general argument, we bring out the inference that such a state will not last for ever, this inference is not necessarily invalid: since, by the hypothesis, it contains no terms necessarily transcending the scope of human intelligence. It is permissible therefore, to inquire, what are the probable ulterior results of this process which must bring Evolution to a close in Universal Death. Without being so rash as to form anything like a positive conclusion on a matter so vast and so far beyond the boundaries of exact science; we may still inquire what seems to be the remote future towards which the facts point.
That this state must be the likely outcome of the processes happening everywhere seems certain. However, the deeper question implicit here—whether this state will last forever—is a completely different one. Giving a definite answer to this deeper question would be inappropriate because asserting any statement that involves unlimited time as one of its elements is to affirm a statement that cannot be fully grasped—it’s an unthinkable statement. At first glance, it might seem that the opposite conclusion must also be equally inappropriate, suggesting that the question is entirely unsolvable. However, further reflection will reveal that this isn't the case. As long as the terms in our reasoning remain finite, the finite conclusions we reach don’t necessarily have to be inappropriate. Although, if the overall argument led us to believe that the state of rest toward which Evolution is taking things must, once reached, last forever, that conclusion would be invalid, as it exceeds human understanding; yet if we further pursue the general argument and conclude that such a state will not last for eternity, that conclusion isn’t necessarily invalid, since it does not involve terms that exceed human understanding. Therefore, it's reasonable to explore what the likely future outcomes of this process might be, which must ultimately lead Evolution to end in Universal Death. Without being so bold as to reach any definitive conclusion on such an immense topic that goes beyond the limits of precise science, we can still consider what seems to be the distant future toward which the facts indicate.
It has been already shown that all equilibration, so far as we can trace it, is relative. The dissipation of a body’s motion by communication of it to surrounding matter, solid, liquid, gaseous, and ethereal, tends to bring the body to a fixed position in relation to the matter that abstracts its motion. But all its other motions continue as before. The arrest of a cannon-shot does not diminish its movement towards the East at a thousand miles an hour, along with the wall it has struck; and a gradual dispersion of the Earth’s rotatory motion, would abstract nothing from the million and a half miles per day through which the Earth speeds in its orbit. Further, we have to bear in mind that this motion, the disappearance of which causes relative equilibration, is not lost but simply transferred; and by continual division and subdivision finally reduced to ethereal undulations and radiated through space. Whether the sensible motion dissipated during relative equilibration, is directly transformed into insensible motion, as happens in the case of the Sun; or whether, as in the sensible motions going on around us, it is directly transformed into smaller sensible motions, and these into still smaller, until they become insensible, matters not. In every instance the ultimate result 474is, that whatever motion of masses is lost, re-appears as molecular motion pervading space. Thus the questions we have to consider, are—Whether after the completion of all the relative equilibrations above contemplated as bringing Evolution to a close, there remain any further equilibrations to be effected?—Whether there are any other motions of masses that must eventually be transformed into molecular motion?—And if there are such other motions, what must be the consequence when the molecular motion generated by their transformation, is added to that which already exists?
It has been shown that all equilibration, as far as we can see, is relative. The loss of a body's motion by transferring it to surrounding matter—solid, liquid, gas, and ether—tends to bring the body to a fixed position in relation to the matter that takes its motion away. But all its other motions continue as before. The halt of a cannonball doesn’t reduce its movement towards the East at a thousand miles an hour, along with the wall it has hit; and a gradual slowing down of the Earth’s rotation wouldn’t take away from the million and a half miles per day that the Earth travels in its orbit. Furthermore, we need to remember that this motion, the disappearance of which leads to relative equilibration, isn’t lost but simply transferred; and through ongoing division into smaller and smaller parts, it eventually becomes ethereal waves radiating through space. Whether the noticeable motion lost during relative equilibration is directly converted into unnoticeable motion, like what happens with the Sun; or whether, as with the noticeable motions around us, it is directly changed into smaller noticeable motions, and these into even smaller ones until they become unnoticeable, doesn’t really matter. In every case, the end result is that any motion of masses that is lost reappears as molecular motion throughout space. Thus, the questions we need to think about are—After all the relative equilibrations we've considered that bring Evolution to an end, do any further equilibrations still need to happen?—Are there other motions of masses that must eventually be transformed into molecular motion?—And if there are such other motions, what happens when the molecular motion created by their transformation is added to the existing molecular motion?
To the first of these questions the answer is, that there do remain motions which are undiminished by all the relative equilibrations thus far considered; namely, the motions of translation possessed by those vast masses of incandescent matter called stars—masses now known to be suns that are in all probability, like our own, surrounded by circling groups of planets. The belief that the stars are literally fixed, has long since been exploded: observation has proved many of them to have sensible proper motions. Moreover, it has been ascertained by measurement, that in relation to the stars nearest to us, our own star is moving at the rate of about half a million miles per day; and if, as is admitted to be not improbable by sundry astronomers, our own star is traversing space in the same direction with adjacent stars, its absolute velocity may be, and most likely is, immensely greater than this. Now no such changes as those taking place within the Solar System, even when carried to the extent of integrating the whole of its matter into one mass, and diffusing all its relative movements in an insensible form through space, can affect these sidereal movements. Hence, there appears no alternative but to infer, that these sidereal movements must remain to be equilibrated by some subsequent process.
To answer the first of these questions, there are still movements that are unaffected by all the relative balances we've discussed so far; specifically, the translational movements of those massive blobs of glowing matter called stars—now recognized as suns that are probably surrounded by orbiting groups of planets, just like our own. The idea that stars are fixed in place has long been debunked: observations have shown that many of them have noticeable proper motions. Additionally, measurements have confirmed that in relation to the stars closest to us, our own star is moving at about half a million miles per day; and if, as many astronomers agree, our star is moving through space in the same direction as nearby stars, its actual speed may be, and is likely, much greater than this. Now, no changes like those occurring within the Solar System, even if we were to combine all of its matter into a single mass and disperse all its relative movements in an imperceptible way through space, can influence these stellar movements. Therefore, it seems there's no option but to conclude that these stellar movements will need to be balanced by some future process.
The next question that arises, if we venture to inquire the probable nature of this process, is—To what law do sidereal motions conform? And to this question Astronomy replies—the 475law of gravitation. The relative motions of binary stars have proved this. When it was discovered that certain of the double stars are not optically double but physically double, and move round each other, it was at once suspected that their revolutions might be regulated by a mutual attraction like that which regulates the revolutions of planets and satellites. The requisite measurements having been from time to time made, the periodic times of sundry binary stars were calculated on this assumption; and the subsequent performances of their revolutions in the predicted periods, have completely verified the assumption. If, then, it is demonstrated that these remote bodies are centres of gravitation—if we infer that all other stars are centres of gravitation, as we may fairly do—and if we draw the unavoidable corollary, that this gravitative force which so conspicuously affects stars that are comparatively near each other, must affect remote stars; we find ourselves led to the conclusion that all the members of our Sidereal System gravitate, individually and as an aggregate.
The next question that comes up, if we ask about the likely nature of this process, is—What law do stars follow in their movements? Astronomy answers this with the law of gravitation. The relative motions of binary stars have proven this. When it was found out that some of the double stars are not just optically double but physically double and orbit each other, it was immediately suspected that their orbits might be controlled by a mutual attraction similar to what governs the orbits of planets and moons. Necessary measurements have been made over time, and the periodic times of various binary stars were calculated based on this assumption; the actual movements of their orbits during the predicted periods have completely confirmed the assumption. If it’s shown that these distant bodies are centers of gravitation—if we conclude that all other stars are likely centers of gravitation, as we can reasonably do—and if we take the unavoidable conclusion that this gravitational force, which clearly impacts stars that are relatively close to each other, must also affect distant stars; we find ourselves arriving at the conclusion that all members of our Sidereal System gravitate, both individually and collectively.
But if these widely-dispersed moving masses mutually gravitate, what must happen? There appears but one tenable answer. Even supposing they were all absolutely equal in weight, and arranged into an annulus with absolute regularity, and endowed with exactly the amounts of centrifugal force required to prevent nearer approach to their common centre of gravity; the condition would still be one which the slightest disturbing force would destroy. Much more then are we driven to the inference, that our actual Sidereal System cannot preserve its present arrangement: the irregularities of its distribution being such as to render even a temporary moving equilibrium impossible. If the stars are so many centres of an attractive force that varies inversely as the square of the distance, there appears to be no escape from the conclusion, that the structure of our galaxy must be undergoing change; and must continue to undergo change.
But if these widely spread moving groups attract each other, what happens? There seems to be only one reasonable answer. Even if they were all exactly the same weight, arranged in a perfect ring, and had just the right amount of centrifugal force to keep them from drifting toward their common center of gravity, the situation would still be one that the slightest disturbance could disrupt. So, we are even more compelled to conclude that our actual Sidereal System can’t maintain its current arrangement: the irregularities in its distribution make even a temporary balance impossible. If the stars act as centers of an attractive force that decreases with the square of the distance, it seems unavoidable to conclude that our galaxy's structure must be changing and will continue to change.
Thus, in the absence of tenable alternatives, we are brought 476to the positions:—1, that the stars are in motion;—2, that they move in conformity with the law of gravitation;—3, that, distributed as they are, they cannot move in conformity with the law of gravitation, without undergoing change of arrangement. If now we permit ourselves to take a further step, and ask the nature of this change of arrangement, we find ourselves obliged to infer a progressive concentration. Whether we do or do not suppose the clustering which is now visible, to have been caused by mutual gravitation acting throughout past eras, as the hypothesis of Evolution implies, we are equally compelled to conclude that this clustering must increase throughout future eras. Stars at present dispersed, must become locally aggregated; existing aggregations, at the same time that they are enlarged by the drawing in of adjacent stars, must grow more dense; and aggregations must coalesce with each other: each greater degree of concentration augmenting the force by which further concentration is produced.
So, without any convincing alternatives, we come to the conclusions: 1, that the stars are moving; 2, that they move according to the law of gravity; 3, that given their current distribution, they cannot move according to the law of gravity without changing their arrangement. If we allow ourselves to take another step and consider what this change in arrangement looks like, we must conclude that there is a progressive concentration. Whether we assume that the clustering we observe now has resulted from mutual gravity acting over past ages, as the theory of Evolution suggests, we still have to conclude that this clustering will increase in the future. Stars that are currently spread out must become grouped together; existing groups, as they pull in nearby stars, must become denser; and groups must merge with one another: each greater level of concentration increasing the force that causes further concentration.
And now what must be the limit of this concentration? The mutual attraction of two individual stars, when it so far predominates over other attractions as to cause approximation, almost certainly ends in the formation of a binary star; since the motions generated by other attractions, prevent the two stars from moving in straight lines to their common centre of gravity. Between small clusters, too, having also certain proper motions as clusters, mutual attraction may lead, not to complete union, but to the formation of binary clusters. As the process continues however, and the clusters become larger, it seems clear that they must move more directly towards each other, thus forming clusters of increasing density; and that eventually all clusters must unite into one comparatively close aggregation. While, therefore, during the earlier stages of concentration, the probabilities are immense against the actual contact of these mutually-gravitating masses; it is tolerably manifest, that as the concentration increases, collision must become probable, 477and ultimately certain. This is an inference not lacking the support of high authority. Sir John Herschel, treating of those numerous and variously-aggregated clusters of stars revealed by the telescope, and citing with apparent approval his father’s opinion, that the more diffused and irregular of these, are “globular clusters in a less advanced state of condensation;” subsequently remarks, that “among a crowd of solid bodies of whatever size, animated by independent and partially opposing impulses, motions opposite to each other must produce collision, destruction of velocity, and subsidence or near approach towards the centre of preponderant attraction; while those which conspire, or which remain outstanding after such conflicts, must ultimately give rise to circulation of a permanent character.” Now what is here alleged of these minor sidereal aggregations, cannot be denied of the large aggregations; and thus the above-described process of concentration, appears certain to bring about an increasingly-frequent integration of masses.
And now what must be the limit of this concentration? The mutual attraction of two individual stars, when it strongly outweighs other attractions and causes them to move closer together, almost certainly leads to the formation of a binary star; since other attractions prevent the two stars from moving in straight lines toward their common center of gravity. Between small clusters, which also have their own motions as clusters, mutual attraction may lead not to complete merger but to the formation of binary clusters. However, as the process continues and the clusters grow larger, it seems clear that they must move more directly toward each other, forming clusters of increasing density; and eventually, all clusters must unite into one relatively close aggregation. Therefore, during the early stages of concentration, the chances are huge against the actual contact of these mutually gravitational masses; but it is quite clear that as concentration increases, collision must become likely, and ultimately certain. This conclusion is backed by respected authority. Sir John Herschel, discussing the numerous and variously aggregated clusters of stars revealed by the telescope, cites with apparent approval his father’s opinion that the more spread out and irregular ones are “globular clusters in a less advanced state of condensation;” he then notes that “among a crowd of solid bodies of whatever size, driven by independent and partially opposing forces, motions in opposite directions must lead to collisions, loss of velocity, and movement toward the center of greater attraction; while those that work together, or that remain after such collisions, must eventually give rise to a permanent circulation.” Now what is stated here about these smaller star groupings surely applies to the larger ones; thus, the previously described process of concentration appears certain to lead to increasingly frequent merging of masses. 477
We have next to consider the consequences of the accompanying loss of velocity. The sensible motion which disappears, cannot be destroyed; but must be transformed into insensible motion. What will be the effect of this insensible motion? Some approach to a conception of it, will be made by considering what would happen were the comparatively insignificant motion of our planet thus transformed. In his essay on “The Inter-action of Natural Forces,” Prof. Helmholtz states the thermal equivalent of the Earth’s movement through space; as calculated on the now received datum of Mr. Joule. “If our Earth,” he says, “were by a sudden shock brought to rest in her orbit,—which is not to be feared in the existing arrangement of our system—by such a shock a quantity of heat would be generated equal to that produced by the combustion of fourteen such Earths of solid coal. Making the most unfavourable assumption as to its capacity for heat, that is, placing it equal to that of water, the mass of the Earth would thereby be heated 11,200 degrees; 478it would therefore be quite fused, and for the most part reduced to vapour. If then the Earth, after having been thus brought to rest, should fall into the Sun, which of course would be the case, the quantity of heat developed by the shock would be 400 times greater.” Now so relatively small a momentum as that acquired by the Earth in falling through 95,000,000 of miles to the Sun, being equivalent to a molecular motion such as would reduce the Earth to gases of extreme rarity; what must be the molecular motion generated by the mutually-arrested momenta of two stars, that have moved to their common centre of gravity through spaces immeasurably greater? There seems no alternative but to conclude, that this molecular motion must be so great, as to reduce the matter of the stars to an almost inconceivable tenuity—a tenuity like that which we ascribe to nebular matter. Such being the immediate effect of the integration of any two stars in a concentrating aggregate, what must be the ulterior effect on the aggregate as a whole? Sir John Herschel, in the passage above quoted, describing the collisions that must arise in a mutually-gravitating group of stars, adds that those stars “which remain outstanding after such conflicts, must ultimately give rise to circulation of a permanent character.” The problem, however, is here dealt with purely as a mechanical one: the assumption being, that the mutually-arrested masses will continue as masses—an assumption to which no objection was apparent at the time when Sir John Herschel wrote this passage; since the doctrine of the correlation of forces was not then recognized. But obliged as we now are to conclude, that stars moving at the high velocities acquired during concentration, will, by mutual arrest, be dissipated into gases of great tenuity, the problem becomes different; and a different inference appears unavoidable. For the diffused matter produced by such conflicts, must form a resisting medium, occupying that central region of the aggregate through which its members from time to time pass in describing their orbits—a resisting medium 479which they cannot move through without having their velocities diminished. Every further such collision, by augmenting this resisting medium, and making the losses of velocity greater, must further aid in preventing the establishment of that equilibrium which would else arise; and so must conspire to produce more frequent collisions. And the nebulous matter thus formed, presently enveloping and extending beyond the whole aggregate, must, by continuing to shorten their gyrations, entail an increasingly-active integration and re-active disintegration of the moving masses; until they are all finally dissipated. This, indeed, is the conclusion which, leaving out all consideration of the process gone through, presents itself as a simple deduction from the persistence of force. If the stars have been, and still are, concentrating however indirectly on their common centre of gravity, and must eventually reach it; it is a corollary from the persistence of force, that the quantities of motion they have severally acquired, must suffice to carry them away from the common centre of gravity to those remote regions whence they originally began to move towards it. And since, by the conditions of the case, they cannot return to these remote regions in the shape of concrete masses, they must return in the shape of diffused masses. Action and reaction being equal and opposite, the momentum producing dispersion, must be as great as the momentum acquired by aggregation; and being spread over the same quantity of matter, must cause an equivalent distribution through space, whatever be the form of the matter. One condition, however, essential to the literal fulfilment of this result, must be specified; namely, that the quantity of molecular motion produced and radiated into space by each star in the course of its formation from diffused matter, shall be compensated by an equal quantity of molecular motion radiated from other parts of space into the space which our Sidereal System occupies. In other words, if we set out with that amount of molecular motion implied by the existence of the matter of 480our Sidereal System in a nebulous form; then it follows from the persistence of force, that if this matter undergoes the re-distribution constituting Evolution, the quantity of molecular motion given out during the integration of each mass, plus the quantity of molecular motion given out during the integration of all the masses, must suffice again to reduce it to the same nebulous form. Here indeed we arrive at an impassable limit to our reasonings; since we cannot know whether this condition is or is not fulfilled. On the hypothesis of an unlimited space, containing, at certain intervals, Sidereal Systems like our own, it may be that the quantity of molecular motion radiated into the region occupied by our Sidereal System, is equal to that which our Sidereal System radiates; in which case the quantity of motion possessed by it, remaining undiminished, our Sidereal System may continue during unlimited time, to repeat this alternate concentration and diffusion. But if, on the other hand, throughout boundless space there exist no other Sidereal Systems subject to like changes, or if such other Sidereal Systems exist at more than a certain average distance from each other; then it seems an unavoidable conclusion that the quantity of motion possessed, must diminish by radiation into unoccupied space; and that so, on each successive resumption of the nebulous form, the matter of our Sidereal System will occupy a less space; until at the end of an infinite time it reaches either a state in which its concentrations and diffusions are relatively small, or a state of complete aggregation and rest. Since, however, we have no evidence showing the existence or non-existence of Sidereal Systems throughout remote space; and since, even had we such evidence, a legitimate conclusion could not be drawn from premises of which one element (unlimited space) is inconceivable; we must be for ever without answer to this transcendent question. All we can say is, that so far as the data enable us to judge, the integration of our Sidereal System will be followed by disintegration; that such integration and disintegration will be repeated; and that, for anything 481we know to the contrary, the alternation of them may continue without limit.
We now need to look at the consequences of the resulting loss of speed. The detectable motion that disappears can't just vanish; it must transform into undetectable motion. What will this undetectable motion result in? We can get a better idea by thinking about what would happen if the relatively minor motion of our planet was transformed. In his essay on “The Inter-action of Natural Forces,” Professor Helmholtz discusses the thermal equivalent of the Earth’s movement through space, based on Mr. Joule’s accepted data. “If our Earth,” he explains, “were suddenly stopped in its orbit—which isn't a risk in our current system—such a shock would generate a quantity of heat equal to what would come from burning fourteen Earths' worth of solid coal. Assuming the worst case for its heat capacity, treating it as though it were equal to water, the Earth's mass would be heated by 11,200 degrees; it would then be completely molten and mostly turned into vapor. If, after this halt, Earth were to fall into the Sun, which would inevitably happen, the heat generated by the shock would be 400 times greater.” Given that the Earth’s relatively small momentum from falling 95,000,000 miles to the Sun equates to molecular motion that would turn the Earth into extremely rare gases, what kind of molecular motion would arise from the halted momenta of two stars that moved toward their shared center of gravity over immeasurable distances? It seems unavoidable to conclude that this molecular motion must be immense enough to reduce the matter of the stars to an almost unimaginable thinness—a thinness like that we attribute to nebula matter. With this immediate effect of the merging of two stars into a concentrated mass, what might be the longer-term impact on the mass as a whole? Sir John Herschel, in the previously quoted passage, describes that the collisions arising in a mutually-gravitating group of stars will lead to those stars that survive such conflicts, “must” ultimately create a permanent circulation. However, the problem was addressed purely as a mechanical issue: it was assumed that the mutually-arrested masses would remain as masses—an assumption that didn't raise objections when Sir John Herschel wrote this. At that time, the idea of the correlation of forces was not recognized. But now we must conclude that stars moving at the high speeds gained during concentration will, through mutual arrest, dissipate into very thin gases, changing the problem significantly and leading to a different conclusion. The diffuse matter created by such collisions must form a resistant medium occupying the central region of the mass, through which its members pass as they orbit— a resistant medium that decreases their speeds. Any further collision, by increasing this resistant medium and further reducing speeds, will help prevent the establishment of equilibrium, creating more frequent collisions. Furthermore, the nebulous matter formed will envelop and extend beyond the entire mass, continuously shortening their rotations and leading to more active integration and reactive disintegration of the moving masses until they are all dissipated. This indeed is a conclusion that, without considering the process involved, appears as a straightforward deduction from the persistence of force. If the stars have been concentrating, even indirectly, on their common center of gravity and must ultimately reach it; it follows, given the persistence of force, that the amounts of motion they each possess must be enough to pull them back to those distant areas from which they initially moved toward it. Since, due to the circumstances, they cannot return to those distant areas as solid masses, they must return as diffuse masses. Action and reaction are equal and opposite; thus, the momentum causing dispersion must equal the momentum gained from aggregation. Spread across the same amount of matter, this momentum will cause an equivalent distribution through space, regardless of the type of matter. However, one essential condition for this result to literally hold true must be specified: the quantity of molecular motion produced and emitted into space by each star during its formation from diffuse matter must be offset by an equal quantity of molecular motion radiated from other parts of space into the region our Sidereal System occupies. In other words, if we start with the amount of molecular motion implied by the matter of our Sidereal System being in nebulous form, then, according to the persistence of force, if this matter undergoes the reorganization that forms Evolution, the amount of molecular motion released during the integration of each mass, plus the amount of molecular motion released during the integration of all the masses, must be enough to revert it to the same nebulous form. Here, we indeed reach an insurmountable limit to our reasoning, as we cannot determine whether this condition is satisfied or not. Assuming there is unlimited space, containing Sidereal Systems similar to ours at certain intervals, the quantity of molecular motion radiating into the area of our Sidereal System might equal the amount our Sidereal System radiates; in that situation, the amount of motion it has will remain intact, and our Sidereal System may continue indefinitely to repeat this cycle of concentration and diffusion. However, if, on the other hand, there are no other Sidereal Systems throughout boundless space going through similar changes, or if such other systems are too far apart, it seems inevitable that the amount of motion present will decrease due to radiation into unoccupied space; thus, with each successive return to a nebulous state, the matter in our Sidereal System will occupy less space, until eventually, after an infinite time, it either reaches a point where its concentrations and diffusions are relatively small or a state of complete aggregation and rest. Since, however, we have no evidence confirming or denying the existence of Sidereal Systems in remote space; and even if we did have such evidence, a valid conclusion couldn't be drawn from premises that include an element (unlimited space) that is inconceivable; we must remain without an answer to this transcendent question. All we can assert is that, based on the available data, the integration of our Sidereal System will be followed by disintegration; that this integration and disintegration will repeat; and that, for all we know, this alternation may continue indefinitely.
But leaving this ultimate insoluble problem, and confining ourselves to the proximate and not necessarily insoluble one, we find reason for thinking that after the completion of those various equilibrations which bring to a close all the forms of Evolution we have contemplated, there must still continue an equilibration of a far wider kind. When that integration everywhere in progress throughout our Solar System, has reached its climax, there will remain to be effected the immeasurably greater integration of our Solar System, with all other such systems. As in those minor forms now going on around us, this integration with its concomitant equilibration, involves the change of aggregate motion into diffused motion; so in those vaster forms hereafter to be carried out, there must similarly be gained in molecular motion what is lost in the motion of masses; and the inevitable transformation of this motion of masses into molecular motion, cannot take place without reducing the masses to a nebulous form. Thus we seem led to the conclusion that the entire process of things, as displayed in the aggregate of the visible Universe, is analogous to the entire process of things as displayed in the smallest aggregates. Where, as in organic bodies, the whole series of changes constituting Evolution can be traced, we saw that, dynamically considered, Evolution is a change from molecular motion to the motion of masses; and this change, becoming more active during the ascending phase of Evolution while the masses increase in bulk and heterogeneity, eventually begins to get less active; until, passing through stages in which the integration grows greater, and the equilibrium more definite, it finally ceases; whereupon there arises, by an ulterior process, an increase of molecular motion, ending in the more or less complete dissolution of the aggregate. And here we find reason to believe that, along with each of the thousands of similar ones dispersed through the heavens, our Solar System, after passing through stages 482during which the motion of masses is produced at the expense of lost molecular motion, and during which there goes on an increasingly active differentiation and integration, arrives at a climax whence these changes, beginning to decline in activity, slowly bring about that complete integration and equilibration which in other cases we call death; and that there afterwards comes a time, when the still-remaining motions of masses are transformed into a molecular motion which causes dissolution of the masses. Motion as well as Matter being fixed in quantity, it would seem that the change in the distribution of Matter which Motion effects, coming to a limit in whichever direction it is carried, the indestructible Motion thereupon necessitates a reverse distribution. Apparently, the universally-coexistent forces of attraction and repulsion, which, as we have seen, necessitate rhythm in all minor changes throughout the Universe, also necessitate rhythm in the totality of its changes—produce now an immeasurable period during which the attractive forces predominating, cause universal concentration, and then an immeasurable period during which the repulsive forces predominating, cause universal diffusion—alternate eras of Evolution and Dissolution. And thus there is suggested the conception of a past during which there have been successive Evolutions similar to that which is now going on; and a future during which successive other such Evolutions may go on.
But putting aside this ultimate problem that can't be solved and focusing on the more immediate issue, we have reasons to think that after completing the various adjustments that wrap up all the forms of evolution we've discussed, there will still be an ongoing adjustment of a much larger scope. When this integration, which is happening throughout our Solar System, reaches its peak, there will still be the far greater integration of our Solar System with all the other systems. Just like the smaller changes happening around us, this integration and its accompanying adjustments involve transforming concentrated motion into dispersed motion; similarly, in these larger future forms, any gain in molecular motion corresponds to a loss in massive motion, and the necessary transformation of this massive motion into molecular motion cannot happen without breaking the masses down into a nebulous state. Therefore, we seem to draw the conclusion that the entire process of things, as shown in the total visible universe, is similar to the whole process displayed in the smallest aggregates. In organic bodies, where we can trace the whole series of changes that make up evolution, we observed that, when viewed dynamically, evolution is a shift from molecular motion to motion of masses; this shift becomes more active during the rising phase of evolution while the masses grow in size and diversity, and eventually starts to decrease; until, after passing through stages of increased integration and clearer equilibrium, it finally stops; then, through another process, there is an increase in molecular motion that leads to the more or less total breakdown of the aggregate. Here, we have reason to believe that alongside each of the thousands of similar systems scattered throughout the cosmos, our Solar System, after going through stages where the motion of masses comes at the expense of lost molecular motion, and during which a more active differentiation and integration occurs, reaches a peak where these changes, beginning to slow down, gradually lead to complete integration and equilibrium, which in other cases we refer to as death; and after that, there comes a time when the remaining motions of masses are converted into molecular motion that results in the dissipation of those masses. Since both motion and matter are fixed in quantity, it seems that the change in the distribution of matter that motion brings, reaching a limit no matter the direction, requires an opposite distribution due to indestructible motion. Clearly, the universally existing forces of attraction and repulsion, which we have observed necessitate a rhythm in all small changes throughout the universe, also require rhythm in the total changes—creating vast periods where the attractive forces dominate, leading to universal concentration, followed by vast periods where the repulsive forces dominate, initiating universal diffusion—alternating phases of evolution and dissolution. Thus, the idea is suggested of a past filled with successive evolutions similar to the one currently occurring, and a future where other successive evolutions may happen.
Let none suppose, however, that this is to be taken as anything more than a speculation. In dealing with times and spaces and forces so immensely transcending those of which we have definite experience, we are in danger of passing the limits to human intelligence. Though these times and spaces and forces cannot literally be classed as infinite; yet they are so utterly beyond the possibility of definite conception, as to be almost equally unthinkable with the infinite. What has been above said, should therefore be regarded simply as a possible answer to a possible doubt. When, pushing 483to its extreme the argument that Evolution must come to a close in complete equilibrium or rest, the reader suggests that for aught which appears to the contrary, the Universal Death thus implied will continue indefinitely; it is legitimate to point out how, on carrying the argument still further, we are led to infer a subsequent Universal Life. But while this last inference may fitly be accepted as a demurrer to the first, it would be unwise to accept it in any more positive sense.
Let no one think, however, that this should be seen as anything more than a theory. When we talk about times, spaces, and forces that are so far beyond what we actually know, we risk going beyond the limits of human understanding. Although these times, spaces, and forces can’t truly be considered infinite, they are so completely beyond what we can clearly understand that they are nearly as unimaginable as the infinite itself. What has been said above should, therefore, be seen merely as a possible answer to a potential question. When, by taking the argument that Evolution has to end in complete balance or rest to its extreme, the reader suggests that, for all we know, the Universal Death implied might extend indefinitely; it is reasonable to point out that if we push the argument even further, we could conclude a following Universal Life. However, while this last conclusion might adequately counter the first one, it would be unwise to accept it too definitively.
§ 137. Returning from this parenthetical discussion, concerning the probable or possible state of things that may arise after Evolution has run its course; and confining ourselves to the changes constituting Evolution, with which alone we are immediately concerned; we have now to inquire whether the cessation of these changes, in common with all their transitional characteristics, admits of à priori proof. It will soon become apparent that equilibration, not less than the preceding general principles, is deducible from the persistence of force.
§ 137. Returning from this side discussion about the likely state of affairs that may occur after Evolution has completed its process, and focusing solely on the changes that make up Evolution, which is what we are primarily concerned with; we now need to examine whether the stopping of these changes, along with all their transitional features, can be proven a priori. It will soon be clear that equilibration, just like the earlier general principles, can be inferred from the persistence of force.
We have seen (§ 85) that phenomena are interpretable only as the results of universally-coexistent forces of attraction and repulsion. These universally-coexistent forces of attraction and repulsion, are, indeed, the complementary aspects of that absolutely persistent force which is the ultimate datum of consciousness. Just in the same way that the equality of action and re-action is a corollary from the persistence of force, since their inequality would imply the disappearance of the differential force into nothing, or its appearance out of nothing; so, we cannot become conscious of an attractive force without becoming simultaneously conscious of an equal and opposite repulsive force. For every experience of a muscular tension, (under which form alone we can immediately know an attractive force,) presupposes an equivalent resistance—a resistance shown in the counter-balancing pressure of the body against neighbouring objects, or in that 484absorption of force which gives motion to the body, or in both—a resistance which we cannot conceive as other than equal to the tension, without conceiving force to have either appeared or disappeared, and so denying the persistence of force. And from this necessary correlation, results our inability, before pointed out, of interpreting any phenomena save in terms of these correlatives—an inability shown alike in the compulsion we are under to think of the statical forces which tangible matter displays, as due to the attraction and repulsion of its atoms, and in the compulsion we are under to think of dynamical forces exercised through space, by regarding space as filled with atoms similarly endowed. Thus from the existence of a force that is for ever unchangeable in quantity, there follows, as a necessary corollary, the co-extensive existence of these opposite forms of force—forms under which the conditions of our consciousness oblige us to represent that absolute force which transcends our knowledge.
We have observed (§ 85) that phenomena can only be understood as the outcomes of universally coexisting forces of attraction and repulsion. These forces of attraction and repulsion are, in fact, the complementary sides of an absolutely constant force that is the ultimate basis of consciousness. Just like the balance of action and reaction follows from the constancy of force, since any imbalance would suggest that the differential force disappears into nothingness or appears from nothing, we cannot be aware of an attractive force without also being aware of an equal and opposite repulsive force. Every experience of muscular tension—under which we can only immediately recognize an attractive force—assumes an equivalent resistance. This resistance is reflected in the counterbalancing pressure of our body against nearby objects, in the absorption of force that causes movement, or in both. We cannot imagine this resistance as anything other than equal to the tension without suggesting that force has either emerged from nothing or disappeared, which would contradict the persistence of force. From this necessary connection arises our previously mentioned inability to interpret any phenomena except in terms of these correlatives. This inability is evident in our compulsion to consider the static forces displayed by tangible matter as resulting from the attraction and repulsion of its atoms, as well as our compulsion to think about dynamical forces acting through space by viewing space as filled with similarly endowed atoms. Thus, from the existence of a force that is always unchanged in quantity follows, as a necessary conclusion, the simultaneous existence of these opposing forms of force—forms through which the conditions of our consciousness require us to represent that absolute force that goes beyond our knowledge.
But the forces of attraction and repulsion being universally co-existent, it follows, as before shown, that all motion is motion under resistance. Units of matter, solid, liquid, aëriform, or ethereal, filling the space which any moving body traverses, offer to such body the resistance consequent on their cohesion, or their inertia, or both. In other words, the denser or rarer medium which occupies the places from moment to moment passed through by such moving body, having to be expelled from them, as much motion is abstracted from the moving body as is given to the medium in expelling it from these places. This being the condition under which all motion occurs, two corollaries result. The first is, that the deductions perpetually made by the communication of motion to the resisting medium, cannot but bring the motion of the body to an end in a longer or shorter time. The second is, that the motion of the body cannot cease until these deductions destroy it. In other words, movement must continue till equilibration takes place; and equilibration must eventually take place. Both these are 485manifest deductions from the persistence of force. To say that the whole or part of a body’s motion can disappear, save by transfer to something which resists its motion, is to say that the whole or part of its motion can disappear without effect; which is to deny the persistence of force. Conversely, to say that the medium traversed can be moved out of the body’s path, without deducting from the body’s motion, is to say that motion of the medium can arise out of nothing; which is to deny the persistence of force. Hence this primordial truth is our immediate warrant for the conclusions, that the changes which Evolution presents, cannot end until equilibrium is reached; and that equilibrium must at last be reached.
But since the forces of attraction and repulsion exist together, it follows, as previously mentioned, that all motion involves some form of resistance. Units of matter—solid, liquid, gaseous, or etheric—that occupy the space a moving body travels through create resistance due to their cohesion, inertia, or a combination of both. In simple terms, the denser or lighter medium occupying the positions that the moving body passes through has to be pushed out of the way. As the moving body expels that medium, it loses as much motion as it gives to the medium. This means that all motion occurs under these conditions, leading to two key outcomes. First, the continuous transfer of motion to the resisting medium will eventually stop the motion of the body, whether sooner or later. Second, the body’s motion cannot stop until these transfers result in its complete loss of motion. In other words, movement will continue until balance is achieved, and balance will ultimately be obtained. Both of these outcomes are clear implications of the persistence of force. To claim that a body’s motion can vanish—partially or entirely—without being transferred to something pushing against it is to deny the persistence of force. Similarly, to claim that the medium can be moved out of the body's path without affecting its motion is to suggest that the medium's motion can come from nothing, which also denies the persistence of force. Thus, this fundamental truth supports the conclusion that the changes we see in Evolution cannot cease until balance is reached, and balance will eventually be achieved.
Equally necessary, because equally deducible from this same truth that transcends proof, are the foregoing propositions respecting the establishment and maintenance of moving equilibria, under their several aspects. It follows from the persistence of force, that the various motions possessed by any aggregate, either as a whole or among its parts, must be severally dissipated by the resistances they severally encounter; and that thus, such of them as are least in amount, or meet with greatest opposition, or both, will be brought to a close while the others continue. Hence in every diversely moving aggregate, there results a comparatively early dissipation of motions which are smaller and much resisted; followed by long-continuance of the larger and less-resisted motions; and so there arise dependent and independent moving equilibria. Hence also may be inferred the tendency to conservation of such moving equilibria; since, whenever the new motion given to the parts of a moving equilibrium by a disturbing force, is not of such kind and amount that it cannot be dissipated before the pre-existing motions (in which case it brings the moving equilibrium to an end) it must be of such kind and amount that it can be dissipated before the pre-existing motions (in which case the moving equilibrium is re-established).
Equally important, since it can also be derived from this same undeniable truth, are the earlier points about setting up and maintaining moving balances, in their various forms. It follows from the continuity of force that the different motions present in any collection, whether considered as a whole or among its individual parts, must be gradually exhausted by the resistances they each face; and that as a result, those with the least amount of motion, or that encounter the most resistance, or both, will come to a stop while the others keep going. Therefore, in any group of things moving in different ways, there will be an early dissipation of the smaller and more resisted motions; followed by a prolonged persistence of the larger and less resisted motions; and thus, dependent and independent moving balances emerge. This also implies a tendency to preserve such moving balances; since whenever the new motion added to the parts of a moving balance by a disruptive force is such that it cannot be exhausted before the existing motions (in which case it ends the moving balance), it must be of a type and intensity that can be dissipated before the existing motions (in which case the moving balance is restored).
486Thus from the persistence of force follow, not only the various direct and indirect equilibrations going on around, together with that cosmical equilibration which brings Evolution under all its forms to a close; but also those less manifest equilibrations shown in the re-adjustments of moving equilibria that have been disturbed. By this ultimate principle is proveable the tendency of every organism, disordered by some unusual influence, to return to a balanced state. To it also may be traced the capacity, possessed in a slight degree by individuals, and in a greater degree by species, of becoming adapted to new circumstances. And not less does it afford a basis for the inference, that there is a gradual advance towards harmony between man’s mental nature and the conditions of his existence. After finding that from it are deducible the various characteristics of Evolution, we finally draw from it a warrant for the belief, that Evolution can end only in the establishment of the greatest perfection and the most complete happiness.
486So, from the constant presence of force arise not only the different direct and indirect balances happening all around, along with the universal balance that ultimately brings Evolution in all its forms to a conclusion; but also those less obvious balances seen in the adjustments of moving balances that have been disturbed. This fundamental principle demonstrates the tendency of every organism, disrupted by some unusual influence, to revert to a balanced state. It also explains the ability, present to a small extent in individuals and to a greater extent in species, to adapt to new circumstances. Furthermore, it provides a foundation for the idea that there is a gradual progress toward harmony between human mental nature and the conditions of existence. After discovering that various characteristics of Evolution can be inferred from it, we ultimately conclude that Evolution can only culminate in achieving the highest perfection and the fullest happiness.
18. Sir David Brewster has recently been citing with approval, a calculation by M. Babinet, to the effect that on the hypothesis of nebular genesis, the matter of the Sun, when it filled the Earth’s orbit, must have taken 3181 years to rotate; and that therefore the hypothesis cannot be true. This calculation of M. Babinet may pair-off with that of M. Comte, who, contrariwise, made the time of this rotation agree very nearly with the Earth’s period of revolution round the Sun; for if M. Comte’s calculation involved a petitio principii, that of M. Babinet is manifestly based on two assumptions, both of which are gratuitous, and one of them totally inconsistent with the doctrine to be tested. He has evidently proceeded on the current supposition respecting the Sun’s internal density, which is not proved, and from which there are reasons for dissenting; and he has evidently taken for granted that all parts of the nebulous spheroid, when it filled the Earth’s orbit, had the same angular velocity; whereas if (as is implied in the nebular hypothesis, rationally understood) this spheroid resulted from the concentration of far more widely-diffused matter, the angular velocity of its equatorial portion would obviously be immensely greater than that of its central portion.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Sir David Brewster has recently referenced with approval a calculation by M. Babinet, which suggests that if we assume the nebular hypothesis is correct, the matter of the Sun, when it occupied the Earth's orbit, would have taken 3,181 years to rotate. Therefore, this hypothesis cannot be accurate. M. Babinet's calculation can be compared to that of M. Comte, who, on the other hand, made the rotation time align quite closely with the Earth's revolution period around the Sun. If M. Comte’s calculation involved a begging the question, M. Babinet's is clearly based on two assumptions, both of which are unwarranted, and one of them is completely inconsistent with the doctrine being tested. He has evidently relied on the current assumption regarding the Sun's internal density, which is unproven and has reasons for challenge; and he seems to have assumed that all parts of the nebulous spheroid, when it filled the Earth's orbit, had the same angular velocity. However, if (as suggested by a rational understanding of the nebular hypothesis) this spheroid was formed from the concentration of matter that was much more widely spread out, the angular velocity of its equatorial section would naturally be significantly greater than that of its central section.
19. See paper “On the Inter-action of Natural Forces,” by Prof. Helmholtz, translated by Prof. Tyndall, and published in the Philosophical Magazine, supplement to Vol. XI. fourth series.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Check out the paper “On the Interaction of Natural Forces” by Prof. Helmholtz, translated by Prof. Tyndall, and published in the Philosophical Magazine, supplement to Vol. XI, fourth series.
20. Until I recently consulted his “Outlines of Astronomy” on another question, I was not aware that so far back as 1833, Sir John Herschel had enunciated the doctrine that “the sun’s rays are the ultimate source of almost every motion which takes place on the surface of the earth.” He expressly includes all geologic, meteorologic, and vital actions; as also those which we produce by the combustion of coal. The late George Stephenson appears to have been wrongly credited with this last idea.
__A_TAG_PLACEHOLDER_0__.Until I recently looked up his “Outlines of Astronomy” for another topic, I didn’t realize that as far back as 1833, Sir John Herschel stated that “the sun’s rays are the ultimate source of almost every motion that happens on the surface of the earth.” He specifically includes all geological, meteorological, and vital processes, as well as those we create through burning coal. The late George Stephenson seems to have been mistakenly given credit for this last idea.
CHAPTER XVII.
Summary and Conclusion.
§ 138. In the chapter on “Laws in general,” after delineating the progress of mankind in recognizing uniformities of relation among surrounding phenomena—after showing how the actual succession in the establishment of different orders of co-existences and sequences, corresponds with the succession deducible à priori from the conditions to human knowledge—after showing how, by the ever-multiplying experiences of constant connections among phenomena, there has been gradually generated the conception of universal conformity to law; it was suggested that this conception will become still clearer, when it is perceived that there are laws of wider generality than any of those at present accepted.
§ 138. In the chapter on “Laws in general,” after outlining the progress of humanity in recognizing patterns in the world around us—after demonstrating how the actual sequence in establishing different forms of coexistence and events aligns with the sequence that can be inferred beforehand from the conditions of human understanding—after illustrating how, through countless experiences of consistent relationships among phenomena, the idea of universal adherence to law has gradually been developed; it was suggested that this idea will become even clearer when we realize that there are laws that are broader and more general than any currently accepted.
The existence of such more general laws, is, indeed, almost implied by the ensemble of the facts set forth in the above-named chapter; since they make it apparent, that the process hitherto carried on, of bringing phenomena under fewer and wider laws, has not ceased, but is advancing with increasing rapidity. Apart, however, from evidence of this kind, the man of science, hourly impressed with new proof of uniformity in the relations of things, until the conception of uniformity has become with him a necessity of thought, tacitly entertains the conclusion that the minor uniformities which Science has thus far established, will eventually be 488merged in uniformities that are universal. Taught as he is by every observation and experiment, to regard phenomena as manifestations of Force; and learning as he does to contemplate Force as unchangeable in amount; there tends to grow up in him a belief in unchangeable laws common to Force under all its manifestations. Though he may not have formulated it to himself, he is prepared to recognize the truth, that, being fixed in quantity, fixed in its two ultimate modes of presentation (Matter and Motion), and fixed in the conditions under which it is presented (Time and Space); Force must have certain equally fixed laws of action, common to all the changes it produces.
The existence of such broader laws is basically implied by the collection of facts mentioned in the chapter above; they clearly show that the ongoing process of categorizing phenomena under fewer and broader laws hasn't stopped but is actually speeding up. Beyond this kind of evidence, a scientist, constantly faced with new proof of uniformity in the relationships between things, comes to view uniformity as a necessary way of thinking. He quietly comes to the conclusion that the smaller uniformities Science has established so far will eventually merge into universal uniformities. Every observation and experiment teach him to see phenomena as expressions of Force, and as he learns to view Force as constant in quantity, he develops a belief in unchanging laws that apply to Force in all its forms. Even if he hasn't articulated it to himself, he's ready to accept the idea that, since Force is constant in quantity, consistent in its two ultimate forms of expression (Matter and Motion), and fixed in the conditions under which it operates (Time and Space), it must have certain equally fixed laws of action that are common to all the changes it causes.
Hence to the classes who alone are likely to read these pages, the hypothesis of a fundamental unity, extending from the simplest inorganic actions up to the most complex associations of thought and the most involved social processes, will have an à priori probability. All things being recognized as having one source, will be expected to exhibit one method. Even in the absence of a clue to uniformities co-extensive with all modes of Force, as the mathematical uniformities are co-extensive with Space and Time, it will be inferred that such uniformities exist. And thus a certain presumption will result in favour of any formula, of a generality great enough to include concrete phenomena of every order.
So, for the groups who are most likely to read these pages, the idea of a fundamental unity, stretching from the simplest inorganic actions to the most complex thought connections and social processes, will seem likely from the start. Since everything is recognized as having one source, it’s expected they will show one method. Even if there isn't evidence of uniformities that apply across all forms of Force, similar to how mathematical uniformities relate to Space and Time, it will be assumed such uniformities do exist. This leads to a certain assumption in favor of any formula that is general enough to cover concrete phenomena of all kinds.
§ 139. In the chapters on the “Law of Evolution,” there was set forth a principle, which, so far as accessible evidence enables us to judge, possesses this universality. The order of material changes, first perceived to have certain constant characteristics in cases where it could be readily traced from beginning to end, we found to have these same characteristics in cases where it could be less readily traced; and we saw numerous indications that these same characteristics were displayed during past changes of which we have no direct knowledge. The transformation of the homogeneous into 489the heterogeneous, first observed by naturalists to be exhibited during the development of every plant and animal, proved to be also exhibited during the development of every society; both in its political and industrial organization, and in all the products of social life,—language, science, art, and literature. From the disclosures of geology, we drew adequate support for the conclusion, that in the structure of the Earth there has similarly been a progress from uniformity, through ever-increasing degrees of multiformity, to the complex state which we now see. And on the assumption of that nebular origin to which so many facts point, we inferred that a like transition from unity to variety of distribution, must have been undergone by our Solar System; as well as by that vast assemblage of such systems constituting the visible Universe. This definition of the metamorphosis, first asserted by physiologists of organic aggregates only, but which we thus found reason to think, holds of all other aggregates, proved on further inquiry to be too wide. Its undue width was shown to arise from the omission of certain other characteristics, that are, not less than the foregoing one, displayed throughout all kinds of Evolution. We saw that simultaneously with the change from homogeneity to heterogeneity, there takes place a change from indefiniteness of arrangement to definiteness of arrangement—a change everywhere equally traceable with that which it accompanies. Further consideration made it apparent, that the increasing definiteness thus manifested along with increasing heterogeneity, necessarily results from increasing integration of the parts severally rendered unlike. And thus we finally reached the conclusion, that there has been going on throughout an immeasurable past, is still going on, and will continue to go on, an advance from a diffused, indeterminate, and uniform distribution of Matter, to a concentrated, determinate, and multiform distribution of it.
§ 139. In the chapters on the “Law of Evolution,” we presented a principle that, based on the evidence available, seems to be universally applicable. The pattern of material changes, first recognized for having specific consistent traits in cases where it could be easily followed from start to finish, showed these same traits even in situations where it was less clear. We noticed many signs that these characteristics also appeared during past changes for which we have no direct evidence. The shift from uniformity to diversity, initially noted by naturalists in the development of every plant and animal, was also seen in the development of every society, in both its political and industrial organization, as well as in all aspects of social life—language, science, art, and literature. From geological findings, we gathered solid evidence for the conclusion that the structure of the Earth has also progressed from uniformity, through increasing diversity, to the complex state we observe today. Assuming the nebular origin suggested by many facts, we inferred that a similar transition from unity to varied distribution must have occurred in our Solar System, as well as in the vast collection of such systems that make up the visible Universe. This definition of the transformation, first claimed by physiologists regarding organic aggregates, but which we believed extends to all other aggregates, proved to be too broad upon further investigation. Its excessive breadth was shown to stem from neglecting certain other traits that are equally present in all types of Evolution. We observed that alongside the transition from homogeneity to heterogeneity, there occurs a shift from indefinite arrangement to definite arrangement—a change that can be traced just as clearly as the transformation it accompanies. Further consideration revealed that the increasing clarity along with greater diversity is a necessary result of the rising integration of parts that become unlike. Thus, we ultimately concluded that there has been, is currently, and will continue to be progress from a scattered, vague, and uniform distribution of Matter to a concentrated, clear, and diverse distribution of it.
At a subsequent stage of our inquiry, we discovered that this progressive change in the arrangement of Matter, is accompanied 490by a parallel change in the arrangement of Motion—that every increase in the structural complexity of things, involves a corresponding increase in their functional complexity. It was shown that along with the integration of molecules into masses, there arises an integration of molecular motion into the motion of masses; and that as fast as there results variety in the sizes and forms of aggregates and their relations to incident forces, there also results variety in their movements. Whence it became manifest, that the general process of things is from a confused simplicity to an orderly complexity, in the distribution of both Matter and Motion.
At a later stage of our research, we found that this ongoing change in the arrangement of matter is accompanied by a similar change in the arrangement of motion—that every increase in the structural complexity of things also involves a corresponding increase in their functional complexity. It was demonstrated that as molecules combine into larger structures, there is also a blend of molecular motion into the motion of those larger structures; and that as there is variety in the sizes and shapes of these aggregates and their interactions with external forces, there is also variety in their movements. Thus, it became clear that the overall process of things moves from a disorganized simplicity to an organized complexity in the distribution of both matter and motion.
It was pointed out, however, that though this species of transformation is universal, in the sense of holding throughout all classes of phenomena, it is not universal in the sense of being continued without limit in all classes of phenomena. Those aggregates which exhibit the entire change from uniformity to multiformity of structure and function, in comparatively short periods, eventually show us a reverse set of changes: Evolution is followed by Dissolution. The differentiations and integrations of Matter and Motion, finally reach a degree which the conditions do not allow them to pass; and there then sets in a process of disintegration and assimilation, of both the parts and the movements that were before growing more united and more distinct.
It was noted, however, that while this type of transformation is universal in the sense that it applies to all classes of phenomena, it isn't universal in the sense that it continues indefinitely across all categories. Those systems that show a complete shift from uniformity to diversity in structure and function, over relatively short periods, ultimately reveal a counter set of changes: Evolution is followed by Dissolution. The differentiations and integrations of Matter and Motion eventually reach a level that conditions do not allow them to exceed; then a process of disintegration and assimilation begins, affecting both the parts and the movements that were previously becoming more unified and distinct.
But under one or the other of these processes, all observable modifications in the arrangement of things may be classed. Every change comes under the head of integration or disintegration, material or dynamical; or under the head of differentiation or assimilation, material or dynamical; or under both. Each inorganic mass is either undergoing increase by the combination with it of surrounding elements for which its parts have affinity; or undergoing decrease by the solvent and abraiding action of surrounding elements; or both one and the other in varied succession and combination. By perpetual additions and losses of heat, it is having its 491parts temporarily differentiated from each other, or temporarily assimilated to each other, in molecular state. And through the actions of divers agents, it is also undergoing certain permanent molecular re-arrangements; rendering it either more uniform or more multiform in structure. These opposite kinds of change, thus vaguely typified in every surrounding fragment of matter, are displayed in all aggregates with increasing distinctness in proportion as the conditions essential to re-arrangement of parts are fulfilled. So that universally, the process of things is either in the one direction or the other. There is in all cases going on that ever-complicating distribution of Matter and Motion which we call Evolution; save in those cases where it has been brought to a close and reversed by what we call Dissolution.
But under one or the other of these processes, all visible changes in the arrangement of things can be categorized. Every change falls under the categories of integration or disintegration, whether material or dynamic; or under differentiation or assimilation, whether material or dynamic; or sometimes both. Each inorganic mass is either increasing due to the combination with surrounding elements that its parts can bond with or decreasing due to the dissolving and abrasive action of surrounding elements; or both, in various sequences and combinations. Through constant additions and losses of heat, its parts are temporarily either differentiated from each other or temporarily assimilated in a molecular state. Additionally, through the actions of various agents, it is also experiencing certain permanent molecular rearrangements, making it either more uniform or more diverse in structure. These opposite types of change, shown in every surrounding piece of matter, become more distinct in all aggregates as the necessary conditions for rearranging the parts are met. Thus, universally, the process of things is moving in one direction or the other. In all cases, there is an ever-complicating distribution of Matter and Motion that we refer to as Evolution, except in those cases where it has been halted and reversed by what we call Dissolution.
§ 140. Whether this omnipresent metamorphosis admits of interpretation, was the inquiry on which we next entered. Recognizing the changes thus formulated as consisting in Motions of Matter that are produced by Force, we saw that if they are interpretable at all, it must be by the affiliation of them on certain ultimate laws of Matter, Motion, and Force. We therefore proceeded to inquire what these ultimate laws are.
§ 140. Whether this constant transformation can be interpreted was the question we explored next. Acknowledging that the changes outlined consist of movements of matter caused by force, we understood that if they can be interpreted at all, it must be by relating them to specific fundamental laws of matter, motion, and force. So, we moved on to investigate what these fundamental laws are.
We first contemplated under its leading aspects, the principle of correlation and equivalence among forces. The genesis of sensible motion by insensible motion, and of insensible motion by sensible motion, as well as the like reciprocal production of those forms of insensible motion which constitute Light, Heat, Electricity, Magnetism, and Chemical Action, was shown to be a now accepted doctrine, that involves certain corollaries respecting the processes everywhere going on around us. Setting out with the probability that the insensible motion radiated by the Sun, is the transformed product of the sensible motion lost during the progressive concentration of the solar mass; we saw that by this insensible motion, are in turn produced the various kinds of sensible 492motion on the Earth’s surface. Besides the inorganic terrestrial changes, we found that the changes constituting organic life are thus originated. We were obliged to conclude that within this category, come the vital phenomena classed as mental, as well as those classed as physical. And it appeared inevitably to follow that of social changes, too, the like must be said. We next saw that phenomena being cognizable by us only as products of Force, manifested under the two-fold form of attraction and repulsion, there results the general law that all Motion must occur in the direction of least resistance, or in the direction of greatest traction, or in the direction of their resultant. It was pointed out that this law is every instant illustrated in the movements of the celestial bodies. The innumerable transpositions of matter, gaseous, liquid, and solid, going on over the Earth’s surface, were shown to conform to it. Evidence was given that this same ultimate principle of motion underlies the structural and functional changes of organisms. Throughout the succession of those nervous actions which constitute thought and feeling, as also in the discharge of feeling into action, we no less found this principle conspicuous. Nor did we discover any exception to it in the movements, temporary and permanent, that go on in societies. From the universal coexistence of opposing forces, there also resulted the rhythm of motion. It was shown that this is displayed from the infinitesimal vibrations of molecules up to the enormous revolutions and gyrations of planets; that it is traceable throughout all meteorologic and geologic changes; that the functions of every organic body exemplify it in various forms; that mental activities too, intellectual and emotional, exhibit periodicities of sundry kinds; and that actions and reactions illustrating this law under a still more complex form, pervade social processes.
We began by examining the core concepts of correlation and equivalence among forces. We explored how noticeable motion arises from unnoticed motion, and vice versa, as well as how forms of unnoticed motion—like Light, Heat, Electricity, Magnetism, and Chemical Action—reciprocally produce each other. This is now an accepted idea that leads to certain conclusions about the processes happening all around us. Starting with the assumption that the unnoticed motion emitted by the Sun is transformed from the noticeable motion lost during the Sun’s mass concentration, we observed that this unnoticed motion generates various types of noticeable motion on the Earth's surface. In addition to the inorganic changes on Earth, we found that the changes that form organic life originate in the same way. We concluded that vital phenomena, both mental and physical, also fall under this category. It seemed inevitable to suggest that similar descriptions apply to social changes as well. Next, we recognized that the phenomena we observe are products of Force, which presents itself in two forms: attraction and repulsion. From this, we derived the general law that all Motion must occur along the path of least resistance, in the direction of the strongest attraction, or in the direction dictated by their combination. This law is illustrated constantly in the movements of celestial bodies. The countless movements of matter—whether gas, liquid, or solid—taking place on the Earth’s surface were shown to adhere to this law. We provided evidence that this same fundamental principle of motion is involved in the structural and functional changes of living organisms. Throughout the series of nervous activities that form thought and emotion, as well as the expression of those feelings into actions, this principle was clearly present. We found no exceptions to it in the temporary and permanent movements occurring within societies. The universal coexistence of opposing forces also leads to the rhythm of motion. We demonstrated that this rhythm is present in everything from tiny molecular vibrations to the massive rotations of planets; it's observable in all meteorological and geological changes; the functions of every living organism reflect it in various ways; mental activities, both intellectual and emotional, show different types of periodicity; and that actions and reactions demonstrating this law in even more complex forms are prevalent in social processes.
Such being the principles to which conform all changes produced by Force on the distribution of Matter, and all 493changes re-actively produced by Matter on the distribution of Force, we proceeded to inquire what must be the consequent nature of any re-distributions produced: having first noted the limiting conditions between which such re-distributions are possible, and the medium conditions that are most favourable to them. The first conclusion arrived at, was, that any finite homogeneous aggregate must inevitably lose its homogeneity, through the unequal exposure of its parts to incident forces. We observed how this was shown in surrounding things, by the habitual establishment of differences between inner and outer parts, and parts otherwise dissimilarly circumstanced. It was pointed out that the production of diversities of structure by forces acting under diverse conditions, has been illustrated in astronomic evolution, supposing such evolution to have taken place; and that a like connection of cause and effect is seen in the large and small modifications undergone by our globe. In the early changes of organic germs, we discovered further evidence that unlikenesses of structure follow unlikenesses of relations to surrounding agencies—evidence enforced by the tendency of the differently-placed members of each species to diverge into varieties. We found that the principle is also conformed to in the establishment of distinctions among our ideas; and that the contrasts, political and industrial, that arise between the parts of societies are no less in harmony with it. The instability of the homogeneous thus caused, and thus everywhere exemplified, we also saw must hold of the unlike parts into which any uniform whole lapses; and that so the less heterogeneous must tend continually to become more heterogeneous—an inference which we also found to be everywhere confirmed by fact. Carrying a step further our inquiry into these actions and reactions between Force and Matter, there was disclosed a secondary cause of increasing multiformity. Every differentiated part becomes, we found, a parent of further differentiations; not only in the sense that it must lose its own homogeneity in heterogeneity, 494but also in the sense that it must, in growing unlike other parts, become a centre of unlike reactions on incident forces; and by so adding to the diversity of forces at work, must add to the diversity of effects produced. This multiplication of effects, likewise proved to be manifest throughout all Nature. That forces modified in kind and direction by every part of every aggregate, are gradually expended in working changes that grow more numerous and more varied as the forces are subdivided, is shown in the actions and reactions going on throughout the Solar System, in the never-ceasing geologic complications, in the involved symptoms produced in organisms by disturbing influences, in the many thoughts and feelings generated by single impressions, and in the ever-ramifying results of each new agency brought to bear on a society. To which add the corollary, confirmed by abundant facts, that the multiplication of effects must increase in a geometrical progression, as the heterogeneity increases. Completely to interpret the structural changes constituting Evolution, there remained to assign a reason for that increasingly-distinct demarcation of parts, which accompanies the production of differences between parts. This reason we discovered to be, the segregation of mixed units under the action of forces capable of moving them. We saw that when the parts of an aggregate have been made qualitatively unlike by unlike incident forces—that is, when they have become contrasted in the natures of their component units; there necessarily arises a tendency to separation of the dissimilar orders of units from each other, and to aggregation of those units which are similar. This cause of the integration that accompanies differentiation, turned out to be likewise exemplified by all kinds of Evolution—by the formation of celestial bodies, by the moulding of the Earth’s crust, by organic modifications, by the establishment of mental distinctions, by the genesis of social divisions. And we inferred, what we may everywhere see, that the segregation thus produced goes on so 495long as there remains a possibility of making it more complete. At length, to the query whether the processes thus traced out have any limit, there came the answer that they must end in equilibration. That continual division and subdivision of forces, which is instrumental in changing the uniform into the multiform and the multiform into the more multiform, we saw to be at the same time a process by which force is perpetually dissipated; and that dissipation, continuing as long as there remains any force unbalanced by an opposing force, must end in rest. It was shown that when, as happens with aggregates of various orders, a number of movements are going on in combination, the earlier dispersion of the smaller and more resisted movements, entails the establishment of different kinds of moving equilibria: forming transitional stages on the way to complete equilibrium. And further inquiry made it apparent that for the same reason, these moving equilibria have a certain self-conserving power; shown in the neutralization of perturbations, and the adjustment to new conditions. This general principle, like the preceding ones, proved to be traceable throughout all forms of Evolution—astronomic, geologic, biologic, mental and social. And our concluding inference was, that the penultimate stage of this process, in which the extremest degree of multiformity and completest form of moving equilibrium is established, must be one implying the highest conceivable state of humanity.
The principles we've discussed explain how Force affects the distribution of Matter and how Matter, in turn, influences the distribution of Force. We then looked into what changes can happen as a result, first outlining the limits within which these changes are possible and the conditions that favor them. Our first conclusion was that any uniform collection must eventually lose its uniformity due to the unequal exposure of its parts to various forces. We noticed this in our surroundings, where differences between inner and outer parts and other differing situations are commonly established. We pointed out that variations in structure caused by forces acting under different conditions can be seen in astronomical evolution, assuming that evolution has occurred. A similar relationship of cause and effect is evident in the various changes our planet has undergone. In early organic developments, we found further evidence showing that structural differences arise from differing relations to external influences—this was supported by the tendency of differently positioned members of each species to evolve into different varieties. We also found that this principle applies to how we form distinctions in our ideas and to the political and industrial contrasts that appear within societies. The instability created by this loss of uniformity, clearly seen everywhere, also applies to the differing parts into which any uniform whole can break down. Therefore, the less diverse parts must always trend toward greater diversity—something we found consistently supported by evidence. Taking our inquiry further into the interactions between Force and Matter, we revealed a secondary cause contributing to increasing diversity. We observed that every distinct part becomes a source of further differentiation; not only must it lose its own uniformity, but as it diverges from other parts, it becomes a center of distinct reactions to incoming forces. This increases the diversity of forces at play, which in turn adds to the diversity of effects produced. This multiplication of effects is evident throughout Nature. Different forces, altered in type and direction by every part of every group, are gradually used up as they create changes that grow more numerous and varied as the forces are subdivided. This is demonstrated in the actions and reactions occurring throughout the Solar System, the ongoing geological complexities, the varied responses in organisms caused by disturbances, the different thoughts and feelings generated from single impressions, and the extensive results of each new influence introduced to a society. Additionally, we confirmed that the multiplication of effects increases geometrically as diversity grows. To fully explain the structural changes that embody Evolution, we needed to clarify the reason behind the increasingly clear differences between parts that come with producing disparities. We discovered that this reason is the segregation of mixed units influenced by forces that can move them. We saw that when the parts of a collection become qualitatively different due to different incoming forces—that is, when their component units contrast with each other—they naturally tend to separate into groups of dissimilar units and to aggregate similar units. This cause of integration accompanying differentiation was also observed across various forms of Evolution—such as the formation of celestial bodies, the shaping of the Earth's surface, modifications in living organisms, the establishment of mental distinctions, and the emergence of social divisions. We concluded, as observable everywhere, that this segregation continues as long as there is a possibility to make it more complete. Finally, when we asked whether these processes have any limit, we found that they will eventually lead to balance. The continuous division and subdivision of forces, which transforms uniformity into diversity and then into greater diversity, also serves as a means by which force is consistently dissipated. This dissipation persists as long as there is any force not balanced by an opposing one, ultimately leading to stillness. It was shown that when different types of movements occur together within various aggregates, the earlier dispersal of smaller and more resisted movements results in the establishment of different kinds of moving balances, serving as transitional phases toward complete equilibrium. Further investigation revealed that these moving balances have a certain self-sustaining quality, evident in their ability to neutralize disturbances and adjust to new circumstances. This general principle, like the others we discussed, is traceable throughout all forms of Evolution—whether astronomical, geological, biological, mental, or social. Our final conclusion was that the next-to-last stage in this process, characterized by the highest degree of diversity and the most complete form of moving balance, must lead to the highest conceivable state of humanity.
Thus it became apparent that this transformation of on indefinite, incoherent homogeneity into a definite coherent heterogeneity, which goes on everywhere, until it brings about a reverse transformation, is consequent on certain simple laws of force. Given those universal modes of action which are from moment to moment illustrated in the commonest changes around us, and it follows that there cannot but result the observed metamorphosis of an indeterminate uniformity into a determinate multiformity.
Thus, it became clear that the shift from a vague, chaotic sameness to a well-defined, organized diversity, which occurs everywhere, eventually leads to a reverse change. This is based on certain simple laws of force. Given those universal patterns of action that are illustrated in the most common changes around us, it follows that the observed transformation from an unclear uniformity to a clear variety must occur.
496§ 141. Finally, we have asked whether, for these universal modes of action, any common cause is assignable—whether these wide truths are dependent on any single widest truth. And to this question we found a positive answer. These several principles are corollaries from that primordial principle which transcends human intelligence by underlying it.
496§ 141. Lastly, we inquired if there's any shared cause for these universal ways of acting—whether these broad truths rely on a single overarching truth. We found a clear answer to this question. These various principles are derived from that fundamental principle which goes beyond human understanding by supporting it.
In the first part of this work it was shown, by analysis of both our religious and our scientific ideas, that while knowledge of the cause which produces effects on our consciousness is impossible, the existence of a cause for these effects is a datum of consciousness. Though Being is cognizable by us only under limits of Time and Space, yet Being without limits of Time and Space was proved to be the indefinite cognition forming the necessary basis of our definite cognitions. We saw that the belief in an Omnipresent Power of which no commencement or cessation can be conceived, is that fundamental element in Religion which survives all its changes of form. We saw that all Philosophies avowedly or tacitly recognize this same ultimate truth:—that while the Relativist rightly repudiates those definite assertions which the Absolutist makes respecting real existence, he is yet at last compelled to unite with him in predicating real existence. And this inexpugnable consciousness in which Religion and Philosophy are at one with Common Sense, proved to be likewise that on which all exact Science is founded. We found that subjective Science can give no account of those conditioned modes of existence which constitute consciousness, without postulating unconditioned existence. And we found that objective Science can give no account of the existence which we know as external, without regarding its changes of form as manifestations of an existence that continues constant under all forms. Absolute Being, or Being which persists without beginning or end, was shown to be the common datum of all human thought; for the sufficient reason that the consciousness of it cannot be suppressed, without the suppression of consciousness itself.
In the first part of this work, we analyzed both our religious and scientific ideas and showed that although it's impossible to know the cause behind the effects on our consciousness, we are aware that there is a cause for these effects. While we can only understand Being within the limits of Time and Space, we demonstrated that Being beyond these limits is the undefined knowledge that serves as the necessary foundation for our specific understandings. We found that belief in an Omnipresent Power, which cannot be thought of as having a beginning or an end, is a fundamental aspect of Religion that endures through all its changes in form. We saw that all Philosophies, whether they acknowledge it or not, recognize this same ultimate truth: that while the Relativist correctly rejects the specific claims of the Absolutist about real existence, he ultimately must join him in affirming real existence. This undeniable understanding, where Religion and Philosophy align with Common Sense, also proved to be the basis of all precise Science. We established that subjective Science cannot explain the conditioned states of existence that make up consciousness without assuming unconditioned existence. Likewise, we found that objective Science cannot account for the existence we perceive as external without treating its changing forms as expressions of a consistent existence that remains unchanged through all forms. Absolute Being, or Being that exists without beginning or end, was shown to be the shared understanding of all human thought; because the awareness of it cannot be repressed without suppressing consciousness itself.
497From this truth which transcends proof, we have seen that the general principles above set down, are deducible. That the power or force manifested to us in all phenomena, continues unaltered in quantity, however its mode of manifestation be altered, is a proposition in which these several propositions are involved. It was shown that on the Persistence of Force are based the demonstrations that Matter is indestructible and Motion continuous. When its proofs were examined, the correlation and equivalence of forces was found to follow from the Persistence of Force. The necessity we are under of conceiving Force under the two-fold form of attraction and repulsion, turns out to be but an implication of the necessity we are under of conceiving Force as persistent. On the Persistence of Force, we saw that the law of direction of Motion is dependent; and from it also we saw that the rhythm of Motion necessarily results. Passing to those changes of distribution which, by the Motion it generates, Force produces in Matter, it was pointed out that from the Persistence of Force are severally deducible, the instability of the homogeneous, the multiplication of effects, and that increasing definiteness of structure to which continuous differentiation and integration leads. And lastly we saw that Force being persistent, Evolution cannot cease until equilibrium is reached; and that equilibrium must eventually be reached.
497From this truth that goes beyond proof, we have seen that the general principles mentioned above can be deduced. The idea that the power or force revealed to us in all phenomena remains unchanged in quantity, even if its form of manifestation changes, is a statement that includes several propositions. It has been demonstrated that the Persistence of Force is the foundation for the assertions that Matter is indestructible and Motion is continuous. When we examined its proofs, we discovered that the correlation and equivalence of forces stem from the Persistence of Force. The necessity for us to think of Force in terms of both attraction and repulsion is simply a consequence of our need to view Force as persistent. Based on the Persistence of Force, we saw that the direction of Motion depends on this law; and we also observed that the rhythm of Motion naturally follows. When we look at the changes in distribution caused by the Motion generated by Force in Matter, it was highlighted that from the Persistence of Force can be deduced the instability of the homogeneous, the multiplication of effects, and the increasing clarity of structure that results from continuous differentiation and integration. Finally, we determined that since Force is persistent, Evolution cannot stop until equilibrium is achieved; and that equilibrium will eventually be attained.
So that given Force manifested in Time and Space, under the forms of Matter and Motion; and it is demonstrable, à priori, that there must go on such transformations as we find going on.
So, that given Force showed up in Time and Space, through the forms of Matter and Motion; and it's clear, a priori, that such transformations must continue as we observe them happening.
§ 142. See then the accumulation of proofs. The advance of human intelligence in establishing laws continually wider in generality, raises the presumption that there are all-comprehensive laws. Turning to the facts, we discern a pervading uniformity in the general course of things where this can be watched, and indications of such uniformity where it 498cannot be watched. Considering this uniformity analytically, we find it to result from certain simpler uniformities in the actions of Force. And these uniformities prove to be so many necessary implications of that primordial truth which underlies all knowledge—the Persistence of Force. The aspect of things raises a presumption; extended observations lead to an induction that fulfils this presumption; this induction is deductively confirmed; and the laws whence it is deduced are corollaries from that datum without which thought is impossible.
§ 142. Look at the growing body of evidence. The evolution of human understanding in creating laws that are increasingly broad suggests the existence of universal laws. When we examine the facts, we can observe a consistent pattern in the overall flow of events where it's observable, and signs of such consistency where it isn't. Analyzing this uniformity reveals that it comes from certain simpler patterns in the actions of Force. These patterns turn out to be necessary outcomes of the fundamental truth that supports all knowledge—the Persistence of Force. The situation suggests a hypothesis; further observations lead to an inference that supports this hypothesis; this inference is confirmed through deduction; and the laws derived from it are consequences of that fundamental principle, without which thought would not be possible.
No higher degree of verification than this can be imagined. An induction based on facts so numerous and varied, and falling short of universality only where the facts are beyond observation, possesses of itself a validity greater than that of most scientific inductions. When it is shown that the proposition thus arrived at à posteriori, may also be arrived at à priori, starting from certain simple laws of force; it is raised to a level with those generalizations of concrete science which are accepted as proved. And when these simple laws of force are affiliated upon that ultimate truth which transcends proof; this dependent proposition takes rank with those propositions of abstract science which are our types of the greatest conceivable certainty.
No higher degree of verification than this can be imagined. An induction based on facts that are so numerous and varied, and only falling short of universality when the facts are beyond observation, has a validity greater than that of most scientific inductions. When it's shown that the proposition reached after the fact can also be reached a priori, starting from certain simple laws of force, it is elevated to the same level as those generalizations of concrete science that are accepted as proven. And when these simple laws of force are connected to that ultimate truth which goes beyond proof, this dependent proposition is placed alongside those propositions of abstract science that represent our examples of the highest conceivable certainty.
Let no one suppose that any such degree of certainty is alleged of the various minor propositions brought in illustration of the general argument. Such an assumption would be so manifestly absurd, that it seems scarcely needful to disclaim it. But the truth of the doctrine as a whole, is unaffected by errors in the details of its presentation. As the first principles of mathematics are not invalidated by mistakes made in working out particular equations; so the first principles set forth in the foregoing pages, do not stand or fall with each special statement made in them. If it can be shown that the Persistence of Force is not a datum of consciousness; or if it can be shown that the several laws of force above specified are not corollaries from it; then, indeed, 499it will be shown that the theory of Evolution has not the certainty here claimed for it. But nothing short of this can invalidate the general conclusions arrived at.
Let no one think that we claim any kind of certainty about the various minor points made to illustrate the broader argument. Such a belief would be so obviously ridiculous that it hardly needs to be denied. However, the truth of the overall doctrine remains unaffected by mistakes in how it’s presented. Just as the basic principles of mathematics remain valid even if errors occur in solving specific equations, the foundational principles discussed in the previous pages do not depend on the accuracy of every individual assertion made about them. If it can be proven that the Persistence of Force is not something we can directly observe, or if it can be shown that the different laws of force mentioned earlier are not derived from it, then it will indeed prove that the theory of Evolution does not have the certainty we claim for it. But nothing less than that can undermine the general conclusions reached.
§ 143. If these conclusions be accepted—if it be admitted that they inevitably follow from the truth transcending all others in authority—if it be agreed that the phenomena going on everywhere are parts of the general process of Evolution, save where they are parts of the reverse process of Dissolution; then it must be inferred that all phenomena receive their complete interpretation, only when recognized as parts of these processes. Regarded from the point of view here reached, each change that takes place, is an incident in the course of the ever-complicating distribution of Matter and Motion, except where it is an incident in the course of the reverse distribution; and each such change is fully understood, only when brought under those universal principles of change, to which these transformations necessarily conform. Whence, indeed, it appears to be an unavoidable conclusion, that the limit towards which Science is advancing, must be reached when these formulæ are made all-comprehensive. Manifestly, the perfection of Science, is a state in which all phenomena are seen to be necessary implications of the Persistence of Force. In such a state, the dependence of each phenomenon on the Persistence of Force, must be proved either directly or indirectly—either by showing that it is a corollary of the Persistence of Force, or by showing that it is a corollary from some general proposition deduced from the Persistence of Force. And since all phenomena are incidents in the re-distributions of Matter and Motion; and since there are certain general principles, deducible from the Persistence of Force, to which all these re-distributions conform; it seems inferrable that ultimately all phenomena, where not classed as consequences of the Persistence of Force, must be classed as consequences of these derivative principles.
§ 143. If we accept these conclusions—if we agree that they inevitably follow from the truth that surpasses all others in authority—if we conclude that the phenomena occurring everywhere are parts of the overall process of Evolution, except where they are parts of the opposite process of Dissolution; then we can infer that all phenomena are fully understood only when recognized as parts of these processes. From this perspective, every change that occurs is an event in the increasingly complex distribution of Matter and Motion, unless it is an event in the reverse distribution; and each such change is only fully understood when it aligns with those universal principles of change that these transformations necessarily adhere to. Therefore, it seems to be an unavoidable conclusion that the goal of Science is reached when these formulas are made all-encompassing. Clearly, the ultimate perfection of Science is a state where all phenomena are viewed as necessary implications of the Persistence of Force. In this state, the relationship of each phenomenon to the Persistence of Force must be demonstrated either directly or indirectly—either by showing that it is a corollary of the Persistence of Force or by showing that it follows from some general proposition derived from the Persistence of Force. And since all phenomena are events in the re-distributions of Matter and Motion; and since certain general principles can be deduced from the Persistence of Force that all these re-distributions align with; it seems that ultimately all phenomena, when not categorized as consequences of the Persistence of Force, must be categorized as consequences of these derived principles.
500§ 144. Of course this development of Science into an organized aggregate of direct and indirect deductions from the Persistence of Force, can be achieved only in the remote future; and indeed cannot be completely achieved even then. Scientific progress, is progress in that equilibration of thought and things which we saw is going on, and must continue to go on; but which cannot arrive at perfection in any finite period, because it advances more slowly the further it advances. But though Science can never be entirely reduced to this form; and though only at a far distant time can it be brought nearly to this form; yet much may even now be done in the way of rude approximation. Those who are familiar with the present aspects of Science, must recognize in them the broken outlines of a general organization. The possibility of arranging the facts already accumulated, into the order rudely exhibited in the foregoing pages, will itself incline them to the belief that our knowledge may be put into a more connected shape than it at present has. They will see the probability that many now isolated inductions, may be reduced to the form of deductions from first principles. They will suspect that inferences drawn from the ultimate laws of force, will lead to the investigation and generalization of classes of facts hitherto unexamined. And they will feel, not only that a greater degree of certainty must be acquired by Science, as fast as its propositions are directly or indirectly deduced from the highest of all truths; but also that it must so be rendered a more efficient agent of further inquiry.
500§ 144. Obviously, this development of Science into a well-organized collection of direct and indirect conclusions based on the Persistence of Force can only happen far in the future; and even then, it won't be fully realized. Scientific progress is really about improving the balance between our understanding and the realities of the world, which we noted is taking place and will continue to do so; however, it won't achieve perfection in any limited timeframe because it progresses more slowly as it advances further. Although Science can never be entirely shaped into this form, and although it can only approach this form over a long period, there's still a lot that can be done now in the way of rough approximation. Those who are familiar with the current state of Science will recognize in it the incomplete outlines of a broader organization. The ability to arrange the facts we've already gathered into the rough order presented in the preceding pages will suggest to them that our knowledge can be organized more coherently than it currently is. They will see the likelihood that many of the currently isolated conclusions might be connected back to foundational principles. They will suspect that insights drawn from the fundamental laws of force will prompt the exploration and classification of types of facts that have yet to be studied. And they will understand that not only must Science achieve a greater degree of certainty as its statements are derived from the ultimate truths, but it must also become a more effective tool for further investigation.
To bring scientific knowledge to such degree of logical coherence as is at present possible, is a task to be achieved only by the combined efforts of many. No one man can possess that encyclopedic information required for rightly arranging even the truths already established. But as progress is effected by increments—as all organization, beginning in faint and blurred outlines, is completed by successive modifications and additions; advantage may accrue from an 501attempt, however rude, to reduce the facts already accumulated—or rather certain classes of them—to something like co-ordination. Such must be the plea for the several volumes which are to succeed this.
To achieve a level of logical coherence in scientific knowledge that is currently possible requires the combined efforts of many people. No single person can have the extensive information necessary to properly organize even the truths that have already been established. However, since progress happens in small steps—just as all organization starts with vague and unclear outlines and is refined through continuous changes and additions—there can be benefits from an attempt, no matter how rough, to organize the facts that have already been gathered—or at least some categories of them—into a more coordinated structure. This must be the rationale for the various volumes that will follow.
§ 145. A few closing words must be said, concerning the general bearings of the doctrines that are now to be further developed. Before proceeding to interpret the detailed phenomena of Life, and Mind, and Society, in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force, the reader must be reminded in what sense the interpretations are to be accepted. In spite of everything said at the outset, there are probably some who have gained the impression that those most general truths set forth in the preceding chapters, together with the truths deducible from them, claim to be something more than relative truths. And, notwithstanding all evidence to the contrary, there will probably have arisen in not a few minds, the conviction that the solutions which have been given, along with those to be derived from them, are essentially materialistic. Let none persist in these misconceptions.
§ 145. A few final thoughts are necessary regarding the overall implications of the ideas that are about to be expanded upon. Before diving into the detailed analysis of Life, Mind, and Society in relation to Matter, Motion, and Force, it's important to clarify how these interpretations should be understood. Despite what has been stated previously, some may have the impression that the broad truths discussed in the earlier chapters, along with the truths that can be drawn from them, are claimed to be more than just relative truths. Furthermore, despite all evidence to the contrary, many might believe that the provided solutions, as well as the ones that can be inferred from them, are fundamentally materialistic. Let no one cling to these misunderstandings.
As repeatedly shown in various ways, the deepest truths we can reach, are simply statements of the widest uniformities in our experience of the relations of Matter, Motion, and Force; and Matter, Motion, and Force are but symbols of the Unknown Reality. That Power of which the nature remains for ever inconceivable, and to which no limits in Time or Space can be imagined, works in us certain effects. These effects have certain likenesses of kind, the most general of which we class together under the names of Matter, Motion, and Force; and between these effects there are likenesses of connection, the most constant of which we class as laws of the highest certainty. Analysis reduces these several kinds of effect to one kind of effect; and these several kinds of uniformity to one kind of uniformity. And the highest achievement of Science is the interpretation of all orders of phenomena, as differently-conditioned manifestations 502of this one kind of effect, under differently-conditioned modes of this one kind of uniformity. But when Science has done this, it has done nothing more than systematize our experience; and has in no degree extended the limits of our experience. We can say no more than before, whether the uniformities are as absolutely necessary, as they have become to our thought relatively necessary. The utmost possibility for us, is an interpretation of the process of things as it presents itself to our limited consciousness; but how this process is related to the actual process, we are unable to conceive, much less to know.
As has been shown in many ways, the deepest truths we can discover are simply statements about the broad patterns we observe in our experiences of Matter, Motion, and Force; and Matter, Motion, and Force are just symbols for the Unknown Reality. That Power, the nature of which is forever beyond our understanding and which has no limits in Time or Space, produces certain effects in us. These effects share certain similarities, the most general of which we group together under the terms Matter, Motion, and Force; and among these effects, there are consistent connections, the most reliable of which we identify as laws of the highest certainty. Analysis breaks these different types of effects down to one kind of effect; and these various types of uniformity down to one kind of uniformity. The highest achievement of Science is to interpret all types of phenomena as differently-conditioned manifestations of this one type of effect, under differently-conditioned modes of this one type of uniformity. However, after Science has accomplished this, it has simply organized our experience and hasn't expanded the boundaries of our experience at all. We can't say any more than we could before whether these uniformities are as absolutely necessary as they seem relatively necessary to our thoughts. Our ultimate possibility is to interpret the process of things as it appears to our limited awareness; but how this process relates to the actual process, we cannot conceive, let alone know.
Similarly, it must be remembered that while the connection between the phenomenal order and the ontological order is for ever inscrutable; so is the connection between the conditioned forms of being and the unconditioned form of being, for ever inscrutable. The interpretation of all phenomena in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force, is nothing more than the reduction of our complex symbols of thought, to the simplest symbols; and when the equation has been brought to its lowest terms the symbols remain symbols still. Hence the reasonings contained in the foregoing pages, afford no support to either of the antagonist hypotheses respecting the ultimate nature of things. Their implications are no more materialistic than they are spiritualistic; and no more spiritualistic than they are materialistic. Any argument which is apparently furnished to either hypothesis, is neutralized by as good an argument furnished to the other. The Materialist, seeing it to be a necessary deduction from the law of correlation, that what exists in consciousness under the form of feeling, is transformable into an equivalent of mechanical motion, and by consequence into equivalents of all the other forces which matter exhibits; may consider it therefore demonstrated that the phenomena of consciousness are material phenomena. But the Spiritualist, setting out with the same data, may argue with equal cogency, that if the forces displayed by matter are cognizable only under the 503shape of those equivalent amounts of consciousness which they produce, it is to be inferred that these forces, when existing out of consciousness, are of the same intrinsic nature as when existing in consciousness; and that so is justified the spiritualistic conception of the external world, as consisting of something essentially identical with what we call mind. Manifestly, the establishment of correlation and equivalence between the forces of the outer and the inner worlds, may be used to assimilate either to the other; according as we set out with one or other term. But he who rightly interprets the doctrine contained in this work, will see that neither of these terms can be taken as ultimate. He will see that though the relation of subject and object renders necessary to us these antithetical conceptions of Spirit and Matter; the one is no less than the other to be regarded as but a sign of the Unknown Reality which underlies both.
Similarly, it should be noted that while the link between the observable world and the ultimate nature of reality is always mysterious, so is the connection between conditioned modes of existence and the unconditioned state of being, equally inscrutable. The interpretation of all phenomena in terms of Matter, Motion, and Force is simply a simplification of our complex thought symbols into the most basic forms; and even when the equation is simplified to its lowest terms, the symbols are still just symbols. Therefore, the reasoning in the previous pages does not favor either of the opposing theories regarding the fundamental nature of things. Their implications are neither strictly materialistic nor strictly spiritualistic; and they are equally spiritualistic as they are materialistic. Any argument that seemingly supports one theory is countered by equally valid arguments for the other. The Materialist may conclude that, as a necessary deduction from the law of correlation, feelings that exist in consciousness can be transformed into equivalent mechanical motion and, in turn, into equivalents of all other forces present in matter; thus, they may assert that consciousness phenomena are material phenomena. However, the Spiritualist, starting from the same data, can argue just as convincingly that if the forces demonstrated by matter can only be recognized through the equivalent amounts of consciousness they produce, it suggests that these forces, when not perceived in consciousness, possess the same intrinsic nature as when they are within consciousness; thereby justifying the spiritualistic view of the external world as consisting of something fundamentally akin to what we refer to as mind. Clearly, establishing a correlation and equivalence between the forces of the outer and inner worlds can be used to equate one with the other, depending on which perspective we choose to start with. But anyone who rightly understands the doctrine presented in this work will realize that neither of these perspectives can be viewed as ultimate. They will understand that while the relationship between subject and object necessitates these opposing notions of Spirit and Matter, each is merely a representation of the Unknown Reality that underlies both.
TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES
- Changed “which takes place” to “which take place” on p. 315.
- Duplicated the large spaces in the original text.
- Silently corrected typographical errors.
- Retained anachronistic and non-standard spellings as printed.
Download ePUB
If you like this ebook, consider a donation!